Skip to main content

Full text of "Natural science"

See other formats


■'  •     -.  I 


yf 


h ,  - 


443 


% 


« 


&c  <*■*■ 


1 


% 


*  ' 


OO 


P» 


;*, 


»s< 


o 


'^, 


■« 


«& 


ALL  RIGHTS  RESERVED 


NATURAL 
SCIENCE 


A   MONTHLY  REVIEW  OF 
SCIENTIFIC    PROGRESS 


VOL.    XL 

JULY  — DECEMBER    1897 


LONDON 

J.    M.    DENT    &    CO. 

(57   SAINT   JAMES'S    STREET,    S.W. 


<?*.  6 <f[ t.  <&*>- *¥ 


h^* 


SUBJECT  INDEX  TO  ARTICLES 

These  titles  may  be  cut  out  and  pasted  on  cards  for  a  slip-catalogue. 
Those  who  do  not  wish  to  use  the  decimal  notation  as  a  guide  to 
the  subject  matter  can  cut  oft*  the  numbers. 

507  Bolton,  H.    The  Provincial  Museum.— Nat.  Sci.,  XL,  387    Dec,  1897 

550.1  Howorth,   H.   H.     A   New   Scheme  of  Geological  Arrangement  anil 

Nomenclature.— Nat.  Sri.,  XL,  321  Nov.,  1897 

551.47(98)  Smith,  B.  L.     Note  on  tin'  warm  Undercurrent  in  the  Arctic  Ocean 

between  Greenland  and  Spitsbergen. — Nat.  Sci.,  XL,  Is 

July,  1897 

551.79  Oldham,  R.  D.     The  Facetted  Pebbles  of  India.—  Nat.  Sci.,  XL,  197 

Sept.,  1897 

565.3  Bernard,  H.  M.     Fossil  Apodidae.  —Nat.  Sci.,  XL,  397         Dec,  1897 

567  Lankester,  E.  R.     TheTaxonomic  Position  of  the  Pteraspidap,  Cephal- 

aspidae,  and  Asterolepidae. — Nat.  Sci.,  XL,  45  July,  1897 

568  Ridewood,  W.  G.     On  the  Restoration   of  Some  Extinct   Reptiles.— 

Nat.  Sci.,  XL,  190  Sept.,  1897 

569.(8)  Ameghino,  F.     South  America  as  the  Source  of  the  Tertiary  Mammalia. 

— Nat.  Sri.,  XL,  256  Oct.,  1897 

571.1  Cunnington,  W.     The  Authenticity  of  Plateau  Man. — Nat.  Sci.,  XL. 

327  Nov.,  1897 

571.1  M'Kay,  G.  R.     Evidence  of  the  Antiquity  of  Man  in  East  London,  Cape 

Colony,  with  a  Note  on  the  Castor-Oil  Plant. — Nat.  Sci.,  XL, 
334  Nov.,  1897 


O  O  A 


571.93(42.25)     Abbott,  W.  J.  L.     Primeval  Refuse  Heaps  at  Hastings.— Nat.  Sci., 
XL,  40,  94  July,  Aug.,  1897 

572.(94.2)  'Theta.'     Initiation  Rites  of  the  Arunta  Tribe,   Central  Australia. — 

Nat.  Sri.,  XL,  119  Aug.,  1897 

575  Bulman,  G.  W.     Bees  and  the  Development  of  Flowers. — Nat.  Sri., 

XL.  100  Aug.,  1897 

575  Hyatt,  A.     The  Influence  of  Woman  in  the  Evolution  of  the  Human 

Race.— Nat.  Sci.,  XL,  89  Aug.,  1897 

575  Hutton,  F.  W.     The  Place  of  Isolation  in  Organic  Evolution.— Nat. 

Sri.,  XL,  240  Oct.,  1897 

575  Coste,  F.  H.  P.     Professor  Schiller  on  Darwinism  and  Design. — Nat. 

Sci.,  XL,  408  Dec,  1897 

575.1  Hartog,  M.     The   Fundamental   Principles   of  Heredity.— Nat.    Sri.. 

XL,  233,  305  Oct.,  Nov.,  1897 

575.1  Tayler,  J.  L.     The  Relation  of  Acquired  Modifications  to  Heredity. — 

Nat.  Sci.,  XL,  247  Oct.,  1E97 

575.2  Pearson,  K.     On  the  Scientific  Measure  of  Variability. — Nat.   Sci., 

XL.  115  Aug.,  1897 


SUBJECT  INDEX  TO  ARTICLES 

575.2  Tayler,  J.   L.     The  Relation  of  Acquired  Modifications  to  Heredity. 

— Nat.  Sci. ,  X I . ,  24  7  Oct. ,  1897 

575.3  Hutton,  F.  W.     The  Place  of  Isolation  in  Organic  Evolution. — Nat. 

Sci.,  XL,  240  Oct.,  1897 

575.4  Henslow,  G.     Does  Natural  Selection  play  any  part  in  the  Origin  of 

Species  among  Plants.— Afad.  Sci.,  XL,  166  Sept.,  1897 

575.8  Jordan,    K.      Reproductive   Divergence.      A    Factor   in    Evolution? — 

Nat.  Sci.,  XL,  317  Nov.,  1897 

575.8  Yernon,  H.  M.     Reproductive  Divergence.     An  Additional  Factor  in 

Evolution.—  Nat.  Sci.,  XL,  181  Sept.,  1897 

575.8  Yernon,  H.  M.     Reproductive  Divergence.     A  Rejoinder. — Nat.   Sci., 

XL,  404  Dec,  1897 

576.3  Beer,  R.     Cell  or  Corpuscle?— Nat.  Sci.,  XL,  392  Dec,  1897 

581.1  Beer,  R.     The  Seed  Production  of  Cut  Flowers.— Nat.  Sci.,  XL,  337 

Nov.,  1897 

581.151  Klebs,  G.     Polymorphism  in  the  Algae.—  Nat.  Sci.,  XL,  107 

Aug.,  1897 

581.16  Bulman,  G.  W.     Bees  and  the  Development  of  Flowers. — Nat.  Sci., 

XL,  100  Aug.,  1897 

589.3  Klebs,  G.     Polymorphism  in  the  Algae. — Nat.  Sci.,  XL,  107 

Aug.  1897 

590.7(7)  Dean,  B.     A  Californian  Marine  Biological  Station. — Nat.  Sci.,  XL, 

28  July,  1897 

590.7(7)  Sclater,  P.  L.     The  Proposed  Zoological  Park  of  New  York.—  Nat. 

Sci.,  XL,  36  July,  1897 

591.15  Weldon,  W.  F.  R.     Karl  Pearson  on  Evolution.—  Nat.  Sci.,  XL,  50 

July,  1897 

591.9  Carpenter,  G.  H.     The  Problems  of  the  British  Fauna. — Nat.  Sci., 

XL,  375  Dec,  1897 

591.9(9)  Murray,  J.     On  the  Distribution  of  the  Pelagic  Foraminifera  at  the 

•    Surface  and  on  the   Floor  of  the   Ocean.—  Nat.    Sci.,   XL,    17 

July,  1897 

593.12  Murray,  J.     On  the  Distribution  of  the  Pelagic  Foraminifera  at  the 

Surface  and  on  the    Floor  of  the  Ocean. — Nat.   Sci.,   XL,    17 

July,  1897 

593.5  Stebbing,  T.  R.  R.     A  Carcinological  Campaign.— Nat.  Sci.,  XL,  251 

Oct.,  1897 

595.793  Bulman,  G.  W.     Bees  and  the  Development  of  Flowers.  —Nat.  Sci., 

XL,  100  Aug.,  1897 

599.9  Hyatt,  A.     The  Influence  of  Woman  in  the  Evolution  of  the  Human 

Race.—  Nat.  Sci.,  XL,  89  Aug.,  1897 

925.  Liitken,  C.  F.     Steenstrup.— Nat.  Sci.,  XL,  159  Sept.,  1897 


NATURAL  SCIENCE 

A  Monthly  Review  of  Scientific  Progress 


No.  65— Vol.  XI— JULY  1897 


NOTES  AND  COMMENTS 

The  Cambridge  Graces 

On  few  recent  educational  questions  have  we  felt  such  difficulty  in 
forming  an  opinion  as  on  the  proposal  that  the  women  students  at 
Cambridge  should  be  granted  the  degrees  for  which  they  may  have 
passed  the  examinations.  Anxious  that  the  opportunities  for  women's 
education  should  be  extended  in  every  way,  our  natural  sympathies 
were  in  favour  of  the  proposals.  There  can  be  no  doubt  that  those 
Girtonians  and  Newnhamites  who  enter  the  educational  profession 
would  find  it  a  great  advantage  to  have  a  Cambridge  degree.  To 
refuse  it  to  women  who  have  resided  at  Cambridge  for  the  necessary 
number  of  terms,  and  have  passed  all  the  prescribed  examinations, 
seems  to  us  unfair  and  almost  churlish.  Women  who  have  done 
the  same  work  and  stood  the  same  tests  as  men,  should  surely  be 
allowed  the  same  certificate  of  efficiency.  It  seems  to  us  hopeless 
to  expect  that  popular  opinion  will  ever  estimate  a  Girton  certificate 
as  of  equal  value  to  a  Cambridge  degree,  while  the  university 
refuses  the  latter.  The  present  position  of  women  students  at 
Cambridge  seems  to  us  anomalous,  illogical,  and  very  unfair.  But 
we  doubt  if  the  proposed  changes  would  have  improved  matters. 
No  one  denies  that  had  the  graces  been  passed,  there  would  have 
been  a  great  increase  in  the  number  of  women  students  at  Cambridge. 
It  is  affirmed  by  some  Cambridge  authorities,  whose  opinions  are 
usually  entitled  to  respect,  that  the  admission  of  women  would  have 
been  followed  by  a  considerable  decrease  in  the  number  of  male 
undergraduates.  Suppose  that  in  ten  or  twenty  years'  time,  there 
are  half  as  many  women  students  as  men.  It  would  then  be 
intolerable  that  the  tutors  and  lecturers  at  the  women's  colleges  and 
halls  should  have  no  voice  in  arranging  the  courses  of  study.  If 
women  be  allowed  the  examinations  and  degrees,  and  form  a  third 
of  the  registered  students,  it  would  be  quite  unfair  that  they  should 
not  be  eligible  for  all  prizes  and  scholarships,  and  that  their 
interests  should  not  be  protected  by  direct  representation  on  the 


2  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [July 

boards  of  studies.  We  should  not  grudge  the  women  any  prizes  that 
they  won.  The  competition  of  the  best  women  would  do  the  men 
nothing  but  good.  The  danger  is  that  alterations  would  be  made 
in  the  interests  of  the  weaker  of  the  women,  which  might  enable 
men  to  gain  degrees  with  even  less  work  than  at  present.  More- 
over, a  course  of  study  suitable  for  men  may  not  be  suitable  for 
women.  So  long  as  women  only  enter  for  the  tripos  examinations, 
this  objection  is  not  serious.  But  if  women  are  to  have  degrees,  it 
would  be  absurd  to  allow  men  to  take  an  easy  poll  degree,  and 
restrict  women  to  the  tripos.  The  training  for  an  ordinary  Cam- 
bridge degree  may  not  be  an  ideal  education  for  men,  although  it 
may  do  well  enough  for  the  average  curate  and  country  gentleman. 
But  in  an  education  of  that  standard  the  requirements  of  men  and 
women  are  very  different.  If  women  are  to  be  admitted  to  poll 
degrees,  then  alterations  in  the  examinations  for  them  ought  to  be 
made.  Hence  we  are  inclined  to  prefer  a  separate  university  for 
women  to  a  mixed  university,  at  which  both  men  and  women  would 
have  to  put  up  with  an  hermaphrodite  education  suitable  for  neither. 
Moreover,  if  women  be  allowed  to  enter  the  university  and  share  in 
the  scholarships,  there  is  no  logical  reason  why  girls  should  not  be 
admitted  in  separate  classes  to  the  public  schools,  to  the  students  of 
which  so  many  of  the  best  scholarships  are  restricted. 

The  Woman  of  the  Future 

One  thing  is  still  lacking  to  "  the  new  woman."  It  is  a  beard. 
But  this,  according  to  Dr  A.  Brandt,  she  may  hope  to  have  in  the 
course  of  some  thousands,  possibly  hundreds,  of  years.  Many 
women  have  beards  already.  Some  take  a  pride  in  them,  and  utilise 
them  as  a  source  of  income  ;  others  keep  them  in  check  by  the  use 
of  depilatories,  of  forceps,  or  even  a  razor.  As  for  moustaches  they 
are  so  common  as  to  pass  without  remark,  and  a  tender  shade  upon 
the  upper  lip  of  a  brunette  may  even  be  regarded  as  an  added 
beauty.  Still,  at  the  present  period  in  the  evolution  of  our  race,  it 
is  for  the  most  part  in  old  age  that  the  beard  comes  to  woman. 
The  beard  does  not  appear  in  man  before  puberty,  and  increases  in 
strength  with  age,  often  compensating  for  a  loss  of  hair  on  the  head. 
Dr  Brandt,  therefore,  writing  in  the  Revue  Scicntifiquc  for  May  15, 
regards  the  beard  not  as  an  ancestral,  but  as  in  part  a  second  and 
in  part  a  senile  character.  Like  other  characters  that  first  appear 
late  in  the  life  of  individuals,  it  is  likely  to  be  accelerated  in  its 
development.  In  other  words,  hair  will  appear  on  the  face  at  an 
earlier  and  earlier  age,  as  time  goes  on,  both  in  men  and  women. 
"  Perhaps  a  day  will  dawn  when  we  shall  think  a  moustache  in  a 
woman  less  ugly  than  a  bust  deformed  by  the  corset." 


NATURAL  SCIENCE,    VOL.  XL 


Plate  I. 


^     tysprUu      ^ 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  3 

The  Contributors  to  the  '  Challenger  '  Beport.s 

The  fifty  volumes  of  the  '  Challenger '  reports  having  been  recently- 
completed,  a  complimentary  album  was  presented  to  the  editor, 
Dr  John  Murray,  by  his  colleagues.  The  album  was  itself  a 
work  of  art,  but  its  chief  interest  lay  in  the  circumstance  that 
it  contained  the  photographs  of  all  who  had  contributed  to  the 
literature  of  the  Eeports.  As  some  of  these  authors  are  no  longer 
among  us,  and  others  are  dispersed  over  the  four  quarters  of  the 
globe,  it  was  an  arduous  undertaking  to  fill  up  this  portrait-gallery 
of  scientific  worthies.  But  Mr  W.  E.  Hoyle,  as  Hon.  Secretary  to 
the  presentation  committee,  met  with  the  friendliest  response  to 
every  application,  and,  with  the  assistance  of  Mr  Walter  Crane  in  the 
artistic  department,  successfully  coped  with  all  the  difficulties  that 
arose,  whether  expected  or  unexpected.  After  so  much  trouble  had 
been  expended,  the  happy  thought  occurred  to  Mr  Hoyle  that  many 
who  might  never  have  a  chance  of  seeing  the  original  album,  gleam- 
ing in  purple  and  gold,  would  welcome  an  opportunity  of  possessing 
a  copy  of  its  contents.  The  Committee  warmly  approved  of  this 
suggestion,  and  the  result  is  seen  in  a  thin  quarto  volume  (price, 
12  s.  6cl),  uniform  in  size  and  binding  with  the  reports.  It  con- 
tains reduced  copies  of  the  88  portraits  on  19  plates,  together  with 
reproductions  in  black  and  white  of  Mr  Walter  Crane's  designs  for 
the  cover  and  dedication.  As  a  specimen  of  the  portraiture  we  are 
enabled  to  show  our  readers  a  likeness  of  the  late  Sir  C.  Wyville 
Thomson,  the  original  director  of  the  civilian  staff.  Whether  the 
small  edition  of  200  copies  will  suffice  for  all  who  will  wish  to 
possess  this  interesting  volume  may  be  doubted.  The  publishers 
are  Messrs  Dulau  &  Co. 


Phenacomys 

The  genus  Phenacomys  has  no  doubt  existed  at  least  as  long  as  the 
genus  Homo,  and  specimens  of  this  small  vole  may  even  have  been 
known  to  man,  and  have  been  hoarded  by  that  acquisitive  animal  in 
his  museums  for  a  considerable  period.  We  know,  in  fact,  that  a 
specimen  obtained  and  presented  by  Mr  J.  K.  Lord  of  the  North 
American  Boundary  Commission,  has  been  in  the  British  Museum 
since  1863.  None  the  less  so  short  a  time  as  eight  years  ago, 
zoologists  were  unaware  of  the  existence  of  this  genus,  although  the 
suspicions  of  a  few  may  have  been  aroused  by  Nehring's  descrip- 
tion, in  1883,  of  some  bones  and  teeth  found  in  a  cave  in  Southern 
Hungary.  Within  the  last  eight  years,  however,  no  less  than  nine 
living  species  of  the  genus  have  been  described,  all  from  Boreal 
North  America.     Ninety-five  specimens  have  been  at  the  disposal  of 


4  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [July 

Mr  Gerrit  S.  Miller,  jun.,  who,  in  the  Proceedings  of  the  Biological 
Society  of  Washington  (xi.,  pp.  77-87,  April  21,  1897),  considers 
that  there  are  six  valid  species.  These  fall  naturally  into  three 
groups,  each  of  which  occupies  a  different  geographic  region.  They 
generally  inhabit  dry,  grassy  plains  and  mountain  parks,  and, 
except  for  some  small  characters  in  the  teeth,  are  much  like  the 
ordinary  Microtus ;  from  the  humid  coast  district  of  Oregon,  how- 
ever, there  comes  a  long-tailed  form,  which  appears  to  be  strictly 
arboreal. 


The  Geographical  Distribution  of  the  Dragon-flies 

One  of  the  greatest  surprises  in  store  for  the  student  at  the 
outset  of  his  study  of  zoo-geography  is  the  discovery  that  animals 
so  different  in  their  powers  of  locomotion  as  mammalia  and  birds 
agree  nevertheless  so  closely  in  geographical  distribution,  that 
a  map  representing  the  zoological  areas  of  the  one  class,  will,  in  its 
broad  outlines,  be  equally  applicable  to  the  other.  The  obvious 
inference  to  be  drawn  from  this  circumstance,  the  inference,  namely, 
that  the  actual  means  of  progression,  whether  it  be  flight  or  swim- 
ming or  running,  are  far  less  important  factors  in  determining  the 
dispersal  of  species  than  one  would  be  led  on  a  'priori  grounds  to 
suppose,  is  still  further  supported  by  a  recent  paper  on  "  The 
Geographical  Distribution  of  Dragon-flies,"  published  by  Mr  G.  H. 
Carpenter  in  vol.  viii.  of  the  Scientific  Proceedings  of  the  Royal  Dublin 
Society.  Though  this  paper  is  chiefly  nothing  but  a  compilation 
from  Mr  W.  F.  Kirby's  catalogue  of  the  Odonata,  it  is  nevertheless 
a  valuable  piece  of  work,  since  it  represents  in  a  concise  and 
intelligible  form  the  range  of  all  the  genera  of  the  great  order  of 
powerful-flying  insects,  and  is  accompanied  by  a  map  showing  how 
closely  in  the  main  their  distribution  tallies  with  that  of  the  other 
orders  and  classes  of  terrestrial  animals  that  have  been  faunistically 
studied.  Seven  regions  are  recognised  :  the  Holarctic,  comprising 
the  Palaearctic  of  Sclater  and  Wallace,  phis  the  Nearctic  almost  down 
to  the  fortieth  parallel  of  latitude ;  the  Ethiopian ;  the  Mascarene  ; 
the  Oriental ;  the  Australian,  including  New  Zealand  ;  the  Sonoran  ;. 
and  the  Neotropical.  It  is  interesting  to  note  that  there  is  no 
evidence  of  a  Mediterranean  region  in  the  Old  World  corresponding 
to  the  Sonoran  of  the  New,  and  that  the  species  from  Madagascar 
are  no  more  Ethiopian  than  Oriental  in  their  affinities.  The  advo- 
cates of  Lemuria  may  get  some  satisfaction  from  the  latter  circum- 
stance; but  those  who  are  in  favour  of  an  Antarctic  area  will  not 
gain  much  support  from  the  dragon-flies,  since  the  species  of  these 
insects  that  inhabit  Patagonia,  Cape  Colony,  and  New  Zealand  bear 
no  witness  to  a  former  land  connection  between  these  countries. 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  5 

The  AuTiiRoroDs  of  Funafuti 

Part  II.  of  the  "  Memoir  on  the  Atoll  of  Funafuti,"  based  on 
collections  made  by  Mr  Charles  Hedley,  was  published  by  the 
Australian  Museum,  Sydney,  on  February  25,  1897.  Its  arrival 
gives  us  rather  a  shock,  for  we  were  under  the  impression 
that,  when  the  Royal  Society  invited  the  Australian  Museum  to 
send  a  naturalist  on  their  expedition,  a  stipulation  was  made  that 
the  representatives  of  the  Royal  Society  should  retain  the  right 
of  prior  publication.  If  such  an  agreement  was  not  made,  it  ought 
to  have  been,  in  the  interests  not  merely  of  justice,  but,  as  this 
publication  proves,  of  science  also. 

Mr  W.  J.  Rainbow  undertakes  to  describe  the  whole  of  the  land 
arthropods,  and  his  knowledge  is  scarcely  commensurate  with  the 
undertaking.  Whose  knowledge  could  be  ?  Probably  it  is  not  Mr 
Rainbow  who  is  to  blame,  but  the  authorities  of  the  Australian 
Museum,  who,  like  the  head  officials  in  many  other  scientific 
institutions,  seem  to  think  that  they  have  only  to  say  to  a 
subordinate,  "  Do  ! "  and  he  doeth  it,  even  though  it  be  a  task  for 
which  years  of  training  are  necessary.  In  recent  zoology,  just  as 
in  palaeontology,  work  of  this  kind  can  only  be  done  well  by  the 
specialist  having  at  his  disposal  large  collections  and  complete 
libraries.  We  have  no  wish  to  be  hard  on  an  obedient  servant,  but 
we  must  justify  our  remarks  by  a  few  selected  criticisms  of  Mr 
Rainbow's  work. 

On  p.  97,  the  syllable  "Nob."  following  "genus  Zispe,"  is,  no 
doubt,  a  printer's  error  for  '  Latr,'  since  Latreille  founded  this  genus 
in  1796.  We  let  this  pass,  but  discover  from  the  figure  that  the 
single  female  specimen,  here  made  the  type  of  a  new  species  of 
Lispc,  is  not  a  Lispe  at  all,  and  does  not  even  belong  to  the  same 
family.  So  far  as  may  be  judged  from  the  figure,  it  is  a  Coelopa 
(family,  Phycodromidae.)  "  Nob."  again,  this  time  following  "  genus 
Ebenia "  !  Mr  Rainbow  may  have  described  a  genus  under  the 
name  Ebenia,  though  he  gives  no  reference  to  the  place  where  he 
published  it ;  but  the  real  Ebenia  was  founded  by  Macquart  for  a 
Brazilian  species  having  no  sort  of  affinity  with  the  two  specimens 
here  described  under  that  name.  It  is  impossible  to  say  whether 
the  four  species  of  Diptera  described,  three  on  the  evidence  of  single 
specimens,  are  new  or  not ;  the  descriptions  are  too  short  to  be  of 
value,  the  figures  are  atrocious,  no  reference  is  made  to  allied  forms, 
and  the  author,  while  including  family  characters,  ignores  those  of 
specific  rank.  With  the  exotic  Muscidae  {sens,  lat.)  in  their  present 
state  of  chaos,  every  attempt  of  inexperienced  workers  to  describe 
new  species  is  a  distinct  retarding  of  science. 

Of    Arachnida,    88    specimens    were    secured,    and    these    are 


6  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [July 

distributed  by  Mr  Eainbow  into  25  species,  of  which  15  are 
new.  Fifteen  !  At  any  rate  Epcira  ventricosa,  and  probably  some 
of  the  other  species  of  Epeira  described  as  new,  appear  to  be  nothing 
but  representatives  of  that  wide-spread,  highly  variable,  and  well- 
known  species  Epeira  thc'is  ;  while  Hyllus  ferox  and  H.  audax,  sup- 
posed new  species,  have  been  placed  in  a  wrong  genus,  and  are 
probably  old  friends. 

The  scorpion  described  as  "  Btdhus  brevicaudatus  sp.  n. "  belongs 
to  a  totally  different  family  from  Buthus;  it  is  perhaps  the  best 
known  of  all  scorpions,  and  more  than  a  century  ago  Fabricius 
named  it  Hormurus  australasiae. 

Fortunately  for  Mr  Rainbow  and  for  us,  he  does  recognise 
that  some  of  the  species  found  on  Funafuti  are  neither  new  nor 
peculiar  to  that  island,  but  that  they  have  been  introduced  by  man. 
Among  these  are  certain  mosquitoes,  which  the  natives  catch  with  a 
kind  of  racquet,  the  meshes  of  which  are  made  of  the  glutinous 
snares  of  orb-weaving  spiders.  White  ants,  Calotermes  margini- 
pennis,  attack  the  coco-palms  at  a  height  of  three  to  six  feet  above 
the  ground,  tunnelling  their  way  through ;  as  a  result  the  trees  are 
snapped  off  by  the  gales.  It  is  probable  that  both  the  tree  and  the 
termite  were  introduced  by  human  agency,  via  Hawaii,  about  two 
centuries  ago. 

The  Crustaceans  and  Echinodeems  of  Funafuti 

These  animals  have  fallen  into  the  more  experienced  hands  of 
Mr  T.  Whitele^e.  The  Crustacea  are  the  lords  of  the  atoll,  swarm- 
ing  into  all  vacant  places.  "  The  Coenobita,"  says  Mr  Hedley, 
"  wander  across  from  shore  to  shore,  and  dispute  any  stray  edibles 
with  the  rats.  Some  crabs  even  take  up  their  residence  in  the  tree 
tops  of  Pandanus,  while,  as  everybody  knows,  Birgus  is  as  much  at 
home  on  a  palm  bole  as  a  squirrel  on  an  oak.  .  .  .  Human  habita- 
tions are  not  even  secure  from  crabs.  .  .  .  Active  as  they  are  during 
the  day,  it  is  at  night  that  the  land  crabs  hold  high  carnival.  On 
the  beaches  the  Crustacea  were  everywhere  abundant,  particular 
species  possessing  each  their  special  zone.  About  high  tide  mark 
on  the  windward  shore  promenaded  Grapsus  maculatus,  a  crowd  of 
which  scattered  before  the  footsteps  of  a  visitor,  and  sought  refuge 
under  loose  coral  blocks  or  in  deep  pools.  Eolling  over  a  slab  of 
dead  coral  rock  anywhere  between  tide  marks,  exposed  the  haunt  of 
a  little  community  of  Pctrolisthes  dcntata  and  Lcioloplms  planissimus. 
Intercepted  in  their  efforts  to  escape,  these  would  flatten  themselves 
clown  to  the  surface  of  the  stone  so  closely  that  the  collector's 
fingers  with  difficulty  grasped  them.  The  deeper  rock-pools  at  the 
border   of  the  reef-flat,  the  chief  home  of   Salarms,  were  usually 


t- 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  1 

tenanted  by  a  few  Calcinus  clcgans,  whose  brilliant  red,  blue,  and 
white  claws  distinguished  it  as  the  dandy  of  the  company.  This 
species  is  never  out  of  the  range  of  the  rough  waves.  The  extreme 
windward  portion  of  the  reef  left  dry  at  low  tide  was  but  rarely 
attainable ;  Aniculus,  whose  bristly  claws  usually  protruded  from  a 
stolen  Turbo  shell,  was  a  distinctive  feature  of  this  zone.  In  the 
honey-combed  pits  of  the  millipore  mounds  that  breasted  the  surf, 
cowered  Daira  pcrlata.  The  close  resemblance  of  colour  and  contour 
to  the  surrounding  rock  rendered  this  crab  difficult  to  detect,  and 
when  seen  the  creature's  powers  of  adherence  and  the  sweep  of  the 
Pacific  rollers  rendered  it  as  difficult  to  seize." 

Gcograpsus  crinipcs,  Dana,  occurred  in  association  with  Coenobita 
and  Cardisoma,  at  a  distance  from  the  sea,  among  broken  coral  rocks 
shaded  by  vegetation.  This  is  the  first  instance  of  a  grapsoid  crab 
living  wholly  on  dry  land,  and  it  displays  interesting  adaptations  to 
terrestrial  conditions.  It  breathes  by  hair-lined  pores  between  the 
bases  of  the  second  and  third  pairs  of  walking-legs ;  and  its  colour, 
a  dirty  yellowish-white,  harmonises  with  that  of  the  coral  fragments. 

Athelguc  aniculi  is  a  new  Epicarid  living  on  Aniculus  typicus,  a 
hermit  crab  that  lives  in  the  shell  of  Turbo  sctosus,  on  the  outer  edge 
of  the  reef,  most  exposed  to  the  surf. 

The  collection  of  echinoderms  comprises  130  specimens,  repre- 
senting 19  species,  mostly  common  forms  : — 7  echinoids,  3  asteroids, 
3  ophiuroids,  6  holothurians.  A  detailed  description  is  given  of 
two  specimens  referred  to  Culcita  acutispina.  Most  specimens  of 
this  starfish,  as  also  of  Anthcnea  acuta,  common  in  Port  Jackson,  are 
unsymmetrical  when  dredged  up ;  but,  if  placed  on  a  level  surface 
in  sea-water,  they  soon  regain  their  natural  form,  and  may  be  killed 
in  that  state  either  by  flooding  them  with  fresh  water  or  by  placing 
them  in  strong  spirit.  Neglect  to  take  these  precautions  may  have 
led  to  the  establishment  of  invalid  species. 

Granivorous  Insects 

Another  of  the  excellent  Bulletins  (N.S.  No.  8)  issued  by  the 
Entomological  Division  of  the  U.  S.  A.  Department  of  Agricul- 
ture has  reached  us.  It  is  written  by  Mr  F.  H.  Chittenden,  and 
deals  with  insects  which  have  been  observed  in*  North  America  to 
injure  stored  grain  and  other  vegetable  products.  It  is  of  interest 
to  find  included  among  these,  certain  beetles  of  the  family  Dermes- 
tidae  and  their  grubs.  These  insects,  which  include  the  well-known 
'  Bacon  Beetle,'  have  long  been  notorious  as  devourers  of  dried 
animal  matter,  but  have  not  attracted  attention  as  vegetarians.  It 
appears,  however,  that  some  of  them  can  find  sustenance  on  stored 
grain,  meal,  and  cloth. 


8  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [July 

A  Study  in  Parasitism 

Bulletin  No.  5  (Technical  Series)  of  the  same  department  con- 
tains an  exhaustive  account  by  Mr  L.  D.  Howard  of  the  insect- 
enemies  of  the  white-marked  tussock  moth  (Orgyia  leucostigma). 
The  hairy  caterpillars  of  this  moth  have  become,  during  recent 
years,  highly  injurious  to  foliage  trees  in  the  cities  of  the  northern 
States.  It  appears  that  the  vast  multiplication  of  these  caterpillars 
began  with  the  introduction  of  the  European  sparrow.  This  bird 
has  well-nigh  exterminated  other  caterpillars  which  used  to  compete 
with  the  '  tussocks '  for  a  livelihood  on  the  trees ;  it  will  not  touch 
the  hair-protected  '  tussocks '  itself,  but  it  has  largely  driven  out 
the  native  birds  which  used  to  feed  on  them.  Fortunately,  how- 
ever, an  army  of  insect-parasites  keep  the  caterpillars  from  increas- 
ing beyond  all  bounds.  Fifteen  species  of  Hymenoptera  and  six  of 
Diptera  are  described  as  laying  their  eggs  in  either  larva  or  pupa  of 
the  Orgyia.  These  parasites  are  in  their  turn  subject  to  attack  by 
thirteen  species  of  minute  Hymenoptera.  An  alarming  increase  of 
the  '  tussocks '  at  Washington  during  the  summer  of  1895  was 
accompanied  by  a  corresponding  increase  in  the  parasites,  so  that 
the  vast  majority  of  the  caterpillars  were  destroyed.  The  next  year, 
however,  owing  to  the  work  of  the  secondary  parasites,  the  '  tussock ' 
recovered  its  ground  to  a  considerable  extent.  Two  species  of  tiny 
hymenoptera  were  proved  to  be  '  tertiary '  parasites,  their  grubs 
devouring  those  of  the  secondaries.  Finally,  eleven  species  of 
Diptera  act  as  scavengers,  their  grubs  feeding  on  the  dead  pupae  and 
cocoon-masses  of  the  contending  insect -armies. 


A  Study  in  Commensalism 

It  is  cheering  to  turn  from  this  summary  of  conflict  and  slaughter 
to  another  side  of  insect-life  lately  investigated  by  Mr  C.  Janet. 
In  a  little  work  of  6  2  pages  ("  Sur  le  Lasius  mixtus,  YAntennophorus 
uhlmanni,  &c.  "  :  Limoges,  1897)  he  describes  the  relations  which 
subsist  between  social  ants  (Lasias)  and  certain  gamasid  mites  and 
other  arthropods  which  are  found  in  their  nests.  The  mites  of  the 
species  Antennophorus  uhlmanni  are  carried  about  by  the  worker 
ants  ;  in  their  penultimate  and  adult  stages  they  seem  unable  to 
make  their  own  way  about  the  nest,  and  wait  feeling  with  their  long 
front  legs  for  an  ant  to  which  they  can  attach  themselves.  An  ant 
normally  carries  three  of  the  mites — one  under  the  head  and  one  on 
either  side  of  the  abdomen ;  these  positions  are  the  least  incon- 
venient possible  to  the  ant.  The  mites  feed  entirely  on  liquid  dis- 
gorged by  their  hosts.      An  individual  under  an  ant's  head  naturally 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  9 

draws  his  supply  from  the  insect's  mouth,  especially  when  she  dis- 
gorges to  feed  a  comrade.  A  mite  carried  on  the  abdomen  of  an 
ant  taps,  with  his  two  front  pairs  of  feet,  another  ant  which  happens 
to  be  near,  and  for  thus  asking  obtains  food.  No  benefit  to  the  ants 
from  the  presence  of  these  mites  is  suggested,  and  the  relation  bears 
the  aspect  of  disinterested  charity. 

Another  species  of  mite,  Discopoma  comata,  is  on  the  other  hand  a 
true  parasite.  These  gamasids  attach  themselves  to  the  ant's  ab- 
domen, pierce  the  intersegmental  membrane,  and  suck  food-supplies. 

A  bristle-tail  or  thysanure,  Lepismina  polypoda,  plays  the  part  of 
pickpocket  in  the  ant-colony.  He  comes  stealthily  between  two 
ants  when  one  is  feeding  the  other,  grabs  the  drop  of  liquid  nourish- 
ment in  its  passage,  and  makes  his  escape  as  quickly  as  possible  to 
levy  contribution  on  other  couples  until  his  hunger  is  satisfied. 


The  Pigments  of  the  Decapod  Crustacea 

Another  interesting  contribution  has  just  been  made  to  our  know- 
ledge of  the  pigments  of  the  decapod  Crustacea  by  Miss  M.  I. 
Newbigin  (Journ.  Physiol,  vol.  xxi.,  pp.  237-257,  May  1897). 
She  discusses  the  predominant  characteristics  of  the  pigments  of 
Homarus  vulgaris,  Nephrons  norivegicus  and  Astacus  nobilis.  The 
conclusions  arrived  at  support  recent  observations  on  the  same  sub- 
ject, but  a  speculative  tone  mainly  towards  the  end  of  the  paper 
rather  spoils  the  general  effect. 

Thus  we  cannot  accept  the  conclusion  "that  there  is  some  con- 
nection between  the  little  known  substance  in  the  muscle  and  the 
formation  alike  of  the  blue  pigment  and  of  chitin."  The  conclu- 
sion also  that  the  red  lipochrome  is  present  as  a  calcium  combina- 
tion in  the  shell  is  only  speculation.  The  pigment  is  laid  down 
there  before  calcification  takes  place :  in  fact  pigment  and  calcium 
salt  are  more  or  less  independent  of  each  other. 

While  in  the  earlier  parts  of  the  paper  a  distinction  is  drawn 
between  the  yellow  and  red  pigments,  in  the  '  summary '  the  former 
is  said  to  be  partially  derived  from  the  latter  "  under  the  influence 
of  certain  reagents."  A  '  lipochromogen '  is  not  a  '  compound  '  of 
a  lipochrome  :  it  is  a  precursor  of  one.  The  return  to  Krukenberg's 
term  '  hepatochrome '  would  certainly  be  unfortunate,  as  the  organ 
in  which  such  pigment  or  rather  pigments  occur  is  not  a  liver  but 
mainly  a  pancreas,  and  although  no  band  in  red  was  recognised  in 
extracts  of  the  digestive  gland  by  Miss  Newbigin  there  is  a  chloro- 
phylloid  pigment,  which  is  better  named  enterochlorophyll,  present 
in  most  if  not  in  all  cases. 

There  is  no  mention  of  this  spectrum  given  by  the  pigment  itself 


10  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [July 

when  the  red  hypoderniis  is  examined  by  the  spectrum  eye-piece  by 
means  of  reflected  light. 

We  fail  to  find  any  evidence  in  this  paper  that  the  '  chemistry  ' 
of  the  crustacean  pigments  has  been  advanced  beyond  the  old  stage 
of  solution  and  colour-change  with  reagents.  What  we  want  is 
isolation  and  purification  before  we  can  say  that  our  knowledge  of 
the  subject  has  been  largely  increased. 

However,  in  spite  of  these  minor  blemishes  (and  all  new  work 
must  be  imperfect),  we  welcome  this  paper  and  hope  the  author  may 
continue  her  observations. 


The  Embryonic  Shell  in  Bivalves 

The  shell,  or  rather  pair  of  shelly  valves  of  the  young  bivalve,  that 
forms  before  the  little  creature  is  hatched,  is  usually  very  different 
in  appearance  to  that  enclosing  the  fully  formed  animal.  The 
prodissoconch,  as  it  has  been  termed,  is  small,  unornamented,  and 
may  frequently  be  seen  capping  the  umbones  of  the  older  shell. 
It  has  been  considered  the  sole  stage  prior  to  the  exclusion  of  the 
embryo  from  the  egg-shell.  Mr  Felix  Bernard,  however,  (Comptes 
Renclus  Acad.  Sci.  Paris,  vol.  cxxiv.  pp.  1165-8)  has  detected  an  earlier 
stage  which  he  calls  the  protostracum,  and  he  has  been  able  to  find 
this  protostracum  on  the  summit  of  each  prodissoconch  studied  by 
him.  The  Glochidium  stage  in  the  Unionidae  is  the  equivalent  of 
this  protostracum.  In  most  cases  the  hinge-line  of  the  protostracum 
undergoes  no  increase  during  the  completion  of  the  prodissoconch 
stage.  It  consists  of  a  series  of  interlocking  crenulations,  for  which 
Mr  Bernard  accepts  Dall's  suggested  name  of  provinculum,  with  a 
central  ligament  pit.  The  development  of  the  Heterodonts  is  so  rapid, 
that,  as  a  rule,  the  crenulations  have  no  time  to  form,  but  are 
superseded  by  the  true  teeth,  whose  development  has  already  been 
commented  on  in  these  pages  (vol.  ix.  p.  358).  This  acceleration  of 
development  of  the  hinge  is  correlative  with  the  earlier  incubation 
of  the  individuals  of  this  group,  entailing  an  earlier  use  of  the  shell 
with  a  consequent  stimulation  of  the  hinge  through  function. 

The  free  swimming  larval  stage,  which  has  its  foot  adapted  for 
creeping,  and  free  mantel  lobes,  guiltless  of  siphons,  and  whose  gills 
are  situated  in  the  rear,  whilst  it  possesses  the  velum  characteristic 
of  all  larval  mollusca,  is  common  to  all  Pelecypoda  and  representa- 
tive of  the  ancestral  form. 

The  Eeproduction  of  Diatoms 

The  two  chief  methods  by  which  diatoms  have  hitherto  been 
supposed    to    reproduce    themselves    are    (1)    by  simple  vegetative 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  11 

division,  and  (2)  by  the  formation  of  so-called  auxospores,  which 
are  usually  the  result  of  conjugation.  The  former  method  of 
division  is  of  unusual  interest  in  the  diatoms,  since,  owing  to  the 
peculiar  arrangement  of  their  valves  by  which  one  fits  inside  the 
other,  a  formation  of  progressively  smaller  and  smaller  individuals 
is  a  necessary  result  of  simple  division.  The  growth  in  size  of  the 
valves  is  usually  supposed  to  be  impossible  on  account  of  their 
silicified  nature.  It  is  imagined,  however,  that  the  production  of 
infinitely  small  individuals,  which  would  obviously  result  from  the 
continuance  of  such  a  method  of  division,  is  prevented  by  the  in- 
terpolation of  auxospore  formation ;  by  the  latter  means  the  diatom 
is  given  an  opportunity  of  regaining  its  maximum  size. 

Mr  George  Murray,  in  a  paper  entitled  "  On  the  reproduction  of 
some  marine  Diatoms"  (Proc.  Roy.  Soc,  Eclin.,  Dec.  1896),  has, 
however,  thrown  new  light  on  reproduction  in  this  group.  The 
author  has  observed  in  some  marine  forms  a  very  interesting  and 
totally  new  method  of  division.  This  form  of  reproduction  was 
observed  in  Coscinodiscus,  Biddulphia,  Choeboceros,  &c,  but  was 
followed  out  most  fully  in  the  first-mentioned  genus.  In  Coscino- 
discus the  cell-contents  divide  by  successive  division  into  eight  or 
sixteen  portions,  and  these  become  rounded  off  and  lie  free  in  the 
mother  cell  like  spores  in  a  sporangium.  Each  of  these  portions 
becomes  invested  with  valves  showing  the  characteristic  markings, 
and  in  fact  becomes  a  young  Coscinodiscus.  These  young  forms  ulti- 
mately escape  from  the  parent  cell,  and  are  found  floating  free  in  the 
water  as  packets  of  eight  or  sixteen  small  individuals  enclosed  in  a 
delicate  membrane ;  later  on  the  several  individuals  themselves 
become  completely  free.  It  is  by  this  method  of  division  that  the 
enormous  quantities  of  marine  diatoms,  occurring  in  many  waters  at 
certain  seasons,  are  doubtless  produced. 

As  mentioned  above,  diatoms  are  usually  supposed  to  be  incapable 
of  superficial  growth,  owing  to  the  silicified  nature  of  their  membrane  ; 
but,  as  Mr  Murray  points  out,  this  view  is  hardly  well  founded. 
At  all  events,  it  raises  the  question  of  the  nature  of  the  membranes 
produced  by  the  young  diatoms  inside  the  old  valves.  These  diatoms 
must  obviously  be  much  smaller  than  the  parent,  and  so,  in  the 
absence  of  growth,  continued  reproduction  by  this  method  would  have 
as  disastrous  an  effect  on  the  size  of  the  species  as  the  method  of 
simple  division,  and  would  similarly  necessitate  the  production  of 
auxospores.  With  this  question  in  view  Mr  Murray  investigated 
the  nature  of  the  membrane  of  the  daughter  forms,  and  his  con- 
clusion is  that  the  valves  are  either  not  silicified  or  only  incompletely 
so.  There  is  thus  nothing  to  prevent  the  further  growth  of  these 
young  diatoms  to  the  full  size  of  the  species.  That  this  later  growth 
takes  place  is  supported  by  observation,  for  the  very  small  forms  of 


12  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [July 

certain  species  of  Coscinodiscus  which  are  abundant  at  one  season, 
disappear  later  in  the  year. 


Plants  and  the  Weather 

We  have  received  an  interesting  little  pamphlet  on  the  effects  of 
weather  upon  vegetation,  the  subject  of  a  recent  lecture  to  the 
Bradford  Naturalists'  Society. 

The  lecturer,  Mr  John  Clayton,  has  made  some  simple  but  none 
the  less  instructive  experiments,  the  results  of  which  he  put  before 
his  audience.  The  effects  of  sunshine  are,  as  we  should  expect,  very 
striking.  Of  twelve  bean-plants,  as  like  as  possible  in  size  and 
health,  six  were  placed  in  the  ground  where  they  would  catch  all 
the  sunshine  of  the  day ;  the  other  six  were  sheltered  by  a  boarding 
which  effectually  prevented  any  rays  from  falling  upon  them.  When 
freshly  gathered  in  October  the  weight  of  beans  and  pods  grown  in 
sunshine  was  more  than  three  times  as  great  as  in  the  case  of  those 
grown  in  the  shade  (99:29),  while  the  weight  of  the  dry  beans  was 
in  a  similar  proportion  (16  :  5).  The  experiment  was  continued  in 
succeeding  years.  Thus  in  1892  the  fresh  weight  of  beans  and  pods 
grown  from  the  sunshine-grown  seed  of  1891  was  half  as  much  again, 
as  in  the  case  of  plants  from  shade-grown  seeds — all  being  grown  in 
sunshine  and  under  precisely  similar  conditions  in  the  second  year. 
In  the  fourth  year  plants  with  an  exclusively  shady  ancestry  produced 
flowers,  but  failed  to  mature  fruit. 

A  series  of  measurements  illustrating  the  contraction  of  trees  in 
frost  was  made  in  the  winter  of  1894-5.  A  comparison  of  the 
girth  of  tree-trunks  in  October,  when  growth  had  ceased  but  before 
the  frost  set  in,  with  the  girth  at  9  a.m.  on  February  8th,  at  a 
temperature  of  3°  F.,  showed  an  appreciable  contraction  under  frost. 
In  the  sycamore  it  was  from  two  to  three  sixteenths  of  an  inch,  in 
the  elm  from  three  to  five  sixteenths,  in  the  oak  from  five  to  six 
sixteenths.  On  March  2,  at  a  temperature  of  39°  F.,  the  trunks  had 
expanded  to  their  original  measurements.  To  this  contraction  under 
frost  is  due  the  frequent  splitting  of  our  forest  trees. 

An  interesting  review  is  also  given  of  the  distribution  of  sunshine, 
rain,  &c,  in  the  different  months  of  the  year ;  and  various  improve- 
ments are  suggested  for  individual  months,  which  we  recommend  to 
the  consideration  of  the  clerk  of  the  weather. 


Plant  Chemistry 

The  chemistry  of  some  common  plants  is  discussed  by  Dr  P.  Q. 
Keegan  in  a  recent  number  of  The  Naturalist.     The  buttercup  owes 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  13 

its  brilliant  golden  hue  to  a  pigment  called  carotin  (from  its  presence 
in  the  carrot  root), "  which  is  amassed  in  discoidal  bodies  that  nearly 
rill  up  the  cells  of  the  epidermis,  especially  towards  the  base 
of  the  petal ;  in  other  parts,  especially  when  the  flower  is  fully 
expanded,  it  seems  diffused  in  oily  droplets  or  amorphous  granules." 
In  either  case  the  starch  grains  in  the  subjacent  tissue  act  as  a 
reflector,  and  contribute  greatly  to  enhance  the  effect.  The  flower- 
heads  contain  a  considerable  amount  of  sugar,  starch,  calcium  oxalate, 
and  soluble  phosphates,  in  these  respects  approaching  more  to  the 
character  of  leaves  than  is  usual.  The  stem  and  root  of  this  butter- 
cup (Ranunculus  bulbosus)  are  remarkable  for  the  presence  of  an 
acrid  camphoraceous  body  easily  decomposed  into  a  volatile  bitter 
principle  (anemonin)  and  an  acid,  even  during  the  drying  of  the 
plant,  so  that  its  original  poisonous  character  disappears. 

Bird'S|foot  trefoil  (Lotus  comiculatus),  with  the  brilliant  orange 
and  crimson  tints  of  its  little  papilionaceous  flowers,  is  known  to 
everyone.  To  produce  this  vividness  and  lustre  the  epidermal  cells 
are  swollen  into  papillae,  and  contain  no  less  than  three  distinct  pig- 
ments. There  are  the  solid  carotin  corpuscles,  and  also  two  colour- 
ing-matters in  solution  in  the  cell-sap.  One  is  a  clear,  yellow  juice, 
the  other  is  identical  with  the  anthocyan  of  the  rose.  Where  the 
latter  predominates  we  get  the  deep  red  colour. 

The  tiny  flowers  of  the  cheerful  little  yellow  bedstraw  (Galium 
verum)  contain  carotin,  much  yellow  resinous  matter,  and  "  a  curious 
purplish  substance  (possibly  purpurin)  insoluble  in  cold  alcohol  or 
benzene  after  purification."  The  flowers  also  contain  a  species  of 
ferment  which,  like  rennet,  has  the  power  of  coagulating  boiling 
milk.  A  substance  known  as  rubichloric  acid  is  present,  not  only  in 
the  flowers  but  in  the  stem  and  root.  It  forms  a  colourless  solution 
in  water,  but  when  boiled  with  a  few  drops  of  hydrochloric  acid, 
suddenly  produces  a  deep  blue,  then  a  green  colour,  and  deposits  a 
dense,  dark  green  precipitate  soluble  in  ammonia.  The  disc  florets 
of  the  daisy  are  tinged  with  carotin  granules ;  the  crimson  of  the 
ray  florets  is  due  to  a  soluble  pigment  described  as  a  tannin  anhy- 
dride. The  blue  of  the  harebell  and  chicory  is  again  a  tannin 
derivative. 

Two  colouring  matters  are  engaged  in  the  decoration  of  the 
primrose.  At  the  base  of  the  petal-limbs,  where  the  tint  is  more 
deeply  orange,  carotin  granules  are  present ;  the  rest  of  the  corolla 
contains  a  pale  yellow,  soluble  pigment.  Although  the  tints  are 
comparatively  feeble,  chemical  analysis  shows  that  the  plant  is 
capable  of  "  an  infinitely  richer  wealth  of  coloration  "  than  it  shows 
in  our  climate,  since  "  it  seems  almost  impossible  to  exhaust  the 
flower  heads  of  substances  which  yield  vivid  and  powerful  orange 
and  yellow  dyes." 


14  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [July 

Ox  Willows 

The  March  number  of  the  Botanical  Gazette  opens  with  a  useful 
paper  by  C.  J.  Chamberlain,  entitled  "  Contribution  to  the  life 
history  of  Salix."  The  author  has  worked  out  the  development  of 
the  flower,  and  that  of  the  microspores  and  macrospores,  and  their 
germination,  the  process  of  fertilisation,  and  the  embryology  in 
several  species  of  willows  growing  in  the  northern  United  States. 

In  view  of  the  results  of  the  work  of  Treub,  Nawaschin,  and 
Miss  Benson,  on  Casuarina  and  various  genera  of  the  so-called 
Amentiferae,  considerable  interest  attaches  to  Mr  Chamberlain's 
researches. 

He  finds  that  Salix  shows  none  of  those  striking  divergences 
from  the  usual  course  of  events  in  the  ovule,  which  have  been 
demonstrated  in  the  above-mentioned  genera,  and  his  results  con- 
firm previous  views  as  to  the  primitive  simplicity  of  the  willow 
flower.  A  diligent  search  in  buds,  both  of  the  male  and  female 
flowers,  failed  to  reveal  the  slightest  trace  of  a  rudimentary  perianth, 
such  as  might  be  expected  were  the  floral  simplicity  the  result  of 
reduction.  The  path  of  the  pollen-tube  is  perfectly  normal,  an 
entrance  to  the  ovule  being  effected  through  the  micropyle.  The 
synergids  have  a  strongly  developed  beak,  and  breaking  through 
the  embryo-sac,  project  into  the  micropyle  and  attract  the 
pollen-tube. 

Great  difficulty  was  experienced  in  finding  the  antipodal  cells 
in  the  embryo-sac;  only  in  six  cases  out  of  several  hundreds  examined 
were  they  clearly  seen.  This  leads  the  author  to  suggest  that  their 
reputed  absence  in  Casuarina  may  be  due  to  a  similar  difficulty. 
The  course  of  cell-division,  in  the  development  of  the  embryo  from 
the  fertilised  ovum,  shows  several  differences  in  detail  from  that 
described  by  Hanstein  for  Cajjsella. 

Some  interesting  sports  were  also  noted.  Besides  the  well- 
known  mixed  catkins,  which  were  observed  in  considerable  number 
on  a  vigorous  plant  of  S.  glaucophylla  in  three  successive  seasons, 
the  writer  describes  and  figures  the  growth  of  stamens  inside  the 
ovary,  an  occurrence  hitherto  unknown  in  Salix.  These  intra- 
ovarian  stamens  consisted  generally  of  a  one-celled  stalked  or  sessile 
anther,  borne  on  the  wall  of  the  carpel  or  on  a  placenta-like  out- 
growth. Occasionally  these  ambisporangiate  ovaries  had  a  perfectly 
natural  appearance,  but  generally  they  were  more  or  less  deformed. 
The  ovules  were  generally  inverted  (anatropous),  their  normal  form  ; 
but  occasionally  upright  (orthotropous)  ovules  were  found,  sometimes 
borne  on  a  long  stalk.  Quite  normal  embryo-sacs  and  embryos  were 
produced  in  these  sporting  pistils.  Masters  in  his  "Teratology" 
mentions  only  one  authenticated  case  of  the  formation  of  stamens 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  15 

within  the  ovary  cavity,  namely  in  Baeckca  diosmifolia  (a  member 
of  the  myrtle  family).  Certain  ovaries  of  quite  normal  external 
appearance  contained  numerous  perfect  or  sometimes  imperfect 
stamens,  but  no  trace  of  any  ovules. 


Some  Basic  Dyke-kocks  from  Southern  India 

A  recent  issue  of  the  Records  of  the  Geological  Survey  of  India 
(vol.  xxx.  part  i.)  contains  a  paper  by  Mr  T.  H.  Holland  dealing 
with  certain  basic  dykes  widely  distributed  in  Peninsular  India. 
On  both  geological  and  petrographical  grounds  they  are  correlated 
with  the  Cuddapah  lava-flows,  and  they  shew  none  of  the  effects 
of  dynamic  metamorphism  so  general  in  the  older  series  of  dykes 
referred  to  in  the  Dharwar  system.  The  author  treats  the  rocks 
under  three  groups  :  olivine-norite,  augite-norite,  and  augite-diorite. 
The  first  consists  essentially  of  olivine,  enstatite,  augite,  and  a  basic 
plagioclase,  with  subordinate  biotite.  The  second  lacks  olivine,  and 
has  more  augite  relatively  to  enstatite.  In  the  third  group  biotite 
and  usually  enstatite  have  disappeared,  a  comparatively  late  crys- 
tallization of  augite  gives  a  tendency  to  the  ophitic  structure,  and 
interstitial  micropegmatite  (sometimes  with  potash-felspar)  is  invari- 
ably present.  Considerable  variations  occur,  including  transitions 
in  the  first  group  to  peridotites  and  in  the  second  to  pyroxene-rocks. 
To  each  group  there  are  '  hemicrystalline '  equivalents  corresponding 
with  the  rocks  of  plutonic  habitus,  and  some  of  these  present  types 
not  hitherto  described  but  comparable  with  the  limburgites  or 
magma-basalts.  These  contain  phenocrysts  of  olivine,  of  enstatite, 
or  of  both  minerals  in  a  dark  compact  matrix,  largely  of  glass.  The 
author  also  points  out  resemblances  between  the  dyke-rocks  and  the 
Cuddapah  lavas  of  which  they  are  the  probable  equivalents. 

The  rocks  styled  augite-diorites  seem  to  be  practically  identical 
with  some  which  in  this  country  have  been  termed  quartz-bearing 
gabbros,  etc.,  and  the  author  makes  an  interesting  comparison 
between  the  Indian  examples  and  those  of  Carrock  Fell,  St  David's 
Head,  and  Carlingford,  with  the  well-known  rocks  of  Penmaenmawr 
and  the  Whin  Sill.  He  finds  no  evidence  to  support  Professor 
Sollas'  suggestion  that  the  micropegmatite  in  such  rocks  is  the  result 
of  a  later  injection  of  a  distinct  acid  magma  into  minute  veins  and 
druses.  He  regards  it  as  the  final  product  of  crystallization  of  the 
rock  formed  under  somewhat  changed  ('  aqueo-igneous ')  conditions, 
consequent  upon  the  concentration  of  the  original  water  in  the 
residual  magma.  He  suggests  that  distinct  veins  of  granophyre 
traversing  the  rock,  as  described  by  Sollas  in  thfe  Carlingford  dis- 
trict, may  be  '  contemporaneous  veins  '  rather  than  later  injections, 


16  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [July 

and  that  even  the  considerable  bodies  of  granophyre  so  often 
associated  with  gabbro  in  many  districts  may  be  due  to  the  squeezing 
out  of  the  residual  magma  under  greater  pressure.  Such  a  hypo- 
thesis is  certainly  in  accord  with  conclusions  reached  by  quite 
different  lines  of  penological  research,  and  has  the  advantage  of 
brino-ino*  into  relation  a  number  of  facts  which  are  already  well 
known.  In  this  view  differences  of  pressure  due  to  more  or  less 
deep-seated  consolidation  are  held  to  account  for  the  association  of 
the  pyroxene-plagioclase-aggregate  and  micropegmatite,  sometimes  as 
contiguous  and  obviously  cognate  bodies  of  rock,  sometimes  as  con- 
stituents of  one  and  the  same  rock. 


Taking  Time  by  the  Fokelock 

In  these  days  when  a  determined  effort  is  being  made  to  settle 
once  for  all  the  dates  of  publication  of  generic  and  specific  names, 
and  when  bibliographers  like  Mr  Sherborn  are  devoting  them- 
selves to  finding  out  the  times  of  issue  of  classical  works  issued  at 
irregular  intervals  and  with  no  record  of  their  appearance,  one  is 
horror-stricken  to  find  a  contemporary,  held  in  high  esteem  by  reason 
of  the  beauty  of  its  illustrations  and  the  scientific  character  of  its 
letterpress,  doing  its  best  not  merely  to  conceal  the  dates  of  the 
appearance  of  its  fascicules,  but  actually  endeavouring  to  give  a  false 
impression  of  punctuality. 

The  part  of  the  Journal  de  Conchyliologic  for  October  1895,  and 
dated  '1st  October  1895/  appeared  in  this  country  on  3rd  Sept. 
1896,  and  contained  the  descriptions  of  several  new  species. 

In  the  issue  for  Jan.  1896,  ostensibly  published  '  1st  Jan. 
1896,'  but  received  on  21st  Dec.  1896,  these  are  referred  to 
in  the  following  form :  "  [Genus,  species,  author],  Journal  de 
Conchyliologie,  vol.  xxxiii.,  1895,"  thus  giving  the  impression  ■ 
that  they  were  published  before  they  actually  were,  and  laying 
traps  for  the  unwary  priority-student  of  the  future.  We  have 
every  sympathy  with  journals  which  try  by  prompt  publication  to 
•live  their  contributors  the  fair  reward  of  their  labours,  but — '  fair 
play  is  a  jewel.' 


591.9/9  17 

593.12 


I. 

On  the  Distribution  of  the  Pelagic  Foraminifera  at 
the  Surface  and  on  the  Floor  of  the  Ocean. 


THE  pelagic  Foraminifera  play  a  most  important  role  in  the 
economy  of  the  present  ocean,  as  well  as  in  the  geological 
history  of  our  planet.  Living  specimens  of  these  pelagic  Protozoa 
are  distributed  everywhere  in  the  surface  waters  of  the  open  ocean, 
about  fifteen  or  twenty  species  being  met  with  in  the  surface  waters 
of  the  tropics,  and  one  or  two  dwarfed  species  are  captured  among 
the  floating  icebergs  of  the  Arctic  and  Antarctic  regions.  The  dead 
shells  of  these  Foraminifera  make  up  by  far  the  larger  part  of  the 
carbonate  of  linie  present  in  the  deep-sea  deposits  known  as  Pteropod 
and  Globigerina  Oozes,  which  cover  about  50,000,000  square  miles 
of  the  ocean's  bed.  In  addition,  they  make  up  the  major  part  of 
the  carbonate  of  lime  present  in  the  other  deep-sea  deposits,  such  as 
Diatom  Ooze,  Eadiolarian  Ooze,  Eed  Clay,  and  the  deeper  terrigenous 
deposits  which  are  laid  down  in  close  proximity  to  continents  and 
oceanic  islands.  Indeed,  it  may  be  said  that,  taken  as  a  whole, 
nine-tenths  of  the  carbonate  of  lime  in  marine  deposits  from  depths 
greater  than  one  hundred  fathoms  is  derived  from  the  dead  shells  of 
the  pelagic  Foraminifera. 

When  the  Challenger  set  out  on  her  cruise  around  the  world, 
all  the  naturalists  of  the  expedition  believed  that  the  habitat  of  the 
Glohigcrinae  was  on  the  sea-bed  in  deep  water.  This  opinion  was 
held  by  Wallich,1  Carpenter,2  and  Wyville  Thomson.3  Gwyn 
Jeffreys,4  however,  took  another  view ;  he  regarded  the  Globigcrinae 
as  surface  organisms,  and  the  Globigerina  Ooze  as  made  up  of  dead 
shells  which  had  fallen  to  the  bottom  from  the  surface  waters.  The 
fact  that  M'Donald5  and  Major  Owen6  had  captured  several  species 
of  these  Foraminifera  in  tow-nets  at  the  sea-surface  appears  to  have 

1  The  North  Atlantic  Sea-bed.  London,  1862;  also  Deep-Sea  Researches  on  the 
Biology  of  Globigerina.     London,  1876. 

2  Proc.  Roy.  Soc,  vol.  xxiii.  p.  234.     1875. 

3  Proc.  Roy.  Soc,  vol.  xxiii.  p.  32.     1874. 

4  Proc.  Roy.  Soc,  vol.  xviii.  p.  443.      1869. 

5  See  Huxley's  Appendix  to  Dayman's  Report  on  Deep-Sea  Soundings  in  the  North 
Atlantic  made  in  H. M.S.  Cyclops  in  June  and  July  1857.  London,  published  by  the 
Admiralty,  1858. 

6  Journ.  Linn.  Soc  LoncL,  vol.  ix.  (Zool.),  p.  147.     1866. 

B 


18 


NATUBAL  SCIENCE 


[July 


been  overlooked  or  forgotten.  Huxley1  discussed  this  question,  and, 
while  not  coming  to  any  definite  conclusion  on  the  subject,  he  held 
that  the  balance  of  evidence  was  in  favour  of  those  who  maintained 
that  the  Globigcrinae  lived  on  the  bottom  of  the  ocean. 

During    the    first    few  months   of    the    Challenger  Expedition 
the  attention  of  the  naturalists  was  almost  wholly  taken  up  with  the 


Fk;.  1. — Ilastiycrina  pelagica  (d'Orbigny)  [murrayi,  Wyville  Thomson]  with  floating 
apparatus  and  pseudopodia  extended,  as  found  floating  on  the  surface. 

examination  of  the  deep-sea  organisms  obtained  in  the  trawl  and 
dredge,  and  with  the  larger  animals  procured  at  the  surface.  When, 
however,  the  expedition  entered  the  tropics  I  frequently  observed 
Globigcrinae,  Orbulinae,  Pulvimdinac,  and  Splicer vidinae  at  the  bottom 
of  the  glass  globes  into  which  the  contents  of  the  surface-nets  were 
washed,   and   the   attention    of    Wyville    Thomson    and    the    other 

1  Appendix  to  Dayman's  Report,  already  cited. 


1S97]     DISTRIBUTION  OF  PELAGIC  FORAMINIFERA       19 

naturalists  was  called  to  the  fact.  It  was  Wyville  Thomson's 
opinion,  however,  that  these  shells  really  came  from  the  deep-sea 
deposits.  It  was  the  custom  to  sift  and  wash  large  quantities  of 
the  ooze  procured  in  the  dredge  on  the  deck  of  the  ship,  and  it 
was  believed  that  some  of  the  shells  from  the  deck  being  washed 
overboard  were  subsequently  caught  by  the  tow-nets  dragging  astern. 
But  the  appearance  of  the  shells  taken  in  the  tow-nets  was  so  different 
from  that  of  those  procured  from  the  bottom  that  I  could  not  accept 
the  above  explanation.  When  the  weather  permitted,  the  tow-nets 
were  dragged,  at  considerable  distances  from  the  ship,  from  a  rowing 
boat,  and  Foraminifera  were  procured  in  abundance.  By  using  a 
water-glass  I  was  sometimes  able  to  dip  up  a  single  specimen  in  a 
glass  beaker  without  in  any  way  touching  it.  When  this  specimen 
was  taken  on  board  the  ship,  and  placed  under  the  microscope,  the 
whole  sarcode  of  the  animal  was  to  be  seen  expanded  outside  of  the 
shell,  as  represented  in  Fig.  1.  When  our  attention  was  once 
directed  to  the  subject,  the  pelagic  Foraminifera  were  observed  in 
almost  every  haul  of  the  tow-net.  Many  of  the  Globigerinae,  the 
Orbidinac,  and  the  Hastigerinae  are  furnished  with  long  spines,  and 
when  the  animal  is  expanded  the  sarcode  rests  between  the  spines. 
In  the  Pidvinulinae,  the  Sphacvoidineic,  and  Pulleniae,  which  have 
no  spines,  the  shell  is  frequently  so  hidden  in  the  expanded  yellow- 
coloured  sarcode  that  it  may  escape  observation. 

On  the  return  of  the  Challenger  Expedition,  the  late  Mr 
H.  B.  Brady1  and  others  pointed  out  that,  if  the  Globigerinae  were 
pelagic  organisms,  it  was  a  most  extraordinary  circumstance  that  no 
naturalist  had  recorded  them  in  any  of  the  numerous  tow-net 
gatherings  about  the  British  coasts.  This,  however,  quite  agreed 
with  the  experience  of  the  Challenger  naturalists.  Whenever  the 
ship  entered  a  bay,  an  estuary,  or,  indeed,  any  coastal  waters,  the 
pelagic  Foraminifera  became  very  rare  or  entirely  disappeared  from 
the  nets,  although  they  may  have  been  abundant  fifty  miles  from 
the  coast.  I  have  never  seen  a  single  specimen  in  the  tow-nets 
around  the  coasts  of  Scotland.  In  the  Triton  and  Knight  Errant 
Expeditions  pelagic  Foraminifera  were  found  in  abundance  in  the 
Gulf  Stream  waters  which  flow  up  the  Faroe  Channel,  although  not  a 
single  specimen  was  observed  in  the  Minch  or  North  Sea  waters. 
The  pelagic  Foraminifera  are  truly  oceanic  creatures,  even  more  so 
than  the  Pteropoda  :  they  are  most  abundant  in  true  oceanic 
currents ;  where  these  currents  flow  directly  towards  a  coast  they 
may  be  borne  close  to  the  shore,  but  usually  they  are  only  to  be  met 
with  far  out  at  sea. 

From  an  examination  of  the  large  number  of  microscopic  pre- 

1  Quart.  Journ.  Micro.  S'ci.,  vol.  xix.,  N.S.,  p.  292.  1879  ;  see  also  Zool.   Chall. 
Exp.,  part  xxii.,  pp.  ix-xv.     1884. 


20 


NATURAL  SCIENCE 


[July 


Globigerina  sacculifcra,  Brady. 

»> 

aequilateralis,  Brady. 

)> 

ccmglobata,  Brady. 

j> 

dubia,  Egger. 

>> 

rubra,  d'Orbigny. 

>) 

bulloides,  d'Orbigny. 

)> 

inflala,  d'Orbigny. 

>> 

digitata,  Brady. 

ji 

cretacca,  d'Orbigny. 

5) 

dutertrei,  Brady. 

5) 

pachydermia  (Ebrenberg). 

)> 

marginata  (Renss). 

>> 

linnaeana  (d'Orbigny). 

>> 

helicina,  d'Orbigny. 

parations  and  tow-net  gatherings  made  during  the  Challenger  Ex- 
pedition, the  following  species  of  Foraniinifera  have  been  recognised 
as  pelagic : — 

Orbulina  univcrsa,  d'Orbigny. 
Hastigerina  pelagiea  (d'Orbigny). 
Pullenia  obliquilocidata,  Parker  and  Jones. 
Sphaeroidina  dehiscens,  Parker  and  Jones. 
Candeina  nitida,  d'Orbigny. 
Cymbalopora      ( Tretomphalus)      bulloides 

(d'Orbigny). 
Pulvinulina  menardii  (d'Orbigny). 

,,  iumida,  Brady. 

,,  canariensis  (d'Orbigny). 

,,  micheliniana  (d'Orbigny). 

,,  crassa  (d'Orbigny).     • 

,,  patagonica  (d'Orbigny). 

Cymbalopora  bidloides1  (Fig.  3)  can  hardly  be  regarded  as  a  true 
pelagic  Forarninifer.  It  was  only  captured  in  the  neighbourhood 
of  coral  reefs,  and  the  curious  thing  about  it  is  that  not  a  single 
specimen  was  taken  containing  ordinary  sarcode,  similar  to  that 
observed  in  the  other  species  of  pelagic  Foraminifera.  In  all  the 
specimens  the  shells  were  filled  with  immense  numbers  of  minute 
zoospores ;  these  latter  spread  over  the  field  of  the  microscope  in  a 
cloud-like  swarm  when  a  shell  was  broken  under  the  cover-glass. 

The  usual  colour  of  the  sarcode  of  the  pelagic  Foraminifera  is-- 
yellowish-brown.  In  Hastigerina  it  is  bright  red  from  the  presence 
of  red  coloured  oil-globules  and  pigment.  This  red  colour  enabled 
me  to  pick  up  this  species  with  a  beaker  on  the  sea-surface  more 
easily  than  other  species.  In  Globigerina  bulloides  (hirsuta)  and 
aequilateralis  the  yellow-orange  colour  of  the  sarcode  is  due  to  the. 
presence  of  numerous  oval-shaped  xanthidise,  or  '  yellow  cells,' 
similar  to  those  found  in  the  Radiolaria.  When  the  sarcode  with 
these  '  yellow  cells '  flows  out  of  the  foramina,  and  mounts  between 
the  numerous  spines  outside  the  shell,  the  whole  presents  a  very 
striking  object  under  the  microscope  ;  the  transparent  sarcode  can 
be  seen  running  up  and  down  the  long  silk-like  spines,  and  the 
'  yellow  cells,'  seated  at  the  base  of  these  spines,  quite  obscure  the 
body  of  the  shell. 

The  majority  of  the  species  in  the  above  list  occur  within  the 
tropics,  and  the  thick-shelled  species  occur  only  in  warm  water,  such 
as  Sphaeroidina  dehiscens,  Pulvinulina  menardii  (Fig.  4),  Pullenia 
obliquilocidata,  Globigerina  conglobata  and  saccidifcra.  The  number  of 
species  becomes  less  in  the  temperate  regions,  Pulvinulina  michelini- 
ana and  canariensis,  Orbulina  universa  (Fig.  2),  Globigerina  bidloides 
and  injlata  being  the  prevailing  forms.     In  the  Arctic  and  Antarctic 

1  See  Narr.  Chall.  Exp.,  vol.  i.,  pp.  838-9,  1885. 


1897]     DISTRIBUTION  OF  PELAGIC  FOBAMINIFERA       21 

regions  Globigcrina  dutcrtrci  and  pachy  derma,  together  with  very 
minute  specimens  of  Globigcrina  bulloidcs,  appear  to  be  the  only  forms 
present  in  the  surface  waters.  The  gradual  disappearance  of  the 
tropical  species,  and  their  replacement  by  other  species,  as  the  colder 
water  to  the  north  and  south  of  the  equatorial  regions  is  entered,  has 


Fig.  2. — Orbulina  imiversa  (d'Orbigny),  from  the  surface. 

always  appeared  to  me  rather  puzzling,  especially  when  it  is  re- 
membered that  these  changes  take  place  in  a  continuous  oceanic 
current,  like  the  Gulf  Stream,  flowing  from  the  equator  towards  the 
poles.  It  sometimes  seemed  as  if  the  one  form  slowly  passed  into 
the  other  with  the  changed  conditions  of  surface  temperature. 

The  same  species  inhabit  all  the  great  oceans,  but  in  the  Indian 
and    Pacific   Oceans    certain    species    appear    to    predominate,   for 


99 

—  _ 


NATURAL  SCIENCE 


[July 


instance,  Pullenia  ohliqidloculata  and  Globicjcrina  aequilatcralis ;  on 
the  other  hand,  Pulvinulina  menarclii  and  Gldbigcrina  rubra  appear 
to  be  more  abundant  in  the  tropical  Atlantic. 

The  species  inhabiting  the  north  and  south  temperate  regions, 
and  the  species  inhabiting  the  two  polar  regions,  appear  to  be 
nearly  if  not  quite  identical. 

The  distribution  of  the  dead  shells  of  the  pelagic  Foraminifera 
on  the  floor  of  the  ocean  corresponds  exactly  with  the  distribution 
of  the  living  specimens  at  the  surface  of  the  sea.  It  has  sometimes 
been  urged  that  the  dead  shells  of  tropical  species  might  be  carried 
a  long  way  to  the  north  or  to  the  south  by  oceanic  currents,  but 
this  does  not  seem  in  any  way  to  be  the  case ;  the  distribution  of 
the  dead  shells  on  the  bottom  does  not  appear  to  be  much  if  any 


Fig.  3. — Cymbalopora  (Tretomphalus)  bulloides  (d'Orbigny).  a,  large  surface  specimen  ; 
b,  small  (young)  specimens  from  the  same  gathering  ;  c,  distal  face  of  the 
balloon-like  chamber,  showing  the  entosolenian  orifice,  seated  in  a  slight 
depression.     All  magnified  60  diam. 

wider  than  that  of  the  living  specimens  at  the  surface,  and  this 
shows  that  the  dead  shells  must  reach  the  bottom  a  very  short  time 
after  the  death  of  the  organisms.  The  fact  that  the  distribution  of 
these  shells  at  the  bottom  of  the  ocean  is  governed  by  the  surface 
conditions  is  of  itself  almost  conclusive  proof  that  they  live  only  at 
the  surface,  for  otherwise  their  distribution  would  be  similar  to 
that  of  bottom-living,  or  benthos,  species,  which  is  wholly  inde- 
pendent of  the  temperature  conditions  prevailing  at  the  surface  of 
the  sea.  Carpenter x  and  Brady  2  at  one  time  held  the  view  that 
young  individuals  lived  at  the  surface  and  adult  ones  at  the  bottom ; 
in  addition  to  the  fact  that  no  living  specimen  has  ever  been  obtained 
from  the  bottom,  the  above  considerations  with  regard  to  distribu- 
tion show  that  this  view  is  not  supported  by  any  trustworthy  obser- 
vations.     In  the  surface  gatherings  the  young  individuals  are  much 


1  Op.  cit. 


-  Op.  cit. 


1897]     DISTRIBUTION  OF  PELAGIC  FORAMINIFERA       23 

more  abundant  than  adult  ones,  still  shells  as  heavy  as  any  in  the 
deposits  are  occasionally  taken  in  the  surface-nets.  The  young 
individuals  are  likewise  more  abundant  at  the  surface  than  in  the 
deposit,  when  compared  with  the  adult  shells  present ;  this  is 
especially  the  case  in  deposits  from  very  deep  water.  This  arises, 
as  we  shall  see,  from  the  more  rapid  solution  of  the  young  shells  as 
they  fall  through  the  sea-water  to  the  bottom. 

When  examining  a  deep-sea  deposit  it  is  always  possible  to  say, 
from  a  study  of  the  pelagic  shells  of  the  Foraminifera,  whether  the 
sample  comes  from  the  tropics,  the  temperate  or  the  polar  regions, 
but  from  the  examination  of  these  shells  alone  it  would  be  extremely  ^ 
difficult  to  say  whether  the  specimen  was  from  the  northern  or 
southern  hemisphere. 

Off  the  Agulhas  Bank  at  the  Cape  of  Good  Hope,  off  the  east 
coasts  of  Australia  and  Japan,  and  off  the  east  coasts  of  North  and 
South  America,  oceanic  currents  from  different  sources  meet  and 


Fig.  4. — Pulvinulina  menardii  (d'Orbigiiy),  from  the  tropical  deposits. 

mix,  and  there  is  a  wide  range  of  annual  temperature  at  the  sur- 
face. In  these  positions  large  numbers  of  pelagic  Foraminifera  (as 
well  as  other  organisms)  appear  to  be  killed  by  the  sudden  changes 
of  temperature,  and  consequently  there  are  indications  that  the 
deposits,  so  far  as  due  to  these  shells,  are  accumulating  more  rapidly 
in  these  areas  than  in  other  situations.  It  is  a  curious  fact  also 
that  in  these  regions  the  deposits  of  glauconite  and  phosphatic 
nodules  are  more  abundant  than  elsewhere. 

In  a  certain  sense  the  course  of  a  surface  oceanic  current  can 
be  traced  on  the  bottom  by  means  of  these  dead  pelagic  shells ; 
for  instance,  the  axis  of  the  Gulf  Stream  is  marked  out  by  deposits 
of  Globigerina  Ooze  from  the  Strait  of  Florida  to  within  the  Arctic 
circle.  No  similar  warm  current  enters  the  Antarctic  region,  and 
consequently  no  true  Globigerina  Ooze  is  found  to  the  south  of 
lat.  50°  S.  When  the  Challenger  took  her  first  deep-sea  sound- 
ing after  leaving  Heard  Island  (in  lat.  60°  S.)  there  was  much 
speculation  as    to  what   the   nature  of   the    deposit    would  be.      I 


V 


24 


NATURAL  SCIENCE 


[July 


ventured  to  say  that  it  would  not  be  a  Globigerina  Ooze,  founding 
that  opinion  on  the  fact  that  only  one  or  two  small  Foraminifera 
had  been  observed  in  the  tow-nets  for  several  days.  When  a 
white-coloured  deposit  was  brought  on  board  from  1260  fathoms 
the  laugh  was  rather  against  '  the  philosophers,'  for  in  external 
appearance  it  greatly  resembled  the  calcareous  oozes  of  the  Atlantic. 
On  examination,  however,  it  was  found  to  be  a  Diatom  Ooze  with 
only  relatively  few  Globigerina  shells. 

The  most  striking  peculiarity  in  connection  with  the  distribution 
of  these  dead  shells  on  the  floor  of  the  ocean  is  the  fact  that  they 
are  wholly  absent  from  all  the  greater  depths  of  the  ocean,- although 
at  the  surface  their  living  representatives  are  as  abundant  over 
these  deep  areas  as  elsewhere.  If  we  suppose  a  volcanic  cone  to 
rise  from  the  greater  depths  of  the  ocean  up  to  within  400  or  300 
fathoms  of  the  surface,  it  will  be  found  that  the  summit  of  this 
cone  is  covered  with  a  calcareous  deposit  for  the  most  part  made  up 


Fig.  5.— Globigerina  Ooze,  from  1900  fathoms  in  the  Atlantic  ;  magnified  25  diam. 

of  the  dead  shells  of  pelagic  organisms,  the  deposit  may  contain 
90  per  cent,  of  carbonate  of  lime,  and  in  it  every  species  of  shell 
met  with  in  the  surface  waters  of  the  region  is  represented.  As 
we  descend  the  sides  of  this  cone  into  deeper  water,  the  thinner 
and  more  delicate  shells,  like  Candcina  and  Hastigerina,  disappear 
first  from  the  deposit  (along  with  the  Pteropod  shells).  In  about 
2000  fathoms  the  deposit  consists  chiefly  of  pelagic  Foraminifera, 
and  the  proportion  of  young  shells  is  much  smaller  than  in  the 
deposits  at  lesser  depths.  With  increasing  depth  the  whole  of 
these  calcareous  shells  gradually  disappear,  till  at  4000  and  5000 
fathoms  probably  not  a  vestige  of  them  can  be  traced,  and  the 
deposit  all  round  the  cone  in   3000  fathoms  becomes  a  Red  Clay 


1897]     DISTRIBUTION  OF  PELAGIC  FORAMINIFFRA       25 

with  only  traces  of  carbonate  of  lime  in  its  composition.  Again,  if 
we  suppose  a  basin-like  depression  on  the  floor  of  the  ocean,  the 
centre  of  which  descends  to  4000  or  5000  fathoms,  while  the  rim 
of  the  basin  has  only  a  depth  of  1000  or  2000  fathoms,  then,  on 
the  rim  deposits  of  Pteropod  and  Globigerina  Oozes  will  be  found 
with  70  or  80  per  cent,  of  carbonate  of  lime,  while  the  centre  of 
the  basin  will  be  occupied  by  a  Eed  Clay  with  probably  not  a  trace 
of  these  carbonate  of  lime  shells.  The  gradual  disappearance  of 
these  calcareous  shells  with  increasing  depth  is  evidently  due  to  the 
solvent  action  of  sea-water,  and  especially  of  deep-sea  water.  In 
the  lesser  depths  a  very  large  proportion  of  these  surface  shells 
seem  to  reach  the  bottom  before  they  are  completely  dissolved,  and 
accumulation  takes  place.  With  increasing  depth  the  more  delicate 
shells  are  dissolved  before  reaching  the  bottom,  and  accumulation 
becomes  slower  and  slower,  the  last  traces  of  these  shells  observed 
in  the  deposits  with  increasing  depth  being  broken  fragments  of 
large  Pulvinidinae  and  Sphaeroidinac.  The  greater  quantity  of  lime 
in  solution  which  Dittmar  found  in  the  Challenger  samples  of  deep- 
sea  water  is  apparently  a  consequence  of  the  solution  of  the  pelagic 
shells  here  referred  to. 

During  the  early  part  of  the  Challenger  Expedition,  Wyville 
Thomson  was  much  puzzled  to  account  for  the  origin  of  the  fine 
Eed  Clay  which  occupies  the  basin-like  depressions  of  the  sea-bed 
far  from  land,  and  he  suggested  that  this  was  an  ash x  left  behind 
after  the  solution  of  the  carbonate  of  lime  shells.  He  was  led  to 
this  view  by  observing  that  when  the  shells  were  taken  from  the 
purest  samples  of  Globigerina  Ooze,  and,  after  being  carefully 
washed  with  pure  water,  were  dissolved  with  dilute  acid,  a  small 
clayey  residue  of  a  red  colour  remained  behind.  I  was  not  satisfied 
with  this  experiment,  for  I  observed  that  the  colour  of  the  residue 
varied  in  different  samples,  and  it  seemed  to  me  that  the  fine  clayey 
matter  had  infiltrated  the  shells  after  they  had  reached  the  bottom. 
I  accordingly  collected,  in  the  course  of  several  months,  about  10 
grammes  of  pelagic  Foraminif era  from  the  surface  of  the  sea.  When 
these  shells  were  dissolved  in  dilute  acid  not  a  vestige  of  residue 
was  observed.  It  was  subsequently  shown  that  the  Eed  Clay  came 
from  a  variety  of  sources,  and  that  in  the  deep  sea  far  from  con- 
tinents it  was  chiefly  derived  from  the  trituration  and  decomposi- 
tion of  floating  pumice.2 

During  the  past  year  or  two  I  have  carefully  collected  all  the 
available  temperatures  of  the  surface  waters  of  the  ocean,  and  from 
these  have  constructed  a  map  showing  the  annual  range  of  tempera- 

1  Proc.  Roy.  Soc,  vol.  xxiii.,  p.  45.     1874. 

2  See  Murray,  Proc.  Roy.   Soc.    Edin.,  vol.  ix.,  p.  247.      1876;  also   Murray  and 
Renard,  Deep-Sea  Deposits  Chall.  Exp.,  p.  294.     1891. 


26  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [July 

ture  in  different  regions  of  the  ocean.  This  map  shows  that  the 
surface  of  the  sea  may  be  grouped  into  five  great  zones,  viz.  : — (1) 
A  nearly  continuous  equatorial  zone,  where  the  temperature  is  high 
and  the  range  throughout  the  year  does  not  exceed  10°  Fahrenheit. 
This  zone  includes  all  the  principal  coral-reef  regions.  (2  and  3) 
Two  polar  zones,  where  the  temperature  is  low  and  the  annual  range 
likewise  does  not  exceed  10°  F.  In  these  zones  there  are  relatively 
few  lime-secreting  organisms.  (4  and  5)  Two  regions  lying  between 
the  equatorial  zone  and  the  two  polar  zones,  where  a  wide  range  of 
temperature  occurs  between  the  different  seasons  (the  annual  range 
amounting  to  as  much  as  52°  F.  in  some  places).  In  these  tem- 
perate regions  the  secretion  of  carbonate  of  lime  appears  to  be  much 
more  active  in  the  warmer  than  in  the  colder  months.  It  thus 
appears  that  the  most  favourable  conditions  for  lime-secreting 
organisms  are  met  with  in  the  warm,  equable  tropical  waters  of  the 
ocean,  and  here  as  a  matter  of  fact  we  find  the  greatest  develop- 
ment of  corals,  and  the  largest  number  of  lime-secreting  pelagic 
organisms.  In  the  polar  areas  and  in  the  cold  water  of  the  deep 
sea  there  is,  as  is  well  known,  a  feeble  development  of  all  carbonate 
of  lime  structures  in  marine  organisms. 

From  experiments  which  have  been  carried  out  by  Mr  Irvine 
and  myself  at  the  Granton  Marine  Station,  we  have  reason  to  believe 
that  this  distribution  is  dependent  primarily  on  the  physical  or  tem- 
perature conditions  of  the  oceanic  waters.  When  carbonate  of  lime 
is  precipitated  by  alkaline  solutions,  such  as  carbonate  of  soda, 
carbonate  of  ammonia,  or  carbonate  of  methylamine,  the  effect  of 
temperature  is  very  marked,  and  it  appears  to  be  the  case  that  the 
secretion  of  carbonate  of  lime  by  organisms  is  of  the  nature  of  a  fine 
precipitation  in  the  interior  of  the  soft  structures.1  If  we  add 
sufficient  carbonate  of  ammonia  to  sea-water  at  different  temperatures 
to  convert  all  the  lime  salts  present  into  carbonate,  we  obtain  a  pre- 
cipitate which  varies  both  in  its  crystalline  form,  in  amount,  and  in 
time  of  formation.  At  32°  F.  the  precipitate  begins  to  form  in 
about  six  hours  as  small  but  distinct  crystals  of  calcite,  the  quan- 
tity in  twenty  hours  amounting  only  to  0'2  gramme  from  a  litre  of 
water.  At  a  temperature  of  about  47°  F.  a  mixture  of  calcite  and 
aragonite  is  precipitated;  at  80°  to  90°  F.  the  quantity  precipitated 
is  about  0*6  gramme,  the  precipitate  begins  to  form  in  from  a  half 
to  one  hour,  and  it  appears  to  consist  of  minute  crystals  of  aragonite. 
It  thus  seems  evident  that  carbonate  of  lime  would  be  more  easily 
and  more  rapidly  secreted  in  the  high  temperatures  of  the  tropics 
by  means  of  the  effete  products  of  the  organism. 

As  is  well  known,  carbonate  of  lime  in  any  form  is  easily  soluble 
in  water  containing  carbonic  acid,  and  the  aragonite  form  is  more 

1  Murray  and  Irvine,  I'roc.  Roy.  Soc.  Ed/in.,  vol.  xvii.,  pp.  79-109.    1S90. 


1897 j     DISTRIBUTION  OF  PELAGIC  FOEAMINIFERA       27 

quickly  soluble  than  the  calcite  form  in  the  proportion  of  about  three 
to  two.  Both  aragonite  and  calcite  are  apparently  very  partially 
soluble  in  sea-water  which  does  not  contain  free  or  loosely-combined 
carbonic  acid,  but  when  these  dead  shells  are  in  contact  with  decaying 
organic  matter,  giving  off  carbonic  acid,  they  are  rapidly  dissolved. 
An  experiment  with  Globigerina  Ooze  in  a  sea- water  containing 
additional  carbonic  acid  showed  that  the  thin  walls  of  the  chambers 
of  the  shells  were  first  dissolved,  leaving  rings  of  the  thicker  por- 
tions of  the  Pulvinulina  shells,  for  example.  Decaying  organic 
matter  has  a  powerful  solvent  action  on  carbonate  of  lime,  due  to 
two  causes :  (1)  by  the  carbonic  acid  formed  as  one  of  the  products 
of  this  decay,  and  (2)  on  account  of  the  formation  of  sulphides  and 
sulphuretted  hydrogen,  due  to  the  reduction  of  the  sulphides  present 
in  sea-water.1  John  Murray. 

1  See  Murray  and  Irvine,  op.  cit.,  table  on  p.  106. 


590.7(7)  28  [July 


II. 

A  California!!  Marine  Biological  Station. 


'©j 


T 


VHE  European  zoologist  who  visited  the  Pacific  states  would  be 
very  apt  to  find  his  way  to  the  old  Spanish-Calif ornian  town 
of  Monterey,  and  to  the  Marine  Laboratory  of  the  Leland  Stanford 
Junior  University.  As  this  station,  however,  seems  to  the  present 
writer  surprisingly  little  known  in  proportion  to  its  deserts,  a  brief 
account  of  its  equipment  and  surroundings  may  prove  of  interest  to 
the  readers  of  Natural  Science. 

This  at  the  present  time  is  the  only  permanent  biological  station 
on  the  American  side  of  the  Pacific.  Temporary  stations  have 
indeed  been  established  within  recent  years.  The  University  of 
California  has  several  times  carried  on  a  seaside  school  of  zoology, 
both  at  Pacific  Grove  near  Monterey,  and  on  the  Santa  Catalina 
Islands  in  the  region  of  Santa  Barbara.  Further  northward,  in 
Puget  Sound,  Washington,  a  local  society,  that  of  the  Young 
Naturalists  of  Seattle,  has  done  excellent  faunal  work  during  its 
camping  seasons ;  and  in  the  same  region  during  last  summer 
Columbia  University  of  New  York  established  a  laboratory  at  Port 
Townsend. 

The  Stanford,  or  the  Hopkins  Laboratory,  as  it  is  called,  is  both 
an  annexe  and  an  integral  part  of  its  university.  It  was,  indeed, 
contemplated  as 'early  as  the  time  of  the  building  of  the  university, 
when  it  was  decided  that  a  portion  of  the  studies  in  zoology  and 
botany  might  be  carried  on  during  the  summer,  the  students  to  be 
given  the  regular  credit  for  their  work  as  in  the  winter  courses. 
It  was,  accordingly,  with  a  summer  laboratory  in  view,  that  in  1891 
two  of  the  Stanford  professors,  Drs  0.  P.  Jenkins  and  C.  H.  Gilbert, 
visited  the  region  of  Monterey  (which  had  indeed  been  known  to 
Dr  Gilbert  previously  during  his  studies  on  the  fishes  of  the  Pacific), 
and  made  a  reconnaissance  to  determine  the  particular  point  of  the 
bay  which  was  best  suited  to  the  needs  of  the  collector  and  investi- 
gator. The  site  they  then  determined  upon  was  at  Pacific  Grove,  a 
few  miles  westward  of  Monterey.  Here,  in  the  first  place  were 
found  most  favourable  fields  for  collecting.  The  shores  were 
unshifting,  the  coast  was  rugged,  while  huge  rock  masses  and  bluffs 
alternated  with  sheltered  harbours  and  beaches,  rich  in  forms  of 
animals  and  seaweed  life.  The  locality  seemed  also  a  particularly 
convenient  one  on  account  of  its  facilities  for  the  lodging  and  living 


1897]   A  CALIFORNIAN MARINE  BIOLOGICAL  STATION   29 


of  students,  a  summer  settlement  of  possibly  five  hundred  people 
being  in  the  immediate  neighbourhood.  It  was  here  finally  that 
land  was  obtained,  a  gift  of  the  Pacific  Grove  Improvement  Com- 
pany, and  the  buildings  were  shortly  put  up  and  equipped,  thanks 
to  the  generosity  of  Mr  Timothy  Hopkins,  after  whom  the  laboratory 
has  been  named. 

The  buildings  are  shown  in  the  adjoining  figure  (Fig.  1),  but 


J 


^' 


f 


SK?.flW'" 


Fig.  1. — The  Hopkins  Seaside  Laboratory,  near  Monterey,  California.     East  view.* 

the  picture  gives  only  a  slight  idea  of  their  surroundings  ;  thus  they 
are  seen  to  be  built  on  a  level  field,  and  there  is  but  a  glimpse  of 
the  sea  in  the  background.  One  needs,  therefore,  to  imagine  the 
laboratory  site  as  a  small  treeless  plateau,  on  the  top  of  an  abrupt 
rocky  point  which  terminates  about  a  hundred  yards  to  the  right  in 
the  picture.  The  sea  surrounds  the  buildings,  therefore,  on  three 
sides.  In  front  there  is  a  sheltered  harbour  and  a  small  sandy 
beach,  furnishing  an  admirable  landing  place  for  the  boats ;  at  the 
back  the  surf  is  breaking  on  the  rocks  thirty  feet  below — hardly 
far  enough  away  as  it  has  been  proved,  for  in  the  winter  storms  the 
waves  have  threatened  to  overturn  the  buildings,  and  have  rendered 
necessary  the  additional  braces  which  one  sees  at  the  corners  of  the 
building.  From  its  position  the  laboratory  becomes  a  prominent 
feature  of  the  entire  neighbourhood.  The  visitor  will  not  fail  to 
notice  it  even  at  the  incoming  of  his  train,  for  he  naturally  will  be 
looking  seaward  after  his  three  hours'  journey  from  San  Francisco. 
He  will  just  have  passed  through  the  hot  and  dusty  valley  country, 
but  his  interest  revives  as  the  train  emerges  on  the  sea-coast  at 
Monterey,  thence  to  skirt  the  shore  of  the  bay  during  the  few  final 
minutes  of  the  trip. 

The  bay  of  Monterey  appears  not  unlike  that  of  Naples.     There 
is  the  same  long  curving  beach,  broken  with  rocky  points,  the  clear 


*  The  illustrations  have  been  prepared  by  Mr  Percy  Buckman  from  photographs 
taken  by  the  author. 


30 


NATURAL  SCIENCE 


[July 


blue  water,  and  the  same  setting  of  half  tropical  vegetation,  although 
the  mountainous  background  is  lacking.  The  climate  is  here  less 
variable  than  at  Naples ;  the  temperature  remains  almost  constant 
throughout  the  year,  each  day  averaging  about  60°R,  and  during 
six  of  the  months  outdoor  life  is  not  interrupted  by  rain.  The 
railroad  line  terminates  at  Pacific  Grove.  Here  on  one  side  of  the 
railroad  are  bluffs  and  the  rocky  point  on  which  the  laboratory  is 
situated,  while  on  the  other  a  tidy  little  town,  with  well  kept  villas, 
bright  shops,  lines  of  tents  for  the  summer  campers,  a  good  hotel, 
and  a  small  park-like  square,  rich  in  the  deep  greens  and  light 
olives  of  Californian  plants.  All  about  are  scattered  forest  trees — 
live  oaks,  tall  pines,  eucalyptus  and  palms.  With  these  are 
numerous  trees  and  hedges  of  the  Monterey  cypress  (C.  macrocarpa), 
whose  very  restricted  range  gives  it  an  especial  interest. 

Point  Aulon,  the  little  promontory  on  which  the  laboratory  is 
situated,  juts  out  from  the  western  end  of  the  town.      It  has  been 


PB'JCKMAN.Jlf. 


~^ee-: 


!*£>.-"•: 


'*ttil^^ 


f* 


'*p  n^ 


Fid.  2. — The  Hopkins  Laboratory.     West  view. 

fenced  off  as  a  kind  of  marine  park  for  the  cottagers ;  and  here  at 
all  times  throughout  the  summer  may  be  seen  clusters  of  people, 
old  and  young,  idling  away  their  holidays,  clambering  about  the 
rocks,  or  watching  the  ceaseless  strings  of  cormorants,  or  the  doings 
of  the  little  school  of  boats  huddled  closely  together  off  the  point 
salmon  catching,  or  the  return  of  the  little  fleet  of  Chinese  fisher- 
men, whose  curious  town  may  be  seen  on  a  projecting  coast  point 
in  the  direction  of  Monterey.  Such  a  thing  as  the  sight  of  an 
occasional  whale  or  sea-lion,  and  these  will  come  surprisingly  near 
the  point,  or  even  the  loss  of  a  straw  hat,  will  cause  a  flutter  of 
excitement  among  the  summer  visitors,  diverting  their  attention,  as 
a  student  will  uncharitably  believe,  from  their  attempts  to  invade 
the  penetralia  of  the  laboratory. 

Our  second  illustration  (Fig.  2)  gives  a  west  view  of  the  two 
buildings.  The  older,  used  during  the  first  and  second  sessions  of 
the  summer  school  in  1892  and  1893,  stands  to  the  left,  long,  and 


1897]   A  CALIFORNIAN  MARINE  BIOLOGICAL  STATION   31 

with  many  windows.  It  measures  sixty  feet  long  by  twenty  feet 
wide.  The  newer,  smaller,  but  more  substantial  building  measures 
forty  by  twenty-six  feet.  From  the  figure  one  may  also  see  the 
two  large  salt-water  tanks,  which  have  been  so  arranged  that  each 
can  supply  either  building.  The  older  building  is  now  used  mainly 
for  the  classes  of  elementary  students.  It  has  two  laboratories  on 
the  ground  floor,  a  small  engine  room,  and  a  concreted  workshop, 
which  serves  as  a  dissecting  room  for  the  larger  marine  beasts. 
Upstairs  a  long  laboratory  faces  the  east,  and  on  the  south  side  a 
series  of  small  separate  rooms  have  been  arranged  for  investigators. 
In  the  newer  building  a  laboratory  occupies  the  rear  end  of  the 
ground  floor,  used  during  last  summer  mainly  for  students  in  the 
botanical  courses  ;  and  on  the  floor  just  above  there  is  a  room  of 
the  same  size,  with  blackboards,  cases,  and  portable  tables,  used 
both  as  a  lecture  room  and  laboratory.  The  front  part  of  the  house 
in  both  storeys  is  divided  by  partitions  into  a  dozen  rooms  for  in- 
vestigators, and  it  has,  in  addition,  a  photographic  dark  room. 
Throughout  both  buildings  the  fittings  are  simple  but  adequate. 
There  is  an  abundant  supply  of  microscopes,  reagents,  glassware 
and  the  usual  set  of  dredges,  tangles,  and  nets,  a  small  beam-trawl, 
and  apparatus  for  sounding  and  temperature-taking.  At  present 
the  boat  facilities  include  only  a  rowing  boat  and  a  small  sailing 
boat,  the  latter  almost  too  small  for  dredging  or  trawling,  except  in 
comparatively  shallow  water.  Hitherto,  however,  the  laboratory 
seems  scarcely  to  have  needed  collecting  facilities  for  .  the  deeper 
water — enough  at  least  to  warrant  the  support  of  a  steam  vessel. 
The  shore  fauna  has  been  of  the  richest,  and  dredging  in  shallow 
water  could  well  be  done  with  the  boat  at  hand.  As  a  convenient 
■means  of  collecting  in  the  shallow  rocky  bays  a  water-glass  has 
been  found  of  great  service,  especially  in  securing  conspicuous 
forms  such  as  echinoderms  and  holothurians,  and  has  to  a  certain 
degree  served  as  a  substitute  for  diving  apparatus,  which  here,  as  at 
the  French  marine  station  at  Banyuls,  might  well  prove  of  the 
greatest  value.  The  station  has  never  found  difficulty  in  securing 
an  abundant  supply  of  fish  material,  thanks  to  the  Chinese  fishermen 
of  the  neighbouring  village. 

A  whole  article  might  be  written  on  this  small  Chinese  village 
near  Monterey.  It  is  but  a  quarter  of  an  hour's  walk  from  the 
laboratory,  approached  along  the  ledge  of  the  railroad  on  the  seaside 
rim  of  the  town — a  daily  walk  for  a  number  of  the  students,  who 
have  come  to  have  the  greatest  faith  in  the  fishing  powers  of  the 
heathen.  This  walk  is  by  no  means  an  uninteresting  one  ;  the  sea- 
birds  are  around,  whitening  the  tall  rocky  ledges,  and  on  every  hand 
there  are  quantities  of  little  ground  squirrels — a  species  of  sper- 
mophile — which  sit  up  before  the  visitor  like  little  prairie   dogs. 


32 


NATURAL  SCIENCE 


[July 


The  village  itself  looks  as  though  it  has  been  imported  from  China 
in  its  present  condition,  a  huddled  little  town  of  unpainted  shanties 
sprinkled  closely  along  a  crowded  street,  with  a  few  shops,  a  joss- 
house,  and  a  sky-line  of  picturesque  scaffolding  for  fish-drying. 
There  will  be  a  crowd  of  mushroom-hatted  fishermen,  a  din  of 
chaffering,  a  mixture  of  nets,  trawl  lines  and  baskets,  distinctly 
unpleasant  odours,  placards  of  crimson  and  tinsel  spattered  with 
Chinese  characters.  The  people  are  Cantonese,  many  of  whom  have 
been  living  here  for  two  generations.  They  are  classed  as  a 
peculiar  poor  grade  of  Chinaman,  and  are,  I  am  told,  looked  upon 
at  home  as  mere  barbarians,  if  for  no  better  reasons,  that  they  have 
lived  in  China  only  two  or  three  centuries,  and  are  unable  to  trace 
their  descent  for  more  than  seven  generations.  To  the  stranger,  how- 
ever, they  certainly  appear  very  industrious,  honest  (except  in  bargain- 
ing), kindly  and  painstaking.      They  are  excellent  fishermen,  and  in 


Fig.  3. — The  Chinese  Fishing  Village  at  Monterey.     A  corner  of  the  beach. 

several  instances  very  intelligent  collectors.  Their  little  fleet  of 
boats  is  often  out  before  sunrise ;  between  seven  and  ten  they  have 
become  scattered  along  the  coast,  and  their  trawl  lines  are  put  out, 
often  six  or  more  (each  about  five-eighths  of  a  mile  long)  to  a  boat ; 
about  noon-time  they  return,  their  skiffs  sometimes  gunwale-deep 
with  fish-rock  cod,  black  bass,  flounders,  mackerel,  with  an  occa- 
sional wolf-fish,1  their  little  latteen  sails  making  the  picture  a  still 
more  foreign  one.  In  a  few  moments  after  landing,  the  fish  are 
carried  off  in  shoulder  baskets,  to  be  shipped  to  San  Francisco,  and 
the  boats  are  drawn  high  up  on  the  beach  (Fig.  3).  The  little  colony 
also  carries  on  a  very  successful  squid-catching  industry,  so  that  at 
night  there  is  often  as  much  life  and  excitement  in  Chinatown  as 
during  the  day.  The  amount  of  a  catch  will  often  be  measured  by  tons. 
1  Sebastodes  (nebulosus)  and  melanops,  Scomber  (colias),  Platichthys,  Anarrhichthys. 


1897]   A  CALIFORNIAN  MARINE  BIOLOGICAL  STATION   33 

The  boats  go  out  with  nets  and  red  pine  fires,  which  are  hung  cresset- 
wise  over  the  sides  of  the  boats  to  lure  the  squid.  Some  of  these  are 
intended  to  be  cleaned  and  dried  on  latticed  trays  as  a  staple  article 
of  diet  in  Chinese  markets.  The  bulk  of  the  catch  is,  however, 
spread  over  the  fields  for  drying,  then  to  be  packed  in  matting  bags 
for  export  to  China,  as  a  rich  fertilizer  for  the  rice  fields.  Another 
phase  of  their  industry  is  that  of  collecting  abalones,  Haliotis,  these 
also  to  be  dried  for  export.  The  people  have  their  usual  Oriental 
thrift, — they  are  infamous  at  a  bargain,  but  make  up  this  deficiency 
by  the  skill  with  which  they  separate  the  fertile  or  unfertile  eggs  of 
sharks  or  Bdcllostoma,  and  recognise  what  they  refer  to  as  the  '  hen ' 
or  '  rooster  '  sharks  or  rat-fish  {Chimaera). 

There  is  also  another  little  imported  village  in  this  neighbour- 
hood, nearer  Monterey,  namely,  a  settlement  of  Portuguese,  who, 
like  the  Chinese,  have  retained  minutely  their  foreign  ways.  Their 
boats  are  precisely  those  one  would  see  in  the  Tagus,  and,  judging 
from  the  writer's  experience  in  Portugal,  he  believes  that  the 
immigrants  have  not  improved  in  the  way  of  zoological  collectors. 

The  laboratory  has  now  completed  its  fifth  season,  and  the  work 
of  last  year  seems  to  have  been  carried  on  very  much  in  the  lines 
of  former  years.  There  is  a  class  in  the  dissection  of  types,  and  in 
the  study  of  methods,  limited  to  twenty  or  thirty  students,  each 
paying  a  stated  fee  for  a  term  of  six  weeks.  A  second  class  includes 
advanced  students  in  zoology,  mainly  from  Palo  Alto.  The  investi- 
gators, finally  to  be  mentioned,  occupy  the  private  rooms  in  both 
buildings.  These  are  afforded  their  quarters,  reagents,  and  collect- 
ing facilities  gratuitously.  Class  instruction  is  carried  on  by  the  pro- 
fessors of  the  Stanford  University,  during  the  present  year  by 
Doctors  Jenkins,  Shaw,  and  Wilbur.  Among  the  investigators  of 
the  past  summer  were  W.  R.  Shaw,  working  on  the  development 
of  conifers,  E.  P.  Wheeler,  on  the  embryology  of  Dicyema  and  on 
diptera,  D.  A.  Saunders,  on  the  brown  seaweeds,  H.  Heath,  on  the 
anatomy  and  development  of  Chiton,  0.  P.  Jenkins,  on  contractility 
of  muscles  and  conductivity  of  nerve-tissues  in  invertebrates,  H.  P. 
Johnson,  on  the  annelids,  and  W.  E.  Ritter,  on  the  ascidians,  W. 
A.  Setchell,  on  (laminarian)  seaweeds,  and  the  present  writer,  on  the 
development  of  Chimaera  and  Bdcllostoma.  Many  of  these  investi- 
gators have  previously  spent  summers  at  the  laboratory.  Among  the 
workers  of  former  seasons  might  be  mentioned  H.  Ayers,  whose 
lecture  on  Bdellostoma,  published  in  the  volume  of  zoological 
lectures  of  Wood's  Holl  Laboratory  (1893),  has  merited  wide  atten- 
tion. Dr  C.  H.  Gilbert,  as  the  director  of  the  station  jointly  with 
Dr  Jenkins,  has  also  been  a  constant  visitor,  and  has  here  prepared 
no  little  part  of  his  studies  on  the  ichthyology  of  the  Pacific.  Dr 
E.  C.  Price,  also  one  of  the  zoological  staff  at  Palo  Alto,  was  the 

c  33 


34 


NATURAL  SCIENCE 


[July 


first  of  the  several  workers  at  the  laboratory  to  secure  embryos  of 
Bdellostoma ;  while  on  the  botanical  side  F.  M.  M'Farland  and 
L.  H.  Campbell  have  been  in  frequent  attendance.  President  Jordan 
has  also  taken  the  warmest  personal  interest  in  the  work  of  the 
station,  and  although  his  researches  have  hardly  been  carried  on  at 
Pacific  Grove,  he  has,  nevertheless,  been  a  constant  visitor. 

It  is  evident,  perhaps,  from  the  foregoing  pages  that  the  zoologi- 
cal station  of  the  Stanford  University  has  neither  the  equipment 
nor  the  subsidies  of  the  Stazione  at  Naples,  or  even,  as  yet,  of  the 
laboratory  at  Wood's  Holl  ;  but  the  zoologist  will  certainly  find 
there  all  of  the  facilities  for  his  work  which  can  reasonably  be 
needed.  The  warm  interest  which  Dr.  Jenkins  has  shewn  in  the 
welfare  of  each  worker  of  the  station  will  not  be  forgotten  ;  and  it 
is  doubtless  due  in   no   small  degree  to  this  care  that  the  visitor 


Fig.  4. — The  Coast  of  the  Pacific  at  Cypress  Point,  near  Monterey. 

takes  away  with  him  the  kindliest  recollections  of  Stanford's  hospi- 
tality. The  richness  of  the  fauna  and  flora  of  this  little  nook  in  the 
Pacific  cannot  fail  to  leave  the  strongest  impression  upon  the 
visitor's  mind.  He  will  remember  the  rugged  shore  line,  with  its 
stunted  and  twisted  cypresses  (Fig.  4),  the  sunken  rocks  bristling 
with  the  largest  sea-urchins,  the  bright-coloured  star-fishes,  the 
orange-red  Cucumaria,  a  yard  in  length.  So  too  the  tidal  rocks 
covered  with  Pollicipes,  the  clumps  of  palm-tree-shaped  Postelsia, 
the  tangled  masses  of  bull-kelp  (Nereucystis  lutcana),  whose  stems 
are  often  many  fathoms  in  length  ;  the  field-like  areas  of  Macrocystis 
(i)/.  'pyrifera) ;  the  rich  molluscan  fauna,  including  the  red  shelled 
Haliotis,  to  be  found  even  at  the  base  of  the  laboratory  rocks, 
Cryptochiton  (C.  stellcri)  seven  inches  long,  and  abundant  nudibranchs. 
There  is  a  wealth  of  ascidians,  annelids  and  hydroids.     Nor  does 


1897]   A  CALIFORNIAN  MARINE  BIOLOGICAL  STATION   35 

this  neighbourhood  represent  the  vertebrates  in  a  less  interesting 
way.  Mr  Leverett  M.  Loomis,  curator  of  the  California  Academy 
of  Sciences,  tells  the  writer  that  the  coast  line  at  Monterey  is 
particularly  prolific  ornithologically ;  it  includes  among  its  common 
birds,  cormorants,  pelican,  auklets,  murres,  and  albatross.  Among 
fishes  there  are  several  forms  of  especial  interest.  A  species  of 
Chimacra  (Hydrolagm  collici)  is  plentiful  in  deeper  water,  twenty 
or  more  being  a  not  unusual  catch  by  a  single  boat.  The  hag-fish 
(Bdellostoma  stouti)  is  one  of  the  most  common  forms  of  the  bay  ; 
and  in  some  localities  it  is  so  abundant  that  it  becomes  a  serious 
nuisance  to  the  fishermen. 

Bash  ford  Dean. 

Columbia  University,  New  York  City, 
April  1,   1897. 


590.7(7)  36  [JuLY 


III 

The  Proposed  Zoological  Park  of  New  York 

TN  the  great  city  of  New  York,  at  the  present  time,  the  only  place 
-*-  where  living  animals  are  kept  for  the  edification  and  amuse- 
ment of  the  public  is  what  is  called  the  '  Central  Park  Menagerie,' 
under  the  control,  we  believe,  of  the  Commissioners  of  the  Public 
Parks,  which,  though  well  kept  and  arranged,  so  far  as  it  goes,  is 
utterly  unworthy  of  one  of  the  largest  cities  in  the  world,  which  is 
adorned  by  so  many  and  so  various  institutions.  Several  attempts 
have  been  made  at  different  periods  to  start  a  zoological  garden  on 
a  proper  scale  in  New  York,  but  it  is  only  within  the  last  few  years 
that  the  subject  has  been  taken  up  seriously,  and  in  a  manner 
which  seems  likely  to  produce  definite  results.  So  far,  however,  has 
the  matter  now  progressed,  that  we  have  before  us  the  first  Annual 
Eeport  of  the  New  York  Zoological  Society,  which  received  its 
charter  in  1885,  with  the  worthy  objects  of  "establishing  a  free 
zoological  park  to  contain  collections  of  native  and  exotic  animals,'" 
of  "  preserving  the  native  animals "  of  the  U.S.  from  further  de- 
struction, and  generally  of  promotiug  the  interests  of  zoological 
science. 

Let  us  now  see  what  the  first  Annual  Eeport  of  the  New  York 
Zoological  Society  tells  us  about  its  progress  and  future  prospects. 
Its  Executive  Committee  appear  to  be  mostly  business  men  of  New 
York,  who  are  interested  in  the  subject,  but  amongst  them  we  note 
the  name  (as  chairman)  of  Mr  Henry  F.  Osborn,  who  is  well  known 
to  all  the  scientific  world  as  one  of  our  leading  authorities  on 
mammals,  and  amongst  the  '  Scientific  Council '  we  recognize  the 
names  of  Prof.  Allen,  Mr  F.  M.  Chapman,  Dr  T.  H.  Bean,  and  other 
gentlemen  well  known  in  scientific  zoology.  In  Mr  W.  T.  Hornaday 
the  Council  have  made  a  choice  as  director  for  their  Park,  of  another 
gentleman  also  well  known  in  Europe,  who  possesses  many  excellent 
qualifications  for  the  post.  One  of  the  first  steps  taken  by  the  Com- 
mittee— and  a  very  wise  one — was  to  send  Mr  Hornaday  off  to 
Europe  for  the  purpose  of  inspecting  and  studying  in  detail  the  best 
zoological  gardens  of  England  and  the  Continent,  Mr  Hornaday's 
account  of  his  tour  of  inspection,  in  the  course  of  which  he 
visited  fifteen  zoological  gardens,  will  be  read  with  interest,  and 
we  think  we   may   say  not   without  profit,  by  all  those  who  wish 


X.t  TURAL  SCIENCE,   VOL.  XI. 


Platk  II. 


BIRD8-EYE   VIEW   i)F   THE   PROPOSED   ZOOLOGICAL   PARK   AT    NEW   YORK 
Photographed  from  the  Society's  Topographic  Model 


1897]    PROPOSED  ZOOLOGICAL  PARK  OF  NEW  YORK     37 

to  make  acquaintance  with  this  subject.  Five  of  the  gardens  visited, 
namely,  those  of  London,  Antwerp,  Amsterdam,  Hamburg  and 
Berlin,  are  classed  by  Mr  Hornaday  as  being  of  '  first  rank,'  and 
receive  due  praise  for  their  success  in  various  particulars.  Warm 
thanks  are  also  offered  to  the  officials  of  these  and  the  other 
gardens  for  the  great  help  they  have  afforded  to  Mr  Hornaday 
in  his  investigations.  The  principal  criticism  made  upon  these 
gardens  by  Mr  Hornaday  is  that  of  want  of  space,  many  of  them 
being  so  overcrowded  with  buildings  and  yards,  that  little  attempt 
can  be  made  to  imitate  the  natural  haunts  of  the  creatures  exhibited 
in  them. 

In  European  gardens,  Mr  Hornaday  truly  observes,  "the  large 
game — animals,  such  as  the  various  species  of  deer,  elk,  bison, 
buffaloes,  etc.,  are  kept  in  small  pens,  because  ample  park-space  is 
not  available.  Living  trees  are  never  utilized  as  homes  for  arboreal 
mammals.  Ledges  of  natural  rock  are  entirely  absent,  but  hills  of 
artificial  rock,  and  small  masses  of  stone,  are  quite  common.  With 
the  exception  of  the  great  '  flying '  cages  of  London,  Eotterdam  and 
Paris,  the  homes  provided  for  birds  are  always  of  the  most  conven- 
tional and  artificial  character.  The  '  flying '  cages,  however,  just 
mentioned  are  so  very  large,  and  contain  so  much  of  nature  in  the 
form  of  living  trees,  shrubs,  plants  and  water,  that  the  birds  within 
them  seem  to  be  as  much  at  home  as  if  they  were  really  in  a  state 
of  nature,  in  a  leafy  wilderness." 

We  shall  see  presently  that  in  the  proposed  new  garden  in  New 
York,  it  has  been  wisely  arranged  that  much  more  ample  space  shall 
be  provided  than  is  to  be  found  in  the  existing  establishments  in  the 
Old  World. 

Mr  Hornaday  also  speaks  of  the  attempts  made  in  some  of  the 
European  gardens  to  provide  oriental  buildings  for  oriental  animals, 
and  buildings  of  an  elaborate  architectural  design.  It  is  his 
opinion,  and  we  quite  agree  with  him,  that  conformity  to  a  plain 
and  uniform  style  of  architecture  is  more  desirable  in  such  matters 
than  a  "  succession  of  startling  contrasts." 

But  although  we  have  derived  much  instruction  from  Mr 
Hornaday's  Beport,  and  from  the  appositeness  of  some  of  his  remarks, 
it  is  time  now  to  turn  to  what  our  enterprising  American  friends 
propose  to  do  in  order  to  found  in  New  York  a  Zoological  Garden, 
certainly  better  provided  with  space,  and,  if  possible,  better  ordered 
in  every  other  respect  than  those  of  Europe.  In  selecting  for  the  site 
of  the  proposed  new  garden  South  Bronx  Park,  a  tract  of  "261  acres  of 
forest,  meadow-land,  and  water,"  in  the  northern  environs  of  the 
city,  in  what  is  called  the  "annexed  district,"  the  Executive  Council 
appear  to  have  made  a  wise  choice.  As  will  be  seen  by  the  bird's-eye 
view  of  the  surface  of  this  piece  of  ground,  taken  from  a  relief  model 


~Q 


8  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [jULY 


of  which  by  the  kind  favour  .of  that  Council  we  are  enabled  to  give  a 
copy  herewith  (Plate  II.),  the  ground  is  sufficiently  varied,  well  supplied 
with  water,  and  provided  with  plenty  of  trees  for  shade.  It  also  seems 
to  be  conveniently  accessible  by  several  lines  of  railway,  electric  and 
otherwise,  although  perhaps  rather  far  distant  from  the  great  centres 
of  New  York  population.  But  considering  its  large  dimensions  it 
could  hardly  be  expected  to  be  nearer.  If,  however,  the  proposed 
buildings  are  to  be  scattered  about  over  so  wide  an  area,  it  will 
become  necessary,  we  think,  ultimately,  if  not  immediately,  to  pro- 
vide some  mode  of  locomotion  from  one  building  to  another  within 
the  gardens. 

The  great  extent  of  space  available  in  South  Bronx  Park  will 
of  course  be  highly  advantageous  to  the  larger  Ruminants,  and  we 
may  expect  that  herds  of  deer,  antelopes  and  other  bovine  animals 
will  hereafter  form  one  of  its  marked  features.  Tlie  manner  in  which 
the  Executive  Committee  propose  to  deal  with  animals  of  this 
character  will  be  seen  by  a  second  illustration  which  our  friends 
have  likewise  provided  for  us  (Plate  III.),  and  which  represents  "  Elk 
at  sunrise,  photographed  from  life."  The  following  passages  extracted 
from  the  Report  inform  us  generally  of  the  views  of  the  Society  re- 
garding its  proposed  collection  of  living  animals,  in  the  wisdom  of 
which  we  must  all  fully  concur. 

"  As  may  fairly  be  expected,  the  first  duty  of  the  Society  in  the 
formation  of  collections,  will  be  to  bring  together  a  liberal  number 
of  fine  examples  of  the  more  noteworthy  and  interesting  species  of 
the  animals  of  North  America,  particularly  of  those  species  that  are 
threatened  with  extinction.  No  reasonable  effort  will  be  spared  to 
show  each  species  of  the  larger  mammals  under  conditions  of 
liberal  space  and  surroundings  which  will  at  least  suggest  its 
natural  haunts,  which  will  promote  the  comfort  and  longevity  of 
the  captives,  and  render  their  contemplation  by  visitors  a  pleasure. 
Next  to  the  mammals,  birds  and  reptiles  of  North  America,  the 
fauna  of  South  America  will  receive  attention  ;  but  the  Society's 
collections  must  of  necessity  include  a  sufficient  number  of  the 
living  creatures  of  the  Old  World  to  furnish  the  student  and  the 
general  public  with  good  examples  of  the  principal  orders,  families 
and  sub-families  of  the  higher  land-vertebrates  of  the  world. 

"  It  follows  that,  in  the  formation  of  the  numerous  living  col- 
lections, which  will  find  homes  in  the  Zoological  Park,  the  first  to 
be  gathered  will  be  the  representatives  of  the  '  great  game  animals ' 
of  North  America — the  buffalo,  elk,  moose,  mountain-sheep,  ante- 
lope, black-tailed  deer,  Virginia  deer,  and  caribou,  and  also  the 
mountain  goat,  if  it  can  be  induced  to  survive  in  this  climate.  The 
enclosures  planned  for  these  species  vary  in  area  from  three  to 
twenty  acres  each.      All  will   be  abundantly  provided  with  shade, 


1897]    rilOPOSED  ZOOLOGICAL  PARK  OF  NEW   YORK     39 

water  and  shelter,  and  such  cliff-dwellers  as  the  mountain-sheep 
will  be  located  on  rugged  masses  of  natural  rock.  It  is  proposed 
that  the  buffalo  herd  shall  contain  about  twenty-five  carefully 
selected  animals,  living  in  a  twenty-acre  range,  and  be  in  every 
way  worthy  to  represent  this  important  species." 

Tn  conclusion,  we  are  sure  that  all  persons  interested  in  Natural 
History  will  wish  full  success  to  the  Zoological  Society  of  New 
York,  and  will  hope  that  the  sum  necessarily  required  to  start  such 
a  large  undertaking  may  be  speedily  raised.  From  the  well-known 
munificence  of  the  wealthy  Americans  in  all  matters  of  this  sort  it 
cannot  be  doubted  that  these  expectations  will  be  abundantly 
realised.  P.  L.  Sclater. 


571.93(42.25)  40  [JuLY 


IV 
Primeval  Refuse  Heaps  at  Hastings 

"TTTHEN  we  reflect  upon  the  abundance  of  refuse  heaps  left 
VV  by  early  man  on  the  eastern  coast  of  the  North  Sea,  as 
compared  with  similar  accumulations  on  our  own  shores,  we  are 
tempted  to  seek  a  reason  for  the  remarkable  difference.  In  the 
former  region  these  relics  of  man  exist  for  many  miles  upon  the 
shores  as  enormous  heaps,  hundreds  of  yards  long  and  hundreds  of 
feet  in  width,  usually  varying  from  three  to  six  feet,  but  sometimes 
attaining  as  much  as  ten  or  twelve  feet  in  thickness ;  while  in 
England  they  are  practically  unknown. 

There  are  several  facts  in  connection  with  these  old  refuse  piles 
which  may  assist  us  in  our  search  for  them  in  the  British  Isles. 
In  the  first  place  they  are  the  relics  of  a  people  who  lived  upon 
fish,  supplemented  by  such  animal  food  as  they  were  fortunate  or 
clever  enough  to  obtain.  Darwin,  in  his  "  Journal "  (p.  234), 
draws  a  picture  of  the  shellfish-eating  Tierra  del  Fuegians  which, 
though  a  very  dismal  one,  would  doubtless  equally  well  describe 
what  might  have  been  seen  on  the  shores  of  the  Baltic  in  the 
period  under  consideration : — "  The  inhabitants  living  chiefly  upon 
shell-fish  are  obliged  constantly  to  change  their  place  of  residence, 
but  they  return  at  intervals  to  the  same  spot,  as  is  evident  from 
the  pile  of  old  shells."  Obviously,  the  refuse  and  rubbish  of  these 
people  would  be  confined  to  the  coast,  for  had  they  penetrated  into 
mid-country  their  relics  would  necessarily  be  in  the  main  of  a 
different  nature.  It  is  also  evident  that  the  comparative  stability 
of  a  coast  line  is  essential  to  the  existence  of  the  "  Kitchen- 
Middens  "  ;  and  this  idea  is  supported  in  Denmark  itself,  where 
these  accumulations  are  found  far  more  plentifully  around  the  more 
permanent  and  protected  fjords,  than  upon  the  ever-varying  sea- 
board. On  the  eastern  side  of  England  the  cliffs  have  been 
wasting  practically  ever  since  the  incursion  of  what  we  call  the 
North  Sea,  and  the  breach  by  the  Straits  of  Dover.  It  thus  be- 
comes obvious,  that  searching  for  these  deposits  in  these  or 
similarly  circumstanced  localities  would  be  hopeless.  If,  on  the 
other  hand,  we  can  get  a  firm  unwasting  coast  line,  furnished 
with  convenient  rock-ledges,  which  at  once  offer  shelter  while 
in  use  and  immunity  from  destruction  of  deposits  formed  upon  them, 
we  have  all  the  necessary  conditions  for  the  existence  of  Kitchen- 
Middens,  and  there  they  will  doubtless  be  found  all  round  the  coast. 


1897]       PRIMEVAL  REFUSE  HEAPS  AT  HASTINGS        41 

There  is,  however,  no  reason  why  the  people  who  left  these 
mounds  of  refuse  should  not  have  proceeded  inland,  and  there 
formed  settlements  ;  but  under  these  conditions  the  relics  left 
behind  would  necessarily  be  of  a  very  different  nature.  Certainly 
they  would  not  consist  largely  of  shells  as  does  the  Midden 
material  near  the  sea-shore.  If  we  found  a  similar  set  of  animal 
remains  in  the  Middens  and  in  inland  settlements,  it  would  be 
something  to  indicate  that  both  deposits  might  have  been  geologi- 
cally contemporaneous.  But  this  evidence  would  be  by  no  means 
conclusive,  as  the  people  inland,  in  the  absence  of  a  plentiful 
supply  of  fish,  might  have  been  driven  to  the  chase,  and  thus  have 
captured  a  large  number  of  animals  which  eluded  the  skill  of  the 
fisherman,  remains  of  which  would  be  present  among  the  relics  of 
the  former  but  not  among  the  latter.  Then  again,  the  landsmen 
would  naturally  be  first  to  practise  any  kind  of  domestication  of 
animals  for  the  purpose  of  food  and  clothing,  and  would  doubtless 
adopt  this  custom  long  before  the  fishermen  annexed  it  to  supple- 
ment their  method  of  obtaining  sustenance.  It  will  thus  be  seen 
that,  although  a  given  set  of  animal  remains  might  enable  us  to 
fix  approximately  the  geological  '  age '  of  the  deposits,  their 
presence  or  absence  would  not  be  sufficient  evidence  to  enable 
us  to  correlate  deposits  found  upon  the  sea-shore  with  those 
occurring  mid-land.  Unfortunately  the  appearance  and  disappear- 
ance of  animals  associated  with  man  are  not  so  clearly  indicated 
by  our  time  charts,  as  at  present  constructed,  as  they  ought  to  be ; 
so  that  the  fossils  of  man's  mental  evolution  over  a  given  locality 
— namely,  the  exhibitions  of  skill  in  the  production  and  fabrication 
of  articles  to  obtain  the  necessaries  of  life,  and  make  it  more 
endurable,  or  gratify  his  desires — must  serve  as  the  figures  upon 
our  chronograph.  If,  for  example,  all  implements  found  in  these 
deposits  were  of  the  well-known  Palaeolithic  types,  we  should  not 
hesitate  in  classing  the  Middens  as  Pleistocene.  If  there  were  a 
profusion  of  beautifully  polished  axes  and  barbed  arrow  heads,  we 
should  assign  them  to  the  ordinary  Neolithic  men ;  and  if  only 
a  single  bronze  implement  were  found,  we  should  just  as  readily 
relegate  them  to  the  age  of  metal.  So  also  if  we  find  a  certain 
set  of  relics  differing  from  anything  else  previously  recognised, 
although  they  may  tell  us  little  of  the  actual  age  of  the  deposit, 
yet  they  may  prove  invaluable  in  correlating  the  age  of  identical 
objects  found  over  a  large  extent  of  country,  and  justify  our  assign- 
ing them  to  one  race  of  people  :  and  if  from  each  of  the  localities 
in  which  these  are  found  we  obtain  supplementary  evidence,  we 
may  at  last  obtain  a  most  comprehensive  and  reliable  account  of 
the  heretofore  unknown  people. 

Judged  by  this  standard,  I  do  not  at  present  see  anything  to 


42  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [July 

connect  the  people  who  left  the  Hastings  "  Kitchen  Middens  "  with 
those  of  the  Baltic ;  still  a  great  deal  of  work  remains  undone  on 
both  sides  of  the  North  Sea.  The  flora  and  fauna  of  the  two 
countries  are  too  dissimilar  for  exact  comparison  ;  but  the  imple- 
ments in  the  two  cases  are  practically  quite  unlike.  Many  of  the 
habits  of  both  peoples  were,  and  are,  the  common  property  of  all 
savages,  or  semi-savages,  living  under  similar  conditions ;  but  beyond 
this  I  do  not  feel  we  can  go  safely,  and  I  am  therefore,  from  other 
evidence,  disposed  to  regard  the  Hastings  Midden  men  as  quite  a 
different  race  from  those  of  the  Baltic,  and  recognise  their  closer 
relationship  witli  the  race  who  made  the  identical  curious  little 
implements  in  the  Valley  of  the  Meuse  and  other  places. 

We  will  next  take  a  survey  of  some  of  the  features  presented  by 
the  Hastings  "  Kitchen  Middens,"  and  note  some  of  the  points  raised 
by  them,  and  the  contained  materials.  For  fuller  description  of 
these  on  some  points,  to  prevent  repetition,  the  reader  is  referred  to 
the  paper  in  The  Journal  of  the  Anthrojjological  Institute,  vol.  xxv., 
plates  x.-xiii. 

Hastings  has  always  been  celebrated  for  its  picturesque  rock- 
ledges,  caves,  and  fissures,  which  exist  on  both  sides  of  the  old 
town ;  but  few,  if  any,  ever  realize  the  antiquity  of  some  of  these, 
dating  back  as  they  do  to  the  very  earliest  history  of  the  weald,  and 
will,  doubtless,  some  day  reveal  to  us  our  lost  Miocene  World. 
There  can  be  no  doubt  that  the  celebrated  St  Clement's  Caves  or 
fissures  originated  in  the  great  Earth  movements  above  referred  to : 
that  they  were  inhabited  in  later  Palaeolithic  times,  and  were 
enlarged  by  ambidextrous  Stone  Age  man,  and  still  more  extensively 
excavated  by  right-handed  Iron  Age  man,  as  shown  by  the  pick 
marks  still  extant.  I  have  found  fragments  of  Neolithic  pottery  in 
them,  and  although  much  of  their  contents,  dating  back  to  the  earlier 
occupations,  may  have  been  cleared  away  by  Iron  Age  man,  I  still 
think  they  would  well  repay  a  thorough  investigation.  To  what 
extent  they  were  used  by  the  Midden  men  it  is  difficult  to  say  at 
present;  but,  so  far  as  research  has  gone,  it  appears  that  the  fissures 
nearer  the  sea  were  used  more  by  way  of  shelter,  and  it  is  the  rock- 
ledges  outside  these  upon  which  the  relics  of  the  life  of  the  time  have 
been  preserved.  Plate  V.  shows  the  general  appearance  of  these 
fissured  and  cavernous  rocks ;  the  accumulation  of  Midden  material 
upon  one  of  the  ledges  is  seen  in  the  front,  as  shown  during  the 
excavations.  These  projecting  surfaces  exist  at  all  altitudes  up  to, 
say,  120  ft.;  here  were  enacted  all  the  dramas  of  domestic  life, 
hither  were  brought  the  trophy  of  the  chase,  the  captures  from  the 
sea,  and  the  gatherings  from  the  shore  ;  to  this  resort  were  taken  the 
pebbles  from  the  beach,  and  here  they  were  worked  into  the  various 
forms  and  implements  that  man  required  for  his  increasing  needs : 


1897]       PRIMEVAL  EFFUSE  HEAPS  AT  HASTINGS         43 

here  he  lit  his  fire,  heated  his  pot  or  roasted  the  pony  or  deer  he 
had  captured  in  the  chase  ;  here  he  changed  his  broken  flint  tip 
snapped  in  the  chase,  replaced  it  by  a  new  one,  and  threw  the 
broken  butt  end  upon  the  Midden.  Here  he  also  sat  and  split  his 
marrow  bones,  and  feasted  right  royally  upon  the  contained  luscious 
grease ;  and  here  he  piled  up  his  refuse  heaps  of  everything  with 
which  he  for  the  time  being  had  done. 

It  is  difficult  to  say  which  are  the  most  interesting,  the  fauna  of 
the  period,  the  relics  of  which  have  been  stored  up  in  these  old 
heaps,  or  the  fossils  of  man's  civilization  in  the  form  of  flint  and 
bone  implements,  pottery,  etc,  We  will  take  the  latter  first,  as 
belonging  to  the  highest  of  the  mammals  represented. 

THE    WORKED    FLINTS. 

Being  away  from  the  chalk,  the  supply  of  flint  had  to  be  drawn 
from  the  pebbles  on  the  sea  shore.  These  were  taken  up  to  the 
settlement,  and  in  several  places  heaps  of  these  were  found :  they 
were  sometimes  '  quartered '  when  flat  flakes  were  required,  at 
others  they  were  flaked  into  long  narrow  flakes,  which  required  but 
little,  if  anything,  done  to  them  to  make  them  fit  for  use.  The 
almost  absence  of  the  ordinary  more  or  less  circular-edged  skin- 
scraper- — the  commonest  of  all  Neolithic  implements — is  very 
remarkable ;  but  some  spatulate  forms  were  found,  several  of  which 
were  tanged  for  hafting.  There  were  no  large  axes  or  adzes  found, 
nor  even  the  small  triangular  form,  which  exist  in  such  profusion  in 
the  Danish  Kitchen  Middens,  and  no  flint  bore  the  slightest  trace 
of  polishing.  One  of  the  most  remarkable  and  interesting  features 
of  the  flints  was  the  variety  of  forms  of  the  chisels,  gouges,  and 
gravers,  the  cutting  edges  being  always  well  worked,  and  either 
rounded  or  rectangular,  turning  now  to  the  left  and  now  to  the 
right.  A  peculiar  feature  which  strikes  one  in  connection  with 
these  is,  that  they  differ  entirely  from  the  majority  of  flint  tools  one 
sees  in  museums,  in  which  is  shown  the  expenditure  of  extensive 
trouble  and  work  to  bring  the  implement  into  an  orthodox  shape, 
although  the  cutting  or  operating  edge  is  confined  to  an  exceedingly 
small  spot,  and  is  entirely  independent  of  the  elaborate  work  of  the 
other  part  of  the  implement.  In  these,  on  the  other  hand,  it  is  just 
a  simple  flake,  which  is  usually  untouched,  except  at  the  point, 
where  it  is  worked  in  a  straight  or  oblique  inward  or  outward  curve 
or  line ;  occasionally  they  are  large,  but  not  very  often.  With 
such  a  variety  of  carving  tools  in  the  possession  of  these  old  people, 
one  is  disposed  to  feel  disappointed  at  finding  so  little  evidence  of  the 
practice  of  carving.  Still,  it  must  be  borne  in  mind  that  the 
Kitchen  Middens  after  all  were  only  waste  heaps,  and  nothing  of 
any  value  would  be  likely  to  be  found  in  them,  except  an  occa- 


44  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [July  1897 

sionally  lost  article.  That  bone  was  largely  used  we  shall  presently 
see,  and  doubtless  great  care  would  be  taken  with  these  finely-carved 
articles,  and  they  may  be  found  when  the  innermost  recesses  of  the 
fissures  have  been  penetrated.  That  a  large  portion  of  flint  flakes 
were  intended  for  arrow  and  fish-spear  tips  is  certain  from  the  fact 
that  many  are  secondarily  worked  into  bilateral  symmetry.  Dis- 
regarding mere  chips  the  long-pointed  flakes  monopolise  75  per 
cent,  of  the  flints  found  ;  they  vary  in  size  from  4  in.  by  f  in.  down 
to  \  in.  and  by  \  in.  They  were  doubtless  used  for  lance  and  arrow 
heads,  fish-spears  and  fish-hooks ;  no  sign  of  a  barb  of  any  kind 
was  seen.  A  point  of  special  interest  in  regard  to  these  tips  was 
that  very  many  of  them  had  well-worked  butts,  sometimes  showing  the 
removal  of  ten  or  a  dozen  small  flakes  in  the  formation  of  the  well- 
rounded,  nicely-bevelled,  square  or  circular-ended  base.  There  was 
one  feature  about  these  which  puzzled  me  for  a  long  time,  and  that 
was  that  the  present  periphery  of  the  flake-face  of  the  flint  usually 
truncated  these  secondary  flakings.  It,  therefore,  became  evident 
that  the  secondary  base  was  worked  round  a  single  or  double  ridge 
while  the  lance-tip  was  yet  upon  the  core,  from  which  it  was  dis- 
lodged by  the  last  skilful  blow.  In  experimenting  I  found  this 
practicable ;  and  ultimately  I  found  a  block  of  flint  worked  into 
ridges  in  the  process  of  manufacturing  these  tools  in  the  way 
suggested,  with  one  base  worked  ready  for  the  next  blow  to  produce 
a  perfect  implement.  This  specimen  is  shown  in  Plate  VI. ,  at 
the  bottom  right  corner,  and  the  arrow  marks  the  point  at  which 
the  last  blow  would  have  been  struck,  that  would  have  dislodged 
the  finished  tip,  such  as  is  seen  just  at  the  left  of  it.  That 
the  tips  were  used  and  broken  in  the  chase  or  in  fishing  is  certain 
from  the  immense  numbers  of  broken  butt-ends  that  were  found  in 
the  Midden ;  as  it  is  only  reasonable  to  suppose  that,  if  these 
were  broken  in  fishing  or  in  hunting,  the  broken  butts  would  have 
been  taken  off  the  line  or  shaft  when  the  user  returned  to  chez 
lui  and  thrown  upon  the  refuse  heap,  and  replaced  by  new  ones. 
Large  quantities  were  used  as  knives,  and  were  hard  worn. 

The  next  most  plentiful  tool  was  the  needle  maker,  or  small 
hollow-scraper  ;  these  varied  in  size,  say,  from  an  inch  or  more, 
down  to  a  tool  that  would  turn  out  a  bone  duplicate  of  a  good- 
sized  thread  needle. 

There  was  an  immense  number  of  cooking  stones  indicative  of 
the  method  of  applying  heat.  Charcoal  was  fairly  plentiful ;  and 
many  of  the  bones  of  horse,  pig,  sheep,  &c.,  were  burned  in  the 
process  of  roasting  upon  the  old  hearths ;  the  latter  still  remained 
in  places.  That  the  pots  were  put  upon  the  fire,  however,  is  certain 
from  the  fact  that  many  had  a  deposit  of  soot  upon  them. 

W.  J.  Lewis  Abbott. 
(To  be  continued  next  month,  with  the  illustrations.) 


567  45 


The  Taxonomic  Position  of  the  Pteraspidae, 
Cephalaspidae,   and  Asterolepidae  * 

IN  his  notice  of  the  life  and  work  of  the  late  Professor  Cope, 
published  in  the  June  number  of  Natural  Science,  Mr  Arthur 
Smith  Woodward  writes  : — "  It  is  mainly  due  to  his  initiative  that 
we  now  regard  the  strange  Pteraspidae,  Cephalaspidae,  and  Astero- 
lepidae (Ostracodermi  or  Ostracophori  as  Cope  termed  them)  of  the 
Upper  Silurian  and  Devonian  rocks  as  the  armoured  extinct  allies 
of  the  modern  lampreys  (Marsipobranchii)." 

No  one,  I  am  convinced,  entertains  a  more  sincere  admiration 
for  the  palteontological  work  of  Professor  Cope  than  I  do.  His 
extraordinary  insight  (one  might  almost  say  '  instinct ')  in  dealing 
with  many  problems  of  vertebrate  morphology  placed  him  in  a  very 
high  position  amongst  modern  comparative  anatomists.  But  his 
genius  was  all  the  more  astonishing  owing  to  the  fact  that  it  was 
accompanied  by  equally  extraordinary  mental  deficiencies — namely, 
a  frequent  failure  of  the  power  of  correct  conscious  reasoning  and 
a  love  of  what  Mr  Smith  Woodward  calls  "  wild  guesses  "  and  other 
persons  might  term  "  baseless  conclusions." 

Mr  Smith  Woodward,  in  the  passage  quoted,  cites  with  approval 
one  of  Cope's  most  empty  taxonomic  vagaries  concerning  the  class 
of  fishes ;  he  solemnly  states  that  it  is  due  to  Cope's  "  initiative  " 
that  "  we  "  now  regard  the  Ostracodermi  as  Marsipobranchii.  Zoo- 
logists are  of  course  aware  of  the  fact  that  Mr  Smith  Woodward 
has  given  the  weight  of  his  reputation  as  an  ichthyologist  to  this 
remarkable  proposition.  It  seems  to  be  a  proper  occasion,  now 
that  he  tells  us  that  there  are  others  besides  himself  who  have 
been  impelled  by  Cope's  initiative  into  so  astonishing  a  point  of 
view,  to  ask  Mr  Smith  Woodward  to  state  the  reasons  which 
induce  him  deliberately  to  assert  that  Pteraspis  and  Cephalaspis 
are  armoured  Marsipobranchii. 

I  think  it  will  be  generally  admitted  that  it  is  not  a  sufficient 
justification  for  upholding  such  a  taxonomic  novelty  as  the  one  in 
question  to  point  out  that  no  one  has  s]iown  any  other  position  to 

*  For  a  general  illustrated  account  of  these  extinct  organisms  see  Natural  Science, 
vol.  i.  (1892),  pp.  596-602. 


46  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [jULY 

be  the  proper  one  for  the  doubtful  group ;  we  may  not,  for  that 
reason  alone,  boldly  assert  that  they  are  Marsipobranchs.  Nor 
again  will  it  be  held  to  be  sufficient  in  the  opinion  of  most  zoo- 
logists to  say  "  Mr  X.  was  a  very  gifted  man,  and  he  used  to  say 
that  the  so-and-so's  are  really  such-and-such."  It  really  is  time 
for  Mr  Smith  Woodward  to  give  us  more  solid  reasons  than  such 
as  these  for  classing  Ostracodermi  with  Marsipobranchii. 

I  shall  be  surprised  if  he  can  do  so ;  for  I  have  turned  the 
matter  over  carefully  and  happen  to  have  a  rather  intimate 
acquaintance  with  both  the  Ostracodermi  and  the  Marsipobranchii. 
I  am  unable  to  find  a  single  fact  which  can  be  considered  as 
positive  evidence  of  affinity  between  the  two  groups. 

It  is  true  that  we  do  not  know  of  the  existence  of  paired  fins 
in  the  Ostracodermi — -nor  in  Marsipobranchii — but  though  the 
supposed  pectorals  of  Cephalaspis  are  probably  not  to  be  regarded 
as  pectorals,  we  are  not  in  a  position  to  assert  that  Pteraspis  had 
no  lateral  fins,  nor  that  the  '  flippers  '  of  Ptcrichthys  do  not 
represent  such  organs. 

Before  the  proposition  favoured  by  Mr  Smith  Woodward  could 
be  seriously  discussed  in  the  terms  in  which  it  is  stated,  it 
would  be  necessary  to  show  that  the  Ostracodermi  are  a  natural 
group,  and  no  one  can  pretend  that  this  is  the  case.  The  Cepha- 
laspids,  the  Pteraspids,  and  the  Pterichthyicls  were  originally  asso- 
ciated as  '  Ostracodermi '  for  purposes  of  mere  temporary  con- 
venience. It  is  a  question  whether  in  these  days  of  an  avowed 
genealogical  implication  in  our  classifications,  such  '  lumber- 
rooms  '  as  '  Ostracodermi  '  are  permissible.  I  think  not.  There 
is  absolutely  no  reason  for  regarding  Cephalaspis  as  allied  to 
Pteraspis  beyond  that  the  two  genera  occur  in  the  same  rocks, 
and  still  less  for  concluding  that  either  has  any  connection  with 
Pterlchthys. 

If,  in  view  of  this  fact,  we  consider  in  a  more  detailed  way  the 
suggestion  of  Cope,  acclaimed  by  Smith  Woodward,  we  find  that  it 
amounts  to  the  assertion,  that  there  are  evidences  of  the  close  genetic 
relationship  of  the  Marsipobranchii  with  either  the  Cephalaspids,  or 
the  Pteraspids,  or  the  Pterichthyids — or  possibly  with  all  of  them. 

So  far  as  I  am  aware  the  only  satisfactory  evidence  of  marsi- 
pobranch  affinities  which  one  could  expect  to  be  offered  by  fossil 
remains  of  palaeozoic  date,  is  the  presence  of  a  single  median  nasal 
aperture.  The  characteristic  monorrhine  structure  of  the  marsi- 
pobranchs might  have  been  recorded  in  the  preserved  remains  of  an 
armoured  marsipobranch,  had  such  a  creature  ever  existed.  Is  there 
any  evidence  of  such  a  single  nostril  in  Pteraspids,  or  Cephalaspids,  or 
Pterichthyids  ?  Most  assuredly  there  is  not.  There  is  no  aperture  in 
the  cephalic  shields  of  any  of  these  forms  which  can  be  assigned  to 


1897]    TAXONOMIC  POSITION  OF  PTERASPIDAE,  ETC.    47 

the  nostril.  If  these  fishes  possessed  a  nostril,  single  or  double  (as 
presumably  they  did),  it  seems  that  it  was  placed  in  such  a  position 
as  to  avoid  perforating  the  bony  shields  of  the  head.  To  assume — in 
the  total  absence  of  evidence  pro  or  con — that  these  fishes  were 
monorrhine,  is  surely  illegitimate  and  arbitrary.  Further,  there 
are  in  Eal,craspis  and  some  other  head-shields  indications  of  lateral 
chambers,  remotely  suggesting  lateral  branchial  chambers ;  but  the 
form  and  position  of  these  would  be  equally  consistent  with 
elasmobranch  as  with  marsipobranch  affinities. 

It  seems  to  me  that  even  Huxley's  cautious  statement  as  to  the 
affinities  of  Ptcraspis  and  Cephalaspis  goes  too  far.  He  says 
(Quart.  Journ.  Gcol.  Soc,  vol.  xiv.,  p.  279),  "  A  careful  consideration 
of  the  facts,  then,  seems  to  me  to  prove  only  the  necessity  of  sus- 
pending one's  judgment."  So  far  I  entirely  agree  with  him.  He 
proceeds,  "  That  Cephalaspis  and  Pteraspis  are  either  ganoids  or 
teleosteans  appears  certain,  but  to  which  of  these  orders  they 
belong  there  is  no  evidence  to  show."  That  was  written  a  long 
time  ago.  It  seems  to  me  that  whilst  there  is  abundant  evidence 
to  shew  that  Pteraspids  and  Cephalaspids,  and  also  Pterichthyids  were 
craniate  vertebrates,  there  is  nothing  to  show  conclusively  that  they 
are  referable  to  any  known  group  of  fishes,  rather  than  that  they 
are  to  be  regarded  as  representatives  of  isolated  extinct  lines  of 
descent.  Their  possession  of  paired  orbits,  fish-like  scales,  and  fish- 
like median  fins,  renders  it  the  course  involving  least  assumption  con- 
cerning matters  of  which  we  are  ignorant,  to  treat  them  as  detached 
groups  of  primitive  fish-like  forms,  concerning  the  closer  relation- 
ships of  which  judgment  must  be  suspended. 

The  palaeontologist  is,  we  must  admit,  entitled  to  make  sug- 
gestions and  guesses  as  to  the  affinities  of  the  organisms  which  have 
left  behind  them  the  fragments  with  which  he  has  to  deal.  On 
the  other  hand,  if  he  aspires  to  be  a  zoological  taxonomist  he  must 
accept  the  common  point  of  view  of  zoologists.  He  does  injury 
rather  than  benefit  to  zoological  science  when  (as  is,  unfortunately, 
sometimes  the  case)  he  endeavours  to  impose  an  unwarranted 
"  gness "  upon  zoological  taxonomy  as  though  it  were  a  soberly 
worked-out  conclusion,  or  reconstructs  classifications  hitherto  based 
upon  the  consideration  of  comprehensive  anatomical  data,  in  order 
to  give  unnatural  prominence  to  such  characteristics  alone  as  are 
furnished  by  the  hard  parts  of  organisms — parts  with  which  a 
study  of  fossil  forms  renders  him  specially  familiar. 

E.  Kay  Lankester. 


551.47(98)  48  [July 


VI 

Note  on  the  Warm  Undercurrent  in  the  Arctic  Ocean 
between  Greenland  and  Spitzbergen 

[In  our  review  of  Nansen's  "  Farthest  North  "  (Natural  Science,  vol.  x.  p.  270, 
April  1897)  we  took  occasion  to  remark  that  the  author's  recognition  of  com- 
paratively warm  water  beneath  the  cold  surface  of  the  Arctic  Ocean  was  no 
'  surprising  '  discovery,  but  merely  confirmed  "  the  observations  of  Scoresby, 
Markham,  and  Maury,  and  the  views  of  Lyell,  Croll,  and  other  people  not 
unknown."  We  now  have  the  pleasure  of  further  illustrating  this  point  by 
publishing  the  following  observations,  with  which  we  have  been  favoured  by 
Mr  Leigh  Smith.  They  were  written  in  1875,  but  have  not  hitherto  been 
printed. — Edit.  Nat.  Sci.] 

THE  following  table  of  deep-sea  temperatures  observed  (with  a 
Miller-Casella  thermometer)  on  board  the  Samson  in  18*71-72, 
seems  to  me  to  establish  Maury's  theory  of  a  warm  undercurrent 
running  into  the  Arctic  Basin  between  Greenland  and  Spitzbergen. 
I  cannot  find  an  account  of  the  temperatures  taken  by  me  on  board 
the  Diana  in  1873,  but  they  confirmed  previous  results. 

Table  of  Deep-Sea  Temperatures  taken  in  1871-72  on  Board  the  Samsox. 

T    ,  T  Surface  Depth,  m 

Lat-  LonS-  temp.  fathoms.  TeraP- 

81o,20'  18°'0'E  33  300  42-5 

80-10  6-55E  34-5  600  39 

80-1  6-36E  34  50  37 

40 
78-34  8-8  E  37  600*  33"5 

77-16  4-38E  34-5  25  32 


Surface 

Depth, 

temp. 

fathoms. 

33 

300 

34-5 

600 

34 

50 

?  J 

200 

37 

600* 

34-5 

25 

J  J 

250 

31 

150 

36 

150 

31 

200 

33 

50 

j) 

200 

40-5 

100 

J) 

250 

41-5 

100 

>» 

250 

32-5 

30 

)  » 

100 

38 

1001 

i  j 

230 

39  "5 
76-36  2-14E  31  150  39"5 

76-21  0-21E  36  150  39-5 


>> 

i'3< 
i-2J 

76-20  0-21E  31  200  39"5 

76-20  0-54E  33  50  40 

48-5 
30  12-55E  40-5  100  34-5 

33-5 
75-0  13-15E  41-5  100  34 

42 '5 
32-5  30  34 

35-5 
73-27  20-21E  38  100f  35 

44 

*  After  this  sounding  was  taken  the  thermometer  ought  to  have  been  lowered  to 
250  fathoms,  as  it  is  probable  that  there  might  have  been  warm  water  that  the  ther- 
mometer passed  through  too  quickly  to  register. 

t  South  of  Bear  Island.     Warm  current  going  east. 


1897]      WARM  UNDERCURRENT  IN  ARCTIC  OCEAN        49 

This  warm  undercurrent,  after  passing  Hakluyt's  Headland, 
goes  to  the  N.-E.,  and  some  of  it  may  come  to  the  surface  in  the 
shallow  seas  on  the  western  shores  of  lands  lying  in  that  direction. 
This  would  account  for  the  fact  that  Payer  found  open  water  and 
a  warmer  climate  to  the  north. 

Dv  Carpenter,  in  a  paper  read  at  the  Royal  Institution  of  Great 
Britain  on  March  20,  1874,  refers  to  his  theory  as  "A  general 
oceanic  circulation  sustained  by  a  difference  of  temperature  alone." 
In  a  paper  read  before  the  Royal  Geographical  Society,  June  1, 
1874,  he  also  states  his  theory  in  the  same  terms.  It  is  true  that 
he  afterwards  admits  that  difference  of  salinity  will  produce  a 
circulation,  but  then  his  theory  simply  becomes  Maury's  theory. 

Independent  of  all  theory  the  heaviest  water  will  go  to  the 
bottom ;  therefore,  if  there  is  an  oceanic  circulation,  whatever  may 
be  its  cause,  a  warm  stream  of  heavy  salt  water  will  flow  beneath 
a  cold  stream  of  lighter  brackish  or  fresh  water. 

Down  the  east  coast  of  Greenland  there  is  an  Arctic  current  * 
about  200  miles  broad,  bearing  on  its  surface  a  mighty  floating 
glacier,  which  extends  to  Cape  Farewell,  a  distance  of  1400  miles. 
The  rate  of  this  current  is  variously  estimated  from  5  to  15  miles 
a  day.t 

How  is  the  water  and  the  salt  so  carried  out  of  the  Polar  Basin 
replaced  ?  Must  it  not  be  by  an  undercurrent  of  greater  specific 
gravity  running  into  the  Polar  Basin  ?  B.  Leigh  Smith. 

*  See  Scoresby's  "  Arctic  Regions,"  Drift  of  the  Hansa. 

t  I  am  anxious  to  establish  the  existence  of  this  current,  as  two  great  authorities 
have  lately  doubted  it.  I  therefore  append  the  following  note,  dated  Feb.  16,  1897, 
from  Mr  R.  Kinnes,  manager  of  several  whalers  cruising  during  the  summer  season 
along  the  east  coast  of  Greenland  : — "The  drift  of  the  ice  down  the  east  coast  of  Green- 
land varies  from  10  to  12  miles  per  day,  and  I  think  this  may  be  taken  as  a  fair  average. 
If  the  wind  is  N.-E.  it  goes  much  faster,  but  with  a  S.-W.  wind  it  travels  eastwards. 
The  pack  may  vary  from  150  to  200  miles  in  breadth,  according  to  the  season.  The 
current  travels  a  little  faster  than  the  ice,  and  to  the  southward,  near  Cape  Dan,  it 
becomes  stronger."  I  may  also  add  that  in  1874  Captain  David  Gray  was  up  the  east 
coast  on  the  Eclipse,  and  he  sent  me  the  following  extract  from  his  log: — "July  24. 
Found  by  to-day's  observations  that  we  have  driven  43  miles  S.  by  W.  J  W.  true  in  the 
past  three  daj-s,  and  that  in  the  face  of  fresh  winds  from  S.-W." — B.L.S.,  May  1897. 


49 


591.15  50  [July 


VII 

Karl  Pearson  on  Evolution  * 

THE  belief  that  the  fundamental  problems  of  organic  evolution 
are  essentially  statistical  problems,  which  require  numerical 
treatment  before  they  can  be  adequately  solved,  is  constantly  gain- 
ing ground ;  and  with  the  growth  of  this  belief  the  need  for  finer 
methods  of  statistical  inquiry  has  grown  also.  With  the  exception 
of  Mr  Francis  Galton,  who  worked  for  years  almost  alone  in  this 
direction,  no  one  has  done  so  much  as  Professor  Pearson  to  make 
the  systematic  investigation  of  animal  statistics  possible.  His 
development  of  the  theory  of  Chance  enables  us  now  to  find  fairly 
simple  mathematical  expressions,  by  which  masses  of  statistics, 
hitherto  incapable  of  arrangement  in  such  a  form  that  the  mind 
could  grasp  their  meaning,  may  be  easily  and  accurately  represented. 
Professor  Pearson  devotes  four  of  the  essays  in  his  recently-pub- 
lished volumes  to  a  popular  account  of  some  of  his  results. 

The  first  essay  ("  The  Chances  of  Death  ")  begins  by  showing 
how  regularly  "  chance  "  is  seen  to  operate,  when  a  large  series 
of  fortuitous  events  can  be  observed.  The  regular  character  of 
such  events,  and  the  accuracy  with  which  they  can  be  predicted 
in  the  long  run,  is  illustrated  by  records  of  experiments  of  the 
usual  kind  with  coins,  dice,  and  cards ;  and  it  is  then  shown  that 
a  law  of  the  same  form  as  that  used  to  express  the  result  of  a  long 
series  of  games  of  chance  may  be  used  to  express,  with  the  same 
degree  of  accuracy,  the  frequency  with  which  given  magnitudes 
of  a  cephalic  index  occur  in  a  race  of  men,  or  the  frequency  of 
patients  of  given  age  among  a  large  group  of  typhoid  fever  cases. 
Finally,  the  frequency  of  incidence  of  death  at  various  ages  among 
every  thousand  people  born  at  the  same  time  is  exhibited  as  the 
resultant  of  five  series  of  fortuitous  events,  each  series  producing 
its  maximum  death-rate  at  a  particular  period  of  life. 

These  examples  are  admirably  fitted  to  show  how  such  appar- 
ently irregular  phenomena  as  death,  or  attacks  of  fever,  or  variation 
in  the  dimensions  of  a  particular  organ,  may  be  easily  and  accu- 
rately represented  so  that  the  mind  can  grasp  the  effect  upon  the 
population   as   a   whole,  grouping   the   series   of  isolated   instances 

*  The  Chances  of  Death,  and  other  Studies  in  Evolution.     By  Karl  Pearson.     2  vols, 
8vo,  pp.  xii.  388,  and  iv.  460.     London:  Edward  Arnold,  1897.     Price,  25s. 


1897]  KARL  PEARSON  ON  EVOLUTION  51 

simply  and  naturally  under  one  general  law.  The  reader  who  is 
acquainted  with  the  theory  of  Chance,  as  it  is  propounded  in  the 
ordinary  text-books,  will  appreciate  the  great  extension  of  the 
theory  which  is  necessary  in  order  to  treat  successfully  such  statis- 
tical results  as  those  expressed  by  the  remarkable  "  curve  of  infan- 
tile mortality,"  or  even  those  relating  to  the  incidence  of  scarlet 
fever,  enteric  fever,  and  diphtheria,  at  particular  periods  of  life. 

These  illustrations  being  given  in  the  first  essay,  the  second  is 
devoted  to  the  results  of  roulette,  as  played  at  Monte  Carlo,  this 
being  chosen  as  an  example  of  results  which  are  so  little  capable  of 
prediction  by  the  theory  of  Probability  as  to  justify  the  belief  that 
some  constant  influence  other  than  chance  is  at  work.  The  point 
of  general  interest  is  the  smallness  of  the  discrepancy  between  the 
observed  result  and  that  given  by  the  theory  of  Chance  which  can 
be  used  as  evidence  of  some  constant  disturbing  factor. 

The  third  essay,  on  "  Reproductive  Selection,"  contains  a  most 
interesting  study  of  the  importance  to  be  ascribed  to  variation  in 
fertility.  The  material  used  consists  of  two  tables,  showing  the 
number  of  children  arising  from  each  of  a  large  series  of  marriages. 
The  first  series  contains  4390  marriages,  which  are  spoken  of  as 
"  Anglo-Saxon  "  ;  they  are  for  the  most  part  English  and  Americans 
of  the  well-to-do  classes,  with  some  from  the  Almanach  de  Gotha. 
The  second  series  includes  over  34,000  Danish  marriages.  The 
result  is  so  important  that  a  rough  outline  at  least  must  be  given. 
The  following  table  shows  the  number  of  "  Anglo-Saxon "  mar- 
riages which  produced  any  given  number  of  children : — 

No.  of  Children,    1        2       3       4       5        6       7       8       9       10     11    12    13   14  15   16  17 
No.  of  Marriages,  546    656    682    628    496    383   336   228   172    118    63    47    22     8     2     1     2 

The  series  contains  no  record  of  barren  marriages ;  but  for 
reasons  fully  discussed  in  the  essay,  320  is  assigned  as  the  number 
of  barren  marriages  likely  to  have  existed  in  a  population  with  the 
observed  number  of  fertile  unions.  The  above  table  may  therefore 
be  regarded  as  representing  the  offspring  of  4710  marriages. 

The  total  number  of  children  produced  is  19,833,  giving  an 
average  of  about  four  and  a  half  per  marriage;  but  the  striking- 
feature  about  the  table  is  the  demonstration  that  half  of  this  entire 
number  of  children  is  produced  by  little  more  than  a  quarter  (25*8 
per  cent.)  of  the  total  number  of  marriages,  so  that  half  the  second 
generation  are  the  offspring  of  a  quarter  of  the  first.  Now,  suppose 
this  character  of  excessive  fertility  to  be  completely  inherited,  Pro- 
fessor Pearson  shows  that  (in  the  absence  of  an  enormous  selective 
death-rate)  ninety-nine  per  cent  of  the  -sixth  generation  would  be 
descended  from  the  "  superfertile  "  quarter  of  the  original  generation. 
The  effect  of  selection  in  checking  this  result  among  human  beings 


52  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [July 

is  examined,  and  the  conclusion  is  reached  that  it  is  not  sufficient  to 
make  any  great  difference — half  the  adolescent  members  of  the 
second  generation  beiug  produced  by  less  than  29  per  cent,  of  the 
first. 

It  is  evident  that  any  character,  possessed  by  this  original  29 
per  cent,  of  "  superfertile  "  couples,  will  quickly  spread  among  suc- 
cessive generations,  unless  it  be  extremely  disadvantageous  to  its 
possessors ;  and  as  an  example  of  the  complicated  problem  presented 
by  this  result,  it  may  be  mentioned  that  Professor  Pearson  found, 
on  examining  206  families,  that  the  mean  height  of  133  men,, 
fathers  of  less  than  five  children  each,  was  half  an  inch  greater  than 
the  mean  height  of  73  men,  each  of  whom  was  father  of  more  than 
five  children;  but  these  73  men  produced  between  them  561  chil- 
dren, the  133  less  fertile  producing  only  394  children.  On  the 
other  hand,  the  more  fertile  mothers  were  sensibly  taller  than  the 
less  fertile.  Perhaps  no  example  could  show  more  clearly  than  this 
the  complex  nature  of  the  phenomena  with  which  the  student  of 
animal  evolution  has  to  deal,  and  the  absurdity  of  trying  to  deal 
with  them  otherwise  than  by  the  patient  numerical  evaluation  of  each 
factor  separately. 

The  last  essay  to  which  attention  can  here  be  called  is  that  on 
"  Variation  in  Man  and  Woman."  The  object  is  to  support  the  con- 
tention that  women  are  on  the  whole  more  variable  than  men ;  and 
an  immense  series  of  measurements  has  been  collected,  in  many  of 
which — such,  for  example,  as  the  cephalic  index,  the  stature  at  par- 
ticular ages,  and  others — this  is  undoubtedly  the  case.  But  it  must 
be  borne  in  mind  that  Professor  Pearson  refuses  to  consider  "  second- 
ary sexual  characters,"  and  that  he  proposes  a  peculiar  measure  of 
variability.  What  exactly  the  rejection  of  secondary  sexual  char- 
acters means,  it  is  difficult  to  understand ;  surely  any  character, 
other  than  the  structure  of  the  reproductive  organs,  may  be  called  a 
secondary  sexual  character,  if  the  two  sexes  differ  with  respect  to 
it ;  and  if  this  definition  be  adopted,  Professor  Pearson's  position 
becomes  unintelligible ;  if,  on  the  other  hand,  the  term  be  limited 
to  those  characters  which  are  directly  affected  by  sexual  selection, 
then  Professor  Pearson  should  not  permit  himself  to  discuss  the 
relative  variability  of  a  particular  organ  in  men  and  in  women  with- 
out first  showing  that  marriages  occur  at  random  so  far  as  that 
organ  is  concerned.  No  definition  of  a  secondary  sexual  character 
is  offered  in  tlie  essay,  which  is  apparently  directed  against  some 
rash  persons  who  have  asserted  that  every  character  is  more  variable 
in  men  than  in  women,  and  who  attempt  to  deduce  social  and 
practical  consequences  from  this  proposition. 

A  more  important  point  is  the  assumption  "  that  the  only  useful 
sense  in  which  we  can  study  relative  variability  is  by  endeavouring 


1897]  KARL  PEARSON  ON  EVOLUTION  53 

to  answer  the  problem  :  Is  one  sex  closer  to  its  mean,  more  con- 
servative to  its  type,  than  the  other  ?  and  that  the  only  scientific 
answer  to  this  lies  in  the  magnitude  of  the  per  centage  variations  of 
the  two  sexes  for  corresponding  organs." 

The  meaning  of  this  may  be  made  clear  by  an  example.  Suppose 
a  number  of  sticks,  about  a  yard  long,  to  be  chosen  by  some  rough 
process  of  measurement  ;  and  suppose  that  more  careful  examination 
showed  the  average  length  of  these  sticks  to  be  3  feet,  while  half 
the  sticks  were  between  2  feet  1 1  inches  and  3  feet  1  inch  in 
length.  Suppose,  further,  a  second  group  of  sticks,  whose  average 
length  is  G  feet,  while  half  the  sticks  lie  between  5  feet  10  inches 
and  6  feet  2  inches.  Now,  since  one  inch  is  the  same  fraction  of 
three  feet  that  two  inches  is  of  six  feet,  Professor  Pearson  asserts  that 
the  only  scientific  view  of  the  variability  of  the  two  sets  of  sticks  is 
that  which  treats  the  two  bundles  as  equally  variable  ;  and  he 
accordingly  defines  the  "  coefficient  of  variation,"  or  measure  of 
variability,  as  the  ratio  of  the  "  Standard  Deviation  "  or  "  Error  of 
Mean  Square  "  to  the  Mean. 

Now,  it  may  at  once  be  freely  admitted  that  the  coefficient  of 
variation,  as  above  defined,  is  an  exact  measure,  and  probably  the 
best  available  measure,  of  the  degree  to  which  a  group  of  animals  is 
"  close  to  its  type  "  ;  that  is  to  say,  it  is  a  measure  of  the  extent 
and  frequency  of  the  mistakes  a  man  would  make,  if  he  should 
simplify  a  discussion  of  these  animals  by  using,  instead  of  the 
individual  animals,  a  series  of  perfectly  average  "  types."  It  is 
precisely  the  measure  of  accuracy  of  the  customary  morphological 
definition  of  a  species  or  variety.  But  the  student  of  evolution  may 
have  to  concern  himself  with  another  measure  of  variability,  when 
he  asks  not  "  how  close  is  the  race  to  its  type,"  but  "  how  much 
material  for  Selection  is  afforded  by  the  variability  of  the  race  ? " 

The  functional  importance  of  a  variation  of  known  magnitude, 
and  the  effect  of  such  a  variation  upon  the  selective  death-rate, 
seem  legitimate,  if  difficult,  subjects  of  scientific  inquiry ;  and  if  it 
can  be  shown  that  an  organ  in  one  sex  gives  more  scope  for  the 
selective  formation  of  varieties  or  races  than  does  the  corresponding 
organ  in  the  other  sex,  it  is  surely  legitimate  (neglecting  the  possible 
complications  due  to  peculiarities  of  heredity)  to  say  that  one  sex 
is  more  variable  than  the  other.  For  example,  it  is  certainly 
possible,  in  the  case  of  the  common  fowl,  to  produce  races  of  cocks 
which  differ  more  from  each  other  in  the  length  of  their  tail- 
feathers  than  do  any  hens  yet  produced ;  and  the  statement,  that 
the  tail  of  cocks  in  general  is  more  variable  than  the  tail  of  hens  in 
general  seems  thereby  justified,  whether  the  "  coefficient  of  variation  " 
in  the  cocks  of  any  one  race  be  greater  than  that  of  the  corre- 
sponding hens  or  not. 


54  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [July 

No  one  acquainted  with  the  facts  of  animal  variation — certainly 
not  Professor  Pearson  himself — will  assert  that  the  "  coefficient  of 
variation  "  is  always  a  measure  of  the  importance  of  variations  ;  no 
one  will  believe  that  in  any  animal  a  deviation  of  ten  per  cent,  in 
excess  of  the  mean  of  one  organ  has  of  necessity  the  same  im- 
portance as  a  deviation  of  ten  per  cent,  in  excess  of  the  mean  in 
another  organ.  A  finger  nail  of  double  the  normal  length,  or  a  hair 
of  double  the  normal  thickness,  will  hardly  produce  so  much  incon- 
venience as  a  leg  of  double  the  normal  length.  It  is  even  certain 
that  in  closely  allied  species  the  same  per  centage  deviation  of 
corresponding  characters  may  produce  widely  different  effects. 

There  is  no  doubt  that  the  "  coefficient  of  variation "  is  for 
certain  purposes  a  valuable  measure  of  variability  ;  and  Professor 
Pearson  has  shown,  in  some  of  his  more  technical  papers,  that  it  is 
of  great  use  in  establishing  important  propositions  in  the  theory  of 
Chance.  At  the  same  time,  students  of  evolution,  paying  attention 
specially  to  the  functional  importance  of  variation,  may  need  units 
proportional  to  this  importance  ;  and  such  units  may  well  be  different 
in  different  cases.  The  violent  assertion  that  there  is  only  one 
"  scientific  "  measure  of  variability  is  therefore  to  be  regretted. 

Whether  one  agrees  with  Professor  Pearson  on  this  single  question 
or  not,  one  cannot  but  be  grateful  to  him  for  the  four  essays  here 
referred  to,  as  well  as  for  the  more  elaborate  memoirs  on  which  they 
are  based.  The  picture  they  present  of  the  orderly  treatment  to 
which  animal  statistics  can  be  subjected,  so  that  hitherto  unwieldy 
and  perplexing  masses  of  figures  can  be  made  to  yield  simple  and 
intelligible  results,  should  do  much  to  make  the  study  of  Probability, 
in  its  application  to  the  problems  of  animal  evolution,  more  popular 
than  it  is,  and  to  enable  biologists  at  last  to  put  before  themselves  an 
adequate  numerical  estimate  of  those  phenomena  which  it  is  the 
business  of  their  lives  to  formulate  and  to  explain. 

W.   F.  R.   Weldon. 


1897]  55 


SOME  NEW  BOOKS 

Oui;  Dead  Volcanoes 

The  Ancient  Volcanoes  of  Great  Britain.  By  Sir  Archibald  Geikie,  F.R.S.  8vo. 
2  vols.,  pp.  xxiv.  and  478,  and  pp.  xvi.  and  492.  With  7  folding  maps  and  383 
illustrations.     London  :  Maemillan  &  Co.,  1897.     Price,  36s  net. 

This  work  is  an  expansion  of  the  two  addresses  given  by  its  author  to 
the  Geological  Society  of  London  in  1891  and  1892.     Those  of  us  who 
have  often  marvelled  at  the  amount  of  detail,  largely  new,  that  was 
brought  into  the  compass  of  the  addresses,  may  have  foreseen  the  solid 
and  permanent  character  of  the  two  large  volumes  now  before  us. 
In  earlier  years,  Sir  Archibald  Geikie  spent  his  leisure  in  volcanic 
areas — travelling,  observing,  correlating,  and  storing  up  the  wealth  of 
information  which  is  now  made  orderly  and  accessible.     The  270 
pages — more   than   a   quarter   of   the   whole  work — devoted  to  the 
Devonian,  Carboniferous,  and  Permian  volcanoes  of  Scotland  will  be 
welcomed  on  these  historic  grounds.     And  in  later  years,  with  the 
resources  of  the  Geological  Survey  at  his  command,  the  author  has 
been  able  to  extend  his  area,  so  as  to  examine  the  whole  range  of  vol- 
canic phenomena  in  our  islands.     Ireland  is  not  mentioned  in  the 
strict  title  of  the  work,  but  is  in  reality  dealt  with  in  a  manner  that 
atones  for  a  great  many  omissions  on  the  part  of  British  text-books. 
We  have  here,  in  fact,  a  basis  which  must  be  consultedbefore  work  is 
begun  on  any  igneous  rocks  of  the  British  Isles,  for  Sir  Archibald 
frequently,  and  very  properly,  treats  of  holocrystalline  and  deep-seated 
masses  in  addition  to  the  volcanic  relics  associated  with  them. 

So  far  as  we  can  judge,  the  passages  compiled  from  previous  writers 
have  been  drawn  up  with  admirable  accuracy,  even  to  the  use  of  the 
rock -names  employed  in  the  original  papers.  These  names,  in  fact, 
would  sometimes  be  the  better  for  a  little  comment  or  revision,  as  in 
the  case  of  the  French  rock-term  '  labradorite,'  imported  on  p.  29. 
The  book  is,  however,  written  for  geologists,  and  largely  for  those 
engaged  in  actual  investigation  ;  it  has,  at  any  rate,  the  merit  of  offer- 
ing no  encouragement  to  young  persons  'reading'  for  examinations. 

AVhile  book  i.  is  of  a  general  character,  there  is  much  in  it  that  is 
admirable  and  suggestive  to  the  worker  in  the  field.  We  may  note, 
for  instance,  the  diagram  of  "  the  gradual  emergence  of  buried  volcanic 
cones  through  the  influence  of  prolonged  denudation  "  (p.  75).  The 
characteristic  structures  of  iy-neous  rocks  are  described,  and  are  illus- 
trated  by  photographs  from  actual  specimens.  The  polished  surface 
of  '  Napoleonite '  on  p.  22,  and  the  fluidal  Antrim  rhyolite  on  p.  23, 
are  perfect  examples  of  their  kind. 

It  is  surely,  however,  an  undue  extension  of  terms  to  call  the 
structure  of  '  Napoleonite  '  variolitic  ;.  and  we  could  wish  that  vario- 
litic  and  orbicular  structure  had  not  been  separated  from  spherulitic 
in  the  text.     The  ophitic  structure,  again,  is  referred  to,  as  in  so  many 


56 


NATURAL  SCIENCE 


[July 


works,  from  its  superficial  or  microscopic  aspect,  the  enveloping 
crystals  of  pyroxene  being  described  as  '  large  plates.'  As  all  field- 
workers  know,  they  are  often  so  uniform  in  length,  breadth,  and 
thickness,  as  to  produce  the  appearance  of  nodules  on  the  weathered 
surfaces  of  a  rock. 

In  dealing  with  columnar  structure,  it  is  remarked  that  in  one  type, 
of  which  the  rock  at  Fingal's  Cave  is  an  example,  "  the  columns  pass 
with  regularity  and  parallelism  from  the  top  to  the  bottom  of  a  bed." 
The  other  type  is  of  the  irregular  character.  "  At  Staffa  the  regularly 
columnar  bed  is  immediately  overlain  with  one  of  the  starch-like 
character."  Though  we  are  told  that  the  two  types  may  even  pass 
into  one  another,  we  should  have  liked  an  opinion  as  to  their  con- 
tinuity in  the  case  of  Staffa.  In  vol.  ii.,  p.  210,  the  photograph  of 
that  island  is  used  to  show  the  '  bedded  '  structure  of  the  basalt ;  and 
the  reader  might  easily  regard  the  mass  as  formed  of  two  successive 
sheets.     Some  reference  would  be  useful  to  Scrope's  observations  in 


Diagram  illustrating  the  gradual  emergence  of  buried  volcanic  cones  through  the 
influence  of  prolonged  denudation. 

the  Vivarais  ("Considerations  on  Volcanoes,"  1825,  p.  141),  already 
noticed  in  Prof.  Judd's  '  Volcanoes.' 

Another  case  in  which  the  opinion  of  Sir  Archibald  Geikie  would 
have  been  of  service  is  in  regard  to  the  relation  of  laccolites  to  earth- 
movement.  How  far  does  the  pressure  that  propels  the  lava  forward 
enable  it  to  lift  up  the  dome  of  strata  and  to  form  a  cistern  for  itself  ? 
In  any  case,  we  are  not  left  with  the  vague  idea  that  some  expansive 
force  within  the  molten  mass  itself  enables  it  to  upheave  the  earth 
above  it  (p.  87,  and  vol.  ii.  p.  361) ;  but  might  not  greater  emphasis  have 
been  laid  upon  the  view  stated  on  p.  98,  where  the  cavities  occupied 
by  the  lava  are  themselves  referred  to  earth-movement  ?  Mr  Gilbert, 
however,  was  undoubtedly  of  opinion  in  1877  that  the  pressure  on  the 
fluid  mass  was  sufficient  to  produce  the  arching  above  the  laccolite. 

A  good  summary  of  the  theory  of  differentiation  in  plutonic  masses, 
and  of  recent  results  on  '  bosses,'  is  given  on  pp.  88-99.  The  variation 
of  an  intrusive  magma  by  absorption  of  surrounding  rocks  is  also  very 
fairly  dealt  with. 

Chapter  vii.  gives  scope  for  some  of  those  admirable  descriptions 
of  landscape,  which  recur  afterwards  delightfully  through  the  work, 
and  which  constantly  remind  us  of  the  open-air  culture  of  the  author. 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  57 

Page  after  page  attests  the  energetic  field-work  on  which  each  series 
of  results  is  based,  though  now  and  then  acquaintance  with  the 
ground  is  required,  before  wTe  can  detect  how  much  is  due  to  a  grasp 
of  the  features  of  the  scene  itself,  and  how  much  is  culled  from  the 
drier  field  of  published  memoirs. 

We  must  not  attempt,  chapter  by  chapter,  to  touch  on  the 
numerous  new  suggestions,  or  the  revisions  of  previous  work,  con- 
tained in  the  description  of  each  special  area.  On  p.  145,  we  note 
that  the  Cambrian  is  stated  to  pass  down  conformably  into  the 
Pebidian  of  St  David's,  which  is  included  with  it,  the  Arvonian  and 
Dimetian  being  intrusive  ;  and  no  pre-Cambrian  rocks  are  tolerated 
here.  But  in  other  places  the  earlier  work  of  the  survey  is  candidly 
set  aside,  where  the  personal  investigation  of  the  author  has  led  to  a 
change  of  view.  Here  and  there,  work  remaining  to  be  done  is 
indicated,  as  in  the  Malvern  range  (p.  170),  and  in  the  important 
Borrowdale  series  (p.  227). 

In  the  latter  case,  the  discussion  given  in  the  present  work  does 
much  to  fill  the  gap,  and  is  a  fine  example  of  the  caution  with  which 
such  altered  masses  must  now-a-days  be  approached.  We  have  done 
with  the  broad  structural  diagrams,  accompanied  by  '  theories  of  the 
earth,'  which  had  to  serve  as  a  basis  for  future  observations,  at  a 
time  when  the  labourers  were  few  ;  and  Sir  Archibald  Geikie  writes 
of  the  map  of  the  lake  district,  "  so  rapid  has  the  progress  of  certain 
branches  of  geology  been  since  these  sheets  were  published,  that  the 
map  is  even  now  susceptible  of  considerable  improvement." 

A  strikingly  new  chapter,  embodying  results  hitherto  unpublished, 
or,  perhaps,  only  hinted  at  in  the  annual  reports  of  the  Geological 
Survey,  deals  with  "the  Silurian  Volcanoes  of  Ireland"  (pp.  239-256). 
"We  note  than  an  Arenig  age  is  suggested  for  the  crushed  tuffs  of 
eastern  Tyrone,  formerly  regarded  as  '  Dalradian  ' ;  but  "  no  recognis- 
able radiolaria  have  yet  been  detected  "  in  the  associated  cherts. 

An  interesting  point  in  the  description  of  the  Old  Eed  Sandstone 
eruptions  is  the  occurrence  of  infillings  of  sandstone  in  the  cavernous 
hollows  of  lavas  poured  out  under  water  (pp.  283  and  333).  In  some 
cases,  these  sandstones  are  even  stratified,  reminding  one  of  the 
material  deposited  in  the  interstices  of  a  coral-reef. 

"We  are  glad  to  note,  on  p.  346,  the  decided  attitude  taken  up 
with  regard  to  the  correlation  of  the  Dingle  Beds.  Irish  geologists 
have,  more  or  less,  played  with  this  important  stratified  series,  usually 
referring  it  to  the  Silurian,  although  it  clearly  caps  the  Ludlow  beds. 
Since  Jukes  led  an  attack  upon  the  Devonian  system  as  a  whole,  an 
attempt  has  been  made  to  do  without  that  system  in  Ireland,  the 
Upper  Old  Red  Sandstone  being  carried  bodily  up  into  the  Carbonifer- 
ous, and  the  lower  thrust  down  into  the  Silurian.  No  man  living  can 
speak  with  better  authority  on  this  point  than  Sir  Archibald  Geikie. 

The  first  volume  closes  with  a  superb  series  of  full-page  photo- 
graphs of  the  Carboniferous  volcanic  phenomena  of  Scotland.  "While 
these  recall  the  wTork  done  by  the  Geological  Survey  of  the  United 
States,  we  can  only  regret  that  in  our  own  islands  their  publication, 
on  this  ample  scale,  has  been  reserved"  for  private  enterprise.  "We 
cannot  resist  mentioning  by  name  the  view  of  the  agglomerate  of  the 
Binn  of  Burntisland  (p.  431),  which  equals  the  fine  Cainozoic  sections 


58  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [jULy 

in  the  neighbourhood  of  Budapest,  and  the  spheroidal  weathering  of 
dolerite  at  North  Queensferry,  given  on  p.  455. 

The  second  volume  opens  with  the  Great  Whin  Sill,  which  is  pro- 
visionally referred  to  the  Carboniferous  period.  A  considerable  series 
of  volcanoes  is  then  included  as  Permian,  or  possibly  Triassic,  on  the 
ground  that  "  there  is  usually  ample  proof  that  the  strata  in  question 
[associated  with  them]  are  much  later  than  the  Coal-measures,  while 
their  geological  position  and  lithological  characters  link  them  with 
the  undoubted  Permian  series  of  the  north-east  of  England."  The 
best  known  mass  placed  in  this  group  is  the  upper  portion  of  Arthur's 
Seat,  Edinburgh,  which,  the  author  maintains,  is  independent  of  the 
older  and  true  Carboniferous  series.  He  thus  supports  Maclaren's 
view  of  1839,  in  opposition  to  its  subsequent  revision  by  its  author, 
and  to  the  well-known  paper  by  Prof.  Judd. 

Some  exceedingly  pretty  mapping  of  the  fragmental  materials  in 
a  vent  at  Elie  Harbour,  Fife,  is  seen  in  Fig.  217  ;  and  the  volcanic 
sections  of  this  district  are  again  finely  illustrated  by  full-page  photo- 
graphs. The  capping  of  Titterstone  Clee,  in  Shropshire,  is  referred 
also  to  the  Permian  period. 

Then  comes  the  great  gap  in  our  volcanic  history,  book  viii.  open- 
ing with  Cainozoic  times.  The  plateau  -  basalts  are  attributed  to 
fissure-eruptions  rather  than  to  repeated  flows  from  central  vents ; 
and  a  very  valuable  chapter  (pp.  260-269)  supplies  an  account  of  such 
eruptions  in  recent  times  in  Iceland.  It  is,  however,  pointed  out  that 
the  tabular  sheets  are  composed  of  the  union  of  successive  flows,  one 
overlapping  on  the  edges  of  another  (p.  193) ;  and  the  fact  that  cones 
are  formed  along  the  lines  of  fissure,  each  sending  out  its  separate 
flows,  is  clearly  brought  out  on  pp.  264  and  265.  The  absence  of 
clear  evidence  of  the  connexion  between  our  dykes  and  the  superficial 
flows  is  very  candidly  stated  (p.  268).  The  recognisable  vents,  such 
as  Slemish  in  Antrim,  and  other  well-known  necks  in  the  same 
county,  indicate  more  normal  conditions  of  eruption. 

While  there  is  this  difficulty  in  correlating  the  intrusive  basalts 
with  the  lavas  penetrated  by  them,  we  must  also  face  the  similar 
difficulty  arising  from  the  lack  of  continuity  between  the  gabbro 
masses  of  Mull  and  Skye  and  the  surrounding  plateau-basalts.  If  the 
dykes  form  the  orifices  for  the  extrusion  of  the  latter,  why  may  not 
the  heart  of  Skye  have  served  equally  as  a  great  volcanic  centre?  In 
both  cases,  the  intrusive  rock  presented  to  us  is  that  which  last  consoli- 
dated in  the  vent ;  its  earlier  and  basal  volcanic  products  may,  how- 
ever, remain  to  us  in  the  surrounding  lavas.  Surely  the  great  core  of 
Vesuvius  is  at  this  moment  intrusive  in  the  earlier  lavas  of  its  flanks. 
The  author  recognises  some  such  argument  on  p.  348,  but  will  not 
allow  the  site  of  the  Cuillin  Hills  to  have  any  direct  relation  to  the 
existing  surface-products  (p.  362).  Granting  that  a  number  of  small 
vents  suits  the  conditions  recognised  in  Antrim,  why  may  we  not  have 
traces  of  more  centralised  activity  in  Mull  and  Skye  ?  The  difference 
of  opinion  between  the  author  and  Trof.  Judd  on  this  point  appears 
less  fundamental,  less  to  be  insisted  on,  the  more  clearly  we  have  laid 
before  us  the  relations  of  the  dykes  and  plateau-basalts  from  the 
fissure-eruption  point  of  view. 

It  can  hardly  be  expected  that  Ireland  should  receive  more  detailed 


fca 


1897] 


SOME  NEW  BOOKS  59 


treatment,  in  regard  to  its  Cainozoic  volcanic  areas,  than  is  accorded  to 
it  in  the  present  volume,  which  is  far  and  away  more  generous  than 
any  predecessor.  While  Ireland  cannot  at  any  point  equal  the  crags 
of  Scuir  na  Gillean  (p.  335),  so  finely  set  forth  by  Mr  Abraham,  yet 
we  should  have  liked  some  recognition  of  the  strikingly  scenic  aspect 
of  the  Mournes,  one  of  the  most  '  self-contained  '  and  solitary  moun- 
tain-groups in  the  British  Isles.  One  page  deals  with  this  district, 
while  as  many  as  seven  are  devoted  to  the  Limerick  Basin,  fourteen 
to  the  toadstones  of  Derbyshire,  and  thirteen  to  St  Kilda.  To  ask 
for  more,  however,  when  we  close  these  handsome  volumes,  is  only  a 
well-merited  compliment  to  their  author.  G.  A.  J.  Cole. 

A  Live  Naturalist 

Round  the  Year  :  A  Sekies  of  Short  Nature  Studies.  By  Professor  L.  C.  Miall. 
8vo,  pp.  viii. ,  296.  With  illustrations  chiefly  by  A.  R.  Hammond.  London  : 
Macmillan  &  Co.     1896.     Price,  5s. 

"  Live  Natural  History  !  "  The  phrase  is  our  author's,  and  no  better 
example  of  it  could  be  found  than  this  book.  It  is,  we  may  imagine, 
just  such  a  book  as  might  have  been  written  by  Gilbert  White  had 
he  lived  in  these  days,  and  had  the  benefit  of  a  thorough  scientific 
training.  Against  the  '  dry,  marrowless,  useless,'  '  melancholy  '  and 
'  stodgy '  catalogue-type  of  natural  history,  the  author  raises  a  just 
protest.  There  "is  also  a  style  of  natural  history  writing  that  consists 
largely  of  phrases  without  knowledge  and  imagination  unallied  to 
observation.  Professor  Miall  gives  us  the  attempted  literary  charm  of 
the  latter  with  the  accuracy  and  wealth  of  knowledge  of  the  former. 
He  takes  us  out  into  the  fields  and  over  the  mountains,  but  does  not 
forget  that  there  is  a  well-stocked  library  at  home.  It  is  indeed  a 
feature  that  we  would  fain  see  more  of  in  so-called  popular  '  Natural 
Histories ' — this  constant  reference  to  fuller  accounts  and  original 
authorities.  So  many  writers  treat  their  readers  as  sheer  dyspeptics, 
unable  to  digest  aught  beyond  pap. 

As  examples  of  the  subjects  so  fascinatingly  and  suggestively 
dealt  with,  we  may  mention  :  snow-flakes,  birds  in  mid-winter,  cat 
and  dog,  the  moon,  spring  crocuses,  catkins,  the  oil-beetle,  the  botany 
of  a  railway  station,  hay-time,  cabbages  and  turnips,  weeds,  the  love 
of  mountains,  the  reversed  spiral,  the  structure  of  a  feather,  the 
shortest  day  of  the  year. 

It  is  now  July,  and  we  find  our  author  treating  of  duckweed. 
How  many  of  us  know  its  flower  ?  Now  is  the  time  to  see  it.  Let 
the  field  naturalist  take  some  duckweed  from  the  water,  and,  with 
Professor  Miall,  let  him  examine,  describe,  and  draw  it.  The  reasons 
for  its  peculiar  shape  may  then  be  guessed  at,  and  the  guesses  checked 
by  experiments  with  models.  Thus  he  is  led  to  understand  more 
about  the  relations  of  this  common  water-plant  to  its  environment, 
and  the  ways  in  which  it  may  spread  from  one  pool  to  another.  How 
widespread  it  is  he  must  learn  from  books,  such  as  Hegelmaier's  "Die 
Lemnaceen." 

A  word  of  praise  is  due  to  the  illustrations,  the  fresh  pen-and-ink 
drawings  by  Mr  Hammond  being  specially  clear  and  artistic. 


60  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [July 

Sceaps  from  Serials. 

The  June  number  of  the  Westminster  Review  contains  the  conclu- 
sion of  an  article  by  J.  E.  Hewitt  on  the  cave  deposits  of  the  Ardennes, 
which  he  thinks  contain  evidence  to  show  that  the  palaeolithic  dwellers 
in  those  caves  had  a  regular  totemistic  system. 

There  is  no  magazine  in  New  Zealand,  but  the  Press  of  Christ- 
church  attempts  to  supply  the  want  by  publishing,  every  Monday, 
signed  articles  on  literary,  social,  and  philosophical  questions.  The 
issue  for  April  26  contains  an  interesting  account  by  Prof.  Arthur 
Dendy  of  the  land-planarians,  nemertines,  and  the  Peripatus  of  New 
Zealand. 

The  Photogram  is  publishing  a  useful  series  of  articles  on  applied 
photography.  Application  No.  5,  which  appears  in  the  June  number 
is  '  in  Zoology,'  by  Dr  R.  W.  Shufeldt,  and  is  illustrated  by  some 
admirable  examples.  A  cognate  subject  is  "  Stalking  with  the 
Camera,"  by  K.  B.  Lodge,  of  which  part  3  appeared  in  the  May  num- 
ber. This  appears  to  be  quite  as  exciting  as  stalking  with  a  gun,  and 
the  results  are  both  permanent  and  valuable. 

Geologists  who  propose  attending  the  International  Geological 
Congress,  and  who  may  be  so  fortunate  as  to  have  obtained  tickets  for 
the  excursion  to  the  Caucasus,  should  study  a  sketch  of  the  geology 
of  that  region,  published  by  V.  Dingelstedt  in  the  Nauchnoe  Obozryenic. 
Or  in  case  this  is  beyond  them,  they  will  find  an  excellent  summary 
in  the  May  number  of  the  Scottish  Geographical  Magazine. 

The  Journal  of  School  Gcogrcqjhy,  edited  by  R.  E.  Dodge,  New 
York,  maintains  its  bright  and  useful  character.  The  April  number 
contains  a  short  article  on  the  geographical  distribution  of  plants,  by 
Prof.  Conway  Macmillan,  who  contends  that  the  study  of  plant  dis- 
tribution in  a  limited  area,  such  as  a  pond  and  its  shores,  or  a  hill 
and  its  slopes,  would  be  of  more  value  in  schools  than  '  the  ordinary 
herbalism.' 

In  the  numbers  of  the  Revue  Generate  cle  Botanique  for  the  present 
year  some  useful  reviews  of  recent  work  done  in  certain  departments 
of  the  science  are  in  progress.  One  by  A.  Prunet  deals  with  results 
in  plant  anatomy,  published  in  the  years  1892  to  1894.  The  first 
four  numbers  treat  of  the  anatomy  of  the  cell  under  the  headings  of 
Nucleus,  Elements  figures  (including  Crato's  phi/socle,  and  certain  chloro- 
lenciles),  and  Membrane.  The  review  is  illustrated,  and  references  are 
given  to  original  papers.  The  second,  by  Geneau  de  Lamarliere, 
relates  to  descriptive  work  on  mosses,  published  between  January  1889 
and  January  1895. 

New  Serials 

The  Revista  Italiana  di  Sociologia,  Rome,  intends  to  be  a  thoroughly 
scientific  and  independent  review.  Since  it  numbers  among  its  editors 
such  men  as  Salvatore  Cognetti  de  Martiis,  Augusto  Rosco,  G.  Cavag- 
lieri,  G.  Sergi,  V.  Tangorra,  and  Enrico  Tedeschi,  it  is  probable  that 
the  promise  will  be  fulfilled. 

We  have  received  No.  2  of  the  Aeronautical  Journal,  which  to  non- 
members  costs  2s.,  though  it  contains  only  20  pages.  It  is  thoroughly 
practical,  and  brings  together  all  that   is   taking  place   in   the  aero- 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  61 

nautical  world,  whether  in  the  form  of  experiments,  lectures,  publica- 
tions, magazine  articles,  inventions,  or  patents. 

La  Eevista  Nueva  is  an  illustrated  monthly,  which  commenced 
publication  at  San  Jose,  Costa  Eica,  in  September  1896.  The  directors 
are  E.  Fernandez  Guardia  and  Alberto  Masterrer,  and  they  have  the 
moral  support  of  the  Government.  The  price  is  60  cents  a  number, 
1  dol.  50  cents  a  quarter.  For  the  most  part  the  Eevista  is  devoted  to 
general  and  literary  topics  ;  but  we  notice  that  the  earlier  numbers 
contain  a  series  of  articles  by  Anastasio  Alfaro  on  the  antiquities  and 
the  mammals  of  Costa  Eica.  Among  the  coloured  plates  are  repre- 
sentations of  figured  jars  in  the  museum  of  Costa  Eica. 

We  have  received  the  first  two  fascicules  of  Eevista  Quindicinale 
di  Esicologia,  Esicliiatria,  Neuropatologia  ad  uso  del  Medici  c  dei 
Giuristi,  which  is  the  expressive  though  cumbersome  title  of  a  fort- 
nightly magazine,  blessed  with  two  directors,  seven  editors,  and  twenty- 
nine  collaborators.  The  chief  editor  is  Dr  Sante  de  Sanctis,  E.  Clinica 
Psichiatrica,  Via  Penitenzieri,  13,  Eome.  The  publishers  are  Fratelli 
Capaccini,  Via  Sistina  22,  Eome.  Each  fascicule,  which  consists  of 
16  pages,  contains  two  original  articles  and  several  reviews.  A  year's 
subscription  (from  May  1  in  each  year)  is  6  lire.  The  Rcvista  should 
do  much  to  produce  healthy  co-operation  in  Italy  between  the  students 
of  pure  psychology  and  their  fellow-workers  in  criminal  and  patho- 
logical psychology  ;  success  seems  guaranteed  by  the  eminence  of  the 
contributors. 

Further  Literature  Received. 

First  Stage  Mechanics  of  Fluids,  G.  H.  Bryan  and  F.  Rosenberg.  First  Stage  Sound. 
Light  and  Heat,  J.  Don  :  Clive.  Text-book  of  Geology,  W.  J.  Harrison  :  Blackie. 
Hand-book  to  the  Order  Lepidoptera,  W.  F.  Kirby  :  Allen.  Catalogue  of  the  Fossil 
Cephalopoda  in  the  British  Museum,  Part  III.,  A.  H.  Foord  and  G..C.  Crick.  Cata- 
logue of  Tertiary  Mollusca  in  the  British  Museum,  Part  I. ,  G.  F.  Harris  :  Trustees  Brit. 
Mus.  The  Concise  Knowledge  Natural  History,  ed.  by  P.  Myles  :  Hutchinson.  Field 
Geology  in  South  Westmoreland,  H.  G.  Foster- Barham  :  Atkinson,  Kendal.  Investiga- 
tions into  Applied  Nature,  W.  Wilson  :  Simpkin,  Marshall,  The  Aeronautical  Annual, 
1897  :  AVesley.  The  Psychology  of  the  Emotions,  Th.  Ribot :  Scott.  Annual  Report 
of  the  Geological  Survey  of  the  United  Kingdom,  1896,  A.  Geikie :  Science  and  Art 
Dept.  Memoirs  of  the  Field  Columbian  Museum,  Chicago,  Vol.  I.,  No  2,  Ornitho- 
logical Series,  No.  3,  Botanical  Series.  Farmers'  Bulletin,  No.  4  :  U.S.  Dept. 
Agriculture. 

Poissons  provenant  des  campagnes  du  yacht  l'Hirondelle  (1885-88),  R.  Collett.  On 
the  Origin  of  the  European  Fauna,  R.  F.  Scharff :  Proc.  Roy.  Irish  Acad.  On  the 
Brains  of  two  Sub-Fossil  Malagasy  Lemuroids,  C.  J.  F.  Major:  Abstr.  Roy.  Soe.  On 
Nereids  commensal  with  Hermit  Crabs,  N.  R.  Harrington  :  Trans.  Neiu  York  Acad.  Set. 
Edward  D.  Cope,  H.  F.  Osborn  :  Science.  Comparison  of  the  Carboniferous  and 
Permian  Formations  of  Nebraska  and  Kansas,  C.  S.  Prosser :  Journ.  Geol.  Some 
Observations  on  certain  Species  of  Arion,  W.  E.  Collinge  :  Journ.  MalacoJ.  On 
Ctenoplana,  A.  Willey  :  Quart.  Journ.  Micro.  Sci. 

Jersey  Times,  June  7  ;  Tunbridge  Wells  Gazette,  May  26  ;  Amer.  Geol.,  June  ; 
Amer.  Journ.  Sci.,  June  ;  Amer.  Nat.,  June  ;  1' Anthropologic,  March- April ;  Botan. 
Gazette,  May;  Feuille  des  jeunes  Nat.,  June;  Irish  Nat.,  June;  Knowledge,  June; 
Literary  Digest,  May  15,  22,  29,  June  5  ;  Naturae  Novit. ,  May  ;  La  Naturaleza  (Madrid), 
May  14,  28,  June  8  ;  Naturalist,  June ;  Nature,  June  3,  10,  17  ;  Natureu,  May  ; 
Photogram,  June;  Review  of  Reviews,  May,  June;  Revue  Scient.,  May  22,  29,  June 
12  ;  Science,  May  14,  28,  June  4  ;  Scient.  Amer.,  May  15,  22,  29,  June  5  ;  Scot.  Geogr. 
Mag.,  June  ;  Scot.  Med.  and  Surg.  Journ.,  June  ;  Victorian  Nat.,  May ;  Proc.  Biol.  Soc. 
Washington,  Vol.  XL,  May  13  ;  Chivers'  New  Book  List,  June  ;  Halifax  Naturalist, 
Vol.  II.  No.  8,  June  ;  Journ.  School  Geogr.,  May. 


6  2  [July 


OBITUARIES 

AUGUSTUS   WOLLASTON  FRANKS 
Born  1826.     Died  May  21,  1897 

Sir  Augustus  Wollaston  Franks,  K.C.B.,  D.C.L.,  F.B.S.,  Pres.  S.A., 
F.G.S.,  Trustee  of  the  British  Museum,  late  keeper  of  British  and 
Mediaeval  Antiquities  and  of  Ethnography  at  the  British  Museum, 
was  born  at  Geneva  in  1826,  and  educated  at  Eton  and  Trinity 
College,  Cambridge,  taking  his  M.A.  degree  in  1852.  His  taste  for 
the  beautiful  in  works  of  art,  and  his  appreciation  of  the  niceties, 
peculiarities,  and  fantasies  of  artists,  whether  the  results  were 
produced  with  the  inspiration  of  genius,  or  by  handicraft  and  labour, 
led  him  to  collect  largely  in  each  department  of  artistic  work,  and 
fortunately  his  ample  means  enabled  him  to  do  so.  With  munificent 
liberality  he  gave  many  valuable  collections  to  the  National  Museum 
at  Bloomsbury.  It  was  thus  that,  not  only  theoretically,  but  practi- 
cally and  personally,  he  was  acquainted  with  the  extensive  and  many- 
sided  groups  of  antiquities  and  ethnographic  exhibits  under  his 
keepership.  He  was  not  a  mere  official  custodian,  but  a  cultured 
connoisseur,  and  a  high-class  authority  on  all  points  connected  with 
the  scientific  and  historical  aspects  of  the  materials  or  collections  in 
his  charge.  Necessarily  his  study  of  medieval  things  kept  him  in 
touch  witli  those  of  prehistoric  age  in  the  British  Collection  which 
was  under  his  care ;  and,  indeed,  of  these  there  are  many  objects  of 
human  workmanship  dating  from  extremely  early  times.  Con- 
temporary with  these  were  similar  productions  in  European  and 
other  countries.  These  are  largely  represented  in  the  British  Museum 
by  the  "  Christy  Collection,"  which  Sir  Wollaston  Franks  augmented 
by  successive  gifts  of  similar  well-sorted  examples  from  many  localities. 
Indeed,  this  notable  department  in  the  museum  well  deserves  now 
to  be  called  the  "  Christy-Franks  Collection." 

In  March  1864,  Mr  Henry  Christy  invited  a  party  of  his  friends, 
interested  as  antiquaries  and  geologists,  to  examine  some  of  the  bone- 
caves  on  the  Vezere,  Dordogne  district,  in  the  south  of  France,  which, 
with  his  friend  Edouard  Lartet,  he  had  for  some  time  been  investi- 
gating with  great  care,  and  at  considerable  expense.  The  party 
comprised  Mr  W.  J.  Hamilton  (President  of  the  Geological  Society), 
Prof.  Rupert  Jones  (Assistant  Secretary  of  the  Geological 
Society),  Capt.  (since  Sir)  Douglas  Galton,  Mr  (since  Sir)  John 
Lubbock,  Mr  (since  Sir)  John  Evans,  and  Mr  (since  Sir)  A.  W. 
Franks.*  Not  only  had  the  last-named  already  interested  himself  in 
Henry  Christy's  researches  in  the  ethnographic  relationship  of  various 
textile  fabrics,  which  had  led  him  to  Mexico,  and  in  that  country  to 
the  observation  of  stone  implements ;  but  A.  W.  Franks  heartily 
joined  Christy  in  the  study  of  stone  implements,  and  of  those  who 

*  Quart.  Joum.  Gcol.  S'oc,  vol.  xx.,  1864,  p.  444;  and  "  Reliquiae  Aquitanicae, " 
Partxii.,  1873,  p.  161. 


1S97J  OBITUARIES  63' 

made  and  used  them,  whether  ancient  peoples,  recent  savages,  or 
living  workmen  in  some  modern  trades  and  manufactures.  Together 
with  Dr  Hugh  Falconer,  he  aided  H.  Christy  and  E.  Lartet  in  plan- 
ning their  great  work,  "  Reliquiae  Aquitanicae,"  which  was  intended 
to  comprise  descriptions  of  all  the  Dordogne  caves  and  their  contents. 
Unfortunately  the  death  of  both  Christy  and  Lartet  circumscribed  the 
work  within  smaller  limits,  for  no  more  caves  were  worked  out  by 
them,  and  but  few  plates  were  subsequently  added  to  the  eighty  or 
more  already  lithographed  for  its  illustration.  It  is  noticed,  we  see, 
in  the  preface  of  the  book  that,  "  In  bringing  together  and  arranging 
the  varied  materials  supplied  by  friends  at  home  and  abroad  desirous 
of  making  the  "  Reliquiae  Aquitanicae "  useful  in  archaeology  and 
anthropology,  the  directing  counsels  of  Mr  A.  W.  Franks,  F.R.S., 
have  been  constant  and  efficient,  like  his  courtesy  and  knowledge." 

He  took  charge  of  the  "  Christy  Collection,"  at  123  Victoria  Street, 
S.W.,  for  some  time  before  it  was  transferred  to  the  British  Museum  ; 
and  he  individualised  the  specimens  with  accurate  drawings  by  his 
talented  assistants — first,  T.  K.  Gay,  and  subsequently  Charles  Read. 
The  latter  worthily  succeeded  Sir  Wollaston  on  his  resignation,  in 
1894,  as  keeper  in  the  British  Museum. 

It  was  with  great  caution  that  Sir  Wollaston  exercised  his  judg- 
ment as  to  the  authenticity  of  implements  of  stone  and  their  relative 
age.  He  was  not  an  enthusiast  in  the  subject  of  the  great  antiquity 
of  the  Human  Bace.  Possibly,  had  he  been  induced  to  give  more 
leisure  to  the  study  of  the  geological  aspect  and  details  of  the  subject, 
he  might  have  become  cognisant  of  the  value  of  Sir  Joseph  Prestwich's 
researches  in  the  geological  age  of  some  of  the  older  groups  of  flint 
implements,  especially  of  those  collected  with  earnest  and  intelligent 
care  at  Ightham,  in  Kent,  by  Mr  Benjamin  Harrison  (see  Natural 
Science,  Vol.  V.,  p.  209,  Oct.  1 894). 

Sir  A.  Wollaston  Franks  contributed  largely  to  scientific  literature, 
especially  by  memoirs  and  notices  in  the  Transactions  and  Proceedings 
of  learned  societies.  He  has  greatly  enlarged  the  knowledge  of 
antiquities  and  their  real  relationships,  not  only  by  original  research, 
but  by  his  willing  advice  and  ready  information  to  enquirers,  whether 
in  London  or  the  provinces.  He  has  bequeathed  his  collections  to 
the  British  Museum.  He  was  elected  to  the  Royal  Society  in  1854. 
For  many  years  an  active  and  valued  Fellow  of  the  Society  of 
Antiquaries,  he  was  elected  Director  of  the  Society  in  1858.  Sub- 
sequently for  some  years  he  was  Vice-President,  and  eventually  he 
became  President  in  1892.  T.  B.  J. 

JULIUS    VON    SACHS 

Born  October  2,  1832.     Died  June  1897 

We  regret  to  announce  the  death  of  Professor  Julius  von  Sachs,  the 
botanist,  who  perhaps  more  than  any  other  is  responsible  for  the 
present  position  of  his  science — be  it  good  or  bad — at  any  rate  from 
the  point  of  view  of  the  university  or  college  curriculum.  His 
"  Lehrbuch  der  Botanik,"  or  its  English  translation,  was  for  more  than 
twenty  years  the  text-book  for  advanced  students ;  and  even  now  it 
holds  an  honoured  place  in  all  botanical  libraries. 


64  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [July 

Born  at  Breslau  sixty-five  years  ago,  Sachs  studied  in  the  German 
University  of  Prague,  and  in  1851  became  assistant  to  Purkinje.  In 
1856  he  was  appointed  Privatdocent  for  Plant  Physiology  in  the  same 
University.  In  1861  he  was  called  to  the  Chair  of  Botany  in  the 
Agricultural  Academy  of  Poppelsdorf ;  six  years  later  he  removed  to 
Freiburg  ;  and  finally  in  1868  he  obtained  the  Professorship  of  Botany 
at  Wiirzburg,  which  he  held  until  his  death. 

Sachs  was  a  hard  worker  and  a  voluminous  author.  The  Loyal 
Society's  catalogue  enumerates  92  papers  up  to  1883  only.  The  first, 
on  the  crayfish,  appeared  in  Ziva,  a  periodical  printed  in  Bohemian, 
and  published  at  Prague.  If  we  turn  over  the  numbers  of  Ziva  for  a 
few  years  from  1853  onward,  the  great  energy  of  the  man  and  the  bent 
of  his  mind  towards  the  morphology  and  physiology  of  plants  is  evi- 
dent. Among  the  excellent  figures  which  accompany  the  text  and 
which  alone  appeal  to  most  of  us,  we  see  the  originals  of  many  which 
have  since  become  classical.  Besides  his  Text-book  of  Botany,  the  Clar- 
endon Press  has  put  two  other  of  Sachs'  useful  works  within  the  reach 
of  all  English-speaking  students — the  "  Lectures  on  the  Physiology  of 
Plants,"  translated  by  Prof.  Marshall  Ward,  and  the  "  History  of 
Botany."  Some  idea  of  the  amount  of  his  work  may  be  gained  from 
the  size  of  the  collected  contributions  to  plant  physiology,  published 
in  1892-3,  which  form  a  book  of  more  than  1200  pages,  large  octavo. 
The  relation  of  temperature  and  light  to  the  living  plants,  chlorophyll 
and  assimilation,  the  measurement  of  water  through  the  tissues,  and 
the  transport  of  food-material,  are  the  very  wide  headings  under  which 
his  work  in  this  branch  is  grouped.  Besides  his  numerous  papers  in 
the  Botanische  Zeitung,  Flora,  and  many  other  German  periodicals, 
Sachs  founded  and  edited  the  Arbeiten  des  Botanischen  Instituts  in 
Wiirzburg,  the  first  volume  of  which  appeared  in  1874,  and  the  third 
and  last  in  1888.  They  represent  mainly  his  own  work  or  that  of  his 
pupils,  many  of  whom  have  since  become  well  known  as  investigators 
and  teachers. 

FLITZ  MUELLEE 

Born  1822.     Died  May  21,  1897 

This  eminent  helminthologist,  carcinologist,  and  field-naturalist  died 
last  month  at  his  residence  in  Blumenau,  Santa  Catarina,  Brazil. 
His  earliest  contributions  to  science  appeared  in  Wiegmann's  Archiv 
fur  Naturgeschichte  in  1844,  and  were  written  under  the  Christian 
name  of  Friedrich.  Later  on  he  appeared  as  Fritz,  again  as  Friedrich, 
and  in  more  recent  publications  as  Frederico — a  series  of  changes 
which  have  confused  not  a  few  librarians.  So  far  as  his  contributions 
to  periodical  literature  are  concerned,  the  list  in  the  Loyal  Society's 
catalogue  is  correct,  and  in  the  tenth  volume  of  that  work  we  read 
that  Midler's  full  name  was  Johann  Friedrich  Theodor  Mliller. 
The  latter,  no  doubt,  was  information  received  from  himself,  but 
Miiller  does  not  mention  this  fact  in  a  sketch  of  his  life  in  his  own 
hand  that  lies  before  us.  He  was  a  voluminous  and  steady  worker, 
but  his  chief  claim  to  remembrance  is  his  book,  "Fur  Darwin,"  which 
was  a  first-class  contribution  to  the  subject  of  Natural  Selection,  and 
was  translated  into  English  as  "  Facts  and  Arguments  for  Darwin," 
by  the  late  W.  S.  Dallas.  C.  D.  S. 


1897]  OBITUARIES  65 

Baron  Oscar  Dickson,  who  died  at  his  estate  Almniis,  near 
Gothenburg,  on  June  5,  aged  73,  used  his  opportunities  as  one  of  the 
wealthiest  men  in  Sweden  to  succour  all  scientific  and  educati  onal 
enterprise,  and  especially  geographical  explorations,  most  notable 
among  which  has  been  the  voyage  of  the  Vega  through  the  north-east 
passage  under  Baron  Nordenskjold.  Some  years  ago  Baron  Dickson 
offered  to  contribute  largely  to  an  Antarctic  expedition  under  the 
command  of  Nordenskjold,  if  the  Australian  colonies  would  help,  but 
the  scheme  fell  through. 

There  are  also  announced  the  deaths  of :— Martin  L.  Linell,  assistant  in  the  De 
partment  of  Insects  in  the  U.S.  National  Museum,  aged  47  ;  C.  A.  L.  Robertson,  one 
of  the  editors  of  the  Journal  of  Mental  Science,  and    well  known  through  his  work  in 
medical  physiology ;  H.  V.  Carter,  for  many  years  Professor  of  Anatomy  and  Physi- 
ology in  the  Grant  Medical  College  at  Bombay  ;  E.  Russow,  ex -Professor  of  Botany  at 
Dorpat,  on  April  23,  aged  56  ;  Ch.  Scholz,  Professor  of  Geodesy  in  the  Polytechnicum 
at  Delft  ;  Traill  Green,  first  President  of  the  American  Academy  of  Medicine,  and 
author  of  the  "Floral  and  Zoological  Distribution  of  the  United  States"  ;  Dr  Derou- 
raix,  Professor  of  Medicine  at  Brussels  University  and  assistant  Court  Physician,  on 
May  22,  aged   84  ;  Antoine  T.   d'Abbadie,   formerly   President  of  the  Academy  of 
Sciences  at  Paris,  and  the  author  of  many  valuable  works  on  geographical  exploration 
and  geodesy;  Joseph  F.  James,   at  Hingham,   Mass.,  on  March  29  (of  pneumonia), 
teacher  of  botany  at  the  Cincinnati  College  of  Pharmacy,  Miami  University,  and  Mary- 
land   Agricultural   College,    and   formerly   connected  with  the  Division  of  Vegetable 
Physiology  and  the  U.S.  Geological  Survey  ;  Emily  L.  Gregory,  professor  of  botany  at 
Barnard  College,  U.S.A.  ;  Jakob  Breitenlohner,  professor  of  meteorology  and  clima- 
tology in  the  College  of  Agriculture,  Vienna  ;  Sinku  Sakaki,  professor  of  psychiatry  in 
the  University  of  Tokyo  ;  Peter  D.  Keyser,  formerly  professor  of  ophthalmology  at 
the  Medical  Chirurgical  College,  Philadelphia,  and  surgeon  to  the  Wills  Eye  Hospital  ; 
Ludwtg   Hollaender,  who  wrote  on  dental  anatomy  ;  Dr  Feulard,  a  well-known 
dermatologist,  in  the  fire  at  the  Paris  charity  bazaar ;  Luoien  Biart,  a  French  physician 
in  Mexico,  who  had  sent  thence  botanical  and  ornithological  collections  to  the  Paris 
Museum  ;  L.   Juranyi,  professor  of  botany  at  the  R.   University  of  Hungary,   and 
director   of  its    botanic  garden,    on  Feb.  27,   at   Abbazia,   aged   59  ;    Edson    Sewell 
Bastin,    professor   of  materia    medica   and   botany   at   the   Philadelphia    College   of 
Pharmacy,  and  author  of  an  "Elements  of  Botany,"  aged  54  ;  the  entomologist,   C.  J. 
J.  M.  Bugnion,  on  Jan.  19,  at  Lausanne,  aged  86  ;  the  coleopterologist,  J.  Hamilton, 
of  Alleghany  city,  on  Feb.  12,  in  Florida,   aged  69  ;  Wilhelm  Horn,  director  of  the 
forestry  research  station  in  Brunswick,  on  April  4,  aged  68  ;  Mrs  Alice  Bodington,  a 
well-known   and   accurate   populariser   of  science,    at   New   Westminster,    B.C.  ;    the 
coleopterologists,  H.  d'Achon  in  Orleans,  and  V.  Maurice  Teinturier  in  Clayeures, 
France  ;  at  the  beginning  of  April,  the  professor  of  geology  and  palaeontology  at  the 
Neufchatel  Academy,  Leon  du  Pasquier,  aged  33  ;  Victor  Lemoine,  of  Reims,  who 
investigated  the  vertebrate  fossils  of  the  Lower  Tertiary  deposits  near  that  city  ;  Edmund 
Neminar,  formerly  assistant  Professor  of  Mineralogy  and  Petrography  at  Innsbruck 
University,  on  April  10,  in  Vienna  ;  Karl  Kolbel,  curator  at  the  State  Natural  History 
Museum  in  Vienna,  and  specialist  in  Arachnida,  Myriopoda,  and  Crustacea  ;  on  Ponape, 
one  of  the  Caroline  Islands,  J.  S.   Kubary,  who  had  a  wide  acquaintance  with  the 
fauna  and  flora  of  the  South  Seas  ;  on  Feb.  7,  in  Lyons,  the  botanist,  Alexis  Jordan, 
author  of  "  Icones  ad  Floram  Europae,"  aged  83;   on  Feb.  17,  at  Ashton-on-Ribble, 
the  entomologist,  J.  B.  Hodgkinson,  aged  73  ;  Friedrich  Wilhelm  Klatt,  teacher 
of  botany  in  Hamburg,  on  March  3  ;  George  W.  Traill,  the  marine  algologist  ;   on 
Feb.  7,  in  Moscow,  the  curator  of  the  Zoological  Museum,  Alexander  N.  Kortschagin, 
carcinologist ;  on  Feb.  27,  at  Luebo  on  the  Kassai,  Congo  State,  the  Belgian  botanist, 
Alfred  Dewevre  ;  on  Feb.  28,  at  Grange-over-Sands,  the  Rev.  John  Edward  Cross, 
author  of  a  paper  on  the  geology  of  N.-W.  Lincolnshire,  aged  73  ;  on  March  18,  in 
Cassel,  the  ichthyologist,  Friedrich  Seelig,  aged  69  ;   Prof.  Hermann  Friedrich 
Kessler,    student  of  Aphides  in   Cassel  ;    Heinrich    Wankel,   anthropologist,   in 
Olmutz,  aged  76  ;  Emile  Magitot,  President  of  the  Societe  d'Authropologie  of  Paris, 
and  an  eminent  odontologist  ;  A.    Stocquart,    Professor  of  Vertebrate  Anatomy   at 
Brussels,  aged  40  ;  Leopold  Manen,  correspondent  of  the  Paris  Academy  of  Sciences 
in  the  section  of  Geography  and  Navigation,  in  May  last  ;  on  Jan.  23,  in  Baltimore, 
Md.,  Joseph  Ewing  Macfarland,  who  was  connected  with  the  U.S.  Geological  Survey, 
and  had  been  doing  field  work  in  Tennessee  y  Hugh  Nevill,  of  the  Ceylon  Civil  Ser- 
vice,  at   Hyeres,  on   April  10,  formerly   editor   and  publisher  of  the    Tabropanian, 
and  a  successful  collector  of  zoological  specimens,  as  well  as  of  Ceylonese  antiquities ; 
Madame  Jean  Dollfus,  who  for  many  years  conducted  La  Feuille  desjeunes  Naturalistes, 
founded  by  her  son,  E.  Dollfus. 

E  « 


66  |  July 


NEWS 

The  following  appointments  are  announced  : — 

W.  Garstang,  of  Lincoln  College,  Oxford,  to  be  Naturalist  to  the  Marine  Biological 
Association  of  the  United  Kingdom  ;  Dr  Charles  W.  Dabney,  jun.,  to  be  special  agent 
in  charge  of  Scientific  and  Statistical  Investigations  in  the  U.S.  Department  of  Agri- 
culture ;  Dr  J.  L.  Prevost,  to  be  full  Professor  of  Physiology  at  Geneva  ;  Dr  E.  Kauf- 
mann,  privat-docent  in  Anatomy  at  Breslau,  to  be  Professor  ;  Dr  Max  Wolters,  privat- 
docent  in  Anatomy  at  Bonn,  to  be  Professor  ;  A.  J.  Moses,  to  be  Professor  of  Mineralogy, 
and  H.  M.  Howe,  to  be  Professor  of  Metallurgy,  in  Columbia  University  ;  W.  H.  Lang, 
to  be  Lecturer,  and  Miss  D.  Clark,  to  be  Demonstrator  in  Botany,  and  Miss  M.  Maclean, 
to  be  Demonstrator  in  Anatomy,  at  Queen  Margaret  College,  Glasgow  ;  Dr  Fritz  Freeh,  to 
be  Professor  of  Geology  and  Paleontology,  at  Breslau  ;  Dr  Walter  Kruse,  to  be  Pro- 
fessor of  Hygiene,  at  Bonn  ;  D.  W.  Ule,  to  be  Professor  of  Geography,  at  Halle ; 
Dr  Raphael  Slidell,  Freiherr  von  Erlanger,  and  Dr  Paul  Samassa,  privat-docents  in 
Zoology,  at  Heidelberg,  to  be  Assistant-Professors  ;  Dr  J.  Thomayer,  to  be  Professor  of 
Pathology,  at  the  Bohemian  University,  Prague  ;  Dr  E.  B.  Copeland,  to  be  Assistant- 
Professor  of  Botany  in  the  University  of  Indiana,  as  successor  to  Dr  G.  J.  Peirce,  who 
becomes  Professor  of  Plant  Physiology  in  Leland  Stanford  Junior  University  ;  Dr  Ivan 
V.  Muschketoff,  to  be  full  Professor  of  Geology,  at  the  Mining  Institute,  St  Petersburg, 
in  place  of  A.  P.  Karpinski,  resigned  ;  Dr  A.  Stoss,  Prosector  at  the  Veterinary 
College,  Munich,  to  be  Assistant-Professor  in  place  of  Prof.  Johannes  Ruckert,  who 
goes  to  the  University  ;  at  the  Geologischer  Reichsanstalt,  Vienna,  A.  Bittner,  as 
Chief  Geologist,  G.  Geyer,  as  Assistant-Geologist,  G.  v.  Bukowski  and  A.  Rosiwal,  as 
Adjuncts  ;  Dr  Tschirwinski,  of  Moscow,  to  be  Professor  of  Pharmacology,  at  Dorpat. 

The  widow  of  Prof.  G.  vom  Rath  has  presented  his  library  to  the  University  of  Bonn. 

Mr  F.  D.  Godman  has  been  elected  president  of  the  British  Ornithologists'  Union. 

Mr  H.  H.  W.  Pearson  has  received  from  Cambridge  University  a  grant  of  £100  for 
botanical  research  in  Ceylon. 

The  National  Herbarium,  U.S.A.,  is  sending  an  expedition  under  Mr  E.  P.  Sheldon, 
late  of  Minnesota  University,  to  explore  the  Blue  Mountains,  Oregon. 

The  memorial  to  the  African  explorer,  Joseph  Thomson,  at  his  native  place, 
Thornhill  near  Dumfries,  was  unveiled  on  June  8,  by  Sir  Clements  Markham. 

The  Windward  has  taken  out  special  stores  for  Mr  Andree,  in  case  he  meets 
with  any  accident  and  should  be  obliged  to  seek  safety  on  Franz  Josef  Land. 

A  history  of  the  Berlin  Academy  of  Sciences  is  to  be  prepared  by  Prof.  Harnack, 
and  to  be  published  on  the  200th  anniversary  of  the  Academy's  foundation. 

The  city  of  New  York  is  raising  a  loan  of  500,000  dollars  for  the  erection  of  a 
further  wing  to  the  American  Museum  of  Natural  History. 

Through  the  influence  of  President  David  Starr  Jordan,  says  Science,  arrangements 
have  been  made  for  the  establishment  of  zoological  gardens  in  San  Francisco. 

Captain  Aiiney,  who  delivered  the  sixth  Robert  Boyle  Lecture  before  the  Oxford 
University  Junior  Scientific  Club  on  June  1,  took  for  his  subject  "The  scientific 
requirements  of  colour  photography." 

The  first  award  of  the  Tilanus  gold  medal,  to  be  decided  every  five  years  by  the 
University  of  Amsterdam,  has  been  made  to  Dr  Zwaardemaker  of  Utrecht,  for  his  work 
on  the  physiology  of  smell. 

We  much  regret  to  hear  that  there  is  talk  of  withdrawing  the  Government  subsidy 
to  the  fresh-water  biological  station  at  Plon,  where,  under  Dr  Otto  Zacharias,  so  much 
valuable  work  has  been  accomplished. 

The  Russian  Geographical  Society  and  Academy  of  Sciences  are  sending  an  expedi- 
tion to  study  the  geography  and  natural  history  of  the  khanates  of  Roshan,  Shignan, 
and  Darwaz. 


1897] 


NEWS  67 


M  11  K.  C.  L.  Perkins,  who  has  been  investigating  the  zoology  of  the  Sandwich 
Islands  for  a  committee  of  the  British  Association  and  Royal  Society  has  returned  to 
England. 


■&' 


The  following  numbers  of  students  at  the  Imperial  College  of  Science,  Tokyo,  were 
recently  given  by  Engineering : — Mathematics,  11;  Astronomy,  2;  Physics,  30; 
Chemistry,  15  ;  Zoology  and  Botany,  12  ;  Geology,  14.     In  all  there  are  89  students. 

Dr  Louis  Grehant,  Professor  of  Physiology  at  the  Musi'e  d'Histoire  Naturelle, 
Paris,  has  been  awarded  4000  francs  by  the  French  Government  to  assist  his  researches 
on  the  hygienic  applications  of  physiology. 

An  important  change  has  just  been  made  at  the  Spanish  universities  and  other 
educational  institutions  under  State  control.  Foreigners  are  now  allowed  to  study  there 
and  to  enter  for  the  examinations,  and  to  take  degrees  at  the  universities. 

The  Shute  Scholarship  in  Animal  Morphology,  recently  founded  at  Oxford  Univer- 
sity, has  an  annual  value  of  £50,  and  is  attached  to  no  college.  The  examination  takes 
place  this  July,  and  is  open  to  all  who  may  be  in  need  of  assistance  at  the  university, 
and  who  have  not  been  members  of  the  university  for  more  than  eight  terms. 

The  late  Prof.  Newberry,  having  left  funds  for  the  encouragement  of  scientific 
research,  it  has  been  decided  to  apply  the  grant  successively  to  geology  and  palaeon- 
tology, zoology,  and  botany.  A  sum  of  50,000  dollars  will  be  awarded  in  the  first 
subject,  on  July  15,  to  competitors  from  among  the  Scientific  Alliance  of  New  York 
City. 

Cambridge  University  has  made  a  grant  of  £300  to  Prof.  A.  C.  Haddon,  to 
enable  him  to  make  an  expedition  to  the  "Torres  Straits  to  continue  his  researches  on 
the  anthropology  of  that  region.  He  will  be  accompanied  by  other  anthropologists 
from  Cambridge,  and  by  an  expert  in  Melanesian  languages. 

The  International  Congress  of  Medicine  and  Surgery  meets  this  year  at  Moscow 
during  August.  Tli^  Russian  Government  has  not  only  contributed  some  £8000 
towards  the  expenses,  but  has  arranged  for  a  two  weeks'  excursion  to  the  Caucasus,  in 
the  course  of  which  the  mineral  springs  of  Kislovodsk  will  be  visited. 

A  laboratory  for  the  study  of  cavernicolous  animals  has  been  started  by  Mr 
Armand  Vire  in  some  subterranean  passages,  recently  rediscovered  beneath  the  Jardin 
des  Plantes  and  the  Boulevard  St  Marcel,  Paris.  Water  is  supplied  from  springs  by 
means  of  pipes. 

It  is  expected  that  the  Belgiea,  the  ship  of  the  Belgian  Antarctic  Expedition, 
will  arrive  at  Antwerp  early  in  July,  and  that  the  expedition  will  start  in  August. 
The  expedition  will  stay  from  October  to  March  on  the  eastern  shore  of  Graham's 
Land.  The  following  year,  after  re-coaling  and  provisioning  at  Melbourne,  it  will  visit 
Victoria  Land. 

A  survey  of  the  Pribyloff  islands  is  now  being  carried  out  by  the  U.S.  Coast  and 
Geodetic  Survey. 

The  Danes  are  charting  the  northern  part  of  the  east  coast  of  Greenland,  with  the 
help  of  some  £1000  contributed  from  the  Carlsberg  Fund. 

The  Rev.  Prof.  Thomas  Wiltshire,  of  Trinity  College,  Cambridge,  for  many  years 
treasurer  of  the  Geological  Society  of  London,  has  presented  his  library  of  scientific 
works  to  the  Woodwardian  Museum,  Cambridge.  The  donation  comprises  about  600 
volumes  and  900  pamphlets. 

The  Belgian  Government  has  convened  a  second  International  Bibliographic  Confer- 
ence at  Brussels,  on  August  2-4.  Those  who  do  not  already  subscribe  to  the  Institut 
International  de  Bibliographic  may  become  members  for  a  subscription  of  20  francs,  on 
application  to  the  Institut,  1  Place  du  Musee,  Bruxelles.  Among  other  subjects  for 
discussion  is  the  state  of  bibliography  of  the  different  sciences. 

The  Geological  Department  of  the  British  Museum  (Natural  History)  has  just 
obtained  an  interesting  series  of  teeth  and  jaws  of  the  dwarf  elephant  discovered  a  few- 
years  ago  by  Dr  Hans  Pohlig  in  the  cavern  of  Carini,  near  Palermo,  Sicily.  The  species 
seems  to  be  Elephas  mnaidriensis,  the  largest  form  met  with  in  the  bone-caves  of  Malta. 
It  may  be  merely  a  dwarfed  race  of  the  existing  African  elephant,  which  was  stranded 
and  gradually  became  extinct  on  the  islands  of  Malta  and  Sicily  when  the  land  barrier, 
which  once  existed  in  that  region  between  Africa  and  Europe,  became  destroyed. 

A  statement  has  lately  appeared  in  many  scientific  journals  that  there  exists  on 
the   Pamirs  a  dwarf   tribe,   with   dwarf  domestic   animals.      This   appears   to   have 


68  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [July 

originated  from  a  journalist  of  St  Petersburg.  Lieut.  Olofsen  explains  that  the  refer- 
ence must  simply  have  been  to  the  Wakhanis,  who  are  of  true  Aryan  type  and  by  no 
means  dwarfs,  although,  owing  to  their  mixture  with  Mongolians,  they  are  not  tall. 
Their  domestic  animals  are  half-starved  but  not  dwarfed.  Neither  do  the  Wakhanis 
worship  fire,  as  has  been  reported. 

Lieut.  Peary,  having  obtained  five  years'  leave  of  absence,  will  start  about  July  10 
for  Whale  Sound  on  the  N.-W.  coast  of  Greenland,  leaving  scientific  parties  on  the 
coast  of  Labrador,  Baffin  Land,  and  Greenland.  In  July  of  next  year,  Lieut.  Peary, 
accompanied  by  a  surgeon  and  six  families  of  Esquimaux,  will  push  up  the  coast  from 
Whale  Sound  to  Osborne  Fjord  (81°N. ),  where  he  will  establish  a  base  of  supplies  in  charge 
of  some  of  the  Esquimaux.  About  March  of  1899  he  will  start  for  the  north  limit  of 
Greenland,  wherever  that  may  be,  and  for  the  Pole. 

The  Botanical  Society  of  America  will  meet  in  Toronto,  on  August  17  and  18, 
immediately  before  the  meeting  of  the  British  Association,  under  the  presidency  of 
Prof.  J.  M.  Coulter.  Dr  C.  E.  Bessey,  retiring  president,  will  deliver  his  address  on 
Tuesday  at  8  p.m.  All  foreign  botanists,  of  whom  many  are  likely  to  be  in  Toronto, 
are  invited  to  be  associates  of  the  society  and  to  read  papers. 

The  following  bequests  of  the  late  E.  D.  Cope  are  mentioned  by  Science  :  His  scien- 
tific books,  osteological  collection,  and  collection  of  fresh-water  molluscs,  to  the  School 
of  Biology  of  the  University  of  Pennsylvania  ;  his  collection  of  minerals  to  the  univer- 
sity ;  duplicates  of  fresh-water  mollusca  to  the  Cincinnati  Society  of  Natural  History 
and  the  American  Museum  of  Natural  History  ;  spirit-specimens  and  skins  to  the  Phila- 
delphia Academy  of  Natural  Sciences.  The  palaeontological  collections  are  to  be  sold 
in  three  lots,  viz.  (1)  the  North  American,  (2)  the  South  American,  from  the  Pampean 
formation  and  West  Indies  and  Mexico,  (3)  European  collections,  chiefly  from  the 
Neogene  of  Allier,  France.  After  the  payment  of  private  bequests,  the  money  arising 
from  this  is  to  found  a  professorship  or  curatorship  in  vertebrate  palaeontology  at  the 
Philadelphia  Academy  of  Natural  Sciences. 

Ax  important  and  urgent  work  is  the  collection  of  anthropological  data  from  races 
that  are  disappearing  or  losing  their  old  customs.  For  this  purpose  Mr  Morris  K. 
Jessup,  president  of  the  American  Museum  of  Natural  History,  is  fitting  out  an  expedi- 
tion under  the  leadership  of  Prof.  F.  W.  Putnam,  assisted  by  Dr  Franz  Boas.  They 
will  proceed  up  the  north-west  coast  of  North  America,  cross  Behring  Strait,  and  so  pass 
down  through  eastern  Siberia  into  China,  and  thence  along  the  Indian  Ocean  to  Egypt. 
The  expedition  will  be  away  six  years,  and  is  expected  to  cost  over  60,000  dollars.  The 
pecial  problem  to  be  studied  is  the  relation  of  the  American  races  to  those  of  Asia  and 
Africa. 

Henry  G.  Bryant,  of  Philadelphia,  accompanied  by  S.  J.  Entrikin  and  E.  B. 
Latham,  has  started  for  Alaska  for  the  purpose  of  climbing  Mount  St  Elias  and  making 
explorations  in  the  adjacent  region.  Mr  Bryant,  says  Science,  has  had  experience  of 
exploration  in  Labrador,  and  has  made  summer  trips  to  Greenland.  Mr  Entrikin  was 
with  Peary  in  Greenland  and  made  an  expedition  over  the  inland  ice.  Mr  Latham  is  a 
member  of  the  U.S.  Coast  Survey,  and  goes  equipped  for  geographical  work.  The 
party,  having  established  a  base  camp  on  the  west  shore  of  Yakatat  Bay  early  in  June, 
will  cross  the  Malaspina  glacier  to  the  Samovar  Hills  ;  from  there  ascend  the  Agassiz 
glacier,  and  thence  up  the  Newton  glacier  to  the  divide  between  Mount  Newton  and  Mount 
St  Elias.  A  camp  will  be  established  on  the  divide,  elevation  about  13,000  feet,  from 
which  the  ascent  to  the  summit  of  Mount  St  Elias  will  be  made.  Oh  returning  to  the 
Samovar  Hills  the  explorations  will  be  continued  westward  through  an  entirely  un- 
known region  until  a  pass  is  discovered  which  will  enable  the  explorers  to  cross  the 
St  Elias  Mountains  and  gain  one  of  the  branches  of  Copper  River.  The  return  to  the 
coast  will  be  by  way  of  Copper  River.  The  party  is  well  equipped,  and  has  every 
prospect  of  success. 

A  photograph  of  the  new  South  African  Museum  at  Cape  Town,  which,  as  we  have 
stated,  was  recently  opened,  is  given  in  Nature  for  May  13.  The  building  is  at  the 
upper  end  of  the  Municipal  Gardens,  and  consists  of  two  floors,  the  upper  of  which  con- 
tains the  principal  exhibition  rooms.  A  room  63  by  41  i  feet  contains  the  birds,  reptiles, 
and  fishes  of  S.  Africa,  recent  and  fossil,  while  a  room  of  equal  size  holds  the  general 
collection  of  vertebrates.  The  S.  African  mammals  are  in  a  smaller  room,  and  another 
contains  the  anthropological  collections  both  S.  African  and  general.  On  the  ground 
floor  are  four  exhibition  rooms,  the  two  larger  containing  the  invertebrates  and  the 
general  geological  collection ;  the  two  smaller,  the  collection  illustrating  S.  African 
geology  and  mining  and  the  local  antiquities.  Other  rooms  on  this  floor  contain  the 
library,  study  collections,  and  offices.  The  taxidermist's  shop  and  store-room  aro  in  a 
separate  building.  All  the  cases  are  made  of  glass  and  iron  (see  Dr  Meyer's  letter  in 
Natural  Science,  vol.  ix.,  p.  142,  Aug.  1896). 


18971  NEWS  69 

The  Auckland  Institute  has  decided  to  add  a  new  hall,  50  feet  square,  to  its  museum, 
on  the  east  side  of  the  ethnographical  hall.  It  is  intended  to  receive  the  statuary 
presented  by  Mr  T.  Russell,  C.M.G.,  which  has  hitherto  found  an  incongruous  home 
among  stuffed  vertebrates.  The  space  thus  gained  will  be  occupied  by  groups  of  the 
larger  mammals,  and  £100  offered  by  Mr  Russell  will  be  used  to  procure  a  group  of  the 
larger  carnivores. 

Little  Barrier  Island,  on  which  an  attempt  is  being  made  to  preserve  the  indigenous 
fauna  and  flora  of  New  Zealand,  has  been  placed  under  the  control  of  the  Institute,  witb 
a  grant  of  £200  for  the  first  year's  expenses.  Mr  R.  H.  Shakespear  has  been  appointed 
curator,  and  it  is  hoped  that  he  may  be  able  to  stop  the  depredations  of  collectors. 

Mi;  H.  C.  Chadwick  has  been  helping  Mr  J.  J.  Ogle  at  the  Bootle  Museum,  and 
has  rearranged  much  of  the  zoological  series  with  elucidatory  diagrams.  Many  new 
exhibition  eases  have  been  acquired,  and  in  one  of  these  the  birds  are  to  be  rearranged, 
after  consultation  with  a  specialist.  The  museum  lends  specimens  to  teachers  for  the 
illustration  of  object-lessons,  and  the  curator  himself  gives  lectures,  illustrated  by  the 
lantern,  which  appear  to  be  much  appreciated  by  young  people. 

According  to  the  Halifax  Naturalist,  the  Natural  History  Museum  of  Halifax, 
which  was  handed  over  to  the  County  Borough  Council  about  eighteen  months  ago  by 
the  Literary  and  Philosophical  Society,  has  now  found  a  permanent  home  in  the  old 
mansion  named  Belle  Vue.  The  geological  and  botanical  collections  are  very  extensive 
and  valuable,  but  zoology  is  as  yet  very  imperfectly  represented.  The  herbarium  has 
lately  been  much  enriched  by  the  fine  Gibson  collection  of  British  plants,  the  gift  of 
Lady  Trevelyan.  The  Curator,  Mr  Arthur  Crabtree,  is  making  a  praiseworthy  attempt 
to  render  the  Museum  of  general  educational  value  by  adequate  labelling,  and  we 
sympathise  with  him  in  his  aspirations  for  a  competent  committee  of  management  to 
direct  and  second  his  efforts.  As  he  remarks,  the  ordinary  municipal  committees  may 
be  very  admirable  bodies,  but  they  are  not  able  to  comprehend  the  requirements  of  a 
Museum  of  Natural  History.  He  needs  a  committee  of  naturalists,  of  which  there  is  no 
lack  in  Halifax,  and  his  proposals  deserve  to  be  carried  out  immediately. 

We  learn  from  V 'Anthropologic  that  the  Museum  of  Moscow  University  has  recently 
received  from  the  Commission  of  the  Archives  of  Riazan  a  collection  of  skulls,  mostly 
prehistoric,  of  which  the  locality  and  conditions  of  finding  are  known  in  each  case. 

The  same  journal  informs  us  that,  near  Elissavetpol,  in  the  Caucasus,  there  have 
recently  been  found  by  seekers  after  copper,  at  a  depth  of  3  metres,  a  massive  bronze 
bracelet  and  a  copper  spear-head  of  quadrangular  shape  and  35  cm.  in  length.  In  the 
same  locality,  on  the  banks  of  the  Tchovdar,  are  traces  of  prehistoric  mining. 

Some  three  thousand  prehistoric  objects  in  bronze,  iron,  bone,  and  pottery,  have 
been  found  on  the  site  of  ancient  places  of  sacrifice  of  the  Tchoudes  at  Gliadenevo,  on 
the  left  bank  of  the  Kama,  near  Perm. 

At  Chita  in  Trans-Baikal,  the  local  branch  of  the  Russian  Geographical  Society  has 
founded  a  museum,  which  already  contains  valuable  natural  history,  archaeological,  and 
Buddhistic  collections. 

On  September  15,  1896,  the  National  Museum  of  Costa  Rica  was  definitely  installed 
in  its  new  quarters,  a  two-storeyed  building.  A  view  of  it  is  given  in  La  Re\nsta  Nucva 
for  October  1896. 

Referring  to  this  museum  in  his  always  valuable  "  Current  Notes  on  Anthropology  " 
(Science,  March  19),  Prof.  D.  G.  Brinton  says  that  few  localities  in  America  offer  better 
specimens  of  aboriginal  pottery  and  stone-work.  The  most  abundant  remains  were  left 
by  the  Guetares,  a  tribe  of  whose  language  and  affinities  we  are  still  ignorant. 

Plenty  of  attempt  has  been  made  to  introduce  some  study  of  common  objects  or  of 
nature  into  our  elementary  schools  ;  but  the  obstacle  generally  lies  in  the  teachers.  A 
similar  difficulty  is  felt  in  America,  and  to  meet  it  the  college  of  agriculture  of  Cornell 
University  has  undertaken  to  help,  free  of  expense,  all  teachers  who  may  wish  to  be  put 
in  the  right  way. 

The  same  subject  has  been  fully  studied  by  a  committee  of  sixty,  appointed  in  May 
1896,  by  the  Chicago  Institute  of  Education,  and  this  committee  has  appointed  sub- 
committees to  prepare  maps  of  the  neighbourhood,  to  prepare  printed  outlines  and 
suggestions  for  teachers,  to  look  after  appropriate  books  in  the  Chicago  libraries,  to 
supervise  the  work  of  instruction  and  keep  touch  with  the  individual  teachers,  and  also 
to  establish  an  exhibit  of  appliances,  to  arrange  cheap  means  of  transport,  and  to  see  to 
finance. 

Those  who  are  advocating  the  extension  of  the  study  of  experimental  psychology  in 
this  country  will  be  glad  to  hear  that  it  is  'proposed  to  establish  a  lectureship  in  that 
subject,  including  the  physiology  of  the  senses,  at  Cambridge  University.  They  will 
not  be  so  glad  to  hear  that  the  salary  is  fixed  at  £50  per  annum.  Lecturing  in  an 
experimental  science  is  not  much  use  ;  one  wants  experiments,  and  for  those  one  wants 
apparatus  and  a  laboratory. 


70  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [July 

The  books  bearing  on  lichens  and  the  dried  specimens  belonging  to  the  late  Dr  J. 
Midler,  generally  known  as  Miiller-Argau,  became  at  his  death  the  property  of  the 
Boissier  Herbarium,  at  Chambesy  near  Geneva.  Following  the  example  of  the  trustees 
of  another  important  lichenological  library,  the  "  Tuckerman  Memorial  Library"  at 
Amherst  College,  Massachusetts,  the  directors  of  the  Boissier  herbarium  have  instituted 
the  "  Foundation  Midler- Argau,"  and  the  curator,  M.  Eugene  Autran,  now  appeals  to 
botanists  generally  for  copies  of  publications  bearing  on  lichens  which  have  appeared 
since  Midler's  death,  or  may  hereafter  appear.  Also  that  specimens  of  new  or  rare 
species,  or  "  materials  for  morphological  and  biological  research  "  may  be  deposited  in 
the  Lichenotheca  Universalis  Midler- Argau,  in  which  is  included  the  herbarium  of  the 
Bernese  F.  Schaerer  (1785-1853).  Gifts  will  be  acknowledged  in  the  Bulletin  of  the 
Boissier  herbarium. 

In  connection  with  the  Autumn  Meeting  of  the  Iron  and  Steel  Institute  at  Cardiff,  on 
August  3rd  to  6th,  Professor  Herman  Wedding  of  the  Berlin  School  of  Mines  has  issued 
a  circular  letter  asking  for  subscriptions  towards  establishing  a  Central  Laboratory  for 
the  Testing  of  Iron  and  Steel.  Such  a  Laboratory  would  be  founded  at  Zurich  under 
the  auspices  of  the  International  Society  for  the  Unification  of  the  Methods  of  Testing 
Materials  of  Construction,  which  was  formed  in  1895,  and  the  proceedings  at  which  were 
reported  in  the  Journal  of  the  Iron  ami  Steel  Institute  for  1895.  The  Secretary  of  the 
Institute,  Bennet  H.  Brough,  has  consented  to  receive  the  names  of  those  who  are 
interested. 

The  Radcliffe  Library  at  Oxford  is  known  to  scientific  men  for  its  wealth  in 
their  peculiar  literature,  and  to  librarians  for  the  excellence  of  its  arrangements.  Such 
libraries  grow  rapidly  nowadays.  Want  of  room  long  felt  has  urged  the  Drapers'  Com- 
pany to  offer  to  erect  a  new  building,  from  plans  by  Mr  T.  G.  Jackson,  at  a  cost  of 
£15,000.  The  offer  has  been  gratefully  accepted  by  the  University,  which  proposes  to 
transfer  the  space  thus  gained  in  the  museum  to  the  medical  school,  and  especially  to 
start  a  library  of  pathology. 

The  new  museum  at  Winchester  College,  built  as  a  memorial  of  the  quingentenary  of 
the  school's  foundation,  was  formally  opened  on  June  16,  1897.  There  was  an  interest- 
ing exhibit  of  Wykehamical  antiquities,  and  the  art  department  made  a  fine  show,  but 
the  arrangement  of  the  natural  history  collections  has  hardly  begun.  When  these  last 
are  more  advanced,  we  shall  hope  to  give  a  detailed  account  of  the  building  and  its 
contents  in  our  series  :  Museums  of  Public  Schools. 

The  first  annual  meeting  of  the  South-Eastern  Union  of  Scientific  Societies  was  held 
at  Tunbridge  Wells  at  the  end  of  May.  The  Rev.  T.  R.  R.  Stebbing  presided,  and 
delivered  the  inaugural  address.  He  dealt  with  the  changes  in  the  attitude  of  the 
public  mind  towards  scientific  research  within  modern  times.  Mr  W.  Cole  contributed 
the  first  paper  on  the  objects  and  methods  of  local  museums,  referring  especially  to  the 
new  Epping  Forest  museum.  Prof.  Boulger  next  discussed  the  duties  of  the  com- 
mittees of  Field  Clubs.  Prof.  Seeley  described  a  geological  section  in  the  New 
Athletic  Ground  at  Tunbridge  Wells,  showing  current-bedding  in  clay.  ' '  The  Search 
for  Coal  in  the  South-East  of  England,"  the  subject  of  a  paper  by  Mr  H.  E.  Turner,  led 
to  a  long  and  interesting  discussion.  The  Mayor  of  Tunbridge  Wells  extended  his 
hospitality  to  the  assembled  delegates,  and  an  interesting  geological  excursion  ter- 
minated the  proceedings. 


1897]  "71 


CORRESPONDENCE 

OCEANIC  ICHTHYOLOGY 

The  reviewer  of  Goode  and  Bean's  "Oceanic  Ichthyology"  (Natural  Science,  vol.  x., 
pp.  338-340)  has  made  a  gratuitous  assumption,  which  devolves  on  me  unmerited  credit 
and  responsibility. 

The  reviewer  says  "it  is  to  be  noted  that  the  literary  part  of  the  work  bears  signs 
of  having  been  intrusted  to  a  third  author  not  under  proper  control  of  the  two 
responsible  authors."  The  "third  author"  is  evidently  myself.  I  feel  compelled  to 
deny  either  credit  or  responsibility  for  all  that  is  not  specifically  accredited  to  me.  Dr 
Goode  devoted  much  time  and  thought  to  the  keys,  and  I  had  nothing  to  do  with  the 
original  compilation. 

The  specific  information  that  certain  fishes  have  and  others  have  not  a  mesocora- 
coid,  so  far  as  the  italicised  portions  credited  to  me  are  concerned,  I  am  responsible  for, 
but  not  entirely  for  their  application. 

The  critic  remarks,  "as  a  matter  of  fact,  the  vast  majority  of  the  fishes  placed 
here  have  not  been  examined  with  reference  to  this  point. "  True  ;  but  enough  have 
been  examined  to  authorise  the  deduction  formulated.  The  same  argument  might  be 
adduced  against  other  generalisations.   .   .   . 

As  to  the  definition  of  Pterothrissidae,  it  will  be  evident  from  the  context  that  the 
mistake  is  due  to  unintentional  repetition  instead  of  the  requisite  antithesis.  The 
family  Alepocephalidae  is  defined  as  having  the  "dorsal  fin  similar  and  opposite  anal," 
and  the  Pterothrissidae  should  have  been  contrasted  as  having  the  dorsal  fin  unlike, 
and  longer  than  anal.  Undoubtedly  carelessness  and  oversight  are  manifest,  and  I  am 
willing  to  assume  that  I  glanced  over  the  proof  and  therefore  to  share  the  blame,  but  I 
had  nothing  to  do  with  the  original  manuscript.  Drs  Goode  and  Bean,  as  well  as  my- 
self, had  much  on  hand,  and  doubtless  the  proof  sheets  were  often  read  in  a  perfunctory 
manner.     But  in  this  respect,  we  have  good  company.  .  .  . 

Such  mistakes  unfortunately  are  too  common  and  are  generally  designated  as 
"  slips  of  the  pen  "  or  "  lapsus  calami."  I  do  not  defend  them,  but  it  does  not  become 
the  guilty  to  animadvert  on  them  too  strongly.  .  .  . 

What  are  or  what  are  not  family  characters,  is  a  question  about  which  Dr  Giinther 
and  I  have  long  differed,  and  I  wish  neither  to  defend  my  view  nor  to  attack  those  of 
others  on  this  occasion.  All  the  many  American  naturalists,  at  least,  agree  with  me  on 
such  points.  Other  strictures  I  leave  to  the  surviving  of  the  authors,  if  he  should  deem 
them  worthy  of  attention. 

Some  notice  of  the  remarkable  novelties  obtained  since  the  publication  of  the 
results  of  the  Challenger  Expedition  might  have  been  given  by  the  reviewer,  but  I 
shall  not  trespass  further  on  your  space  to  do  so.  Theo.  Gill. 

[We  regret  that  Dr  Gill  should  assume  our  review  of  Goode  and  Bean's  ' '  Oceanic 
Ichthyology  "  to  have  been  written  or  inspired  by  Dr  Giinther,  who  had  no  share  what- 
ever in  its  preparation.  Like  many  unsigned  reviews  in  Natural  Science,  it  was  the 
work  of  more  than  one  author,  and  expressed  the  views  of  the  editorial  management  of 
this  journal,  not  those  of  any  one  individual.  We  have  therefore  omitted  from  Dr 
Gill's  lettter  some  remarks  on  Dr  Giinther 's  works.— Ed.  Nat.  Sci.] 


Slugs 


I  have  recently  received  from  an  American  malacologist  a  communication,  in  which 
he  says  that  in  a  paper,*  written  in  conjunction  with  Lieut. -Col.  H.  H.  Godwin-Austen, 
I  have  "wrongly  applied  the  term  slug  by  using  it  for  such  genera  as  Parmarion, 
Microparmarion,  &c." 

It  is  very  largely  a  question  of  individual  opinion  as  to  what  genera  should  be 
included  under  this  term,  but  I  fail  to  see  any  reason  why  Parmarion  and  its  allies 
should  not  be  termed  slugs. 

The  slugs  are  not  a  group  by  themselves  which  can  be  separated  into  distinct 
families  apart  from  the  rest  of  the  Pulmonata.  On  the  other  hand,  very  many  genera 
are  closely  related  to  genera  in  which  there  is  a  conspicuous  shell.  In  the  above- 
mentioned  paper  the  same  opinion  was  expressed  as  follows  :— "  We  think  that  future 

*   Proc.  Zool.  Sec,  1895,  p.  249. 


72  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [July 

research  will  clearly  show  that  many  of  the  slugs  cannot  rightly  be  placed  in  families 
by  themselves,  but  will  find  their  true  position  before  or  after  the  genera  they  have 
descended  from  or  developed  into." 

I  would,  therefore,  include  amongst  the  slugs  all  forms  of  Pulmonate  molluscs  in 
which  the  shell  is  absent,  or  where,  when  present,  it  is  incapable  of  containing  the 
whole  of  the  animal. — Walter  E.  Collinge. 


BUFFALO  v.  BISON 

Mr  G.  H.  Carpenter  doubtless  does  well  to  be  shocked  ;  but  the  Scientific  American 
you  failed  to  correct  has  a  fellow-sinner  in  another  American,  whose  claim  to  the  title 
scientific  not  even  Mr  Carpenter  would  deride.  Dr  C.  Hart  Merriam,  in  Science  for 
May  14  last,  writes  :  "  The  familiar  story  of  the  vanishing  buffalo  is  only  one  of  many." 
It  is  to  be  feared  that  the  influence  of  Fennimore  Cooper  is  still  strong  even  with  the 
purest  of  the  pure  scientific  writers. — Buffalo  Bill. 


We  have  received  an  interesting  note  from  Professor  A.  S.  Packard,  in  which  he 
refers  to  our  recent  articles  on  the  Arthropoda.  In  his  well-known  memoir  on  the  brain 
of  Limulus  (Mem.  Nat.  Acad.  Sciences,  vol.  vi.,  1893)  he  has  already  pointed  out  that 
there  are  four  lines  of  descent  among  these  animals.  Hence  he  considers  the  group  to 
be  polyphyletic.  He  now  writes  : — "I  do  not  believe  the  Crustacea  and  Trilobites  had 
a  common  ancestry.     I  think  they  evolved  from  separate  vermian  ancestors." 


Our  remarks  on  the  so-called  shooting  of  the  golden  eagle  in  Yorkshire  have  also 
brought  us  communications  from  Mr  Ernest  Bell  and  Mr  G.  W.  Murdoch.  The 
former  urges  the  necessity  of  more  stringent  laws  for  the  preservation  of  the  rare  British 
birds  ;  the  latter  takes  a  more  hopeful  view  of  the  case.  It  appears  that  Mr  F.  Boyes. 
of  Beverley,  a  thoroughly  competent  ornithologist,  has  personally  investigated  the 
incident  referred  to  in  Mr  Joseph  Collinson's  letter  last  May  {Nat.  Science,  vol.  x.,  p. 
303),  and  finds  that  the  bird  in  question  was  not  an  eagle  of  any  kind,  but  a  young 
rough-legged  buzzard.  Mr  Murdoch  adds  : — "  I  can  bear  out  Mr  Southwell's  statement 
(Nat.  Science,  vol.  x.,  p.  432)  that  the  golden  eagle  is  in  no  danger  of  extermination  in 
this  country." 

NOTICE 

To  Contributors. — All  Communications  to  be  addressed  to  the  Editor  of  Natural 
Science,  at  67  St  James'  Street,  London,  S.W.  Correspondence  and  Notes  intended 
for  any  particular  month  should  be  sent  in  not  later  than  the  10th  of  the  preceding 
month. 

To  the  Trade. — Natural  Science  is  published  on  the  25th  of  each  month  ;  all 
advertisements  should  be  in  the  Publishers'  hands  not  later  than  the  20th. 

To  our  Subscribers  and  Others. — There  are  now  published  Ten  Volumes  of 
Natural  Science.  Nos.  1,  8,  11,  12,  13,  20,  23,  24  being  out  of  print,  can  only  be 
supplied  in  the  set  of  first  Four  Volumes.  All  other  Nos.  can  still  be  supplied  at  One 
Shilling  each. 

Price  of  Set  of  Vols.  I.,  II.,  III.,  IV £2  10     0 

„      V.,  VI.,  VII.,  VIII 14     0 

„      I.-VIII 3  10     0 

One  Shilling  each  Number  of  any  Bookseller. 

Annual  Subscription,  payable  in  advance  to  J.  M.  Dent  &  Co.,  67  St  James's  Street, 
London,  S.W.,  Thirteen  Shillings  ($3*50),  post  free. 


NATURAL  SCIENCE 

A  Monthly  Review  of  Scientific  Progress 


No.  66— Vol.  XI— AUGUST   1897 


NOTES  AND  COMMENTS 

Co-operation  among  Naturalists 

We  had  barely  space  in  our  last  number  to  chronicle  the  second 
annual  congress  of  the  South-Eastern  Union  of  Scientific  Societies. 
We  have  now  received  The  Transactions  of  the  Union  for  1897, 
price  one  shilling.  The  Union  already  includes  twenty-seven 
affiliated  societies,  and  in  carrying  out  its  motto,  "  Co-operation  not 
uniformity,"  is  doing  a  really  useful  work.  The  papers  and  dis- 
cussions at  the  congress  were  for  the  most  part  thoroughly  practical. 
It  is  recognised,  as  we  have  so  often  pointed  out,  that  there  is  a 
vast  amount  of  labour  wasted  every  year  by  enthusiastic  naturalists, 
whose  misfortune  it  is  to  have  no  friendly  and  enlightened  guidance. 
The  aim  of  such  bodies  as  this  Union  is  to  co-ordinate  scattered  and 
wasted  effort,  and  to  direct  it  into  profitable  yet  no  less  fascinating- 
paths.  Thus  it  is  suggested  that  the  Union  shall  form  research 
committees  to  deal  with  special  branches  of  scientific  observation. 
These  committees  would  be  similar  to  those  of  the  British  Associa- 
tion, but  they  would  confine  themselves  to  local  natural  history. 
Like  the  Midland  Union  or  the  New  Zealand  Institute,  such  an 
union  may  become  the  publisher  for  all  its  affiliated  societies,  and 
thus  exercise  a  much-needed  editorial  discretion.  It  can  also 
organise  lectures  and  lecture-apparatus,  making  a  collection  of 
lantern-slides  to  be  borrowed  from  by  any  society  ;  this  is  already 
being  done  by  the  S.E.  Union.  Again,  there  are  many  legal  questions 
affecting  naturalists  and  local  societies,  and  these  can  best  be  dealt 
with  by  a  strong  corporate  body.  The  present  congress  discussed 
one  such  question,  namely,  "  How  can  the  Technical  Education 
Grant  assist  local  societies  ? "  It  appears  that  it  is  out  of  the 
question  to  ask  for  direct  pecuniary  assistance  ;  but  there  seems 
no  reason  in  justice  or  equity  why  local  societies,  engaged  as  they 
are  in  the  education  of  the  public,  should  not  be  allowed  the  use 
of  a  room  in  buildings  erected  with  public  money  for  purposes  of 

F 


74                                  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

technical  education,  and  we  trust  that  on  this  matter  the  Union 

may    be    able    to    enter    into    cordial    relations  with    the    County 
Councils. 


Government  and  Provincial  Museums 

The  meeting  of  the  Museums  Association,  held  this  year  at  Oxford, 
July  G-9,  was  not  largely  attended,  and  did  not  produce  a  plentiful 
crop  of  papers.  Even  those  that  were  submitted  were  not  all  read, 
owing  to  the  necessity  this  Association  always  feels  itself  under  of 
curtailing  within  narrow  limits  the  time  devoted  to  their  readin<>- 
and  discussion. 

The  chief  discussion  took  place  on  Prof.  Flinders  Petrie's  sug- 
gestion of  a  federal  staff  for  museums ;  by  which  he  means  that 
small  curators  should  be  abolished,  their  place  being  supplied  by 
caretakers,  and  their  work  being  done  by  peripatetic  specialists. 
The  proposal  was  thought  impracticable  ;  but  there  is  no  doubt  that 
more  might  be  done  to  encourage  co-operation.  There  are  two 
schemes  that  suggest  themselves  as  the  kind  of  ideals  towards  which 
we  might  strive.  One  is  that  each  curator  of  a  small  provincial 
museum  should  endeavour  to  become  thoroughly  competent  in  some 
one  branch  of  his  work,  and  that  for  two  or  three  months  in  each 
year  he  should  change  places  with  his  fellow-curator  from  another 
museum — equally  competent,  but  in  another  subject.  Thus  the 
museum,  while  paying  one  curator,  would  as  years  passed  obtain  the 
experience  of  a  dozen.  The  alternative  plan  that  occurs  to  us  is 
that  the  staffs  of  the  notoriously  under-manned  government  museums 
should  be  increased,  and  that  it  should  be  part  of  the  official  duty  of 
each  specialist-curator  to  work  for  two  or  three  months  of  each  year 
at  provincial  museums.  Government  would,  of  course,  have  to  levy 
some  tribute  from  the  provincial  centres,  to  be  applied  to  the  salaries 
of  the  government  officials;  but  apart  from  this  there  would  be  a 
gain  to  the  specialist,  to  the  head  museum,  and  to  the  country,  by 
the  co-ordination,  investigation,  and  effective  utilisation  of  all  our 
obscured  scientific  and  artistic  material,  as  well  as  by  the  increased 
sympathies,  knowledge,  and  experience  of  the  specialist. 

At  present  government  officials  seem  to  hold  somewhat  aloof 
from  the  provincial  museums,  and  from  the  Museums  Association. 
Whether  it  be  that  the  hard-worked  civil  servant  can  ill  spare  days 
from  his  holiday  merely  to  talk  shop,  whether  he  thinks  he  will 
learn  nothing  from  these  meetings,  or  whether  he  really  takes  no 
interest  in  his  life-work  beyond  the  drawing  of  his  salary,  we  do  not 
know.  At  any  rate  the  Museums  Association  recognises  that  it,  for 
its  part,  has  much  to  learn  from  the  keepers  and  assistants  in  our 
larger  museums,  and   it  wishes   that  government  officials  could  be 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  75 

given  facilities  for  attending  the  yearly  meeting  not  less  than  those 
accorded  to  nearly  all  provincial  curators  by  the  much-abused  town 
and  county  councils. 

The  Protection  of  our  Fauna  and  Flora 

We  have  heard  a  good  deal  lately,  both  from  naturalists  and  those 
whom  the  world  in  its  rude  way  calls  faddists,  about  the  exter- 
mination of  many  of  our  native  plants  and  animals.  There  is, 
unfortunately,  little  room  for  doubt  that,  however  ill-advised  may 
be  the  action  of  certain  enthusiasts,  their  fears  are  on  the  whole 
well  founded.  "  Naturam  expellas  furca,  tamen  usque  recurrit,"  is 
only  true  up  to  a  point :  and  when  '  furca '  has  to  be  translated 
'  bricklayer's  trowel,'  that  point  has  been  passed.  Those  who  wish 
to  preserve  at  least  a  sample  of  what  was  once  English  country 
should  read  the  level-headed  paper  sent  by  the  Kev.  J.  J.  Scargill 
of  Bromley  to  the  Congress  of  the  South-Eastern  Union.  Here 
is  a  suggestion  of  his:  "There  are,  perhaps,  a  dozen  animals, 
furred  or  feathered,  that  are  habitually  killed  by  keepers.  Let  a 
man  devote  himself  to  investigating  the  habits  (of  course,  in  its 
wild  state)  of  one  of  these — hawk,  owl  or  magpie,  stoat  or  weasel 
— noting  all  that  it  feeds  on,  and  recording  his  observations  day  by 
day.  In  a  few  years,  and  with  a  sufficient  number  of  observers,  a 
fair  estimate  of  the  truth  might  be  arrived  at.  It  would  be  no 
easy  task,  but  it  would  be  good  '  naturalists'  work '  worthy  the 
attention  of  any  follower  of  Darwin." 

The  want  of  thought  that  works  so  much  ill  can  only  be 
checked  by  the  creation  of  a  public  conscience.  "  There  are,"  says 
Mr  Scargill,  "  several  obvious  means — 1st,  County  Councils  should 
be  active  in  exercising  their  powers  under  the  Act  of  last  year, 
and  prohibit  altogether  the  taking  or  killing  of  such  birds  as  those 
just  mentioned ;  2nd,  the  editors  of  natural  history  magazines 
should  never  let  an  issue  pass  without  a  few  words  on  the  subject; 
3rd,  instruction  on  the  duty  and  the  reasons  for  it  should  be 
periodically  given  in  every  school." 

As  for  the  naturalists  themselves,  especially  those  whom  Mr 
Scargill  describes  as  "  the  camp-followers  of  science,  eager  for  the 
loot,  but  inclined  to  shirk  the  discipline,"  they  may  remedy  matters 
in  two  ways.  First,  let  them  collect  only  for  their  local  museum, 
and  themselves  pay  more  attention  to  the  habits  or  the  structure 
of  the  animals  and  plants  they  meet  with ;  secondly,  let  them  leave 
the  butterflies  and  the  petaliferous  plants  alone  for  a  time :  they 
will  find  the  flies,  the  grasses,  the  "mosses,  the  marine  invertebrates 
quite  as  interesting  and  far  more  profitable.  Let  us  add  that 
there  is  never  any  harm  in   collecting  fossils,  for  they  are   dead 


76  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

already ;  it  is  only  necessary  to  keep  careful  account  of  locality 
and  horizon,  and  to  spare  the  fossiliferous  stones  of  ancient  build- 
ings. There  is  plenty  of  sport  in  fossil-hunting,  and  the  merest  of 
mere  collectors  may  provide  the  most  philosophical  of  palaeontolo- 
gists with  valuable  material,  and  in  this  way  increase  the  value  of 
his  own  collection. 


Fkou-frou  and  Feathers 

All  moralists  have  assured  us  that  "  when  lovely  woman  stoops  to 
folly,"  she  stoops  very  low  indeed.  And  so  when  women  attempt 
to  emulate  the  glories  of  a  Choctaw  chief  or  a  South  Sea  islander,  it 
is  not  considerations  of  art  or  humanity  or  self-respect  that  will 
stop  them.  Consequently  it  is  not  likely  that  the  insensate  votaries 
of  fashion,  who  disfigure  their  heads  with  baskets  of  artificial  flowers 
(irrespective  of  the  season),  virulently  dyed  scraps  of  ribbon,  twists 
of  steel,  and  unnaturally  clipped  or  coloured  bird-feathers,  will  pay 
any  attention  to  a  paragraph  in  a  scientific  journal.  But  we  are 
willing  to  leave  the  irresponsible  half  of  creation  all  their  chiffons 
(which  mean  '  rags  '  or  '  women's  dress '  as  you  please),  their 
coal-tar  dyes,  and  their  scrap-iron,  if  only  they  will  leave  us  our 
birds.  The  rate  at  which  some  of  the  rarest  and  most  beautiful 
birds  on  our  planet  are  being  destroyed  to  gratify  this  extraordinary 
taste  can  hardly  be  realised.  On  the  13th  of  April  last  nearly 
half-a-million  birds  were  sold  at  an  auction  in  London,  and  the 
details  of  the  consignment  were  thus  given,  by  Mrs  Edward  Phillips 


at  tlie  annual  meet 

mg  oi  tiie 

bei  borne  society  : 

Osprey  plumes, 

m 

•                               • 

11,352   ounces 

Vulture  plumes, 

. 

. 

186f  pounds 

Peacock  feathers, 

. 

•                               • 

215,051   bundle 

Birds  of  Paradise, 

. 

,                               . 

2,362 

Indian  parrots, 

. 

. 

.      228,289 

Bronze  pigeons,  including  the 

goura, 

1,677 

Tannagers  and  sum 

Iry  birds, 

,               . 

38,198 

Humming  birds, 

. 

. 

.      116,490 

Jays  and  kingfishei 

•s, 

,                , 

48,75  9 

Impeyan  and  other 

pheasant 

and  jungle  fowl, 

4,952 

Owls  and  hawks, 

. 

.                              . 

7,163 

A  similar  sale  took  place  in  February,  and  others  were  to  follow 
in  July  and  October. 

It  is  small  consolation  to  us  to  think  that  in  a  few  years  the 
price  of  these  luxuries  will  be  prohibitive,  or  that,  unless  fashion 
changes  in  the  direction  of  sea-weeds  or  turnip-tops,  there  will  soon 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  77 

be  no  more  birds  to  destroy.  Nor  can  we  overlook  the  terrible 
suffering  involved  by  this  enormous  slaughter  :  the  young  osprey 
bereft  of  its  parents  left  to  die  in  hundreds,  the  heron  with  the 
plumes  torn  from  its  back^  writhing  into  death.  But  Frou-frou 
cares  for  these  things  no  more  than  she  does  for  the  squalor  of  East- 
end  sweating-dens.  Dear  delightful  doll  that  she  is,  she  actually 
attends  a  meeting  of  the  Selborne  Society  with  aigrettes  in  her 
bonnet. 

What  can  we  do  ?  Frou-frou  does  not  read  Natural  Science. 
But  at  all  events  each  of  our  many  thousand  readers  must  enjoy  the 
acquaintance  of  many  ladies.  He  can  at  least  use  his  influence  in  a 
quiet  way  in  the  home-circle,  if  not  beyond  it.  If  each  of  us  will 
make  sure  of  a  few  facts,  and  keep  pegging  away,  perhaps  we  may 
even  make  converts,  and  so  widen  the  small  circle  of  our  influence. 


National  Geology 

The  annual  report  of  the  Geological  Survey  of  the  United  Kingdom 
for  1896  reaches  us  in  its  handy  separate  form,  and  each  year's  issue 
contains  a  wealth  of  information  about  our  islands.  Sir  A.  Geikie's 
far-seeing  policy  of  attaching  to  the  Survey  men  already  qualified 
by  original  research  must  tend  to  increase  still  further  the  scientific 
character  of  its  publications.  Though  the  results  may  never  appear 
in  so  handsome  and  truly  national  a  form  as  do  those  of  the  United 
States,  yet  this  annual  summary  shows  strikingly  the  character  of 
the  work  in  hand.  Teachers  can  now,  for  the  sum  of  sixpence,  keep 
abreast  of  the  advances  made  by  the  Survey  in  England,  Scotland, 
and  Ireland ;  and,  as  all  practical  workers  know,  these  advances 
often  concern  even  the  broader  boundaries  on  the  map.  The 
classification  of  results  in  this  year's  report  under  the  several 
geological  systems  makes  reference  easy  through  its  hundred 
closely-printed  pages.  We  would  especially  direct  attention  to 
the  progress  of  knowledge  with  regard  to  the  pre-Cambrian  and 
older  Palaeozoic  groups.  The  occurrence  of  widely-spread  diabasic 
lavas  with  'pillow-structure'  (p.  37),  and  of  two  abnormal  short- 
lived volcanoes  in  Eaasay  (p.  74),  may  be  cited  as  among  the 
interesting  igneous  problems  dealt  with.  One  of  the  most  im- 
portant stratigraphical  questions  is  the  relation  of  the  '  Upper 
Greensand '  to  the  Upper  Gault,  referred  to  on  p.  72. 

It  is  obviously  impossible  to  continually  re-edit  the  engraved 
maps  of  the  Survey  so  as  to  embody  current  progress.  If  our 
Parliamentary  legislators,  however",  were  more  frequently  trained 
in  scientific  schools,  they  would  find  much  to  be  proud  of  in 
these  annual  reports,  and  would  congratulate  the  State  and  them- 


78  NATURAL  SCIENCE 


[August 


selves  on  that  zeal  for  discovery  which  raises  the  work  of  a  public 
department  into  one  of  international  distinction. 


Microscopy  in  Manchester 

The  Manchester  Microscopical  Society  has  recently  issued  its 
"Transactions  and  Annual  Eeport"  for  1896,  and  an  excellent 
little  publication  it  is.  To  our  way  of  thinking  it  is  almost  a  model 
of  what  such  a  publication  should  be.  Without  claiming  to  contain 
the  results  of  elaborate  original  research,  the  papers  are  nevertheless 
of  a  very  useful  and  suggestive  nature.  Prof.  Weiss,  of  Owens 
College,  in  his  presidential  address  gives  a  very  good  account  of  the 
main  facts  known  of  the  biology  of  those,  from  some  points  of  view, 
exceedingly  familiar  organisms,  the  diatoms.  We  believe  that  the 
type  of  microscopist  known  a  few  years  back  as  the  '  Diatomaniac ' 
is  wellnigh  extinct,  but  if  a  few  individuals  of  the  species  still 
exist  we  feel  sure  a  perusal  of  Prof.  Weiss's  paper  would  do  much 
to  broaden  their  views  of  things  in  general  and  of  diatoms  in 
particular.  We  heartily  endorse  the  sentiment  of  Prof.  Weiss  when 
he  says,  "  I  should  like  to  plead  for  the  union  of  two  branches  of 
study,  the  systematic  and  the  physiological  or  biological,  the 
severance  of  which  is  greatly  to  be  regretted,  and  has  proved 
wherever  it  occurs  to  be  a  hindrance  to  the  real  progress  of 
Natural  Science."  Other  papers  in  the  Transactions  deal  with 
"  The  Method  of  Eeproduction  in  Plants,"  more  especially  the 
microscopical  forms,  "  The  Structure  and  Development  of  the 
Hydrozoa,"  "  The  Lace-work  Sponge,"  "  The  Defensive  Devices  of 
Lepidopterous  Larvae,"  "  The  Entomology  of  the  Oak,"  and  "  The 
Distribution  of  the  Fresh-water  Fauna."  The  latter  is  by  Prof. 
S.  J.  Hickson,  and  contains  many  most  interesting  facts  and 
suggestions.  Prof.  Hickson  considers  that  the  facts  of  distribu- 
tion teach  us  that  fresh-water  animals  may  be  divided  into  three 
groups:  (1)  the  Cosmopolitan  group,  including  the  large  majority 
■of  fresh- water  species  ;  (2)  the  Archaic  group,  represented  by  such 
forms  as  Apus  and  Limnocodium ;  and  (3)  the  Eecent  group,  com- 
prising species  which  have  only  recently  migrated  into  fresh  water, 
such  as  Cordylophora  and  some  of  the  prawns.  The  problems  to 
which  this  paper  draws  our  attention  increase  our  regret  that  this 
country  is  still  without  any  prospect  of  a  fresh-water  biological 
station. 

Altogether,  judging  from  the  papers  and  report,  the  Manchester 
Microscopical  Society  seems  to  be  in  a  very  vigorous  condition, 
which  is  something  to  be  thankful  for  in  these  latter  days  when 
local  societies  are  too  often  more  asleep  than  awake. 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  70 

The  Apparent  Disappearance  of  the  British  Phyllopods 

In  the  course  of  the  paper  alluded  to  above  Prof.  Hickson  makes 
the  very  positive  statement  that  the  phyllopod  Apus  does  not  occur 
at  all  in  the  British  Isles.      This  may  he  true,  in  fact  we  are  almost 
forced  to  believe  that  it  is  true ;  but   it   is  also  certain  that  this 
animal  used  to  live  in    this   country,    for  Dr  Baird  records  it  as 
having  been  taken  by  three  different  observers,  although  he  does 
not  appear  to  have  found  it  himself.      Since  the  publication  of  the 
"  Xatural   History  of    the    British    Entomostraca "    in    1850,  Apus 
cancrtformis  has  never  again  been  recorded,  so  far  as  we  are  aware, 
and  it  does  seem  almost  certain  that  it  has  totally  disappeared  from 
<»ur  fauna.      The  same  fate  also  seems  to  have  overtaken  the  brine- 
shrimp,  Artemia  salina.     In  Baird's  time  this  form  was  to  be  found 
in  the  '  salt-pans  '  at  Lymington,  and  probably  other  places,  but  at 
the  present  day  one  may  search  the  old  '  salterns '  in  vain  for  any 
:race  of  the  creature.      With  regard  to  the  beautiful  Chiroc&phalus 
diaphanus,  which  Baird  mentions  from  a  large  number  of  localities, 
the   facts    scarcely   warrant    our    regarding    it    as    totally   extinct. 
It  has  certainly  been  seen  several  times  since   1850.     Prof.  G.  S. 
Brady  mentions  it  from  Yorkshire,  and  more  recently  it  has  been 
taken   near  Birmingham ;    nevertheless    for   all    practical   purposes 
it   now  appears   to   have    disappeared.       We    should,   however,   be 
exceedingly  glad  to  hear  if  any  of  our  readers  have  taken  this  form, 
say,  within  the  last  ten  years. 

Prof.  Hickson  attributes  this  dying  out  of  Phyllopoda — he  refers 
to  Apus  more  particularly — to  the  very  limited  means  of  dispersal 
which  these  creatures  have  at  command.  They  are  comparatively 
large  forms,  and  cannot  therefore  be  transported,  attached  to  birds' 
legs,  &c,  so  readily  as  the  smaller  and  commoner  Entomostraca. 
In  addition  to  this  they  do  not  produce  specially  protected  eggs 
like  many  of  the  Daphnias,  &c.  It  seems  probable,  therefore,  that, 
not  being  provided  with  the  means  of  transport  found  in  the  cos- 
mopolitan fresh -water  forms,  the  phyllopods  have  not  been  able 
to  extend  their  geographical  distribution,  while  owing  to  the  drying 
up  of  old  lakes,  and  other  changes,  the  localities  in  which  they  occur 
are  becoming  fewer  and  fewer. 


The  Bibliography  of  Science 

Of  course  we  are  glad  to  find  that  Mr  Arctowski's  article  on  the 
Uenealogy  of  the  Sciences,  which  appeared  in  Natural  Science  for 
-Tune  1807,  should  so  have  pleased  the  editors  of  the  Bulletin  de 
rinstitut  Intcrnationcd  de  Bibliographic  that  they  should  have  pub- 
lished a  French  version  of  it  in  their  number  just  received  by  us. 


80  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

None  the  less  we  are  surprised  that  a  journal  with  so  high-sounding 
a  title  should  so  ignore  the  objects  of  its  existence  and  the  respon- 
sibilities that  it  has  assumed,  as  entirely  to  omit  all  reference  to  the 
original  place  of  publication  of  the  article.  We  may  also  point  out 
the  absence  of  an  exact  date  of  publication  from  the  wrapper,  the 
pages,  and  the  included  catalogue-slips  of  this  Bulletin.  To  parody 
an  old  saying,  we  must  really  cry,  "  Bibliographer !  bibliograph 
thyself." 

The  Belgian  bibliographers  seem  to  have  found  Mr  Arctowski's 
article  as  unpractical  as  interesting.  One  thing  is  certain,  we  are 
not  going  to  wait — not  even  the  Eoyal  Society  Committee — for 
someone  to  write  us  a  phylogenetic  history  of  science.  Therefore 
the  impossibilities  of  the  suggested  classification  do  not  greatly 
matter.  At  the  present  moment  work  is  being  done  in  the  biblio- 
graphy of  science  on  a  definite  and  uniform  plan,  which  may  be 
ridiculous,  incorrect,  confusing,  but  which  is  workable  and  being- 
worked.  There  are  no  doubt  plenty  of  beautiful,  symmetrical 
schemes,  as  clear  as  daylight,  but  they  are  not  in  use.  The  follow- 
ing bibliographies  are  announced  by  the  Institut  International  in  a 
catalogue  of  its  publications : — Bibliographia  Philosophica,  B.  Socio- 
logica,  B.  Astronomica,  B.  Zoologica,  B.  Medica  Italica,  B.  Ana- 
tomica,  B.  Physiologica,  B.  Ostetrica  e  Ginecologica  Italiana,  while 
there  are  in  preparation  a  Bibliographica  Geologica,  B.  Physica, 
B.  Medica  Belgica,  B.  Agronomica  Italica,  and  others. 

Some  of  these  bibliographies  represent  the  adhesion  to  the 
uniform  plan  of  periodicals  or  societies  hitherto  working  on  other 
lines,  such  as  the  Zoologischcr  Anzeigcr,  Anatomischer  Anzeiger,  and 
II  Policlinico.  We  notice  too  that  the  Biological  Society  of  Paris 
accompanies  its  1896  volume  with  an  analytical  index  to  the 
articles,  arranged  on  the  principles  of  the  decimal  classification. 
All  the  subjects  dealt  with  in  over  300  articles  are  thus  referred 
to  in  two  pages.  These  and  numerous  other  facts,  which  it  would 
be  wearisome  to  detail,  show  that  the  system  is  gaining  ground, 
whereat  manv  will  marvel. 


A  Biological  PiEcord 

Yet  another  form  of  scientific  bibliography  comes  to  us  in  I' Annexe 
Biologique,  further  described  as  "comptes  rendus  annuels  des  travaux 
de  biologie  generate  publics  sous  la  direction  de  Yves  Delage,  pro- 
fesseur  a  la  Sorbonne  avec  la  collaboration  d'un  Comitc'  de  Pi'dac- 
teurs."  The  secretary  to  the  editors  is  Dr  Georges  Poirault.  The 
work  is  published  by  Schleicher  Kivres,  15  Puie  des  Saints-Peres, 
Paris,  at  a  price  of  20  francs.  The  first  volume,  just  received  by 
us,  deals  with  the  literature  of  the  year  1895.      We  may  describe 


1S97]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  81 

it  by  saying  that  it  treats  of  those  papers  that  are  noted  by  the 
zeal  of  Mr  J.  Arthur  Thomson  in  the  first  section  of  our  own 
Zoological  Record,  and  that  the  plan  of  the  work  is  like  that  of  the 
Zoologischer  Jahresbericht  and  the  Neues  Jahrbuch  fur  MvmroHogie 
combined.  There  are  53  collaborators,  mostly  French,  so  that  the 
task  of  abstracting  is  pretty  sure  to  fall  into  competent  hands. 
The  want  of  correlation  to  which  this  leads  is  compensated  by  the 
several  introductions  as  well  as  by  special  articles  on  general 
subjects — e.g.,  on  grafting,  by  L.  Daniel ;  experimental  knowledge  of 
the  correlation  of  animal  functions,  by  E.  Gley ;  on  polyzoism,  by 
J.  P.  Durand. 

As  to  what  is  meant  by  biology,  there  is  always  a  quarrel 
simmering;.  It  is  not  long  since  we  received  an  elaborate  discussion 
of  the  subject  from  Mr  Henry  de  Varigny,  extracted  from  the 
"  Dictionnaire  de  Physiologic"  He  defined  it  as  "  the  science  of 
the  relations  of  organisms  to  the  environment  and  to  other 
organisms,  present  and  past."  Professor  Delage,  in  his  Preface  to 
the  present  work,  does  not  waste  much  time  in  discussing  what  is 
or  is  not  biology ;  for  practical  purposes,  as  a  criterion  of  what 
shall  be  included  in  L'Anne'e  Biologiquc,  he  accepts  every  paper 
that  professes  to  give  an  explanation  of  biological  phenomena  (i.e., 
of  the  phenomena  of  living  beings).  It  is  easy  for  an  analyser 
or  recorder  to  see  whether  an  author  professes  to  explain.  But 
Prof.  Delage  has  opened  a  loop-hole  for  complaint,  since  he  also 
promises  to  record  facts  that  may  be  connected  with  some  future 
explanation,  or  even  those  which  "  belong  to  general  biology,  and 
are  not  of  the  same  nature  as  others  already  known."  Who  is  to 
decide  what  facts  will  ultimately  be  of  value  in  the  explanation  of 
our  ever-varying  problems  ?  Each  day  has  its  own  burning  ques- 
tion, casting  others  into  the  shade ;  and  what  the  riddle  of  to- 
morrow may  be  we  know  not.  Facts  that  were  passed  over  a  few 
years  ago  are  all-important  now.  What  facts  shall  we  be  collecting 
twenty  years  hence  ?  But,  apart  from  this  difficulty,  only  to  be 
overcome  by  a  prophet,  there  is  the  certainty  that  hundreds  of 
facts  undoubtedly  worthy  of  record  from  Prof.  Delage's  point 
of  view,  will  be  overlooked  by  himself  and  his  collaborators.  It 
does  not  take  us  five  minutes  to  discover  a  score  of  such  facts, 
published  during  1895,  often  with  full  knowledge  of  their  import, 
but  nowhere  alluded  to  in  this  volume.  We  do  not  blame  their 
omission,  for  we  cannot  think  that  anything  else  is  to  be  expected 
on  the  present  system  of  compiling  bibliographies. 

Taking  this  work  for  what  it  really  is,  and  not  for  its  unattain- 
able ideal,  we  recognise  that  it  is  relatively  complete  ;  that  it  is 
well  arranged  and  well  executed,  profiting  by  the  experience  of 
predecessors.      It  is  an  aid  that  should  be  neglected  by  none  with  a 


82  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

soul  above  species-mongering  and  section-cutting  ;  iu  other  words, 
it  will  be  welcome  to  all  readers  of  Natural  Science. 


Natural  Science  in  Japan 

The  historian  of  science  in  Japan  is  too  apt  to  restrict  his  view 
to  the  influence  of  European  science,  to  the  introduction  of  New- 
tonian and  Darwinian  philosophy  and  of  the  Linnean  system, 
forgetful  that  there  were  philosophies  and  systems  in  the  Far 
East  centuries  before,  or  else  thinking  wrongly  that  these  were  of 
small  account.  In  an  admirable  Introduction  to  the  first  number 
of  Anaotationcs  Zoologicac  Japoneiiscs,  Prof.  K.  Mitsukuri  corrects 
this  error.  Early  in  the  eighth  century  of  the  Christian  era  there 
was  already  established  in  Japan  an  Imperial  University  with  400 
students,  devoted  to  Ethics,  History,  Jurisprudence,  and  Mathe- 
matics. There  was  also  an  office  for  Astronomy,  Astrology,  Calendar- 
compilation,  and  Meteorology,  as  well  as  a  Medical  College  with 
professors  of  Medicine,  Surgery,  Acupuncture,  Necromancy  (the  art 
of  healing  by  charms),  and  Pharmacology.  In  connection  with  the 
last-named  branch  of  study,  much  botanical  information  was  acquired. 
Towards  the  end  of  the  ninth  century  the  large  Imperial  library 
contained  numerous  medical  works,  among  others,  on  the  diseases 
of  women  and  the  diseases  of  the  horse.  In  later  times,  under  the 
Tokugawa  Shoguns,  natural  history,  especially  botany,  was  exten- 
sively studied,  and  elaborate  works  were  published,  of  which  Prof. 
Mitsukuri  instances  the  '  Shobutsu  Kuisan '  issued  early  in  the 
eighteenth  century,  and  the  "  Honzo  Komoku  Keimo "  by  the 
celebrated  teacher  of  natural  history,  Ono  Eanzan,  published  in 
1803.  Honzo,  which  strictly  means  botany,  seems  to  have  come 
to  include  general  natural  history,  for  many  of  these  works  deal 
also  with  stones,  metals,  and  all  kinds  of  animals.  In  Rosny's 
"  Catalogue  de  la  Bibliotheque  Japonaise  de  Nordenskiold  "  we 
even  find  a  note  on  fossil  shells,  which  appeared  so  early  as  1725. 
The  naturalists  also  held  meetings  at  which  they  exhibited  their 
•; insures  to  one  another  and  to  the  public.  The  Garden  of 
Medicinal  plants  at  Tokyo  was  established  in  1G81. 

It  was  during  the  eighteenth  century  that  western  science  first 
came  into  contact  with  the  Japanese,  through  the  medium  of  the 
Dutch  language.  The  story  of  this  and  of  the  gradual  development 
of  modern  science  in  Japan  has  already  been  told  in  our  pages  by 
Mr  F.  A.  Bather  (vol.  iv.,  Jan.,  Feb.,  and  March  1894);  but  many 
details  are  added  by  Prof.  Mitsukuri.  Zoology,  he  notices,  had 
developed  but  slightly  before  the  restoration  of  the  Mikado  in  18G8; 
it  was  not  till  the  appointment  of  Prof.  E.  S.  Morse  to  the  Chair 
of  Zoology  at  Tokyo  University,  in  1877,  that  it  made  any  progress 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  83 

The  indefatigable  American  popularised  the  science,  secured  a  band 
of  earnest  students,  established  a  museum,  and  organized  the  Tokyo 
Biological  Society,  now  the  Zoological  Society.  He  was  succeeded 
by  C.  O.  Whitman,  who  introduced  modern  technical  methods. 

Since  1881  the  development  of  zoology  in  Japan  has  been 
entirely  in  native  hands,  and  does  not  seem  to  have  suffered  from 
that  cause.  All  its  main  branches,  including  its  practical  applica- 
tions, are  now  fairly  represented.  The  Marine  Station  at  Misaki 
has  been  outgrown,  and  a  larger  one  is  being  opened  two  miles  north 
of  the  present  building.  The  teaching  of  zoology  in  the  various 
schools  over  the  country  is  a  recognised  thing.  Further,  the 
addition  of  Formosa  to  the  territory  of  Japan  has  already  been 
taken  advantage  of  by  Japanese  zoologists.  One  thing  is  wanted, 
and  that  is  literature.  Prof.  Mitsukuri  appeals  to  the  naturalists 
of  other  countries  to  send  their  publications  to  the  Imperial  Uni- 
versity, where  they  are  sure  to  be  warmly  appreciated. 

Growth-Changes  ix  the  Spicules  of  Sea-Cucumbers 

The  sea-cucumber,  trepang,  beche-de-mer,  or  holothurian,  is  well 
known  to  be  a  favourite  article  of  food  in  the  Far  East ;  especially 
is  this  the  case  with  the  common  namako  of  Japan.  For  the 
protection  and  cultivation  of  this  animal,  Prof.  Mitsukuri  some 
time  ago  began  an  inquiry,  at  the  instance  of  the  Ministry  of 
Agriculture  and  Commerce.  One  of  the  first  questions  to  be 
answered  was  the  number  of  species,  if  there  were,  as  was  sup- 
posed, more  than  one.  The  species  of  holothurians  are  often 
determined  largely  by  differences  in  the  form  of  the  minute  cal- 
careous spicules  found  in  the  skin.  Now  it  so  happened  that  those 
who  had  examined  this  Japanese  holothurian — namely,  Selenka,  ATon 
Marenzeller,  Lampert,  and  Theel — had  failed  to  find  the  same  appear- 
ances in  the  spicules,  and  had  founded  two  species,  Sticlwpus  armatus 
and  &  japonicus,  together  with  a  variety  of  the  latter,  called  typicus. 
The  shape  of  the  spicules  is  that  of  a  minute  one-legged  table  made 
of  open  fretwTork  ;  but  some  individuals  contain  no  tables  at  all,  only 
smaller  spicules  something  like  round  buttons  with  four  or  five  holes 
in  the  middle.  Prof.  Mitsukuri's  investigations,  now  published 
in  Annotationes  Zoologicac  Japoncnses  (i.  pp.  31-42),  show  that  all 
these  forms  belong  to  Stichojms  japonicus,  and  that  in  this  species 
the  form  of  the  spicules  changes  with  advancing  age.  The  youngest 
individuals  have  an  extremely  large  number  of  most  perfectly  formed 
large-sized  tables,  and  nothing  but  these.  With  the  growth  of  the 
animal,  perfectly  formed  tables  decrease  both  in  number  and  size, 
and  tables  in  various  stages  of  arrested  development  are  found  mixed 
with  them.      This  process  continues  with  age,  until  in  fully  grown 


84  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

individuals  there  are  found  nothing  but  the  small  plates  above- 
mentioned.  These  represent  a  small  part  of  the  original  table  top, 
and  are  comparatively  thinly  scattered  in  the  skin. 

In  the  youngest  stages  the  calcareous  deposits  are  the  most  com- 
plete, and  have  almost  the  character  of  a  coat  of  armour,  like  that  of 
a  star-fish  or  sea-urchin.  This  may  be  for  the  greater  protection  of 
the  young,  in  which  the  skin  and  muscle-layers  are  very  thin  and 
pliable ;  but  it  may  signify  the  descent  of  the  species  from  a  more 
richly  plated  ancestor.  These  differences  are  not  entirely  signs  of 
age,  but,  in  conjunction  with  others,  distinguish  geographical  races. 
Thus  forms  with  spicules  in  the  shape  of  buttons  are  more  common 
in  the  north  of  Japan,  and  are  also  characterised  by  numerous  long- 
pointed  papillae  set  in  four  rows  along  the  back  and  sides,  with 
many  smaller  papillae  between  them.  As  one  passes  southwards 
along  the  coast  one  comes  gradually  to  forms  that  have  only  a  row 
of  low  papillae  along  the  sides,  and  a  few  scattered  over  the  back. 
Habitat,  however,  has  its  influence  no  less  than  latitude.  Those 
that  live  among  rocks  have  a  larger  number  of  tall  papillae,  and  are 
of  a  mottled  brown  colour,  while  those  that  live  on  sanely  ground, 
probably  among  sea-weeds,  have  lower  and  fewer  papillae,  and  are  of 
a  dark-green  colour. 

This  interesting  and  doubly  important  paper  makes  one  doubt 
afresh  the  validity  of  the  many  species  of  holothurians  that  have 
been  based  on  the  examination  of  the  spicules  of  a  few  individuals; 
it  shows  the  necessity  for  the  examination  of  many  specimens  in 
various  stages  of  growth  from  different  localities ;  and  it  affords  one 
more  demonstration  of  the  value  of  the  study  of  all  growth-changes 
and  not  merely  of  those  that  occur  in  the  embryo. 

How  a  Brittle-Star  Lives  in  Jatan 

While  the  Japanese  zoologists,  K.  Mitsukuri  and  T.  Hara,  were  on 
a  collecting  tour  last  year,  they  came,  on  April  1,  to  a  sandy  shoal 
in  the  Bay  of  Kagoshima.  Wading  into  the  water,  they  were  soon 
struck  by  very  curious  objects.  "  Numerous  slender  stalks  a  few 
millimeters  in  diameter  and  10-15  centimeters  high  were  standing 
up  from  the  bottom,  looking  like  the  stems  of  so  many  weeds. 
Along  one  side  of  each  stalk  there  was,  however,  a  row  of  white 
papillae-like  structures.  These  stalks  were  mostly  by  twos,  although 
sometimes  only  one  was  standing  by  itself.  We  do  not  remember 
having  seen  three  making  a  group.  As  we  dug,  to  learn  more  about 
these  curious  objects,  we  were  greatly  surprised  to  find  that  they 
were  the  arms  of  ophiurans,  and  that  the  papilla-like  structures  were, 
therefore,  no  doubt,  tubefeet.  So  far  as  we  could  see  there  was  no 
difference  between  the  five  arms  of  the  animal,  and  why  only  one  or 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  85 

two  of  them  should  he  thus  thrust  upwards  into  the  water,  and  kept 
upright  there,  was  a  mystery.  It  seemed  probable  to  us  that  it  was 
done  to  secure  respiration.  The  sand  of  the  shoal  was  literally 
packed  with  these  animals,  and  there  must  have  been  hundreds  of 
thousands  or,  perhaps,  millions  in  the  whole  shallow."  The  species 
was  near  or  in  the  genus  Ophiopsila.  The  account  is  extracted  from 
the  miscellaneous  notes  in  the  first  number  of  Annotationcs  Zoologicac 
Japonenscs. 

A  Botanical  Discovery  from  Japan 

Botanists  became  greatly  excited  when,  several  years  ago,  Treub 
published  an  account  of  his  discovery  of  Chalazogamy  in  Casuarina. 
By  this  term,  as  our  readers  may  remember  (see  Natural  Science, 
vol.  i.,  p.  132)  he  described  a  method  of  pollination,  in  which  the 
pollen-tube  entered  the  ovule  through  the  chalaza  instead  of  at  the 
micropyle.  Treub  was  so  much  impressed  with  the  importance  of 
this  and  other  deviations  from  the  normal  course  of  events  in 
Casuarina  that  he  separated  it  from  the  rest  of  the  seed-plants  under 
the  name  Chalazogamae,  the  latter,  in  which  presumably  pollination 
was  effected  through  the  micropyle,  forming  the  Porogamae.  More 
recent  work  has  shown  this  revision  of  our  classification  to  be  un- 
necessary, and  that  Casuarina,  though  certainly  presenting  remark- 
able anomalies,  must  still  be  retained  among  Dicotyledonous  Angio- 
sperms. 

There  has  recently  come  from  the  far  East  news,  and  confirma- 
tion of  the  news,  of  a  yet  more  startling  discovery.  S.  Ikeno  and 
S.  Hirase,  working  at  Tokyo  in  Japan,  have  found  that  in  the  pro- 
cess of  fertilisation  in  Cycas  and  Gingko  the  male  element  (generative 
nucleus)  is  converted  before  its  escape  from  the  pollen-tube,  into  a 
motile  spermatozoid.  This  swims  through  a  epiantity  of  sap  occurr- 
ing in  these  genera  between  the  embryo  sac  and  the  top  of  the 
nucleus  which  forms  a  thin  papery  covering  for  the  contents  of  the 
ovule,  and  impregnation  of  the  oosphere  is  therefore  effected  in  the 
same  manner  as  in  the  Vascular  Cryptogams.  The  spermatozoids 
are  much  larger  than  hitherto  known  among  the  Cryptogams,  and  that 
of  Cycas  is  larger  than  that  of  Gingko.  The  shape  is  oval.  The  head 
consists  of  three  spiral  windings  in  Gingko,  and  of  four  in  Cycas,  and 
bears  numerous  motile  cilia.  The  great  importance  of  the  discovery 
of  the  Japanese  botanists  lies  in  the  fact  that  it  strengthens  our 
present  system  of  classification.  Hofmeister  showed  the  near  rela- 
tion subsisting  between  Gymnosperms  and  Vascular  Cryptogams 
working  chiefly  from  the  development  of  the  female  spore  (embryo- 
sac)  and  the  structures  resulting  therefrom.  Now  from  the  male 
side  comes  a  striking  confirmation  of  his  conclusions, — a  confirma- 


86  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

tion  which,  as  Messrs  Ikeno  and  Hirase  point  out,  Hofmeister  had 
suggested  would  be  forthcoming.  It  is  of  much  interest  that 
Conifers  represented  by  Gingho,  as  well  as  Cycads,  show  this  rela- 
tion ;  as  we  have  always  been  wont  to  consider  the  latter  so  much 
the  more  ancient  group  both  on  palaeontological  and  morphological 
grounds.  And  Gingho,  the  maiden-hair  tree,  which  with  its  strange 
fern-like  foliage  and  non-conelike  inflorescence,  has  always  attracted 
us,  will  become  still  more  fascinating.  The  confirmation  of  the  news 
to  which  we  have  referred  was  supplied  by  Dr  Scott,  who  at  the  last 
meeting  of  the  Linnean  Society  showed  actual  microscopic  prepara- 
tions which  he  had  received  from  Japan.  A  few  more  details  will 
be  found  in  a  note  communicated  by  the  discoverers  to  the  June 
number  of  the  Annals  of  Botany. 

Fungi  and  their  Hosts 

It  is  generally  understood  that  a  fungus,  when  parasitic,  preys  upon 
one  and  the  same  host  during  the  whole  period  of  its  life-history. 
Hitherto  only  a  single  exception  to  this  rule  has  been  recorded, 
namely,  that  of  certain  '  rusts  '  (Uredineae),  whose  heteroecism  (as 
change  of  host  is  technically  termed)  was  first  demonstrated  satis- 
factorily by  De  Bary  in  186  4.  Now,  however,  the  Russian  botanists 
Woronin  and  Nawaschin  (Zeitschr.  fur  Pflanzcnkrankcnheiten,  vol. 
vi.,  1896,  pp.  129,  199)  have  discovered  an  interesting  case  of 
the  same  exceptional  phenomenon,  namely,  in  a  new  species  of  the 
Ascomycetes  which  they  have  described  and  named  Sclcrotinia 
Jteteroica.  The  resting-stage  (or  Sclerotium)  giving  rise  to  the 
Ecziza-iorm  grows  in  the  capsules  of  Ledum  palustve ;  the  other 
(or  conidial)  form  they  found  as  a  destructive  parasite  on  the  leaves 
of  Vaccinium  uliginosum.  The  fruit  of  Ledum  palustre  is  attacked 
at  an  early  stage  of  its  growth,  and  is  gradually  replaced  by  the 
sclerotium.  The  diseased  capsules,  which  do  not  differ  much  in 
appearance  from  the  healthy  fruits,  remain  attached  to  the  parent 
plant  during  the  winter,  and  fall  to  the  ground  in  spring  when 
the  stalked  cup-shaped  ascus-fruits  are  developed.  The  ascus 
spores,  scattered  by  the  wind,  light  on  the  buds  and  young  leaves  of 
Vaccinium,  where  they  germinate  and  spread  through  the  cells  of 
the  plant.  The  conidial  fructification,  upright  stalks  with  branched 
chains  of  conidia,  appear  on  the  petiole  and  veins  of  the  leaves, 
which  turn  brown  and  gradually  die.  The  authors  by  repeated  ex- 
periments established  without  doubt  the  relation  between  the  two 
forms  ;  but  it  is  rather  remarkable  that  they  were  able  to  cultivate 
the  conidial  form  from  the  ascus  spores  on  a  decoction  of  plums  ; 
and  this  fact,  as  pointed  out  by  Fischer,  interferes  between  the 
parallel  with    the   above    case    and    that   of   the    Uredineae.      The 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  87 

latter  are  obligative  parasites,  and  no  culture  medium  has  been 
substituted  at  any  stage  for  the  living  host  plants. 

There  are  a  number  of  parasites  among  the  '  Fungi  imperfeeti ' 
which  may  prove  to  be  heteroecious  forms  of  parasitic  ascomycetes, 
and  it  would  be  well  worth  while  to  carry  out  further  experiments 
on  the  subject. 

A  Bacterium  Living  in  Alcohol 

During  the  last  year  much  of  the  rum  manufactured  in  Demerara 
has  been  found  to  be  'faulty,'  and,  the  cause  having  been  sought  for 
in  vain,  great  loss  has  resulted  to  the  colony.  Mr  and  Mrs  Victor 
H.  Veley,  of  Oxford,  have  recently  discovered  a  micro-organism  in 
some  samples  of  faulty  rum  sent  them  for  examination.  The 
bacterium  belongs  to  the  group  Coccaceac,  adopting  Zopf's  classifica- 
tion, and  is  probably  a  new  species.  Mr  and  Mrs  Veley  have 
already  obtained  several  stages  in  the  life-history,  by  cultivation, 
and  hope  shortly  to  publish  an  account  of  its  development  and  the 
chemical  changes  which  it  produces  in  the  liquid.  The  fact  of  any 
micro-organisms  existing  and  multiplying  in  spirit  correctly  assessed 
at  42°  over  proof,  or  about  74*6  °/o  by  weight,  is  of  great  interest 
both  from  a  scientific  and  technical  point  of  view,  and  the  investi- 
gation is  likely  to  prove  of  considerable  importance. 


John  Jeffrey 

In  the  Proceedings  of  the  Biological  Society  of  Washington  (vol.  xi., 
pp.  57-60),  Mr  F.  V.  Coville  gives  a  sketch  of  the  route  taken  by 
John  Jeffrey,  "  one  of  the  most  obscure  "  of  the  botanical  explorers 
who  have  done  important  work  in  North  America.  Botanists  know 
him  only  as  the  subject  of  the  dedication  of  a  Californian  pine  (Pinus 
jejfreyi),  described  by  Andrew  Murray  from  material  sent  home  by 
Jeffrey.  The  brief  account  of  his  work  as  a  traveller  and  collector 
has  been  drawn  up  by  Mr  Coville  by  the  aid  of  documents  both 
manuscript  and  printed,  which  have  hitherto  been  almost  unknown, 
or  at  any  rate  unexamined.  We  know  that  Jeffrey  was  a  Scotsman,  and 
that  in  1850  he  was  sent  to  North  America  under  the  auspices  of  an 
organisation  formed  in  Edinburgh,  with  Prof.  J.  H.  Balfour  as  chair- 
man, and  known  as  the  "  Oregon  Botanical  Association."  He  was 
to  go  to  Western  North  America,  and  collect  the  seeds  of  trees, 
shrubs,  and  other  plants  suitable  for  horticultural  purposes,  in  the 
region  traversed  by  David  Douglas, "  to  complete  his  researches,  and 
to  extend  them  into  those  parts  of  the  country  not  fully  explored  by 
him."    Starting  from  York  Factory  on  Hudson  Bay  in  August  1850, 


88  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

he  worked  by  way  of  the  Saskatchewan  and  Athabasca  rivers  to  the 
Kocky  Mountains,  which  he  crossed  between  Mounts  Brown  and 
Hooker,  and  then  descended  the  Columbia  river  to  Fort  Colville. 
He  arrived  at  this  place  in  May  1851.  The  next  two  years  were 
spent  in  exploring  the  coast  region  between  the  Fraser  river  and 
San  Francisco.  Collections  were  made  on  Mount  Baker,  the  Cascade 
Mountains,  the  Sierra  Nevada,  and  other  ranges  in  Southern  Oregon 
and  California,  and  along  many  of  the  river  valleys.  Several  collec- 
tions were  sent  to  Edinburgh,  the  last  being  those  made  in  1853, 
when  his  term  of  employment  by  the  association  ceased,  the  original 
contract  being  for  three  years'  service.  A  letter  to  Andrew  Murray 
from  a  brother  in  San  Francisco,  dated  May  1854,  gives  the  last 
information  we  have  of  a  hard-working  and  enthusiastic  but  ill-fated 
botanist.  He  planned  an  expedition  to  Fort  Yuma  on  the  Gila 
river  in  Colorado,  from  which  he  never  returned,  and  there  seems 
little  doubt  that  he  perished  of  thirst  in  the  desert. 


The  Camel  in  Eueope 

It  is  difficult  to  determine  the  natural  geographical  distribution  of 
an  animal  which  has  been  so  long  domesticated  as  the  camel.  Dis- 
coveries of  its  remains  in  surface-deposits  need  to  be  carefully 
investigated  by  competent  geologists  before  they  can  be  accepted 
as  actual  fossils,  not  as  bones  merely  buried  by  man.  Great  interest 
therefore  attaches  to  an  announcement  by  Dr  G.  Stefanescu,  the 
eminent  Roumanian  geologist,  of  the  discovery  of  two  portions  of 
the  mandible  of  a  species  of  Camelus  in  an  undoubted  Quaternary 
gravel,  six  metres  below  the  surface,  on  the  river  bank  of  the  Olt 
at  Milcovul-de-jos,  near  Slatina,  Roumania  {Anuandu  Mus.  Gcol., 
Bucharest,  1895).  Dr  Stefanescu  disinterred  the  specimens  him- 
self, and  there  can  be  no  doubt  as  to  their  geological  age.  He 
regards  the  species  to  which  they  belong  as  new,  and  names  it 
Camelus  cdutensis.  We  believe  that  there  are  similar  fragments 
from  the  Volga  basin  in  the  collection  of  Prof.  A.  Rosenberg  of 
Dorpat  (Jurjeff),  but  we  are  not  aware  whether  any  account  of 
these  has  been  published. 


Steenstrup 

We  regret  to  record  the  death  of  the  doyen  of  Danish  zoologists,  the 
veteran  Prof.  Steenstrup.  We  hope  next  month  to  publish  a 
short  account  of  his  life  and  work  by  Prof.  Chr.  F.  Ltitken,  with 
a  recent  portrait. 


575.  89 

599.9 


The  Influence  of  Woman  in    the  Evolution  of  the 

Human  Race 

THE  recent  discussions  of  Mr  Eeid's  book,  "  The  Present 
Evolution  of  Man,"  in  Natural  Science  (vol.  x.,  pp.  184,  24<2, 
305,  393)  have  interested  me,  both  on  account  of  their  able 
treatment  of  this  subject  from  so  many  different  sides  and  also 
on  account  of  their  omissions  of  certain  points  of  view.  Man's 
place  in  nature,  the  possible  influence  on  his  destiny  of  the  position 
he  occupies  as  the  terminal  form  of  his  own  group,  should,  it  seems 
to  me,  be  given  more  consideration  as  a  possible  factor  in  his  evolu- 
tion. This  has  received  incidental  consideration  by  the  writer  in 
connection  with  studies  upon  the  phenomena  of  evolution  among  the 
Invertebrata,  especially  Cephalopoda,  and  the  results  are  instructive 
and  quite  similar  to  those  reached  by  the  distinguished  English 
palaeontologist,  Mr  S.  S.  Buckman. 

The  way  in  which  man's  position  may  possibly  affect  his 
evolution  and  further  prospects  has  been  treated  by  the  writer  in 
a  lecture  upon  "  Woman's  Occupations  and  Habits  and  the  Suffrage 
from  a  Biological  Point  of  View."  This  can  be  used  as  an  example 
of  a  certain  mode  of  treating  the  subject,  and  an  abstract  of  this 
lecture  may  perhaps  interest  the  readers  of  Natural  Science.  It  is 
also  appropriate  that  it  should  appear  first  in  an  English  periodical, 
since,  if  the  reports  are  true  which  reach  this  side  of  the  ocean,  some 
leading  Englishmen  are  so  sadly  deficient  in  knowledge  of  the 
subject  and  its  importance,  that  they  consider  the  question  of 
whether  the  suffrage  shall  or  shall  not  be  granted  to  women  as  a 
huge  political  joke  rather  than  as  a  question  dealing  with  matters 
of  importance  to  the  future  evolution  of  civilised  races.  People  do 
not  yet  recognise  that  the  tendency  of  evolution  is  quite  as  often 
towards  retrogression  and  extinction  as  in  the  direction  of  pro- 
gression ;  the  former  indeed  being  the  final  result  both  in  the  life- 
history  of  the  individual  and  of  his  family,  and  finally  of  the  race  to 
which  he  belongs.  The  laws  of  biology  have  not  hitherto  been  used 
to  test  the  assumptions,  that  co-education  and  the  changes  of 
occupations  and  habits  induced  thereby  and  by  the  legal  freedom  of 
choice  of  occupation  conferred  by  the  use  of  suffrage  upon  women, 
will  be  beneficial  factors  in  the  evolution  of  the  future.  The  writer 
has  thus  been  endeavouring  to  call  attention  to  this  side  of  these 

G 


90  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

questions  in  Boston  and  Cambridge,  U.S.A.,  and  the  following  is  a 
brief  abstract  of  the  arguments  employed  in  the  lecture  referred 
to,  lately  delivered  in  these  two  cities. 

(1)  Men  and  women,  like  the  males  and  females  of  most 
animals,  show  by  their  organisation  that  they  have  been  evolved 
from  a  type  in  which  both  sexes  were  combined  in  the  same 
individual.  The  separation  of  the  sexes  did  not  destroy  this  dual 
nature,  as  is  demonstrated  by  the  development  of  secondary  male 
characters  in  the  old  age  of  many  species  of  animals  and  of  women 
in  extreme  age,  and  of  feminine  characters  in  aged  men.  This 
opinion  can  also  be  supported  by  the  structure  of  the  tissue  cells  in 
the  body,  the  nuclei  of  which  are  made  up  of  paternal  and  maternal 
parts.  This  dual  structure  enables  us  to  understand  the  fact  that 
secondary  sexual  characters  are  latent  in  both  males  and  females,  and 
liable  to  make  their  appearance  after  the  reproductive  period  is 
passed  through,  or  before  this  time  and  prematurely  in  abnormal 
individuals,  or  perhaps  under  certain  conditions  of  habit  or  sur- 
roundings. 

The  maternal  (in  larger  degree  or  wholly  feminine)  parts  of  the 
nuclei  are  certainly  prepotent  during  the  entire  reproductive  or 
adult  stage  of  growth,  and  their  constant  employment  in  the 
performance  of  feminine  functions  prevents  the  development  of 
latent  male  characters.  During  this  time  the  paternal  (in  larger 
degree  or  wholly  male)  parts  of  the  nuclei  have  remained  inert  and 
may  be  supposed  to  be  still  capable  of  multiplying  by  division  and 
producing  extra  growths,  thus  even  in  old  age  building  up  secondary 
male  characters,  such  as  the  comb,  wattles,  etc.,  in  some  birds,  or 
giving  rise  to  secondary  male  characteristics  in  old  women.  This 
may  also  take  place  prematurely  through  suppression  of  the  natural 
functions,  either  by  change  of  habits  or  by  surgical  or  other 
artificial  operations.  These  statements  apply  equally  well  to  men, 
and  some  of  the  most  remarkable  examples  are  to  be  found  in  this 
sex,  but  the  dangers  of  feminisation  to  the  men,  although  possibly 
greater  than  we  now  suppose,  do  not  seem  at  least  to  be  so  im- 
portant or  threatening  as  those  that  lie  in  the  possible  future  of  the 
women.  These  are  striking  out  into  new  paths,  and  are  being 
helped  by  men  who  are  equally  ignorant  with  themselves  of  the 
nature  of  their  own  organisation  and  of  the  possible  dangers  to  their 
race  of  the  success  of  their  efforts. 

(2)  In  the  early  history  of  mankind  the  women  and  men  led 
lives  more  nearly  alike  and  were  consequently  more  alike  physically 
and  mentally,  than  they  have  become  subsequently  in  the  history  of 
highly  civilised  peoples.  This  divergence  of  the  sexes  is  a  marked 
characteristic  of  progression  among  highly  civilised  races.  Co- 
education of  the   sexes,  occupations  of  certain  kinds,  and  woman 


1897]       WOMAN  IN  EVOLUTION  OF  HUMAN  RACE         91 

suffrage  may  have  a  tendency  to  approximate  the  ideals,  the  lives, 
and  the  habits  of  women  to  those  of  men  in  these  same  highly 
civilised  races. 

(3)  Such  approximations  in  the  future,  while  perfectly  natural 
and  not  in  a  common  sense  degenerative,  would  not  belong  to  the 
progressive  stages  of  the  evolution  of  mankind.  Such  changes 
would  be  convergences  in  structure  and  character,  and,  although 
they  might  lead  to  what  we  might  now  consider  as  intellectual 
advance,  this  would  not  in  any  way  alter  the  facts  that  women 
would  be  tending  to  become  virified  *  and  men  to  become  effeminised, 
and  both  would  have,  therefore,  entered  upon  the  retrogressive 
period  of  their  evolution.  The  danger  that  men  may  become 
effeminised  may  be  greater  than  would  at  first  sight  seem  probable, 
but  this  might  not  take  place  at  all  or  to  such  a  slight  extent  as  not 
to  affect  seriously  the  progressive  evolution  of  the  race.  On  the 
other  hand,  the  danger  to  women  cannot  be  exaggerated  nor  too 
carefully  considered,  in  view  of  the  fact  that  advanced  women  have 
adopted  the  standards  of  men,  and  have  not  tried  as  yet  to  originate 
feminine  ideals  to  guide  them  in  their  new  careers  and  thus  maintain 
the  progressive  divergence  of  the  sexes. 

(4)  There  is  a  rise  of  the  individual  through  progressive  stages 
of  development  to  the  adult  and  a  decline  through  old  age  to 
extinction.  In  the  evolution  of  the  stock  to  which  the  individual 
belongs  there  is  a  similar  law,  a  rise  through  progressive  stages  of 
evolution  to  an  acme  and  a  decline  through  retrogressive  stages  to 
extinction.  These  cycles  of  the  ontogeny  (the  life  of  the  individual) 
and  of  the  phylogeny  (the  evolution  of  the  race  or  stock)  can  be 
illustrated  by  two  diagrams  of  lines  arising  from  a  point,  diverging 
to  represent  the  progressive  stages  and  converging  to  represent  the 
retrogressive.  The  divergences  and  subsequent  convergences  are  not 
simply  physiological  analogies,  as  heretofore  supposed,  but  they  occur 
in  obvious  relations  of  structures  and  forms  which  indicate  that  one 
law  governs  the  development  of  the  individual  and  the  evolution  of 
the  stock  to  which  that  individual  belongs. 

The  various  characteristics  of  an  organism  develop  through  youth 
to  the  adult  and  end  in  the  convergences  of  old  age,  which  is  termed 
the  gerontic  stage.  Species,  genera,  or  genetic  stocks  of  any  kind 
likewise  progress  from  their  origin  and  diverge  to  an  acme,  finally 
converging  in  the  phylogerontic  period  (the  gerontic  period  of  the 
phylum).  This  last  word  is  used  because  it  conveys  an  accurate 
meaning  for  which   there  is  no    exact   equivalent   in    the  English 

*  This  term  enables  one  to  consider  the  future  woman  who  has  acquired  manly  habits 
and  character  as  tending  to  become  mannish  without  being  necessarily  a  degenerate 
being  either  physically  or  mentally.  In  point  of  fact  she  may  be  virified  and  yet  be, 
according  to  the  standards  of  advanced  women  of  to-day,  superior  in  both  respects,  so 
far  as  bodily  and  mental  vigour  are  concerned  to  the  women  of  the  present  time. 


92  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

language,  and  please  observe  the  use  of  the  word  "  degeneration " 
is  thus  avoided. 

The  structural  changes  in  the  gerontic  stage  of  the  individual 
are  repeated  with  sufficient  accuracy  in  the  adult,  and  often  even  in 
the  younger  stages  of  types  that  occur  in  the  decline  of  the  evolu- 
tion of  a  phylum,  so  that  one  is  forced  to  consider  seriously  whether 
they  may  not  have  been  inherited  from  types  that  occur  at  the  acme 
of  the  same  group.  The  fact  that  these  changes  occur  first  in  the 
individual  during  the  gerontic  stage  does  not  necessarily  imply  that 
they  first  make  their  appearance  after  the  reproductive  period.  No 
gerontic  limit  is  known  to  the  reproductive  time  in  the  lower 
animals,  and  it  may  well  be  that  the  continual  recurrence  of 
gerontic  stages  in  individuals  during  the  epacme  of  groups  may 
lead  to  their  finally  becoming  fixed  tendencies  of  the  stock  or 
hereditary  in  the  phylum,  and  thus  established  as  one  of  the 
factors  that  occasion  the  retrogression  or  decline  of  groups.  The 
decline  may  also  be  considered  as  occasioned  by  changes  in  the 
surroundings  from  favourable,  as  they  must  have  been  during  the 
progression  up  to  acmatic  time,  to  unfavourable  during  the  succeed- 
ing declining  period  in  evolution.  Still  a  third  supposition  is  also 
possible,  viz.,  that  the  type,  like  the  individual,  has  only  a  limited 
store  of  vitality,  and  that  both  must  progress  and  retrogress,  complete 
a  cycle  and  finally  die  out,  in  obedience  to  the  same  law. 

All  of  these  views  can  be  well  supported,  but,  whatever  may  be 
the  true  explanation,  it  is  obvious  that  there  are  plenty  of  declining 
types,  which,  in  their  full-grown  and  even  in  their  adolescent 
stages,  correlate  in  characters  and  structures  with  the  characters 
and  structures  that  one  first  finds  in  the  transient  old  age  or 
gerontic  stages  of  acmatic  forms  of  the  same  type.  These  can, 
therefore,  be  truthfully  and  accurately  described  as  phylogerontic 
or  old  in  the  phylum. 

The  position  of  man  is  at  the  extreme  end  of  a  series  of  con- 
verging lines  in  his  own  stock.  This  is  also  indicated  by  his 
structure  and  development  which  is  phylogerontic,  and  it  is 
therefore  of  the  highest  importance  for  him  to  avoid  all  move- 
ments tending  to  the  increase  of  his  natural  and  possibly  inherent 
tendencies  towards  retrogression.  The  approximation  of  the  sexes 
in  habits  of  body  or  mind  is  therefore  to  be  avoided,  as  possibly 
leading  to  convergence  of  the  progressive  characters  non-existin- 
between  the  sexes  and  the  inauguration  of  retrogressive  evolution. 

It  is  hoped  that  no  pretence  of  being  able  to  solve  problems 
requiring  such  vast  knowledge  and  many-sided  considerations  will 
be  attributed  to  this  article,  which  has  been  intended  simply  to  call 
attention  to  the  scientific  side  of  the  question.  It  seems  obvious 
that  the  time  has  come  when  thoughtful  men  and  women  should  be 


1807]       WOMAN  IN  EVOLUTION  OF  HUMAN  RACE         93 

warned,  if  this  be  possible,  that  their  organisations  are  not  of  such 
a  kind  that  they  can  rely  upon  continuous  and  certain  progress. 
The  laws  of  evolution  point  distinctly  to  a  future  in  which  retro- 
gression and  extinction  is  perhaps  certain  ;  but  man's  past  history 
and  the  same  laws  also  hold  out  hopes  for  the  maintenance  of 
progress  through  an  indefinite  time,  if  he  is  capable  of  controlling 
his  own  destiny  through  the  right  use  of  experience  and  of  the 
wonderful  control  over  nature  that  his  capacities  have  enabled  him 
to  attain.  Alpheus  Hyatt. 

Boston  Society  of  Natural  History, 
Boston,  Mass.,  U.S.A. 


571.93(42.25)  94  [August 


II 

Primeval  Refuse  Heaps  at  Hastings 

(Concluded  from  p.  44) 

THE  most  remarkable  of  all  the  flint  implements  found  in  the 
Hastings  Kitchen  Middens — or  we  may  perhaps  even  say 
anywhere  else — is  a  group  of  highly  specialised  diminutive  forms 
totally  unlike  anything  outside  their  own  class.  They  are  usually 
exceedingly  small,  very  rarely  exceeding  an  inch  and  a  half  in 
length,  and  sometimes  are  not  one-sixth  that  size.  They  are 
characterised  by  the  peculiarity  of  their  shape  and  outline,  and  the 
method  by  which  the  flint  has  been  worked.  So  persistent  are  the 
quaint  and  curious  types,  and  so  unique  the  working  of  the  flint, 
that  these  delicate  little  implements  have  been  recognised  in  Egypt, 
Arabia,  Spain,  the  Valley  of  the  Meuse,  and  in  England  by  four 
different  field  workers.  Around  Sevenoaks  I  have  found  several 
settlements,  and  in  one  case  a  barrow  of  these  people,  in  which, 
probably,  the  chief  was  cremated,  with  implements.  Experiments 
lead  me  to  the  belief  that  this  peculiar  work,  in  which  the  delicate 
flakes  average  sometimes  only  one-thirtieth  of  an  inch  in  length,  was 
performed  by  a  slot  in  a  piece  of  bone  similar  to  a  saw-setter,  as  with 
a  tool  of  this  sort  I  can  reproduce  this  work  with  its  characteristic 
rectilinear  outline.  More  recently  I  have  noticed  a  few  spheroidal 
flints,  with  the  edges  finely  contused.  I  find  that  by  using 
these  upon  a  flake  lying  upon  a  banker  I  can  lever  off  small  flakes, 
giving  rise  to  a  kind  of  working  very  similar  to  that  found  on  the 
Midden  flints.  Amongst  these  queer  little  forms  are  crescents, 
such  as  Nos.  8,  85,  10,  11,  12,  8,  4,  and  81,  which  were  probably 
employed  for  fishing,  by  a  method  of  suspension  that  has  come 
down  to  us,  as  shown  in  Plate  VI.;  also  oblique  (Nos.  4y  and  ^) 
and  incurved  pointed  tools  (Nos.  85,  87,  88),  probably  used  for 
tattooing  and  other  rites ;  others  are  drills ;  while  the  use  of  others, 
such  as  those  with  trapezoidal  outline  (No.  40,  Plate  VI.),  is  past 
conjecture.  Many  are  simply  sharp  points,  and  were  doubtless 
used  for  fish  hooks,  being  bound  upon  a  crutch  twig,  in  the  manner 
suggested  in  Plate  VI.  It  is  the  extreme  dissimilarity  of  these  little 
things  from  everything  else  that  makes  us  feel  justified  in  recognis- 
ing them  as  the  work  of  one  and  the  same  people  wherever  they  are 
found.  They  are  not  scattered  indiscriminately  all  over  the  surface 
like  the  ordinary  neoliths,   but  are  confined  to  settlements,  which 


1897]      PRIMEVAL  REFUSE  HEAPS  AT  HASTINGS         95 

are  sometimes  thirty  acres  in  extent,  but  more  frequently  are  not 
more  than  a  hundred  yards  square. 

THE    WORKED    BONES 

One  or  two  of  the  fragments  of  bone  showed  signs  of  carving. 
One  was  a  well-made  stiletto ;  another  a  portion  of  a  needle.  A 
third  specimen  was  probably  a  potter's  tool,  as  by  its  use  the  marks 
seen  round  the  rim  of  the  pots  could  have  been  readily  made.  The 
most  interesting  circumstance  connected  with  the  bones  was,  that  in 
two  cases  the  flint  wedges  were  found  in  situ  in  the  bones,  as  they 
were  used  for  splitting  them.  Oue  of  these  is  shown  in  Plate  VI., 
left  lower  figure.  The  whole  of  the  marrow  bones  were  thus  split 
up  for  marrow,  and  the  skulls  for  the  brains ;  and  even  bones 
which  contain  no  marrow  were  often  similarly  reduced,  possibly  for 
either  boiling  to  extract  grease  or  for  use  in  making  bone  tools. 
Several  other  flint  wedges  similar  to  the  above  illustration  were 
also  found ;  and  numerous  bones  showed  deep  cuts  connected  with 
the  death  of  the  auimals,  or  those  that  were  made  in  cutting  up 
the  trophy  of  the  chase. 

THE    POTTERY 

The  pottery  of  the  refuse  heaps  is  of  special  interest,  as  it 
represents  probably  the  oldest  domestic  utensils  with  which  we  are 
acquainted.  Canon  Greenwell  has  called  attention  to  the  fact  that 
most  of  our  Neolithic  pottery  is  funereal  or  associated  with  burials: 
it  is  always  of  well-known  special  types,  and  none  of  these  were 
found  at  Hastings.  Some  of  the  pottery  here  was  made  from  a 
black,  coarse,  gritty,  carbonaceous  clay  fairly  well  baked  ;  some  was 
better  burnt  and  quite  red.  The  majority  of  the  vessels  are  of  one 
of  these  kinds.  There  was  a  much  coarser  kind  of  a  deep  red 
colour,  apparently  composed  of  coarsely  pounded  flint,  quartz,  and 
clay-iron-stone ;  from  this  large  utensils  were  made,  and  these  were 
often  |  of  an  inch  thick.  The  vessels  were  for  the  most  part  of  two 
types — the  cauldron  and  the  dish  ;  they  were  all  hand-made,  none 
showing  a  sign  of  the  use  of  the  wheel.  The  cauldrons  were  very 
like  the  modern  tar-kettle,  with  a  flat  bottom  and  no  feet,  the 
reflected  rim-flange  reaching  out  nearly  as  far  as  the  widest  part  of 
the  vessel.  Several  of  these  which  I  have  restored  give  the 
following  measurements: — Height,  9  cm.;  widest  part  of  rim,  16 
cm.;  widest  part  of  body,  17  cm.;  bottom  slightly  convex  outwards, 
13  cm.  Another  gives  in  the  same  directions  12,  20,  22,  and  16 
cm.  respectively.  A  flat  dish  gave  height,  3*5  cm.;  width  of  rim, 
23  cm.;  width  of  flat  bottom,  18  cm.  Two  fragments  of  rims 
showed  decoration  upon  their  upper  edges.      The  first  consisted  of 


96  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

circular  hollows,  such  as  could  have  been  made  by  the  flat  round- 
pointed  bone  tool,  about  1 1  cm.  long,  found  in  the  Middens  ;  and 
the  other  was  a  crescent  and  line  marking,  such  as  could  have  been 
made  by  a  plano-convex  tool  with  a  straight  edge.  Usually  the 
upper  edges  of  the  rims  were  rounded  ;  in  the  flat  vessels  they 
were  not  always  reflected  outwards  ;  and  now  and  then  an  attempt 
was  made  to  thicken  the  top  edge  into  a  bead,  although  the  thumb 
only  allowed  of  very  poor  success. 


THE    ANIMAL    REMAINS 

We  next  come  to  the  animal  remains  found  in  the  Middens, 
which,  for  many  reasons,  are  extremely  interesting.  In  practically 
all  cases  the  marrow  bones  were  split  for  the  contained  grease ;  they 
indicate  an  unaccountable  number  of  young  animals.  Many  of  the 
bones  are  also  minus  their  spongy  ends  or  have  lost  their  epiphyses, 
and  some  show  the  marks  of  teeth.  The  following  are  some  extracts 
from  my  notes  upon  the  species  represented  : — 

Bos  longifrons  (Celtic  shorthorn). — Large  limb  bones  were  very 
rare,  and  those  discovered  were  all  split  for  the  marrow.  Most  of 
the  bones  are  young  without  epiphyses,  and  indicate  small  animals  ; 
two  or  three  bones  and  fragments,  however,  are  large  and  robust 
enough  for  B.  primigenius.  The  toe  bones  are  all  small.  The  horns 
are  small,  short,  and  slightly  curved,  the  longest  measuring  eight 
inches  along  the  outside  and  seven  inches  girth  ;  most  of  the  horns 
must  have  measured  about  five  inches  along  the  outside  curve.  In 
eight  cases  the  ends  have  been  gnawed  away.  Vertebrae  and  all 
irregular  bones  were  very  numerous.  Jaws  were  always  broken 
into  fragments,  none  carrying  more  than  four  teeth.  Loose  teeth 
were  fairly  numerous,  some  of  which  were  very  much  worn. 

Sits  scrofa  (pig).  —  Parts  of  all  bones  were  present,  and  all 
marrow  bones  split.  Nearly  half  have  lost  their  articulating 
surfaces,  and  only  part  of  them  show  teeth  marks.  One  bone 
shows  the  marks  of  more  spatulate  teeth,  which  may  have  been 
human.  All  the  bones  are  young,  few  with  epiphyses  anchylosed. 
Two  or  three  of  the  latter  were  found  not  to  be  gnawed.  One 
radius  is  exceptionally  stout ;  otherwise  the  bones  in  general  are 
quite  small,  many  being  not  more  than  one-third  grown.  Pieces 
of  head  are  numerous  ;  some  of  the  jaws  appear  rather  heavy, 
and  the  longest  canine  measures  five  inches  in  length.  Pigs'  bones 
were  often  burnt. 

Equus  caballus  (horse). — There  were  about  twenty  bones  of 
horses,  chiefly  leg  and  toe  bones,  one  piece  of  jaw  and  three  odd 
teeth,  all  pointing  to  small  or  very  small   animals  :    they   appear 


NATURAL  SCIENCE,   VOL.  XI. 


Plate  V. 


ymW-  *■'■;:' *mSBbB:-}>  V   -     N      the 


_ 


CLIFF   AT    HASTINGS   WITH    KITCHEN    MIDDEN    ON    LEDGE    BELOW   A   CAVERN 


NATURAL  SCIENCE,   VOL.  XI. 


Plate  VI. 


FLINT    IMPLEMENTS   AND   WORKED   HONES   FROM   THE   HASTINGS   KITCHEN    MIDDENS 


1897]      PRIMEVAL  REFUSE  HEAPS  AT  HASTINGS         97 

to  have  been  mere  ponies.  The  limb  bones  are  split  for  marrow, 
and  two  pieces  are  burnt,  though  none  show  traces  of  gnawing. 

Ovis  aries  (sheep). — All  the  bones  of  the  sheep  were  found,  and, 
with  two  or  three  exceptions,  they  point  to  very  small  animals. 
They  were  exceedingly  numerous,  about  as  much  so  as  either  pig  or 
ox.  All  the  humeri  are  broken  off  short ;  all  the  radii  are  split,  as 
are  also  some  of  the  metacarpals  and  metatarsals.  The  bones  of 
this  genus  are  extremely  perplexing,  as  they  differ  both  in  detail 
and  proportions  from  any  of  the  modern  sheep  with  which  I  have 
been  able  to  compare  them  :  nearly  all  of  them  belong  to  a  small 
long-legged  variety,  sometimes  even  approaching  a  small  deer.  One 
or  two  bones  point  to  an  animal  just  as  much  the  other  way,  being 
altogether  stouter  than  anything  I  am  able  to  find. 

Capra  hircus  (goat). — There  are  a  few  bones  and  a  fragment  of  a 
skull  with  horn  core,  which  Mr  E.  T.  Newton  has  identified  as  goat. 

Caprcolus  caprca  (roebuck). — About  the  same  number  has  been 
referred  to  roe  deer. 

Can  is  fci'iniliaris  (dog). — Two  tibiae  represent  a  dog  of  very 
large  proportions,  almost  stout  enough  for  wolf ;  and  some  half 
dozen  other  bones  point  to  one  of  full  medium  size. 

Canis  lupus  (wolf). — One  or  two  bones  have  been  assigned  to 
the  wolf. 

Fdis  catus  (cat). — There  are  some  half  dozen  bones  belonging  to 
this  species  which  are  of  large  size,  and  one  tibia  has  lost  its  soft 
end,  although  it  shows  no  teeth  marks. 

Canis  vulpcs  (fox). — Several  bones  unquestionably  belong  to  the 
fox. 

Lepus  timidus  and  L.  cuniculus  (hare  and  rabbit). — Both  of 
these  species  are  represented  by  few  bones.  The  former  was  not 
very  large. 

Mcles  taxus  (badger). — This  species  is  represented  by  an  ulna ; 
it  agrees  well  with  a  fine  specimen  I  have  from  the  Thames  Pleis- 
tocene brick  earth,  although  perhaps  hardly  so  robust. 

Birds. — When  we  come  to  the  birds,  I  regret  to  say  that  our 
public  museums  are  still  so  deficient  in  skeletons  for  comparison 
that  the  determinations  are  not  all  quite  so  satisfactory  as  could  be 
wished.  A  larger  series  for  comparison  may  add  several  species  to 
the  list  or  perhaps  otherwise  alter  it.  Of  course  there  is  always  the 
difficulty  of  being  able  to  say  how  much  variation  from  the  present 
examples  one  ought  to  allow,  and  this  can  only  be  decided  more 
correctly  when  we  have  much  more  modern  material  in  our  museums. 
Mr  Newton  has  identified  the  following  : — Black  and  red  grouse,  a 
species  of  duck,  guillemot  and  carrion  crow. 

Fishes. — These  include  cod  in  very  large  quantities,  gurnard, 
mackerel,  whiting,  Coitus,  turbot,  plaice,  and  thornback  (Raja). 


98  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

The  Batrachia  are  represented  by  the  frog  or  toad. 

M oil u sea. — These  offer  several  points  of  interest.  The  first  to 
claim  attention  is  a  number  of  very  large  Helix  aspersa,  which  are 
represented  both  by  whole  and  broken  shells.  These  were  found 
under  about  three  feet  of  midden  material,  and  I  have  no  doubt  they 
were  eaten  by  man.  Zittorina  littorea,  in  point  of  numbers,  stands 
first,  and  the  shells  are  also  of  very  large  size.  The  limpet  {Patella 
vulgatd)  occurs  next  in  quantity,  and  is  represented  by  two  or  three 
varieties.  Cardium  echinatum  is  fairly  represented,  but  C.  cdule 
was  not  met  with.  The  whelk  (Buccinum  undatum)  is  plentiful, 
but  Trophon  was  always  absent.  Purpura  lapillus  is  represented  by 
a  score  or  more  shells,  but  whether  eaten  or  employed  for  their 
purple  juice  it  would  be  difficult  to  say.  One  piece  of  bone  recovered 
was  of  a  purple  colour,  suggestive  of  having  been  dyed,  although  it 
is  highly  improbable  that  the  stain  would  have  lasted  so  long. 
Most  of  the  oysters  (Ostrea  edulis)  are  of  medium  size,  suggestive  of 
shallow  water ;  but  here  and  there  some  were  very  large,  and  may 
have  spent  the  greater  part  of  their  time  in  deep  waters.  The 
mussel  {Mytilus  edulis)  often  occurred  in  large  masses,  although  the 
shells  were  always  badly  preserved.  Natica,  Pholas  and  Mactra  are 
represented  by  a  single  specimen  each. 

CONCLUSION 

With  this  amount  of  material  we  are  able  to  restore  a  fairly 
satisfactory  picture  of  the  men  who  left  the  Eefuse  Heaps  at  the 
mouth  of  the  Hastings  caves.  It  is  certain  that  they  lived  largely 
upon  fish,  both  those  which  could  be  obtained  between  tide  marks 
and  those  which  would  require  the  use  of  boats  of  some  sort  and  the 
employment  of  the  hook  and  line ;  although  the  spear  in  the  hands 
of  dexterous  people,  perched  upon  the  rock  masses  which  strew  this 
coast,  might  have  been  the  favourite  instrument.  We  have  no  evi- 
dence  that  they  knew  anything  about  the  use  of  metal ;  but  they 
were  exceptionally  skilful  fabricators  of  flints,  which  they  worked 
in  a  manner  essentially  their  own,  of  such  diminutive  sizes  as  to 
suggest  that  the  delicate  little  instruments  were  largely  employed 
for  fish  hooks.  The  absence  of  battle  axes  and  all  other  heavy 
tools  would  point  to  their  not  being  much  employed  in  wars  or  agri- 
cultural pursuits.  No  cereals  of  any  kind  were  found,  and  no 
querns  or  large  mealers ;  although  leaves  and  twigs  were  often  pre- 
served. They  knew  the  use  of  fire,  which  they  lit  upon  hearths,  and 
kept  them  going  until  they  had  baked  the  underlying  ground  for 
seven  or  eight  inches.  They  also  employed  cooking  stones,  or  "  pot 
boilers "  as  they  are  sometimes  called.  Their  pottery,  although 
coarse,  was  fairly  well  modelled  considering  there  is  no  sign  of  the 


1S97]       PRIMEVAL  REFUSE  HEAPS  AT  HASTINGS         99 

knowledge  of  the  wheel.  It  was  also  fairly  well  baked,  and  would 
stand  the  fire,  as  is  shown  by  the  deposit  of  soot  upon  some  of  the 
fragments.  They  appear  to  have  known  nothing  about  the  art  of 
polishing  flint  or  the  barbing  of  arrow  heads.  In  none  of  the  settle- 
ments where  the  characteristic  implements  have  been  found,  has 
anything  been  obtained  to  conflict  with  the  evidence  of  the  Middens 
in  any  way.  The  barrow  at  Sevenoaks,  which  contained  similar 
relics,  it  is  true,  was  nearly  round,  pointing  to  the  close  of  the  Neo- 
lithic period ;  but  further  research  induces  me  to  consider  that  these 
people  might  nevertheless  have  preceded  the  days  of  the  barbed 
arrow  and  the  polished  axe,  and  this  conclusion  is  strengthened  by  the 
geological  evidence  of  Dr  Colley  March  in  Lancashire.  It  is  prob- 
able that  the  ox,  the  '  sheep,'  and  the  pig  were  confined  in  en- 
closures, where  they  lived  in  a  semi-domesticated  state.  Man  also 
seems  to  have  domesticated  the  dog,  which  possibly  assisted 
in  keeping  the  cattle,  although  the  canine  bones  sometimes  look 
as  if  they  had  been  gnawed.  It  is  certain  from  the  large 
quantities  of  bones  present  that  animal  food  was  indulged  in 
whenever  obtainable,  perhaps  even  more  so  than  was  the  case  with 
the  Baltic  Midden  men.  But  the  motley  group  of  animals  repre- 
sented at  Hastings  showT  the  men  there  to  have  been  anything  but 
epicures,  as  they  appear  to  have  eaten  anything  upon  which  they 
could  lay  their  hands. 

The  occurrence  of  these  implements  thirty  or  forty  miles  inland 
in  a  number  of  places,  suggests  their  being  the  work  of  a  Nomadic 
people,  but  whether  or  not  the  trans-European  localities  can  be  taken 
to  indicate  the  line  of  original  migration,  further  researches  will  alone 
decide.  This  much  is  however  proved,  that  the  Midden  men  will 
henceforth  have  to  be  added  to  the  pre-historic  races  of  Britain. 

W.  J.  Lewis  Abbott. 


575.  100  (August 

581.16 

595.793 


III 

Bees  and  the  Development  of  Flowers 

IN  the  "  Origin  of  Species,"  Darwin  expressed  the  view  that  we 
owe  the  gay  colours  and  varied  forms  of  our  flowers  to  the 
selective  action  of  insects.  "  We  may  safely  conclude,"  he  writes, 
"  that  if  insects  had  never  existed  on  the  face  of  the  earth,  the 
vegetation  would  not  have  been  decked  with  beautiful  flowers,  but 
would  have  produced  only  such  poor  flowers  as  are  now  borne  by 
our  firs,  oaks,  nut,  and  ash  trees,  by  the  grasses,  by  spinach,  docks, 
and  nettles." 

This  theory  of  the  selective  action  of  insects  on  flowers  has 
been  elaborated  in  great  detail  by  Hermann  Miiller  in  Germany, 
and  by  Sir  John  Lubbock  and  Mr  Grant  Allen  in  this  country  ; 
and  almost  every  writer  on  Natural  Selection  has  accepted  this  view 
as  a  part  of  the  Darwinian  scheme  of  evolution.  In  this  case,  as  in 
many  others,  more  recent  observers,  assuming  that  the  foundations 
are  secure,  have  spent  their  time  in  elaborating  structural  details  in 
the  hypothetical  edifice.  But  when  we  lay  the  ingenious  conception 
along  the  straight  rule  of  facts  in  nature,  the  measures  do  not 
correspond.  In  other  words,  the  foundation,  the  habits  of  insects 
with  regard  to  flowers,  does  not  support  the  hypothetical  super- 
structure. 

Professor  Henslow,  again,  has  proposed  an  amendment,  in  which, 
although  selection  by  insects  is  still  the  motive  power,  the  modus 
operandi  is  different. 

Stated  briefly  the  Darwinian  theory  is  as  follows : — 

Insects  come  to  flowers  for  honey  and  pollen,  and  in  so  doing 
do  not  visit  all  indiscriminately,  but  select  those  which  take  their 
fancy,  or  suit  them  best.  If  they  are  seeking  honey  they  will 
choose  those  flowers  which  afford  the  most,  or  in  which  it  is  most 
easily  obtained  ;  if  they  have  a  special  liking  for  any  colour,  say 
blue,  they  will  pick  out  the  bluest  flowers  ;  if  any  special  shape  of 
flower  affords  them  greater  convenience  for  alighting,  they  will  visit 
these  rather  than  others.  Now  in  any  species  of  flower  all  these 
things — amount  and  position  of  honey,  colour,  and  shape — vary  in 
different  individuals.  If,  then,  insects  possessed  the  requisite  dis- 
crimination, we  might  suppose  them  selecting,  generation  after 
generation,  those  flowers  in  which  these  desirable  points  were  most 
highly    developed.       The    flowers    thus    visited    would    obtain    the 


1897]    BEES  AND  THE  DEVELOPMENT  OF  FLOWERS    101 

benefits  of  cross-fertilisation,  and  their  descendants  would  therefore 
be  more  numerous  and  vigorous  than  of  those  not  visited.  This 
more  vigorous  progeny  of  the  insect-visited  and  cross-fertilised 
flowers  would  gradually  live  down  the  less  vigorous  offspring  of  the 
unvisited  flowers.  Hence  any  particular  character  perseveringly 
selected  by  insects  for  many  generations  would  come  to  predominate, 
be  gradually  perfected,  and  finally  form  a  new  specific  type. 

Such  is  a  brief  outline  of  the  theory  which  has  captivated  the 
minds,  not  only  of  men  of  science,  but  also  of  the  public,  and  which 
has  been  accepted  by  almost  every  evolutionist  as  the  explanation 
of  the  form  and  colour  of  flowers.  Professor  Henslow's  amendment, 
while  still  depending  on  selection  and  the  benefits  of  cross-fertilisa- 
tion, attributes  the  alteration  in  the  shape  and  colour  of  the  flower 
to  the  direct  stimulus  of  the  insect's  action.  Thus  an  insect  hanging 
to  the  lower  petal  of  a  flower  elongates  the  same  by  its  weight,  and 
the  lengthened  petal  is  transmitted  by  heredity ;  the  irritation 
caused  by  its  feet  in  walking  along  the  flower  causes  the  appearance 
of  colouring  matter,  and  the  colour  is  likewise  transmitted ;  as  it 
probes  for  honey  it  causes  a  flow  of  sweet  sap  to  that  part,  and  this 
also  becomes  hereditary.  This  view  is  quite  too  Lamarckian  for 
England  or  Germany,  whatever  may  be  its  fate  in  America. 

The  weight  of  authority  supporting  the  insect  selection  theory, 
and  its  wide  acceptance  in  scientific  circles,  renders  it  perhaps  a 
little  rash  to  criticise  it  adversely ;  yet  a  series  of  observations  on 
the  habits  of  bees  with  regard  to  flowers  extending  over  many  years, 
has  forced  me  to  the  conclusion  that  it  has  no  sufficient  foundation 
in  fact.  Details  of  some  of  these  observations  have  been  given  else- 
where, and  I  shall  here  state  only  the  general  results.  Bees  have 
been  chosen  because,  of  all  insects,  these  are  the  easiest  and  most 
interesting  to  watch  in  their  visits  to  flowers.  They  are  also 
the  most  important  of  insects  for  the  theory,  since  they  are  by  far 
the  most  frequent  and  regular  visitors  of  flowers.  If  the  bee's  action 
can  be  shown  to  be  insufficient,  no  one  will  support  the  claims  of  any 
other  insect.  Let  us,  then,  see  what  the  bee  really  does  in  the  way 
of  selecting  special  forms  and  colours  of  flowers  by  watching  it  in 
the  fields  and  gardens,  and  consider  what  effect  this  can  have  on  the 
flowers  visited. 

It  has  been  frequently  pointed  out  that  Sir  John  Lubbock's  ex- 
periments prove  that  bees  have  special  tastes  for  certain  colours,  and 
that  they  prefer  red  and  blue,  especially  the  latter.  This  preference 
of  the  bee  for  blue  is  one  of  the  cardinal  points  of  the  theory,  and 
has  been  considered  almost  sufficient  in  itself  to  justify  the  assump- 
tion that  blue  flowers  have  been  evolved  by  their  selective  action. 
But  without  wishing  in  the  least  to  disparage  the  work  of  one  of  our 
great  authorities  on  insects,  I  submit  that  observations  of  what  bees 


102  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

actually  do  in  the  way  of  visiting  flowers  is  of  more  importance  to 
the  theory  than  any  such  experiments  ;  and,  as  we  shall  see  pre- 
sently, bees  in  visiting  flowers  do  not  show  any  marked  preference 
for  blue  ones. 

The  analogy  between  man's  selection  resulting  in  artificial  breeds, 
and  natural  selection  resulting  in  species,  was  often  and  strongly  in- 
sisted on  by  Darwin ;  while  the  action  of  the  insect  in  evolving  a 
new  species  of  flower  specially  adapted  to  its  requirements  in  form 
and  colour,  has  been  compared  to  that  of  the  gardener  in  the  pro- 
duction by  selection  of  his  special  varieties.  The  extreme  care  re- 
quired from  the  gardener,  not  only  in  the  selection  of  the  requisite 
variation,  but  also  in  its  isolation  and  preservation  is  well  known. 
If  the  new  variety  in  the  process  of  its  evolution  be  allowed  to  cross 
with  the  parent  stock  it  is  lost.  Darwin  even  went  so  far  as  to 
warn  gardeners  against  allowing  crossing  between  different  indivi- 
duals of  the  new  variety,  as  such  tends  to  produce  reversion.  It  is 
a  little  difficult  to  understand  how  the  bee,  even  if  it  possessed  all 
that  nice  discrimination  of  form  and  colour,  and  all  that  constancy 
required  by  the  theory,  could  accomplish  that  which  demands  such 
care  and  patience  on  the  part  of  the  gardener.  In  order  to  evolve  a 
race  of  blue  flowers  from  those  normally  of  another  colour,  bees 
would  have  to  select  those  among  the  slight  natural  variations  which 
had  a  tinge  of  blue.  If  they  really  preferred  to  gather  honey  from 
blue  flowers — they  would  not  have  merely  to  prefer  blue  in  the  ab- 
stract— they  would  do  so,  and  these  bluish  flowers  would  receive  the 
benefits  of  cross-fertilisation.  But  the  few  bluish  flowers  among  the 
many  normal  ones  would  not  suffice  :  the  bees,  from  the  necessity  of 
obtaining  honey,  would  be  obliged  to  visit  the  normally-coloured 
ones  also.  Thus  the  new  variety  would  be  blended  with  the  parent 
type  and  lost,  for  pollen  would  be  carried  from  the  one  to  the  other. 
In  order  to  isolate  the  bluish  variety,  the  bee  would  not  only  have 
to  prefer  blue,  but  also  steadily  refuse  to  visit  any  other  colour ; 
and  if  it  did  so  when  the  bluish  flowers  were  first  appearing  it 
would  starve  for  want  of  honey.  But  we  have  no  proof  that  the 
bee  even  possesses  the  taste.  In  all  my  observations  of  bees  I 
have  met  with  nothing  to  support  the  view  that  they  prefer  to  take 
their  honey  out  of  blue  flowers.  Some  blue  flowers  they  visit  fre- 
quently, others  they  visit  very  seldom.  No  blue  flowers  are  more 
frequently  visited  than  others  which  are  yellowish-green,  pink,  and 
various  other  shades.  Some  uncompromisingly  green  flowers — as 
the  plane  tree  and  red  currant — are  frequently  visited.  As  regards 
colour,  then,  the  bee  seems  to  have  neither  the  taste  to  select,  nor 
the  ability — through  the  necessity  of  obtaining  sufficient  honey — to 
restrict  itself  in  the  manner  required.  Moreover,  the  fact  that  the 
same  species  of  bee  may  be  seen  visiting  flowers  of  the  most  diverse 


1897]    BEES  AND  THE  DEVELOPMENT  OE  FLOWERS    103 

shapes,  from  the  simplest  to  the  most  complex,  does  not  seem  to 
imply  that  they  have  the  requisite  selective  tendency  as  regards 
form.  This  is  further  illustrated  by  the  fact  that  bees  may  at  times 
be  seen  visiting  ilowers  which  have  lost  their  corollas  wholly  or  in 
part.  Thus  \  have  seen  them  visit  petal-less  flowers  of  wild 
geranium,  bramble,  and  cistus.  Darwin  relates  his  observation  of 
the  same  fact.  More  recently  Professor  Plateau  of  Ghent  has 
removed  the  corollas  of  certain  flowers,  and  found  that  this  proceed- 
ing made  little  difference  to  the  insects  visiting  them.  Bees  may 
also  be  seen  to  visit  abnormally  developed,  as  well  as  half -faded 
flowers.  In  many  cases,  again,  bees  instead  of  using  the  form  of  the 
flower  supposed  to  be  specially  fitted  for  their  convenience,  and  the 
outcome  of  taste,  will  bite  a  hole  near  the  base  of  the  corolla,  and 
get  the  honey  through  it.  These  holes  may  frequently  be  seen  in 
heath  and  the  bush  vetch. 

Again,  if  our  native  flowers  are  the  result  of  the  selective  action 
of  our  native  bees,  and  those  which  they  have  specially  chosen  for 
countless  generations,  how  is  it  that  bees  take  so  readily  to  many 
flowers  of  verv  different  forms  introduced  into  our  gardens  from 
abroad  ?  For  such  introduced  plants  are  in  many  cases  freely  visited 
by  native  bees. 

In  order  to  evolve  and  keep  distinct  new  species  bees  would 
have  to  be  extremely  constant  in  their  visits  to  flowers  :  in  a  single 
journey  from  the  nest,  or  until  they  got  rid  of  all  the  pollen 
adhering  to  their  bodies,  they  would  have  to  visit  only  a  single 
variety.  If  they  did  not  do  so  they  would  not  merely  be  unable  to 
develop  and  differentiate  new  varieties ;  they  would  even  retard  by 
intercrossing,  varieties  developing  into  species  by  any  other  means. 
It  is  pretty  generally  believed  that  the  bee  is  very  constant  in  its 
visits  to  flowers,  and  that  when  it  begins  with  any  particular  species 
it  keeps  to  that  until  it  has  obtained  its  load.  So  long  ago  as  the 
time  of  Aristotle,  indeed,  the  constancy  of  the  bee  was  noted  as  a 
fact  in  natural  history.  But  while  it  is  true  that  bees  do  show  a 
considerable  amount  of  constancy  and  often  visit  a  large  number  of 
flowers  of  the  same  species  in  succession,  they  are  far  from  possessing 
that  amount  of  constancy  required  by  the  theory.  For  this  they 
would  require  to  restrict  themselves,  not  merely  to  a  single  species, 
but  to  one  variety  of  that  species.  This  is  obvious,  since  all  species 
are  supposed  to  have  begun  as  varieties  ;  and  it  is  even  more  import- 
ant that  they  should  restrict  themselves  to  one  variety  than  to  one 
species,  since  such  varieties  will  be  more  readily  crossed  by  transfer- 
ence of  pollen.  But  it  is  a  well-established  fact  that  bees  pass  freely 
from  variety  to  variety  of  the  same  species  in  our  gardens.  Darwin 
has  observed  this,  and  it  is  one  of  the  most  firmly  established  results  of 
my  own  observations.     They  do  not  even  confine  themselves  in  a  single 


104  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

journey  to  varieties  of  the  same  species.  In  numerous  cases  I  have 
seen  bees  visit  two,  three,  and  even  four  species  in  the  course  of  a 
minute  or  two.  The  general  results  of  ray  observations  on  this 
point  are  as  follows  : — 

Hive  bees  are  much  more  constant  than  wild  bees,  yet  they  pass 
freely  from  variety  to  variety,  and  not  by  any  means  rarely  from 
species  to  species.  As  to  the  latter,  take  any  wild  bee,  and  if  you 
can  follow  its  movements  for  twenty  visits  or  more,  the  chances  are 
something  like  ten  to  one  that  it  will  be  seen  to  change  its  species 
of  flower.  If  we  suppose  that  the  bee  of  the  past  acted  as  the  bee 
of  to-day,  then  it  seems  to  me  that  in  this  habit  alone  we  have  a 
complete  refutation  of  the  theory. 

Another  of  the  foundations  of  the  theory  is  the  benefit  supposed 
to  result  from  the  cross-fertilisation  effected  by  the  bee  in  flying 
from  flower  to  flower.  Darwin's  well-known  experiments  on 
cross-fertilisation  point  to  the  conclusion  that  the  seedlings  of 
cross-fertilised  plants  are  more  numerous  and  vigorous  than  those 
of  the  self-fertilised.  Without  wishing  to  throw  doubt  on  the 
general  deductions  from  these  experiments,  I  may  be  permitted  to 
point  out  that  certain  facts  regarding  fertilisation  in  nature  render 
them  of  doubtful  support  to  the  theory.  First,  there  is  the  fact 
that  certain  species  of  flowers  which  are  habitually  self -fertilised  are 
among  the  most  numerous  and  vigorous  of  our  native  plants.  Such, 
for  example,  are  Polygonum  aviculare,  the  least  visited  by  insects, 
and  yet  the  most  abundant  of  its  genus  :  Veronica  hederaefolia, 
one  of  the  commonest  of  the  veronicas,  yet  very  seldom  visited  by 
insects,  as  H.  Midler  points  out :  while  among  the  geraniums,  G. 
molle  and  G.  pwsillum,  which  Midler  states  to  be  the  most  fre- 
quently self-fertilised,  and  perhaps  the  most  common  of  their  genus 
with  the  exception  of  G.  robertianum.  Professor  Henslow,  indeed, 
has  sone  so  far  as  to  state  that  "  in  nature  whenever  self-fertilisation 
can  be  effected  more  seed  is  borne  than  by  the  forms  requiring 
crossing."  Among  the  orchids  again,  some  species  exhibit  the  most 
complicated  arrangements  for  avoiding  self-  and  securing  cross- 
fertilisation  ;  others  exhibit  equal  complications  for  securing  the 
former  and  avoiding  the  latter.  And  if  the  inference  is  that  the 
contrivances  in  the  former  case  were  evolved  because  cross- 
fertilisation  was  an  advantage,  then  it  follows  equally  that  in  the  latter 
case  they  were  evolved  because  self-fertilisation  was  an  advantage 
Darwin,  in  accordance  with  his  general  views  on  cross-fertilisation, 
believed  that  such  self-fertilised  orchids  were  dying  out,  but  the 
increased  number  of  such  now  known  seems  to  forbid  this  view, 
and  it  is  difficult  to  understand  how  such  self-fertilised  orchids  can 
have  been  evolved  from  a  race  specially  fitted  for  cross-fertilisation 
on   the    supposition    that    this    latter   method    is  always  beneficial. 


1897]    BEES  AND  THE  DEVELOPMENT  OE  E LOWERS    105 

Those  flowers  of  the  original  race  which  were  cross-fertilised  should 
have  survived  rather  than  those  self-fertilised.  The  passage  from 
perfect  adaptation  for  cross-fertilisation  to  perfect  adaptation  to 
self-fertilisation  is  a  long  one,  and  must  have  been  spread  over 
many  generations  in  each  of  which  the  latter  was  an  advantage,  if 
it  is  to  be  accounted  for  on  the  principles  of  natural  selection. 
But  it  has  been  suggested  that  the  change  has  been  due  to  the 
absence  of  insects  and  that  thus  only  those  plants  which  were  able 
to  fertilise  themselves  survived.  If,  however,  we  suppose  that  in  the 
ancestral  orchid  the  apparatus  for  cross-fertilisation  was  as  perfect 
as  in  many  species  at  the  present  day,  it  would  be  incapable  of 
self-fertilisation,  and  therefore  die  out  in  the  absence  of  insect 
visits.  Even  if  it  could  in  a  few  cases  fertilise  itself,  how  could  its 
fewer  and  weaker  progeny  compete  with  the  stronger  seedlings  of 
nearly  related  and  cross-fertilised  species  probably  occupying  the 
same  station  ?  If,  however,  in  the  ancestral  orchid  the  arrangement 
for  fertilisation  was  such  that  self-fertilisation  usually  took  place 
in  default  of  insect  visits,  then  no  benefit  would  arise  from  change 
of  form  to  perfect  adaptation  for  self-  and  avoidance  of  insect- 
fertilisation.  With  regard  to  the  benefits  resulting  from  cross- 
fertilisation  generally,  Professor  Henslow  points  out  that  orchids, 
the  most  remarkably  adapted  of  all  plants  for  cross-fertilisation  by 
insects,  "  set  the  least  amount  of  seed  even  when  fully  exposed  to 
insects." 

Another  fact  established  by  Darwin  in  relation  to  cross-fertilisa- 
tion is  that  the  offspring  of  the  cross  is  more  vigorous  when  between 
slight  varieties  of  the  same  species,  or  between  individuals  grown 
under  slightly  different  conditions.  This  fact  is  also  adverse  to  the 
theory  of  the  development  of  a  species  of  flower  by  the  selective 
action  of  the  bee.  For  among  the  offspring  of  the  crosses  affected 
by  it  those  will  be  strongest  which  occur  between  varieties,  or  be- 
tween plants  grown  at  a  distance,  and  therefore  likely  to  differ 
slightly  from  each  other.  But  these  are  precisely  the  individuals 
in  which  the  incipient  characters  tending  to  the  formation  of  a 
new  species  will  be  least  marked.  Hence  the  action  of  the  bee  is 
rather  to  retard  development ;  and  Darwin  himself  has  remarked 
that  frequent  in-crossing  tends  to  give  uniformity  to  species  varying 
slightly  as  they  do  in  a  state  of  nature. 

A  brief  allusion  to  Professor  Henslow's  amendment  of  the 
Darwinian  insect  selection  theory  will  suffice.  Apart  from  the 
extreme  improbability — as  shown  by  recent  research — that  such 
acquired  characters  as  the  lengthening  of  the  petal  of  a  flower  by 
the  weight  of  an  insect  stretching  it,  or  the  coloration  caused  by 
the  irritation  of  an  insect's  feet,  are  transmitted,  Professor  Hens- 
low's  theory  splits  on  the  same  rock  as  the  older  one.     For,  like  the 

H 


106  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

other,  it  requires  a  discriminating  taste  and  constancy  on  the  part 
of  the  bee.  It  involves,  moreover,  the  assumption,  that  while  cer- 
tain simple  and  regular  flowers  visited  by  insects  have  remained 
simple,  others  originally  equally  regular  and  simple  have  had  im- 
pressed on  them  all  sorts  of  irregular  and  complex  forms  by  the 
same  insects  visiting  them  in  the  same  way  and  for  the  same  pur- 
pose. If  the  direct  action  of  the  insect  in  visiting  one  simple  and 
regular  flower  is  to  elongate  one  petal  and  form  a  hood  of  another, 
how  has  it  been  possible  for  it  to  visit  a  host  of  others  for  countless 
generations  without  producing  any  such  effect,  or  altering  the 
simple  regularity  of  their  form  ?  It  is  not  probable,  then,  that 
Professor  Henslow's  amendment  will  be  adopted,  at  least  in  these 
days  of  scientific  doubt  as  to  the  transmission  of  acquired  characters. 
Other  insects,  it  is  generally  admitted,  are  even  less  discriminat- 
ing, and  more  erratic,  in  their  visits  to  flowers  than  bees.  Hence, 
if  bees  cannot  be  accepted  as  evolvers  of  new  species  of  flowers  by 
their  selective  action,  the  whole  theory  of  insect  selection  fails. 
It  remains  a  fact  that  no  alternative  explanation  of  the  origin  of 
the  colour,  scent,  and  form  of  flowers  on  Darwinian  principles  has 
yet  been  brought  forward.  In  this  fact,  indeed,  we  have  the  only 
— if  insufficient — reason  why  the  theory  has  been  so  long  retained. 

Gr.   W.  BULMAN. 

REFERENCES 

1.  Darwin,  C. — "  Origin  of  Species."     London,  1859. 

2.  Lubbock,    Sir  John. — "  British   Wild   Flowers  in  relation  to  Insects."     London, 

1875. 

3.  Darwin,  C. — "Cross-  and  Self-fertilisation  of  Plants."     London,  1876. 

4.  Bennett,  A.  W. — "  Constancy  of  Insects  in  their  visits  to  Flowers."     Journ.  Linn. 

Soc.  Zool.,  vol.  xvii.,  p.  175.     1883. 

5.  Christy,  R.  M. — "  On  Methodic  Habits  of  Insects  when  visiting  Flowers."     Ibid., 

p.  186. 

6.  Allen,  Grant.  —  "  The  Colours  of  Flowers."     London,  1882. 

7.  Mllller,  Hermann. — "  The  Fertilisation  of  Flowers  "  [English  translation].    London, 

1883. 

8.  Henslow,  Rev.  George.— "  Floral  Structures."     London,  1888. 

9.  Bulman,   G.    W.— "  On    the    Supposed    Selective    Action   of    Bees   on   Flowers." 

Zoologist  [3],  vol.  xiv.,  p.  422.     1890. 
10. .— "  The  Constancy  of  the  Bee."     Science  Gossip,  1892. 


581.151  107 

589.3 


IV 

Polymorphism  in  the  Algae 

THE  following  is  a  translation  of  an  extract  (pp.  171-186)  from 
Professor  Klebs'  recent  work  "  Die  Bedingungen  der  Fort- 
pflanzung  bei  einigen  Algen  und  Pilzen,"  Jena,  1896,  reviewed  in 
Natural  Science,  vol.  x.,  p.  128  (Feb.  1897). 

The  pages  in  question  are  written  a  propos  of  Prof.  Klebs' 
interesting  discovery  that  the  well-known  alga,  Botrydium  granu- 
latum,  is  not  in  reality  so  polymorphic  as  the  botanical  world  has 
believed  since  the  publication  in  1877  of  Eostafinski  and  Woronin's 
researches,  but  that  the  forms  therein  described  belong,  in  reality, 
to  two  very  distinct  algae,  Botrydium  granulatum,  Wallroth,  and 
Brotococcus  botryoidcs,  Kiitzing,  the  latter  being  renamed  Brotosiphon 
lotryoidcs  (Kiitzing)  Klebs. 

But  my  immediate  object  is  not  so  much  to  call  attention  to 
this  or  any  other  of  the  interesting  discoveries  of  which  an  account 
is  given  in  Prof.  Klebs'  important  book,  as  to  put  into  a  form  easily 
accessible  to  everyone  interested  a  most  lucid  and  admirable  dis- 
cussion on  a  question  which,  to  judge  from  my  own  experience, 
must  continually  perplex  students  of  algal  literature.  No  one  who 
knows  his  work  can  doubt  Prof.  Klebs'  authority  to  speak  on  the 
topic,  and  it  is  unfortunate  that  his  luminous  remarks,  which  are 
perfectly  complete  in  themselves,  should  remain  buried  in  the 
middle  of  a  chapter  of  his  bulky  volume,  where  they  can  only  be 
read  by  a  few  specialists.  Prof.  Klebs  and  his  publisher,  Dr 
Fischer  of  Jena,  have  most  kindly  accorded  me  permission  to 
publish  this  translation.  A.  G.  Tansley. 

Although  a  number  of  the  lower  green  algae  were  described  in 
the  first  half  of  this  century,  it  was  by  Kiitzing  and  Nageli  that  the 
foundation  of  our  present  knowledge  of  these  forms  was  laid. 
Kiitzing  described  an  enormous  number  of  species  which  he 
distributed  partly  into  new  genera,  partly  into  those  which  Nageli 
had  with  admirable  judgment  already  established.  Side  by  side 
with  the  tendency  to  a  thorough-going  splitting  of  species,  we  find 
in  Kiitzing  the  belief  that  lower  algae  transform  themselves  into 
higher  forms,  even  into  mess-protonema.  Hitherto  these  poly- 
morphistic  ideas  of  Kiitzing's  have  not  succeeded  in  establishing 
themselves,  since  they  are  obviously  based  on  too  cursory  investiga- 


108  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

tions.  The  description  of  new  species  and  genera  of  lower  algae  went 
quietly  forward  till  Cienkowski  published  in  1876  his  observations 
on  the  palmella- condition  of  the  filamentous  algae,  Stigeoclonium, 
Ulothrix,  etc.  These  very  reliable  observations  seemed  to  prove 
that  lower  algae  are  only  developmental  stages  of  the  filamentous 
forms.  Cienkowski  himself,  and  other  workers  also,  went  so  far 
as  to  express  doubt  as  to  the  independence  of  most  unicellular 
green  algae.  In  order  to  decide  the  question,  I  established  from 
1879  to  1881  many  cultures  of  these  forms.  My  observations, 
from  which  I  published  a  short  extract  in  1883,  showed  that  the 
lower  algae,  treated  by  the  methods  then  accessible  to  me,  were  as 
much  independent  organisms  and  remained  as  constant  as  any 
higher  plant.  The  common,  universally  distributed  organism, 
Pleurococcus  vulgaris,  for  instance,  reproduced  itself  only  by 
vegetative  division,  and  it  could  not  by  any  method  be  converted 
into  another  alga.  Artari  (1892)  again  investigated  this  question, 
and  answered  it  in  the  same  sense.  Gay  also  (1891)  has  proved 
by  means  of  cultures  the  independence  both  of  Pleurococcus  and  of 
other  forms.  Nevertheless,  the  old  idea  of  a  far-reaching  poly- 
morphism among  the  algae  is  constantly  reappearing. 

Since  Hansgirg  in  1885  came  to  the  conclusion  that  all  possible 
algae  are  forms  of  a  single  species,  and  thus  showed  himself  as 
uncritical  as  Kiitzing  before  him  (cf.  my  criticism,  Botanischc 
Zcitung,  1886),  Chodat,  and  especially  Borzi,  have  quite  recently 
announced  the  genetic  connection  of  many  algae  which  were 
hitherto  considered  independent.  Both  workers  have  tried  to  give 
greater  weight  to  their  opinions  by  means  of  evidence  obtained  from 
culture  experiments.  To  what  an  extent  Borzi  is  dominated  by  the 
idea  of  polymorphism  is  shown  in  his  most  recent  work  (1895)  by 
the  treatment  of  the  life  cycle  of  "  Protoderma  viride,"  to  which  he 
assigns  species  of  the  following  genera :  Protococcus,  Botryococcus, 
Chlorococcus,  Limnodictyon,  Physodictyon,  Palmella,  Tetraspora, 
Neplirocytium,  Trochiscia,  Oocystis,  Sccnedesmus,  Raphidium.  The 
connection  of  all  these  forms  Borzi  thinks  he  has  proved  by  means 
of  cultures.  According  to  the  view  of  this  worker,  the  various 
developmental  states  have  "  stadii  anamorfici";  thus,  for  instance, 
the  Raphidium-  and  Scenedcsmus-iorms '  have  the  power  under 
certain  circumstances  of  remaining  and  multiplying  as  such  for 
years,  and  then  when  opportunity  offers  they  again  turn  into  the 
higher  forms. 

Chodat  does  not  go  nearly  so  far  as  Borzi  in  his  belief  in 
polymorphism,  and  he  expresses  himself  less  clearly  and  distinctly. 
He  contents  himself  with  believing  (1893-4-5)  that  such  an  alga  as 
for  instance  Raphidium,  is  very  variable,  so  that  it  may  take  on  the 
form  of  a  Sccnedesmus,  a  Protococcus,  a  Characium,  a  DactylococcusT 
or  a  Sciadium.      The  Sccnedesmus  behaves  under  certain  circum- 


1897]  POLYMORPHISM  IN  THE  ALGAE  109 

stances  as  a  Dactylococcws,  and  the  latter  as  a  Sccnedesmus.     But  in 
spite  of  all  his  belief  in  the  existence  of  transitions  between  the 
various  forms  of  lower  algae,  in  spite  of  the  fluctuation  of  all  their 
characters  and  of  the  melting  away  of  all  limits,  Chodat  still  holds  to  a 
certain  independence  in  the  various  types ;  only  it  does  not  appear  from 
anything  he  says  whether  the  deviations  from  these  types  are  due  to 
the  definite  effects  of  external  conditions  or  whether  they  belong  to 
constant   varieties   or    races.      Neither   has    Chodat    always    drawn 
accurate  inferences.      If  his  observation  is  correct,  that  the  already- 
mentioned  Pleurococcus  vulgaris  can  grow  out  into  a  Stigeoclonium, 
it  must  be  assigned  to  the  branched  filamentous  type  of  algae.      But 
Chodat  says,  "  I  do  not  think  that  Pleurococcus  is  a  state  of  a  higher 
alga.      I  think   that   it  must  be  considered  as  a  type  degenerated 
through  the  influence  of  its  habitat,  and  which  in  water  and  under 
favourable  conditions  can  tend  towards  its  primitive  state."     Thus 
Pleurococcus  is  to  be   considered  a  degeneration-form  of  a  Stigeo- 
chmiam,  although  it  behaves  as  an  independent  simple  alga.      If  one 
takes  the  observations  of  Chodat  and  Borzi  together,  so  far  as  they 
relate  to  the  same  form,  for  instance  Baphidium  polymorphum  (or 
braunii),  one  obtains  a  picture  of  a  species  which  for  excentricity 
certainly  leaves  nothing  to  be  desired,  and  which  is  unique  in  the 
organic   world.      Baphidium,   according   to    Borzi,    belongs    to    the 
cycle  of  forms  of  various  higher  algae  (Prasiola,  Ulothrix,  etc.) ;  it 
is  produced  in    this  way — two  zoospores,  in  consequence  of  their 
escape  from  the  sporangium  taking  place  abnormally,  grow  together 
by  their  hinder  ends,  and  this  pair  then  turns  into  a  Baphidium 
(Borzi,  1895,  p.   231,  "  My  cultures  exclude  all  doubt  as  to  this 
fact ").     If  it  had  not  been  such  a  well-known  and  eminent  algologist 
as  Borzi  who  put  forward  these  opinions  they  would  not  have  been 
worth  the  trouble  of  wasting  a  word  upon,  but  under  the  circum- 
stances they  must  be  taken  into  account.      In  any  case  it  is  clear 
from  what  has  been  said,  that  unlimited  confusion  prevails  in  the 
classification  of  the  lower  algae,  and  that  the  most   contradictory 
views  are  held  even  about  the  simplest  and  commonest  organisms 
such  as  Pleurococcus,  Baphidium,  etc. 

We  cannot  decide  on  theoretical  grounds  whether  a  form  is 
independent  or  genetically  connected  with  another.  It  has  in  fact 
happened  in  the  history  of  the  subjects  that  forms  which  at  one 
time  were  considered  independent  have  been  certainly  proved  to  be 
developmental  states  of  other  species.  It  is  conceivable  that  out  of 
the  enormous  number  of  described  species  of  algae  many  others  will 
meet  with  the  same  fate.  The  only  possible  way  to  arrive  at  clearness 
and  knowledge  is  to  use  a  -scientific  method  which  will  stand  the 
test  of  criticism. 

It  is  remarkable  that  so  little  has  been  learnt  from  the  history 


110  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

of  science.  In  the  history  of  botany  the  same  struggle  about  poly- 
morphism has  taken  place  twice,  first  in  the  case  of  the  fungi  and 
then  in  that  of  the  bacteria.  On  both  occasions  as  it  gradually  be- 
came recognised  that  the  pure  culture  of  the  organisms  in  question 
is  the  necessary  starting  point  of  every  research,  the  fruitless 
theoretical  discussions  were  replaced  by  work  on  really  scientific 
lines.  Likewise  in  the  present  case ;  for  the  solution  of  the 
problems  with  which  they  were  concerned  Chodat  and  Borzi 
ought  to  have  started  with  pure  cultures  ;  but  this  is  just  what 
they  failed  to  do.  The  method  of  pure  cultivation  has  hitherto  played 
no  part  in  algology  ;  our  knowledge  has  been  obtained  by  the  method 
of  direct  observation,  which  has  been  employed  in  a  most  thorough 
way  by  such  investigators  as  Thuret,  Cohn,  Pringsheim,  De  Bary, 
and  others.  The  fact  is  that  the  distinctive  characters  of  many 
algae  are  quite  sufficient  to  allow  of  their  recognition  among  other 
organisms,  and  to  enable  their  development  to  be  followed  by  con- 
tinuous direct  observation ;  and  the  artificial  cultivation  of  many 
of  these  algae  is  beset  with  great  difficulties.  There  are  also 
many  of  the  lower  algae  among  which  no  confusion  arises  in 
impure  cultures.  Forms  such  as  Hydrodictyon,  for  instance,  allow 
of  their  entire  development  being  observed  in  the  presence  of  other 
larger  or  smaller  forms.  But  the  matter  is  quite  otherwise  in  all 
those  algae  which  possess  but  few  external  readily  recognisable 
characters,  and  among  which  at  the  same  time  there  is  such  a 
multiplicity  of  closely  allied  species  that  all  possible  so-called 
transitional  forms  exist.  This  is  the  case,  for  instance,  in  the 
subaerial  Ulothrix-like  organisms,  and  also  among  the  lower  green 
algae  such  as  the  numerous  species  of  Pleurococcus,  Protococcus, 
Palmetto,,  etc.,  which  are  extremely  easy  to  confound  with  one 
another.  Furthermore,  the  higher  algae  possess  developmental 
stages  which  to  outward  appearance  are  exactly  like  certain 
lower  forms ;  and  the  false  conclusion  that  therefore  all  lower  algae 
are  developmental  forms  of  higher  algae  is  often  enough  drawn. 
Swarming  gametes  of  Chlamydomonas  cannot  be  distinguished 
from  gametes  of  Ulothrix;  but  it  does  not  follow  that  Chlamy- 
domonas belongs  to  Ulothrix.  Similarly  filamentous  algae  form 
Protococcus-like  stages ;  but  again  it  does  not  follow  that  all  species 
of  Protococcus  belong  to  filamentous  algae.  Simple  similarity  in 
appearance  or  the  apparent  identity  of  two  forms  decides  nothing, 
and  anyone  who  relies  upon  it  runs  the  risk  of  falling  into  the 
grossest  error.  Even  two  such  distinguished  investigators  as  Iiosta- 
finski  and  Woronin  were  baffled  in  their  observations  on  Botrydium 
simply  because  the  developmental  stages  of  the  real  Botrydium  and 
of  Protosiphon  have  a  striking  external  resemblance. 

The  question  now  presents  itself,  how  must  we  proceed  in  order 


1897]  POLYMORPHISM  IN  THE  ALGAE  111 

to  solve  the  problem  of  the  independence  or  genetic  connexion  of 
two  or  more  algae  with  the  greatest  possible  certainty  ?  In  my 
view  such  an  investigation  demands  attention  to  three  important 
points  : — 

(1)  The  pure   cultivation  of   the  organisms  in   question 

Just  as  a  pure  culture  is  obviously  essential  for  any  research 
into  the  history  of  development  of  a  fungus  or  of  a  bacterium,  a 
similar  culture  is  the  necessary  starting  point  in  the  investigation 
of  the  life-history  of  a  lower  alga.  In  general,  the  algae  grow 
much  more  slowly  than  the  fungi  and  bacteria  ;  cultures,  therefore, 
have  to  be  maintained  for  a  longer  period,  and  the  chance  of  the 
accidental  introduction  of  foreign  forms  into  an  originally  pure 
culture  must  not  be  neglected.  Minute  cells  or  spores  of  Proto- 
coccoideae,  etc.,  are  present  in  the  dust  of  the  air.  It  is  only 
necessary  to  leave  a  sterilised  solution  of  nutritive  salts,  not  very 
well  protected,  in  the  light,  in  order  to  convince  oneself  that  algae 
set  into  it  with  the  dust.  It  is  clear  from  the  works  of  Chodat  and 
Borzi,  that  these  workers  had  only  impure  cultures  at  their  disposal, 
since,  on  the  one  hand,  they  used  material  taken  direct  from  its 
natural  habitat,  and  containing  numerous  species  of  algae,  and  on 
the  other,  they  paid  no  attention  to  the  sources  of  error  arising  from 
the  exposure  of  their  cultures  to  dust. 

(2)  Direct    observation 

In  the  case  of  the  lower  algae  it  is  always  necessary  to  observe 
directly  under  the  microscope,  the  course  of  development  or  the 
transformation  of  one  form  of  cell  into  another.  In  default  of  a 
pure  culture,  this  method  may,  under  certain  circumstances,  do 
instead ;  but  it  should  be  used  in  any  case,  even  if  the  culture  is  to 
all  appearance  pure.  A  combination  of  the  two  methods  leads  to 
very  certain  results.  Chodat  and  Borzi  have  employed  them  far 
too  little.  For  instance,  Borzi  ought  to  have  isolated  the  double 
zoospores  of  Prasiola,  etc.,  and  then  uninterruptedly  observed  their 
subsequent  fate,  in  order  to  convince  himself  that  they  actually 
turned  into  Baphidium.  And  similarly  it  would  be  necessary  to 
observe  directly  the  development  of  the  filamentous  alga,  whether 
Prasiola  or  Protoderma,  from  Baphidium,  a  thing  which  it  appears 
Borzi  never  really  saw.  The  same  criticism  holds  in  regard  to 
Chodat's  statement  that  Pleurococcus  vulgaris  changes  into  Stigeo- 
clonium.  The  immediate  transformation  of  an  undoubted  Pleurococcus 
cell  into  a  Stigeoclonium  has  not  been  seen,  any  more  than  a  trans- 
formation of  the  latter  into  Pleurococcus. 


112  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

(3)  An  accurate  knowledge  of  the  conditions  under  which 
the  individual  developmental  stages  occur,  or  the 
transformation  of  one   form   into   another   obtains 

This  point  has  received  as  yet  scarcely  any  attention  in  algae  or 
other  organisms,  e.g.,  fungi,  and  such  knowledge  has  never  been 
recognised  as  necessary,  since  it  has  not  hitherto  been  believed  that 
it  was  possible  to  determine  these  conditions.  In  works  which  deal 
with  polymorphism,  from  Klitzing  to  Borzi,  great  significance  has.  it 
is  true,  been  attributed  to  external  conditions  in  the  transformation 
of  forms,  but  only  in  quite  a  general,  undefined  and  vague  way. 
Never  in  any  case  has  a  given  developmental  form  been  clearly 
recognised  and  demonstrated  as  the  necessary  consequence  of  definite 
external  conditions ;  such  forms  have  mostly  been  observed  merely 
by  chance.  In  his  work  on  Eremosphaera,  Chodat  describes,  besides 
the  well-known  typical  cells,  certain  dwarf  forms  with  somewhat 
different  structure,  he  describes  Pahnclla-Gloeocystis-st&ges,  he  also 
brings  a  Chlamydomonas-iovm  into  connexion  with  these ;  all  of 
which  are  developmental  forms  or  (it  may  be)  independent  species 
found  accidentally  in  the  same  culture  of  Eremosphaera.  "We  never 
get  a  hint  of  an  explanation  how  such  various  states  of  the  same 
alga  can  appear  in  the  same  culture. 

But  since  my  observations  have  shown  that  external  conditions 
actually  decide  the  appearance  of  the  reproductive  stages  of  many 
algae,  it  has  become  necessary  in  all  similar  work  to  attempt  at 
least  to  discover  the  appropriate  conditions  of  the ,  appearance  of 
each  developmental  form. 

The  next  goal  to  be  attained  is  such  an  exact  knowledge  of  the 
conditions  that  we  can  elicit  a  given  developmental  form  at  will. 
Such  investigations  as  these  naturally  demand  much  time  and 
trouble ;  and  even  so  in  the  case  of  many  organisms  they  do  not 
lead  to  the  desired  result.  Thus,  in  certain  species,  in  spite  of  the 
firm  conviction  that  external  conditions  must  be  of  great  significance, 
these  conditions  are  not  yet  sufficiently  clearly  understood,  as  for 
instance  in  the  case  of  Ulothrix  zonata,  ITormidium  nitens,  etc. 
Thus  there  remains  a  gap  in  our  knowledge,  which,  later  on, 
with  the  aid  of  better  methods,  will  be  filled  up.  On  the  other 
hand,  there  is  the  alternative  that  a  given  developmental  form  is 
produced  as  a  result  of  the  operation  of  inner  causes  which  we  are 
not  able  to  elucidate  ;  in  that  case  we  shall  find  by  experience  that 
it  will  appear  quite  regularly  and  can  always  be  observed  at  the 
appropriate  stage  in  the  life-history  of  the  species.  But  in  all  the 
lower  algae — and  these  are  the  forms  I  am  specially  considering 
here — my  whole  experience  leads  necessarily  to  the  conviction  that 
external  conditions  determine  the  appearance  of  each  developmental 


1897]  POLYMORPHISM  IN  THE  ALGAE  113 

form ;  and  hence  in  all  work  on  such  algae  this  line  of  investigation 
demands  the  greatest  attention. 

If  in  the  future  the  lower  algae  are  investigated  on  the  lines 
I  have  indicated,  it  will  be  possible  for  us  to  emerge  from  the 
confusion  prevailing  at  present,  and  to  bring  the  study  of  these 
organisms  on  to  a  higher  plane.  Such  investigations  will,  according 
to  my  view,  be  of  very  great  value  in  advancing  the  systematic  know- 
ledge of  species,  not  only  because  they  will  enable  the  cycle  of  forms 
belonging  to  a  given  species  to  be  completely  determined,  but  also 
because  in  the  diagnosis  of  the  species  they  will  enable  new  charac- 
ters to  be  recognised.  The  way  in  which  the  various  stages  in  the  life- 
history  of  a  lower  organism  react  to  external  conditions,  especially 
the  way  in  which  its  reproduction  depends  upon  the  external  world, 
furnish  specific  characters  as  important  as  the  morphological  ones. 
And  these  physiological  characters  become  so  much  the  more 
valuable  in  proportion  as  the  external  characters  become  less  con- 
spicuous. In  the  bacteria  we  have  already  been  compelled  to  take 
such  characters  into  account ;  and  the  time  is  not  far  distant  when 
it  will  be  self-evident  that  in  the  diagnosis  of  a  new  alga,  there 
must  be  placed  alongside  of  the  accurate  description  of  its  structure 
and  the  history  of  its  development,  a  clear  account  of  its  behaviour 
in  relation  to  the  external  world.  To-day  the  mere  determination 
and  the  giving  of  a  name  to  a  species  is  far  too  generally  the 
sole  aim  in  systematic  botany,  and  it  is  here,  among  these  lower 
organisms,  that  the  proper  goal  of  the  systematic  knowledge  of 
plants  may  be  soonest  reached — to  present  a  complete  picture  of  all 
the  peculiarities  of  each  several  organism. 

The  whole  of  my  more  recent  experiments  with  algae  confirm 
my  earlier  experience,  and  correspond  with  the  results  of  the  in- 
vestigation of  bacteria  and  fungi — they  show,  namely,  that  within 
the  time  available  for  experiment,  the  hereditary  characters  of  an 
organism  are  not  markedly  altered  by  external  conditions.  The 
variations  in  size,  form,  cell-structure,  and  reaction  to  external 
influences,  oscillate  within  definite  limits — limits  which  up  to  the 
present  we  have  not  been  able  to  pass.  The  constancy  of  the  species 
meets  us  with  striking  clearness  in  all  cultivations  and  experiments 
under  existing  conditions ;  it  remains  for  further  experiments,  carried 
on  for  longer  periods,  and  with  the  aid  of  better  methods,  to  decide 
whether  these  limits  cannot  be  broken  through.  The  important 
observations  on  certain  bacteria,  in  which  it  was  found  that  heredi- 
tary characters  such  as  virulence  and  pigment-production,  could  be 
suppressed  for  a  long  time,  point  in  this  direction.  But  anything 
like  such  a  result  has  not  hitherto  been  obtained  among  the  algae, 
although  it  is  possible  that  it  may  be  obtained  in  the  future. 

In  spite  of  the  actual  constancy  of  specific  character  among  the 


114  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

algae,  the  difficulty  of  arranging  the  species  into  genera  and  families 
is  extraordinarily  great,  since  there  has  been  an  enormous  multi- 
plicity of  species  production.  There  exist,  between  the  species 
typical  of  the  various  genera,  numerous  other  forms,  varieties,  etc., 
each  of  which  is  a  perfectly  constant  type,  but  which  confuse  the 
limits  between  genera  and  families.  Very  soon  the  dictum  which 
I  laid  down  in  connexion  with  my  systematic  working  up  of  the 
Flagellata  in  1892,  will  apply  equally  well  to  the  algae,  namely, 
that  the  more  we  take  into  consideration  the  multitude  of  forms, 
the  more  difficult  to  construct  and  the  more  artificial  our  system 
becomes.  The  contradiction  between  the  constancy  of  the  single 
form,  whether  we  call  it  species  or  variety,  and  the  variability  of  all 
characters  within  the  limits  of  an  extended  circle  of  forms,  be  it 
genus  or  family,  has  not  yet  been  explained ;  Darwinian  teaching 
has  brought  clearly  to  light  the  existence  of  this  contradiction,  but 
it  has  not  yet  discovered  how  to  resolve  it. 

Geobg  Klebs. 


575.2  115 


V 

On  the  Scientific  Measure  of  Variability 

a  HO  review  the  reviewer  is  always  a  profitless  task,  and  yet  I 
am  tempted  to  repeat  what  must  be  more  or  less  of  a  failure. 
In  this  case,  however,  the  reviewer  happens  to  be  a  man  whose 
opinion  deservedly  carries  weight,  and  many  readers  may  consider 
that  he  must  have  fairly  epitomised  the  statements  made  in  my 
paper  on  "  Variation  in  Man  and  Woman."  This  does  not  seem  to 
me  to  be  the  case ;  and,  in  justice  to  myself,  I  wish  to  distinctly 
repudiate  one  or  two  opinions  Professor  Weldon  fastens  upon  me 
{Natural  Science,  vol.  xi.,  pp.  50-54). 

In  the  first  place,  Professor  Weldon  states  that  the  object  of 
my  paper  "  is  to  support  the  contention  that  women  are,  on  the 
whole,  more  variable  than  men."  I  wish  to  entirely  disclaim  any 
such  object.  The  paper  was  written  with  the  purely  scientific 
aim  of  comparing  the  variation  of  man  and  woman,  and  was  due 
to  the  fact  that  a  study  of  numerous  writers  on  the  subject  had  led 
me  to  believe  that  there  was  as  yet  no  evidence  to  show  greater 
variation  in  one  sex  than  the  other  ;  that  most  of  the  reasoning  on 
the  subject  was  invalid  and  nearly  all  partizan.  I  may  safely  say 
that  the  two  friends  who  undertook  with  me  the  lengthy  arithmetic 
involved  had  no  "  contention "  and  no  bias.  We  simply  thought 
that  no  evidence  of  a  satisfactory  kind  was  forthcoming, 
in  the  case  of  man,  for  Darwin's  law  of  the  greater  variability 
of  the  male  ;  and  we  determined,  so  far  as  was  possible,  to 
undertake  a  thorough  investigation  of  the  question.  And  what  is 
the  general  conclusion  reached  ?  That  the  female  is  more  variable 
than  the  male — which  is  the  impression  any  reader  must  form 
from  Professor  Weldon's  review  ?  Not  at  all.  In  the  summary 
I  distinctly  state  that,  in  the  material  considered,  there  is  no 
evidence  of  greater  male  variability,  but  rather  of  a  slightly 
greater  female  variability.  In  the  body  of  the  paper  it  is  stated 
that  the  less  civilised  races  have  nearly  equal  variability  for  the 
two  sexes,  while,  in  the  more  highly  civilised,  woman — probably 
owing  to  the  lessening  of  her  struggle  for  existence  as  compared 
with  man — has  apparently  greater  variability.  I  conclude  : — "  I 
would  ask  the  reader  to  note  that  I  do  not  proclaim  the  equal 
variability  of  the  sexes,  but  merely  assert  that  the  present  results 
show  that  the  greater  variability  often  claimed  for  man  remains  as 


116  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

yet  a  quite  unproven  principle."  The  "  contention  "  of  the  paper 
is  that  there  is  no  proof  forthcoming  of  man's  greater  variability. 
Whether  either  sex  is  the  more  variable  is  left  for  the  future  to 
settle  in  the  following  words  : — 

"  When  more  material  is  available,  and  finer  methods  are 
applied,  then  perhaps  it  will  be  possible  to  detect  a  more  note- 
worthy preponderance  of  variability  in  the  one  or  other  sex." 
And,  again,  in  referring  to  the  slight  preponderance  of  variability 
observed  in  woman  : — "  I  strongly  suspect  that  this  preponderating 
variability  of  women  is  mainly  due  to  a  relatively  less  severe 
struggle  for  existence."  These  are  not  the  words  of  one  whose 
"  object  is  to  support  the  contention  that  women  are,  on  the  whole, 
more  variable  than  men."  They  seem  to  me  the  words  of  one  who 
wishes  to  reach  a  scientific  conclusion  without  any  party  or  sex 
bias. 

In  the  next  place,  Professor  Weldon  objects  to  my  use  of  the 
co-efficient  of  variation.  He  apparently  wishes  to  assert  that 
absolute  variation  is  the  real  test  of  most  things.  I  am  some- 
what surprised  to  see  him  advocating  this  test.  It  is  not  so 
many  months  since  an  American  critic  pointed  out  how  fatally 
this  measurement  of  variation  affected  the  conclusions  of  a  certain 
paper  of  Professor  Weldon's  on  selective  mortality  in  crabs.  I 
have  not  seen  any  answer  to  that  criticism,  and  I  very  much  doubt 
if  one  can  be  found.  Some  years  ago  I  pointed  out  to  him  that 
the  same  measurement  of  variability  led  to  absurd  results  in  the 
case  of  the  selective  mortality  of  men. 

But  even  here  Professor  Weldon  puts  in  my  mouth  opinions  I 
have  never  expressed.  He  writes : — "  The  violent  assertion  that 
there  is  only  one  '  scientific '  measure  of  variability  is  therefore  to 
be  regretted."  Now,  so  far  from  asserting  the  validity  of  only  one 
measure  of  variability,  I  carefully  state  in  paragraph  (c)  of  my 
conclusions  : — 

"  There  is  more  than  one  method  of  quantitatively  measuring 
variability,  but  the  measure  which  is  really  significant  for  pro- 
gressive evolution  has  not  hitherto  been  determined." 

On  p.  343  I  write,  "  We  may  stay  to  ask  whether  the  statistics 
of  skull  capacity  do  not  in  themselves  give  us  any  information  with 
regard  to  the  superiority  of  either  standard  deviation  or  the  co- 
efficient of  variation  as  a  test  of  that  variability  which  is  valuable 
for  progressive  evolution,"  and  on  p.  345  I  conclude  that  the 
results  do  not  enable  us  to  say  offhand  that  absolute  or  percentage 
variation  is  a  better  measure  of  the  variability  which  is  a  source 
of  progressive  evolution.  These  are  hardly  the  words  of  one  who 
lias  made  a  "  violent  assertion  that  there  is  only  one  measure  of 
variability." 


1897]   THE  SCIENTIFIC  MEASURE  OF  VARIABILITY    111 

What  is  it  then  that  I  have  asserted  ?  Simply  this,  that  if  it 
be  necessary  to  compare  the  variability  of  the  same  organ  in  two 
sexes  which  have  on  the  average  different  sizes,  it  is  absurd  to  use 
absolute  variations.  This  conclusion  is  nothing  new  ;  it  has  long- 
been  familiar  to  craniologists  and  anthropologists.  They  have,  for 
instance,  compared  brain-weight  relative  to  body-weight  or  to 
stature.  I  contend  that  the  proper  measure  is  the  percentage 
variation  on  the  mean.  My  words  are,  "  I  hold  that  the  only 
useful  sense  in  which  we  can  study  relative  variability  is  by 
endeavouring  to  answer  the  problem.  Is  one  sex  closer  to  its 
mean,  more  conservative  to  its  type  than  the  other?  and  that 
the  only  scientific  answer  to  this  lies  in  the  magnitudes  of  the 
percentage  variations  of  the  two  sexes  for  corresponding  organs." 
It  will  be  seen  at  once  that  this  is  not,  as  Professor  Weldon  appears 
to  misinterpret  it,  an  assertion  of  a  single  scientific  measure  of 
variability  but  a  statement  of  opinion  as  to  the  only  useful  way 
in  which  we  can  compare  in  the  two  sexes  the  relative  variability 
in  the  same  organ.  Professor  "Weldon,  indeed,  seems  to  confuse 
two  things,  the  scientific  measure  of  variability  and  the  effectiveness 
of  this  variability  for  different  organs  in  the  struggle  for  existence. 
Because  the  variability  of  one  organ  is  said  to  be  twice  that  of 
another  organ,  it  does  not  follow  that  the  functional  importance  is 
doubled.  The  scientific  measure  of  variability  is  one  thing,  the 
effectiveness  of  this  amount  of  variability  in  the  struggle  for  exist- 
ence is  another  and  different  thing.  But  even  here  I  am  prepared 
to  assert,  although  I  have  not  done  so  in  my  paper,  that  the  co- 
efficient of  variation,  without  being  proportional  to  the  "  effective- 
ness," is  far  more  reasonable  as  a  measure  of  effectiveness,  when  we 
are  dealing  with  the  same  organ  in  different  sexes,  or  in  individuals 
of  the  same  sex  at  different  ages,  than  absolute  variation.  It  seems  to 
me  that  the  non-regard  of  this  point  has  led  to  the  nugatory  character 
— not  of  the  splendid  system  of  measurements  on  crabs  made  by  Pro- 
fessor Weldon — but  of  several  of  the  conclusions  he  has  endeavoured 
to  base  upon  those  measurements.  I  cannot  get  over  the  fact  that 
the  variation  of  an  inch  in  the  leg  of  a  pony  is  not  the  same  thing 
as  a  variation  of  an  inch  in  the  leg  of  a  horse.  Out  of  the  155 
cases  dealt  with  in  my  paper,  woman  is  in  62  or  63,  I  think, 
absolutely  more  variable  than  man,  and  man  absolutely  more 
variable  in  some  85  ;  in  the  remainder  the  sexes  are  sensibly  equal. 
But  since  woman  is  smaller  than  man  in  the  weight  and  size  of  nearly 
all  organs,  absolute  variability  can  only  be  adopted  with  the  same 
justification  as  we  should  say  that  an  inch  is  the  same  variation  in 
the  leg  of  a  pony  or  a  horse,  -or  a  cubic  centimeter  the  same  varia- 
tion in  the  capacity  of  the  brain  of  a  man  or  a  new-born  infant. 

If  Professor  Weldon  asserts  that  taking  the  co-efficient  of  variation 


118  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

as  a  standard,  then  the  same  amount  of  variation  in  man  and  woman 
has  more  effectiveness  in  one  sex  than  the  other,  I  must  reply,  no 
one  has  yet  investigated  this  point ;  my  own  conclusions  on  skull 
measurements,  so  far  as  they  have  yet  gone,  seem  to  show  that  the 
co-efficient  is  at  least  a  rough  measurement  of  effectiveness.  But  it 
must  be  clear  that  until  we  have  investigated  the  relation  of  effective- 
ness to  some  clear  measure  of  variation,  Darwin's  law  of  the  greater 
variability  of  the  male  is  entirely  unproven.  Whether  we  put 
effectiveness  as  a  function  of  mean  and  of  standard  deviation,  or  as 
a  function  of  mean  and  the  ratio  of  standard  deviation  to  mean,  is 
not,  at  first  sight,  a  matter  of  great  importance ;  it  is  to  be  settled 
rather  by  what  the  algebraist  considers  a  convenient  shape  for  his 
formulae.  It  is  the  biologist  who  has  to  determine  the  form  of  the 
function.  It  probably  varies  widely  from  species  to  species  and 
organ  to  organ,  but  it  may  reasonably  be  supposed  to  vary  only 
continuously  and  gradually  with  age  and  sex.  If  the  selective 
death-rate  of  any  species,  however,  be  a  function  only  of  the  mean 
and  standard-deviation  of  any  particular  organ,  then  the  theory  of 
dimensions  shows  us  at  once  that  the  death-rate  cannot  be  a 
function  solely  of  absolute  variation,  but  must  be  a  function  of  the 
ratio  of  absolute  variation  to  the  mean,  i.e.,  of  the  co-efficient  of 
variation. 

Lastly,  if  Professor  Weldon  thinks  I  have  reviewed  my  biological 
critic  harshly,  I  would  remark  that  I  submitted  my  paper  a  year 
ago  in  proof  to  a  valued  biological  friend,  I  still  have  in  a  familiar 
hand-writing  "no  suggestions  to  make."  That  Professor  Weldon 
should  find  in  my  paper  a  "  violent  assertion  "  to  be  regretted,  con- 
firms my  view  that  modern  biology  is  a  house  divided  against  itself. 

Karl  Pearson. 


572.(94.2)  119 


VI 

Initiation  Kites  of  the  Arunta  Tribe, 
Central  Australia 

IN  Natural  Science  for  April  of  this  year  (vol.  x.,  pp.  254-2G3) 
we  gave  an  account  of  the  Horn  Expedition  to  Central  Aus- 
tralia, and  drew  special  attention  to  the  valuable  anthropological 
observations  of  Mr  F.  J.  Gillen.  This  gentleman's  residence  of 
fourteen  years  among  the  Aruntas  of  Alice  Springs  in  Central 
Australia  has  enabled  him  to  associate  himself  with  them  on 
terms  of  the  closest  intimacy,  and  he  is  looked  on  as  a  full 
member  of  the  tribe.  Since  the  Horn  Expedition,  three  years 
ago,  Professor  Baldwin  Spencer  of  Melbourne  has  been  in  constant 
correspondence  with  Mr  Gillen,  and  has  twice  used  the  university 
vacation  to  revisit  the  district,  although  the  heat  during  the  summer 
months  is  exceedingly  trying  to  any  European.  During  the  summer 
of  1896-7  Professor  Spencer  undertook  the  long  and  difficult 
journey  to  Alice  Springs  in  order  to  witness  the  most  mystic  rite 
of  the  Aruntas,  and  the  one  of  rarest  occurrence,  namely,  the  fire- 
ceremony,  for  which  preparations  had  been  made  by  the  tribe  for 
eighteen  months  beforehand.  His  unique  experiences  were  com- 
municated to  the  Eoyal  Society  of  Victoria  on  his  return,  early  in 
April,  and  the  following  interesting  account  is  given  in  The  Aus- 
tralasian for  April  17,  1897  : — 

Within  a  mile  or  two  of  the  picturesquely-placed  telegraph 
station,  with  its  tiny  cluster  of  stone  houses,  the  strange  aboriginal 
ceremonies  were  to  be  celebrated,  and  here  for  four  months  Pro- 
fessor Spencer  made  his  headquarters.  In  order  to  be  at  hand 
when  all  the  rites  were  being  performed,  Mr  Gillen  and  the  pro- 
fessor occupied  a  wurley,  built  on  the  sacred  ground  of  the  natives, 
and  provisions  were  brought  out  from  the  station.  Driven  to 
desperation  by  flies,  which  had  to  be  actually  brushed  off  every 
article  of  food  while  it  was  being  put  into  the  mouth,  slowly 
grilling  under  the  tropic  sun,  and  choked  by  the  clouds  of  dust 
which  every  gentle  breeze  raised,  the  two  observers  had  to  make 
notes,  take  photographs,  and  measure  evil-smelling  natives  for 
scientific  purposes,  when  other  employment  slackened.  The  un- 
certainty as  to  when  and  where  the  next  ceremony  would  take 
place  kept  Mr  Spencer  and  Mr  Gillen  at  all  times  on  the  qui  vive, 
and  on  several  occasions  they  had  to  tear  after  the  blacks  at  mid-day 


120  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

over  two  or  three  miles  of  scrubby,  stony  ground,  carrying  heavy 
full-plate  camera  and  notebook  to  get  an  accurate  record  of  what 
was  going  on.  In  all,  200  photographs  were  taken  under  extremely 
trying  conditions.  It  is  little  wonder  that  the  many  friends  of  Pro- 
fessor Spencer  were  rather  shocked  to  see  him  looking  so  parched 
and  sun-dried  on  his  return  to  civilisation. 

Initiation  Rites. — The  Arunta  tribe,  like  several  other  Aus- 
tralian tribes,  is  divided  into  sections  or  classes,  which  are  four 
in  number.  In  their  details  the  relationships  of  these  classes  are 
very  complicated,  and  are  fixed  by  definite  rules  which  are  carefully 
observed  by  the  blacks.  It  may  be  briefly  stated  that  a  man  must 
marry  out  of  his  own  class,  while  the  children  belong  to  yet  a  third 
class,  certain  members  of  which  class  are  then  his  tribal  brothers 
and  sisters. 

There  are  four  grades  of  initiatory  ceremonies  which  an  Arunta 
man  must  go  through  before  he  becomes  a  full  member  of  the  tribe. 
Up  to  about  ten  years  the  boy  lives  in  the  women's  camp,  and 
accompanies  them  in  their  search  for  such  food  as  roots,  seeds,  grubs, 
and  the  like.  His  tribal  brothers  then  paint  him  on  the  chest  and 
back,  and  he  is  thrown  up  into  the  air  and  caught.  This  is  sup- 
posed to  be  beneficial  to  his  growth.  After  this  he  now  lives  in 
the  bachelors'  camp,  and  accompanies  the  bachelors  on  their  hunting 
expeditions. 

Eight  or  ten  years  later  he  has  to  submit  to  circumcision  and 
subincision,  as  described  by  Dr  E.  C.  Stirling  and  Mr  Gillen  in  the 
results  of  the  Horn  expedition.  After  that  he  may  take  a  wife, 
and  engage  in  other  ceremonies.  In  the  tribes  of  the  East  of  Aus- 
tralia this  stage  is  marked  off  by  the  knocking  out  of  one  of  the 
front  teeth,  a  ceremony  to  which  a  good  deal  of  importance  is 
attached.  Amongst  the  Aruntas,  though  a  front  tooth  is  occa- 
sionally knocked  out,  yet  the  habit  seems  devoid  of  any  sacred 
import,  and  appears  to  be  a  survival,  the  meaning  of  which  is 
forgotten. 

Totem  and  Churinya. — When  the  candidate  has  reached  thirty, 
or  in  some  cases  forty  years,  he  takes  part  in  two  sets  of  ceremonies 
which  extend  over  several  months,  and  it  was  these  ceremonies 
which  Messrs  Spencer  and  Gillen  had  such  unique  opportunities  of 
observing.  The  first  set  deals  with  the  various  totems  of  the  tribe. 
There  are  very  large  numbers  of  totems  in  the  tribe,  and  to  one  of 
these  each  black  owes  allegiance,  and  may  be  called  by  its  name. 
Some  may  be  kangaroos,  others  native  peach  trees,  others  dingoes  or 
witchetty  grubs,  and  so  on.  It  has  long  been  known  that  the 
marriage  rules  of  the  Arunta  were  governed,  not  by  the  totems,  but 
by  the  classes  previously  alluded  to,  and  why  certain  persons  are 
attached  to  certain  totems  is  one  of  the  most  peculiar  and  important 


1897]    INITIATION  RITES  OF  THE  ARUNTA    TRIBE     121 

results  which  Messrs  Spencer  and  Gillen  have  obtained.  Closely 
interwoven  with  the  idea  of  the  totem  is  the  significance  of  the 
churinya,  or  sacred  stones  and  sticks.  These  objects  are  flat,  oval,  or 
elongate  pieces  of  stone  or  wood,  carved  all  over  with  incised  lines 
which,  in  the  Central  Australian  tribes,  are  circles  or  segments  of 
circles,  while  in  Western  Australia  they  take  the  form  of  zig-zag 
lines.  Each  man  has  his  own  churinya,  which  is  apparently  looked 
on  as  another  embodiment  of  himself,  and  yet  at  the  same  time 
it  possesses  a  mysterious  sacred  significance.  The  women  and  the 
uninitiated  are  not  allowed  to  look  at  it.  The  carvings  on  the 
churinyas  of  persons  of  the  same  totem  are  very  similar.  The 
churinyas  are  not  kept  by  the  blacks  to  whom  they  belong,  but  they 
are  carefully  hidden  in  some  definite  locality  by  one  or  two  of  the  old 
men,  each  totem  having  its  own  particular  set  of  such  stations.  The 
blacks  state  that  in  the  '  dream-times '  of  the  far  distant  past,  when 
their  ancestors  came  into  the  country,  those  of  each  totem  kept 
strictly  by  themselves.  At  this  time  they  are  not  quite  clear  as  to 
whether  those  whose  totem  was,  say  the  wild  duck,  were  really 
human  beings,  or  partly  the  animals  or  plants  the  names  of  which 
they  bear. 

The  lines  of  these  migrations  are  related  in  great  detail  in 
their  traditions,  and  each  camping  ground  is  exactly  located,  so  that 
the  whole  country  is  interlaced  with  lines  of  route,  and  dotted  over 
with  innumerable  camps.  When  one  of  these  '  dream-time '  an- 
cestors died,  he  was  turned  into  a  spirit-child,  and  as  such  dwells 
near  one  of  the  camping  grounds,  always  carrying  in  his  hand  one 
of  the  churinyas.  Conception  is  believed  to  take  place  by  the 
entry  of  one  of  these  spirit-children  into  the  mother,  the  spirit- 
child  dropping  his  churinya  on  the  ground  at  the  time.  On  the 
birth  of  the  child  the  place  is  searched  for  the  lost  churinya,  and 
by  the  kindly  offices  of  one  of  the  old  men  the  search  is  usually 
successful.  If  it  be  not,  a  wooden  one  is  made  of  hardwood,  such 
as  mulga.  The  stone  churinyas  are  the  more  ancient  form,  and  do 
not  appear  to  be  made  at  the  present  day.  This  then  fixes  the 
totem  for  the  individual,  and  explains  why  in  the  Arunta  tribe  the 
child  is  not  of  the  same  totem  as  one  of  the  parents,  as  is  the  case 
in  some  of  the  neighbouring  tribes  of  Central  Australia. 

The  members  of  each  totem  have  a  ceremony  connected  with 
their  totem,  which  they  alone  are  allowed  to  perform,  and  which 
has  for  one  of  its  objects  the  increase  of  the  animal  or  plant  from 
which  the  totem  takes  its  name.  The  eating  of  this  animal  is  not 
tabooed  to  those  who  bear  its  name,  as  is  frequently  the  case  in 
other  parts  of  the  world ;  in  -fact,  it  is  considered  necessary  for  the 
chief  performer  to  eat  a  portion  of  his  totem,  or  the  ceremony  will 
fail. 


122  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

General  Programme. — In  their  general  plan  these  ceremonies 
are  much  alike.  The  chief  performer  is  elaborately  decorated  with 
patterns  in  eaglehawk  down  stuck  to  his  body  with  blood  drawn 
from  some  member  of  the  party.  This  down  is  coloured  red  and 
yellow  with  ochre ;  other  parts  of  the  body  are  smeared  with  a 
black  pigment  mixed  with  grease.  The  amount  of  blood  drawn  on 
these  occasions  is  at  times  surprising,  it  being  estimated  that  one 
man  allowed  five  half-pints  to  be  taken  from  him  during  a  single 
day.  The  decoration  of  this  performer  is  completed  while  the  black 
candidates,  if  they  may  be  so  termed,  are  away  hunting.  On  their 
return  to  the  sacred  ground  they  dance  vigorously  round  him  for 
some  time.  In  most  of  these  performances  the  decorated  men  then 
imitate  the  actions  of  the  animal  whose  totem  they  bear,  and  in 
some  cases  the  acting  is  described  as  wonderful.  In  one  mock 
combat  two  performers  represented  two  eaglehawks  struggling  for  a 
bone,  and  wildly  flapping  their  wings,  which  were  represented  by  a 
bunch  of  gum  leaves  in  each  hand. 

The  '  parra,'  or  sacred  ground,  was  laid  out  with  great  care,  and 
one  of  the  most  peculiar  sights  was  to  see  the  candidates  lying  in  a 
row  with  their  heads  close  to  a  long  bank  of  earth,  as  they  were 
required  to  do  during  most  of  the  nights.  Absolute  silence  was 
entailed,  and  the  strain  during  the  months  through  which  the 
ceremonies  lasted  must  have  been  great,  and  have  considerably 
influenced  the  hysterical,  exalted  frame  of  mind  which  they  at 
times  showed. 

Fire  Rites. — After  a  month  devoted  to  preliminary  rites  the 
fire  ceremonies  began.  The  men  to  be  initiated  formed  into  a  body, 
and,  holding  a  shield  of  gum  leaves  over  themselves,  went  to  the 
women's  camp.  They  were  accompanied  by  a  number  of  the  old 
men  swinging  bull-roarers.  This  seems  to  be  the  only  occasion  on 
which  the  women,  on  hearing  the  dread  sound,  do  not  run  and  hide 
themselves,  nor  are  they  at  any  other  time  allowed  even  to  gaze 
upon  the  sacred  implement.  The  women  who  were  prepared,  ran 
at  the  body  of  men,  and  threw  burning  branches  on  to  them,  which 
the  men  tried,  not  very  effectually,  to  ward  off  with  their  roof  of 
leaves.  This  ceremony  was  repeated  daily  for  about  a  fortnight. 
Next,  a  large  fire,  about  twenty  feet  across,  was  made  and  covered 
with  green  leaves  ;  on  this  terrible  heap  the  candidates  lay  for  some 
time,  several  at  once,  others  calmly  standing  by  and  waiting  their 
turn.  The  heat  of  the  fire  was  very  considerable.  Professor 
Spencer  knelt  on  the  heap  to  try  it,  but  could  not  endure  it,  even 
with  thick  trousers  on.  This  performance  was  concluded  by  all 
present  howling  and  hurling  fircsticks  about. 

During  the  evening,  when  all  the  candidates  were  lying  in  a 
row  as  usual,  one  of  the  old  men  seated  himself  before  them  with  a 


1897]    INITIATION  RITES  OF  THE  AUUNTA   TRIBE     123 

decorated  piece  of  wood  which  he  held  upright,  and  slowly  and 
steadily  knocked  on  the  ground.  At  each  side  of  him  another  old 
man  sat  holding  his  wrist,  and  assisting  in  this  wearisome  work, 
which,  with  most  remarkable  endurance,  was  kept  up  without  a 
pause  from  half-past  nine  at  night  till  about  five  next  morning. 

The  number  of  candidates  was  very  large,  there  being  more  than 
a  hundred  who  were  initiated.  On  the  day  following  the  final 
ceremony  took  place,  the  men  crossing  over  to  the  women's  camp, 
and  each  kneeling  on  a  tire  there. 

Concluding  Notes. — Each  of  the  old  men  who  were  directing 
operations  had  men  of  his  own  totem  under  his  charge,  and  for 
their  proper  initiation  he  was  responsible.  During  the  whole 
period  of  nearly  four  months  they  were  not  allowed  to  speak  to 
him.  At  the  conclusion  of  the  rites  they  had  to  bring  him  some 
food-offering,  such  as  cooked  wallaby,  and  begged  him  to  make  them 
speak.  He  then  touched  their  lips,  and  the  ban  of  silence  was 
removed. 

A  good  deal  of  the  significance  of  many  of  the  ceremonies  has 
probably  been  lost,  but  their  main  object  seems  to  have  been  to  test 
the  endurance  of  the  young  men,  and  to  teach  them  the  past 
history  of  the  tribe,  while  the  possession  of  a  knowledge  of  the 
correct  method  of  procedure  by  the  old  men,  who  practically  formed 
a  council  for  the  administration  of  the  whole  series  of  rites,  would 
naturally  cause  them  to  be  held  in  high  esteem. 

As  this  ceremony  is  only  performed  at  intervals  of  many  years, 
it  is  more  than  likely  that,  with  the  advance  of  the  white  man,  the 
present  may  be  the  last  occasion  on  which  it  will  be  performed  with 
the  completeness  in  which  it  was  witnessed  by  Professor  Spencer 
and  Mr  Gillen.  The  results  so  laboriously  obtained  are  conse- 
quently of  peculiar  value.  0. 


124  [August 


SOME  NEW  BOOKS 

The  Structure  of  Corals 

Microscopic  and  Systematic  Study  of  Madreporarian  Types  of  Corals.  By 
Miss  Maria  M.  Ogilvie,  D.Sc,  Phil.  Trans.  Roy.  Soc,  London.  Vol.  187,  1896, 
pp.  83-345.    Price,  lis.  6d. 

Miss  Ogilvie's  work  on  the  microscopic  and  systematic  study  of 
Madreporaria,  read  before  the  Eoyal  Society  in  November  1895,  was 
a  long  time  in  appearing  in  print.  It  is  a  copious  and  an  ambitious 
work,  one  which  reflects  great  praise  on  the  industry  and  the  capacity 
of  the  authoress,  yet,  as  must  always  be  the  case  in  a  work  of  such 
pretensions,  it  is  open  to  a  considerable  amount  of  criticism  in  details. 
To  criticise  it  adequately  one  would  have  to  enter  into  minutiae  which 
are  of  little  interest  except  to  the  specialist ;  to  criticise  it  at  all  one 
must  necessarily  enter  into  details  which  are  unfamiliar  even  to 
zoological  readers,  unless  they  happen  to  have  made  a  special  study 
of  corals. 

It  is  well  known  that  the  stony  corals,  though  they  present  but  a 
limited  range  of  structural  peculiarities,  are  so  rich  and  various  in 
detail  and  display  such  infinite  variety  of  form,  that  their  classification 
presents  great  difficulties.  These  difficulties  have  been  enhanced  by 
the  fact  that  even  now  the  anatomy  of  the  polyps  is  only  known 
for  a  relatively  small  number  of  forms,  and  that  there  is  a  vast  assem- 
blage of  extinct  corals  of  which  we  only  can  know  the  structure  of  the 
skeletons  :  the  nature  of  the  polyps  to  which  the  skeletons  belonged 
can  only  be  inferred  from  the  small  knowledge  we  have  of  the 
anatomy  of  recent  types.  A  great  number  of  the  palaeozoic  forms  of 
corals  appeared  to  differ  so  much  in  their  characters  from  later  and 
recent  corals  that  they  were  classified  apart  by  Milne  Edwards  and 
Haiine  under  the  names  Eugosa,  Tabulata,  and  Tubulosa.  The  groups 
Tabulata  and  Tubulosa  have  disappeared  some  time  since,  but  the 
group  Eugosa  has  remained,  in  spite  of  the  fact  that  several  authors, 
but  especially  Gottlieb  von  Koch,  have  shown  that  the  intimate 
structure  of  the  coralla  of  many  Eugosa  is  in  all  essential  characters 
the  same  as  that  of  recent  corals.  The  group  of  Eugosa  has  survived, 
against  the  better  judgment  of  many  investigators,  because  it  was 
convenient  to  palaeontologists,  and  in  the  study  of  corals  as  in  that  of 
many  other  groups,  palaeontologists  and  zoologists  have  worked  with 
too  little  heed  to  each  other's  doings.  Miss  Ogilvie  writes  as  a 
palaeontologist,  but  as  one  whose  ideas  are  moulded  by  the  teachings 
of  zoology.  A  great  part  of  her  work  refers  to  the  structure  of 
recent  forms,  and  her  conclusions  as  to  the  nature  and  systematic 
position  of  ancient  corals  are  founded  on  the  knowledge  which  she 
has  gained  from  her  studies  of  living  forms.  The  result  is  that 
she  has  turned  the  old  classification  of  Milne  Edwards  and  Haime 
upside    down,   and    even   those   who   have   accustomed    themselves 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  125 

to  the  modifications  introduced  by  Martin  Duncan  and  Quelch  will 
scarcely  recognise  the  classification  set  forth  in  a  very  ingenious 
diagram  on  page  331  of  this  work.  Corals  are  divided  into  two 
sections,  Zaphrentoidea  or  Madreporaria  Haplophracta  and  Cyatho- 
phylloidea  or  Madreporaria  Pollaplophracta.  The  former  section  is 
divided  into  two  sub-sections,  the  Coenenchymata,  including  the 
families  Poritidae,  Madreporidae,  Pocilloporidae,  Oculinidae ;  and  the 
Murocorallia,  including  the  Zaphrentidae,  Turbinolidae,  Amphias- 
traeidae  and  Stylinidae,  the  two  last  named  being  new  families,  or 
nearly  so.  Ev/phyllia  is  taken  as  the  living  type  of  the  Amphias- 
traeidae,  Galaxea  of  the  Stylinidae.  The  section  Pollaplophracta  is 
divided  into  two  sub-sections  ;  the  Septocorallia,  including  the  families 
Cyathophyllidae,  Astraeidae  and  Fungidae,  and  the  Spinocorallia, 
including  the  family  Eupsammidae.  It  will  be  seen  that  the  old 
groups  of  Aporosa  and  Perforata  as  well  as  the  Kugosa  disappear 
altogether  ;  that  corals  which  were  known  as  perforate  are  placed 
alongside  of  aporose  corals  and  vice  versa ;  thus  the  Eupsammidae 
are  ranked  near  the  Astraeidae,  the  Pocilloporidae  near  the  Madre- 
poridae. 

These  sweeping  changes  are  based  upon  a  microscopic  examina- 
tion of  the  coralla  of  many  recent  and  extinct  forms.  Make  a  section 
through  a  coral  skeleton  and  you  will  recognise  in  the  middle  of  each 
septum,  or  other  component,  a  dark  line  or  centre.  With  thin  sections 
and  high  powers  the  dark  line  resolves  itself  into  a  series  of  dark 
spots,  from  which  the  crystalline  elements  of  the  corallum  radiate 
outwards  in  diverse  ways.  A  close  comparative  study  of  these  features 
has  convinced  Miss  Ogilvie — or  we  should  rather  say  now,  Mrs 
Gordon — that  they  afford  a  new  and  natural  basis  for  classification, 
one  which  is  applicable  to  the  study  of  both  extinct  and  recent  corals, 
because  the  feature  in  question  is  usually  well  preserved  in  fossil 
remains.  A  further  convenience  is  the  fact  that  the  microscopical 
structure  of  the  corallum  may  often,  if  not  always,  be  inferred  from 
its  superficial  characters,  e.g.  granules,  striae,  and  serrations  of  septa. 
To  give  details  of  the  septal  characters  is  here  impossible ;  the  struc- 
ture is  intricate  and  demands  much  space  for  explanation.  It  need 
only  be  said  that  anybody,  having  read  this  part  of  the  work,  may 
easily  verify  the  truth  of  the  statements  made.  Points  which  have 
hitherto  escaped  notice  are  here  brought  forward  for  the  first  time, 
and  the  new  observations  are  invested  with  an  importance  which,  if 
not  always  acceptable,  is  invariably  interesting  and  suggestive. 

Miss  Ogilvie  not  only  describes  the  microscopic  character  of  the 
corallum  ;  she  also  accounts  for  it  by  seeking  to  prove  that  the 
ultimate  elements  of  the  coral  skeleton  are  minute  scales,  each  com- 
posed of  a  bunch  of  minute  crystalline  fibres,  and  that  each  such  scale 
is  in  fact  a  calcified  cell  or  calicoblast,  which  is  bodily  converted  into 
the  calcareous  tissue  of  the  skeleton.  In  making  this  assertion  Miss 
Ogilvie  treads  on  contentious  ground.  She  adopts  and  expands  a 
view  originally  put  forwTard  by  von  Heider,  but  not  generally  accepted, 
because  it  appeared  to_be  negatived  both  by  examination  of  fresh  adult 
coralla  and  by  the  embryological  researches  of  von  Koch.  The  latter 
author,  whose  statements  are  worthy  of  the  utmost  credit,  states  most 
positively  that   in  the  development  of  Astroides  calycalaris,  the  first 


126  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

deposit  of  calcareous  tissue  takes  place  between  the  basal  ectoderm 
and  the  surface  of  attachment,  and  that  it  is  secreted  by,  not  formed 
within  the  ectoderm  cells.  These  statements  are  confirmed  by  H.  V. 
Wilson  for  Manicina  areolata,  and  in  a  question  of  this  sort  it  requires 
very  strong  evidence  to  upset  the  proofs  from  embryology.  Miss 
Ogilvie's  evidence  is  hardly  strong  enough  ;  the  appearances  which 
she  describes  are  not  unfamiliar  to  students  of  corals  and  are  suscep- 
tible of  a  different  interpretation,  but  she  has  at  least  reopened  the 
question,  which  will  have  to  be  settled  on  better  evidence  than  that 
which  she  has  adduced. 

Amongst  the  many  figures  which  illustrate  the  work   there   are 
several  showing  the  relations  of  hard  and  soft  parts  in  recent  corals. 
Some  of  them  are   correct,  others  are   misleading,   if  not   positively 
incorrect.     Take,  for  instance,  the  diagram  of  Turbinaria  on  p.  209. 
The  anatomy  of  this  genus  has  been  thoroughly  described  by  Dr 
Fowler,  and  we  learn  from  him  that  there  is  a  system  of  canals  which 
permeate  the  corallum  and    communicate  with  the  polyp  cavities. 
These  canals  anastomose  freely,  but  Miss  Ogilvie's  figure  shows  only 
a  few  digitate  or  branched  diverticula ;  no  anastomoses,  no  network, 
and   no  transverse    communications    with    the    polyp   cavities.     The 
figure  of  Fungia  on  p.  169  can  only  be  called  a  diagram  of  theoretical 
relations.     As  a  matter  of  fact  the  soft  parts  of  Fungia  have  not  the 
structure  shown  in  the  figure.     Miss  Ouilvie  homolosnses  the  tissues 
on  the  aboral  face  of  Fungia  with  the  edge-zone  of  other  corals.     This 
is  right  enough,  but  it  is  not  right  to  assume,  as  she  does,  that  there 
is  no  communication  between  the  synapticula  and  through  the  theca 
between  the  cavity  of  the  edge-zone  and  the  general  cavity  of  the 
body.     As  a  matter  of  fact  definite  canals  pass  between  the  synapticula, 
some  are  united  below  the  level  of  the  synapticula  by  a  radial  canal, 
some  are  directly  continuous  with  the  cavities  of  the  edge-zone.     The 
mesenteries  are  best  developed  above  the  synapticula,  but  some  extend 
also  between  and  even  below  them,  the  rule  being  that  the  mesenteries 
are  attached  to  synapticula,  either  above  or  at  their  sides,  but  some 
extend  far  down  and  send  narrow  mesogloeal  bands  to  be  attached  to 
the  basal  wall  of  the  disc.     Other  features,  such  as  the  position  of 
the  tentacles,  are  not  correctly  represented.     The  writer  has  the  more 
confidence  in  making  these  statements  since  he  has  recently  examined 
the  anatomy  of  Fungia,  in  order  to  test  the  correctness  of  this  figure. 
One  is  inclined  to  suspect  that  Miss  Ogilvie,  whilst  making  plentiful 
use  of  the  anatomical  researches  of  other  authors,  has  not  herself  any 
great  familiarity  with  the  structure  of  coral  polyps.     There  is  some 
internal  evidence   that,  after    deciding    in    her    own  mind   how   the 
corallum  was  formed,  she  has  inferred  the  anatomy  of  the  polyps  from 
the  microscopical  characters   of  their  coralla,   without  studying  the 
actual  relations  in  a  sufficient  number  of  instances.     Such  inferences 
are  apt  to  be  misleading.     Whether  this  is  the  case  or  not,  Miss 
Ogilvie  has  been  led  by  her   views   on   the  formation  of  calcareous 
tissue  to  give   a  lively  but   an   unlikely  accotmt   of  madreporarian 
development  and  evolution,  an  account  which  is  in  harmony  with  the 
figures  criticised  above,  but  which  does  not  and  cannot  explain  the 
diagnostic  character  of  the  Madreporaria  Perforata  of  M.  Edwards  and 
Hainie — viz.  the  presence  of  a  complex  canalicular  system  in  the  wall, 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  127 

the  septa  and  the  coenenchyme.     For  her  the  form  and  structure  of 
the  calcareous  laminae  or  bars  are  the  result  of  foldings,  wrinklings, 
and  tuckings  in  and  over  of  the  flexible  zooid.     On  p.  315  there  is  an 
imaginative'  description  of  the  evolution  of  the  madreporarian  zooid, 
which  is  represented  as  pulling  in  and  tucking  up  its  body  in  various 
places,  forming  invaginations  here,  evaginations  there,  as  if  guided  by 
some  predetermined  impulse,  and  we  are  to  believe  that  the  form  of 
i  he  corallum  is  determined  by  these  almost  purposive  wrinklings  and 
corrugations  of  the  zooid,  which  fills  up  the  cavities  and  folds  of  the 
creases   in   its   body   with   calcareous   tissue.     Eeferences,    scattered 
throughout    the   volume,   to    invaginations — a    word,    by    the   way, 
which  is  used  in  a  most  puzzling  variety  of  meanings  with  regard 
to  spatial  relations — show  that  Miss  Ogilvie  is  dominated    by  the 
idea    that    the  wrinkling    and    pitting   of   the    soft   tissues   was   the 
antecedent,   the   formation   of  calcareous  structures   the   consequent. 
The  skeleton,  it  is  true,  is  formed  by  the  soft  tissues,  but  it  by  no 
means  follows  that  the  form  of  the  skeletal  parts  is  the  result  of  the 
pre-existing  form  of  the  soft  parts.     The  two  elements  have  been 
formed  pari  passu,  changes  in  the  one  reacting  upon  the  other,  and 
the  final  shape  and  mutual  relations  are  the  result  of  a  continuous 
correlated   development  of  which  wre  cannot  affirm,  at   any  given 
point,  that  the  growth  of  the  one  part  preceded  or  dominated  the 
growth   of  the   other.      On   Miss    Ogilvie's   supposition  it  is  most 
difficult  to  account  for  the  formation  of  the  canal  s}'stem  in  perforate 
corals,  and  we  cannot  but  suspect  that  this  difficulty  has  led  to  her 
giving  a  theoretical  rather  than  an  actual  picture  of  the  structure  of 
Turbinaria  and  of  Fungia.     Not  that  Fungia  is  a  perforate  coral. 

In  classifying  the  Fungidae,  Miss  Ogilvie  has  left  out  of  con- 
sideration the  fact  that  the  young  Fungia  is  a  true  aporose  coral, 
indistinguishable  from  a  Turbinolid,  even  to  the  absence  or  at  least 
the  very  slight  development  of  synapticula.  This  fact  points  to  a 
close  relationship  between  the  Fungidae  and  the  Turbinolidae,  yet 
they  are  classed  far  apart,  the  former  among  the  Pollaplophracta 
Septocorallia,  the  latter  among  the  Haplophracta  Murocorallia.  In 
fact,  the  more  one  examines  the  grounds  of  the  classification  adopted 
in  this  work  the  less  satisfactory  does  it  appear.  The  group 
Coenenchymata  strikes  one  as  purely  artificial.  The  subsections 
Murocorallia  and  Septocorallia  are  founded  on  the  presence  or 
absence  of  so-called  '  thecal '  pieces.  This  is  a  partial  revival  of 
the  classification  proposed  by  von  Heider  and  adopted  by  Ortmann, 
it  has  been  severely  criticised  by  von  Koch  and  others,  and  it  is  not 
too  much  to  say  that  it  is  founded  on  a  misconception.  There  is 
no  essential  difference  between  '  thecal '  and  '  septal '  structures. 
Both  are  formed  in  the  same  manner  from  the  same  regions  of  the 
polyp.  In  many  forms  sections  taken  low  down  in  the  corallum 
show  an  alternation  of  septal  and  apparently  thecal  pieces.  Higher 
up  it  is  found  that  calcareous  lamellae  project  inwards  from  the 
supposed  thecal  pieces,  so  that  the  last  named  appear  as  septa.  The 
same  coral  appears  to  have  an  '  eutheca '  in  one  part,  a  '  pseudotheca ' 
in  another  part,  is  therefore  a  Murocorallian  in  one  region,  a  Septo- 
corallian  in  another.  This  fact  has  been  repeatedly  emphasised  by 
von  Koch,  and  a  clear  and  convincing  discussion  of  the  question  is  to 


128  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 


be  found  in  his  recent  work  in  Gegenbaur's  "-Festschrift."  The 
Turbinoliclae  are  a  standing  example  of  the  unreliability  of  a  classifica- 
tion founded  upon  the  supposed  difference  between  an  Eutheca  and  a 
Pseudotheca.  They  are  positively  stated  on  p.  319  to  have  "  a  well 
built  thcca,  whose  fibrous  elements  are  set  in  a  direction  at  right 
angles  to  those  of  the  septa."  Caryophyllia  is  regarded  as  a  typical 
Turbinolid,  yet  the  writer  has  sections  of  Caryophyllia  smithii  which 
demonstrate  conclusively  that  there  are  no  such  thecal  pieces  with 
fibrous  elements  set  in  a  direction  at  right  angles  to  those  of  the 
wall.  The  wall  is  in  fact  a  typical  pseudotheca,  formed  by  the 
coalescence  of  the  thickened  peripheral  ends  of  the  septa.  The  same 
must  be  asserted  of  Steplianotrochus  and  others.  Remembering  that 
the  wall  of  Caryophyllia  is  a  pseudotheca,  it  is  difficult  to  place 
FlabcUwm  in  the  same  group  with  it,  and  Miss  Ogilvie's  remarks  on 
Flabcllum  suggest  that  she  has  not  grasped  the  meaning  of  von  Koch's 
argument  that  its  '  theca '  is  in  fact  an  epitheca. 

It  would  not  be  difficult  to  find  other  materials  for  criticism,  but 
enough  has  been  said  to  show  that  Miss  Ogilvie's  more  general 
conclusions  must  be  received  with  caution.  So  long  as  she  deals 
with  the  matter  of  her  own  original  observations  she  is  on  safe 
ground,  and  in  describing  the  finer  structure  of  the  coralluin  she  has 
added  largely  to  our  knowledge,  and  has  opened  up  a  suggestive  field 
of  research.  But  she  has  marred  her  work  by  an  effort  to  be  too 
comprehensive,  and  in  her  attempt  to  form  a  complete  system  she 
has  been  obliged  to  rely  on  characters  other  than  those  which  have 
been  the  object  of  her  researches,  and  therefore  has,  in  our  opinion, 
been  led  into  error.  However  extensive  and  excellent  her  work,  it  is 
not  yet  sufficient  to  allow  of  the  making  of  a  wholly  new  and  general 
scheme  of  classification.  But  whilst  one  cannot  accept  the  classifica- 
tion as  it  stands,  one  must  feel  that  it  abounds  in  suggestions.  The 
suo'ii-ested  lines  of  descent  of  living  from  extinct  forms,  offer 
most  interesting  material  for  enquiry.  There  is  an  ingenious,  but 
not  wholly  new,  suggestion  as  to  the  probable  relation  of  mesenteries 
in  palaeozoic  corals,  involving  an  explanation  of  tetrameral  arrange- 
ment of  septa.  The  explanation  of  the  nature  of  the  fossula  is 
ingenious  and  probable;  unfortunately  it  is  one  of  those  points  which 
can  scarcely  be  proved  by  observation. 

In  conclusion,  the  work,  though  it  may  have  defects,  is  a  most 
useful  one ;  it  must  always  influence  other  workers  in  the  same  field, 
and  it  is  probable  that  some  of  the  main  features  of  the  classification 
will  come  to  be  universally  adopted.  One  thing,  at  least,  is  certain, 
nobody  will  henceforth  speak  of  the  group  of  Bugosa. 

G.  C.  Bourne. 

B,  Hertwig's  Text-book  of  Zoology 

Lehrbuch  der  Zoologie.  By  Dr  R.  Hertwig.  Fourth  improved  edition.  8vo. 
Pp.  xii.  612,  with  568  text-figures.  Jena:  G.  Fischer,  1S!>7.  Trice  in  paper 
wrappers,  11  marks  50  pf.  ;  bound,  13  marks  50  pf. 

It  is  just  two  years  since  we  reviewed  the  third  edition  of  this  clear 
and  correct  text-book,  a  fact  that  proves,  at  all  events,  the  success  of 
the  work.     The  present  edition  differs  from  its  predecessors,  not  only 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  129 

in  the  slightly  increased  size,  but  in  some  extension  of  the  parts 
dealing  with  the  Sporozoa  and  the  Vertebrate.  The  Sporozoa  have  of 
late  years  assumed  great  economic  importance,  especially  in  reference 
to  the  breeding  of  fish  and  to  certain  diseases  of  man,  as  was  insisted 
on  by  Professor  Eay  Lankester  in  Natural  Science  for  August  1896. 
I)r  Hertwig  has  therefore  done  well  to  give  them  greater  prominence. 
Among  the  Vertebrate,  while  Dr  Hertwig  has  endeavoured  to  ac- 
commodate Boulenger's  classification  of  the  Keptilia  to  the  restricted 
needs  and  limits  of  a  text-book,  he  has  found  himself  still  unable  to 
introduce  the  modifications  in  the  classification  of  birds  that  have 
been  held  necessary  by  certain  recent  anatomists. 

In  our  former  review  we  alluded  to  the  weakness  of  the  palaeonto- 
logical  part  of  this  otherwise  admirable  book,  and  we  regret  to  find 
that  weakness  just  as  conspicuous.  It  leads  to  sins,  not  merely  of 
omission,  as  the  passing  over  of  all  the  differences  between  an 
ammonoid  and  a  nautiloid  shell,  and  the  absence  of  any  account  of 
the  shell  in  the  decapodous  cephalopods,  but  also  of  commission,  as 
the  long  obsolete  division  of  the  crinoids  into  Palaeocrinoidea  and 
Xeocrinoidea.  A  knowledge  of  palaeontology,  too,  would  have  saved 
Dr  Hertwig  from  devoting  space  to  the  views  of  Haeckel  on  the 
Cystidea,  when  that  space  is  so  valuable  that  this  most  important 
class  of  all  the  echinoderms  has  to  be  dealt  with  in  a  dozen  lines. 
We  trust  that  the  fifth  edition,  which  is  sure  to  be  called  for,  will 
show  some  consideration  to  those  extinct  animals  on  the  knowledge 
of  which  our  classifications  must  ultimately  depend. 

Aethropods  for  Beginners 

Through  a  Pocket-Lens.     By  Henry  Schcrren,  F.Z.S.     8vo.     Pp.  192. 
London :  The  Religious  Tract  Society.  1897.     Price,  2s.  6d. 

Me  Scherren  is  well  known  as  a  writer  of  attractive  little  books  on 
natural  history  for  beginners,  and  his  reputation  in  this  respect  is  not 
likely  to  suffer  from  the  volume  that  is  now  under  notice.  Its  object 
is  to  show  how  much  may  be  learnt  with  an  ordinary  pocket-lens  and 
simple  appliances  ;  but  it  is  surely  somewhat  of  a  pity  that  the  title  is 
not  more  indicative  of  its  contents.  For  the  purpose  could  have  been 
carried  out  with  equal  satisfaction  if  minerals,  or  any  group  of  the 
smaller  plants  or  animals,  had  been  selected  for  study.  As  a  matter  of 
fact  Mr  Scherren's  choice  fell,  and  fell  wisely,  upon  the  Arthropoda,  a 
group  to  which  he  has  devoted  much  of  his  spare  time,  and  which  is 
peculiarly  suitable  for  the  purpose  in  hand  on  account  of  the  abund- 
ance and  obtrusiveness  of  its  species,  its  attractiveness  to  young 
naturalists  and  collectors,  and  the  extent  of  the  variation  in  structure 
and  habits  that  it  displays. 

The  first  chapter  contains  much  useful  advice  on  the  question  of 
lenses,  needles,  forceps,  beakers,  etc.,  showing  that  all  needful  ap- 
pliances for  the  investigations  illustrated  in  the  following  chapters  of 
the  book  may  be  obtained  by  the  expenditure  of  a  small  sum  of 
money.  In  the  way  of  lenses,  however,  there  is  one  object  which 
seems  to  have  escaped  Mr  Scherren's  notice,  and  to  which  he  will 
perhaps  be  glad  to  have  his  attention  drawn.  This  is  the  ordinary 
watchmaker's  lens,  which  will    be  found   invaluable   for  dissecting 


130  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

purposes,  since  with  a  little  practice  it  can  be  held  in  the  eye, 
leaving  the  two  hands  free  for  the  manipulation  of  the  needles 
and  forceps. 

The  types  for  study  have  been  advisedly  selected,  being  those,  like 
the  cockroach,  water-beetle,  garden-spider,  and  prawn,  which  can  be 
obtained  in  almost  every  country  district,  or  in  any  of  our  towns  or 
their  neighbourhood,  and  may  very  easily  lie  kept  alive  in  suitable 
surroundings.  For  one  of  the  great  merits  of  this  little  book  is,  that 
it  recommends  an  observation  of  the  habits  of  the  species  before  they 
be  submitted  to  the  process  of  dissection. 

The  errors  of  the  book  are  few  and,  on  the  whole,  unimportant. 
It  is  not  however  usual  to  regard  the  carapace  in  the  Crustacea  as 
synonymous  with  the  cephalothorax ;  and  to  say  that  the  former 
consists  of  fourteen  segments  in  the  prawn,  when  it  really  represents 
the  tergal  elements  of  but  two  is  misleading.  Moreover,  and  since 
Mr  Scherren — not  without  the  countenance  of  authority—  applies  the 
word  'joint'  to  the  internode  or  segment  of  a  limb,  it  would  be 
interesting  to  learn  by  what  term  the  point  of  junction  of  two 
'  joints '  is  to  be  recognised.  Lastly,  Dr  David  Sharp  will  not  be 
flattered  by  the  ascription  to  him  of  the  authorship  of  the  '  Myria- 
poda '  in  the  Cambridge  Natural  History.  In  spite  of  these  blemishes, 
however,  the  book  may  be  cordially  recommended  to  beginners  as  an 
excellent  practical  lesson  in  the  elements  of  the  morphology  and 
bionomics  of  the  Arthropoda.  R.   I.  POCOCK. 

For  the  Young  Entomologist 

Faune  de  France  :  Orthopteres,  Neuropteres,  Hymenopteres,  Lepidopteres,  Hemi- 
pteres,  Dipteres,  Aphanipteres,  Thysanopteres,  Rhipipteres.  Par  A.  Acloque. 
viii.  and  516  pp.,  with  1235  figures.     Paris:  Bailliere,  1897.     Price,  8  francs. 

The  Young  Beetle-Collector's  Handbook.  By  Dr  E.  Hofmann,  with  an  introduc- 
tion by  W.  Egmont  Kirby,  M.D.  8vo.  viii.  and  17S  pp.,  20  coloured  plates. 
London  :  Swan  Sonnenschein  &  Co.,  1897.     Price,  4s.  6d. 

The  fauna  of  France  in  the  groups  mentioned  above  may  be  estimated 
at  about  15,000  species,  and  M.  Acloque  disposes  of  them  in  this 
small  volume.  We  have  previously  (Natural  Science,  May  1896, 
p.  346)  explained  the  plan  of  the  work,  and  need  only  add  that,  in 
the  volume  now  before  us,  the  necessity  of  keeping  the  number  of 
pages  within  assigned  limits  has  caused  the  author  to  abandon  the 
attempt  at  dealing  with  species  in  the  more  extensive  and  difficult 
families  ;  so  that  in  these  cases  we  find  only  tables  of  the  genera. 

In  his  preface  the  author  recognises  that  this  volume  does  not 
accomplish  all  that  was  intended  when  the  scheme  of  dealing  with 
the  whole  fauna  of  France  in  four  small  volumes  was  adopted.  The 
system  of  terminations  used  in  the  names  of  the  systematic  groups  is 
extremely  repellent  :  the  well-known  family  name  Apidae  becomes 
Apisidi;  and  as  sub-family  names  we  find  Andrenii  and  Bombii, 
derived  from  Andrena  and  Bombus.  Possibly  the  system  is  theo- 
retically excellent,  but  it  reminds  us  of  Montgomery's  lines  about 
Nebuchadnezzar,  who 

"  murmured  as  he  cropped  the  unwonted  food, 
It  may  be  wholesome  but  it  isn't  good." 

Dr  Hofmann's  work  is  remarkably  well  printed,  and  the  twenty 


1897]  SOMJE  NEW  BOOKS  131 

plates  include  about  000  almost  tolerable  figures.  But  the  matter 
contained  in  the  pages  is  somewhat  disappointing.  It  consists  of 
brief  descriptions,  and  of  an  introduction,  too  short  and  vague  to  be 
of  much  use,  dealing  with  more  general  points.  D.  S. 

The  Museums  Association 

Museums  Association  :  Report  of  Proceedings  with  the  Papers  read  at  the  seventh 

Annual  General   Meeting  held   in  Glasgow,   July   21   to  2i>,  1890.     Svo,  pp.  107. 
London:  Dulau  &  Co.,  1896.     Price  5s. 

If  anything  were  needed  to  show  the  growth  of  interest  in  the  ques- 
tions connected  with  the  administration  and  development  of  museums 
it  may  be  found  in  the  institution  and  continued  prosperity  of  the 
"  Museums  Association,"  and  the  issue  of  the  compact  volumes  of 
papers  read  at  their  annual  meetings.  Last  year's  meeting  took  place 
at  Glasgow,  and  for  the  first  time  since  its  foundation  seven  years  ago 
the  association  had  an  "  Art-man  "  as  its  president  in  the  person  of 
Mr  James  Paton,  curator  of  the  Kelvingrove  Museum  and  Corporation 
Art  Galleries  in  that  city.  In  his  presidential  address  Mr  Paton 
gives  an  extremely  interesting  account  of  the  institutions  under  his 
direction,  but  considering  that  the  majority  of  his  audience  must  have 
been  men  of  science,  I  think  that  he  might  safely  have  omitted  telling 
them  that  the  aim  of  the  picture  gallery  is  "  higher  and  holier,"  pre- 
sumably from  the  context,  than  the  scientific  museum.  Few  scientific 
men  are  wholly  blind  to  Art,  many  are  in  the  highest  degree  sus- 
ceptible to  its  influence,  but  all  the  same — comparisons  are  invidious  ! 

Mr  F.  A.  Bather's  paper  entitled  "  How  may  museums  best  retard 
the  advance  of  science,"  being  of  a  satirical  vein  throughout,  is  very 
entertaining  reading ;  and,  on  the  whole,  I  think  we  may  give  ready 
assent  to  most  of  the  ideas  which  he  has  chosen  this  method  of 
conveying. 

Other  papers  in  the  volume  are: — Mr  H.  Coates  on  the  Arrange- 
ment of  the  Perthshire  Natural  History  Museum ;  Mr  E.  M.  Holmes 
on  Type  Specimens  in  Botanical  Museums ;  Descriptive  Geological 
Labels,  by  Mr  H.  Bolton  ;  Mr  F.  A.  Bather  on  Electrotypes  in 
Natural  History  Museums  ;  Mr  G.  W.  Orel  on  Chemistry  in 
Museums ;  Suggestions  for  a  Proposed  Natural  History  Museum 
in  Manchester,  by  the  late  Prof.  Huxley;  Clara  Nordlinger  on 
a  Visit  to  the  Directress  of  the  Schleswig-Holstein  Museum ; 
Illustrated  Lectures  in  Art  Galleries  and  Museums,  by  T.  Eennie  ; 
and  the  Lighting  of  Museums,  by  Thomas  White. 

The  perusal  of  these  papers  brings  under  our  notice  two  important 
questions  connected  with  museum  economy.  The  first  of  these 
relates  to  Type  Specimens.  It  is  extremely  desirable  that  all 
museums  should  publish  catalogues  of  the  types  contained  in  their 
collections,  and  by  many  museums  this  has  already  been  clone.  But 
the  idea  of  bringing  together  all  the  type  specimens  in  the  kingdom, 
perhaps  in  the  world,  as  some  people  possibly  desire,  is  not  only  utterly 
impracticable,  but  from  some  points  of  view  not  even  desirable.  A 
little  travel  is  not  at  all  a  bad  thing  for  a  zoological  worker,  and  no 
doubt  when  he  visits  other  towns  and  other  countries  for  the  purpose 
of  consulting  type  specimens  he  will  have  the  opportunity  of  enlarg- 


132  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

ing  his  mind  in  other  directions  as  well.  At  the  same  time  it  may  be 
readily  conceded  that  the  possession  of  type  specimens  by  small 
provincial  museums  in  out-of-the-way  places,  is  not  for  the  advantage 
of  science. 

But  perhaps  of  greater  importance,  from  a  general  point  of  view, 
is  the  disposal  of  the  exhibited  collections  for  educational  purposes. 

The  now  well-known  idea  that  the  exhibited  portion  of  a  museum 
should  be  a  collection  of  labels,  illustrated  by  specimens,  may  be 
carried  a  great  deal  too  far — so  far  as  to  upset  the  fundamental  idea 
of  a  museum  without  attaining  the  object  desired.  Those  who  wish 
to  study  any  particular  branch  of  Natural  History  ought  to  find,  in  a 
well-arranged  typical  collection,  where  the  specimens  are  provided 
with  suitable  descriptive  labels,  much  invaluable  assistance — but 
such  labels  can  never  supply  the  place  of  proper  text-books,  studied 
at  home  as  well  as  in  the  museum  or  laboratory.  We  may  take  an 
example  in  this  connection  from  Mr  H.  Bolton's  set  of  descriptive 
labels  for  the  geological  collection  in  the  Peel  Park  Museum,  Salford, 
which  are  published  in  full  in  this  volume.  These  labels  are  in 
themselves  very  good  and  praiseworthy  summaries  of  the  present 
knowledge  of  the  geological  formations  in  Great  Britain,  but  to  the 
serious  student  who  possesses  a  good  text-book  of  geology  they  are 
wholly  unnecessary,  while  to  those  who,  like  most  of  the  general 
public,  are  previously  entirely  ignorant  of  the  subject,  they  must 
be  utterly  unintelligible.  The  use  of  a  label  is,  T  presume,  to  tell 
what  a  specimen  is  and  what  it  shows,  and  not  to  enter  into  a 
dissertation  on  any  general  subject,  that  being  the  business  of  the 
text-book  and  of  the  teacher. 

Mr  Ord's  plan  for  teaching  chemistry  by  specimens,  diagrams, 
models,  and  descriptive  labels,  is  to  my  mind  carrying  the  educational 
theory  of  museums  to  a  pitch  of  absurdity.  A  collection  of  metals, 
salts,  &c,  is  no  doubt  a  desirable  feature  in  connection  with  the 
chemical  department  of  a  school  or  college,  but  you  will  learn 
chemistry  only  in  the  laboratory,  and  certainly  not  in  a  museum. 

But,  however  some  of  us  may  disagree  with  some  of  the  notions 
of  individual  writers  of  papers  in  the  present  volume,  the  Museums 
Association  is  bound  to  do  good  by  promoting  the  free  discussion 
of  the  questions  at  issue.  E.  H.  Traquair. 

The  Geological  Department  of  the  British  Museum 

A  Guide  to  the  Fossil  Invertebrates  and  Plants  in  the  Department  of  Geology 
and  Palaeontology  in  the  British  Museum  (Natural  History),  Cromwell  Road, 
London,  SAY.  8vo.  Pp.  xvi.  158,  with  182  text-figures.  Printed  by  order  of  the 
Trustees,  1S9".     Priee,  Is.  ;  also  in  two  parts,  price  6d.  each. 

Tins  is  a  remarkable  shillingsworth,  so  much  so  that  anything  less 
than  effusive  thanks  for  it  smacks  of  ingratitude.  Thanks,  we  are 
sure,  the  public  will  oiler  to  the  trustees,  to  Dr  Henry  Woodward, 
the  popular  keeper  of  the  department,  and  to  the  able  set  of  colla- 
borators whose  help  he  acknowledges.  Only  had  the  book  been 
priced  at  five  shillings  or  so  could  we  have  ventured  on  any  criticism. 
We  might  then  have  asked  for  a  little  more  co-ordination  between  the 
parts,  a  keener  sense  of  proportion,  and  more  careful  selection  of 
illustrations.     With  thirty-six  pages  devoted  to  the  eephalopods,  the 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  133 

four  other  classes  of  the  Mollusca  might  have  had  more  than  eight. 
We  should  not,  even  in  a  geological  guide,  expect  to  find  the  Bracbio- 
poda  and  Bryozoa  associated  with  the  Arthropoda  and  Vermes  as  a 
'  Subkingdom  Annulosa.'  To  balance  the  fifteen  pages  on  sponges, 
or  the  seventeen  figures  of  trilobites,  we  should  have  asked  for  more 
than  twenty-four  lines  on  those  particularly  interesting  forms,  the 
Cystidea  and  Blastoidea,  especially  as  our  national  museum  possesses 
not  only  a  fine  collection  of  these  rarities,  but  an  officer  well  qualified 
to  deal  with  them.  And,  in  the  account  of  the  sponges,  one  might 
have  suggested  that  a  simple  division  into  Silicispongiae  and  Calci- 
spongiae  scarcely  represented  modern  ideas  of  classification.  Finally, 
we  should  have  demanded  very  much  better  paper  and  printing  ;  and 
even  now  we  hardly  consider  that  the  get  up  of  the  work  befits  a 
great  public  department — it  is  certainly  inferior  to  that  of  previous 
Guides. 

But  whether  regarded  as  a  text-book  or  as  a  guide  there  is  no 
doubt  that  in  many  respects  the  work  is  a  great  advance  on  anything 
hitherto  attempted  at  the  price.  We  hope  that  the  public  will 
recognise  this,  and  that  the  speedy  exhaustion  of  the  edition  may 
pave  the  way  for  another  with  all  the  merits  and  without  the  few 
defects  of  the  present  one. 

"  PALAEONTOGRAPHICA  "    AMONG    CRIMINAL    LITERATURE 

Relics  of  Primeval  Life.     By  Sir  J.  W.  Dawson,  K.C.M.G.,  F.R.S.     8vo,  pp.  ix. 
336,  with  67  figs.     London  :  Hodder  &  Stoughton,  1897. 

Sir  William  Dawson's  book  on  "  The  Dawn  of  Life  "  having  been 
for  some  time  out  of  print,  he  has  prepared  the  present  volume  to 
take  its  place.  A  good  deal  of  the  old  matter  and  many  of  the  illus- 
trations therefore  naturally  reappear.  The  familiar  story  of  the  dis- 
covery of  Eozoon,  and  of  the  spread  of  the  belief  in  its  organic 
structure,  is  again  told,  and  Sir  William  Dawson  refers  to  the  prin- 
cipal criticisms  on  the  other  side.  On  pp.  273-274  Eozoon  is  made  to 
tell  the  story  of  its  own  existence  in  an  imaginary  autobiography. 
It  candidly  admits  its  low  intelligence  and  that  it  did  not  know 
whence  it  came ;  but  "  at  length  a  change  came.  Certain  creatures 
with  hard  snouts  and  jaws  began  to  prey  on  me."  Apparently  the 
most  objectionable  of  the  hard-snouted  generation  was  Mobius,  whose 
work,  in  spite  of  its  "large  and  costly  figures"  (p.  161),  is  described 
as  valueless,  owing  to  "  that  narrow  specialism  and  captious  spirit  for 
which  German  naturalists  are  too  deservedly  celebrated."  Mobius, 
according  to  Sir  William  Dawson,  "  did  his  best ; "  but  so  bad  is  his 
best  that  the  publication  of  his  memoir  "  was  a  crime  which  science 
should  not  readily  pardon  or  forget  on  the  part  of  the  editors  of  the 
German  periodical  "  in  which  it  appeared. 

Sir  William  Dawson  does  not  give  his  opponents  a  very  cordial 
invitation  to  continue  the  discussion,  for  he  remarks  in  reference  to 
the  honest  way  in  which  Eozoon  did  his  duty,  that  those  who  "  dispute 
as  to  his  origin  and  fate  "  are  "  much  less  perfectly  fulfilling  the  ends 
of  their  own  existence."  So  we  will  try  to  fulfil  the  ends  of  our  own 
existence  by  discussing  subjects  in  which  an  adverse  verdict  is  not  a 
"  crime." 


134  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

Our  Naturalists 

Mr  L.  Upcott  Gill,  170  Strand,  has  kindly  sent  us  "  The  Naturalist's 
Directory,"  1897;  price  Is.  This,  the  third  edition,  will  undoubtedly 
be  useful  to  us,  for  it  contains  a  large  number  of  names  that  are  not 
to  be  found  in  the  ordinary  lists  of  learned  societies  or  in  the  invalu- 
able "  Zoologisches  Adress-1  >uch  "  of  Friedlander.  We  presume  the 
majority  of  those  included  in  the  above-mentioned  works  are  here 
omitted  of  set  purpose ;  there  would  be  no  difficulty  in  comprising 
them.  At  the  same  time,  some  hint  might  have  been  given  as  to  the 
principles  on  which  the  selection  was  made.  It  is  pleasing  to  find 
that  there  are  so  many  people  claiming  to  be  naturalists  in  the  British 
Isles.  As  for  the  foreign  and  colonial  lists,  their  similar  vagaries  are 
perhaps  due  to  the  fact  that  they  are  avowedly  restricted  to  persons 
desiring  to  correspond  or  exchange  specimens  with  collectors  and 
students  in  this  country.  The  extension  of  these  lists,  no  difficult 
task,  would  be  of  much  use.  The  book  also  contains  a  trade-directory, 
a  list  of  societies,  field-clubs,  and  museums  in  the  British  Isles,  a  list 
of  the  principal  natural  history  works  published  during  1896  in  the 
British  Isles,  and  a  somewhat  erratically  selected  but  useful  list  of 
natural  science  magazines,  in  which,  if  we  may  judge  from  our  own 
case,  the  information  is  not  always  so  correct  as  it  might  be. 

Botanical  Bibliography 

The  Cambridge  Botanical  Supply  Co.  are  distributing  samples  of 
their  card  catalogue  of  current  literature  relating  to  American  botany. 
Items  are  arranged  according  to  authors'  names,  but  an  edition  of 
subjects  is  also  in  preparation.  The  matter  is  prepared  by  a  board  of 
editors,  which  includes  the  leading  botanists  of  Columbia  College,  the 
National  Herbarium,  and  other  institutions,  and  is  published  under 
the  direction  of  a  committee  of  the  American  Association  for  the 
Advancement  of  Science. 

The  cards  used  are  of  heavy  linen  ledger  paper  made  to  order  for 
this  purpose.  They  are  cut  with  extreme  accuracy  by  an  expensive 
machine.  The  size  is  50  by  125  mm.  The  number  of  cards  issued  in 
1891  averaged  49  per  month  ;  for  1895  the  average  was  over  60,  and 
the  total  number  of  cards  to  April  1897,  2319.  Subscriptions  ($5,  paid 
in  advance)  may  be  sent  to  Wm.  Wesley  &  Son,  28  Essex  Street, 
Strand,  London. 

We  commend  this  useful  enterprise  to  the  notice  of  the  British 
Association  for  the  Advancement  of  Science. 

Westmorelandshire's  Field  Geology  forms  the  subject  of  a  paper 
by  Mr  H.  G.  Foster- Bar! lam,  which  was  read  before  the  Burneside 
Mutual  Improvement  Society  on  February  11,  1897.  The  paper, 
which  is  illustrated  by  sketch-maps  and  sections,  is  published  by 
B.  Atkinson,  Stramongate,  Kendal,  at  Is.,  post  free,  and  gives  a  general 
account  of  the  interesting  district. 

Scraps  from  Serials 

The    ever    interesting    Scottish    Geographical    Magazine    gives    two 
lively  articles  in  its  July  number.     Sir  Henry  Tyler  writes  on  the 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  135 

Geography  of  Communications,  showing  the  enormous  progress  that 
has  been  made  during  the  Victorian  era,  and  Major  A.  C.  Yates 
describes  Loralai,  a  frontier  cantonment  in  Baluchistan. 

An  article  that  should  interest  ethnologists  is  J.  F.  Hewitt's  "The 
History  of  the  Week  as  a  Guide  to  Prehistoric  Chronology,"  in  the 
Westminster  Ecriciv  for  July. 

The  American  Journal  of  Science  for  July  contains  a  description 
of  Ctenacanthus  spines  from  the  Carboniferous  Keokuk  Limestone  of 
Iowa,  by  Dr  C.  E.  Eastman  ;  a  morphological  account  of  two  species 
of  Cyperaceae,  Fuirena  squarrosa  and  F.  scirpoidea,  by  T.  Holm  ;  con- 
tact metamorphism  between  slate  and  diabase  in  the  El  Pasco  range, 
California,  described  by  H.  W.  Fairbanks,  who  also  writes  on  tin- 
deposits  at  Tenescal ;  notes  on  outliers  of  the  Comanche  series  (Lower 
Cretaceous)  in  Oklahoma  and  Kansas,  by  T.  W.  Vaughan. 

The  July  Photogram  contains  yet  another  article  on  the  Photo- 
graphy of  Birds'  Nests,  by  Dr  E.  W.  Shufeldt.  An  article  on  Tech- 
nical Photography  describes  the  studios  of  J.  Bulbeck  &  Co.  "We 
should  like  to  see  something  on  the  application  of  photography  to  the 
illustration  of  scientific  papers.  It  is  a  failure  in  nine  cases  out  of 
ten,  no  doubt,  but  whether  it  is  worse  than  the  ordinary  draughtsman 
is  a  delicate  point. 

The  Irish  Naturalist  for  July  is  chiefly  devoted  to  "Some  Observa- 
tions by  English  Naturalists  (E.  Standen,  L.  E.  Adams,  G.  W. 
Chaster,  and  J.  E.  Hardy)  on  the  fauna  of  Eathlin  Island  and 
Ballycastle  District." 

The  Naturalist  for  July  contains  Mr  John  Cordeaux's  Presidential 
Address  to  the  Yorkshire  Naturalists'  Union.  It  deals  with  glaciers, 
plant-distribution,  the  antiquities  of  Holderness,  and '  Yorkshire 
ornithology.  Following  this,  G.  0.  Benoni  encourages  others  by  his 
example  to  take  notes  on  natural  history  matters.  One  thing  to  be 
noticed  is  "  the  young  oak  thrusting  up  from  [the  field  mouse's] 
abandoned  home  and  store  after  a  mild  winter,  as  he  stalks  his  rabbits 
down  the  woodside."     It  is  indeed. 

New  Serials 

Messrs  Gixn  &  Co.,  Boston,  U.S.A.,  announce  The  Zoological 
Bulletin,  a  companion  serial  to  the  Journal  of  Morphology,  de- 
signed for  shorter  contributions  in  animal  morphology  and  general 
biology,  with  no  illustrations  beyond  text-figures.  It  is  pro- 
posed to  publish  six  numbers  a  year  of  about  fifty  pages  each 
in  the  same  form  and  style  as  the  Journal  of  Morphology.  The 
Bulletin  will  contain  nothing  but  scientific  communications.  The 
editors  are  C.  O.  Whitman  and  W.  M.  Wheeler,  assisted  by  a  number 
of  collaborators.  The  subscription  price  per  volume  of  six  numbers 
is  $3.00,  and  single  numbers  are  sold  separately  at  75  cents,  each. 

We  have  already  announced  the  new  quarterly  East  Asia,  edited 
by  Dr  H.  Faulds  of  Stoke-on-Trent,  and  published  by  Hughes  &  Harber 
of  Longton,  Staffordshire,  at  one  shilling  a  part.  The  first  number, 
published  at  the  beginning  of  July,  proves  both  entertaining  and  in- 
structive. The  chief  articles  are  "  Judicial  Reform  in  China,"  by  Dr 
Sun  Yat  Sen;  "The  Numeral  System  for  the  Blind  in  China,"  by  Miss 


136  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

C.  F.  Gordon-dimming  ;  "  At  a  Japanese  Barber's,"  by  F.  A.  Bather ; 
and  an  interesting  account  of  "  The  Community  in  Cocos-Keeling  and 
Christmas  Islands,"  abstracted  from  a  Blue-book.  There  is  a  list  of 
recent  books  and  magazine  articles  dealing  with  the  far  East.  The 
Eeviews  and  Notes  would  be  better  for  more  exactness  of  reference, 
and  prices  of  books  should  be  given.  Anthropologists  will  find  in 
this  excellently  printed  journal  many  an  item  to  interest  them. 

Further  Literature  Received 

Synoptical  Flora  of  North  America,  vol.  i.,  pt.  i.,  fasc.  ii.,  A.  Gray,  ed.  B.  J. 
Robinson:  American  Book  Co.,  New  York.  The  Life-histories  of  the  British  Marine 
Food-fishes,  W.  C.  Mcintosh  and  A.  T.  Masterman  :  C.  J.  Clay.  Traite  de  Zoologie, 
fasc.  xi.,  xvi.,  ed.  R.  Blanchard  :  Rueff,  Paris.  Catalogus  Mammalium  tam  viventium 
quam  fossilium,  ed.  nov.,  fasc.  ii.,  E.  L.  Trouessart :  Friedliinder.  Thirty-first  Ann. 
Rep.  Museums  and  Lecture  Rooms  Syndicate,  Cambridge.  Ann.  Rep.  Raffles  Library 
and  Museum,  Singapore,  1896.  Third  Rep.  Whitechapel  Public  Library  and  Museum. 
Society  for  the  Protection  of  Birds — Educational  Series,  No.  12. 

The  Reading  of  Words,  W.  B.  Pillsbury  :  Aoner.  Journ.  Psychol.  Humanitarian 
League  Correspondence.  An  Extraordinary  Case  of  Colour  Blindness,  F.  H.  P.  Coste 
(extract  ?). 

Jersey  Times,  July  9  ;  Amer.  Geol. ,  July  ;  Amer.  Journ.  Sci. ,  July  ;  Amer.  Nat. , 
July  ;  Annot.  Zool.  Japan,  May  ;  Feuille  des  jeunes  Nat.,  July  ;  Illinois  Wes.  Mag., 
June;  Irish  Nat.,  July;  Journ.  School  Geogr.,  June;  Knowledge,  July;  Literary 
Digest,  June  12,  19,  26,  July  3  ;  Nat.  Novit.,  June  ;  La  Naturaleza  (Madrid),  Nos.  18,  19  ; 
La  Naturaleza  (Mexico),  No.  17  ;  Naturalist,  July  ;  Nature,  June  24,  July  1,  8,  15  ; 
Nature  Notes,  July  ;  Photogram,  July;  Rev.  Scient. ,  June  26,  July  3,  10  ;  Science, 
June  11,  18,  25,  July  2  ;  Science  Gossip,  July  ;  Sci.  Amer.,  June  12,  19,  26,  July  3  ; 
Scot.  Geogr.  Mag.,  July  ;  Westminster  Rev.,  July  ;  Proc.  Biol.  Soc,  Washington, 
vol.  xi.,  pp.  145-174  ;  Bull,  de  l'lnst.  Internat.  Bibliogr.,  ii.,  fasc.  3  ;  Trans,  and  Ann. 
Rep.  Manchester  Micros.  Soc,  1896  ;  Bull.  Alabama  Agric.  Exper.  Station,  No.  80  ; 
La  Bibliographie  Scient.,  Bull.  Trimestr.,  vol.  ii.,  No  4  ;  L'Annee  Biol.,  1895. 


18971  137 


NEWS 

The  following  appointments  are  announced  : — 

Dr  J.  Biittikofer,  of  the  State  Museum  in  Leiden,  to  be  director  of  the 
Zoological  Garden  at  Rotterdam  ;  Dr  Johannes  Martin  to  be  director  of  the 
Natural  History  Museum  in  Oldenburg  ;  Dr  W.  B.  Pillsbury  to  be  instructor  in 
psychology  and  director  of  the  Psychological  Laboratory  in  the  University  of 
Michigan  ;  Dr  Antoneo  Crocichia  to  be  professor  of  biology  at  the  Catholic 
University,  Washington  ;  Prof.  W.  T.  Engelmann  to  succeed  the  late  Prof.  Du 
Bois  Reymond  as  professor  of  physiology  at  the  University  of  Berlin  ;  Adolf 
Beck,  from  professor-extraordinarius  to  professor  of  physiology  at  Lemberg  ; 
Mr  Muir,  of  Halifax  University,  to  be  professor  of  psychology  in  Mount  Holyoke 
College ;  Dr  C.  E.  Seashore  to  be  assistant-professor  of  psychology  at  the  University 
of  Iowa  ;  E.  M.  Weyer  and  M.  Matsumoto  to  be  assistants  in  the  Yale  Psycho- 
logical Laboratory  ;  Jas.  H.  MacGregor  to  be  assistant  in  zoology  at  Columbia 
University  ;  Dr  Ludwig  Heim  to  be  professor-extraordinarius  of  bacteriology  at 
the  University  of  Erlangen  ;  Dr  G.  Boccardi  to  be  associate-professor  of  micro- 
scopical anatomy  at  Naples  ;  Dr  J.  J.  Zumstein  to  be  professor  of  anatomy  at 
the  University  of  Marburg  ;  Dr  Mayr  to  be  prosector  at  the  Veterinary  College, 
Munich  ;  Dr  H.  Baum  to  be  professor  of  osteology  at  the  Dresden  Technical 
High  School  ;  Miss  Mary  E.  Pennington  to  be  Thomas  A.  Scott  felloAv  in 
hygiene  at  the  University  of  Pennsylvania  ;  Dr  Brault  to  be  professor  of 
tropical  diseases  at  Algiers ;  S.I.  Franz  to  be  assistant  in  psychology  at 
Columbia  University  ;  Dr  T.  Fuchs  to  be  associate-professor  of  palaeontology  at 
Munich  ;  Miss  Bertha  Stoneman  to  be  professor  of  botany  in  the  Huguenot 
College  for  "Women  in  Cape  Colony  ;  Prof.  Georg  Volkens  to  be  assistant  in  the 
Botanical  Museum  of  the  Berlin  University  ;  J.  R.  Campbell  to  be  lecturer  in 
agriculture  at  the  Harris  Institute,  Preston  ;  Dr  A.  O.  Kihlman  to  be  assistant - 
professor  of  botany  at  Helsingfors  ;  Herbert  M.  Richards  to  be  tutor  in  botany 
at  Columbia  University  ;  Dr  J.  Szadowski  to  be  associate-professor  of  geology  at 
Klausenburg  ;  W.  S.  Boulton,  of  Mason  College,  Birmingham,  to  be  lecturer  in 
geology  at  University  College,  Cardiff  ;  Dr  Pliilijapi  to  be  assistant  in  the 
Geologico-Palaeontological  Department  of  the  Natural  History  Museum  in 
Berlin  ;  Frederick  L.  Ransome  to  be  assistant  geologist  on  the  U.S.  Geological 
Survey  ;  T.  I.  Pocock,  of  Corpus  Christi  College,  Oxford,  to  be  assistant  geologist 
on  the  Geological  Survey  of  the  United  Kingdom  ;  R.  E.  Dodge  to  be  professor  of 
geography  at  the  Teachers'  College,  New  York  ;  Dr  W.  F.  Hume  and  L.  Gorringe 
to  be  assistants  on  the  Geological  Survey  of  Egypt ;  E.  W.  MacBride  to  be 
professor  of  zoology  in  McGill  University,  Montreal. 

A  biological  station  will  shortly  be  opened  near  Sebastopol. 

A  summer  school  of  biology  on  the  Mississippi,  not  far  from  Monmouth,  111., 
has  been  organised  by  Drs  Maxwell  and  Swann. 

The  Derby  and  Mayer  Museums  at  Liverpool  have  acquired  the  fine  collection 
of  flint  implements  brought  from  Egypt  by  Mr  Seton-Karr. 

L'Association  Francaise  pour  l'Avancement  des  Sciences  meets  at  St  Etienne, 
August  5-12,  under  the  presidency  of  Prof.  E.  J.  Marey. 

According  to  Science  the  University  of  Montana,  at  Missoula,  has  decided  to 
erect  a  main  building  at  a  cost  of  $47,500,  and  a  science  hall  at  a  cost  of  $12,500. 

K 


138  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

It  is  proposed  to  erect  a  monument  at  Moscow  to  the  zoologist  and  anthro- 
pologist, Anatole  Bogdanow,  who  died  in  April  1896. 

A  giant  salamander  of  Japan,  that  had  lived  in  the  Jardin  des  Plantes  for 
thirty-seven  years,  died  on  June  15,  having  a  length  of  1\30  metre  and  a  weight 
of  24  kilograms.     Two  survivors  mourn  its  loss. 

Science  states  that  a  zoological  club  of  nineteen  members  has  been  organised 
at  Springfield,  Mass.,  the  president  being  W.  W.  Colburn,  and  the  secretary  Miss 
M.  A.  Young. 

With  reference  to  the  note  in  our  last  number  on  the  biological  station 
at  Plon,  we  now  learn  that  the  Prussian  Government  will  assist  it  after  October 
1898. 

An  expedition,  under  the  leadership  of  Mr  C.  M.  Harris  of  Augusta,  Me.,  and 
at  the  cost  of  the  Hon.  Walter  Rothschild,  is  studying  the  fauna  and  flora  of  the 
Galapagos  Islands. 

An  expedition  to  Okhotsk  and  Kamtschatka,  under  the  leadership  of  K. 
Bogdanowitsch,  has  found  gold  at  thirteen  different  places  in  the  river-systems 
of  the  Jana,  Kyran,  Nemuj,  Mute,  and  Lantar. 

A  botanical  society,  named  after  Baron  F.  von  Muller,  has  been  founded 
at  Perth,  W.  Australia.  Its  president  is  Sir  John  Forrest,  the  indefatigable 
Premier,  and  its  secretary,  Mr  Skews. 

Sir  Martin  Conway  and  Mr  E.  J.  Garwood  have  returned  to  Spitzbergen  to 
continue  the  exploration  of  the  interior  of  the  main  island.  Afterwards  they 
will  go  to  Horn  Sound  and  finish  the  exploration  of  the  southern  peninsula. 

Science  states  that  it  is  proposed  to  enlarge  the  Missouri  Botanical  Garden, 
by  the  gradual  addition  of  80  acres,  of  which  21  will  be  drained  and  graded 
during  the  present  season. 

Dr  J.  E.  Humphrey,  botanist,  and  Prof.  W.  K.  Brooks,  zoologist,  are  con- 
ducting a  course  of  marine  biology  in  Jamaica  for  students  of  Johns  Hopkins 
University.  The  laboratory  has  formerly  been  at  Port  Henderson,  on  the  south 
side  of  the  island,  but  this  year  it  is  at  Port  Antonio,  on  the  north. 

The  U.S.  Senate  has  agreed  to  admit  free  of  dutjr  printed  books  over  twenty 
years  old,  books  in  foreign  languages  and  those  devoted  to  scientific  research, 
and  books  and  scientific  instruments  imported  for  public  and  educational 
institutions. 

Dr  J.  Walter  Fewkes,  of  the  Bureau  of  American  Ethnology,  is  making  a 
third  expedition  to  the  Pueblo  Region,  where,  says  Science,  he  will  survey  and 
excavate  the  ruins  of  Kintiel,  near  Navajo  Springs,  Arizona.  He  is  accompanied 
by  Dr  W.  Hough  of  the  U.S.  National  Museum. 

Messrs  E.  M'Illhenny,  W.  E.  Snyder,  and  N.  G.  Baxton  have  gone  to  Point 
Barrow  to  collect  the  fauna  and  flora  of  N.E.  Alaska.  Science  hears  that  the 
collections  will  go  to  the  National  Museum,  U.S.,  and  the  University  (if 
Pennsylvania. 

A  biological  station,  under  the  direction  of  Prof.  C.  W.  Dodge,  is  to  be 
established  by  the  University  of  Rochester,  N.Y.,  on  Hemlock  Lake.  We  have 
not  yet  heard  that  any  fresh-water  biological  station  is  to  be  established  in 
England. 

The  Scottish  Geographical  Magazine  states  that  on  May  8  an  expedition  under 
Lieut.  Drizhenko  left  St  Petersburg  for  Lake  Baikal,  which  will  be  sounded  and 
surveyed,  while  natural  history   collections   will  be  made.     The   work  will  be 
continuedfor    five  years. 


1897]  NEWS  139 

The  tenth  congress  of  Russian  naturalists  and  physicians,  which  was  to  have 
been  held  this  August  in  Kiev,  has,  in  consequence  of  the  International  Con- 
gresses of  Geology  and  Medicine  both  meeting  in  Russia,  been  postponed  till 
August  1898. 

The  University  of  Pennsylvania  is  to  have  a  new  Museum  of  Archaeology  and 
Palaeontology.  The  architecture,  says  the  American  Naturalist,  will  be  in 
Italian  renaissance  style.  A  botanical  garden,  covering  ten  acres,  will  surround 
the  museum. 

The  International  Postal  Congress  has  decided  that  henceforth  objects  of 
natural  history,  animals,  dried  plants,  or  preserved  zoological  specimens  may  be 
sent  as  samples  of  merchandise,  at  |d.  for  every  two  ounces,  the  maximum  weight 
being  350  grammes. 

Another  expedition  to  Alaska  is  that  of  Dr  W.  H.  Evans  of  Washington, 
who  has  gone  to  examine  the  agricultural  resources  of  the  district  south  of  the 
Aleutian  peninsula.  Dr  Sheldon  Jackson  goes  on  a  similar  errand  to  the  Yukon 
basin. 

The  Societe  helvetique  des  Sciences  Naturelles  holds  its  eightieth  animal 
meeting  at  Engelberg,  near  Mt.  Titlis,  Sept.  12  to  15.  The  president  of  the 
annual  committee  is  Dr  E.  Etlin,  Sarnen,  Obwalden,  to  whom  those  who  wish  to 
attend  should  apply. 

Mr  R.  H.  Kitson,  of  Trinity  College,  has  been  awarded  the  Harkness  Scholar- 
ship in  Geology  and  Palaeontology  at  Cambridge  University.  Mr  V.  H.  Black- 
man  of  St  John's  College  and  the  British  Museum,  has  been  awarded  the 
Hutchinson  Studentship,  for  his  researches  on  Algae. 

The  Zoological  Society  of  London  has  awarded  its  silver  medal  to  Mr 
Alexander  Whyte,  recently  naturalist  to  the  Administration  of  British  Central 
Africa,  who  has  sent  home  large  collections  illustrating  the  fauna  and  flora  of 
Xyassaland. 

With  reference  to  our  note  on  the  extinction  of  the  bison  (which  some  call 
buffalo),  it  is  interesting  to  learn  from  Nature  that  a  variety  known  as  the  '  wood- 
bison  '  is  still  to  be  met  with  near  Fort  Chipewyan,  south  of  the  Great  Slave 
Lake,  where  it  was  seen  in  1894  by  Mr  Caspar  Whitney.  There  is  no  specimen 
in  the  British  Museum.     Nature  says  there  ought  to  be,  and  so  do  we. 

At  Danesdale,  near  Driffield,  Yorkshire,  are  some  200  mounds,  locally  known 
as  Danes'  Graves.  These  have  recently  been  excavated  by  Canon  Greenwell, 
Mr  J.  R.  Mortimer,  and  Mr  T.  Boynton,  who  have  found  remains  of  a  chariot  and 
various  articles  of  iron  and  bronze,  tending  to  show  that  the  graves  are  of  pre- 
Roman  age,  though  more  exact  determination  is  at  present  not  attempted. 

General  Russell  Sturgis  has  offered  New  York  University  a  site  on  his 
estate  at  Hamilton,  Bermuda,  for  the  establishment  of  a  marine  biological  station. 
Prof.  C.  L.  Bristol,  Prof.  W.  H.  Everett,  Dr  Tarleton  H.  Bean,  Dr  W.  M. 
Rankin  of  Princeton,  and  three  students  of  the  University  have  gone  to  prospect 
and  to  collect. 

The  seventh  session  of  the  Australasian  Association  for  the  Advancement  of 
Science  is  to  be  held  at  Sydney  in  the  second  week  of  January  next,  under 
the  presidency  of  Prof.  Liversidge.  Capt.  F.  W.  Hutton  is  to  be  president  of 
the  Geological  section,  Prof.  T.  J.  Parker  of  the  Biological,  and  Mr  A.  W.  Howitt 
of  the  Ethnological.     „ 

A  living  specimen  of  Pleurotomaria  beyrichi  was  obtained  last  March  by  Mr 
Alan  Owston  of  Yokohama,  and  was  examined  by  Prof.  Mitsukuri.  It  appears 
that  two  lobes,  one  on  either  side  of  the  foot,  envelop  the  shell  to  some  extent,  and 


140  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

this  may  account  for  the  fact  that  the  shells  of  this  genus  are  always  very  clean. 
The  relations  of  the  mantle  to  the  slit  on  the  outer  lip  could  not  be  observed. 

After  descending  Aconcagua,  Zurbriggen  and  Mr  Stuart  Vines  ascended  tlie 
neighbouring  Tupungato,  which  proved  to  be  a  volcano,  21,000  feet  high.  An 
active  volcano  was  seen  to  the  west. 

Another  large  volcano,  Orizaba,  has  recently  been  ascended  by  Mr  K.  T. 
Stoepel.  Its  extreme  height  is  18,333  feet,  the  length  of  the  crater  1540,  its 
breadth  1300,  its  depth  330. 

With  the  idea  that  a  fresh  outlet  may  be  provided  for  the  grain-bearing 
provinces  of  Canada,  an  exploration  of  Hudson  Bay  is  now  in  progress,  under 
the  command  of  Capt.  Wakeham.  Dr  R.  Bell  and  Mr  Low,  of  the  Canadian 
Geological  Survey,  will  make  geological  and  topographical  surveys  of  the  coasts 
and  islands,  while  Capt.  Wakeham  on  the  Diana  will  investigate  the  naviga- 
bility and  fishing  resources  of  the  waters. 

On  August  10,  Lord  Kenyon,  President  of  the  Shropshire  Horticultural 
Society,  will  unveil  the  statue  of  Darwin  that  has  been  erected  by  the  Society 
at  the  entrance  to  the  Public  Library  and  Museum,  the  former  school-buildings, 
of  Shrewsbury.  The  statue,  which  is  in  bronze  on  a  granite  pedestal,  is  the  work 
of  Mr  Horace  Montford  of  Shrewsbury,  and  is  not  wholly  unlike  the  fine  statue 
in  the  Natural  History  Museum,  London,  though  somewhat  more  alert  in 
expression. 

An  influential  meeting  was  held  in  the  rooms  of  the  Royal  Geographical 
Society  on  July  5  to  induce  the  Australasian  Premiers  to  bring  the  subject  of 
Antarctic  exploration  before  their  respective  Governments.  It  was  stated  that 
the  Society  was  prepared  to  contribute  £5000  towards  the  amount  subscribed 
by  the  Colonies.  Elocpient  and  convincing  speeches  were  delivered  ;  but  the 
Premiers  were  unable  to  be  present. 

Under  the  directorship  of  Dr  T.  Kochibe,  the  Geological  Survey  of  Japan  has 
been  making  good  progress,  and  the  staff  has  been  increased.  There  has  for  some 
time  been  accumulating  a  collection  chiefly  illustrative  of  practical  geology,  and 
it  is  now  proposed  to  build  a  proper  geological  museum  in  Tokyo.  A  short  time 
ago  some  valuable  phosphatic  beds  of  Tertiary  age  were  discovered  along  the 
north-east  shore  of  the  province  of  Kyushu,  and  Dr  Tsuneto,  of  the  Agronomic 
division  of  the  Survey,  has  been  experimenting  with  the  material  so  as  to  make  it 
available  for  the  small  Japanese  peasant-farmers  to  use  as  manure.  The  organic 
remains  in  the  deposit  are  those  of  marine  invertebrates. 

The  Commissioners  of  the  Whitechapel  Public  Library  and  Museum,  in  their 
third  report,  are  glad  to  note  the  life  infused  into  the  museum  by  the  Curator, 
Miss  K.  M.  Hall.  The  average  daily  attendance  is  275.  A  series  of  science  lec- 
tures has  been  given  free  by  eminent  workers,  and  has  been  fully  attended.  Two 
exhibitions  of  spring  flowers,  and  two  of  children's  natural  history  collections, 
have  been  held.  Twenty  visits  of  classes  from  Elementary  Schools  have  been 
made  under  Article  20  of  the  Education  Code.  The  only  thing  in  this  report 
that  is  not  satisfactory  is  the  absence  of  Natural  Science  from  the  list  of  periodicals 
in  the  news-room. 

Last  October  the  Museum,  Art  Gallery,  Public  Library,  and  Technical  Insti- 
tute of  Worcester,  combined  under  the  title  of  the  Victoria  Institute,  were  moved 
into  a  new  building.  It  was  soon  found,  oddly  enough,  that  the  space  for  the 
museum  was  less  than  in  the  old  building,  and  it  was  necessary  to  appropriate  the 
basement  for  the  exhibition  of  the  geological  and  ethnological  specimens  in  spite  of 
l lie  little  light  available.  This  is  a  pity,  for  the  local  geological  collection  is  a 
good  one  in  itself,  and  further  contains  specimens  of  some  historic  interest  from 


1897]  NEWS  141 

the  collections  of  Hugh  Strickland,  \V.  S.  Symonds,  and  Wynnington  Ingram. 
Among  other  collections  in  the  Museum  are  one  of  local  birds,  and  a  good  one  of 
foreign  marine  shells  the  gift  of  the  late  Sir  Geo.  Whitmore.  The  heavy  task  of 
transferring  and  re-arranging  all  the  material  falls  on  the  shoulders  of  the  curator, 
Mr  W.  H.  Edwards. 

The  Zoological  Museum  of  the  Royal  Academy  of  Science,  St  Petersburg,  has 
acquired  thirty-three  specimens  of  fossil  bones  and  numerous  remains  of  Post- 
Tertiary  mammals  collected  by  J.  Savenkov  at  Krasnoyarsk.  Among  them  are 
some  bones  and  a  piece  of  skin  of  Rhinoceros  tichorhinus,  which  were  taken  from  a 
well-preserved  specimen  of  a  rhinoceros,  covered  with  skin,  found  60  versts  east 
of  Kasatschje,  on  the  bank  of  the  Charaula,  a  left  tributary  of  the  Tomskaja. 

In  the  Annuaire  Ge'ologique  et  Mineralogique  de  la  Russie,  vol.  ii.  livr.  3-4, 
from  which  this  news  is  taken,  Marie  Pavlov  describes,  with  photographs,  the 
occurrence  of  a  mammoth  (Elephas  primigenius  trogontherii)  near  the  town  of 
Yaroslavl,  found  during  the  making  of  a  railroad,  at  a  depth  of  6  metres.  The 
remains  have  been  sent  to  the  Geological  Museum  of  Moscow  University. 

That  there  is  still  something  new  to  be  found  in  England  is  constantly 
being  shown  by  the  active  members  of  the  Hull  Scientific  and  Field  Natur- 
alists' Club.  The  last  item  is  the  Moonwort  (Botrychmm  lunaria),  which  Mr 
Waterfall  has  seen  growing  wild  at  York.  Mr  Fierke,  in  a  lecture  on  crabs, 
gave  a  list  of  those  found  on  the  Yorkshire  coast,  and  urged  members  to  devote 
a  little  more  of  their  attention  to  the  rocks  and  pools  of  the  sea-shore,  where, 
we  agree  with  him,  they  will  find  a  rich  field  for  useful  work.  The  programme 
of  excursions  and  meetings  for  July-September  should  induce  a  large  number  to 
join  this  vigorous  body,  which  also  holds  out  the  inducement  of  a  new  and 
better  room  over  a  cycle  shop. 

Among  those  who  received  Jubilee  honours  were  :  Dr  Edward  Frankland, 
Dr  Huggins,  Mr  J.  Norman  Lockyer,  Dr  Thome  Thome,  Mr  Wolfe  Barry, 
President  of  the  Institute  of  Civil  Engineers,  and  Admiral  Wharton,  Hydro- 
grapher  to  the  Admiralty,  to  be  K.C.B.;  Mr  W.  H.  M.  Christie,  Astronomer 
Royal,  to  be  C.B.;  Sir  William  MacCormac,  President  of  the  Royal  College  of 
Surgeons,  Dr  S.  Wilkes,  President  of  the  Royal  College  of  Physicians,  and  Mr 
Thos.  Smith,  Surgeon-in-ordinary  to  Her  Majesty,  to  be  Baronets  ;  Sir  Joseph 
Hooker  and  Lieut. -General  Strachey  to  be  G.C.S.I. ;  Mr  William  Crookes, 
President-designate  of  the  British  Association,  and  Dr  Gowers,  to  be  knights  ; 
Sir  Herbert  E.  Maxwell  to  be  Privy  Councillor. 

We  have  received  the  report  of  the  Raffles  Library  and  Museum,  Singapore, 
for  1896,  by  Dr  R.  Hanitsch.  A  number  of  new  cases  have  been  introduced,  and 
the  museum  has  undergone  entire  rearrangement.  There  is  now  exhibited  the 
beginning  of  a  collection  of  the  local  marine  fauna.  A  shifting  of  specimens  has 
also  taken  place,  allowing  more  room  to  the  birds  and  reptiles,  and  concentrating 
the  ethnological  collections.  Owing  to  the  absence  of  a  workshop,  the  exhibition 
rooms  had  to  be  closed  while  the  changes  were  in  progress.  Among  the  acquisi- 
tions of  the  museum  is  a  specimen  of  Madreporaria  reticulata  {!),  4  ft.  5  in. 
by  2  ft.  8  in.,  picked  up  on  October  20,  1896,  by  the  Cable  ship  Sherard 
Osborne  in  the  Bali  Straits,  at  fifteen  fathoms,  where  it  had  grown  round  a 
cable  laid  in  1888,  thus  giving  another  proof  of  the  rapid  growth  of  corals. 
Lieut.  Harvey,  R.E.,  lent  a  boat  and  crew  for  dredging  excursions  on  several 
occasions,  and  other  dredging  trips  were  arranged  by  Mr  G.  Holt  and  the  Com- 
mittee. A  zoological  station  has  often  been  proposed,  and  is  greatly  needed  ;  a 
simple  movable  shed,  with  plain  furniture,  jars,  and  preserving  iluids,  is  all  that 
is  absolutely  required. 


142  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [August 

Many  interesting  matters  are  dealt  with  in  the  report  of  the  Albany 
Museum,  Cape  of  Good  Hope,  for  1896,  to  which  we  have  already  alluded  in 
part.  The  alarming  spread  of  insect  pests  in  the  Eastern  province  was  thought 
to  be  largely  due  to  the  wholesale  destruction  of  insectivorous  birds.  The  pro- 
tection of  certain  birds  under  an  Act  already  existing  was  therefore  recom- 
mended by  the  committee,  who  also  suggested  that  saloon  rifles,  air-guns  and 
catapults  should  be  placed  under  the  same  restrictions  as  firearms.  These  pro- 
posals have  been  agreed  to  by  the  municipalities  of  Grahamstown,  Port  Eliza- 
beth, Port  Alfred,  Uitenhage,  East  London,  Somerset,  East  Cathcart,  and  the 
divisional  Councils  of  Albany  and  Bathurst.  -  The  birds  for  which  protection  is 
desired  are  :  Vultures,  secretary  bird,  several  hawks,  especially  the  jackalsvogel 
(Buteo  jakal)  and  the  black-shouldered  kite  (Elanus  coerulexis),  owls,  goat- 
suckers, swallows,  kingfishers,  hombills,  cuckoos,  honeyguides,  woodpeckers, 
barbets,  thrushes  (excluding  fruit  thrushes),  warblers,  sunbirds  or  honeysuckers, 
flycatchers,  butcherbirds,  crows  (but  not  the  rook),  spreeuws  (excluding  redwing 
spreeuw  Amydrus  morio),  larks,  wagtails,  plovers,  and  sandpipers.  This  list 
purposely  omits  rarities  and  game-birds. 

Dr  Schonland  has  started  a  small  botanic  garden  for  S.  African  plants, 
and  intends  to  transfer  these  to  the  ground  round  the  museum. 

We  are  glad  to  see  that  the  geological  and  mineralogical  collections  of  the 
museum  are  being  used  for  teaching  purposes,  since  Dr  Schonland  lectures  to 
those  students  of  St  Andrew's  College,  Grahamstown,  who  are  studying  for  the 
first  mining  examination  of  the  University  of  the  Cape  of  Good  Hope.  This, 
it  is  hoped,  will  lead  to  more  thorough  geological  examination  of  the  surrounding 
country. 

Dr  Schonland  has  examined  some  peculiar  rock-drawings  in  Bechuanaland, 
supposed  to  be  the  work  of  bushmen.  They  can,  he  says,  only  be  looked  upon 
as  some  kind  of  writing  resembling  to  a  certain  extent  early  Semitic  writing. 
An  account  of  these,  with  photographs,  was  published  in  the  South  African 
Telegraph. 

On  June  3rd  a  second  expedition  to  make  deep  borings  into  the  coral  atoll  of 
Funafuti  set  sail  from  Sydney.  Towards  the  expense  of  this,  Miss  Eadith 
AValker,  of  Yaralla,  has  contributed  £500  ;  the  Government  of  New  South 
Wales  has  lent  a  diamond  drill ;  the  Hon.  Ralph  Abercromby  has  furnished  an 
oil-engine  at  a  cost  of  £100 ;  the  Hon.  H.  C.  Dangar  and  Prof.  T.  P.  Anderson 
Stuart  have  provided  a  fine  boat ;  the  Royal  Society,  London,  contributes  £100 
directly,  and  probably  another  £100  through  its  coral-boring  committee  ;  finally 
the  London  Missionary  Society  has  offered  to  bring  the  party  back  to  Sydney  in 
September.  The  expedition  is  under  the  auspices  of  the  Royal  Geographical 
Society  of  Australasia,  and  its  leader  is  Prof.  T.  W.  E.  David,  of  Sydney.  He 
and  Mr  G.  Sweet  of  Melbourne  are  going  at  their  own  expense,  and  will  take 
charge  of  the  borings.  Mrs  David  accompanies  them  as  store-keeper  and 
botanical  collector.  Mr  W.  Poole,  an  engineer  of  Sydney  University,  will 
manage  the  light  boring  apparatus,  and  will  be  aided  by  Mr  Woolnough,  who 
also  takes  charge  of  the  zoological  collecting.  These  gentlemen  give  their 
services  free.  The  large  diamond  drill  is  in  charge  of  Mr  Hall,  a  foreman  of 
considerable  experience,  who  has  under  him  two  sub-foremen  and  three  drill- 
workmen.  In  view  of  the  difficulties  already  met  with  at  Funafuti,  a  special 
boring  plant  has  been  provided  under  the  direction  of  Chief-Inspector  W.  II.  J. 
Slec,  and  weighs  over  25  tons.  The  main  bore,  on  the  central  island  of  Funafuti, 
will  In:  begun  with  a  standpipe  having  an  inside  diameter  of  G  inches,  and  the 
lining  pipe  at  first  is  to  be  5  inches  inside  diameter.  If,  at  two  or  three  hundred 
feet,  the  friction  should  become  too  great,  4-inch  pipes  will  be  lowered  inside 
these.     It  is  thought  that  the  foundations  of  the  atoll  will  be  reached  between 


1897]  NEWS  143 

200  and  r>oo  feet,  but  the  apparatus  taken  permits  of  a  depth  of  1000 
feet  being  reached.  The  core  obtained  will  be  forwarded  first  to  the  Royal 
Society  of  London,  which  will  return  one-half  to  the  Royal  Geographical 
Society  of  Australasia.  The  expedition  will  also  make  smaller  borings  on  the 
sand  cay  in  the  middle  of  the  lagoon,  will  conduct  dredging  operations  for 
Sydney  University  and  the  Australian  Museum,  and  will  collect  samples  of  sea- 
water  for  Prof.  Liversidge  to  examine  for  gold. 

Our  information  is  gathered  from  an  article  in  the  Sydney  Morning  Herald  of 
June  3,  kindly  sent  us  by  Mr  C.  Hedley. 

From  the  thirty-first  Annual  Report  of  the  Museums  and  Lecture  Rooms 
Syndicate,  Cambridge  University,  we  glean  the  following  information.  The 
course  in  Botany  is  still  largely  attended,  too  largely  for  the  accommodation  ; 
plans  for  enlargement  of  the  buildings  are  under  the  consideration  of  the  Sites 
Syndicate.  The  Herbarium  has  received  a  fine  collection  of  Pyrenean  and  Alpine 
plants  made  by  the  late  Chas.  Packe  of  Christ  Church,  Oxford,  and  presented  by 
his  widow.  Large  collections  of  Canadian  and  Indian  species  have  also  been  re- 
ceived. In  the  Zoological  museum  a  fine  adult  male  skeleton  of  Balaenoptera 
musculus,  a  specimen  known  as  the  '  Pevensey  whale,'  has  been  articulated  by  Mr 
E.Lane,  and  supported  on  iron- work  designed  by  Mr  W.  E.  Dalby.  The  collection 
of  Polyzoa  has  been  stored  in  the  cabinet  made  after  the  pattern  described  by  Canon 
Norman  in  the  Report  of  the  Museums  Association  for  1895.  "  I  am  confident," 
says  Mr  Harmer,  "  that  anyone  who  tries  this  system  will  be  grateful  to  Dr 
Norman  for  its  excellence."  Some  such  method  of  storing  was  much  needed 
owing  to  the  large  increase  in  the  collection  of  Polyzoa,  mainly  owing  to  the 
generosity  of  Miss  E.  C.  Jelly.  The  series  is  very  rich  in  Australian  species,  and 
excellently  illustrates  the  papers  of  the  late  P.  H.  MacGillivray.  Another 
notable  addition  is  a  series  of  slides  of  the  appendages  of  cirripedes,  made  by 
Darwin  when  working  on  his  well-known  monograph.  Unfortunately  many  of 
the  preparations  have  greatly  deteriorated.  Prof.  Mitsukuri,  a  former  student, 
has  presented  some  beautiful  specimens  of  deep-sea  hexactinellid  sponges.  The 
additions  to  the  collection  of  Reptilia  are  noteworthy,  including  the  large  cast  of 
Iguanodon  presented  by  the  King  of  the  Belgians,  a  fine  male  of  the  rare  Testudo 
elephantina,  presented  by  the  late  Lord  Lilford,  a  skeleton  of  Gavialis  gangeticus 
from  the  Jumna,  the  gift  of  Mr  E.  H.  Hankin,  and  many  valuable  skeletons  sent 
from  Borneo  by  Mr  C.  Hose.  The  trustees  of  the  late  Duke  of  Hamilton  have 
presented  the  skeleton  and  skin  of  a  bull  from  the  Cadzow  herd  in  Hamilton 
Park,  believed  to  descend  from  the  ancient  wild  cattle  of  Great  Britain.  These 
gifts,  which  at  present  stray  into  the  lecture-rooms,  render  the  enlargement  of 
the  museum  a  matter  of  pressing  necessity.  Dr  Sharp  states  that  Mr  G.  D. 
Haviland's  collection  of  Termitidae,  already  alluded  to  by  us,  is  the  most  valuable 
ever  formed,  for  it  almost  doubles  the  number  of  known  species.  The  professor 
of  Human  Anatomy  remarks  on  the  increase  in  the  anthropology  classes,  due  to 
the  enthusiasm  of  Dr  A.  C.  Haddon.  Geology  also  continues  to  increase  in 
popularity,  and  the  want  of  space  under  which  it  has  so  long  been  suffering  is 
naturally  not  less  felt.  The  chief  donation  is  that  of  several  of  Mr  Whidborne's 
type  and  figured  specimens,  illustrating  his  monograph  on  the  Devonian  fauna  of 
S.  England.  The  list  of  books  presented  by  Rev.  T.  Wiltshire  is  printed,  and 
includes  many  rarities. 

In  our  comment  on  willows  last  month  (p.  14),  we  regret  to  have  overlooked  the  fact 
that  the  growth  of  stamens  inside  the  ovary  in  Salix  had  already  been  noted  by  the  Rev. 
George  Henslow.  In  his  "  Origin  of  Floral  Structures  "  (p.  296,  Fig.  78)  lie  figures  two 
autheriferous  carpels  of  Salic,  and  one  example  of  the  same  arrangement  in  Ranunculus 
mi  ricomv.s. 


144  [August 


CORRESPONDENCE 

ANATOMY  OF  BIRDS 

It  is  hard  to  be  accused  of  heresy  by  one  whose  orthodox  faith  has  been  disturbed  by 
his  own  misreading  of  a  very  good  text.  Mr  Pycraft  [Natural  Science,  vol.  x.  p.  415) 
complains  of  my  having  described  "certain  membrane  bones,  to  wit,  the  maxilla, 
premaxilla,  quadrato-jugal,  and  jugals,  as  modifications  of  the  first  visceral  arch," 
and  that  this  statement  does  not  tally  with  the  analytical  diagram.  (Article  Skull, 
Newton's  Dictionary  of  Birds. )  Of  course  it  does  not,  because  that  diagram  is  correct, 
and  because  I  did  not  include  the  premaxilla  ,and  the  maxilla  as  modifications  of  the 
first  visceral  arch.  In  my  copy  of  the  Dictionary  (p.  872,  line  5),  the  words  "the 
right  and  left  maxillae  "  are  separated  from  what  follows  by  a  semicolon,  and  this  alters 
the  meaning  of  the  sentence  as  much  as  the  proverbial  fly's  dot  in  Hebrew  texts.  In 
the  diagram  the  premaxilla  and  the  maxilla  are  treated  as  visceral  arches,  just  as 
they  should  be,  but  I  am  so  orthodox,  or  courteous,  as  to  leave  to  the  palato-  quadrate  - 
mandibular  arch  its  time-honoured  name  of  first  visceral. 

Mr  Pycraft  would  have  done  better  not  to  mention  Mehnert,  as  all  "  those  who  have 
given  the  matter  their  attention  "  ought  to  know,  that  Mehnert's  conception  of  the 
pectineal  process  is  erroneous,  and  this  process  is  one  of  the  chief  clues  to  the  homologies 
of  the  pelvic  components. 

Lastly,  are  not  the  Saxon  terms  "greater,  middle,  and  lesser"  as  good  as  major, 
medium,  and  minor  ?  And  if  the  minor  wingcoverts  come  too  near  the  edge  of  the  wing 
they  become  marginals,  which  as  such,  by  the  way,  have  been  mentioned  in  the  article 
"Tectrices." 

However,  I  have  no  reason  to  complain  of  my  reviewer.  He  has  let  me  off  kindly, 
and  has  drawn  a  veil  over  certain  real  faults  which  I  should  find  it  difficult  to  explain 
away.  ■  H.  Gadow. 

Cambridge,  June  2\st,  1897. 


THE  OSTRACODERMS  OF  PROFESSOR  COPE 

In  reference  to  Professor  Ray  Lankester's  interesting  note  (supra,  pp.  45-47)  on  the 
affinities  of  the  early  Palaeozoic  organisms  termed  Ostracodermi  by  Cope,  I  regret  that 
no  new  facts  of  fundamental  importance  for  the  discussion  of  the  problem  have  been 
obtained  since  my  brief  summary  published  in  Natural  Science  for  October  1892.  A  re- 
statement of  the  basis  of  Cope's  view  would  thus  be  merely  a  repetition  of  the  facts  and 
comparisons  contained  in  the  literature  of  the  subject  up  to  that  date.  I  should  like, 
however,  to  remark  that  neither  Professor  Cope  nor  I  have  ever  placed  the  Ostracoderms 
in  the  Marsipobranchii.  In  the  obituary  notice  of  Cope,  I  expressly  referred  to  them  as 
'  allies '  of  those  animals  ;  and  they  have  always  been  mentioned  as  at  least  a  distinct 
sub-class.  The  chief  difference  between  the  views  of  Profs.  Cope  and  Lankester 
seems  to  be,  that  the  latter  considers  the  unpaired  character  of  the  nasal  aperture  in  the 
Marsipobranchii  of  fundamental  importance,  while  the  former  regards  it  as  a  secondary 
specialisation  of  no  notable  significance  from  a  phylogenetic  standpoint.  Prof.  Cope 
believed  that  at  the  base  of  the  craniate  vertebrata,  immediately  below  the  true  fishes, 
there  could  be  recognised  a  class  of  organisms  destitute  both  of  the  lower  jaw  and  of  paired 
limbs.  He  termed  those  the  Agnatha,  and  eventually  placed  among  them  the  two  distinct 
sub-classes  of  Ostracodermi  and  Marsipobranchii.  It  still  seems  to  me  that  this  was  a 
great  step  in  advance  towards  the  true  phylogenetic  arrangement  of  the  lower  vertebrata, 
and  it  was  this  that  I  ventured  to  '  acclaim  '  in  the  sentence  which  led  to  Prof. 
Lankester's  protest.  It  is  well  that  we  who  are  accustomed  to  spend  so  much  time  in 
deciphering  the  tattered  relics  of  extinct  organisms  in  the  rocks  should  occasionally  be 
checked  thus  in  our  tendency  to  speculation  ;  but,  notwithstanding  the  imperfection  of 
our  materials,  it  becomes  continually  clearer  as  we  proceed  that  Palaeontology  alone 
furnishes  the  criterion  for  estimating  the  relative  taxonoinic  value  of  the  different 
morphological  characters  of  any  group  of  organisms  that  happen  to  possess  hard  parts 
capable  of  fossilisation.  A.  Smith  WOODWARD. 

NOTICE 

To  Contributors.—  All  Communications  to  be  addressed  to  the  Editor  of  Natural 
SCIENCE,  at  67  St  James'  Street,  London,  S.AV.  Correspondence  and  Notes  intended 
for  any  particular  month  should  be  sent  in  not  later  than  the  10th  of  the  preceding 
month. 


NATURAL  SCIENCE 

A  Monthly  Review  of  Scientific  Progress 


No.   G7— Vol.  XI— SEPTEMBEE   1897 


NOTES  AND  COMMENTS 

Polar  Exploration 

The  balloon  voyage  of  Andree  in  the  Arctic  Regions  seems  to  have 
monopolised  public  interest  this  month,  and  the  absence  of  news 
from  him  has  caused  some  very  unnecessary  anxiety  as  to  his  safety. 
Even  if  the  winds  be  favourable  and  the  balloon  do  not  leak,  he  is 
not  due  on  the  coast  of  either  America  or  Asia  until  well  into 
August ;  and  it  is  then  quite  possible  that  he  may  have  to  spend 
the  winter  in  some  northern  post,  from  which  news  may  not  reach 
Europe  until  the  spring.  Several  other  important  expeditions  are 
in  the  field.  Lieutenant  Peary  is  leading  another  party  to  Green- 
land, where  he  hopes  to  make  arrangements  for  his  proposed  Polar 
expedition  and  to  secure  the  great  block  of  meteoric  iron  which 
could  not  be  removed  last  summer.  He  will  be  accompanied  by 
Mr  Charles  Schuchert  and  Mr  White,  who  hope  to  make  large  col- 
lections of  the  famous  fossil  plants  of  Disco  Island.  Sir  Martin 
Conway  and  Mr  Garwood  are  continuing  the  exploration  of  Spitz- 
bergen  by  crossing  the  northern  ice-sheet  on  ski.  The  Windward 
has  again  sailed  for  Franz  Josef  Land,  and  ought  to  be  back  in 
September  with  news  of  Mr  Jackson's  latest  achievements.  Mean- 
while but  little  has  been  done  in  Antarctic  research.  The  Belgian 
expedition  under  Dr  Gerlache  and  M.  Arctowski  have  at  length 
obtained  the  necessary  funds,  and  left  Europe  in  the  middle  of 
August.  The  proposed  German  expedition  is  still  appealing  for  sup- 
port, but  does  not  appear  to  be  very  warmly  taken  up.  We  hope, 
however,  that  the  Royal  Geographical  Society  will  see  its  way  to  a 
vigorous  agitation  during  the  winter  in  favour  of  its  proposed 
British  Antarctic  Expedition. 

Arctic  Geology 

REGRET  at  an  ignorance  concerning  Antarctic  geology  is  increased 
by  two  papers  in  Nature,  in  which   Dr  J.  W.  Gregory  reminds  us 

L 


146  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [September 

of  the  interesting  problems  connected  with  the  history  of  the  Arctic 
regions.  In  the  first  paper,  a  summary  is  given  of  the  geological 
structure  of  the  land  masses  surrounding  the  Arctic  Ocean ;  the 
variations  in  the  relative  positions  of  land  and  water  are  traced,  and 
it  is  argued  that  the  Polar  Basin  has  been  formed  by  subsidence 
during  Tertiary  times.  In  the  second  paper,  the  author  considers 
the  changes  in  climate  that  have  taken  place  in  the  North  Polar 
Regions.  He  refers  to  the  famous  theory  according  to  which  the 
Arctic  regions  were  once  clothed  in  tropical  vegetation  and  their 
shores  were  once  fringed  by  coral  reefs.  The  evidence  on  which 
this  theory  rests  is,  however,  shown  to  be  very  untrustworthy.  The 
plant  determinations  made  by  Heer  are  unreliable,  and  there  is  no 
evidence  that  coral  reefs  were  ever  formed  within  the  Arctic  Circle. 
Corals  grew  in  Arctic  seas  in  earlier  times  as  they  do  to-day,  but 
there  has  been  no  adequate  proof  that  they  ever  formed  reefs.  Dr 
Gregory  accordingly  distrusts  all  the  theories  as  to  the  great  size  of 
the  sun  in  Palaeozoic  times  and  the  universal  uniform  climate  in 
the  pre-Tertiary  period,  which  have  been  based  on  the  asserted 
Arctic  palm-groves  and  coral  seas.  That  climatic  changes  have 
occurred  is  not  disputed,  but  the  author  does  not  think  it  possible 
to  estimate  their  extent  until  the  palaeontology  of  the  Arctic  regions 
has  been  carefully  revised.  The  most  important  work  on  this 
subject  now  being  carried  on  is  Professor  Nathorst's  redescription  of 
the  fossils  about  which  Heer  theorised  so  wildly.  Dr  Gregory  also 
concludes  that  palaeontological  evidence  tells  strongly  against  the 
view  that  the  position  of  the  Poles  has  altered  to  any  great 
extent. 


BlliDS    AND    THEIE    STOMACHS 

The  United  States  Department  of  Agriculture,  knowing  that  the 
welfare  of  the  country  depends  largely  on  the  prosperity  of  the 
farming  class,  has  undertaken  for  long  past  a  proper .  consideration 
of  birds  in  their  relation  to  agriculture.  In  its  fifty-fourth  bulletin 
it  deals  with  the  stomach-contents  of  some  twenty  common  birds. 
Among  these  may  be  mentioned  the  cuckoos,  woodpeckers,  bluejays, 
ricebirds,  blackbirds,  orioles,  cedarbirds,  catbirds,  bluebirds,  &c. 
There  is  a  good  deal  of  practical  common-sense  in  the  introduction 
of  this  pamphlet  by  Mr  P.  E.  L.  Beal,  who  points  out  the  tendency 
to  dwell  on  the  harm  done  by  birds  rather  than  the  good.  He  goes 
on  to  say  : — 

"  Within  certain  limits,  birds  feed  upon  the  kind  of  food  that  is 
most  accessible.  Thus,  as  a  rule,  insectivorous  birds  eat  the  insects 
that  are  most  easily  obtained,  provided  they  do  not  have  some 
peculiarly  disagreeable  property.       It  is  not  probable   that  a  bird 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  147 

habitually  passes  by  one  kind  of  insect  to  look  for  another  which  is 
more  appetizing,  and  there  seems  little  evidence  in  support  of 
the  theory  that  the  selection  of  food  is  restricted  to  any  particular 
species  of  insect,  for  it  is  evident  that  a  bird  eats  those  which  by 
its  own  method  of  seeking  are  most  easily  obtained.  Thus,  a  ground- 
feeding  bird  eats  those  it  finds  among  the  dead  leaves  and  grass  ; 
a  flycatcher,  watching  for  its  prey  from  some  vantage  point,  captures 
entirely  different  kinds  ;  and  the  woodpecker  and  warbler,  in  the 
tree  tops,  select  still  others.  It  is  thus  apparent  that  a  bird's  diet 
is  likely  to  be  quite  varied,  and  to  differ  at  different  seasons  of  the 
year. 

"  In  investigating  the  food  habits  of  birds,  field  observation  can 
be  relied  on  only  to  a  limited  extent,  for  it  is  not  always  easy 
to  determine  what  a  bird  really  eats  by  watching  it.  In  order  to  be 
positive  on  this  point,  it  is  necessary  to  examine  the  stomach 
contents.  When  birds  are  suspected  of  doing  injury  to  field  crops 
or  fruit  trees,  a  few  individuals  should  be  shot  and  their  stomachs 
examined.  This  will  show  unmistakably  whether  or  not  the  birds 
are  guilty." 

In  his  notes  on  the  tree-sparrow  (Spizdla  monticola)  Mr  Beal 
shows  that  the  stomachs  of  these  birds  in  winter  are  crammed  with 
the  seeds  of  weeds,  and  he  estimates  that  in  the  State  of  Iowa 
alone,  if  there  are  only  ten  birds  to  a  square  mile,  no  less  than  875 
tons  of  weed  seed  are  consumed  by  this  single  species'  in  a  single 
season,  basing  his  calculations  on  the  modest  estimate  that  each  bird 
eats  one  fourth  of  an  ounce  a  day  for  a  winter  season  of  200  days. 
This  may  be  used  as  an  argument  by  the  ignorant  to  show  how 
much  they  eat  of  grain  in  the  summer,  but  examination  of  stomachs 
of  the  same  birds  in  summer  shows  conclusively  that  one  third 
of  the  bulk  is  made  up  of  insects  (not  available  for  consumption  in 
the  winter),  grass  and  weed  seed,  and  a  little  oats.  The  young 
birds  also  are  largely  fed  on  insects. 

We  cannot  spare  space  to  quote  the  statistics  of  other  birds,  but 
the  story  is  much  the  same  in  each  case.  It  is  for  the  farmer 
to  decide  whether  he  cares  to  spare  a  little  grain  in  the  summer  in 
order  that  his  fields  may  be  kept  comparatively  free  of  weeds 
from  year  to  year,  or  whether  he  prefers  to  kill  the  birds  and  have 
his  pockets  emptied  by  paying  for  weeding,  and  the  destruction  of 
hosts  of  insects  which  are  kept  at  bay  solely  by  the  birds  he  so 
religiously  endeavours  to  destroy. 

We  have  already  one  work  on  the  economic  ornithology  of  Great 
Britain  on  the.  lines  of  this  bulletin  ("  Ornithology  in  relation  to 
Agriculture  and  Horticulture,"  by  various  writers,  edited  by  John 
Watson,  1893);  but  a  real  benefit  would  accrue  to  the  farmers  in 
enabling  them  to  know  accurately  their  friends  and  their  enemies 


148  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [September 

(should  they  care  to  do  so),  if  the  Government  or  the  County 
Councils  would  take  up  the  question  officially  and  systematically. 
But  such  a  work  would  involve  much  original  research. 

Amekican  Economic  Entomology 

We  have  also  received  from  the  U.S.  Department  of  Agriculture 
a  short  but  interesting  pamphlet  by  Mr  C.  L.  Marlott  on  "  Insect 
Control  in  California."  The  well-known  plan  of  introducing  lady- 
bird beetles  to  prey  upon  the  imported  scale-insects  which 
devastate  the  western  fruit-orchards  has  been  successfully  extended  ; 
while  an  efficient  artificial  insecticide  has  been  found  in  hydrocyanic 
acid  gas  with  which  the  trees  are  fumigated  after  being  covered  with 
a  temporary  canvas  tent.  Mr  F.  H.  Chittenden  writes  on  the 
European  Asparagus  beetles  which,  like  so  many  old-world  insects, 
have  been  introduced  into  the  Atlantic  States.  Dr  L.  D.  Howard 
gives  an  illustrated  account  of  various  portable  steam  pumping- 
engines  used  for  spraying  trees  with  insecticide  fluids. 

Glands  in  Insects 

In  the  latest  part  of  the  Transactions  of  the  Entomological 
Society  of  London  (1897,  pp.  113-126,  pt,  v.),  Mr  Oswald  H.  Latter 
describes  the  structure  and  function  of  the  sternal  gland  found  in 
the  prothorax  of  the  caterpillar  of  the  "  Puss  "  moth  (Cerura  vinula). 
The  formic  acid  secreted  by  this  gland  has  long  been  recognised 
as  a  defence  to  the  larva  against  its  enemies.  Mr  Latter  has  now 
shown  that  at  the  end  of  larval  life  the  secretion  has  another 
function.  Mixed  with  the  silk  the  acid  serves  to  make  the  cocoon 
which  contains  the  pupa  exceedingly  hard  and  waterproof  as  well  as 
strongly  adherent  to  foreign  substances  such  as  the  chips  of  wood 
which  this  caterpillar  habitually  works  into  its  cocoon. 

Mr  Latter  points  out  that  in  other  lepidoptera  and  insects 
of  different  orders,  many  segments  of  the  body  possess  glands  which 
may  reasonably  be  considered  serially  homologous  with  that  under 
consideration  ;  he  suggests  that  all  these  glands  represent  the  coxal 
glands  of  arachnids.  The  prothoracic  gland  of  C.  vinula  opens  into 
a  shallow  vestibule,  whence  arise  branched  eversible  tubes  bearing- 
groups  of  spines  in  their  cavities.  Mr  Latter  is  unable  to  suggest  a 
satisfactory  function  for  these  tubes,  but  he  points  out  that  the 
groups  of  spines  recall  the  parapodial  setae  of  chaetopods,  and  that 
the  whole  structure  supports  Mr  Bernard's  view  that  such  glands 
are  derived  from  the  acicular  gland  sacs  of  ringed  worms.  Should 
these  relationships  prove  to  be  correct,  Mr  Latter  believes  that  they 
"  will  go  far  towards  establishing  the  primitive  nature  of  the  cruci- 
form larva  of  which  many  observers  are  already  in  favour." 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  149 


The  Photography  of  Microscopic  Organisms  in  Motion 

According  to  the  Scientific  American,  the  principles  of  the  kineto- 
scope  have  been  applied  to  the  microscope  with  some  interesting- 
results  by  Dr  Eobert  L.  Watkins  of  New  York.  The  instrument 
employed,  termed  a  micromotoscope,  has  been  very  difficult  to  devise, 
owing  to  the  manipulation  of  the  light  and  lens.  When  the  light 
is  concentrated  sufficiently  for  photography,  it  very  quickly  kills  or 
seriously  injures  almost  any  kind  of  life  in  the  microscopic  field. 
The  greater  the  magnification,  the  more  intense  and  the  nearer  the 
lens  the  light  must  be.  Difficulties  are  also  multiplied  by  the 
length  of  time  sometimes  taken  in  arranging  the  focus  on  the  sensi- 
tive film.  After  repeated  efforts,  however,  Dr  Watkins  has  obtained 
some  measure  of  success,  and  motions  that  are  not  too  rapid  have 
been  very  satisfactorily  recorded.  He  has  been  able  to  produce 
about  2500  pictures  per  minute.  This  is  not  a  sufficiently  rapid 
process  to  photograph  the  motion  of  the  blood  circulating  in  the 
web  of  a  frog's  foot ;  but  it  has  served  admirably  in  the  case  of  at 
least  one  rotifer,  which  exhibits  the  most  interesting  form  of  cell 
motion  yet  reproduced. 


The  Great  Auk  in  Ireland 

Remains  of  the  extinct  Great  Auk  (Alca  impennis)  have  already 
been  recorded  from  the  north  of  Ireland,  but  the  known  range  of 
this  interesting  bird  has  just  been  considerably  extended  by  the 
discovery  of  a  few  bones  in  a  Kitchen  Midden  on  the  coast  of 
Waterford,  nearly  as  far  south  as  52°  N.  latitude  (E.  J.  Ussher, 
Irish  Nat.,  vol.  vi.,  p.  208).  A  humerus,  tibia  and  metatarsus 
have  been  identified  by  Dr  Hans  Gadow  and  Professor  Alfred 
Newton.  They  were  associated  with  bones  of  common  domestic 
animals  and  the  red  deer,  and  thus  probably  do  not  date  back  to 
an  earlier  period  than  the  remains  already  found  in  the  refuse- 
heaps  of  Caithness  and  Durham. 


Extinct  Birds  of  Madagascar 

During  his  stay  in  Madagascar  Dr  Forsyth  Major  spent  several 
months  in  the  Sirabe  district  searching  for  remains  of  Aepyornis. 
What  success  attended  his  efforts  has  already  been  noticed  in  these 
columns,  but  besides  Acpyomis,  Dr  Major  discovered  remains 
of  numerous  other  birds  associated  with  it.  Mr  C.  W.  Andrews,  to 
whom  we  are  indebted  for  the  careful  description  of  these  Aepyornis 


150  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [September 

remains,  is  now  collecting  in  Christmas  Island,  but  before  setting 
out  on  this  expedition  he  left  for  publication  a  paper  which  has  just 
appeared  in  the  Ibis  (July),  dealing  with  the  most  remarkable 
of  these  other  Madagascar  birds.  Those  here  described  are  mainly 
carinate  and  were  associated  with  Ac.  hildebrandti  of  Burckhardt,  in 
a  marly  layer  indicating  an  old  lake  bottom  at  a  depth  of  1 2  to  1 5 
feet.  Above  the  marl  comes  a  coarse  gravel  consolidated  with 
carbonate  of  lime  and  containing  rolled  and  broken  bones,  which  may 
mark  a  volcanic  outburst  accompanied  by  hot  springs  charged  with 
that  mineral.  Above  this  deposit  is  another  of  black  earth  from 
5  to  6  feet  in  thickness,  in  which  bird  bones  occur  though  rarely.  It 
is  interesting  to  note  that  Ac.  hildebrandti  does  not  occur  in  the  black 
earth,  but  remains  of  the  smaller  Ac.  mutteri  were  found  together 
with  well-preserved  bones  of  Mullcrornis  agilis. 

The  most  important  of  Dr  Major's  discoveries  as  described  by  Mr 
Andrews  may  be  briefly  enumerated.  A  large  Anserine  bird,  having 
resemblances  to  Chcnalopex  pugil,  from  Lagoa  Santa,  Brazil.  This 
has  been  called  Ccntromis  majori.  Another  Anserine  is  closely 
allied  to  Chenalopcx  acgyptiacus,  but  the  numerous  slight  differences 
between  the  fossil  and  the  recent  species  induced  Mr  Andrews 
to  term  it  C.  sirabensis.  He  however  thinks  it  possible  that  when 
further  remains  are  found,  it  may  turn  out  to  be  Sarcidiomis 
mauritianus,  an  extinct  bird  described  by  Newton  and  Gadow  from 
Mauritius.  A  new  rail,  Tribonyx  roberti,  is  described  from  a 
pelvis ;  while  a  well-preserved  tibia  is  also  referred  to  this  species. 
Ardea,  Platcdea,  Astur,  and  Plotus,  are  among  the  other  remains 
discovered,  but  at  present  the  material  is  not  of  a  sufficient  quantity 
to  justify  further  description.  It  may  be  as  well  to  note,  however, 
that  Ccntromis  is  described  from  remains  of  four  or  five  individuals  ; 
and  the  Chenalopcx  from  a  large  collection  of  bones,  many  of  which 
were  found  associated. 

The  Origin  of  the  Edentate  Mammals 

The  phylogeny  of  the  edentate  mammals  has  long  been  a  standing 
puzzle  to  palaeontologists,  and  this  gap  in  our  knowledge  has 
rendered  it  impossible  to  come  to  a  full  understanding  of  the 
South  American  fauna.  So  far  as  the  typical  or  American  forms 
(sloths,  ground-sloths,  ant-eaters,  and  armadillos)  are  concerned,  the 
problem  has  been  solved  by  the  labours  of  Dr  J.  S.  Wortman,  of 
the  American  Museum  of  Natural  History,  of  which  an  illustrated 
account  has  appeared  in  the  Bulletin  of  the  Museum  (vol.  ix.  pp. 
59-110).  A  valuable  illustrated  article  on  the  same  subject,  by 
Prof.  0.  C.  Marsh,  has  also  been  published  in  the  American  Journal 
of  Science  (vol.  iii.,  1897,  pp.  137-140). 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  151 

For  many  years  there  have  been  known  more  or  less  imperfect 
remains  of  certain  remarkable  and  puzzling  mammals  from  the 
Eocene  of  the  United  States,  which  have  been  described  under  the 
names  of  Hcmiganus,  Psittacotherinm ,  Calamodon,  and  Stylinodon ; 
the  two  first  being  from  the  Puerco  beds,  while  the  third  is  from 
the  Wasatch,  and  the  fourth  from  the  Bridger  and  Wind  river. 
The  unfortunate  animals  to  which  these  bones  and  teeth  belonged 
have  been  shifted  about  from  place  to  place,  according  to  the  fancy 
or  bias  of  each  individual  describer ;  one  of  their  last  resting- 
places  being  among  the  Tillodontia. 

Dr  Wortman  has,  however,  succeeded  in  showing  that  whereas 
in  the  latter  it  is  the  second  incisor  in  each  jaw  which  (as  in  the 
rodents)  undergoes  hypertrophism,  in  the  animals  forming  the 
subject  of  his  memoir  it  is  the  canine  which  undergoes  special 
enlargement.  Obviously,  therefore,  there  can  be  no  intimate  re- 
lationship between  the  two  groups ;  and  as  the  one  he  has  specially 
investigated  requires  a  new  title,  the  name  Ganodonta  has  been 
proposed. 

To  enter  into  details  of  the  structure  of  these  ganodonts  would 
obviously  be  out  of  place  here.  But  any  competent  anatomist  who 
may  take  the  trouble  to  consult  the  excellent  descriptions  and 
figures  given  in  the  original  memoir  can  scarcely  fail  to  be  con- 
vinced that  in  these  animals  Dr  Wortman  has  succeeded  in 
identifying  the  long-missing  ancestors  of  the  American  edentates. 
Although  the  Puerco  forms  have  enamelled  and  rootless  molars,  in 
the  latter  types  the  roots  at  first  become  confluent,  and  finally 
disappear,  while  at  the  same  time  the  enamel  becomes  restricted 
to  bands,  and  the  whole  structure  of  the  tooth  is  simplified. 
The  canines,  too,  become  more  and  more  like  those  of  the  Pliocene 
and  Pleistocene  ground-sloths ;  while  the  resemblance  between  the 
skulls  and  limbs  of  the  latter  and  these  of  the  ganodonts  is  such 
as  to  render  no  other  conclusion  possible  but  that  the  one  group  is 
the  forerunner  of  the  other.  Not  only,  therefore,  have  the  ancestors 
of  the  true  edentates  been  discovered,  but  we  have  proof  that  the 
first  tooth  of  the  modern  sloths  is  a  canine,  and  not  a  premolar. 

The  Ganodonta  are  regarded  as  forming  a  sub-order  of  the 
Edentata ;  the  genera  mentioned  above  constituting  one  family 
(Stylinodontidac),  while  a  second  family  (Conorydidae)  is  made  up 
of  the  genera  Conorydcs  and  Onychodectcs,  to  which  further  allusion 
is  unnecessary  in  this  place.  Whether  the  living  Old  World 
families  (Orycteropodidae  and  Manidae)  should  or  should  not  be 
included  4n  the  Edentata,  Dr  Wortman  leaves  an  open  question ; 
but  in  either  event  he  confesses  himself  unable  to  draw  up  a 
satisfactory  definition  of  the  order. 


152  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [September 

The  South  American  Edentate  Mammals 

Having  satisfactorily  demonstrated  the  ancestral  position  of 
the  Ganodonta  to  the  modern  American  Edentata,  Dr  Wortman 
goes  on  to  observe  that  if  this  be  true,  "  it  follows  that  all  the 
South  American  edentates  must  have  been  derived  from  the 
North  American  Ganodonta,  since  their  earliest  appearance  in 
South  America  does  not  antedate  the  Santa  Cruz  epoch.  In  this 
formation  they  appear  suddenly  in  great  numbers  and  variety, 
without  apparently  any  announcement  in  the  older  Pyrothcrium 
deposits.  This  fact  in  itself  would  seem  to  indicate  that  they 
were  migrants  from  another  region,  and  while  we  are  as  yet  unable 
to  place  these  deposits  in  the  time-scale  with  accuracy,  it  is  yet 
highly  probable  that  the  Santa  Cruz  beds  are  not  older  than  our 
North  American  Oligocene.  In  North  America  the  Ganodonta 
appear  in  the  very  earliest  Puerco  deposits,  and  continue  without 
interruption  into  the  Bridger,  where  they  disappear.  No  evidences 
of  them  have  up  to  date  been  detected  in  the  Uinta  or  White 
River  beds. 

"  Now  it  is  currently  believed  by  geologists  that  no  land  con- 
nection existed  between  North  and  South  America  from  the  close  of 
the  Cretaceous  to  the  close  of  the  Miocene,  when  an  extensive  land 
bridge  was  formed.  I  am  not  familiar  with  the  geological  evidence 
upon  which  the  conclusion  rests,  but  if  one  is  permitted  to  judge 
from  the  subjoined  statements  of  Mr  F.  C.  Nicholas,  it  is  at  the 
very  least  open  to  question.  It  is,  of  course,  possible  that  the 
Ganodonta  may  have  reached  South  America  by  way  of  Europe, 
Africa,  and  Antarctica,  but  on  the  whole  it  seems  infinitely  more 
probable  that  there  was  a  land  bridge  of  short  duration  during 
Eocene  time  between  North  and  South  America,  and  that  they 
reached  their  destination  in  this  way,  than  by  the  questionable  and 
circuitous  route  just  mentioned.  If  they  gained  entrance  into 
South  America  by  the  European- African  route,  it  seems  indeed 
strange  that  they  should  have  left  no  remains  in  the  later  Tertiaries 
of  Europe.  "With  the  exception  of  a  single  specimen  of  Calamodon 
Europaeus,  from  deposits  corresponding  with  the  Wasatch  in  age,  all 
traces  of  the  American  Edentata  are  absent  in  Europe,  Asia  and 
Africa." 

To  the  first  paragraph  in  this  ([notation  no  exception  can  be 
taken.  With  regard  to  the  second,  we  have  not  the  pleasure  of 
being  acquainted,  either  personally  or  by  his  writings,  with  Mr  F. 
C.  Nicholas,  who  may  be  a  most  excellent  person,  bnt  the  rambling 
extracts  from  a  letter  of  his,  which  Dr  Wortman  prints  in  a  foot- 
note, can  scarcely  affect  the  problem  of  a  land  connection  between 
the  two  Americas  in  early  Tertiary  times.      Apart  from  this,  the . 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  153 

evidence  adduced  by  Dr  W.  B.  Scott  and  others  as  to  the  separation 
of  North  and  South  America  cannot  be  overthrown  by  the  con- 
clusions drawn  from  one  group  of  animals,  more  especially  when  an 
alternative  route  of  migration  will  explain  the  facts  equally  well,  if 
not  indeed  better. 

The  Old  World  Edentate  Mammals 

While  it  may  be  admitted  that  one  swallow  does  not  make  a 
summer,  it  cannot  be  contended  that  a  single  tooth  is  not  amply 
sufficient  to  prove  the  existence  of  the  group  of  animals  in  the 
country  where  it  was  found.  And  as  Dr  Wortman  expressly  states 
that  Calamodon  europaeus — founded  on  a  canine  from  the  Swiss 
siderolithes — is  a  member  of  the  Ganodonta,  there  is  ample  evidence 
of  the  existence  of  that  group  in  Europe  during  the  Eocene.  Prob- 
ably Dr  Wortman  is  unaware  how  rare  mammalian  fossils  are  in 
those  deposits,  and  why  he  should  make  a  point  of  their  absence 
from  the  later  European  Tertiaries  passes  our  comprehension.  With 
regard  to  Africa,  no  Eocene  or  middle  Tertiaries  are  known,  and 
consequently  no  arguments  can  be  drawn  one  way  or  another. 
Moreover,  it  is  known  that  when  the  later  South  American  ground- 
sloths  succeeded  in  entering  the  northern  half  of  the  New  World 
during  the  Pliocene,  they  flourished  excellently  well,  and  if  their 
ancestors  reached  the  South  from  the  North,  it  is  difficult- to  see  why 
the  group  should  have  immediately  died  off  in  the  latter  area. 

To  our  own  thinking  it  is  much  more  probable  that  the  Eocene 
Ganodonts  of  the  northern  hemisphere  migrated  southwards  from 
Europe  to  Africa,  and  eventually  reached  South  America  by  that 
route,  as  appears  to  have  been  the  case  with  certain  other  groups  of 
mammals.  This,  of  course,  opens  up  the  question  whether  the  Old 
World,  so-called  Edentates  may  not  after  all  really  belong  to  that 
group.  Without  denying  the  possibility  of  this,  it  may  be  urged 
that  whereas  the  skulls  and  limb  bones  of  the  Ganodonta  are 
strikingly  like  those  of  the  South  American  edentates,  those  of 
Manis  and  Orycteropus  are  as  strikingly  unlike.  If,  therefore, 
they  belong  to  the  same  stock,  they  would  appear  to  have  diverged 
before  the  Ganodonta  assumed  their  characteristic  type.  But  as 
this  was  acquired  in  the  early  Eocene,  the  Edentate  origin  of 
Orycteropus  and  Manis  seems  very  problematical.  At  the  same 
time  we  have  at  present  no  other  group  in  which  to  look  for  the 
parentage  of  those  strange  creatures. 

New  Light  on  the  Ova  of  Vertebrata 

In  the  series  of  observations  published  by  K.  Mitsukuri,  of  Tokyo, 
in  the  Journal  of  the  College  of  Science  of  the  Imperial  University, 


154  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [September 

Japan,  we  have  a  fresh  instance  of  the  admirable  work  done 
by  certain  of  the  Japanese  morphologists.  Mitsukuri's  researches 
concern  the  fate  of  the  blastopore,  the  relations  of  the  primitive 
streak,  and  the  formation  of  the  posterior  end  of  the  embryo  in 
Chelonia,  together  with  some  remarks  on  the  nature  of  meroblastic 
ova  in  vertebrates.  But,  as  is  not  infrequently  the  case,  the  most 
important  results  are  those  which  receive  least  consideration  in  the 
title  of  the  paper.  The  nature  and  fate  of  the  '  yolk-plug '  (or  cell- 
mass  projecting  between  the  lips  of  the  blastopore),  which  undergoes 
very  complex  changes  and  shiftings  of  position,  is  far  more  interest- 
ing than  that  of  the  blastopore  itself,  owing  to  the  theoretical  con- 
siderations which  Mitsukuri's  view  of  it  involves.  The  previously- 
asserted  homology  of  this  cell-mass  with  the  yolk-plug  of  the 
Amphibia,  and  with  a  similar  structure  observed  by  Van  Beneden  in 
Mammalia,  is  well-maintained.  The  necessity  for  a  re-classification 
of  vertebrate  ova  into  '  primary '  and  '  secondary '  types  is  clearly 
established,  if  the  theory  of  the  loss  and  acquisition  of  yolk  in  verte- 
brate eggs  several  times  in  the  course  of  phyletic  development  be 
correct.  The  primitive  plate  and  yolk-plug  in  Chelonia  are  shown 
to  be  rudiments  of  a  large  primary  yolk-mass  which  existed  in  the 
early  history  of  amniote  eggs.  The  large  yolk-mass  seen  in  amniote 
eggs  of  the  present  day  has  been  secondarily  acquired,  and  the 
enclosure  of  this  mass  by  the  blastoderm  is  a  coenogenetic  process 
having  nothing  to  do  with  gastrulation.  On  the  other  hand,  the 
enclosure  of  the  primary  yolk-mass  by  the  blastoderm  is  closely 
connected  with  gastrulation.  Mammalian  ova  are  supposed  to  have 
lost  even  the  secondary  yolk-mass.  Any  comparison,  therefore, 
between  the  various  classes  of  ova  can  only  justly  be  made  when 
these  facts  are  given  due  weight,  and  they  are  likely  to  throw 
additional  light  on  questions  dealing  with  the  primitive  character  or 
otherwise  of  various  groups. 

Peimitive  Methods  of  Trepanning 

In  V Anthropologic  (vol.  viii.,  pt.  ii.,  1897)  a  most  interesting  account 
is  given  by  Dr  H.  Malbot,  assisted  by  Dr  E.  Verneau,  on  the  Tre- 
panning of  the  Skull  by  the  Chaouias  of  the  Aures  Mountains,  in  the 
province  of  Constantine,  Algeria.  A  preliminary  account  of  these 
people  and  their  country  was  given  in  the  previous  number  of  the 
same  journal.  It  is  a  most  curious  fact  that  in  a  remote  district  in 
the  above-named  region,  this  people  of  mixed  racial  origin  practise 
trepanning  on  an  elaborate  scale,  and  apparently  maintain  this  prac- 
tice as  an  heritage  from  ancient  times.  Trepanned  skulls  have  been 
found  in  ancient  cemeteries  in  Algeria,  and  prove  the  practice  to  be 
an  old  one  in  the  region.      The  Chaou'ias  have  established  a  great 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  155 

name  for  success  in  this  operation,  which  they  conduct  in  a  manner 
which  is  characterised  by  great  boldness,  combined  with  decidedly 
rough  and  ready  methods.  The  surgical  equipment  is  of  the 
simplest  description,  the  principal  instruments  being  a  kind  of  auger 
(brima),  or  centre-bit  rather,  and  two  kinds  of  very  rude  saws 
(mcnchar)  of  peculiar  hooked  shape  and  very  short  cutting  edges. 
The  text-book,  there  is  but  one,  is  a  manuscript,  a  copy  of  which  is 
possessed  by  each  qualified  trepanner.  The  brima  is  used  for  ex- 
ploring, and  holes  are  drilled  into  the  bone  of  the  skull,  at  first 
through  the  outer  table  only,  for  examination  of  the  diploe ;  but,  if 
necessary,  the  hole  is  extended  through  the  inner  table,  exposing 
the  dura  mater.  Large  portions  of  the  skull  are,  if  it  is  deemed 
desirable,  removed  through  the  agency  of  the  brima,  several  holes 
being  drilled  with  it  very  close  together,  and  when,  after  some  weeks, 
necrosis  has  destroyed  the  narrow  bridges  of  bone  between  the  holes, 
the  whole  piece  of  bone  round  which  the  holes  were  drilled  is 
detached  with  a  lever  and  removed.  The  saw  is  used  for  grave 
cases,  and  the  sawed  grooves  are  sunk  to  the  inner  table,  the  remain- 
ing thickness  of  bone  being  scraped  away  with  a  hooked  instrument. 
In  other  cases  the  grooves  are  less  deep,  and  necrosis  does  the  rest 
of  the  work,  the  final  detachment  of  the  bone  being  effected  as  before 
with  a  lever.  Prayers  and  incantations  always  accompany  the 
operation.  They  must  be  needed  !  Some  stubborn  cases  demand 
the  trial  of  every  class  of  trepanning,  and  at  successive  sittings  the 
operator  puts  them  all  in  practice ;  ' '  C'est  une  veritable  orgie  de 
trepanation  ! "  The  most  peculiar  part  of  the  whole  thing  is  that 
the  patient  as  a  rule  recovers,  this  being  due  rather  to  the  natural 
physical  qualities  of  the  Berber  race,  than  to  the  skill  of  the  operator. 
Eecovery  may,  in  fact,  be  said  to  be  in  spite  of  the  surgeon.  Dr 
Malbot  was  fortunate  enough  to  obtain  a  skull  showing  all  the 
methods  practised,  a  most  striking  specimen  of  which  he  gives  a 
figure.  The  skull  is  now  preserved  in  the  Museum  of  Natural 
History  at  Paris. 

This  paper  should  be  read  in  connection  with  Dr  Eobert  Munro's 
paper  on  "  Prehistoric  Trepanning  and  Cranial  Amulets,"  which  has 
been  lately  republished  in  his  book  on  "  Prehistoric  Problems." 
This  gives  a  good  and  well-illustrated  general  account  of  ancient 
trepanning,  a  special  reference  being  made  to  cases  belonging  to 
Neolithic  times.  The  use  of  fragments  of  skulls  as  amulets  is  also 
gone  into  in  detail,  and  the  fact  made  clear  that  trepanning  was  in 
some  cases  surgical,  in  others  posthumous,  following  Broca's  famous 
memoir  of-  1876.  Dr  Munro  gives  a  sketch  of  the  geographical 
distribution  of  this  operation,  and  discourses  on  the  methods 
employed  in  early  times.  It  is  a  pity  that  so  few  details  regarding 
the  practice  of   trepanning   amongst  modern  primitive  peoples  are 


156  NATURAL    SCIENCE  ^  [September 

forthcoming,  and  it  is  greatly  to  be  hoped  that  attention  may  be 
directed  to  this  custom  wherever  it  occurs,  as  the  procedure  observed 
amongst  races  in  a  low  condition  of  culture  may  help  to  throw 
further  light  upon  the  archaeological  aspect  of  the  question. 

Speak-throwers  from  New  Guinea 

Mr  T.  Jennings  (Proc.  Linn.  Soc,  N.S.W.,  1896,  p.  793)  has 
recently  described  in  detail  and  figured  two  Papuan  spear-throwers 
of  bambu  from  New  Guinea.  These  instruments  have  only  com- 
paratively recently  been  recognised  as  occurring  in  New  Guinea, 
though  numbers  have  now  been  received  in  the  various  European 
museums.  The  type  is  interesting  for  its  form,  which  differs  from 
that  of  the  well-known  hook-ended  spear-throwers  of  Australia,  and 
resembles  rather  that  of  the  socket-ended  examples  from  the  Caro- 
line and  Pelew  Islands,  figured  by  Dr  von  Luschan.  The  addition 
of  a  wooden  flange  as  a  rest  for  the  spear  is  peculiar  to  New 
Guinea,  and  the  carving  on  these  rests  is  often  elaborate,  and  is  varied 
individually,  no  two,  probably,  being  quite  similar.  The  original 
design  in  nearly  all  cases  has  apparently  been  some  animal  form 
grotesquely  treated.  The  two  examples  described  by  Mr  Jennings 
differ  somewhat  in  detail  from  those  figured  by  Dr  von  Luschan  in 
his  more  elaborate  paper  on  the  subject,  published  in  the  Bastian 
Festschrift.  Mr  Jennings  adds  a  few  remarks  upon  the  peculiar 
geographical  distribution  of  these  implements,  but  his  account  does 
not  aim  at  being  a  complete  one,  and  the  distribution  is  pretty  well 
known. 

Cycads 

In  our  last  number  (p.  85)  we  referred  to  some  recent  work  by  a 
Japanese  investigator  which  gave  additional  interest  to  an  ancient 
and  always  interesting  group  of  plants.  The  Cycads  are  the  oldest 
family  of  seed-plants.  They  had  reached  and  passed  their  maxi- 
mum (in  Triassic  and  Jurassic  ages)  before  the  appearance  of  the 
angiospermous  type  which  is  dominant  at  the  present  day.  Their 
habit,  a  simple,  short  stem  with  a  crown  of  leaves,  recalls  the 
tree-fern  much  more  than  our  dicotyledonous  forest-tree  with  its 
widely  branching  axis  and  small  deciduous  leaves.  And  the  dis- 
covery, of  which  we  gave  a  short  account  last  month,  was  only  an 
additional  evidence  of  the  fact,  recognised  now  for  more  than 
thirty  years,  that  Cycads,  if  not  a  connecting  link,  are  at  any  rate 
representatives  of  a  type  of  plant-life  occupying  a  place  in  the 
scale  of  evolution  between  ferns  and  those  seed-plants  in  which 
the  ovules  are  packed  away  in  a  closed  ovary-chamber.  Their 
occurrence  to-day  is  what  we  should  expect  in  a  disappearing  but 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  157 

once  dominant  group.  There  are  only  nine  genera  with  about 
seventy-five  species,  but  the  order  is  widely  distributed  in  the 
warmer  parts  of  the  earth,  though  individual  genera  and  species 
have  a  very  limited  distribution.  The  old  world  has  five  genera, 
the  new  world  four,  but  America  possesses  by  far  the  greater 
number  of  species,  Central  America  and  Mexico  being  the  richest 
areas,  while  Australia  is  the  largest  centre  in  the  old  world. 
Cijcas  (sixteen  species)  is  the  most  widely-spread  type,  occurring 
in  the  warmer  parts  of  Asia  up  to  south  Japan,  in  Australia, 
Polynesia  and  the  Malagasy  Islands.  Stangcria  and  Bowenia  are 
monotypic  genera  from  Natal  and  Queensland  respectively.  Dioon 
has  two  species  in  Mexico ;  Encepltalartos,  twelve  in  South  and 
tropical  Africa  ;  Macrozamia,  fourteen  in  Australia.  Zamia  is  the 
largest  genus  with  thirty  species,  and  is  found  from  Peril  to  the 
West  Indies  and  Florida ;  Ceratozamia  is  Mexican  with  six  species, 
and  Microcycas  is  a  monotypic  genus  from  Cuba.  But  a  much 
larger  number  of  fossil  genera  have  been  described,  chiefly  from 
leaves,  though  fruits  and  other  reproductive  organs  are  also  known. 
Tims  Engler  in  his  Pflanzenfamilicn  enumerates  twenty-three 
"  more  important "  ones  found  almost  exclusively  in  Europe,  but 
occasionally  in  Greenland  and  Spitzbergen.  Our  nine  genera  are 
obviously  scattered  remnants  of  a  once  large  and  dominant  family. 
Even  individuals  are  isolated ;  except  in  the  case  of  species  of 
Cycas  they  are  few  and  far  between. 

In  the  June  number  of  the  Botanical  Gazette,  H.  J.  Webber  gives 
an  account  of  his  investigations  into  the  structure  and  behaviour  of 
the  pollen-tube  in  a  species  of  Zamia.  One  of  his  figures  shows 
a  peculiarity  in  the  growth  of  the  tube,  which  at  first  penetrates 
the  nucellus  for  a  short  distance  and  then  resumes  growth  at  the 
other  end,  that,  namely  to  which  the  grain  is  still  attached.  The 
important  generative  cell  remains  at  the  pollen-grain  end  in  which 
it  is  carried  down  into  the  cavity  above  the  archegonia  or  female 
organs.  Webber  describes  two  centrosome-like  structures  in  this 
generative  cell,  the  function  of  which  is  doubtful.  The  most 
interesting  part  of  his  communication  is  contained  in  a  note 
which  records  the  discovery,  as  the  paper  was  going  through  the 
press,  of  motile  antherozoids.  As  to  how  or  where  they  arise, 
whether  they  are  or  are  not  in  any  way  connected  with  the 
strange  bodies  in  the  generative  cell,  we  are  left  completely  in 
the  dark,   and  can  only  hope  for  a  continuation  in  our  next. 

The  Fossils  of  the  English  Chalk  Pock 

Thanks    to  Mr  Henry  Woods,  we  have    now  an    intelligent    and 
careful    account   of   the    mollusca   of   one   zone   of   the   Cretaceous 


158  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [September 

system  of  England.  We  say  intelligent  advisedly,  because  Mr 
Woods  has  not  included  in  his  lists  those  scraps  of  fossils  which 
are  considered  by  some  authors  worthy  to  occupy  their  text  and 
their  plates.  The  mollusca  of  the  Chalk  Bock  have  been  described 
in  the  Quarterly  Journal  of  the  Geological  Society,  vols.  Hi.  and  liii., 
and  comprise  ten  cephalopods,  sixteen  gasteropods,  and  twenty-nine 
lamellibranchs,  and  of  these  some  seven  of  the  first  group  occur  in 
Saxony  and  Bohemia,  two  or  three  only  of  the  second  group,  and 
about  one  half  of  the  third.  Fossils  from  this  zone  are  rarely 
obtained  in  a  perfect  condition,  and  are  frequently  denuded  of  their 
shell,  but  Mr  Woods  has  succeeded  in  figuring  some  typical  speci- 
mens which  will  be  useful  to  the  collection.  In  looking  through 
part  ii.  of  his  paper,  we  do  not  see  any  mention  of  Dover,  where  the 
Chalk  Eock  is  easily  accessible  and  fairly  rich  in  fossils  ;  indeed,  in 
a  few  hours  we  have  collected  all  but  two  of  the  gasteropods  men- 
tioned by  Mr  Hill  in  the  Quarterly  Journal,  vol.  xlii.  As  the  ener- 
getic members  of  the  Geologists'  Association  were  observed  in 
numbers  at  the  Chalk  Eock  of  Dover  last  Easter,  Mr  Woods  might 
easily  have  obtained  a  list  of  specimens.  It  is  gratifying  to  read 
that  the  author  intends  to  proceed  with  the  Inocerami,  for  they  are 
in  worse  confusion  than  most  other  shells.  His  synonymies  of 
Lima  hoperi  and  Spondylus  spinosus  are  interesting  and  important. 
Mr  Woods  will  forgive  us  perhaps  if  we  point  out  to  him  that 
Salvius  did  not  print  the  molluscan  part  of  Linne's  edition  xii.  until 
1767,  and  therefore  the  date  cannot  be  1766  ;  but  why  not  use  the 
tenth  edition,  1758,  now  almost  universally  recognized? 

A  list  of  other  remains  identified  is  supplied,  and  discussions  on 
the  distribution  and  relations  of  the  fauna  and  conditions  under 
which  the  Chalk  Eock  was  deposited  are  given.  The  whole  is  a 
useful  and  valuable  paper  which  will  be  largely  in  request. 

TlERKA    DEL    FUEGO 

In  September  last  year  we  were  favoured  by  Dr  Ohlin  with  an 
account  of  the  zoological  results  of  Baron  Oscar  Dickson's  expedi- 
tion to  Tierra  del  Fuego.  A  preliminary  notice  of  the  geographical 
results  of  that  expedition  is  now  published  in  the  Scottish  Geo- 
graphical Magazine  for  August.  The  country  consists  of  a  wood- 
less tableland  in  the  north,  and  a  mountainous  district  in  the 
south,  the  latter  being  the  extreme  continuation  of  the  Cordilleras. 
The  boundary  between  the  two  zones  is  almost  a  straight  line. 
The  northern  country  is  stated  to  be  of  Tertiary  age,  covered  partly 
by  gravel  and  partly  by  moraine. 


NATURAL  SCIENCE,    VOL  XI. 


Platk  VII 


JOHANNES   JAPETUS   SMITH    STEENSTKUl' 
Born  March  8,  1813;   died  June  20,  1897 


921.8  150 


Steenstrup 

JOHANNES  JAPETUS  SMITH  STEENSTEUP  was  born  on 
March  8,  1813,  in  the  northern  part  of  Jutland,  in  the 
district  termed  Thy,  where  his  father  was  a  parson.  In  the  year 
1832  he  was  sent  from  the  cathedral  -  school  of  his  native 
province  at  Aalborg  to  be  a  student  at  the  University  of 
Copenhagen.  In  two  succeeding  years  (1833-35)  he  was  obliged 
to  remain  in  the  paternal  home,  occupied  with  teaching  his 
younger  brothers  and  with  natural  history  excursions  into  his 
native  country,  collecting  numerous  examples  of  its  interesting 
natural  productions,  its  plants  and  animals,  its  fossils  and  geological 
features.  Of  scientific  facilities  or  aids  he  had  very  little  ;  a  copy 
of  the  published  parts  of  the  celebrated  "  Flora  Danica,"  of  Linne's 
"  Sy sterna  Naturae,"  of  0.  M.  Miiller's  "  Prodromus  zoologiae 
danicae,"  were,  I  believe,  almost  the  only  books  of  science  avail- 
able for  Steenstrup  in  these  early  times  of  his  scientific  self- 
training  and  self- education  ;  his  only  helper  at  this  time  being  a 
gifted  parson,  his  uncle,  formerly  a  pupil,  especially  in  botany  and 
entomology,  of  the  renowned  naturalist  and  teacher  Melchior,  at  the 
college  of  Herlufsholm.  After  his  return  to  the  university  in  1835, 
in  the  full  bloom  of  a  self-made  young  naturalist,  he  became  the 
pupil  and  friend  of  Schouw,  the  botanist,  of  Forchammer,  the 
geologist,  and  of  Eeinhardt,  sen.,  the  zoologist,  whose  ingenious 
lectures  left  an  impression  on  Steenstrup's  mind  never  to  be  effaced. 
Among  the  particular  friends  of  those  days  of  his  youth  were  the 
gifted  botanist  Drejer,  lost  at  an  early  age,  Liebmann,  Schouw's 
successor  as  Professor  of  Botany  after  his  return  from  Mexico, 
Eeinhardt,  jun.,  the  celebrated  zoologist  and  traveller  in  Brazil,  etc. 
Only  two  years  after  his  return  to  the  university  Steenstrup  earned 
the  honours  for  two  prize  essays,  the  one  (never  published,  only 
epitomised  in  my  text-book,  "  Dyreriget,"  and  therefrom  in  Palmen's 
work  on  the  migrations  of  birds),  "  on  the  differences  between  the 
wanderings  of  birds  and  fishes,"  the  other,  published  afterwards 
(1842)  in  the  Transactions  of  the  Danish  Academy  of  Science, 
"  on  the  geological  investigation  of  certain  forest-moors  on  Seeland," 
etc. — a  work  of  great  sagacity  and  acute  observation,  the  first  to 
elucidate  the   sequence   of   the   different  forest-vegetations  charac- 


160  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [September 

teristic  of  the  early  periods  in  the  recovery  of  our  country  after 
its  emergence  from  the  waves  and  the  close  of  what  is  now  termed 
"  the  Ice- Age  " — the  ages  of  the  aspen  (Populus  tremula),  of  the 
fir  {Pinus  sylvestris),  the  oak  (Quercus  sessiliflora),  and  ulti- 
mately the  alder  (Alnus  glutincsa)  and  the  beech  (Fagus 
sylvatica).  Much  time  was  destined  to  elapse  before  these 
studies  of  the  gifted  rising  naturalist,  so  important  for  the  history 
of  the  life  of  our  globe,  were  taken  up  elsewhere  in  other  northern 
regions. 

In  the  year  1839-40  Steenstrup  was  sent  by  the  Government, 
with  an  Icelandic  student,  Hallgrimson,  and  Mr  Schytte,  afterwards 
Professor  of  Chemistry  in  Chile  and  Governor  at  Puntas  Arenas  on 
the  Straits  of  Magellan,  to  Iceland  for  an  economic  investigation  of 
this  country.  The  story  of  this  voyage,  though  interesting  to  those 
who  have  had  the  good  fortune  to  hear  Steenstrup's  reminiscences 
of  the  country,  its  nature  and  its  people,  was  never  published  ;  nor 
was  his  interesting  and  fruitful  discovery  that  the  so-called  "  Surtur- 
brand  "  in  the  Tertiary  trap  formation  of  Iceland  contained  a  series 
of  remains  of  an  arboreal  vegetation,  with  its  tulip-trees  (Lirio- 
dendron),  etc.,  most  resembling  that  of  certain  subtropical  regions, 
until  his  Icelandic  materials  and  figures  were  placed  in  the  hands  of 
Oswald  Heer.  Steenstrup's  investigations  on  the  volcanic  formation 
of  Iceland  have  been  taken  up  by  younger  minds,  who  have  no 
doubt  been  much  benefited  by  the  information  that  was  in  Steen- 
strup's possession.  Another  discovery  made  by  Steenstrup  on  this 
trip  to  Iceland  happened  during  some  sunny  days  near  the  coast  of 
Norway,  viz.,  the  discovery  of  the  metamorphosis  of  crabs  (Hyas 
araneus)  and  soldier  crabs  (Pagurus  bcrnhardus),  at  a  period  when 
metamorphosis  in  Crustacea  was  very  little  known,  and  therefore 
was  received  by  excellent  zoologists  with  considerable  doubt.  Steen- 
strup's letters  to  Eeinhardt  on  this  subject  were  printed  in  the 
Proceedings  of  the  Royal  Danish  Academy  in  1870.  The 
specimens  collected  were  also  sent  down  to  his  teacher.  They 
were  seen  here  by  Ptathke,  who  described  them  together  with  the 
material  collected  by  himself.  The  history  of  the  metamorphosis 
in  the  higher  Crustacea  now  occupies  an  extensive  literature ; 
among  the  first  pioneers  in  this  important  chapter  Steenstrup's 
name  must  have  its  place. 

Shortly  after  his  return  from  Iceland  in  1841  Steenstrup  was 
appointed  lecturer  in  Potany  and  Mineralogy  (geology)  in  the 
Academy  of  Soroe  in  Seeland,  the  only  place  in  Denmark  where 
Natural  History  and  a  knowledge  of  modern  languages  had  its 
rightful  place  among  the  classical  lines  of  study.  Here  he  remained 
until  1846,  occupied  especially  witli  two  of  his  best  known  works, 
published  as  programmes  of  the  college,  viz.,  "The  Alternations  of 


1897]  STEEXSTRUF  161 

Generations"  (1842),  and  "On  the  Existence  of  Hermaphroditism 
in  Nature"  (1845).  The  first  of  these  is  too  well  known  to  need 
any  explanation  here ;  it  can  only  be  wondered  that  this  doctrine  so 
wonderful  at  the  time  of  its  publication  has  been  so  little  modified 
in  its  essential  points  and  lost  or  gained  so  little  in  extension  since 
that  time.  Space  forbids  me  to  enlarge  further  on  this  topic,  which 
more  than  any  other  of  Steenstrup's  writings  has  spread  his  name 
and  fame  over  the  whole  civilised  world.  His  second  work,  that 
"  On  Hermaphroditism,"  was  less  successful,  though  its  subject  was 
in  intimate  connection  with  lines  of  thought  resulting  from  or  con- 
nected with  "  metagenesis,"  as  it  is  now  generally  termed.  One  may 
admire  the  author's  acuteness  of  perception  and  the  extent  of  his 
comparative  studies,  and  confess  that  he  quite  rightly  abolished  many 
cases  of  unfounded  hermaphroditism  among  inferior  animals ;  but  it 
must  be  allowed  that  hermaphroditism  is  still  fully  recognised,  with 
few  exceptions,  among  leeches,  flukes,  tapeworms,  pulmonate  and 
opisthobranch  snails,  barnacles,  etc.  (Tardigrada  have  lately  been 
thrown  off),  without  our  being  able  to  give  an  adequate  natural 
reason  for  its  presence  in  some  tribes  and  its  absence  in  others. 
In  recent  times  Steenstrup's  memoir  has  awakened  the  important 
remark,  that  in  all  probability  hermaphroditism  has  not  been  the 
primordial  rule  in  any  division  of  higher  or  lower  zoological  rank, 
but  must  be  a  "  later  acquisition "  in  the  course  of  evolution,  for 
which  no  satisfactory  reason  can  yet  be  given.  While  speaking 
still  of  Steenstrup's  residence  at  Soroe,  it  should  be  mentioned  that 
here  he  pursued,  in  the  course  of  other  faunistic  studies,  an  examina- 
tion into  the  specific  duplicity  of  our  common  frogs  (Rana  temporaria) 
and  the  distinctive  characters  of  what  he  termed  R.  oxyrhinus  and 
R.  platyrhinus,  which  have  played  a  rather  important  part  in  the 
recent  study  of  the  Anourous  Batrachia. 

In  1846,  after  the  death  of  Eeinhardt,  sen.,  Steenstrup  was 
nominated  to  replace  him  in  the  chair  of  Zoology  at  the  University 
•of  Copenhagen,  and  as  Director  of  its  modest  zoological  collection. 
He  was  a  beloved  and  admired  teacher  for  the  students  of  medicine 
and  for  the  pupils  of  the  polytechnic  school,  and  at  the  same  time  the 
gifted  chief  leader  of  the  "  Natural  History  Society."  A  member  of 
ithe  Royal  Society  of  Science  from  1842,  he  was  its  secretary  after 
Forchammer's  death  until  after  years  of  great  activity  he  gave  up 
this  post  in  1878.  The  election  to  the  Presidency  after  Madvig's 
•death  he  declined,  as  he  had  more  than  once  declined  the  Rectorship 
of  the  University,  being  anxious  not  to  be  drawn  too  much  away 
from  his  scientific  studies  and  his  professorial  duties.  In  1848  he 
was  with  Forchammer  placed  at  the  head  of  the  "  Poyal  Natural 
History  Museum,"  with  the  recommendation  of  the  Minister  of 
Education  to  promote  its  union  with  the  University  Museums — a 

M 


162  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [September 

proposal  which  naturally  enough  interested  Steenstrup  much,  hut 
met  with  some  opposition,  not  only  from  the  University,  which 
reasonably  feared  the  increased  pecuniary  obligations  involved  in 
such  a  scheme,  but  also  from  the  majority  of  the  keepers  at  the 
Eoyal  Museum.  At  last  the  battle  was  won  by  the  bill  of  1863, 
which  ordered  the  construction  of  a  much  wanted  building  in  the 
grounds  of  the  University.  It  was  finished  and  opened  to  the 
public  and  to  Science  in  1870,  and  has  since  been  the  handsome, 
but  perhaps  not  sufficiently  large  home  of  zoological  science  with  us, 
constructed  by  the  gifted  architect,  Chr.  Hansen,  whose  genius  was, 
I  believe,  strongly  fertilised  by  Steenstrup's  ideas.  Steenstrup  was 
not,  as  originally  planned,  the  sole  director  of  the  new  museum,  but 
by  the  election  of  the  University  the  president  of  its  council, 
consisting  of  two  keepers  (inspectors),  Schodte  and  Bernhardt,  and 
himself  as  administrators  of  its  different  departments.  I  shall  not 
here  speak  of  the  difficulties  and  painful  controversies  connected 
with  this  organisation.  Steenstrup  retired  from  his  position  as 
Professor  of  Zoology  in  the  year  1885,  after  a  painful  period, 
rendered  more  distressing  through  an  unfortunate  accident  (a 
fracture  of  collum  femoris).  I  shall  confine  myself  to  a  short 
resume"  of  his  chief  scientific  work  from  1846  to  1885,  the  years 
of  his  professorship. 

It  was  one  of  Steenstrup's  characteristic  features  that  he  was 
not  only  an  excellent  zoologist  and  a  specialist  in  some  of  its 
branches,  but  also  a  good  geologist  and  botanist,  capable  of  discuss- 
ing many  topics  relating  to  different  sciences ;  and  it  may  be 
said,  that  he  had  a  certain  predilection  for  those  points  of 
science,  where  its  different  sections  meet  and  intercross.  It  will 
therefore  be  easily  understood  that  a  man  with  his  abilities  and 
constitution  of  mind  must  play  an  important  part  in  a  large 
scientific  community.  It  is,  of  course,  a  difficult  task  to  classify 
his  works,  which  can  often  be  referred  to  more  than  one  of  the 
related  sciences,  and  whose  value  may  be  judged  from  different 
points  of  view.  It  will  be  understood  that  while  his  humble  suc- 
cessor in  the  chair  of  Zoology  since  1885  may  think  himself 
entitled  to  judge  of  his  purely  zoological  work,  he  must  speak  some- 
what more  discreetly,  notwithstanding  the  partly  natural  historical 
character  of  Steenstrup's  archaeological  and  related  publications,  on 
this  part  of  his  literary  work,  and  leave  the  ultimate  judgment 
to  his  historical  and  archaeological  colleagues. 

One  of  Steenstrup's  great  services  was,  that  he  induced — what 
was  then  a  rarity — some  of  our  excellent  seafaring  men  of  the  navy 
or  of  the  merchant  line,  to  devote  their  leisure  hours  to  collecting 
the  animals  of  the  seas  through  which  they  sailed,  making  careful 
notes  of  the  localities  examined  with  their  nets,  and  in  this  manner 


1 897]  S  TEENS  Til  UP  163 

furnishing  the  museum  with  pelagic  and  other  material  from  almost 
every  part  of  the  ocean.  Several  parts  of  this  "Plankton"  have 
since  been  worked  upon  by  his  pupils  and  others  {e.g.,  Boas  on  the 
Pteropoda,  Traustedt  on  the  Salpae,  Lutken  on  the  Dolphins  and 
the  "  hemi-metamorphoses  of  fishes,"  Bovallius  on  the  Hyperidae, 
etc.).  With  this  series  of  studies  may  also  be  reckoned  the  memoir 
of  Steenstrup  and  myself  on  the  parasitic  Entomostraca  of  the 
ocean  with  several  other  forms  of  the  same  tribe  ;  also  the  former's 
anti-critical  note  on  the  genera  Sllcnium,  Lesteira  and  Pegasimallus, 
and  his  papers  (too  numerous  to  be  enumerated  here)  on  Cepha- 
lopoda (Notac  teuthologicae,  etc.)  in  the  Transactions  and  Proceed- 
ings of  the  Academy  of  Science,  in  the  Vidcnskabcligc  Mcddclcl- 
scr  fra  den  naturhistorishe  Forcning,  and  elsewhere  in  popular 
journals.  I  shall  dwell,  however,  more  particularly  only  on  two 
points.  Firstly,  there  is  his  surprising  demonstration  that  the 
apparently  abnormal  development  of  one  or  occasionally  two  arms 
in  male  cuttlefishes,  hitherto  overlooked  or  not  understood,  was  in 
fact  the  homologue  of  the  well-known  "  hectocotyle  "  in  the  pelagic 
Octopoda.  His  eager  desire  to  throw  the  light  of  his  genius  and  of 
his  science  on  obscure  problems,  led  him  also  to  investigate  the  tale 
of  the  wonderful  sea-monk,  the  monster  that  was  cast  ashore  in  our 
vicinity  in  the  sixteenth  century,  described  and  figured  by  Belon, 
Bondelet  and  Gesner,  and  playing  an  important  part  in  the  semi- 
mystic  Natural  History  of  the  Benaissance.  Nobody  had  been 
able  to  decipher  this  enigmatical  monster  until  Steenstrup  deprived 
it  of  its  fabulous  investment,  demonstrated  it  to  be  simply  a  decapod 
giant  cuttlefish.  Specimens  of  this  same  kind  {Architeuthus)  have 
been  thrown  on  our  shore,  formerly  and  later  on  the  shores  of  Ice- 
land, Faroe,  Jutland,  Newfoundland  and  Japan,  and  happily  one  of 
our  captains  did  find  such  an  animal  floating  in  the  Atlantic,  and 
secured  to  Steenstrup  some  of  its  most  important  parts.  Steen- 
strup's  full  account  of  these  remains  was  partly  in  print,  though 
never  completely  published ;  but  some  of  his  plates  have  been 
placed  in  the  hands  of  his  fellow-zoologists.  To  the  other  purely 
zoological  articles  of  Steenstrup,  I  shall  only  allude  briefly,  namely, 
to  those  on  Sphenopus  (Sabclla  marsiqrialis  Giil),  on  Philichthgs, 
Phizochilus,  Xenobanalus,  Pachybdclla  and  Pdtogaster,  on  the  enig- 
matical objects  correctly  interpreted  as  the  "  gillrakers  "  of  Sdachus 
maximus,  on  the  natural  systematic  place  of  the  walrus,  etc.  His 
interpretation  of  the  wandering  of  the  eye  in  young  flounders  has 
not  been  accepted  with  unanimity,  but  still  has  some  trustworthy 
points  to  fall  back  upon.  Our  common  memoir  on  the  Mola-tvihe 
(Orthagoriscus)  and  its  larval  stages,  has  not  been  published  in  its 
complete  form  ;  perhaps  it  may  be  so  still.  Several  palaeonto- 
logical  papers  on  mammals,  birds  and  reptiles  (turtles)   found  in  our 


164  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [September 

peat-beds  or  other  formations  have  appeared  at  least  in  abstract,  as 
also  some  account  of  the  refuse-heaps  or  shell-heaps  ("  kitchen- 
middens  ")  of  our  shores,  whose  correct  interpretation  was  the  work 
of  Steenstrup,  and  has  obtained  world-wide  notice  and  given  birth 
to  many  investigations  in  other  countries.  Some  papers  on 
Helmintha  {e.g.,  Fasciola  intestinalis)  should  not  be  forgotten.  His 
interpretation  of  the  Brachiopoda  as  not  belonging  to  the  true 
Acephala  has  in  later  time  become  popular ;  his  interpretation  of 
the  partly  operculated  "Palaeozoic  corals"  (Cyathophyllidae)  as  not 
being  Anthozoa-proper,  but  something  else,  perhaps  allied  to  Ser- 
polidae,  Hippuritidae  or  Brachiopoda,  has  met  with  decided  doubt 
and  opposition,  but  in  my  opinion,  not  found  its  final  decision.  In 
the  study  of  the  newer  (Glacial)  geological  formations,  Steenstrup 
took  an  active  part  with  his  lamented  younger  friend  and  colleague, 
Johnstrup,  and  some  of  his  later  papers  briefly  give  his  views  on 
some  of  the  theories  advanced  in  Scandinavia  concerning  this  im- 
portant part  of  Scandinavian  geology.  That  he  with  Nathorst,  the 
Swedish  botanist-geologist,  partook  in  the  discovery  of  the  earliest 
glacial  plant  remains  in  our  Scandinavian  peat-bogs,  should  also  be 
remembered.  He  was  present  at  most  of  the  meetings  of  the 
Scandinavian  naturalists  during  the  period  of  his  scientific  activity 
and  has  left  the  marks  of  his  influence  in  the  reports  of  the  meet- 
ings of  the  Americanists  and  Archaeologists  at  Copenhagen  and 
Brussels.  Beyond  his  travels  in  Iceland  and  his  visit  to  the  Faroe 
Islands,  he  made  several  journeys  to  Germany,  France,  Northern 
Italy,  Switzerland,  Dalmatia,  and  England,  enriching  his  knowledge 
and  adding  to  his  acquaintance  and  friendly  relation  with  eminent 
men  of  many  countries  and  many  sciences.  His  scientific  corre- 
spondence would  fill  many  volumes. 

Already  in  the  earlier  part  of  his  career,  Steenstrup  had 
published  some  papers  of  a  chiefly  historical  aim,  throwing  light  on 
obscure  phenomena,  elucidated  from  a  naturalist's  point  of  view 
(e.g.,  on  the  so-called  "  havgaerdinger,"  on  Ottar's  relation  to  King 
Alfred  on  his  travels  in  northern  seas,  and  on  the  passage  of  King 
Harold  through  the  Limfjord).  After  he  had  retired  from  his 
zoological  professorship  in  1885.  he  treated  with  great  emphasis 
several  archaeological  problems  of  the  same  character  (e.g.,  the  Haell- 
ristningar,  the  voyages  of  the  Zeni,  the  Yak-Lungta-Brakteats,  the 
silverplates  found  at  Gundestrup,  the  mammoth  station  at  Predmost 
in  Bohemia.  Most  of  them  have  been  published,  though  not  the 
first.  I  shall  not  do  more  than  point  out  the  existence  and 
interest  of  these  remarkable  papers,  not  being  competent  to  pass  a 
scientific  judgment  upon  them ;  but,  at  the  same  time,  I  would  ex- 
press my  conviction,  that  they  will  remain  through  all  future  time  a 
testimony  of  the  great  insight,  sagacity  and  knowledge  of  my  gifted 


1897]  STEENSTRUP  165 

friend  and  teacher,  the  glory  of  his  country,  of  Europe,  and  of  his 
century.  That  he  was  honoured  with  the  highest  distinctions  from 
his  country  and  from  many  other  sources,  I  need  not  tell,  nor 
enumerate  the  learned  societies  (Stockholm,  Christiania,  Berlin, 
Paris,  London,  etc.)  of  which  he  was  a  member.  This  sketch  of 
Steenstrup's  life  and  work  may  appear  longer  than  usual  to  the 
readers  of  this  journal,  but  it  is  not  long  or  detailed  enough  to  do 
justice  to  what  ought  to  have  been  said.  I  cannot  conclude  with- 
out naming  his  wife,  Ida  {nee  Kaarsberg),  the  love  of  his  youth,  lost 
several  years  before  her  husband  died.  Several  children  died 
earlier  or  later  ;  one  daughter  is  left,  and  there  is  one  son,  Johannes 
Steenstrup,  Doctor  in  Law  and  Professor  Iiostgaardianus  in  History 
at  our  University,  whose  work  on  the  history  of  the  Normans  will 
especially  be  known  to  many  English  readers. 

Che.  Fk.  Lutken. 


575.4  166  [September 


II 

Does  Natural  Selection  play  any  part  in  the  Origin 
of  Species  among  Plants  ? 

INTRODUCTION.  —  The  objects  of  the  present  paper  are  to 
answer  this  question  in  the  negative,  and  to  prove  that  natural 
selection  is  a  superfluous  factor  as  an  aid  in  the  origination  of  new 
varietal  characters  ;  though  it  has  much  to  do  with  the  "  survival 
of  the  fittest  "  in  "  the  struggle  for  existence  "  among  beings  in  any 
particular  locality.  It  is,  of  course,  the  Darwinian  conception  that 
these  factors  are  somehow  concerned  in  the  origin  of  species  ;  but  I 
would  maintain  that  they  must  be  kept  totally  distinct  from  it. 
Darwin,  in  truth,  insisted  upon  this  fact  himself ;  that  whatever  the 
causes  or  origins  of  variations  might  be,  such  were  questions  with 
which  natural  selection  had  nothing  whatever  to  do.  His  words 
are : — "  The  direct  action  of  the  conditions  of  life  ...  is  a  totally 
distinct  consideration  from  the  effects  of  natural  selection  .  .  .  [it] 
has  no  relation  whatever  to  the  primary  cause  of  any  modification 
of  structure."1  What  I  wish  to  show  is  that  sufficient  variations 
to  constitute  a  variety  are  always  the  result  of  a  direct  or  indirect 
response  to  the  "  definite  action "  of  a  new  environment ;  indeed 
many,  if  not  all  the  organisms,  of  whatever  kind  they  may  be,  which 
are  subjected  to  it,  often  vary  more  or  less  in  a  like  manner.2  It 
will  then  be  seen  at  once  that  not  only  are  there  no  "  indefinite 
variations  "  for  natural  selection  to  deal  with,  but  as  a  consequence 
its  raison  'd'etre,  as  an  aid  in  the  origin  of  species  is  gone  ;  and  it 
can  take  no  part  in  the  origination  of  varieties. 

I  wish  also  to  point  out  that  Darwin's  theory  of  natural 
selection  rests  entirely  upon  a  series  of  a  'priori  assumptions  or 
deductions,  which  have  never  been  verified ;  nor,  indeed,  do  they 
seem  capable  of  verification. 

Definition  of  a  Species. — In  order  to  be  clear,  it  is  desirable 
to  state  precisely  what  one  understands  by  the  term  "  Species." 
According  to  the  method  pursued  by  systematic  botanists  in 
describing  plants,  a  species  may  be  defined  as  follows : — "  Any 
particular  species  of  a  genus  is  known  by  a  collection  of  characters 
taken  from  any  or  all  parts  of  the  plant.      These  characters  are,  or 

1  "Animals  and  Plants  under  Domestication,"  vol.  ii.,  p.  272. 

2  Hence,  arises  the  fades  characteristic  of  aquatic,  desert,  alpine,  and  other  plants  : 
as  I  have  described  in  my  work  — "  The  Origin  of  Plant  Structures." 


1897]  ORIGIN  OF  SPECIES  AMONG  PLANTS  167 

are  theoretically  assumed  to  be,  constant."  One  or  more  of  these 
characters  may  be  found  on  another  species,  which  in  a  similar 
manner  is  known  by  its  collection  of  constant  characters. 

What  may  have  been  their  origin,  and  how  the  survival  and 
maintenance  of  any  superficial  characters  of  a  plant  have  been 
secured,  are  philosophical  questions  with  which  the  systematist  has 
no  concern  at  all. 

Useless  Characters. — Before  showing  that  the  hypothesis  ef 
natural  selection  is  superfluous  in  the  origination  of  varietal  charac- 
ters, let  us  turn  to  the  descriptions  of  plants  given  in  some  standard 
work,  say,  Sir  J.  D.  Hooker's  "  Students'  Flora  of  the  British  Isles." 
It  will  be  found  that  many  characters  are  taken  as  specific  or 
generic  which  cannot,  with  any  show  of  reason,  be  regarded  as 
specifically  useful ;  such  as  the  numerical  excess  or  deficiency  in 
the  number  of  parts  in  the  floral  whorls  ;  e.g.,  Gcntiana  campestris 
is  described  as  having  the  calyx  "four-partite";  while  in  G-.  amarella, 
it  is  "  five-lobed  "  ;  but  fours,  fives  and  sixes  may  be  often  found  on 
one  and  the  same  plant,  as  in  a  corymb  of  elder  flowers,  due  to  an 
accidental  deficiency  or  excess  of  nutriment,  respectively  ;  and  no 
vital  importance  can  be  attributed  to  the  trivial  specific  distinc- 
tion between  "  partite  "  and  "  lobed."  Such  illustrations  of  quite 
unimportant  characters  regarded  as  specific  can  be  multiplied  to 
any  extent ;  but  they  are  some  of  the  very  characters  which 
Darwin  admits  are  not  due  to  natural  selection.  He  says : 
— "  We  thus  see  that  with  plants  many  morphological  changes 
may  be  attributed  to  the  laws  of  growth  and  interaction  of  parts, 
independently  of  natural  selection."  l  They  are,  in  fact,  simply 
the  inevitable  results  of  a  response  to  environmental  conditions,  using 
the  term  in  the  broadest  sense. 

With  regard  to  such  indifferent  characters  being  hereditary, 
Darwin  first  says  that  he  "  felt  great  difficulty  in  understanding  the 
origin  or  formation  of  parts  of  little  importance  ;  almost  as  great, 
though  of  a  different  kind,  as  in  the  case  of  the  most  perfect  and 
complex  organs," 2  and  he  devotes  a  section  to  a  theoretical 
interpretation  of  them.  Indeed  he,  on  several  occasions,  recognises 
the  existence  of  useless  characters ;  e.g.,  he  says,  "  I  am  inclined  to 
suspect  that  we  see,  at  least  in  some  of  the  polymorphic  genera, 
variations  which  are  of  no  service  or  disservice  to  the  species ;  and, 
consequently,  have  not  been  seized  on  and  rendered  definite  by 
natural  selection." 3  In  this  passage  the  word  "  disservice  "  almost 
seems  as  if  he  had  a  suspicion  that  "  injurious "  characters  might 
sometimes  be  present,  though  he  elsewhere  says : — "  Any  actually 
injurious  deviations  in  their  structure  would,  of  course,  have  been 

1  "  Origin  of  Species,"  6th  ert.,  p.  175  ;  see  also  p.  367. 

2  "  Origin,  etc.,"  p.  156.  ■"'  "  Origin,  etc.,"  p.  35. 


168  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [September 

checked  by  natural  selection."  Secondly,  the  following  are  Darwin's 
words  with  reference  to  the  inheritance  of  characters  which  are  no 
longer  useful : — "  No  doubt  the  definite  action  of  changed  con- 
ditions .  .  .  have  all  produced  an  effect,  probably  a  great  effect, 
independently  of  any  advantage  thus  gained.  ...  I  fully  admit  that 
many  structures  are  now  of  no  direct  use  to  their  possessors,  and 
may  never  have  been  of  any  use  to  their  progenitors."  .  .  .  He 
mentions  the  webbed  feet  of  upland  geese,  etc.  ..."  With  these 
important  exceptions,  we  may  conclude  that  the  structure  of  every 
living  creature  either  now  is,  or  was  formerly,  of  some  direct  or 
indirect  use  to  its  possessor," l  He  would  thus  include  all  rudi- 
mentary organs  as  having  been  formerly  useful,  but  now  useless ;  of 
these  he  remarks  that  rudimentary  organs  from  being  useless  are  not 
regulated  by  natural  selection,  and  hence  are  variable.  If  they  be 
so  in  the  animal  kingdom,  they  are  not  so  in  the  vegetable ;  e.g.,  the 
staminodes  and  rudiments  of  ovaries  of  flowers  are  constant  in  form 
to  each  species,  genus  or  order  which  is  characterised  by  them, 
respectively;  as,  e.g.,  Er odium,  Samolus,  Mercurialis,  Parietaria, 
Valerianeae,  Myrsineae,  etc.,  and  are  recognised  as  permanent 
diagnostic  characters. 

Injurious  Characters. — In  many  flowers  there  have  been 
acquired  and  retained  by  heredity,  what  may  be  called  by  Darwin's 
term  "disservice,"  or  even  "injurious"  characters.  For  if,  e.g.,  the 
use  of  flowers  be  to  set  good  seed,  then  anything  which  tends  to 
hinder  that  process  is  obviously  injurious.  Such  occurs  in  the 
structure  of  the  flowers  of  most  orchids,  and  in  many  adaptations 
to  insect  fertilisation,  as  dichogamy,  protandry,  polymorphism,  etc., 
whenever  they  tend  to  bar  self-fertilisation. 

For  it  need  hardly  be  observed  now,  that  Darwin's  assumption 
from  the  numerous  adaptations  in  flowers  for  intercrossing  by 
insects,  that  self-fertilisation  was  "  injurious,"  was  based  on  a  quite 
erroneous  deduction  altogether.  The  fact  being  that  in  nature 
autogamous,  or  self-fertilised  plants,  are  by  far  the  most  prolific, 
perfectly  healthy,  most  abundant  in  individuals,  and  most  widely 
dispersed.2 

On  the  other  hand,  all  special  adaptations  to  secure  self- 
fertilisation  are  obviously  useful,  are  quite  as  numerous  and 
excellent  in  the  adjustment  of  the  organs,  as  are  those  for  inter- 


crossing.3 


Now  it  is  worth  while  observing  that  the  result  of  such  injurious 

1  "Origin,  etc.,"  p.  160. 

2  The  reader  is  referred  (should  he  require  it)  to  the  writer's  papers  on  "Self- 
fertilisation,"  Trans.  Linn.  Soc.  1877;  Review  of  Darwin's  "Cross  and  Self-fertilisa- 
tion of  Flowers"  in  "Gardener's  Chronicle"  (1877);  and  "The  Origin  of  Plant 
Structures."  ,  . 

3  See  Kerner  &  Oliver's  "Natural   History  of   Plants;"    "Autogamy,     vol.  n., 

p.  331,  n; 


1S97]  ORIGIN  OF  SPECIES  AMONG  PLANTS  169 

features  may  even  be  the  actual  extinction  of  a  species  ;  for  it  is 
conceivable  that  if  a  plant  cannot  set  seed  by  self-fertilisation,  and 
is  not  crossed  by  insects  or  the  wind,  it  will  die  out,  if  it  be  an 
annual  or  not  propagated  by  its  vegetative  system.  It  will  thus  be 
eliminated  by  natural  selection.1  But  the  process  falls  within  the 
subject  of  the  distribution  of  species,  both  in  time  and  space,  and 
has  nothing  whatever  to  do  with  the  origination  of  such  harmful 
structures ;  which,  as  long  as  they  exist,  are  regarded  as  specific  or 
generic  characters. 

The  survival  of  the  fittest,  therefore,  and  the  destruction  of  the 
least  fit  and  incapable  to  survive,  are  questions  altogether  inde- 
pendent of  the  Origination  of  Structural  Variations,  upon  which 
the  survival,  or  destruction  in  some  cases,  may  actually  depend. 
The  reader  must  constantly  bear  in  mind  Darwin's  words  which  I 
again  quote,  because  of  their  importance  :  "  The  direct  action  of  the 
conditions  of  life  ...  is  a  totally  distinct  consideration  from  the 
effects  of  natural  selection  .  .  .  [it]  has  no  relation  whatever  to  the 
primary  cause  of  any  modification  of  structure."  2  This  last  is  the 
sole  matter  with  which  I  am  concerned. 

Individual  Differences. — These  according  to  Darwin3  and  Dr 
"Wallace  are  the  chief  materials  for  natural  selection  to  act  upon. 
As  I  have  already  fully  discussed  this  subject  in  Natural  Science  i 
and  pointed  out  that  as  a  rule  they  are  quite  incapable  of  giving  rise 
to  varietal  characters  which  a  systematist  would  take  note  of,  I  need 
say  no  more  than  invite  the  reader's  careful  attention  to  my  article. 

I  might,  however,  briefly  point  out  a  fallacy  in  Dr  Wallace's 
conclusion.  He  has  given  numerous  tables  in  his  work,  "  Darwinism," 
and  argues  that  any  excess  in  dimension  of  an  organ  from  the  mean 
is  eliminated  by  natural  selection  ;  so  that  a  species  keeps  its  dimen- 
sions pretty  constant,  annually.5  But  no  intimation  is  given  as  to 
how  great  a  deviation,  in  excess  or  deficiency  of  the  mean,  is  required 
to  prove  destructive  to  the  creature  itself.  Experience,  however, 
shows  that  both  nanism  and  gigantism  are  common  phenomena  in 
nature  among  plants ;  in  which  the  customary  deviations  are  vastly 
exceeded.  Moreover  they  can  be  induced  to  arise  under  cultivation 
coupled  with  perfect  health,  fertility  and  heredity.  Therefore,  the 
whole  of  this  argument  falls  to  the  ground. 

Supposed  Requirements  of  Natural  Selection  in  the  For- 
mation of  New  Varieties. — The  primary  condition  assumed  by 
Darwin  and  Dr  Wallace  is  a  large  population.  In  order  to  produce  a 
new  variety  these  writers  tell  us  that  "  in  the  great  majority  of  cases 
a  new  species  arises  amidst  the  population  of  an  existing  species." 

1  "Origin,  etc.,"  p.  57. 

2  "  Animals  and  Plants  under  Domestication,"  vol.  ii.,  p.  272. 

8  "  Origin,  etc.,"  p.  34.  4  Vol.  vi.,  p.  385  (1895). 

5  Journ.  Linn.  Soc.  {ZouL),  vol.  xxv.,  p.  483. 


170  NA TUBAL   SCIENCE  [September 

"  The  greatest  clanger,"  writes  Dr  Wallace,  "  to  a  species  under  new 
and  adverse  conditions  is,  that  it  should  not  be  able  to  adapt  itself 
to    thein    with   sufficient   rapidity.      It   is   for  this  reason  that,  as 
Darwin  concludes,  new  species  arise  from  those  which  have  a  large 
population,  which  occupy  a  wide  area,  and  which  present  much  varia- 
tion, a  combination  .   .  .   rarely  found  except  in  continental  areas."  l 
How  far  is  this  hypothesis  borne  out  by  facts  ?     As  a  matter  of  fact 
the  majority  of  species  of  a  country  have  not  a  large  population, 
nevertheless  many  of  such  species  have  varied  as  much  as,  if  not 
more,  indeed,  than  the  more  gregarious  species  with  large  popula- 
tions ;  thus,  it  is  easy  to  think  of  plants,  of  which  large  populations 
exist,    generally   gregarious,    and  therefore   supplying    the   primary 
condition   supposed  to   be  requisite  for  natural  selection  ;  but  the 
remarkable  feature  about  them  is  that  they  have  never  been  known 
to  vary  !     Thus,  Sir  J,  D.  Hooker  gives  no  varieties  whatever  to  any 
of    the    following    species,    Ranunculus   Jicaria,    Caltha   palustris, 
Lychnis  diurna,  Erica  cinerea,  Bcllis  pcrcnnis,  Urtica  dioica,  Galium, 
verum,    Scilla   nutans,    Lemna    minor,    Pteris   aquilina,   &c.       And 
when  we  cross  the  channel  (though  England  is  really  or  physically 
part  of  the  Continent)  we  find  no  more  signs  of  variation  there, 
whether  in  France,  Germany,  Switzerland,  the  Tyrol,  &c. 

On  the  other  hand,  take  an  extremely  common  plant,  Polygonum 
avictdarc ;  though  abundant,  it  is  scarcely  a  social  plant,  at  least,  to 
the  extent  of  those  mentioned.  It  produces  several  varieties,  but 
are  they  found  in  the  midst  of  the  commonest,  say,  the  roadside 
type  ?  Sir  J.  D.  Hooker  says  : — "  Var.  P.  littorale  (littoral)  a 
passage  to  P.  maritimum  (maritime) ;  Var.  agrestinum  (field 
form) ;  Var.  arenastrum  (sand-loving  form)  ;  Var.  rurivagum  (way- 
side form) ; "  hence  these  varieties  are  not  found  in  the  midst  of 
the  commonest  form,  but  away  from  it,  in  localities  characterised 
by  special  physical  features.  In  other  words,  these  varieties  arise 
by  self-adaptation  to  their  special  environments,  respectively. 

The  second  condition  requisite  for  variations  consists  of  "  changed 
conditions  of  life."  Both  Darwin  and  Dr  Wallace  admit  that  "  a 
change  of  climate  and  food  "  is  requisite  for  a  new  variety  to  arise 
among  the  parent  type.  The  latter  writer  says : — "  Now  let  some 
important  change  occur,  either  in  climate,  in  abundance  of  food,  or 
by  the  irruption  of  some  new  and  hitherto  unknown  enemies,  a 
change  which  at  first  injuriously  affects  the  species." 2  Similarly 
Darwin  writes : — "  Let  the  external  conditions  of  the  country  alter," 
and  again,  "take  the  case  of  a  country  undergoing  some  .  .  .  change."3 

The  question  at  once  arises,  where  and  when  do  we  find  these 
changes  occurring  in,  or  coming  to,  any  particular  district,  where 
some  species  with  a  large  population   happens  to  be  ?      Is  nature 

1  Lot:  cit.,  p.  484.  -  Loc.  tit.,  p.  483.  3  "Origin,  etc.,"  p.  63. 


1897]  ORIGIN  OF  SPECIES  AMONG  PLANTS  171 

dependent  upon  geological  catastrophes  for  producing  variations  in 
plants  and  animals  ?  Indeed,  this  would  seem  to  be  Darwin's  view 
in  his  discussion  on  geologic  time,  in  which  he  says : — "  It  is 
probable,  as  Sir  W.  Thomson  insists,  that  the  world  at  a  very  early 
period  was  subjected  to  more  rapid  and  violent  changes  in  its 
physical  conditions  than  those  now  occurring;  and  such  changes 
would  have  tended  to  induce  changes  at  a  corresponding  rate  in  the 
organisms  which  then  existed."1 

But  when  we  find  that  one  species  will  change  into  another 
recognised  species  under  our  very  eyes,  if  its  environment  be  altered, 
why  need  one  appeal  to  millions  of  years  for  aid  ?  Dr  Wallace, 
e.g.,  notes  how  "  Arabis  anchoretica  has  tissue-papery  leaves  due 
to  its  growth  in  hollows  in  the  rock.  Seeds  of  this  plant  when 
cultivated  at  Kew  produced  the  common  species  A.  alpina.  The 
same  thing  occurs  with  many  plants  as  every  cultivator  knows." 

Darwin  and  Dr  Wallace  agree  in  requiring  "  rapid  adaptation," 
but  Darwin  admits  "  that  natural  selection  generally  acts  with 
extreme  slowness."  3 

Now,  if  nature  has  to  wait  for  catastrophes  before  some 
"chanced  conditions  of  life"  come  to  her  organisms,  is  not  this 
something  like  trying  to  bring  the  mountain  to  Mahomet,  instead 
of  letting  Mahomet  walk  to  the  mountain  ?  Which  is  easier  to 
do,  to  let  plants  and  animals  migrate  to  a  place  with  a  different 
climate  and  abundance  or  deficiency  of  altered  food,  rather  than 
imagine  the  latter  to  come  to  them  ? 

Migration  is  so  obvious  a  process  that  Darwin  cannot  help 
alluding  to  it,  as  when  he  says : — "  Among  animals  which  unite  for 
each  birth  and  are  highly  locomotive,  doubtful  forms  ranked  by  one 
zoologist  as  a  species  and  by  another  as  a  variety,  can  rarely  be 
found  within  the  same  country,  but  are  common  in  separated  areas."  4 
They  have  not,  therefore,  arisen  at  one  common  spot. 

A  new  climate  and  abundance  of  food  are  often  supplied  by 
domestication  and  cultivation,  and  the  anticipated  results  follow, 
viz.,  variation  ad  libitum,  the  consequences  also  being  often  heredi- 
tary as  they  are  in  nature. 

Acquired  Characters  are  Hereditary  in  Plants. — Dr  Wal- 
lace writes  : — "  Climate  and  Food  undoubtedly  produce  modifications 
in  the  individual,  but  it  has  not  yet  been  proved  that  the  modifications 
are  hereditary.  If  this  could  be  proved  the  whole  discussion  on 
the  heredity  of  acquired  characters  would  be  settled  in  the 
affirmative."  5  But  surely  cultivation  proves  it  every  day  ?  Our 
garden  vegetables  are  all  derived  from  wild  plants,  and  they  come 
true  by  seed. 

1  "Origin,  etc.,"  p.  286.  ■  Natural  Science,  vol.  v.  p.  182.  3  "Origin,  etc.,"  p.  84. 
4  "Origin,  etc.,"  p.  37.        5  " Darwinism,"  p.  489. 


172  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [September 

What  more  do  we  want  to  prove  that  acquired  characters  are 
hereditary  ?  I  do  not  understand  what  he  means  when  he  says : — 
"  In  every  case  these  changes  can  be  interpreted  as  .  .  .  adapta- 
tions or  individual,  non-hereditary  modifications  in  the  case  of 
plants."  1  That  garden  races  are  adaptations  to  their  environment 
is  obvious,  and  to  say  that  they  cannot  be  hereditary  is,  as  it  seems 
to  me,  to  shut  one's  eyes  gratuitously  to  the  most  conspicuous  facts. 
The  "  Student"  Parsnip  was  "fixed"  in  five  years,  i.e.,  from  1847 
to  1852,  having  been  raised  by  Professor  J.  Buckman  from  seed 
of  the  wild  plant,  and  it  is  still  pronounced  to  be  "  the  best  in  the 
trade  " ;  its  acquired  characters  have  been,  therefore,  relatively  fixed 
for  half  a  century,  though  the  plant's  variability  may  never  cease 
to  exist,  because  no  so-called  "  fixed  race "  is  absolutely  stable. 
Hence  we  constantly  hear  of  Mr  A's  improved  race  of  Mr  B's  pea, 
bean,  or  what  not.  Nevertheless,  that  the  typical  garden  form  is 
always  reproduced,  and  that  its  sub-varieties  or  races  come  relatively 
true  by  seed,  is  all  that  is  wanted  to  establish  the  truth  of  acquired 
characters  being  hereditary  in  plants. 

Migration,  essential. — With  regard  to  the  origin  and  fixation 
of  varieties  in  nature  a  closer  observation  shows  that,  as  a  rule, 
contrary  to  the  Darwinian  view,  new  varieties  of  plants  have  not 
arisen  among  the  parent  types,  but  away  from  them.  Thus, 
Sir  J.  D.  Hooker,  who  in  his  knowledge  of  the  geographical  distribu- 
tion of  plants  is  facile  princcjjs,  says  : — "  As  a  general  rule  the  best 
marked  varieties  occur  on  the  confines  of  the  geographical  area  which 
a  species  inhabits."  2  Darwin  also  quotes  A.  de  Candolle's  opinion 
that  "  plants  which  have  very  wide  ranges  generally  present  varieties ; 
and  this  might  have  been  expected  (he  writes),  as  they  are  exposed 
to  diverse  physical  conditions." 3  Precisely  so ;  but  then  this  is 
due  to  migration  together  with  adaptation  to  the  new  physical 
environments  ;  for  the  "  diverse  physical  conditions "  do  not  come 
to  the  plants  where  the  large  populations  have  been  supposed  to 
"row.  It  is  interesting  to  see  that  both  Darwin  and  Dr  Wallace, 
after  asserting  the  importance  of  large  populations  ■  among  which 
new  varieties  are  said  to  arise,  are  compelled  by  facts  to  admit 
precisely  the  contrary.  Thus,  both  Dr  Wallace  and  Darwin  observe 
that  the  struggle  for  existence  will  be  "  most  severe  between  in- 
dividuals of  the  same  species  ;  for  they  frequent  the  same  districts, 
require  the  same  food,  and  are  exposed  to  the  same  dangers."  Such 
is  the  condition  said  to  be  required  for  natural  selection ;  but  now, 
on  the  contrary,  he  tells  us,  "  as  an  effect  of  this  principle  [?]  we 
seldom  find  closely  allied  species  of  animals  or  plants  living  together, 
but  often  in  distinct  though  adjacent  districts  where  the  conditions 

1  Loc.  cit.,  p.  490.  2  "  Introductory  Essay  to  the  Flora  of  Tasmania,"  p.  v. 

:!  "Origin,  etc.,"  p.  43. 


1897]  ORIGIN  OF  SPECIES  AMONG  PLANTS  173 

of  life  are  somewhat  different,"  If  so,  and  this  statement  is  quite 
in  accordance  with  Sir  J.  D.  Hooker's  view  already  quoted,  how 
could  the  varieties  have  arisen  in  the  midst  of  the  plant  type  ? 
Similarly,  Darwin  says  that  mountain  breeds  always  differ  from 
lowland  breeds ;  and  "  a  mountainous  country  would  probably  affect 
the  hind  limbs  from  exercising  them  more,  and  possibly  even  the 
form  of  the  pelvis,"  &c.  What  is  all  this  but  the  formation  of  new 
varietal  structures  by  a  response  to  the  direct  or  definite  action  of 
the  environment  ?  But,  then,  it  is  obvious  from  Darwin's  remarks 
that  the  mountain  breeds  are  not  supposed  to  have  arisen  among 
the  lowland  forms  or  vice  versd ;  just  as  the  submerged  forms  of 
Ranunculus  could  not  have  arisen  among  land  buttercups  or  vice 
versa.  Consequently  Darwin  could  not  shut  his  eyes  to  the  fact 
that  "  isolation  is  an  important  element  in  the  modification  of 
species."  l  Again,  he  says  : — "  Migration  and  isolation  are  necessary 
elements  for  the  formation  of  new  species."  2 

On  the  other  hand,  Dr  Wallace  says : — "  Physical  isolation,  I 
believe  with  Darwin  [?],  to  be  of  comparatively  little  importance, 
and  to  have  very  rarely  been  the  chief  agent  in  modification." 

If  migration  and  isolation,  which  are  only  to  be  secured  on 
the  confines  of  the  geographical  area  of  a  species,  as  Sir  J.  D. 
Hooker  says,  are  so  important,  then  it  becomes  obvious  that  the 
centre  of  the  parent  population  is  not  the  place,  as  a  rule,  to  look 
for  the  origin  of  a  new  variety,  but  as  far  away  from  it  as  possible. 
From  this  it  follows  that  the  less  struggle  for-  existence 
there  be  with  the  parent  type,  the  better  it  is  for  the  origi- 
nation of  new  varieties;  and  it  is  best  of  all  where  there 
is  no  struggle  at  all. 

Dr  Wallace  enquired  of  two  experienced  British  botanists  if 
there  "  are  any  cases  of  well-marked  varieties,  which  occupy  a  con- 
siderable area  to  the  exclusion  of  the  parent  species,  and  do  not  occupy 
any  area,  or  only  a  very  small  one  with  the  type."  3  One  example 
of  a  Rubus  was  given  him ;  but  a  more  important  question,  however, 
as  it  seems  to  me,  would  be  : — Is  a  sub-species  or  variety  usually 
found  within  the  area  occupied  by  a  large  number  of  the  parent 
type  ?  Take,  e.g.,  Hicracium,  a  most  variable  genus ;  of  this  Sir 
J.  D.  Hooker  writes :  — "  Variable  as  the  genus  is,  the  sequence  of 
its  forms  is  so  natural  as  to  have  been  recognised  by  all  botanists. 
This  sequence  represents  to  a  considerable  extent  the  spread  of  the 
forms  in  altitude  and  area  in  the  British  Isles."  4  Now  Hicracium 
is  not  a  genus  with  gregarious  species ;  for  though  the  sub-species 
and  varieties  are  very  many,  the  relative  quantity  of  each  is  not 
particularly  great   anywhere ;  and  thus,   so   far  from  lending  any 

1  "  Origin,  etc.,"  p.  SI.  2  "  Origin,  etc.,"  p.  82. 

3  Loc.  cit,  p.  494.  4    '  Students'  Flora,"  p.  232. 


174  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [September 

countenance  to  Darwin's  idea,  that  a  species  must  have  a  numerous 
population  to  produce  varieties,  the  rule  seems  rather  to  he  that 
these  two  features  do  not  necessarily  coincide  at  all. 

Supposed  Aids  to  Natural  Selection. — In  order  to  secure 
the  survival  of  the  fittest,  i.e.,  a  new  variety  among  the  parent  form, 
it  was  perceived  that  two  additional  and  hypothetical  aids  were 
necessary,  viz.,  (1)  some  degree  of  infertility  with  the  parent,  and 
(2)  a  rapidity  of  adaptation. 

With  regard  to  the  first,  all  experience  goes  to  prove  that  it 
does  not  exist ;  for  when  cultivators  wish  to  fix  a  new  race,  as  of 
cabbage,  &c,  they  are  obliged  to  grow  it  as  far  as  possible  away 
from  the  parent  stock.  Indeed,  considering  how  freely  species  can 
be  hybridised,  the  probability  of  an  offspring  refusing  to  be  crossed 
by  the  same  species  is  very  small  or  nil.  Neither  Darwin  nor  Dr 
Wallace  bring  forward  any  examples  of  infertility  with  the  parent 
among  plants. 

Secondly,  a  rapidity  of  adaptation  is  claimed  hypothetically. 
This  does  often  really  exist,  but  it  is  a  little  uncertain  whether 
these  authors  were  aware  of  it.  For  when  a  plant  finds  itself  in  a 
new  and  markedly  different  environment,  which  strongly  affects  it, 
it  then  grows  by  self-adaptation  in  response  to  the  new  external 
influences  :  as  when  passing  from  water  to  land,  or  vice  versa ;  from 
the  wild  state  to  the  artificial  soil  of  a  garden ;  from  lowlands  to 
alpine  or  subarctic  localities,  &c,  as  I  have  shown  in  "  The  Origin  of 
Plant  Structures." 

The  Persistence  or  non-retention  of  new  varietal 
characters. — To  come  to  what  Dr  Wallace  regarded  as  the 
most  important  point  in  his  paper.  Four  times  does  he  mention 
it,  only  slightly  altering  the  expression,  e.g.,  he  says: — "  No  attempt 
has  been  made  to  show,  even  hypothetically,  how,  through  the 
action  of  known  causes,  such  characters  [useless  ones],  when  they 
do  arise,  can  become  first  extended  to  every  individual  of  a  species, 
and  then  be  totally  obliterated  as  regards  any  portion  of  the  species 
which  may  become  modified  so  as  to  constitute  a.  new  species. 
Useful  characters  thus  strictly  limited  are  the  necessary  and 
logical  results  of  modification  through  survival  of  the  fittest.  No 
agency  has  been  shown  to  exist  capable  of  producing  useless 
characters  similarly  limited." l  As  illustrations  to  meet  Dr  Wal- 
lace's demand,  it  may  be  observed  that  the  races  of  cultivated 
pears  are  spineless ;  yet  they  are  derived  from  the  wild  Pyrus 
communis,  which  has  useless  abortive  branches  as  spines.  Similarly 
is  it  the  case  with  some  varieties  of  plums  derived  from  Prunus 
communis. 

With    regard    to    the    retention    of     injurious    characters,    the 

1  Loc.  cit.,  \\  491. 


1897]  ORIGIN  OF  SPECIES  AMONG  PLANTS  175 

obstruction  to  self-fertilisation  produced  by  the  rostellum  is 
common  in  orchids,  and  generally  occurs  in  all  the  species  of 
any  particular  genus.  Yet  it  is  obliterated  in  PKajus  blumei, 
Chysis  aurea,  species  of  Chrysoglossum,  Avundinia  speciosa,  and  Evict 
flavcscens,  &c,  so  that  these  species  set  plenty  of  good  seed  by  self- 
fertilisation,  whereas  40,000  blossoms  of  Dcndvobiwm  spcciosum  set 
one  pod.  I  have  already  had  occasion  to  allude  to  the  rudimentary 
organs  of  Mercurialis,  Erodium,  &c.,  which  are  retained  in  all  the 
species  alike. 

Is  Dr  Wallace,  therefore,  justified  in  making  the  above  asser- 
tion at  all,  or  in  demanding  that  either  useful  or  useless  characters 
should  be  limited  ?  Why  should  either  one  or  the  other  be 
obliterated  when  a  new  variation  arises  ?  The  fact  that  a  genus, 
which  is  the  result  of  sufficient  variation  in  a  species  (unless  it  be 
monotypic),  does  retain  both  useful  and  useless  characters  in  some, 
many,  or  all  of  its  species,  shows  that  there  are  no  grounds  for  his 
statement.  Natural  selection  may  demand  it,  but  nature  utterly 
refuses  to  be  obedient  to  that  theory. 

Too  great  stress  is  laid  upon  a  necessary  fixity,  as  a  proof  of 
specific  characters,  by  many  writers.  This  is  purely  a  relative 
matter.  Cultivation  has  been  suggested  as  a  test  of  a  species ;  but 
this  is  the  very  best  means  of  inducing  a  wild  plant  to  vary,  as  all 
cultivators  know.  The  fixation  of  any  variation  is  a  matter  of 
time.  About  five  years  may,  perhaps,  be  regarded  as  the  average 
period  under  cultivation  in  "  fixing  "  races :  but  nothing  is  known 
about  wild  varieties.  In  either  case  the  rule  is  that  the  environ- 
ment must  be  constant. 

Indefinite  Variations,  non-existent. — This  is  the  second 
hypothetical  source  of  new  variations  according  to  Darwinians. 

With  regard  to  all  the  offspring  varying  approximately  alike 
and  not  "  indiscriminately  "  (Eomanes)  or  "  indefinitely  "  (Darwin) 
when  subjected  to  changed  conditions  of  life,  I  wish  to  emphasise 
the  fact  most  strongly  that  experiments  show  conclusively  that 
if  seedlings  are  subjected  to  a  markedly  different  environment, 
when  they  grow  up  to  maturity,  the  rule  is,  that  all  that  do 
change,  change  in  precisely  the  same  way.  They  do  not  vary 
indefinitely  among  themselves  ;  so  that  there  is  no  material  here — 
any  more  than  with  "  individual  differences  " — for  natural  selection 
to  act  upon.  Thus,  in  cultivating  the  wild  parsnip  or  carrot,  all 
the  seedlings  that  change,  do  so  by  beginning  to  assume  the  same 
new  characters — viz.,  an  increased  size  with  a  greater  fleshiness  in 
the  root,  larger  dimensions  of  the  leaves,  reduction  of  hair,  &c, 
with  a  corresponding  alteration  in  the  anatomical  structures. 

So,  too,  if  the  seeds  of  an  amphibious  plant  as  Bamtnculus 
heterophyllus  be  sown  in  a  garden  border,  all  grow  absolutely  alike 


176  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [September 

in  adaptation  to  the  aerial  medium.  Numerous  other  illustrations 
could  be  given.1 

I  think  it  must  be  from  not  being  aware  of  the  abundance  of 
evidence  of  this  sort,  that  the  idea  arose  that  all  the  offspring  did 
not  acquire  the  same  characters  when  the  external  conditions  were 
changed. 

Dr  Wallace  doubts  it  because,  he  says,  "  the  argument  is,  that 
the  same  causes  will  always  produce  the  same  or  closely  similar 
results.  But  this  is  only  true  when  the  same  causes  act  upon 
identical  materials  and  under  identical  conditions."2  Dr 
Wallace  is  mistaken  in  supposing  that  nature  pays  any  attention 
to  "  individual  differences  "  which  occur  between  any  number  of 
plants  of  the  same  kind.  It  is  not  a  question  of  argument,  but 
of  facts.  These  differences  are  of  no  moment  whatever  when 
self-adaptation  is  required  to  take  place.  The  external  influences 
cause  all  the  individuals  to  change  alike  in  the  same  direction,  and 
utterly  ignore  the  various  dimensions  among  the  "  individual  differ- 
ences "  described  above.  The  result  is  that  the  same  facies  is  ac- 
quired by  all  the  individuals,  though  a  new  set  of  individual  differences 
may  readily  be  found  among  the  individuals  of  the  new  variety. 

Secondly,  besides  doubting  the  occurrence  of  the  same  definite 
variations  in  the  whole  of  the  offspring  subjected  to  new  but 
similar  external  conditions,  Dr  Wallace  adds : — "  It  must  do  more 
than  this,  for  it  must  produce  a  variation  so  exceptionally  stable 
that  it  constantly  recurs  in  all  the  offspring  of  successive  genera- 
tions, even  though  those  offsprings  are  subjected  to  considerable 
change  of  conditions."  3 

But  the  stability  of  a  species,  I  repeat,  is  a  purely  relative 
matter  and  depends  upon  time.  Some  plants  are  very  plastic, 
others  are  not  so,  some  variations  may  become  very  (but  never 
absolutely)  rigidly  fixed,  while  others  may  refuse  to  be  reproduced 
by  seed  with  any  certainty  at  all.  Not  only  is  this  true  when  the 
plant  is  propagated  by  seed  but  it  is  also  true  for  vegetative  multi- 
plication. Tulips,  &c,  introduced  from  the  East,  though  they  have 
presumably  been  constant  in  form  for  unknown  ages,  yet  often 
become  unrecognisable  in  three  years  though  propagated  by  bulbils 
only  ;  apple  trees,  though  propagated  by  grafts  alone  have  given  rise 
to  numerous  varieties ;  even  different  kinds  of  apples  raised  on 
stocks,  but  grown  in  the  same  States  of  N.  America,  respectively, 
often  bear  fruit  of  approximately  the  same  form.4  On  the  other 
hand  the  Jerusalem  artichoke,  asparagus,  sea-kale  and  celery  oiler 

1  The  reader  is  again  referred  to  "  The  Origin  of  Plant  Structures''  for  further 
details. 

'-'  Loc.  cit.,  p.  488.  :!  hoc.  cit.,  p.  489. 

4  "Hud  Variation  and  Evolution,"  Natural  Science,  vol.  vii.,  p.  103.  An  essay  in 
Mr  Bailey's  work  "The  Survival  of  the  Unlike,"  1896. 


1S97]  ORIGIN  OF  SPECIES  AMONG  PLANTS  177 

but  little  variations  to  select  from.  Of  common  vegetables,  parsnips, 
carrots,  radishes,  Brassica  oleracea,  &c,  have  supplied  numerous 
varieties  which  come  true  by  seed  ;  though  each  may  still  furnish 
an  improved  "  race." 

Similarly,  if  a  useless  character  be  acquired  among  cultivated 
plants,  not  only  may  it  occur  in  every  individual  but  it  may  become 
hereditary  and  relatively  fixed  ;  just  as  in  the  examples  of  wild 
plants  already  mentioned.  Thus,  there  is  no  special  advantage  in 
the  mere  variety  of  colouring  of  flowers  as  of  pansies,  nor  in  double 
flowers,  nor  in  excess  of  neuter  flowers  of  composites,  nor  in  the 
abortive  pedicels  of  the  feather  hyacinth,  &c. 

With  regard  to  the  fixation  of  characters,  therefore,  there  is  no 
absolute  rule  whatever,  nor  can  we  say  why  one  plant  is  so  plastic 
and  another  refractory. 

Nature  recognises  no  "must"  in  her  processes.1 

Darwinism,  an  Unverified  and  Unverifiable  Deduc- 
tion.— It  is  a  common  statement  that  Darwin  placed  the  Doctrine 
of  Evolution  on  a  scientific  basis  when  he  pronounced  the  theory  of 
"  The  Origin  of  Species  by  means  of  Natural  Selection."  It  is  against 
this  statement. that  I  would  venture  to  protest  most  strongly.  To 
take  the  latest  example,  Ludwig  von  Graff  says  : — "  The  selection 
theory  of  the  celebrated  Englishman,  Darwin,  first  based  the  idea 
upon  a  scientific  foundation.  The  obvious  phenomena  of  heredity 
and  of  variability  are  the  foundations  of  his  bold  system,  the  axles 
of  life's  mechanism  ;  and  the  motive  power  of  this  mechanism  is  the 
struggle  of  all  living  things  for  the  preservation  and  procreation  of 
life."2 

Darwin's  theory,  however,  as  stated  in  the  title  of  his  book, 
;<  The  Origin  of  Species  by  means  of  Natural  Selection,"  is  a  pure 
deduction;  and  deductions  (i.e.,  a  priori  reasoning),  though  useful 
as  working  hypotheses  are  not  scientific  or  useless,  until  they 
have  been  verified  by  induction  and  experiments. 

The  theory  was  based  on  two  primary  deductions  ;  out  of  these 
secondary  ones  followed.  They  were,  first,  that  "  Individual  Differ- 
ences "  could  supply  materials  for  natural  selection  to  act  upon; 
secondly,  that  when  offspring  of  any  species  varied  under  the  action 
of  new  conditions  of  life,  they  generally  varied  indefinitely,  so  afford- 
ing fresh  material  for  natural  selection.  It  has  been  shown  that 
both  of  these  fundamental  assumptions  are  groundless. 

As  an  illustration  of  his  deductive  method  of  reasoning,  let  us 
take  the  following  typical  passage  which  states  Darwin's  theory 
clearly  and  concisely : — 

1  Dr  Weismann  says  : — "  Doubt  is  the  parent  of  progress  ;"  yet  in  about  a  page  and  a 
half  of  Nature  (June  11,  1896),  in  an  epitome  of  his  theory,  he  uses  the  word  "  Must" 
fourteen  times  ! 

2  Natural  Science,  vol.  ix.,  p.  193. 

N 


178  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [September 

"  It  may  metaphorically  be  said  that  natural  selection  is  daily 
and  hourly  scrutinising,  throughout  the  world,  the  slightest  varia- 
tions ;  rejecting  those  that  are  bad,  preserving  and  adding  up  all 
that  are  good."  l  This,  as  far  as  the  origin  of  species  is  concerned, 
is  a  pure  assumption  ;  and  what  I  contend  for  is,  that  since  observa- 
tion and  experiment  show  conclusively  that  variations  can  arise 
rapidly  under  one's  very  eyes,  there  is  no  need  to  assume  any  other 
process  whatever  than  the  protoplasmic  response  to  environ- 
ments. Thus,  rhizomes  are  often  recognised  as  being  of  specific  or 
other  diagnostic  value,  but  when  an  aerial  stem  is  made  to  grow 
underground,  its  new  growth  at  once  begins  to  assume  the  charac- 
ters of  an  ordinary  rhizome.  Eoots,  stems  and  leaves  normally 
living  submerged  have  characters  which  are  at  once  more  or  less 
assumed  by  a  terrestrial  plant  if  it  be  made  to  grow  in  water,  and 
vice  versd ;  or  if  a  water  plant  send  a  shoot  into  the  air  the  change 
is  abrupt  at  the  level  of  the  water.  Plants  in  damp  places  are  often 
very  different  as  a  whole  from  those  in  excessively  dry  situations. 
Ee verse  their  positions  and  each  at  once  begins  to  assume  the 
characters  of  the  other  as  soon  as  they  grow  in  response  to  their 
surroundings.  If  lowland  plants  or  their  seeds  be  grown  in 
high  alpine  regions  they  at  once  assume  the  facies  of  normal 
alpine  plants.  The  markedly  peculiar  features  of  desert  plants  at 
once  begin  to  break  clown,  when  a  normally  desert  plant  is  grown 
in  ordinary  soil,  just  as  the  wild  carrot  or  parsnip  may  quickly 
acquire  the  characteristic  features  of  the  cultivated  form. 

If  Darwin  had  fully  realised  the  significance  of  these  and  such 
like  facts,  he  could  hardly  have  continued  the  above  passage  with 
the  following  words : — "  We  see  nothing  of  these  slow  changes  in 
progress,  until  the  hand  of  time  has  marked  the  lapse  of  ages  ;  and 
then  so  imperfect  is  our  view  into  long  past  geological  ages,  that  we 
see  only  that  the  forms  of  life  are  now  different  from  what  they 
formerly  were." 2  That  all  this  is  due  to  natural  selection  is 
simply  an  unverified  deduction. 

Self-adaptation,  by  Response  to  the  Definite  Action  of 
Changed  Conditions  of  Life,  the  True  Origin  of  Species. — 
That  plants  vary  by  self-adaptation  to  a  new  environment  is  proved 
by  inductive  evidence  and  amply  verified  by  experiment. 

Let  me  repeat. — The  struggle  for  life  is  incessant.  Apart  from 
ill-luck,  which  applies  to  all  alike,  the  weaker  in  constitution  are 
often  expunged,  while  the  stronger  survive  and  the  general  dis- 
tribution of  plants  in  time  and  space  is  the  result.  This  however, 
as  Darwin  insisted,  is  a  quite  different  thing  from  the  origin  of 
species. 

The  origin  of  species  is  due,  for  the  most  part,  or  as  a  broad 

1  "  Origin,  otcA"  p.  05.  2  "  Origin,  etc.,"  p.  66. 


1897]  ORIGIN  OF  SPECIES  AMONG  PLANTS  179 

general  rule  :  first,  to  migration  and  isolation  from  the  parent  type, 
with  as  much  freedom  from  the  struggle  for  existence  as  possible  ; 
secondly,  to  self-adaptation  by  the  inherent  power  of  response  in 
living  protoplasm,  excited  by  the  physical  influences  of  the  new 
environment.  The  result  is  for  the  most  part  new  structures  in 
harmony  with  the  new  environment.  If  there  be  a  thousand 
seedlings  of  one  and  the  same  plant  which  germinate  and  grow 
together,  they  will  all  put  on,  more  or  less,  the  same  features  under 
the  same  definite  action  of  the  same  surroundings  ;  though  individual 
differences  will  still  be  found  among  them  as  before. 

Conclusion. — Lastly,  the  answer  to  the  question  which  heads 
this  paper  is  that  natural  selection  plays  no  part  in  originating  new 
varieties,  nor  is  it  required  as  "  means  "  or  an  aid  in  the  origin  of 
species  ;  but  is  all-sufficient  in  the  distribution  of  plants. 

Now  the  above  conclusion  is  practically  admitted  by  Dr 
Wallace  himself,  in  the  following  sentence  : — "  Should  they  [fixed 
varieties  of  plants]  be  found  to  occur  more  frequently  in  other 
countries  [i.e.,  '  Representative  plants,'  which  are  indeed  innumer- 
able] as  varieties  of  birds,  mammals,  and  reptiles,  &c,  occur  in 
separate  areas  in  North  America  —  they  may  be  usually 
explained  as  adaptations  to  very  different  climatic  condi- 
tions, in  which  case  the  distinguishing  characters  will  be 
utilitarian  [or  otherwise]  and  the  local  varieties  will  be  really 
incipient  species."  The  passage  I  have  spaced  represents  pre- 
cisely the  views  expressed  in  this  paper.  Darwin,  too,  admits  the 
possibility  of  the  origin  of  species  without  the  aid  of  natural  selec- 
tion. His  words  are  as  follows  : — "  By  the  term  definite  action,  1 
mean  an  action  of  such  a  nature  that,  when  many  individuals  of 
the  same  variety  are  exposed  during  several  generations  to  any 
change  in  their  physical  conditions  of  life,  all,  or  nearly  all  the 
individuals  are  modified  in  the  same  manner.  A  new  sub-variety 
would  thus  be  produced  without  the  aid  of  natural  selection."  * 

Lastly,  this  was  the  conclusion  of  Mr  Herbert  Spencer,  in  1852, 
seven  years  before  Darwin  and  Dr  Wallace  superadded  natural 
selection  as  an  aid  in  the  origin  of  species.  He  saw  no  necessity 
for  anything  beyond  the  natural  power  of  change  with  adaptation  ; 
and  I  venture  now  to  add  my  own  testimony,  based  upon  upwards 
of  a  quarter  of  a  century's  observations  and  experiments,  which 
have  convinced  me  that  Mr  Spencer  was  right  and  Darwin  was 
wrong.  His  words  are  as  follows : — "  The  supporters  of  the 
development  hypothesis  can  show  .  .  .  that  any  existing  species, 
animal  or  vegetable,  when  placed  under  conditions  different  from 
its  prervious  ones,  immediately  begins  to  undergo  certain  changes  of 
structure    fitting    it    for    the    new    conditions    .    .    .    that    in    the 

1  "Animals  and  Plants  under  Domestication,"  vol.  ii.,  p.  271. 


180  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [September 

successive  generations  these  changes  continue  until  ultimately  the 
new  conditions  become  the  natural  ones.  .  .  .  They  can  show  that 
throughout  all  organic  nature  there  is  at  work  a  modifying, influence 
of  the  kind  they  assign  as  the  causes  of  specific  differences  ;  an 
influence  which,  though  slow  in  its  action,  does  in  time,  if  the 
circumstances  demand  it,  produce  marked  changes."  x 

All,  therefore,  I  ask  of  my  readers  is  to  weigh  well  the  evidence 
that  has  been  again  of  late  years  brought  forward  in  favour  of 
adaptation  in  lieu  of  natural  selection  as  the  means  by  which 
varieties  originate ;  and  not  to  be  biassed  by,  it  may  be,  many 
years  of  conviction  that  Darwinism  was  all-sufficient.  It  is  solely 
a  question  of  evidence,  and  as  the  doctrine  of  evolution  ultimately 
broke  down  men's  faith  in  Creation  by  "  Fiats "  and  the 
Argument  of  Design,  so  it  is  hoped  that  before  this  century  closes, 
it  will  be  seen  that  Darwin's  deduction  of  "  The  Origin  of  Species 
by  Means  of  Natural  Selection  "  was  a  most  unfortunate  one,  as  it 
is  quite  incapable  of  verification ;  while  the  conclusion  of  Mr 
Herbert  Spencer  has  been  abundantly  verified,  both  by  inductive 
evidence  and  experimental  proof.  Geokge  Henslow. 


i  i< 


Essay  on  The  Development  Hypothesis,"  1852. 


575.8  181 


III 

Reproductive  Divergence  :  An  Additional  Factor 

in  Evolution 

SOME  ten  years  ago  the  late  G.  J.  Komanes  propounded  his  theory 
of  Physiological  Selection,1  which  was  founded  on  the  fact  that 
certain  individuals  of  a  species,  though  fertile  with  some,  may  be 
perfectly  sterile  with  other  individuals.  Supposing  such  incom- 
patibility to  run  through  a  whole  race,  then  these  varieties, 
separated  by  a  physiological  barrier  from  the  rest  of  the  members 
of  the  species,  would  be  preserved,  and  might  vary  independently, 
and  so  become  gradually  split  off  from  the  parent  species  in  respect 
of  other  characteristics  as  well. 

This  theory  has  not  been  generally  received,  and  Wallace,  in 
particular,  has  demonstrated 2  very  clearly  that  in  the  form  -  pro- 
pounded by  its  author  the  theory  cannot  stand.  Nevertheless,  the 
theory  served  to  draw  attention  to  the  importance  of  variations  in 
the  reproductive  powers  of  organisms  as  a  factor  in  evolution,  and 
to  emphasise  certain  unexplained  difficulties  in  the  theory  of  natural 
selection,  more  especially  with  reference  to  the  sterility  of  first 
crosses  between  species,  coupled  with  the  fertility  of  those  between 
varieties,  the  swamping  effects  of  intercrossing,  and  the  frequent 
inutility  of  specific  characters. 

In  the  present  paper  I  wish  to  bring  forward  a  theory  which  is 
also  concerned  with  variations  in  the  reproductive  powers  of  organ- 
isms as  an  important  factor  in  evolution,  but  which  is  essentially 
different  from  that  propounded  by  Eomanes.  This  theory  may  be 
enunciated  as  follows.  Supposing  that  among  the  members  of 
any  species,  those  individuals,  more  alike,  in  respect  of 
any  characteristic,  such  as  colour,  form  or  size,  are  slightly 
more  fertile  inter  se  than  less  similar  individuals,  it 
necessarily  follows  that  in  the  course  of  succeeding 
generations  the  members  of  this  species  will  diverge  more 
and  more  in  respect  of  the  characteristic  in  question, 
whereby  ultimately  the  original  species  may  be  split  up 
into  two  or  more  fresh  species. 

This  principle  I  have  ventured  to  call  "  Reproductive  Diverg- 
ence."    It  is  best  illustrated  by  a  concrete   example.      Supposing 

1  Journ.  Linn.  Soc.  (Zool.),  vol.  xix.,  p.  337,  1886. 

2  "Darwinism,"  p.  180. 


182  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [September 

that  in  the  Lepidopterous  Ithania  urolina,  an  insect  found  in  the 
Amazon  valley,  small  individuals  were  slightly  more  fertile  with 
other  small  individuals  than  with  larger  individuals,  whilst  these 
were  also  more  fertile  inter  se,  then  it  would  follow  that  fewer 
individuals  of  intermediate  size  would  be  produced,  and  in  course  of 
time  the  species  would  be  split  up  into  a  small  and  a  large  variety. 
These  varieties  would  continue  to  diverge  as  long  as  the  principle 
of  "  reproductive  divergence  "  was  acting,  till  at  length  they  might 
become  differentiated  into  two  mutually  sterile  species.  Supposing, 
on  the  other  hand,  this  variation  in  fertility  were  correlated  with 
slight  differences  of  colour,  then  in  course  of  time  varieties  differing 
in  respect  of  colour  would  be  produced,  or  if  it  were  correlated  with 
both  size  and  colour,  varieties  differing  in  respect  of  both  charac- 
teristics might  be  produced.  As  a  matter  of  fact,  this  insect  does 
actually  occur  as  four  distinct  varieties,  differing  in  colour,  form  and 
size,1  though  whether  in  consequence  of  the  operation  of  repro- 
ductive divergence,  it  is  of  course  impossible  to  say. 

It  will  be  observed  that  the  theory  enunciated  is  made  up  of 
two  parts,  the  first  of  which  can  only  be  verified  by  experiment, 
whilst  the  second  is  the  statement  of  a  fact,  which  is  capable  of 
mathematical  demonstration.     This  we  will  now  proceed  to  afford. 

Let  a  certain  number  of  individuals  of  a  species,  say  900  males 
and  900  females,  be  divided  up  into  three  groups,  according  to  their 
size.  Let  there  be  300  small  males,  #,300  medium  sized  ones,  M, 
and  300  large  ones,  L.  Let  the  900  females  be  similarly  divided 
up  into  the  three  groups,  s,  m  and  I.  In  order  to  maintain  the 
number  of  individuals  constant  in  each  generation,  let  it  be  granted 
that  any  number  of  males  and  females  breeding  together  give  rise 
to  the  same  number  of  males  and  females.  Then  if  these  900 
males  and  females  be  allowed  to  breed  together,  on  an  average  100 
small  males,  S,  will  breed  with  100  small  females,  s,  and  100  male 
and  female  offspring,  Ss,  will  arise.  Similarly  also  there  will  be 
100  male  and  female  offspring,  Sm,  and  100  SI.  Again,  with 
reference  to  the  medium  sized  males,  there  will  be  100  male  and 
female,  Ms,  Mm,  and  Ml  offspring ;  and  with  reference  to  the  large 
sized  males,  100  male  and  female,  Ls,  Lm  and  LI  offspring.  Now 
let  it  be  granted  that  the  offspring  SI  and  Ls  are  of  the  same  size 
as  Mm,  and  that  Sm  and  Lm  are  respectively  of  the  same  size  as 
Ms  and  Ml.  Then  as  the  result  of  the  chance  breeding  of  the  900 
males  and  females,  we  shall  have  the  following  numbers  of  individuals 
of  each  sex  formed  : — 

100  Ss,  200  Sm,  300  Mm,  200  Ml,  100  LI. 

Now  let  us  suppose  that  the  comparative  fertility  of  the  various 
sized  individuals  is  slightly  changed,  so  that  the  principle  of  "  repro- 
1  H.  W.  Bates,  Trans.  Linn.  Soc,  1862,  p.  545. 


1897]  REPRODUCTIVE  DIVERGENCE  183 

ductive  divergence"  may  come  into  operation.  Let  100  individuals 
breeding  with  similar  sized  individuals,  give  birth  to  120  offspring 
of  either  sex  instead  of  100,  whilst  100  individuals  breeding  with 
moderately  smaller  or  larger  individuals  (i.e.,  M  and  m  breeding  with 
s  and  S  or  I  and  L)  give  birth  to,  on  an  average,  only  95  offspring, 
and  100  individuals  breeding  with  considerably  smaller  or  larger 
individuals  (i.e.,  S  or  L  breeding  with  /  or  s)  give  birth  to  only  80 
offspring  of  either  sex.  Then  it  will  be  found  that  the  900  males 
and  females  breeding  together  will  give  birth  to  the  following : — 
120  Ss,  190  Sm,  280  Mm,  190  Ml,  120  LI, 

That  is  to  say,  whilst  the  largest  and  smallest  individuals  have 
increased  in  numbers  by  20  per  cent.,  the  medium  sized  ones  have 
decreased  by  7  per  cent,  and  the  ones  intermediate  between  these 
by  5  per  cent.  The  fact  that  the  medium  sized  individuals  have 
decreased  in  number,  in  spite  of  the  100  M and  m  individuals  which 
breed  together  having  produced  120  Mm,  offspring,  is  of  course  due  to 
the  fact  that  only  160  Mm  individuals  are  produced  by  the  crossing 
of  the  100  S  and  100  L  individuals  with  the  100  /  and  s. 

In  a  similar  manner,  in  succeeding  generations,  the  numbers  of 
individuals  intermediate  in  size  will  gradually  become  smaller  and 
smaller,  whilst  those  of  the  extreme  ones  will  increase.  But,  it 
may  be  said,  even  then  the  two  varieties  thus  formed  will  not 
differ  in  size  to  a  greater  extent  than  the  extreme  individuals  in  the 
original  1800  taken.  This  is  not  the  case.  Thus  supposing  the 
three  groups  of  individuals  were  respectively  on  an  average  65'5, 
68*5  and  71 '5  inches  in  length,  the  extremes  among  the  small 
individuals  being  64  and  67  inches,  those  amongst  the  medium  67 
and  70  inches,  and  those  among  the  large  70  and  73  inches. 
Then  suppose  that  by  the  principle  of  reproductive  divergence  the 
individuals  were  separated  into  two  groups  "of  an  average  of  64  and 
73  inches  in  length.  Then  it  follows  that  these  groups  would 
(approximately)  contain  individuals  varying  between  6 2 '5  and  65*5 
inches,  and  71'5  and  74*5  inches  respectively.  That  is  to  say, 
considerably  smaller  and  considerably  larger  individuals  would  be 
formed  than  were  originally  present.  Also  if  the  principle  of 
reproductive  divergence  continues  to  act  amongst  the  two  varieties 
of  the  original  species  formed,  the  individuals  will  continue  diverg- 
ing more  and  more  in  respect  of  this  characteristic,  with  which  the 
reproductive  power  of  the  organism  is  correlated.  Also,  if  it  be 
granted,  that  on  an  average,  the  more  widely  any  two  individuals 
differ  in  size,  the  greater  is  the  relative  degree  of  sterility  between 
them,  it  follows  that  in  course  of  time  the  individuals  of  the  two 
varieties  will  become  mutually  sterile  :  or  in  other  words,  that  from 
the  original  species  two  new  species  will  have  arisen. 

Having  demonstrated  the  correctness  of  the  second  part  of  the 


184  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [September 

hypothesis  enunciated,  it  remains  to  bring  forward  experimental 
evidence  of  the  validity  of  the  first  part — i.e.,  it  is  necessary  to 
prove  that  in  some  cases  more  closely  similar  individuals  of  a  species 
show  greater  mutual  fertility  than  less  similar ;  in  other  words,  that 
there  may  be  a  partial  sterility  between  varieties.  On  this  point 
Darwin  has  collected  a  considerable  amount  of  evidence  in  his 
"  Variation  of  Animals  and  Plants  under  Domestication."  x  A  few 
of  the  cases  mentioned  there  may  be  now  cited.  Thus  Gartner 
found  that  a  variety  of  dwarf  maize,  bearing  yellow  seed,  showed  a 
considerably  diminished  fertility  with  a  tall  maize  having  red  seed, 
though  both  varieties  were  perfectly  fertile  when  crossed  inter  se. 
Again,  in  the  genus  Verbascum,  numerous  experiments  were  made  by 
Gartner  with  the  white  and  yellow  varieties  of  V.  lychnitis  and  V. 
blattaria,  he  finding  that  crosses  between  similarly  coloured  flowers 
yielded  more  seed  than  those  between  dissimilarly  coloured  flowers. 
These  experiments  have  been  repeated  and  extended  by  Scott  with 
confirmatory  results.  Again,  Girou  de  Buzareingues  crossed  three 
varieties  of  the  gourd,  and  concluded  that  their  mutual  fertilisation 
is  less  easy  in  proportion  to  the  difference  which  they  present. 
Still  again,  the  blue  and  red  varieties  of  pimpernel,  which  are  con- 
sidered by  most  botanists  as  varieties,  were  found  by  Gartner  to  be 
quite  sterile  when  crossed. 

With  regard  to  members  of  the  animal  kingdom,  there  is  very  little 
evidence.  Such  as  there  is,  is  related  only  to  domesticated  animals, 
and  can  be  at  once  objected  to  on  the  ground  that  it  merely  shows 
that  the  animals  in  question  are  descended  from  two  or  more  dis- 
tinct species.  Thus  Youatt 2  states  that  longhorn  and  shorthorn 
cattle,  when  crossed,  show  a  diminished  fertility.  This  statement 
has,  however,  been  denied  by  Wilkinson. 

The  evidence  determinable  from  certain  anthropological  data  is, 
on  the  other  hand,  of  more  value.  Thus  Professor  Broca  has  brought 
forward  evidence  3  that  some  races  of  man  show  diminished  fertility 
together.  Again,  according  to  statistics  collected  in  Prussia  from 
1875  to  1890,  it  was  found  that  Protestants,  Catholics  and  Jews, 
marrying  among  themselves,  had,  on  an  average,  respectively  4'35, 
5-24  and  4*21  children.  When,  however,  the  husband  was  a  Jew 
and  the  wife  a  Protestant  or  Catholic,  the  numbers  of  children  were 
only  1*58  and  1*38  respectively;  and  when  the  wife  was  a  Jewess 
and  the  husband  a  Protestant  or  Catholic,  only  1*78  and  1*66  re- 
spectively. Whether  this  apparent  partial  sterility  was  due  to 
differences  of  race  or  to  social  reasons  it  was  impossible  to  say.4 
Still  again,  from  the  natality  tables  of  Korosi,6  which  are  calculated 

1  2nd  ed.,  vol.  ii.  p.  82.  s  "  Cattle,"  p.  202. 

3  "  On  the  Phenomena  of  Hybridity  in  the  Genus  Homo."     1864. 

4  Quoted  from  Mayo  Smith's  "Statistics  of  Sociology,"  p.  115. 

5  "  Phil.  Trans.,"  1895,  B.  781. 


1397]  REPRODUCTIVE  DIVERGENCE  185 

from  the  marriage  statistics  of  81,000  couples  in  Buda-Pesth,  it  is 
possible  to  obtain  evidence  supporting  our  theory.  Thus  from  these 
figures  one  may  see  that  parents  of  similar  ages  are  more  fertile  inter  se 
than  parents  of  dissimilar  ages.  With  very  young  mothers  the  most 
fertile  fathers  are,  on  an  average,  from  three  to  six  years  in  advance 
as  to  age ;  but  with  increasing  years  of  the  mothers  the  ages  of  the 
fathers  become  less  and  less  in  excess,  till  at  about  thirty  years  of  age 
they  coincide.  At  greater  ages  they  gradually  become  slightly  in  defect. 
Though  this  greater  mutual  fertility  of  individuals  like  in  respect  of 
age  can  be  of  no  influence  in  modifying  the  species,  or  splitting  it 
up  into  varieties,  yet  it  gives  us  reasonable  ground  to  suppose  that 
the  fertility  may  also  be  found  on  examination  to  be  greater  with 
individuals  similar  in  respect  of  some  other  characteristic.  In  such 
a  case  there  would  be  a  tendency  for  two  or  more  varieties  to  be 
formed,  unless  there  were  some  other  agency  counteracting  it. 

It  will  be  seen  that  the  evidence  adduced  in  favour  of  a  partial 
sterility  sometimes  existing  between  varieties  of  a  species  is,  in  the 
case  of  animals  at  least,  very  meagre.  The  reason  of  this  is  not  far 
to  seek.  Thus  wild  animals,  when  placed  in  confinement,  will  not, 
in  the  majority  of  cases,  breed  at  all.  Domesticated  animals,  on  the 
other  hand,  do  not  afford  evidence  of  much  value,  for  the  reason 
given  above.  Also,  it  is  generally  held  that  domestication  of  itself 
tends  to  increase  fertility,  and  so  would  overcome  any  tendency  to 
sterility  of  varieties. 

In  order  to  obtain  evidence  as  to  the  existence  of-  a  diminished 
fertility  between  varieties,  I  have  made  a  considerable  number  of 
observations  on  the  effects  of  crossing  the  various  colour  varieties 
of  the  sea  urchins,  Sphaerechimbs  gramdaris  and  Strongyloccntrotus 
lividus,  and  have  found  that  from  a  given  number  of  ova  the  num- 
ber of  blastulae  and  the  number  of  larvae  subsequently  produced 
are  appreciably  smaller  for  crosses  of  dissimilar  colour  varieties  than 
for  those  of  similar  ones.  Also,  the  larvae  produced  are,  on  an  aver- 
age, about  5  per  cent,  smaller.  As,  however,  it  will  be  necessary 
to  repeat  these  observations  a  large  number  of  times  before  the 
proof  of  such  a  partial  sterility  can  be  considered  quite  unexception- 
able, and  as  moreover  I  hope  to  be  able  to  make  similar  series  of 
observations  among  other  classes  of  the  Animal  Kingdom,  it  would 
be  premature  at  this  point  to  refer  to  these  investigations  at  any 
greater  length. 

It  should  be  borne  in  mind  that  the  theory  of  Reproductive 
Divergence  does  not  require  that  there  should  be  a  partial  sterility 
between  the  varieties  of  species  in  all  cases,  or  in  even  the  majority 
of  cases.  It  merely  premises  that  such  sterility  does  exist  in  cer- 
tain instances,  and  that  in  these  the  members  of  the  species  will 
gradually  become  more  and  more  divergent  in  respect  of  one  or  more 


186  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [September 

characteristics,  unless  of  course  other  causes  are  at  work  counter- 
acting its  influence.  Probably  in  the  majority  of  cases,  in  most 
stable  species  in  fact,  there  is  no  such  variability  of  fertility  between 
slightly  differing  individuals,  and  hence  there  is,  from  this  cause,  no 
tendency  to  the  formation  of  more  or  less  distinct  varieties.  Very 
probably,  however,  there  is  a  latent  possibility  of  such  a  variability  of 
reproductive  power  arising  in  almost  any  species,  when  for  instance 
some  of  its  members  are  exposed  to  fresh  environmental  conditions, 
in  consequence  of  migration  or  change  of  climate.  If  this  is  so, 
then  a  species  will  tend  to  split  up  into  varieties  just  at  the  most 
opportune  moment,  the  varieties  thus  formed  becoming  by  the  action 
of  Natural  Selection  gradually  more  and  more  adapted  to  their  sur- 
roundings, and  so  fresh  species  produced.  That  change  of  environ- 
mental conditions  has  a  very  great  influence  on  the  reproductive 
powers  of  both  animals  and  plants  is  a  well-known  fact,  and  one  on 
which  Darwin  has  collected  much  valuable  evidence.1 

It  now  remains  to  be  demonstrated  how  the  theory  of  reproduc- 
tive divergence  can  successfully  account  for  some  of  the  chief  objec- 
tions which  have  been  brought  against  the  theory  of  Natural  Selec- 
tion, objections  indeed  which  have  been  of  considerable  weight  in 
deciding  many  scientists  against  the  doctrine  of  the  all-sufficiency  of 
Natural  Selection  as  the  cause  of  Evolution. 

The  fact  of  the  very  general  infertility  of  crosses  between  species 
and  their  hybrid  offspring,  coupled  with  that  of  the  fertility  of 
crosses  between  varieties,  and  of  their  mongrel  offspring,  was  recog- 
nised by  Darwin  as  a  formidable  objection.  Though  this  distinction 
between  species  and  varieties  is  now  recognised  as  not  of  such  uni- 
versality as  it  was  formerly  believed  to  be,  yet  it  is  still  admitted  to 
be  a  difficulty  hitherto  by  no  means  adequately  accounted  for.  The 
theory  of  reproductive  divergence  offers  a  most  satisfactory  and  con- 
vincing explanation.  Thus  according  to  it,  as  we  have  seen,  varieties 
and  ultimately  new  species  have,  in  many  cases  at  least,  been  formed 
by  the  operation  of  a  slight  and  accumulating  sterility  between 
unlike  individuals,  whereby  two  or  more  groups  of  individuals  be- 
come more  and  more  segregated,  and  so  capable  of  undergoing  inde- 
pendent variation.  This  divergence  of  species  takes  place  quite 
independently  of  Natural  Selection,  but  this  principle  can  always  be 
exerting  its  action  at  the  same  time,  whereby  the  new  or  modified 
characteristics  produced  can,  if  useful  to  the  species,  be  accumulated 
and  rendered  better  adapted  to  the  environmental  conditions. 
Whether  the  very  general  sterility  of  crosses  between  species  is 
due  originally  in  most  or  in  all  cases  to  reproductive  divergence,  or 
whether  it  came  into  operation  but  seldom,  it  is  not  as  yet  possible 
to  say.     If  extended  series  of  experiments  show  that  it  is  in  fairly 

1  "  Variation  of  Animals  and  Plants  nnder  Domestication,"  vol.  ii.,  pp.  130-149. 


1897]  REPRODUCTIVE  DIVERGENCE  187 

frequent  operation  in  those  species  having  a  tendency  to  split  up 
into  varieties,  it  may  be  concluded  that  it  was,  and  is,  an  extremely 
important  factor  in  the  production  of  sterility  of  crosses  between 
species.  Thus,  as  has  already  been  mentioned,  it  is  not  supposed 
that  reproductive  divergence  comes  into  effect  in  fixed  and  stable 
species,  but  only  in  those  which,  probably  in  consequence  of  changes 
of  conditions  of  environment,  are  in  the  course  of  splitting  up  into 
varieties  and  new  species. 

Connected  with  the  fact  of  the  general  mutual  fertility  of  varie- 
ties, is  that  of  the  swamping  effects  of  intercrossing.  Thus  if 
varieties  are  perfectly  fertile  with  the  parent  form,  it  is  difficult  to 
see  how  they  can  ever  establish  themselves  as  incipient  species, 
unless  they  become  separated  from  the  parent  form  by  a  geographi- 
cal or  other  barrier.  If,  however,  these  varieties  have  arisen  in 
consequence  of  the  operation  of  reproductive  divergence,  it  is  obvious 
that  they  can  preserve  their  characteristics  unobliterated,  and  con- 
tinue to  exist  in  the  same  region  as  the  parent  form. 

One  of  the  most  important  objections  to  the  doctrine  of  the  all- 
sufficiency  of  Natural  Selection  as  a  cause  of  evolution,  is  that  of 
the  very  frequent  inutility  of  specific  characters.  Some  naturalists, 
especially  Wallace,  are  inclined  to  maintain  that  all  specific  charac- 
ters are  of  use,  and  that  it  is  only  due  to  our  ignorance  that  they 
appear  to  us  useless.  It  is  a  more  generally  received  opinion,  on 
the  other  hand,  that  these  characters  can  frequently  be  of  no  useful 
purpose  to  the  organism,  and  must  therefore  have  originated  by  some 
other  means  than  Natural  Selection.  Darwin  himself  was  fully 
alive  to  this  objection,  and  considered  that  such  useless  specific 
characters  might  owe  their  origin  to  the  correlation  of  organs,  or  to 
the  laws  of  growth,  and  to  so-called  spontaneous  variability.1  These 
seem  but  very  inefficient  causes  for  such  frequently  occurring  effects, 
and  hence  there  is  a  strong  prima  facie  evidence  that  some  other 
principle  is  at  work.  The  principle  of  reproductive  divergence  offers 
a  satisfactory  solution  of  the  problem.  Thus,  as  we  have  seen,  by 
means  of  it  species  are  caused  to  diverge  in  respect  of  one  or  more 
characteristics,  and  so  fresh  or  altered  characteristics  can  be  originated 
without  the  influence  of  Natural  Selection.  To  take  a  concrete  in- 
stance, one  mentioned  by  Bateson.2  The  commonest  forms  of  lady- 
birds are  the  small  Coccinella  dcccmpunctata,  and  the  larger  C. 
scptempundata.  The  small  insect  is  very  variable  in  colour  and 
the  pattern  of  its  colours,  whilst  the  large  is  almost  absolutely  con- 
stant in  these  respects.  This  difference  in  specific  characters  may 
have  originated  by  a  common  parent  form  having  had  its  colour 
marking,  and  also  the  size  of  the  individuals  to  a  slight  extent  corre- 

1  "Origin  of  Species,"  6tli  ed.,  p.  171. 

-  "  Materials  for  the  Study  of  Variation,"  p.  572. 


188  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [September 

lated  with  reproductive  power.  After  the  splitting  up  of  this  parent 
form  into  a  large  and  a  small  species,  in  each  of  which  the  colour 
marking  was  invariable,  the  variations  in  fertility  in  the  larger  form, 
as  correlated  with  colour  marking,  may  have  ceased,  owing  perhaps 
to  the  conditions  of  environment  having  changed  from  a  variable  to 
a  more  constant  state,  and  the  species  would  now  become  constant 
in  this  respect.  The  smaller  form,  on  the  other  hand,  may  still  be 
in  the  course  of  splitting  up  into  two  or  more  other  species,  differing 
in  respect  of  colour  marking,  and  maybe,  of  other  characteristics. 

Another  not  fully  explained  question  with  regard  to  the  origin 
of  species  is  that  of  the  divergence  of  character.  Why  is  it  that 
in  the  course  of  evolution,  species  have  widened  out  into  diverse 
branches,  and  have  not  continued  in  merely  linear  series  ?  This 
question  of  divergence  has  been  examined  somewhat  fully  by 
Gulick.1  Darwin  seeks  to  answer  the  question  "  from  the  simple 
circumstance  that  the  more  diversified  the  descendants  from  any 
one  species  become  in  structure,  constitution,  and  habits,  by  so 
much  will  they  be  better  enabled  to  seize  on  many  and  widely 
diversified  places  in  the  economy  of  nature,  and  so  be  enabled  to 
increase  in  numbers."  2  As  Komanes  points  out,3  this  argument  is, 
however,  assailable  in  one  particular,  i.e.,  it  ignores  the  fact  of  the 
swamping  effects  of  intercrossing.  Thus,  in  Darwin's  own  words, 
it  is  where  specific  forms  "  jostle  each  other  most  closely  "  in  an 
overstocked  area  that  Natural  Selection  will  be  enabled  to  act  most 
favourably  on  any  members  which  may  depart  from  the  common 
type.  Now,  any  varieties  formed  under  these  conditions  by  the 
splitting  up  of  a  species  will  be  almost  inevitably  swamped  by 
their  mutual  intercrossing,  unless  there  be  some  degree  of  sterility 
between  them.  Under  these  conditions,  therefore,  reproductive 
divergence  can  act  at  a  great  advantage,  as  not  only  can  it 
originate  varieties,  but  by  the  mere  fact  of  so  doing  it  ensures 
these  varieties  not  being  eliminated  by  the  swamping  effects  of 
their  mutual  intercrossing. 

It  is  unnecessary  on  this  occasion  to  show  how  the  theory  of 
reproductive  divergence  may  be  applied  to  the  other  questions  anil 
difficulties  connected  with  the  theory  of  Natural  Selection  as  an 
explanation  of  the  mechanism  of  the  origin  of  species.  Suffice  it 
to  say  that  to  some  points  in  connection  with  Geographical  Distri- 
bution, with  the  origin  of  rudimentary  organs  and  other  questions, 
it  offers  most  material  aid.  The  objections  to  the  theory  itself,  as 
far  as  they  present  themselves  to  me,  seem  to  be  but  few,  and  of 
but  little  weight.  One  of  the  most  obvious  is  the  frequently  made 
statement,  that  crosses  between   varieties  generally  produce    indi- 

1  Jourv.  Linn.  Roc.  (Zool.),  vol.  xx.,  p.  189. 

2  "  The  Origin  of  Species,"  p.  87.  3  Loc.  cit.,  p.  385. 


1897]  REPRODUCTIVE  DIVERGENCE  189 

victuals  of  greater  vigour  and  fitness  than  the  parents.  As  far  as  I 
am  aware,  there  is  no  evidence  to  show  that  this  greater  vigour  is 
the  result  of  the  differences  of  morphological  form,  but  rather  that 
it  is  due  to  the  individuals  being  descended  from  different  stocks, 
whereby  the  evil  effects  of  in-and-in  breeding  are  avoided,  or  to 
being  exposed  to  differences  of  environmental  conditions,  whereby 
they  may  perhaps  be  rendered  physiologically  unlike  individuals 
to  a  slight  degree,  rather  than  morphologically  unlike.  That  mere 
exposure  to  differences  of  environmental  conditions  may  be  sufficient 
to  give  rise  to  a  vigorous  race  even  when  this  is  propagated  by  the 
closest  in-and-in  breeding,  is  shown  by  the  case  of  the  rabbits  on 
the  Island  of  Porto  Santo,  all  of  which  are  descended  from  a  single 
pregnant  individual. 

Another  objection  which  might  be  raised  is,  that  in  the  case  of 
both  plants  and  animals  it  has  frequently  been  found  that  varieties 
showing  considerable  differences  of  external  form  are  perfectly 
fertile  inter  sc.  Even  if  this  is  the  case,  it  is  no  argument  against 
the  theory  of  reproductive  divergence,  for  it  was  specially  men- 
tioned that  this  is  not  supposed  to  be  invariably  in  operation  when 
a  species  is  in  course  of  splitting  up  into  varieties.  At  the  same 
time,  it  may  reasonably  be  doubted  whether  this  statement  as  to 
the  perfect  fertility  of  varieties  is  a  fact,  because  a  very  slight 
degree  of  sterility  would  easily  escape  notice  unless  extensive  series 
of  breeding  experiments  were  made,  and  careful  records  kept. 

H.  M.  Vernon. 


568  190  [September 


IV 
On  the  Restoration  of  some  Extinct  Reptiles 

THE  exhibition  of  large  diagrams  in  museum  cases  has  met  with 
the  disapproval  of  many  who  are  in  a  position  to  give  an 
authoritative  opinion  ;  but,  by  way  of  justification  of  such  a  practice, 
it  may  be  pointed  out  that  it  frequently  happens  in  a  museum 
that,  since  it  is  only  possible  in  rare  instances  to  have  cases 
specially  made  to  accommodate  definite  series  of  specimens,  spaces 
will  occur  which  are  a  source  of  much  trouble  to  the  curators ;  and 
diagrams,  from  their  elasticity  of  size,  can  always  be  relied  upon 
to  fill  what  must  otherwise  be  left  blank.  It  is  just  such  a 
difficulty  that  has  to  be  confronted  in  planning  out  some  of  the 
cases  at  the  Natural  History  Museum.  The  wall-cases,  for  instance, 
on  the  south  side  of  the  third  Bay  on  the  left-hand  side  of  the 
Entrance  Hall  are  devoted  to  the  elucidation  of  the  more  important 
features  which  are  made  use  of  in  the  classification  of  reptiles,  and 
contain  stuffed  specimens,  casts,  and  skeletons,  articulated  and 
disarticulated,  of  representative  members  of  each  order.  But  the 
cases  are  ten  feet  in  height,  and  the  upper  compartments  are  too 
far  removed  from  the  eye  of  the  observer,  and  too  badly  lighted,  to 
admit  of  the  recognition  of  much  detail  in  the  specimens  exhibited 
there.  The  framework  of  the  back  of  the  case,  also,  is  too  slight 
to  bear  heavy  specimens,  and  it  is  here,  if  anywhere,  that  the 
exhibition  of  wall-diagrams  is  justified. 

As  complete  skeletons  of  extinct  reptiles  of  such  a  size  as  to 
fit  conveniently  into  these  wall -cases  without  crowding  out  the 
recent  members  of  the  class,  or  being  lost  among  them  by  reason 
of  their  diminutive  size,  are  almost  impossible  to  obtain  ;  and  as 
the  disjointed  parts  of  the  skeleton  of  these  extinct  forms  are 
efficiently  represented  either  by  actual  specimens  or  by  casts  in 
the  table-case,  it  was,  when  recently  planning  out  this  wall-case, 
considered  sufficient  for  the  purposes  of  the  Index  Collection  to 
represent  the  Ornithosauria,  the  Ichthyopterygia,  the  Sauropterygia, 
and  the  Anomodontia  by  bold  diagrams  of  the  whole  skeleton  of 
one  selected  species  of  each,  drawn  to  such  a  size  as  to  fill  the 
four  top  spaces.  The  diagrams,  which  have  now  been  completed 
and  are  exhibited  in  the  cases,  measure  about  27  inches  in 
height,   and    41    inches    in    breadth.      They   are   bold    outline    dia- 


1897] 


RESTORATION  OF  EXTINCT  REPTILES 


191 


grams,  in  black  lines  on  a  white  ground,  executed  by  Miss  G.  M. 
Woodward  with  the  artistic  skill  and  excellence  of  technique  which 
invariably  characterise  her  work. 

The  species  chosen  to  represent  the  Order  Ornithosauria  is 
Dimorphodon  macronyx,  from  the  Lower  Lias  of  Lyme  Eegis  (Fig  1). 
Owen's  well-known  restoration  of  this  species  ("  Liassic  Eeptilia," 
Mm.  Pal  Soc,  1870,  pi.  20.,  and  "Hist.  Brit.  Foss.  Rept.,"  1  849-84, 
vol.  iv.,  pi.  17),  naturally  formed  the  basis  of  the  diagram,  but 
the  shapes  and  proportions  of  the  bones  were  taken  from  the 
actual  specimens,  of  which  the  Geological  Department  of  the 
museum  can  boast  a  good  many.1  The  correctness  of  Owen's 
restoration  of  the  pelvis  was  severely  criticised  by  Seeley  in  1891 


Fig.  1.  Dimorphodon  macronyx,  from  the  Lower  Lias  of  Lyme  Regis,     (x'). 

(Ann.  and  Mag.  Nat,  Hist.,  ser.  G,  vol.  vii.,  pp.  235-255),  and 
recourse  was  had  to  figures  11  and  13  of  this  paper  when  drawing 
the  pelvic  region  of  the  skeleton.  The  pteroid  bone,  or  backwardly 
directed  metacarpal  of  the  rudimentary  thumb,  which  is  incorrectly 
shown  on  the  ulnar  side  of  the  limb  in  Owen's  figure,  was  in- 
troduced from  the  specimen  (E.  1034)  in  the  Geological  Gallery, 
and  the  details  of  the  caudal  vertebrae  from  specimen  (41346), 
figured  by  Owen  in  the  "  Liassic  Eeptilia  "  (pi.  19,  fig.  4).  Since  the 
back  part  of  the  skull  is  crushed  in  the  Natural  History  Museum 
specimens  of  Dimorphodon,  the  outlines  of  the  quadrate  bone  and 
the  supra-temporal  and   lateral   temporal  fossae   were   added   from 

1  The  more  complete  skeletons  were  described  and  figured  by  Bucklaud,  Owen, 
and  others,  and  references  to  the  descriptions  and  figures  are  to  be  found  in  the  Brit. 
Mus.  Cat,  Foss.  Beptilia,  part  i.,  pp.  37-39. 


192  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [September 

Newton's  figures  of  the  skull  of  the  allied  genus  Sccqthognathus 
(Phil.  Trans.  1888,  B.  pi.  77  and  78).  There  appears  to  be 
no  palaeontological  evidence  to  warrant  the  great  length  which 
Owen  gave  to  the  hindermost  ribs  in  his  restoration,  and  these 
have,  therefore,  been  considerably  shortened,  so  that  the  contour 
of  the  ventral  abdominal  wall  now  passes  evenly  from  the  ribs 
to  the  ischial  bones  of  the  pelvis.  So  little  is  yet  known  con- 
cerning the  coracoids  and  sternum  of  Ornithosauria  that,  beyond 
representing  the  sternum  as  keeled  and  as  articulating  with  the 
first  few  ribs,  but  little  has  here  been  attempted. 

Of  the  four  restorations  which  form  the  subject  of  the  present 
article  the  greatest  interest  probably  centres  around  that  of 
Ichthyosaurus,  inasmuch  as  the  recent  additions  to  our  knowledge 
of  this  genus  have  rendered  possible  a  very  complete  restoration. 
The  species  chosen  is  Ichthyosaurus  communis  from  the  Lower  Lias 
of  Lyme  Regis,  and  the  specimens  which  form  the  basis  of  the 
reconstruction  are  those  in  the  Geological  Gallery  bearing  the 
register  numbers  (41849)  and  (2000,1*).  This  is  the  same 
species  as  that  of  the  well-known  restoration  of  Owen's  ("  Anat.  of 
Vert.,"  vol.  i.,  1866,  p.  170).  An  illustrated  summary  of  recent 
papers  on  the  Ichthyopterygia  has  already  appeared  in  the  pages  of 
this  journal  (Lydekker,  Nat.  Sci.,  vol.  i.,  1892,  pp.  514-521),  and 
in  this  article  is  reproduced  Fraas's  figure  of  the  wonderfully  well- 
preserved  specimen  of  Ichthyosaurus  quaclriscissus,  showing  the 
complete  outline  of  the  body  and  affording  incontrovertible  evidence 
of  the  presence  of  a  bilobed  tail  with  the  vertebral  column  running 
down  the  ventral  lobe,  and  the  existence  of  a  series  of  irregular 
integumentary  fins  along  the  back  (Fraas,  Ncues  Jahrb.  f.  Mineral., 
1892,  Bd.  2,  pp.  87-90).  These  details  are  reproduced  in  the 
present  restoration  (Fig.  2),  and,  while  the  proportionate  size  and 
the  details  of  the  paddle  skeleton  are  taken  from  the  specimens  of 
Ichthyosaurus  communis  above  specified,  the  postaxial  flap  of  the 
paddle,  not  supported  by  skeletal  parts,  is  added  from  Fraas's  figure, 
from  the  museum  specimen  of  Ichthyosaurus  intermedins  (R.  1664), 
described  and  figured  by  Lydekker  (Gcol.  Mag.,  dec.  3,  vol.  vi.,*1889, 
pp.  388-390),  and  from  Owen's  figure  of  the  paddle  of  Ichthyosaurus 
communis  (?)  ("  Liassic  Reptilia,"  part  hi.,  1881,  pi.  28,  fig.  5).  The 
outline  and  details  of  the  skull  were  introduced  mainly  from  speci- 
mens (39492)  and  (R.  1164)  of  Ichthyosaurus  communis,  both  of 
which  exhibit  a  very  complete  side  view  of  the  skull.  In  none  of 
the  specimens  of  Ichthyosaurus  communis  at  the  Natural  History 
Museum  are  the  bones  of  the  pectoral  girdle  undisturbed,  so  that  in 
restoring  this  part  of  the  skeleton  the  shapes  of  the  constituent 
bones  were  taken  from  specimen  (41848),  but  their  mutual  relations 
from    the   very   complete   girdle    which   the   museum   possesses    of 


1S97] 


RESTORATION  OF  EXTINCT  REPTILES 


193 


3 

o 

2 

o 


03 


0> 

o 

1-3 


a 

s 


g 

00 

e 

=0 

3 

CO 

O 
■^> 


194  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [September 

Oplithahnosaurus  icenieus  (B.  2137),  described  and  figured  by  Seeley 
(Proc.  Roy.  Soc,  vol.  liv.,  1893,  fig.  1,  p.  151).  No  such  difficulty 
beset  the  restoration  of  the  pelvis,  since  the  parts  are  hardly  at  all 
displaced  in  specimen  (41849). 

The  diagram  of  the  Plesiosaur  is  mainly  based  on  the  splendid 
specimen  of  Plcsiosaurus  rostratus  from  the  Lower  Lias  of  Char- 
mouth,  Dorsetshire,  exhibited  in  the  Geological  Gallery  of  the 
Museum,  and  bearing  the  register  number  (38525).  This  specimen 
was  described  and  figured  by  Owen  in  his  "  Liassic  Eeptilia " 
(Sauroptcrygia,  1865,  pi.  9),  but  it  did  not  form  the  basis  of  his 
well-known  text-book  restoration  of  Plcsiosaurus  ("  Anat.  of  Vert.," 
vol.  i.,  1866,  p.  52),  the  species  of  which,  according  to  Lydekker 
(Brit.  Mus.  Cat.  Foss.  Rcpt.,  part  ii.,  1889,  p.  121),  is  macroccphalus. 
The  number  of  cervical  vertebrae  in  PUsiosaurus  rostratus  is  not 
definitely  known.  Owen  put  it  down  as  twenty-four,  but  there 
were  probably  more,  since  in  the  specimen  (38525)  there  are 
evidently  some  vertebrae  missing  after  the  seventeenth  (see 
Lydekker,  loc.  tit.,  p.  272).  Judging  from  the  shape  and  relations 
of  the  cervical  ribs  flexion  of  the  neck  must  have  been  as  difficult 
of  achievement  in  Plcsiosaurus  as  in  our  modern  crocodiles,  and  so 
the  vertebral  column  in  the  cervical  region  has  been  drawn  nearly 
straight  (Fig.  3),  instead  of  being  allowed  the  graceful  sinuous  curve 
which  characterises  Owen's  figure.  The  outline  of  the  body  has 
been  introduced  from  the  figure  given  by  Dames  (Abkandl.  konigl. 
Almcl.  Wiss.,  Berlin,  1895,  ii.,  p.  79)  ;  and  special  attention  may  be 
called  to  the  shape  of  the  tail  fin,  and  to  the  presence  of  an  integu- 
mentary extension  of  the  paddle  behind  the  part  supported  by  the 
internal  skeleton.  The  transverse  temporal  ridge  at  the  back  of 
the  skull  would  probably  not  have  influenced  the  general  contour  of 
the  body  to  the  extent  suggested  by  the  diagram.  This  improba- 
bility should  have  been  avoided  by  making  the  vertebral  column 
articulate  a  little  higher  up  the  occiput,  and  by  putting  the  cranial 
axis  more  in  a  line  with  the  cervical  vertebrae. 

The  cranium  of  the  specimen  above  mentioned  is  considerably 
crushed ;  therefore,  while  preserving  the  proportions  of  the  cranial 
bones  of  this  species,  the  actual  details  were  added  from  the  more 
perfect  skull  (49202)  of  the  allied  species  P.  macroccphalus,  de- 
scribed and  figured  by  Andrews  (Quart.  Journ.  Geol.  Soc,  vol.  lii., 
1896,  pp.  246-253,  pi.  9).  The  skeleton  of  the  paddles  in  the 
specimen  of  Plcsiosaurus  rostratus  is  extremely  well  preserved,  and 
nothing  more  was  necessary  than  to  copy  the  outlines  of  the 
constituent  bones ;  but  as  the  bones  of  the  pectoral  and  pelvic 
girdles  are  disturbed,  a  certain  amount  of  restoration  was  here 
inevitable,  and  the  assistance  derived  from  the  perfect  girdles  of 
Muracnosaurus    plicatus     (R.    2428)    and    Crypt  oclldus    oxoniensis 


1897]  RESTORATION  OF  EXTINCT  REE  TILES  195 

(R.  24 16)  and  (R,  26 1G)  and  the  descriptions  and  figures  of  these 
specimens  by  Andrews  {Ann.  &  Mag.  Nat.  Hist.,  ser.  G.,  vol. 
xvi,  1895,  p.  429;  ibid.,  ser.  6.,  vol.  xv.,  1895,  p.  333;  Qeol. 
Mag.,  dec.  4.,  vol.  iii,  1896,  p.  145)  should  here  be  acknow- 
ledged. 

Fariasaurus  baini  was  chosen  to  represent  the  Anomodontia, 
chiefly  because  of  the  completeness  of  the  skeleton  exhibited  in 
the  Reptile  Gallery  of  the  Geological  Department  of  the  museum. 
This  skeleton  (R.  1971),  from  the  Karoo  formation  (Trias),  was  dis- 
covered by  Prof.  H.  G.  Seeley,  near  Tamboer  Fontein  in  Cape 
Colony,  and  was  described  and  figured  by  him  in  the  Phil.  Trans. 
(1892,  B.,pp.  311-370,  pis.  17-19,  21-23).  The  Anomodontia  con- 
stitute such  a  heterogeneous  collection  of  reptiles  that  it  would  be 
difficult  to  say  what  species  might  be  considered  to  be  most  typical 
of  the  Order.  But  the  completeness  of  this  specimen  of  Fariasaurus 
certainly  renders  it  more  suitable  for  the  purpose  in  hand  than  any 
other   Anomodont   yet   known.       The    diagram    (Fig.    4)    is   not   a 


Fig.  4.  Pariasaurus  baini,  from  the  Trias  of  Cape  Colony,     (x.'s) 

restoration  in  the  same  sense  as  the  other  three,  because,  in  the 
first  place,  the  completeness  of  the  skeleton  renders  possible  a  very 
close  adherence  to  nature,  and,  in  the  second,  because,  the  whole 
of  our  knowledge  of  the  species  being  derived  from  this  one  speci- 
men, a  reconstructed  diagram  would  be  less  instructive  than  an 
outline  drawing  of  the  specimen  boldly  treated.  The  unimportant 
cracks  in  the  bones  shown  in  the  large  folding  plate  in  the  Phil. 
Trans,  have  been  omitted,  and  a  little  diagrammatic  cross-shading 
has  been  employed  here  to  give  the  effect  of  distance,  although  it 
was  not  found  necessary  in  the  other  three  diagrams.  The  legs  are 
shown  articulating  in  the  glenoid  cavity  and  the  acetabulum,  as  in 
the  mounted  specimen  but  not  as  in  the  plate  ;  and  the  anterior 
cervical  vertebrae,  which  during  fossilisation  were  united  into  a 
block  of  extreme  upward  curvature,  are  given  a  more  convenient 
disposition    so    as    to    articulate  with    the    condyle    of    the   skull, 


196  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [September 

which  is   not  the  case   in   the   plate,  nor  in  the  specimen  as  now 
mounted. 

My  grateful  acknowledgments  are  due  to  Sir  William  Flower, 
K.C.B.,  for  permission  to  reproduce  these  figures  for  publication, 
and  to  Mr  A.  Smith  Woodward,  assistant  keeper  of  the  Geological 
Department,  for  sundry  hints  and  advice  during  the  construction  of 
the  diagrams.  W.  G.  Ridewood. 


551.79  19' 


V 

The  Facetted  Pebbles  of  India 

IT  is  now  nearly  forty  years  since  the  first  account  (1)  of  evidence 
of  ice  action  in  Palaeozoic  times  and  within  the  tropics  was  pub- 
lished, and  though  the  concept  of  a  Permian  glacial  period  is  now  one 
of  the  accepted  results  of  geological  research,  the  opposition  to  its 
acceptance  is  by  no  means  dead.  Some  ten  years  ago  this  opposi- 
tion received  an  access  of  strength  by  the  arrival  and  exhibition  in 
England  of  certain  peculiar  fragments  of  rock,  first  discovered  by  Dr 
Warth  (2)  in  the  Permian  boulder  beds  of  the  Salt  Eange,  which 
did  not  merely  show  a  striation  like  that  produced  by  glaciers,  but 
bore  several  surfaces  or  facets  which  met  in  obtuse  angles,  and  some- 
times completely  surrounded  the  stone.  A  number  of  these  were 
sent  home,  unaccompanied  by  stones  of  other  types,  and  an  idea 
seems,  perhaps  not  unnaturally,  to  have  sprung  up  that  these  were 
the  normal  type  of  boulder,  and  not,  as  was  the  case,  curiosities 
which  were  strange  to  geologists  in  India,  and  sent  by  them  to  their 
colleagues  in  Europe,  with  a  view  to  enlightenment  as  to  the  mode 
of  origin  of  a  feature  with  which  they  were  not  acquainted  as  a 
result  of  ice  action. 

Specimens  were  exhibited  at  the  Geological  Society  (3),  the 
British  Association  (4),  and  elsewhere,  and  the  general  opinion  may 
be  expressed  in  the  words  of  a  letter  by  Dr  W.  T.  Blanford  to  the 
Geological  Magazine  (5),  that  "  the  great  difficulty  in  accounting  for 
the  origin  of  these  facetted  blocks  is  that  whilst  the  smoothed  sur- 
faces are  in  every  respect  similar  to  those  on  stones  worn  by  glacial 
action,  no  fragments  from  moraines,  from  boulder-clay,  or  from  other 
glacial  deposits,  are  known  to  exhibit  the  peculiar  facetting  charac- 
teristic of  the  present  specimens." 

Such  was  the  general  opinion  held  by  most,  if  not  all,  of-  those 
who  saw  the  specimens,  and  in  the  museum  at  Zurich  one  of  these 
very  facetted  stones  may  be  seen,  with  an  endorsement  on  the  label, 
by  Professor  Heim,  to  the  effect  that  he  had  seen  nothing  like  it  in 
recent  glacial  deposits. 

In  these  circumstances,  the  facetted  stones  being  supposed  to  be 
the  evidence  on  which  was  based  the  claim  for  a  glacial  origin  of 
the  beds  in  which  they  were  found,  it  was  natural  that  the  opposi- 
tion to  the  claim  should  be  strengthened.      In   reality,  however,  the 


198  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [September 

supposition  that  these  facetted  pebbles  were  in  some  way  the  result 
of  ice  action  was  based  on  the  fact  that  they  were  found  in  beds 
which,  on  quite  independent  grounds,  were  believed  to  be  of  glacial 
origin,  and  this  belief  would  have  been  in  no  way  affected  if  the 
facetted  stones  had  been  shown  to  owe  their  peculiar  form  to  any 
other  agency  than  ice. 

All  this  while,  however,  there  was  on  record  the  description  of 
boulders  of  precisely  similar  character  in  glacial  boulder  clays  of 
Post-Tertiary  age.  In  1879  Professor  Credner  published  an  account 
of  the  scratched  stones  found  in  the  neighbourhood  of  Leipzig,  (6)  in 
which  he  mentions  three  types ;  the  first  being  those  on  which  a 
fiat  surface  had  been  ground  away  on  one  side ;  the  second  com- 
prising those  on  which  two  or  more  such  surfaces  are  found  meeting 
in  obtuse  angles  ;  the  third,  those  which  show  no  facets,  but  are  of 
a  rounded  or  sub-angular  form,  and  bear  grooves  and  scratches 
scattered  over  their  surface.  It  would  be  impossible  to  give  a  better 
classification  of  the  stones  found  in  the  boulder  beds  of  the  Salt 
Range,  and  the  closeness  of  resemblance  is  only  enhanced  when 
Professor  Credner's  detailed  description  is  read. 

This  account  appears  to  have  been  overlooked  by  all  those  who 
saw  the  Salt  Range  specimens,  for  which  small  blame  can  be  laid, 
as  the  volume  of  glacial  literature  is  so  vast  that  the  greater  part 
must  remain  unread — even  by  those  who  devote  themselves  specially 
to  this  subject — and  the  paper  might  have  remained  unnoticed  in 
this  connection  had  it  not  been  accidentally  stumbled  on  while  a 
very  different  line  of  research  was  being  pursued.  Struck  with  the 
light  it  threw  on  the  origin  of  these  curious  pebbles  I  wrote  to 
Professor  Credner  asking  for  further  particulars,  and  in  reply  was 
informed  that  in  the  collection  of  the  Saxon  Geological  Survey  there 
are  a  large  number  of  ice-worn  stones  showing  two  or  more  facets, 
meeting  at  an  angle,  and  that  in  some  these  facets  were  distributed 
round  the  whole  circumference  of  the  stone.  He  also  informs  me 
that  after  a  comparison  of  the  specimens  in  Leipzig  with  the  figures 
and  descriptions  of  Drs  Warth  (2)  and  Noetling  (7),-  he  considers 
that  their  nature  as  glaciated  fragments  of  the  same  character  as 
those  of  the  "  griind-morane  "  of  the  northern  ice-sheet  is  beyond 
doubt. 

From  this  it  is  evident  that  we  have,  in  Post-Tertiary  glacial 
deposits,  ice- worn  fragments  showing  all  the  peculiarities  of  those 
found  in  the  Permian  boulder  beds  of  the  Salt  Range,  and  with  this 
the  last  objection  to  accepting  their  glacial  origin  should  disappear. 

R.  D.  Oldham. 

REFERENCES. 

1.  Blanford,  H.  F.  and  W.T.,  and  Theobald,  W. — On  the  geological  structure  and  rela- 
tions of  the  Talcheer  coalfield  in  the  district  of  Cuttack.  Mem.  Geol.  Surv.  Lid., 
i.,  pt.  i.,  p.  33  (1859). 


1897]  THE  FACETTED  PEBBLES  OF  INDIA  199 

2.  Warth,  H. — A  facetted  pebble  from  the  boulder  bed  (speckled -sandstone)  of  Mount 

Chel  in  the  Salt  Range  in  the  Punjab.     Bee.   Geol.  Surv.  Ind.,  vol.  xxi.,  p.  34 
(1888). 

3.  Blanford,  W.  T. — On  additional  evidence  of  the  occurrence  of  glacial  conditions  in 

the  Palaeozoic  era,  &c.     Quart.  Journ.  Geol.  Soc,  vol.  xlii.,  pp.  249-263  (1886). 
1.  Wynne,  A.  B. — A  facetted  and  striated  pebble  from  the  Olive  group  conglomerate  of 
the  Chiel  Hill  in  the  Salt  Range,  Punjab,  India.     Bep.  Brit.  Assoc,  lvi.,  pt.  ii. , 
631  (1S87).    Geol.  Mag.,  3rd  decade,  vol.  iii.,  p.  492  (1886). 

5.  Blanford,  W.  T. — On  a  smoothed  and  striated  boulder  from  the  Punjab  Salt  Range. 

Geol.  May.,  3rd  decade,  vol.  iii.,  p.  574  (1886). 

6.  Credner,  H. — Ueber  gletscherschlifl'e  auf  Porphyrkuppen  bei  Leipzig,  und  iiber  geritzte 

einheimische  Geschiebe.      Zcitschr.   deutsch.    Geol.   Ges.,   vol.   xxxi.,    pp.    21-24 
(1879). 

7.  Noetling,  F. — Beitrage  zur  Kenntniss  der  glacialen  Schichten  permischen  Alters  in  der 

Salt-Range,  Punjab  (Indien).     Neucs  Jahrbuch,  1S96,  vol.  ii.,  pp.  61-86. 


200  [September 


SOME  NEW  BOOKS 

A  French  Treatise  on  Zoology 

Trait^  de  Zoologie  Concrete.  Vol.  I.  La  Cellule  et  les  Protozoaires.  By  Yves 
Delage  and  Edgard  Herouard.  Pp.  xxx.  584,  with  870  col.  figs.  Paris:  Schleicher 
Freres,  1896.     Price  25  francs. 

This  is  the  first  instalment  of  a  work  which,  if  it  finishes  as  it  has 
begun,  will  be  of  the  greatest  value,  since  it  combines  completeness 
and  erudition  with  a  method  of  treatment  at  once  highly  original  and 
well  adapted  to  the  end  in  view. 

The  primary  object  of  the  authors  is  to  smooth  the  path  of  the 
student  and  to  help  him  in  his  difficulties,  and  in  their  preface  they 
are  at  pains  to  explain  how  it  is  intended  to  bring  about  this  result. 
Every  one  knows  how  difficult  it  is,  when  commencing  the  study  of  a 
group  of  animals  with  the  help  only  of  an  ordinary  text-book  of  com- 
parative anatomy,  to  apply  the  more  or  less  vague  generalities  of 
which  such  works  are  composed  to  the  case  of  a  particular  form. 
The  usual  method  of  describing  a  group  of  animals  in  the  text-books 
or  treatises  on  zoology  is  to  commence  with  a  chapter  or  chapters  in 
which  the  comparative  anatomy  of  the  group  is  described  organ  by 
organ  in  a  purely  abstract  manner — that  is  to  say,  without  reference 
to  the  remaining  organs  of  the  body.  This  is  followed  by  a  systematic 
portion  in  which  the  families  or  genera  are  catalogued  and  distin- 
guished by  means  of  their  external  characters.  The  great  defect  of 
this  mode  of  treatment  is  the  want  of  any  proper  link  between  the 
abstract  and  the  concrete,  between  the  general  and  the  par- 
ticular. The  beginner  who  is  as  yet  unfamiliar  with  the  group  in 
question  finds  an  extreme  difficulty  in  forming  a  clear  idea  of  how  a 
particular  form  is  organised  in  its  entirety,  since  he  has  to  combine 
in  his  mind  a  brief  summary  of  its  external  characters  with  the  rather 
vague  mental  image  of  its  anatomy  which  he  constructs  by  wading 
through  the  comparative  chapters  and  picking  out  such  portions  as 
may  apply  to  the  form  under  consideration.  Hence  text-books  of 
this  class,  though  extremely  valuable  to  the  advanced  student  or 
teacher  as  works  of  reference,  are  confusing  to  the  learner,  who 
requires  above  all  things  something  real  and  concrete,  upon  which  to 
found  his  general  notions. 

It  is  not  every  student  who  has  the  time  or  opportunity  to  obtain 
the  empirical  basis  so  necessary  for  a  clear  grasp  of  the  main  prin- 
ciples, by  consulting  the  special  memoirs  or  monographs  dealing  with 
the  forms  he  is  studying,  and  in  order  to  help  him  out  of  the  diffi- 
culty a  large  class  of  practical  text-books  of  zoology  has  sprung  up 
in  recent  years,  in  which  particular  forms  are  chosen  as  typical 
examples  of  the  larger  systematic  groups  and  described  in  great 
detail.  In  this  way  a  division  of  labour  has  come  about  whereby  the 
treatise  of  comparative  anatomy  is  supplemented  and  elucidated  by 


1897J  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  201 

the  concrete  examples  of  the  practical  text-book.  It  is,  however, 
only  to  a  limited  extent  that  such  co-operation  is  possible  or  prac- 
ticable. The  number  of  types  which  can  be  described  within  the 
limits  of  a  practical  text-book  must  be  necessarily  few  by  comparison 
with  the  ground  covered  by  the  more  abstract  treatises,  and  illustra- 
tive only  of  the  greater  systematic  divisions.  The  design  of  our 
authors  is  an  ambitious  one.  It  is  nothing  less  than  to  effect  a  com- 
promise, so  to  speak,  between  the  abstract  and  the  particular,  and  to 
impart  a  general  knowledge  founded  upon  judiciously  constructed, 
concrete  examples. 

A  complete  knowledge  of  a  natural  group  of  animals  might  be 
supposed  attainable  only  by  a  separate  description  of  each  of  the 
species  in  it.  But  allied  species  and  even  genera  only  differ  amongst 
themselves  by  secondary  characters,  and  it  is  not  until  we  come  to 
families  or  orders  that  we  find  anatomical  characters  of  sufficient 
importance  to  warrant  detailed  treatment  in  the  limited  compass  of  a 
text-book.  Hence  for  each  such  systematic  division  the  authors  pro- 
pose to  commence  with  the  description  of  a  generalised  type,  in  which 
the  characters  of  the  subgroup — in  most  cases  a  suborder — shall  be 
found  combined,  and  then  to  proceed  to  point  out  how  the  various 
forms  comprised  in  the  subgroup  differ  severally  from  the  essential 
type.  But  such  generalised  and  fundamental  types  are  to  be  found 
but  rarely  in  nature.  The  authors  have  therefore  invented  and  con- 
structed a  morphological  type  for  each  suborder,  a  fundamental 
form  "  which  summarises  in  itself  that  which  is  common  to  all  the 
actual  forms  of  the  group,  or  which  is  presented  as  a  simple  initial 
form,  from  which  the  others  would  be  derived  by  progressive  com- 
plications." In  this  way  it  is  possible  to  present  general  notions  in  a 
concrete  form.  It  might  be  objected  that  the  morphological  types 
are  not  real  but  represent  to  a  certain  extent  ideal  abstractions.  In 
answer  to  this  it  is  pointed  out  that  the  term  concrete  does  not 
mean  real.  "A  type  may  be  concrete  even  though  it  is  ideal 
What  does  it  matter  to  a  student  when  he  reads  a  precise  description 
with  the  indication  of  all  the  organs  and  of  their  relations,  whether 
the  being  thus  described  really  exists  in  nature  or  whether  it  repre- 
sents only  the  mean,  we  might  almost  say  the  composite  portrait, 
of  a  small  group  of  real  beings  ?  The  idea  he  will  obtain  of  the  being- 
described,  and  later  of  the  entire  group,  will  be  none  the  less  precise 
and  none  the  less  accurate." 

For  the  reasons  that  have  just  been  set  forth,  Messrs  Delage  and 
Herouard  call  their  work  a  treatise  of  concrete  zoology,  as  opposed 
to  the  more  abstract  zoology  of  the  ordinary  text-books.  They 
claim,  and  we  think  justly,  to  have  helped  the  student  over  one  of  his 
greatest  difficulties,  though  as  they  acknowledge,  the  Protozoa  are 
scarcely  a  fair  test  for  the  efficiency  of  the  method  on  account  of  their 
simple  structure,  and  we  are  begged  to  suspend  our  final  judgment 
until  the  appearance  of  the  volumes  to  follow.  At  the  same  time  the 
great  store  of  information  brought  together  in  a  most  painstaking  and 
laborious  manner  renders  the  work  very  useful  to  others  than 
beginners,  chiefly  on  account  of  the  simple  and  methodical  arrange- 
ment that  has  been  adopted,  and  the  consequent  ease  with  which  any 
required  facts  can  be  hunted  down. 


202  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [September 

The  present  volume  contains  two  parts,  the  first  dealing  with  the 
cell  and  its  functions,  the  second  with  the  Protozoa.  In  the  first  part 
the  authors  give  a  review  of  general  cytology,  and  deal  with  the  vexed 
questions  of  protoplasmic  and  nuclear  structures.  Here,  as  they  admit, 
they  are  often  on  very  controversial  ground,  and  experts  would  find 
much  to  criticise  and  to  dispute  in  the  opinions  put  forward.  It 
cannot,  however,  be  laid  to  the  charge  of  our  authors  that  they  have 
neglected  or  passed  over  other  views,  though  their  criticisms  upon 
them  are  occasionally  perhaps  rather  one-sided ;  for  having  in  view 
once  more  the  exigencies  of  the  student  they  have  divided  the  work 
into  two  parts,  one  printed  in  large  type  composing  the  main  text, 
the  other  in  small  type  contained  in  the  footnotes.  In  the  former 
the  objects  are  described  in  a  simple  and  straightforward  manner  from 
the  point  of  view  taken  by  the  authors,  while  to  the  footnotes  are 
relegated  the  more  controversial  subjects  as  well  as  details  concerning 
the  less  important  or  doubtful  genera  and  similar  matters.  In  this 
way  the  work  is  rendered  extremely  complete,  and  while  on  the  one 
hand  the  student  is  treated  to  a  clear  and  continuous,  if  at  times 
dogmatic,  expose  of  the  subject,  he  is  enabled,  on  the  other  hand,  to 
greatly  extend  his  knowledge,  if  he  wish,  by  means  of  the  references 
and  discussions  in  the  footnotes. 

The  portion  of  the  work  dealing  with  the  Protozoa  contains  a  mass 
of  information  which  it  would  be  impossible  to  criticise  in  detail.  We 
must,  however,  take  exception  to  one  innovation  which  has  been 
introduced  into  this  work,  namely,  the  manner  in  which  the  authors 
have  changed  the  names  of  the  groups,  in  the  attempt  to  introduce 
one  uniform  system  of  terminations  for  the  equivalent  taxonomic 
subdivisions.  The  results  have  been  in  some  cases  almost  disastrous ; 
we  can  hardly  recognise  such  familiar  groups  as  the  Flagellata  and 
Ciliata  when  we  see  them  written  as  "  Fla^ellia "  and  "  Ciliae " 
respectively.  In  science  a  very  good  excuse  is  always  necessary 
before  the  alteration  of  well-established  names  can  be  permitted.  In 
the  present  case  it  is  again  solicitude  for  the  student  which  is 
responsible  for  this  well-meant  but,  we  think,  injudicious  reform. 
It  is  supposed,  for  instance,  that  to  make  the  names  of  classes  end  in 
ia,  and  subclasses  in  iae,  in  all  cases,  will  tend  to  clearness.  Not 
only,  however,  is  this  alteration  of  names  rather  confusing,  especially 
to  the  beginner,  but  it  involves  the  assumption,  which  can  scarcely  be 
maintained,  that  the  various  categories  known  as  classes,  subclasses, 
orders,  and  so  forth,  are  of  the  same  taxonomic  value  in  all  groups. 
The  fact  alone,  however,  that  in  the  classifications  of  different  authors, 
different  names  are  given  to  equivalent  divisions,  is  a  sufficient  refuta- 
tion of  this  view,  for  where  one  author  has  a  subclass  divided  into 
orders,  another  may  have  an  order  divided  into  suborders.  It  is, 
therefore,  rather  premature  to  coin  a  uniform  termination  for  sub- 
classes or  orders  until  the  value  of  these  categories  is  more  fixed. 
But  further,  Messrs  Delage  and  Herouard  have  given  new  names  in 
their  scheme  to  just  those  taxonomic  categories  for  which,  being  of 
lesser  and  therefore  of  more  definite  value,  the  almost  universal  custom 
of  naturalists  has  already  established  a  uniform  terminology.  Nearly 
everywhere  now  names  of  families  are  made  to  terminate  in  idae  and 
subfamilies  in  inae  ;  yet  our  authors  choose  to  employ  the  termination 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  203 

idae  for  suborders  and  inoe  for  families.  The  alteration  in  this  way 
of  an  already  uniform  and  established  system  of  nomenclature  seems 
to  us  quite  unjustifiable. 

In  the  classification  of  the  Protozoa  we  notice  a  certain  number  of 
new  names,  some  of  which  are  coined  for  the  purposes  of  new  classi- 
fications, while  others  are  older  groups  renamed.  The  Sporozoa  are 
divided  into  two  subclasses  (1)  Amoebogeniae  (nov.)  with  amoeboid 
sporozoites,  and  containing  the  Myxosporidia,  and  (2)  Ehabdogeniae 
(nov.),  with  sporozoites  of  definite  form,  including  the  remainder  of 
the  class.  The  Ehabdogeniae  are  further  divided  into  the  two  orders, 
Dolichocystida  (nov.),  comprising  the  Sarcosporidia,  and  Brachycystida 
(nov.),  which  includes  the  remaining  forms,  namely,  the  Gregarinidae, 
Cocciiliidae,Haemosporididae(2)/'^a?iw^W'm,etc.)and  Gymnosporididae 
(Hacmamocba  and  others).  In  the  Ciliata  Stein's  four  orders  are 
maintained.  The  Holotricha  are  divided  into  Gymnostomidae,  cor- 
responding to  Butschli's  Gymnostoma,  and  the  Hymenostomidae 
(nov.),  corresponding  to  Butschli's  Trichostoma  Aspirotricha.  The 
Peritricha  are  divided  into  Scaiotrichidae  (nov.),  comprising  Butschli's 
Lienophorina  and  Spirochonina,  and  Dexiotrichidae  (nov.)  =  Yorticel- 
lina.  In  the  former  the  adoral  zone  of  cilia  has  a  sinistral  (Jl,ko.i6s) 
twist,  in  the  latter  a  dextral  (Ae£io$). 

The  work  is  illustrated  throughout  by  excellent  diagrammatic 
figures,  for  the  most  part  coloured,  some  even  in  as  many  as  four 
colours.  None  of  the  familiar  "  vieux  cliches "  which  persistently 
haunt  one  text-book  after  another,  are  permitted  to  intrude  between 
these  covers,  all  the  figures  being  either  specially  constructed  diagrams 
or  else  copied  or  modified  from  the  original  figures  in  the  special 
memoirs.  In  short,  the  whole  book  is  characterised  throughout  to  a 
marked  degree  by  one  most  precious  quality,  that  of  clearness  and 
lucidity  both  in  description  and  illustration.  In  conclusion,  we  con- 
gratulate Messrs  Delage  and  Herouard  most  heartily  on  the  first 
results  of  their  labours,  and  wish  them  all  success  in  the  great  task 
which  they  have  before  them.  E.  A.  M. 


GONIATITES   IN   THE   BRITISH    MUSEUM 

Catalogue  of  the  Fossil  Cephalopoda  in  the  British  Museum  (Natural 
History).  Part  iii.  Containing  the  Bactritidae  and  part  of  the  suborder 
Ammonoidea.  By  Arthur  H.  Foord  and  George  Charles  Crick.  Pp.  xxxiv.,  303. 
Published  by  order  of  the  Trustees.     London,  1897.     Price,  12s.  6d. 

The  first  part  of  this  Catalogue,  published  in  1888,  and  the  second 
published  in  1891,  dealt  with  the  Nautiloidea  and  were  written  by 
Dr  Foord  alone.  -  That  gentleman's  removal  to  Dublin  made  some 
help  imperative,  and  Mr  Crick,  the  assistant  in  charge  of  the  Cepha- 
lopoda in  the  Geological  Department  of  the  British  Museum,  has 
proved  a  worthy  collaborator.  The  experience  gained  from  previous 
work,  combined  with  this  fortunate  co-operation,  has  brought  the 
present  volume,  which  treats  of  the  older  Ammonoidea,  very  near  our 
ideal  of  what  such  a  museum-catalogue  should  be.  Some  of  these 
publications  of  the  Natural  History  Museum  have  been  important 
contributions  to  knowledge,  but  have  left  us  still  in  the  dark  as  to  the 
precise  extent  or  value  of  the  Museum  collections ;  others  have  dis- 


204  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [September 

played  a  marvellous  zeal  in  the  hunting  up  of  ancient  literature  and 
the  compilation  of  synonymies,  but  have  not  greatly  assisted  the 
student ;  others  again  have  been  dry  lists  of  specimens,  jotted  down 
in  haste  and  repented  of  at  leisure,  but  having  at  least  this  merit, 
that  they  told  us  what  material  the  Museum  contained. 

The  present  volume  seems  to  us  to  combine  the  advantages,  with- 
out the  defects,  of  those  predecessors  to  which  we  have  referred.  The 
descriptions  of  the  species  are  most  carefully  drawn  up,  each  being 
based,  where  possible,  on  examination  of  the  type-specimen  itself,  and 
following  a  uniform  plan,  which  greatly  facilitates  comparison.  A 
useful  diagram  explains  the  terms  employed.  The  difficulty  of 
describing  the  all-important  suture-line  has  been  avoided  by  giving 
a  tracing  made  from  an  actual  specimen,  if  possible  the  type.  There 
are  also  woodcuts  of  specimens,  many  of  them  from  original  drawings 
by  Miss  G.  M.  Woodward.  The  references  to  literature,  in  the  form 
of  lists  of  synonyma,  are  carefully  done,  but  occupy  a  disproportionate 
space.  When  a  species  has  never  received  more  than  one  specific 
name,  e.g.,  Prolecanites  becheri,  it  seems  unnecessary  to  trace  this 
through  all  the  obvious  genera,  such  as  Ammonites  and  Goniatites,  to 
which  it  has  been  referred  by  older  authors,  including  the  compilers 
of  text-books  and  nomenclators.  The  information  is  useful,  but  might 
be  put  in  less  compass.  Finally,  this  is  a  true  catalogue ;  every 
specimen  in  the  Museum  is  mentioned  in  such  a  way  that  it  can  be 
identified,  and  the  number  under  which  it  is  entered  in  the  Museum 
lists  or  registers  is  printed.  Thus  the  foreign  student  can  gauge  pre- 
cisely the  wealth  of  the  collection,  can  tell  whether  what  he  wants  to 
see  is  contained  in  it,  and  on  reaching  the  Museum  can  ask  for  the 
definite  specimen  he  requires. 

One  or  two  improvements  may  be  suggested  for  future  volumes  of 
this  and  other  catalogues.  The  statements  of  locality  are  misleading : 
under  each  species  comes  a  series  of  statements  made  with  reference 
to  the  species  in  general,  including  the  usual  size  attained.  After 
"Size"  follow  "Form,  and  Log"  These,  however,  refer  not  to  the 
species,  but  to  the  particular  specimens  in  the  Museum.  It  would  be 
better  to  give  the  general  geological  and  geographical  distribution  of 
the  species,  and  to  refer  to  definite  localities  under  the  individual 
specimens,  as  is  already  done  in  cases  where  more  than  one  locality 
is  represented.  It  would  be  well  to  draw  more  forcible  attention  to 
the  type-specimens,  e.g.,  by  broad-faced  type,  also  to  distinguish 
cotypes,  paratypes,  and  the  rest.  It  is  good  to  know  the  names  of 
donors,  especially  when  they  are  such  men  as  J.  E.  Lee  and  John 
Kofe ;  but  it  would  also  be  good  in  other  cases  to  know  the  names  of 
those  from  whom  specimens  have  been  purchased,  since  these  must 
often  have  been  geologists  of  repute,  whose  statements  of  locality  and 
the  like  would  be  of  more  value  than  those  of  an  ordinary  dealer  or 
inefficient  collector.  It  is  sad  to  see  how  many  specimens  are  entered 
with  "History  unhwivn"  and  of  how  many  others  "  Transferred  from 
Mas.  Pract.  Gcol."  the  necessary  details  are  not  recorded;  but  this  is 
no  fault  of  Messrs  Foord  &  Crick. 

A  catalogue  is  not  a  text-book ;  nevertheless  the  Catalogues  of 
the  British  Museum  have  come  to  be  looked  for  by  us  outsiders  as 
likely  to  introduce  some  improved  system,  and  to  unravel  the  tangle 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  205 

of  conflicting  authorities.  We  look  for  some  pronouncement  on 
debated  points,  and  for  some  clue  through  the  maze  that  perplexes 
us.  In  these  respects  the  present  work  leaves  us  unsatisfied.  There 
is  no  exposition  of  the  principles  of  the  classification  adopted ;  there 
are  no  keys ;  and  there  is  little  to  indicate  the  relations  of  the  species 
to  one  another.  The  authors  suffer  from  an  excess  of  caution :  they 
tell  us  what  Hyatt  has  written,  what  Haug  thinks,  what  is  the 
opinion  of  Branco,  and  what  one  will  find  in  Zittel ;  hut  what  their 
own  views  are,  wild  horses  will  not  drag  from  them.  It  is  the  duty 
of  people  with  such  advantages  as  have  our  authors,  not  only  to  have 
opinions  but  to  express  them.  It  is  not  enough  to  tell  us  of  so 
interesting  a  form  as  Clymenia  that  its  derivation  "is  at  present 
enigmatical "  ;  it  has  been  that  for  half-a-centurv.  But  one  doubts 
occasionally  whether  even  the  authors  know  their  own  minds.  There 
is  a  vast  deal  of  quotation  as  to  the  systematic  position  of  Bactrites, 
but  where  it  is  placed  after  all,  we  cannot  understand.  In  Part  I.  of 
the  Catalogue,  Dr  Foord  inserted  it  among  the  Nautiloidea ;  in  Part 
II.  he  said  that  he  would  refer  it  to  the  Ammonoidea  ;  and  now  in 
Part  III.  it  is  hung  up  in  the  air,  as  though  it  were  an  Archi- 
cephalopod  or  a  Schematic  Mollusc.  Again,  among  the  quotations 
bearing  on  this,  we  find  a  passage  from  Hyatt  and  some  of  his 
figures  ;  but  we  find  no  quotation  of  the  destructive  criticism  of  this 
passage  published  by  Mr  Crick  himself,  in  conjunction  with  Mi- 
Bather,  in  Natural  Science  for  December  1894  (vol.  v.,  p.  425).  It  is 
less  strange,  but  quite  as  inexcusable,  that  there  should  be  no  refer- 
ence to  the  important  papers  by  J.  M.  Clarke  in  the  American 
Geologist.  There  is  always  some  excellent  excuse  for  the  suppression 
of  evidence,  and  we  shall  no  doubt  learn  that  this  is  all  for  the  good 
of  the  Government — or  its  officials. 

It  is  curious,  in  a  volume  dealing  with  the  Goniatites,  to  find  no 
family  Goniatitidae  and  no  genus  Goniatites.  The  type-species  of 
Goniatites  is  the  Nautilites  sphacricus  of  Martin,  a  perfectly  well- 
known  form,  which  appears  in  this  book  as  a  Glyphioceras.  There 
seems  no  room  for  doubt  that  Glyphioceras  must  rank  as  a  synonym 
of  Goniatites,  since  the  latter  has  some  sixty  years'  priority. 

With  the  few  exceptions  mentioned,  the  volume  is  brought  well 
up  to  date,  and  the  care  with  which  it  has  been  compiled  augurs  well 
for  the  continuation  of  the  series. 

Popular  Natural  History 

The  Concise  Knowledge  Library — Natural  History.  Edited  by  Alfred  H.  Miles. 
8vo,  pp.  xvi.  and  771,  with  530  original  illustrations.  London  :  Hutchinson  & 
Co.,  1897.     Price,  5s. 

This  volume  is  the  first  of  a  projected  series,  the  purpose  of  which  is 
shown  in  the  title,  and  in  the  editorial  preface.  The  volumes  are 
intended  to  be  "  concise  and  popular  ...  at  once  accurate  in  state- 
ment, handy  in  form,  and  ready  of  reference  " ;  and  the  results  hoped 
for  are,  "  that  much  time  may  be  saved  to  busy  people  and  much  help 
afforded  to  students."  The  plan  is  excellent,  but  the  execution  is 
scarcely  so  successful  as  one  would  expect  from  the  names  which 
figure  on  the  title  page.     Mr  Lydekker  is  responsible  for  the  mammals, 


206  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [September 

reptiles,  amphibians,  fishes,  and  cyclostomes ;  Dr  R  Bowdler  Sharpe 
for  the  birds  ;  Mr  Garstang  for  amphioxus  and  balanoglossus  ;  Mr 
W.  F.  Kirby  for  the  arthropods  ;  Mr  B.  B.  "Woodward  for  the  mol- 
luscs ;  Mr  Bather  for  the  lamp  shells  and  starfishes  ;  Mr  Kirkpatrick 
for  the  moss  animals ;  Mr  Pocock  for  the  "  worms "  ;  and  Mr  and 
Mrs  Bernard  for  the  coelenterates  and  the  protozoa.  There  is,  of 
course,  a  good  deal  of  excellent  work  in  the  book,  which  is  a  marvel 
of  cheapness  ;  but  some  of  the  sections  dealing  with  vertebrata  read 
as  if  they  were  made  up  of  popular  newspaper  articles,  hurriedly,  and 
not  very  skilfully,  welded  together.  The  best  part  of  the  book  is  that 
dealing  with  the  lowest  vertebrates  and  the  invertebrates.  The  sections 
on  lamp  shells  and  starfishes  deserve  special  mention;  and  students  of 
the  bryozoa  will  be  grateful  to  Mr  Kirkpatrick  for  appending  to 
his  section  a  classification  and  bibliography.  In  a  second  edition  it 
would  be  well  to  adopt  the  same  zoo-geographical  regions  for  mammals 
and  birds;  and  the  puzzling  sentence  on  p.  122 — "the  teats  of  the 
female  elephants  are  placed  between  the  hind  legs,  and  the  young  calf 
sucks  with  its  mouth,  and  not  with  its  trunk  " — should  be  deleted. 
Stricter  supervision,  too,  should  be  exercised  over  the  illustrations. 
Fig.  86  (p.  156)  bears  the  inscription  Tragclaphus  angasi,  about  which 
no  word  occurs  in  the  text ;  the  inscription  of  Fig.  82  (p.  349)  does 
not  refer  to  the  bird  figured ;  the  illustration  of  the  bearded  reedling 
(p.  368)  bears  the  generic  name  Calamophilus,  while  Panurus  is  given 
in  the  text,  though  it  does  not  appear  in  the  index.  The  misprints, 
of  which  there  are  considerably  more  than  are  justly  chargeable  to  the 
printer,  should  be  carefully  sought  for  and  corrected.  Alunda,  Teirao, 
Phasiandae,  Paro,  Syrrhoptes,  Scolopaeinae,  Nydierax  nycticrax,  Try- 
panns,  Anthrophysa  (and  many  others)  are  likely  to  prove  hindrances 
rather  than  helps  ;  and  some  readers  may  stumble  at  "  catenanan 
formation."  "  Pellage,"  too,  is  an  unusual  form  in  English  books  ; 
while  "  Leydecker  "  and  "  Brydden  "  conceal  familiar  names. 

Moths 

A  Handbook  to  the  Order  Lepidoptera.  By  W.  F.  Kirby,  F.L.S.,  F.E.S.  Vol. 
V.  Moths.  Part  3.  8vo,  pp.  332,  plates  32.  (Allen's  Naturalist's  Library.) 
London  :  W.  H.  Allen  &  Co.,  1897.     Price,  6s. 

With  praiseworthy  celerity,  Mr  Kirby  has  brought  his  handbook  of 
lepidoptera  to  a  conclusion.  It  is  unfortunate  that  his  account  of  the 
noctuids,  the  geometers,  and  the  whole  of  the  so-called  "  micro- 
lepidoptera  "  has  had  to  be  compressed  into  the  volume  now  before 
us.  The  space  is  quite  inadequate  for  a  clue  treatment  of  these  groups, 
especially  as  the  author  continues  to  devote  a  quarter  or  half  a  page 
to  the  synonymy  and  references  of  each  species  which  he  selects  for 
description.  Although  a  large  number  of  moths  are  described  and 
figured,  the  families  are  necessarily  much  more  cursorily  treated  than 
those  dealt  with  in  the  preceding  volumes.  For  example,  among  the 
noctuids  we  find  only  one  British  species,  each  of  such  large  genera  as 
Acronyeta,  Lcucaui/*,  and  Ayrotis,  and  not  a  single  representative  of 
Hadena ;  and  turning  to  the  geometers,  the  large  and  important 
genera  Eiipithecia  and  Cidaria  are  altogether  omitted.  As  for  the 
"  microlepidoptera,"  Mr  Kirby  states  in  his  preface  that  he  has  found 


1S97]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  207 

it  "  impossible  to  do  more  than  describe  and  figure  a  selection  of 
species  belonging  to  various  families." 

It  is  a  considerable  disappointment  to  find  that  in  his  classification 
of  the  noctuids  and  geometers,  Mr  Kirby  closely  follows  the  arrange- 
ment proposed  forty  years  ago  by  Guenee,  instead  of  availing  himself 
of  the  work  of  those  modern  writers  who  have  critically  studied  the 
structure  of  these  moths.  There  is  probably  hardly  a  serious  student 
of  the  noctuids  who  would  not  closely  associate  the  genera  which 
Guenee  distributed  between  his  two  "  families,"  Apameidae  and 
Hadenidae ;  yet  Mr  Kirby  treats  these  assemblages  as  sub-families, 
and  separates  them  widely  in  his  series.  It  is  sincerely  to  be  hoped 
that  in  the  coming  volumes  of  his  great  catalogue  of  the  lepidoptera 
Mr  Kirby  will  adopt  a  more  modern  classification.  Otherwise  the 
value  of  his  work  will  be  seriously  diminished. 

It  could  not  be  expected  that  much  space  would  be  devoted  to  the 
habits  of  the  moths  which  are  mentioned,  but  a  few  notes  of  consider- 
able interest  on  this  subject  are  given  by  Mr  Kirby.  He  has  rescued 
from  a  long  obscurity  an  account  published  in  1830  by  the  Eev.  L. 
Guilding  on  the  aquatic  larva  of  a  West  Indian  pearl-moth  (Petrophila 
fluviatilis).  He  also  calls  attention  to  de  Eiville's  account,  published 
nearly  one  hundred  and  fifty  years  ago,  of  a  Mediterranean  Antispila, 
whose  caterpillar  mines  in  vine  leaves. 

A  large  number  of  species  are  figured  in  the  coloured  plates,  a  good 
proportion  of  them  for  the  first  time.  Though  the  effect  of  some  of  the 
colouring  is  rough,  and  there  is  a  want  of  uniformity  in  the  setting  of 
the  specimen,  these  figures  will  be  helpful  for  the  determination  of 
species.  Mr  Kirby's  wide  knowledge  of  insects  and  their  literature 
must  needs  make  his  writings  useful  to  naturalists,  even  if  they  do 
not  care  to  adopt  all  the  changes  in  well-known  names  which  he 
believes  to  be  necessary.  G.  H.  C. 


A    BlBLIOGEAPHICAL    ENIGMA 

Manuel  de  Geograprie  botaxique.  Par  Oscar  Drude.  Traduit  par  Georges 
Poirault  et  revu  et  augmente  par  l'auteur.  Livraisons,  14-16.  8vo,  pp.  513-552, 
with  4  maps.     Paris  :  Klincksieck,  1897. 

We  are  glad  to  receive  this,  the  completion  of  a  useful  translation  and 
edition  of  Drude's  work  on  plant  geography.  The  previous  parts 
have  been  noticed  as  they  appeared ;  the  last  consists  chiefly  of  an 
exhaustive,  and  so  far  we  have  tested  it,  accurate  index,  a  list  of 
additions  and  corrections,  and  four  folding  maps.  The  price  of  the 
book  as  a  whole  is  18  francs.  While  commending  the  work,  we  must 
call  attention  to  a  serious  omission,  from  a  bibliographical  point  of 
view.  The  title  page,  just  issued,  bears  date  1897  ;  but  the  first  part 
appeared  in  June  1893,  and  the  remainder  at  various  dates  between 
1893  and  1897.  As  the  covers  of  the  individual  parts  all  bear  the 
same  date,  viz.,  1893,  and  as  there  is  no  reference  to  successive  dates 
in  the  text,  its  issue  in  parts  will  be  lost  sight  of,  and  the  whole  will 
seem  to  have  appeared  in  the  present  year.  Thus  another  puzzle 
will  be  added  to  the  future  bibliographer's  list — a  list  already  far  too 
long.     To  lessen  this  evil  as  far  as  possible  wTe  append  the  dates  of 


208  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [September 

notice  in  Natural  Science  of  the  individual  parts.  As  Natural  Science 
is  wont  to  be  prompt,  this  gives  a  very  fair  indication  of  the  dates  of 
publication  : — 

Part  1,  noticed  in  vol.  iii.,  p.  152  (Aug.  1893). 

Parts    2  and    3,  noticed  in  vol.     iv.,  p.  464  (June  1893). 

4  and    5,  „         vol.  vii.,  p.  214  (Sept.  1895). 

6  and    7,  „  „        p.  282  (Oct.    1895). 

8    to   10,  „  vol.  viii.,  p.    62  (Jan.   1896). 

„     11    to    13,         „  „        p.  393  (Dec.   1896). 


New  Serials 

We  learn  from  Science  that  the  Italian  Societa  Positivista  has 
established  a  bi-monthly  journal,  //  Pensiero  Moclerna,  published  at 
Via  Collegio  Romano  26  (Home  ?),  and  edited  by  Prof.  Sergi.  The 
object  of  the  society  is  to  demonstrate  the  importance  of  science  for 
modern  life. 

The  American  X-ray  Journal  is  edited  and  published  by  Dr  Heber 
Roberts,  St  Louis,  Mo.,  and  is  intended  for  the  medical  profession. 

We  may  mention  here  the  Bulletin  of  the  Geological  and  Natural 
History  Survey  of  the  Chicago  Academy  of  Sciences.  The  first  is  a 
monograph  of  the  lichens  of  Chicago  and  the  neighbourhood  by 
W.  W.  Calkins. 

Further  Literature  Received 

First  Principles  of  Natural  Philosophy,  A.  E.  Dolbear :  Giim,  Boston.  The 
Choniostomatidae.  H.  T.  Hansen  :  Host,  Copenhagen.  Euclid  (Books  i.-iv.),  and  The 
Tutorial  Trigonometry  :  Give.  System  der  Bakterien,  W.  Migula  :  Fischer,  Jena. 
Untersuchungen  liber  das  Erfrieren  der  Pflanzen,  H.  Molisch  :  Fischer.  Allgemeine 
Physiologie,  M.  Verworn,  ed.  2  :  Fischer.  Open-Air  Studies  in  Botany,  C.  Lloyd 
Praeger  :  Griffin.  Elementary  Biology,  T.  Jeffrey  Parker,  ed.  3  :  Macmillan.  Twenty- 
seventh  Ann.  Rep.  Entom.  Soc,  Ontario,  1896.  U.S.  Dept.  Agriculture,  Technical 
Series,  No.  6.  Ann.  Rep.  Manchester  Museum,  1S96-97.  Journ.  Inst.,  Jamaica,  vol. 
ii.,  No.  4.     First  Ann.  Rep.  Geol.  Commiss.,  Cape  of  Good  Hope,  1896. 

Crustacea  of  Norway,  G.  0.  Sars.  vol.  ii. ,  pts.  v.,  vi.  :  BergensMus.  The  Asparagus 
Beetles,  F.  H.  Chittenden  :  Ycar-Book  U.S.  Dcpt.  Agric.  Insect  Control  in  California, 
C.  L.  Marlatt :  ibid.  The  Use  of  Steam  Apparatus  for  Spraying,  L.  0.  Howard  :  ibid. 
The  Protective  Value  of  Action,  volitional  or  otherwise,  in  Protective  Mimicry,  F.  M. 
Webster:  Journ.  New  York  Entom.  Soc.  Biological  Effects  of  Civilization  on  the  Insect 
Fauna  of  Ohio,  F.  M.  Webster:  Ann.  Rep.  Ohio  State  Acad.  Sci. 

Jersey  Weekly  Press,  August  7  ;  Amcr.  Geol.,  August  ;  Amer.  Journ.  Sci.,  August ; 
Amer.  Nat.,  August  ;  l'Anthropologie,  May- June  ;  Botan.  Gazette,  June- July  ;  Feuille 
des  jeunes  Nat.,  August;  Irish  Nat.,  August;  Literary  Digest,  July  10,  17,2-1,31, 
August  7;  Naturae  Novit.,  No.  12,  June;  La  Naturaleza  (Madrid),  Nos.  20-22; 
Naturalist,  August  ;  Nature,  July  22,  29,  August  5,  12  :  Naturen,  June,  July  : 
Photogram,  July,  August  ;  Review  of  Reviews,  July,  and  do.  Australia,  May;  Revista 
Quind.  Psichologia,  &c,  vol.  i.,  fasc.  1-7  ;  Rev.  Scient.,  July  17,  24,  August  7,14: 
Science,  July  9,  16,  23,  30  ;  Sci.  Amer.,  July  10,  17,  24,  31,  August  7  ;  Scot.  Geogr. 
Mag.,  August  ;  Scot.  Med.  and  Surg.  Journ.,  August  ;  Froe.  Biol.  Soc,  Washington, 
vol.  xi.,  pp.  213-230  (July  15). 


1897]  209 


OBITUARIES 

Sib  John  Charles  Bucknill,  one  of  the  first  editors  of  Brain  and 
editor  of  the  Journal  of  Mental  Science  for  nine  years,  was,  at  the 
time  of  his  death  recently,  acting  in  the  capacity  of  Censor,  Councillor 
and  Lumleian  Lecturer  in  the  Royal  College  of  Physicians.  In  1866 
he  was  elected  Fellow  of  the  Royal  Society,  and  in  July  1894  he  was 
knighted.  He  produced  a  large  number  of  psychological  works, 
making  insanity  and  similar  subjects  a  specialty.  He  became 
especially  popular  through  his  psychological  essays  on  the  "  Mad  folk 
of  Shakespere." 

Mb  Samuel  Laing,  who  died  on  August  8th  at  the  advanced  age  of 
87  years,  was  formerly  chairman  of  the  Brighton  Railway  and  had  a 
lifelong  connection  with  railway  interests.  He  devoted  his  leisure  to 
scientific  pursuits,  and  his  principal  original  work  was  the  exploration 
of  the  prehistoric  refuse  heaps  of  Caithness,  which  he  described,  with 
the  aid  of  Prof.  Huxley,  in  1866.  During  recent  years  he  successfully 
devoted  himself  to  the  popularisation  of  science,  his  best  known  works 
being  entitled  "  Modern  Science  and  Modern  Thought  "  and  "  Human 
Origins." 


'6' 


The  death  of  Captain  Bertram  Lutley  Sclater  at  Zanzibar  on  July 
24th  will  excite  widespread  sympathy  among  English  naturalists  for 
his  father,  Dr  P.  L.  Sclater,  as  well  as  deep  regret  at  the  loss  of  an 
officer  whose  career  was  full  of  promise.  His  main  work  was  road- 
making  in  British  Central  and  British  East  Africa ;  during  which  he 
accomplished  many  careful  surveys.  His  maps  form  a  valuable 
addition  to  our  knowledge  of  the  geography  of  those  countries,  in  the 
future  development  of  which  the  work  which  cost  him  his  life  will 
play  an  important  part. 

Another  geographer  whose  death  cannot  pass  unnoticed  in  Natural 
Science  was  the  late  Ney  Elias,  a  man  whose  work,  though  popularly 
very  little  known,  was  of  such  importance  as  to  place  him  among  the 
greatest  English  travellers  of  this  century.  His  first  paper,  "  Notes  of 
a  Journey  to  the  New  Course  of  the  Yellow  River,"  is  one  of  the 
classics  of  physical  geography.  His  exploration  of  western 
Mongolia  during  a  journey  from  Pekin  to  Nijni  Novgorod  is  one  of 
the  six  great  feats  in  Asiatic  travel.  In  1885  he  settled  the  vexed 
question  as  to  the  sources  of  the  Oxus,  and  later  on  made  numerous 
less  famous  journeys  in  the  Indian  borderlands.  His  shyness  was  exces- 
sive, and  he  had  no  ambition  for  notoriety.  His  great  feats  are  recorded 
in  technical  geographical  papers,  but  these  will  live.  His  reputation 
as  a  traveller  will  probably  be  greater  in  a  century's  time  than  it  is 
to-day.  But  in  the  meanwhile  it  would  be  very  useful  if  his  papers 
were  collected  and  republished  with  some  sketch  of  his  life. 

p 


210  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [September 

The  death  is  announced  of  Theophile  Chudzinski  at  Paris  on  June 
18th,  aged  55.  By  birth  a  Pole,  he  studied  at  Moscow  until  the  insur- 
rection of  1863  caused  him  to  give  up  his  studies  and  join  in  the  move- 
ment. This  was  followed  by  an  incarceration  of  several  months  in 
Austria,  but  escaping  he  made  his  way  to  Belgium  and  subsequently 
to  France,  where  he  spent  the  rest  of  his  life.  It  was  in  pursuing  his 
anatomical  researches  that  he  was  first  noticed  by  Broca  at  Paris,  who 
later  gave  him  a  post  in  the  Laboratoire  d'Anthropologie  des  Hautes- 
Etudes.  For  several  years  Chudzinski  assisted  his  master  until  the 
latter's  death,  when  he  devoted  himself  to  anatomical  works,  particu- 
larly to  the  study  of  the  brain  and  the  anatomical  resemblances  and 
differences  between  that  of  man  and  of  the  anthropoid  apes.  A  large 
number  of  anthropological  and  anatomical  works  were  the  result  of 
his  minute  researches.  These,  although  edited  in  Paris,  were  not 
published  in  French. 

LuciEN  Biart,  who  died  recently,  was  a  talented  author,  and  although 
he  chose  to  veil  his  scientific  knowledge  in  the  form  of  novels,  that 
knowledge  was  incontestable.  A  great  love  of  travel  took  him  in 
1845  to  Mexico,  where  he  studied  archaeology  and  ethnography.  In 
addition  to  his  novels,  the  chief  of  which  are  "  Le  Eoi  des  Prairies," 
"  Entre  deux  Oceans,"  etc.,  he  wrote  a  volume  on  the  red  races  for  the 
Bibliotheque  ethnologique,  as  well  as  a  monograph  on  the  Aztecs. 

The  deaths  are  also  announced  of : — Paul  Schutzenbergee,  the  physiological 
chemist  of  the  College  de  France,  Paris,  aged  67  ;  P.  C.  Plugge,  Professor  of  Pharma- 
cology and  Toxicology  at  Gcittingen  ;  Arminio  Nobile,  Professor  of  Geodesy,  and  author 
of  many  valuable  papers  on  astronomy,  at  Rome  ;  Professor  Oertel  of  Munich,  dis- 
tinguished for  his  researches  on  the  etiology  of  diphtheria  ;  Alfred  Moquart,  Pro- 
fessor of  Anatomy  at  Brussels,  on  June  5,  aged  42  years  ;  Martin  Wilckens  of  the 
Agricultural  School  of  Vienna,  on  June  10,  aged  64  ;  Count  Victor  Trevisan  di 
San  Leon,  the  cryptogamist,  in  Milan,  on  April  8,  aged  79  years  ;  Robert  Douglas, 
known  for  his  work  in  arboriculture  and  forestry,  on  June  1,  at  Waukegan,  111.,  aged 
84  ;  G.  Ossowski,  the  geologist,  on  April  16,  at  Tomsk  ;  P.  B.  L.  Verlot,  botanist, 
at  Verrieres-les-Buisson  ;  Rev.  Robert  Hunter,  botanist,  on  Feb.  25,  at  Eppiug 
Forest,  aged  74  ;  Samuel  James  Augustus  Salter,  botanist,  on  Feb.  28,  at  Basing- 
stoke, aged  72  ;  Geheimrat  Heydenreich,  student  of  Lepidoptera,  on  May  18,  at 
Osnabruck  ;  the  coleopterologist,  Daniel  Muller,  on  May  22,  at  Barcelona ;  the 
oologist,  C.  Q.  Aschan,  schoolmaster  at  Kuopio,  Finland  ;  Dr  Anders  Johan 
Malmgren,  a  well-known  ichthyologist  and  student  of  Annelida,  of  Uleaborg,  Finland  ; 
Dr  Wolfert  and  a  mechanic  named  Knabe,  who  fell  while  sailing  at  a  height  of  1000 
feet  in  a  navigable  balloon,  at  Tempelhof,  near  Berlin  ;  Ferdinand  Beclard,  palaeon- 
tologist at  the  Brussels  Museum,  who  was  in  the  midst  of  important  studies  of  Devonian 
brachiopods  ;  R.  Allan  Wight,  the  economic-entomologist  of  Paerva,  near  Auckland, 
N.Z.,  on  the  22nd  December  1896,  aged  73  years  ;  Michael  Angelo  Console,  professor 
in  Palermo  University,  and  well-known  as  a  cactus-hunter,  on  May  13,  aged  85  ; 
Peter  von  Tunner,  of  the  mining  district  of  Leoben,  on  June  8,  aged  89  years  ; 
Dominik  Hofer,  the  veterinarian  of  Munich  University,  on  June  13,  aged  80;  Dr 
Jules  Jullien  of  Havre,  the  zoologist  (Bryozoa)  ;  Charles  F.  Wells  and  J.  W. 
Jones,  who  were  exploring  the  West- Australian  deserts,  killed  by  the  natives  in  June  ; 
Friedrich  C.  Straub,  the  botanist,  at  Liberia,  on  March  21,  aged  26  ;  Alfred 
Sutton,  of  the  well-known  firm  of  J.  Sutton  &  Sons,  Reading,  on  August  9,  aged  80. 


18971  2l1 

i 


NEWS 

The  following  appointments  are  announced  : — 
Henry  Charles  Williamson,  as  Naturalist  to  the  Fishery  Board  for  Scotland  ; 
W.  W.  Watts,  of  the  Geological  Survey,  as  assistant-professor  of  geology  in  the 
Mason  College,  Birmingham  ;  Miss  Bertha  Stoneman  as  professor  of  botany  in 
the  Huguenot  College  for  Women  at  Cape  Town  ;  Dr  Edward  Fischer  to  succeed 
his  father,  Prof.  L.  Fischer  (retired),  as  professor  of  botany  in  the  University  of 
Bern  ;   Dr  Julius  Paoletti  of  Padua  to  be  professor  of  natural  history  at  the 
Melfi  Technical  Institute  ;  Dr  Pio  Bolson  as  second  assistant  in  the  Botanical 
Garden  of  Padua  ;  Dr  M.  Raciborski  of  Cracow  and  Dr  Zehntner  of  Pasoeroean 
(Java)  to  be  professors  of  botany  and  entomology  at  the  experimental  station  for 
sugar  production  at  Kagok  Tegal  (Java) ;  Hugo  Miinsterberg  of   Freiburg  as 
professor  of  psychology  in  Harvard  University  ;  Dr  Antonio  Crocichia  as  pro- 
fessor of  biology  in  the  Catholic  University  of  Washington  ;  Dr  H.  Fling  to  the 
chair  of   biology,    F.    A.  Mitchell  to   the   chair  of  geography,    and   Dr   F.  D. 
Sherman  to  the  chair  of  psychology  at  the  Oshkosh  Normal  School  ;  Ernest  B. 
Forbes  as  assistant  state  entomologist  in  Minnesota  ;  Dr  C.  E.  Beecher  as  pro- 
fessor of  historical  geology  at  Yale  University  ;  Dr  L.  V.  Pirsson  as  professor  of 
physical  geology  in  the  Lawrence  Scientific  School  ;  Dr  Geo.  B.  Shattuck  as 
assistant  in  geology  at  Johns  Hopkins  University  ;  Oliver  L.  Fassig  as  instructor 
in  climatology,  and  Dr  Charles  R.  Bardeen  as  assistant  in  anatomy  at  the  same 
University  ;  Dr  Albert  Schneider  as  professor  of  botany,  pharmacognosy  and 
materia  medica  in  the  School  of  Pharmacy  of  the  North-Western  University, 
Chicago  ;    E.  B.  Copeland,  of  the   University   of  Wisconsin,   to   be   assistant- 
professor  of  botany  in  the  University  of  Indiana  ;  Dr  G.  J.  Pierce  to  be  assistant- 
professor  of  botany  in  Stanford  University  ;  Henry  Kraemer  to  the  chair  of 
botany  and  microscopy  in  the  Philadelphia  College  of  Pharmacy  ;   Cleveland 
Abbe,  jun.,  as  a  fellow  in  geology  of  Johns  Hopkins  University. 

Sir  Frederick  McCoy  has  retired  from  his  professorship  in  the  University 
of  Melbourne. 

Mr  A.  W.  Bennett  has  succeeded  Prof.  Jeffrey  Bell  as  editor  of  the  Journal 
of  the  Royal  Microscopical  Society. 

Mr  C.  Da  vies  Sherborn  has  resigned  the  secretaryship  of  the  Geologists' 
Association  of  London,  and  will  be  succeeded  in  October  by  Mr  Percy  Emary. 

Mr  C.  W.  Andrews  should  have  arrived  at  Christmas  Island  before  this 
number  appears.     He  left  Batavia  about  the  21st  July  on  Mr  Ross's  schooner. 

The  Irish  Field  Club  Union  held  their  annual  excursion  in  July  around  the 
north  coast  of  Antrim,  making  Ballycastle  Bay  their  headquarters. 

Mr  R.  T.  Gunther  is  on  his  way  to  Lake  Urumiya  on  the  Persian  frontier,  to 
study  the  fauna  of  that  lake.  We  regret  to  hear  that  he  has  had  a  temporary 
breakdown  in  health,  and  hope  he  will  soon  recover  and  proceed  on  his  way. 

We  learn  from  the  Revue  Scientifique  that  it  is  proposed  to  found  an  experi- 
mental station  in  Madagascar,  for  the  introduction  of  European  cereals  and  the 
improvement  of  local  vegetable  produce. 


212  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [September 

Lady  Humphry,  widow  of  the  late  Sir  George  Humphry,  Professor  of 
Surgery  at  Cambridge,  has  presented  her  husband's  library  to  the  surgical 
department  of  the  university. 

On  July  8th,  the  Geographical  Institute  of  Lisbon,  founded  in  commemora- 
tion of  the  400th  anniversary  of  Vasco  da  Gama's  departure  for  the  Indies,  was 
opened  by  the  Geological  Society  of  Portugal. 

The  German  Botanical  Society  begins  its  annual  meeting  at  Brunswick  on 
September  21  at  the  same  time  as  the  German  Association  of  Naturalists  and 
Physicians.     There  will  be  an  exhibition  of  scientific  apparatus. 

Prof.  Gustav  Born,  of  Breslau,  has  received  the  Sommering  prize  from  the 
Senckenberg  Society  of  Natural  History  at  Frankfurt  for  his  investigations  on 
the  growth  of  the  larvae  of  amphibia. 

In  the  absence  of  Prof.  Biitschli,  Prof.  V.  Carus  presided  over  the  annual 
meeting  of  the  German  Zoological  Society  at  Kiel,  June  9-11.  There  were  present 
thirty-seven  members  and  thirteen  guests.  The  next  meeting  will  be  held  at 
Heidelberg  at  Whitsuntide,  1898. 

Dr  Henry  Woodward,  keeper  of  the  department  of  geology  in  the  British 
Museum  (Natural  History),  has  been  permitted  by  the  Treasury  to  retain  his 
office  for  another  two  years.  According  to  the  rules  of  retirement  in  the  Civil 
Service,  his  term  of  service  would  have  expired  next  November. 

The  Darwin  statue  at  Shrewsbury  was  duly  unveiled,  and  stands  in  front  of 
the  Free  Library.  It  is  the  work  of  a  Shrewsbury  man,  Mr  Horace  Mountford, 
is  said  to  be  an  excellent  likeness,  and  is  the  gift  of  the  Shropshire  Horticultural 
Society. 

Professors  D.  T.  Macdougal  and  Campbell,  representing  a  Commission  from 
the  American  Universities,  have  visited  Jamaica  with  a  view  of  founding  there  a 
botanical  research  laboratory.  Other  Commissioners  have  gone  to  Trinidad.  On 
their  return  to  the  United  States  they  will  compare  notes  as  to  the  best  locality 
and  come  to  a  decision. 

Mr  George  Murray  and  Mr  V.  H.  Blackman  have  returned  from  their  trip 
to  Panama,  after  a  successful  and  profitable  voyage.  They  have  obtained  a  large 
quantity  of  plankton  containing  many  new  specimens,  which  will  shortly  be 
worked  out,  and  have  made  numerous  interesting  observations  on  living  forms. 
They  spent  two  or  three  days  in  Jamaica  on  the  way. 

According  to  Science,  Mr  B.  W.  Porter  and  Mr  A.  V.  Shand,  who  are  with 
Lieut.  Peary,  expect  to  pass  the  winter  in  Baffin  Land  for  the  purpose  of  ethno- 
logical and  zoological  studies  and  collections.  In  the  summer  of  1898  they  hope 
to  travel  further  north  and  to  return  to  Aberdeen  on  a  whaling  ship  from  Cum- 
berland Sound. 

The  first  meeting  of  the  Jersey  Natural  Science  Association  was  held  on 
August  5,  Dr  A.  C.  Godfray  in  the  chair.  The  attendance  was  small  but 
enthusiastic,  and  included  many  well-known  names.  We  wish  the  Association 
every  success,  but  hope  they  will  not  find  the  usual  trouble  arising  from  the  pro- 
posed library  and  museum. 

Among  those  visiting  Russia  during  the  meeting  of  the  Seventh  International 
Geological  Congress  at  St  Petersburg  are  :— Dr  John  Ball,  Mr  L.  Belinfante,  Mr 
F.  A.  Bather,  Prof.  J.  F.  Blake,  Mr  J.  H.  Cooke,  Mr  P.  Emary,  Mr  L.  Fletcher,  Sir 
Archibald  Geikie,  Mr  Upfield  Green,  Mr  G.  F.  Harris,  Dr  Frazer  Hume,  Prof. 
M'Kenny  Hughes,  Mr  Philip  Lake,  Mr  D.  A.  Louis,  Mr  Henry  Louis,  Prof. 
Sollas,  Dr  P.  L.  Sclater,  Mr  G.  A.  Stonier,  Mr  J.  J.  H.  Teall,  Prof.  II.  G.  Seeley, 
Mr  H.  Bauerman,  and  Dr  Wheelton  Hind. 


1897]  NEWS  213 

The  British  Museum  (Natural  History)  has  acquired  the  Savin  collection  of 
vertebrate  remains  from  the  Norfolk  forest-bed  and  other  deposits  of  that  coast. 
A  collection  of  gault  fossils  from  the  300  feet  level  of  the  shaft  of  the  Dover  coal- 
field has  also  been  received,  and  Ave  understand  that  the  whole  of  the  remains 
from  this  very  interesting  and  important  shaft  will  be  preserved  for  the  national 
collections,  as  a  typical  reference  series  for  the  underground  geology  of  the  S.E. 
of  England. 

The  new  Botanical  Garden  of  New  York  will  be  on  an  imposing  scale, 
rivalling  the  new  Zoological  Garden  which  Dr  Sclater  recently  described  in  these 
pages  (Natural  Science,\ol.  xi.,  p.  36).  The  coniferous  trees  will  occupy  thirty  acres, 
the  deciduous  trees  more  than  seventy  acres  ;  the  space  for  the  herbaceous  plants 
will  be  not  less  than  eight  acres,  while  the  bog-plants  alone  will  cover  five  acres. 
The  area  of  the  lakes  and  ponds  will  be  six  acres.  The  museum  will  have  a 
frontage  of  300  feet,  with  two  wings,  each  200  feet  in  length. 

We  learn  from  Science  that  an  important  change  has  been  effected  in  the 
administration  of  the  U.S.  National  Museum.  Acting  upon  the  advice  of  Hon. 
Chas.  D.  Walcott,  at  present  assistant-secretary  of  the  Smithsonian  Institute, 
three  sections  have  been  formed — the  section  of  anthropology,  with  Dr  W.  H. 
Holmes,  of  the  Field  Columbian  Museum  of  Chicago,  as  head  curator  ;  that  of 
geology,  with  head  curator  Dr  George  Merrill ;  and  of  biology,  with  Dr  Frederick 
W.  True  as  curator. 

Harvard  University  has  received  under  the  will  of  Mr  A.  W.  Thayer 
$30,000  as  an  endowment  fund  to  assist  poor  students.  University  College, 
Liverpool,  receives  £7000  as  becpxest  from  Mrs  Gee  for  the  advancement  of  the 
medical  department.  It  has  been  decided  to  institute  a  Bobert  Gee  fellowship  in 
anatomy  of  £100  a  year  and  four  entrance  scholarships  of  £25  each  for  one  year. 
Yale  University  receives  land  valued  at  $25,000  by  the  will  of  Dr  J.  T.  Atwater 
of  Foughkeepsie  ;  and  the  Ohio  State  University  an  estate  left  by  the  late  Mr 
Henry  F.  Page. 

The  following  have  received  awards  from  the  Academy  of  Sciences  at  Berlin 
to  assist  them  in  their  researches  : — Prof.  Engler,  2000M.  (for  African  botany)  ; 
Dr  B.  Hesse,  500M.  (eyes  of  lower  marine  animals) ;  Prof.  H.  Hiirthle,  850M. 
(muscles)  ;  Prof.  Cohen,  1500M.  (meteorites)  ;  Dr  G.  Lindau,  900M.  (lichens)  ; 
Prof.  B.  Bonnet,  800M.  (for  a  work  on  blood-vessels)  ;  Dr  L.  Wulff,  1500M. 
(artificial  crystals)  ;  Dr  Liihe,  2000M.  (fauna  of  North  African  salt  lakes)  ;  Prof. 
F.  Freeh,  1500M.  (geology) ;  and  Dr  G.  Brandes,  300M.  (Nemertina). 

The  Lancet  announces  that  Prof.  Engelmann,  the  successor  of  Dr  du  Bois- 
Beymond  as  Professor  of  Physiology  at  Berlin,  is  about  to  make  some  alterations 
in  the  Institute.  Of  the  four  departments,  those  for  microscopical  and  biological 
work  and  for  chemical  physiology  will  continue  with  their  present  directors. 
Prof.  Engelmann  intends  to  enlarge  the  department  for  special  physiology,  and 
to  share  the  work  of  direction  with  Dr  Hermann  Munk.  The  department  for 
physical  physiology  will  for  the  future  be  known  as  the  Department  for  the 
Physiology  of  the  Sensory  Nerves.  Prof.  Konig,  director  of  the  last-mentioned 
department,  will  lecture  upon  the  sensory  organs  during  the  last  four  weeks  of 
summer,  and  Prof.  Thierfelder,  of  the  department  for  chemical  physiology,  during 
the  first  four  weeks  of  winter,  on  physiological  chemistry. 

The  Fifty-Eighth  Annual  Beport  of  the  Boyal  Botanic  Society  shows  a  much 
more  favourable  prospect.  The  lease  of  the  Gardens  in  Begents  Park  has  been  re- 
newed for  a  further  term  of  twenty-one  years.  The  Council  has  decided  to  open  a 
school  of  practical  gardening,  granting  certificates  to  gardeners,  and  the  material 


214  NATURAL    SCIENCE  •       [September 

for  practice  is  assuredly  ready  to  hand.  This  new  school  has  been  officially  recog- 
nised by  the  Technical  Education  Board,  who  have  voted  £100  to  the  Society  in 
aid  of  the  scheme.  The  Council  further  intends  to  establish  an  institute  for  the 
teaching  of  botany  and  for  promoting  original  research  ;  but  as  this  is  a  bold  and 
ambitious  scheme,  outside  aid  will  be  necessary  to  give  it  a  practical  effect. 

M.  Henri  de  la  Vaulx,  now  travelling  in  Patagonia,  has  written  to  the 
Societe"  de  Geographie  de  Paris  from  Rawson,  the  capital  of  Chubut.  He  has 
visited  the  Monsonero  Indians,  where  he  has  found  a  tolderia  18  leagues  south  of 
Keurskeule.  The  cacique,  Sayhueke,  received  him  with  great  cordiality,  and  he 
witnessed  a  komaruko,  a  religious  fete.  M.  de  la  Vaulx  has  made  an  ethno- 
graphical collection  and  taken  some  photographs.  On  the  shore  of  Lake  Colhue 
the  explorer  discovered  ancient  stone  sepulchres,  in  which  he  found  a  skeleton 
almost  perfect,  as  well  as  ten  skulls  of  Telhuelche  Indians.  There  were  a  large 
number  of  arrowheads,  knives,  and  stone  boleadoros.  These  discoveries  will  prove 
of  great  importance  to  the  study  of  the  ancient  peoples  of  Chubut. 

In  connection  with  the  South-Eastern  Union  of  Scientific  Societies,  a  section  for 
geological  photographs  has  just  been  established.  Its  objects  are  : — (1)  To  stimu- 
late interest  in  the  observation  and  recording  of  geological  phenomena  ;  (2)  to 
form  annually  a  set  of  lantern  slides  dealing  with  some  part  of  the  geology  of  the 
south-east  of  England,  and  to  circulate  these,  with  an  explanatory  lecture,  among 
the  affiliated  societies  during  the  winter  session  ;  (3)  to  form  a  permanent  collec- 
tion of  geological  slides  and  photographs  ;  (4)  to  contribute  to  the  national 
collection  of  geological  photographs  now  being  formed  at  the  Jermyn  Street 
Museum  under  the  auspices  of  the  British  Association.  Particulars  as  to  the 
work  may  be  obtained  from  Mr  H.  E.  Turner,  the  hon.  secretary,  Bank  Street, 
Ashford,  Kent. 

The  Bill  which  the  Duke  of  Devonshire  presented  to  the  House  of  Lords 
concerning  the  University  of  London  has  been  withdrawn  for  the  Session.  It 
proposes  to  appoint  the  following  Commissioners  : — Lord  Davey  (chairman),  the 
Bishop  of  London,  Lord  Lister,  Sir  William  Roberts,  M.D.,  Sir  Owen  Roberts, 
Professor  Jebb,  and  Mr  E.  H.  Busk,  whose  powers  continue  till  Dec.  31,  1898, 
and  whose  duty  is  "to  make  statutes  and  regulations  for  the  University  of 
London  in  general  accordance  with  the  scheme  of  the  report "  presented  by  the 
previous  Commissioners,  with  any  "  modification  which  may  appear  to  them  ex- 
pedient after  considering  the  changes  which  have  taken  place  in  London  educa- 
tion of  a  university  type  since  the  date  of  the  report,  &c."  The  Bill  provides  that 
"after  the  expiration  of  the  powers  of  the  Commissioners,  the  Senate  of  the 
University  shall  have  power  to  make  statutes  and  regulations  for  altering  or 
supplementing  any  of  the  statutes  or  regulations  made  by  the  Commissioners." 
The  Senate,  consisting  of  the  Chancellor  and  fifty-five  other  members,  to  be 
nominated  by  the  Crown  and  certain  learned  and  public  bodies,  "  shall  be  the 
supreme  governing  body  and  executive  of  the  University.  All  University  pro- 
perty shall  be  administered  by  the  Senate,  and  the  Senate  shall  have  the  entire 
conduct  of  the  University  and  all  its  affairs  and  functions,  provided  always  that 
no  religious  test  shall  be  adopted,  and  no  applicant  for  a  University  appointment 
shall  be  at  any  disadvantage  on  the  ground  of  religious  opinions  ;  no  procedure 
to  a  higher  degree  shall  be  allowed  without  examination  or  other  adequate  test, 
nor  shall  any  honorary  or  ad  etindem  degree  be  conferred  unless  the  Senate,  in 
exceptional  cases,  think  fit  to  confer  such  a  degree  on  a  teacher  of  the  University  ; 
no  disability  shall  be  imposed  on  the  ground  of  sex." 


1897]  215 


CORRESPONDENCE 

WOMEN  WITH  BEARDS 

The  idea  of  the  woman  of  the  future  having  a  beard,  noticed  in  Natural  Science,  vol. 
xi.,  p.  2,  as  set  forth  by  Dr  A.  Brandt,  is  scarcely  new.  If  it  is  not  definitely  stated 
by  Darwin  in  his  "  Descent  of  Man,"  at  any  rate  it  is  an  obvious  conclusion  from  what 
he  has  to  say  concerning  the  appearance  of  distinctive  masculine  characters,  such  as 
horns,  sometimes  in  the  male  sex  only,  sometimes  in  both  sexes.  The  appearance  of  the 
beard  in  Homo  is  quite  analogous  to  that  of  horns  in  other  animals  ;  and  just  as  horns 
have  apparently  been  acquired  b}r  the  females  of  certain  species  by  what  may  be  called 
"inherited  transference  "  from  the  males,  so  will  beards  be  obtained  in  time  by  the 
future  females  of  Homo. 

I  thought  I  had  actually  drawn  attention  to  this  matter  of  beards  in  "Some  Laws 
of  Heredity"  (Proc.  Cotteswold  Field  Club,  vol.  x.,  1892),  but  I  cannot  find  it.  I 
had  it  and  the  case  of  horns,  etc.,  in  my  mind  when  I  wrote  therein  (p.  275),  "A 
marked  character  of  the  male  sex  .  .  .  being  transmitted  in  accordance  with  the  law 
of  earlier  inheritance,  ultimately  appears  early  in  life  in  the  male.  Then  the  character 
tends  to  appear  in  the  female  sex  also,  though  why  it  does  so  is  not  clear."  Also  the 
transference  may  be  from  female  to  male,  which  would  appear  to  be  the  case  with 
rudimentary  mamma  in  the  male  of  Homo. 

Let  me  point  out  another  biological  aspect  of  the  case  : — Facial  hairiness  is  ex- 
hibited more  by  the  unmarried  than  by  the  married  women.  It  seems  that  each  woman 
receives  from  her  male  parent  latent  beard-characters.  If  she  have  children  she 
certainly  transmits  such  characters  to  them.  If  she  has  no  offspring  it  seems  that  the 
characters  tend  to  develop  in  her  own  person.  So  it  will  be  in  the  old  woman,  and  not 
in  the  "new  woman  "  of  the  future,  that  the  beard  will  be  most  prominent — a  startling 
retribution  that  the  most  masculine  characters  should  appear  in  those  who  are  the 
greatest  old  maids.  S.  S.  Buckman. 

Cheltenham. 


CHEMISTRY  IN  MUSEUMS 

In  his  notice  of  the  "  Report  of  the  Proceedings  of  the  Museums  Association,"  1896 
(Natural  Science,  voL  xi.,  p.  132),  Dr  R.  H.  Traquair,  after  referring  to  my  paper  on 
"  Chemistry  in  Museums  "  as  carrying  "  the  educational  theory  of  museums  to  a  pitch 
of  absurdity,"  goes  on  to  say:  "  A  collection  of  metals,  salts,  &c,  is  no  doubt  a  desirable 
feature  in  connection  with  the  chemical  department  of  a  school  or  college,  but  you  will 
learn  chemistry  only  in  the  laboratory,  and  certainly  not  in  a  museum."  The  phrase 
"pitch  of  absurdity  "  is  too  often  on  the  lips  and  on  the  pen  points  of  scientific  men,  and 
coming  from  the  quarter  whence  it  does  is  only  a  too  effective  means  of  killing  sugges- 
tions which  might  possibly  lead  to  beneficial  improvements.  As  to  the  sentence  I  have 
quoted,  one  might  generalise  in  the  same  heedless  fashion  about  any  of  the  sciences 
which  museums  seek  to  illustrate.  But  it  is  not  intended  in  these  institutions  to  supply 
a  complete  course  of  study  in  any  branch  of  science,  but  to  place  such  illustrations  of 
them  before  the  public  as  will  be  helpful  to  those  interested  in  the  study.  Hundreds  of 
cases  of  stuffed  birds  and  mammals  will  not  teach  the  science  of  zoology  ;  all  the  dried 
plants  and  wood  sections  in  the  museums  of  Europe  will  not  teach  the  science  of  botany, 
nor  can  we  learn  palaeontology  by  looking  at  a  fossil  Glyptolaemus  in  a  museum  case. 
These  sciences  also  can  only  be  "learnt  in  the  laboratory."  Would  Dr  Traquair  on 
that  account  refuse  the  stuffed  bird  or  mammal,  the  dried  plant  and  the  fossil,  a  place 
in  the  museum  ?  Do  not  the  many  mineralogical  cases  which  litter  the  floors  of  museums 
contain  simply  "a  collection  of  metals,  salts,  &c."  ?  and  these  teach,  if  they  teach  any- 
thing at  all,  a  very  little  of  the  science  of  chemistry.  Is  Dr  Traquair  of  opinion  that  a 
good  artificial  crystal  of  common  salt  is  of  less  educational  value  than  an  indifferent 
natural  crystal  of  Halite  ? 

At  the  time  when  my  paper  was  written  I  was  fresh  from  the  laboratory  of  a  tech- 
nical college,  and  thought  I  saw  a  way  to  help  not  only  the  laboratory  student,  but 
also  that  larger  class  which  is  interested  in  science  but  cannot  obtain  access  to  the 
laboratories.  I  did  not,  be  it  observed,  advocate  the  formation  of  a  new  museum  de- 
partment ;  I  merely  asked  for  the  re-arrangement  and  extension  of  a  department  already 
existing  in  some  museums.    In  the  Edinburgh  Museum  of  Science  and  Art,  for  instance, 


216  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [September 

there  is,  as  far  as  case-room  is  concerned,  a  very  fair  section  devoted  to  the  illustration 
of  chemical  science,  hut  the  arrangement  followed  is  so  antiquated,  and  the  specimens 
are  so  few — many  of  the  cases  are  almost  empty — and  so  little  representative,  that  the 
whole  thing  is  distinctly  farcical. 

It  seems  to  me  that  men  like  Dr  Traquair,  looking  down  from  a  great  height  on  the 
unscientific  rabble,  are  too  much  in  the  habit  of  dividing  the  population  into  three 
classes — scientific  men,  who  have  little  use  for  museums  ;  science  students,  who  have 
their  manuals  and  their  laboratories  ;  and  the  general  public,  who  have  to  be  amused 
with  stuffed  animals  and  big  crystals.  They  forget  that  large  and  increasing  class,  who 
are  the  main  support  of  such  papers  as  Knowledge,  Science  Gossip,  and  even  Natural 
Science,  who  look,  and  have  a  right  to  look,  to  museums  to  illustrate  their  reading.  It 
is  for  this  class  that  museums  must  cater  more  and  more.  The  museum  of  the  future, 
if  it  is  to  be  of  any  educational  value  whatever,  must  become  the  laboratory,  the 
technical  college,  the  university,  of  those  who  have  to  earn  a  livelihood  by  their  hands. 
Consequently  the  formation  of  such  a  collection  as  I  advocated,  were  it  only  in  view  of 
its  importance  as  an  adjunct  to  the  evening  lecturer,  is  an  absolute  necessity. 

Kelvingrove  Museum,  Glasgow.  George  W.  Ord. 


Several  correspondents  have  noted  an  unfortunate  misprint  which  escaped  correction 
in  the  June  number  (vol.  x.,  p.  427,  line  34),  where  "a  cross  between  Myxine  and  the 
cod  "  ought  to  read  "  a  cross  between  the  megrim  and  the  cod." 


NOTICE. 

To  Contributors. — All  Communications  to  be  addressed  to  the  Editor  of  Natural 
Science,  at  67  St  James'  Street,  London,  S.W.  Correspondence  and  Notes  intended 
for  any  particular  month  should  be  sent  in  not  later  than  the  10th  of  the  preceding 
month. 

To  the  Trade. — Natural  Science  is  published  on  the  25th  of  each  month  ;  all 
advertisements  should  be  in  the  Publishers'  hands  not  later  than  the  20th. 

To  our  Subscribers  and  Others. — There  are  now  published  Ten  Volumes  of 
Natural  Science.  Nos.  1,  8,  11,  12,  13,  20,  23,  24  being  out  of  print,  can  only  be 
supplied  in  the  set  of  first  Four  Volumes.  All  other  Nos.  can  still  be  supplied  at  One 
Shilling  each. 

Price  of  Set  of  Vols.  I.,  II.,  III.,  IV £2  10     0 

„      V.,  VI.,  VII.,  VIII.         .         .         .14     0 
,,      I.— VIII 3  10     0 

One  Shilling  each  Number  of  any  Bookseller. 

Annual  Subscription,  payable  in  advance  to  J.  M.  Dent  &  Co.,  67  St  James's  Street, 
London,  S.W.,  Thirteen  Shillings  ($3  "50),  post  free. 


NATURAL  SCIENCE 

A  Monthly  Review  of  Scientific  Progress 


No.  68— Vol.  XI— OCTOBEE   1897 


NOTES  AND  COMMENTS 

The  Training  of  the  Biologist 

The  most  striking  feature  of  late  in  the  study  of  animals,  at  least  in 
this  country,  is  the  marked  tendency  of  the  orthodox  school  of 
teachers  to  break  through  the  narrow  bounds  which  have  confined 
them  since  '  Biology '  replaced  the  old-fashioned  natural  history 
and  comparative  anatomy.  It  is,  indeed,  strange  that  while  the 
methods  of  Darwin  have  had  such  an  immense  influence  upon  the 
lines  of  advanced  work  and  research,  they  should  have  had  so  little 
effect  upon  the  curriculum  of  elementary  teaching.  As  Prof.  Miall 
well  said  in  his  recent  address  to  Section  I)  of  the  British  Asso- 
ciation, "  the  animals  set  before  the  young  zoologist  are  all  dead ;  it 
is  much  if  they  are  not  pickled  as  well.  When  he  studies  their 
development,  he  works  chiefly  or  altogether  upon  continuous  sections, 
embryos  mounted  in  balsam  and  wax  models.  He  is  rarely  encouraged 
to  observe  live  tadpoles  or  third-day  chicks  with  beating  hearts.  As 
for  what  Gilbert  White  calls  the  life  and  conversation  of  animals, 
how  they  defend  themselves,  feed,  and  make  love,  this  is  commonly 
passed  over  as  a  matter  of  curious  but  not  very  important  informa- 
tion ;  it  is  not  reputed  scientific,  or  at  least  not  eminently  scientific." 
Finally,  as  to  the  inter-relationships  of  animals,  the  average  graduate 
of  the  orthodox  university  school  is  in  a  state  approaching  blissful 
ignorance.  He  is  usually  led,  if  not  actually  taught,  to  look  down 
with  scorn  upon  the  '  systematist.'  He  imagines  he  has  mastered 
the  whole  of  the  principles  of  Biology  before  he  has  acquired  the 
most  elementary  notions  of  generic  and  specific  characters  and  the 
phenomena  of  variation. 

There  have  been  two  noteworthy  utterances  on  this  subject 
during  the  past  month,  that  of  Prof.  Miall  in  his  Presidential 
Address  already  referred  to,  and  that  of  Mr  Walter  Garstang  in  the 
last  number  of  the  Quarterly  Journal  of  Microscopical  Science  (vol. 
xl.,  p.  211).  Both  urge  that  the  time  has  arrived  for  some  reform 
in  the  methods  of  elementary  training,  and  we  commend  their  plea 

Q 


218  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [October 

to  the  careful  consideration  of  all  teachers  interested  in  the  future 
progress  of  biological  science. 

Mr  Garstang  gives  a  practical  illustration  of  the  importance  of 
the  study  of  living  animals  in  his  interesting  paper  "  on  some  modi- 
fications of  structure  subservient  to  respiration  in  Decapod  Crustacea 
which  burrow  in  sand."  It  is  to  this  that  his  general  remarks  are 
prefaced,  as  follows  : — 

"  A  good  deal  of  scepticism  has  been  expressed  in  recent  years 
by  various  writers  as  to  the  utility  of  the  more  trivial  features  which 
distinguish  the  genera  and  species  of  animals  from  one  another.  I 
do  not  think  that  such  scepticism  can  excite  much  surprise  if  one 
remembers  that  the  vast  majority  of  '  biologists '  are  almost  ex- 
clusively engaged  in  the  study  of  comparative  anatomy  and  embry- 
ology. The  amount  of  attention  paid  to  these  branches  of  biology 
has  long  been  utterly  out  of  proportion  to  the  scant  attention 
devoted  to  the  scientific  study  of  the  habits  of  animals  and  of  the 
function  of  the  organs  and  parts  composing  their  bodies.  With 
isolated  and  noteworthy  exceptions,  the  only  naturalists  who 
seriously  add  to  our  knowledge  of  the  latter  subjects  are  those  who 
travel  in  distant  countries,  and  who  are  thus  thrown  into  close  re- 
lations with  animals  in  their  native  haunts.  Yet  all  the  time  there 
are  thousands  of  forms  living  on  our  own  coasts  and  almost  at  our 
very  doors  of  whose  detailed  habits  and  life-conditions  we  know 
practically  nothing.  I  venture  to  think  that  the  time  has  come 
for  consideration  whether  the  subject  of  bionomics  (in  Prof. 
Lankester's  sense  of  the  word)  should  not  receive  more  adequate 
recognition  than  it  does  at  present  in  the  curriculum  of  our  univer- 
sities. That  such  recognition  would  almost  immediately  produce 
effects  in  a  rapid  extension  of  our  knowledge  is  certain  ;  and  the 
subject  is  invested  with  so  much  intrinsic  interest,  as  well  as  with 
such  important  bearings  on  the  problems  of  evolution,  that  I  believe 
such  recognition  would  also  have  the  effect  of  attracting  many 
students  to  the  pursuit  of  morphology  who  at  present  avoid  it  as  a 
region  of  mere  comparative  anatomy.   .  .   . 

"  It  must  in  any  event,  however,  remain  clear  that  the  great 
problems  which  Darwin  left  us  as  his  heritage,  after  so  greatly 
illuminating  them,  are  not  to  be  solved  by  the  exclusively  morpho- 
graphical  researches  which  occupy  the  time  and  zeal  of  the  great 
majority  of  naturalists  to-day.  Even  in  the  best  of  hands  such 
researches  are  capable  of  obscuring  even  the  simple  facts  of  structure 
which  they  profess  to  elucidate ;  while  the  study  of  the  functional 
relations  of  parts,  side  by  side  with  the  anatomical  elucidation  of 
the  parts  themselves,  provides  not  only  the  data  for  generalisations 
of  intrinsic  importance,  but  assistance  of  an  invaluable  character  in 
the  field  of  morphological  criticism." 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  219 

The  Historical  Method  in  Teaching  Biology 

Prof.  Miall,  in  his  Presidential  Address,  not  only  emphasises 
the  importance  of  the  study  of  living  animals  in  a  manner  that  will 
scarcely  bear  abstracting,  he  also  adds  another  important  sugges- 
tion, that  too  little  attention  is  bestowed  by  biological  teachers  upon 
the  historical  development  of  the  subject.  Many  students  attend 
the  lectures  and  demonstrations  simply  because  they  are  compelled 
to  do  so  by  the  college  curriculum  or  by  the  exigencies  of  a  certifi- 
cate. Those  who  happen  to  have  no  preliminary  inclination  to  the 
subject  thus  find  many  of  the  statements  of  bare  facts  dull,  unin- 
teresting, and  useless  for  mental  discipline.  Suppose  that  that  well- 
worn  topic,  the  Alternation  of  Generations,  is  being  treated.  As 
Prof.  Miall  remarks,  "  the  lecturer  defines  his  terms  and  quotes 
his  examples  ;  we  have  Salpa  and  Aurclia  and  the  Fern,  and  as 
many  more  as  time  allows.  How  can  he  expect  to  interest  any- 
body in  a  featureless  narrative,  which  gives  no  fact  with  its  natural 
circumstances,  but  mashes  the  whole  into  pemmican  ?  What 
student  goes  away  with  the  thought  that  it  would  be  good  and 
pleasant  to  add  to  the  heap  of  known  facts  ?  The  heap  seems  need- 
lessly big  already.  And  yet  every  item  in  that  dull  mass  was  once 
deeply  interesting,  moving  all  naturalists  and  many  who  were  not 
naturalists  to  wonder  and  delight.  The  Alternation  of  Generations 
worked  upon  men's  minds  in  its  day  like  Swammerdam's  discovery 
of  the  butterfly  within  the  caterpillar,  or  Trembley's  discovery  of 
the  budding  Hydra,  which  when  cut  in  two  made  two  new  animals, 
or  Bonnet's  discovery  that  an  Aphis  could  bring  forth  living  young 
without  having  ever  met  another  individual  of  its  own  species. 
All  these  wonders  of  nature  have  now  been  condensed  into  glue. 
But  we  can  at  any  time  rouse  in  the  minds  of  our  students  some 
little  of  the  old  interest,  if  we  will  only  tell  the  tale  as  it  was  told 
for  the  first  time." 

Of  course,  there  are  many  practical  difficulties  in  carrying  out 
this  suggestion.  It  entails  much  reading  of  ancient  literature, 
which  the  ordinary  teacher  rarely  sees.  It  trespasses  upon  the 
allotted  lecture  hours,  already  too  short  for  the  material  to  be 
treated.  At  the  same  time,  if  it  succeeded  in  infusing  a  little 
more  philosophy  into  our  medical  students  and  others,  who  are 
too  apt  to  look  upon  the  preliminary  biological  course  as  drudgery, 
it  would  well  repay  the  additional  labour  involved  in  preparation. 

The  Times  on  Archaeology 

The  foregoing  matters  are  of  more  or  less  professional  interest.     So 
also  are    the    geological  questions — the  pre-Cambrian  problems  of 


220  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

Canadian  geology — treated  by  Dr  George  M.  Dawson  in  his  admir- 
able address  to  Section  C  at  Toronto.  Sir  John  Evans'  address  as 
President  of  the  British  Association,  however,  is  one  to  interest 
even  the  least  scientific  of  the  general  public.  It  is  a  valuable 
expression  of  opinion  of  one  of  the  foremost  minds  upon  the 
question  of  the  Antiquity  of  Man,  and  recent  attempts  in  Europe 
to  carry  the  human  period  backwards  much  further  than  the 
Palaeolithic  gravels.  As  might  be  expected,  Sir  John  Evans' 
opinions  are  conservative.  The  engraved  Pliocene  shell,  Pcctunculus, 
is  dismissed  with  ridicule.  For  the  asserted  Indian  Miocene  man 
he  accepts  the  explanation  ably  advanced  in  Natural  Science  by  Mr 
R  D.  Oldham ;  the  form  of  the  fractured  flints  of  the  Cromer 
Forest  Bed  he  attributes  to  natural  fractures ;  he  wishes  for  more 
evidence  as  to  the  age  of  the  beds  which  yielded  Pithecanthropus 
erectus,  and  the  claims  advanced  in  favour  of  '  Eolithic  '  man  from 
the  high  level  gravels  near  Sevenoaks,  he  considers,  as  he  did  in 
1890,  to  be  still  unproved.  In  all  these  points  we  regard  Sir 
John  Evans'  scepticism  as  healthy  ;  and  as  he  is  unquestionably 
one  of  the  best  living  authorities  on  stone  implements,  his  opinion 
must  carry  great  weight.  The  asserted  pre-Glacial  man  of  East 
Anglia,  based  on  implements  supposed  to  have  been  found  beneath 
the  glacial  deposits,  the  recent  excavations  by  Mr  Clement  Eeid 
seem  to  have  conclusively  disproved.  And  in  the  other  cases 
referred  to  the  evidence  is  either  wholly  discredited  or  still 
inconclusive. 

The  most  remarkable  expression  of  opinion  called  forth  by 
this  learned  and  calmly  scientific  exposition  of  the  facts  was  an 
astounding  leading  article  in  The  Times.  Most  of  the  scientific 
members  of  the  staff  of  that  paper  seem  to  have  gone  to 
Canada,  and  the  reactionary  journalists  apparently  resolved  to 
make  the  most  of  their  opportunity.  Accordingly,  we  read  con- 
cerning archaeology,  in  the  first  leading  article  of  August  19th, 
that — 

"  All  its  speculations  upon  neolithic  and  palaeolithic  man  are 
founded  upon  a  single  observation,  as  yet  completely  unrelated,  save 
by  the  loosest  conjecture,  with  any  other  portion  of  human  know- 
ledge. That  observation  is  that  flints,  chipped  or  polished  in  a 
manner  for  which  natural  agencies  do  not  seem  to  account,  have 
been  found  in  certain  deposits  at  widely-separated  points  on  the 
surface  of  the  globe.  That  they  were  chipped  by  man  as  we  know 
him  is  a  mere  conjecture.  How  they  came  to  be  so  widely  dis- 
tributed is  a  question  that  baffles  even  the  licence  of  surmise. 
Geology  does  not  attempt  to  fix  within  a  thousand  centuries  the 
age  of  the  beds  in  which  they  are  found  ;  and  geological  specula- 
tions   themselves    rest   upon  assumptions  which  may  be  plausible 


1897]:  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  221 

where  all  real  knowledge  is  wanting,  but  which  can  never  be  scien- 
tifically verified.  Attentive  perusal  of  Sir  John  Evans'  address 
itself  suffices  to  show  that  archaeology  is  in  no  sense  a  science,  but 
rather  a  recondite  and  remote  branch  of  historical  speculation." 

This  extract  is  long,  but  it  is  worth  reprinting,  since  it  is  a  sad 
reminder  of  how  slowly  knowledge  of  the  elementary  facts  of  science 
really  spreads.  After  this,  it  is  perhaps  unnecessary  to  consider 
any  of  The  Times  later  criticisms  of  the  President's  address  or  of 
his  proposed  Imperial  Ethnographic  Bureau.  It  was,  however, 
unfortunate  that  Sir  John  Evans  should  have  prejudiced  his  pro- 
posal by  suggesting  that  the  work  might  be  undertaken  by  the 
Imperial  Institute. 

The  Mammals  of  the  Lost  Antarctic  Continent 

As  soon  as  space  permits,  we  hope  to  publish  some  further  interest- 
ing contributions  to  our  knowledge  of  primaeval  man  and  the  ques- 
tion of  his  antiquity.  This  month  we  go  a  little  further  back  in 
the  history  of  the  mammalia,  and  print  a  translation  of  an  import- 
ant address  to  the  New  University  of  La  Plata  by  Dr  Elorentino 
Ameghino,  which  is  liable  to  be  overlooked  in  its  separate  form  in 
the  original  Spanish.  We  do  not  pretend  to  endorse  his  conclusions; 
we  look  upon  some  of  them,  indeed,  as  visionary  speculations.  But 
during  the  past  ten  years  the  brothers  Ameghino  have  done  more 
than  anyone  else — not  even  excepting  the  eminent  Director  of  the 
Museum  La  Plata  (Dr  F.  P.  Moreno) — to  elucidate  the  geology  and 
the  mammalian  fossils ;  and  Dr  Florentino  Ameghino,  who  is  an 
accomplished  zoologist  and  comparative  anatomist,  commands  a  re- 
spectful hearing,  if  only  on  account  of  the  remarkable  contributions 
he  has  made  to  our  knowledge  of  the  Tertiary  mammals  and  birds. 
We  have  already  referred  to  the  progress  of  his  researches  on  several 
occasions  in  Natural  Science. 

It  is  well  known  that,  according  to  our  present  information,  the 
chief  types  of  the  higher  mammals  all  suddenly  appear  both  in 
Europe  and  North  America  at  the  dawn  of  the  Tertiary  period. 
We  are  acquainted  with  old  land  surfaces  of  the  late  Secondary 
period  in  both  countries,  but  hitherto  we  have  not  found  a  trace  of 
the  ancestors  of  the  higher  Tertiary  mammals  on  any  of  them.  Dr 
Ameghino  now  claims  to  have  discovered  these  long-lost  ancestors  of 
the  Cretaceous  period  in  Patagonia.  He  believes  in  the  theory  of 
an  Antarctic  Continent,  which  split  up  at  the  beginning  of  the 
Tertiary  period  into  South  America,  New  Zealand,  Australia,  South 
Africa,  and  less  important  islands.  Here  he  considers  that  the 
Mesozoic  ancestors  of  the  mammals  were  evolved.  He  believes  that 
they  first  wandered  into  the  Euro-Asiatic  Continent  at  the  end  of 


222  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

the  Cretaceous  period  from  South  Africa,  which  then  became 
directly  connected  with  the  lands  of  the  northern  hemisphere. 
These  mammals  passed  directly  from  the  Euro-Asiatic  Continent  by 
a  land-bridge  into  North  America.  Then  the  isthmus  of  Panama 
was  formed,  and  many  of  the  later  Tertiary  mammals  were  able  to 
wander  back  to  the  land  of  their  primeval  ancestors  in  the  direction 
of  Patagonia. 

The  theory  is  a  pretty  one,  and  we  only  wish  the  facts  support- 
ing it  were  more  convincing ;  for  some  theory  of  this  kind  would 
explain  many  mysteries  in  the  distribution  of  animals.  For  our  own 
part,  we  cannot  recognise  the  very  antique  and  ancestral  features 
which  Dr  Ameghino  perceives  in  his  '  Pyrotherium- fauna '  from 
Patagonia ;  but  we  must  await  the  promised  memoir  in  which  the 
remarkable  new  mammals  in  question  are  to  be  fully  described. 


The  Geology  of  Patagonia 

The  interest  aroused  in  the  age  of  the  tertiary  deposits  of 
Patagonia  will  be  still  further  fostered  by  a  forthcoming  paper 
by  Mr  J.  B.  Hatcher  of  Princeton  University,  who  visited  the 
district  in  1896.  Mr  Hatcher  has  already  recorded  a  few  notes 
in  the  American  Journal  of  Science  for  September.  In  south 
latitude  51°  31/  he  discovered,  near  Cape  Fairweather,  a  series  of 
marine  beds  with  a  fairly  abundant  invertebrate  fauna,  overlying 
the  Santacruzian  formation,  which  in  that  locality  are  well-de- 
veloped and  full  of  fossil  mammals.  These  Fairweather  beds,  as 
Mr  Hatcher  has  named  them,  have  been  deposited  upon  an  eroded 
surface  of  the  Santacruzian  formation,  and  consist  of  some  30  to  40 
feet  (as  at  present  observed).  The  lower  part  is  fine-grained, 
incoherent  sandstone,  the  upper  a  coarse,  loose,  but  in  places  an 
extremely  hard  conglomerate,  which  passes  insensibly  into  the 
overlying  Patagonian  shingle  formation,  from  which  it  can  only  be 
distinguished  by  the  fossils  it  contains.  The  marine  invertebrata, 
according  to  Prof.  Pilsbury,  point  to  a  Pliocene  age,  but  they  do 
not  promise  to  be  of  much  service  in  determining  the  vexed  question 
of  the  age  of  the  Santacruzian  beds.  Mr  Hatcher  at  present  believes 
that  the  Fairweather  beds  are  the  equivalent  of  those  beds  dis- 
covered by  Darwin  in  North -Eastern  Tierra  del  Fuego,  and  pro- 
visionally referred  by  him  to  the  Santacruzian  beds  discovered  by 
Fitzroy  at  the  mouth  of  the  Gallegos  river,  and  he  has,  in  support 
of  his  view,  fragments  of  crabs'  legs  very  similar  to  those  which 
occur  in  the  bluffs  of  San  Sebastian  Bay.  The  general  dip  of  the 
strata  also  lends  colour  to  his  deductions.  We  shall  await  with 
interest  the  more  detailed  report  which  Mr  Hatcher  promises. 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  223 

The  Sirenian  Mammals 

The  want  of  all  definite  knowledge  of  the  ancestry  of  the 
Tertiary  land-mammals  is  strange.  Our  absolute  ignorance  of  the 
origin  of  the  marine  mammals  like  the  whales,  dolphins,  and  sea- 
cows  is  still  stranger.  Marine  deposits  of  the  Cretaceous  and  early 
Eocene  periods  are  recognised  nearly  all  over  the  world,  but  not  a 
trace  of  the  Cetacea  and  Sirenia  has  been  found  in  them.  So  far  as 
known,  these  curious  types  appear  fully  evolved  at  the  top  of  the 
Eocene. 

Nor  does  embryology  help  us  much.  It  has  shed  a  little  light 
upon  the  nature  of  the  Cetacea ;  we  might  therefore  expect  some 
information  from  this  source  concerning  the  Sirenia.  Thus  far,  how- 
ever, the  results  are  small,  and  Prof.  Willy  Kukenthal's  new  memoir 
on  the  Sirenia  (in  Semon's  "  Zoologische  Forschungsreisen  in  Aus- 
tralien  und  dem  Malayischen  Archipel,"  vol.  iv.,  lief.  1),  which  is 
one  of  the  most  important  monographs  issued  during  the  past  month, 
does  not  contribute  much  to  the  solution  of  the  great  problem. 
The  available  material,  it  is  true,  is  small — only  four  stages  of 
Halicore  and  six  stages  of  Manatus — and  only  three  chapters 
(external  form,  integument,  and  dentition)  are  published.  It  is  a 
most  important  contribution  to  the  facts  of  the  case,  and  for  this 
alone  we  must  at  present  remain  grateful. 


The  Origin  of  the  Irish  Fauna 

Not  only  is  it  almost  impossible  as  yet  to  fathom  the  mysteries 
connected  with  the  dawn  of  the  present  order  of  things  in  the  dis- 
tribution of  life  on  the  various  land-areas  ;  it  is  very  difficult  to 
discover  the  routes  of  the  migration  and  distribution  of  organisms 
even  during  comparatively  modern  periods.  During  the  last  few 
years,  however,  much  attention  has  been  paid  to  the  relations  of  the 
existing  faunas  and  progress  made  in  the  determination  of  their 
affinities.  Among  others,  many  Irish  naturalists  have  discussed  in  a 
very  interesting  manner  the  relations  of  the  fauna  of  their  island, 
and  have  arrived  at  various  conclusions,  some  of  which  may  prove 
to  be  of  permanent  value. 

Quite  recently  Dr  E.  F.  Scharff,  Keeper  of  the  Natural  History 
Collections  in  the  Dublin  Museum,  has  returned  to  the  subject,  and 
published  an  interesting  paper  in  the  Proceedings  of  the  Eoyal 
Irish  Academy  (ser.  3,  vol.  iv.,  No.  3,  1897,  pp.  427-514).  The 
contribution  is  lengthy,  and  it  is  written  in  a  somewhat  disconnected 
style ;  and  how  the  author  gets  from  his  premises  to  his  conclusions 
is  not  always  apparent.  Dr  Scharff  argues  that  part  of  the  Irish 
fauna  lived  in   Ireland  in  pre-glacial  times ;    that  the  lower  con- 


224  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

tinental  boulder-clay  is  Pliocene ;  and  that  it  is  a  marine  formation 
deposited  in  a  great  sea  which  covered  a  large  tract  of  Eussia  and 
Central  Asia ;  that  the  Siberian  mammals  migrated  into  Western 
Europe  to  the  south  of  this  sea ;  and  that  the  British  Pleistocene 
fauna  and  flora  do  not  indicate  former  Arctic  conditions  in  this 
country.  The  range  of  subjects  discussed  in  this  memoir  is  con- 
siderable. The  conclusions  are  startling,  but  only  when  considered 
apart  from  the  statements  on  which  they  are  based.  "  The  occur- 
rence in  almost  all  the  English  boulder-clays  of  marine  shells  "  is  an 
example  of  Dr  Scharff  s  sensational  statements.  The  paper  cannot 
be  discussed  in  a  short  notice.  Our  chief  fear  is  that  Dr  Scharff' s 
speculations  will  prejudice  the  use  of  zoological  distribution  in 
geological  investigation. 

Franz  Josef  Land 

Captain   PlObertson,   the   enterprising   commander   of   the    whaler 
Balacna,  has    given   an   interesting  description  of  his  voyage  this 
summer  to  Franz  Josef  Land.       His  geographical  discoveries  are 
interesting.      He  found  some  new  islands  on  the  south  coast,  but  his 
most  important  achievement  was  returning  westward  from  Franz 
Josef  Land  along  the  79  th  parallel  of  latitude.      He  thus  passed 
over  the  site  of  the  two  famous  islands  reported  by  Johannesen  and 
Andreassen  in  1884  ;  but  he  found  no  trace  of  them.      The  Nor- 
wegian seamen  must,  therefore,  have  been  out  in  their  reckoning. 
The  sea  this  summer  was  exceptionally  free  from  ice,  and  the  polar 
pack  had  receded  far  to  the  north.      Captain  Eobertson  thinks  that 
in  such  a  ship  as  the  Balacna  the  whole  Franz  Josef  Land  archi- 
pelago could  be  charted  in  a  single  summer.     This  opinion  renders 
the  results  of  the  Jackson-Harmsworth  expedition  all  the  more  dis- 
appointing so  far  as  can  be  judged  from  the  accounts  already  pub- 
lished.     But  now  that  the  expedition  has  returned  we  may  hope  for 
a  final  account  of  its  work  by  the  members  themselves.     Perhaps 
this  may  remove  the  somewhat  widespread  prejudice  roused  by  the 
unjust  publication  of  private  letters  and  the  injudicious  advertise- 
ment of  the  London  agents.      The  expedition  is  said  to  have  cost 
some  £49,000.     We  hope  Mr  Harmsworth  is  satisfied. 

Mimicry  and  Protective  Colouration 

The  questions  of  protective  colouration  and  mimicry  have  a 
perennial  interest  for  naturalists  and  the  general  public.  Now  that 
the  conclusions  of  Trimen,  Bates,  and  Wallace  are  being  dogmatically 
taught  in  magazine  articles  and  popular  books,  it  is  only  to  be  ex- 
pected that  they  should  begin  to  be  discredited  by  some  of  the 
younger  school  of  biologists,  and  several  of  the  works  attacking  the 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  225 

'  orthodox '  theories  have  been  noticed  in  Natural  Science.  In  de- 
fence of  the  old  positions  we  notice  a  short  paper  by  Mr  F.  M. 
Webster  of  Ohio,  in  the  Keport  of  the  Entomological  Society  of 
Ontario  for  1896  (pp.  80-86).  The  author  minimises  the  value  of 
experiments,  tending  to  show  that  insects  with  '  warning '  colours 
are  not  always  distasteful.  He  points  out  that  the  fact  that  Prof. 
Plateau  enjoyed  feeding  on  the  caterpillars  of  the  magpie  moth 
does  not  prove  them  palatable  to  more  usual  enemies.  No  insect 
is  so  familiar  an  example  of  '  warning '  colour  as  the  North 
American  danaid  butterfly,  Anosia  archippus.  Mr  Webster  narrates 
an  instance  of  a  number  of  these  butterflies  being  eaten  by  mice  in 
Texas,  and  tells  how  he  himself  observed  a  colony  of  brightly- 
coloured  cabbage  bugs  (Margantia  histrionica)  devoured  by  the  same 
rodents.  But  he  believes  that  mice  must  be  very  exceptional 
enemies  to  these  species,  and  that  the  bright  colours  may  be  of 
'  warning '  value  to  animals  that  eat  insects  habitually. 

The  same  author  in  another  paper  (Journal  New  York  Entom. 
Soc,  1897,  pp.  67-77)  deals  with  the  mental  or  instinctive  factors 
in  protective  resemblance.  It  is  well  known  that  in  addition  to 
the  form  and  colour  of  the  insect,  a  special  attitude  or  a  position  on 
some  particular  background  of  leaf  or  twig  is  essential  to  the  per- 
fection of  the  illusion.  Mr  Webster  believes  that  such  habits  have 
not  been  developed  without  the  action  of  some  conscious  will  and 
intelligence  on  the  part  of  the  creatures  concerned.  He  compares 
the  young  twig-like  caterpillar  to  the  human  infant  who  has 
inherited  none  of  the  accumulated  knowledge  of  his  ancestors, 
though  he  has  inherited  an  aptitude  for  learning. 

The  Effect  of  Civilisation  on  the  North  American  Insect 

Fauna 

Another  subject  of  general  interest,  lately  dealt  with  by  Mr 
Webster  (Fifth  Annual  Report  of  the  Ohio  State  Academy  of  Science), 
is  the  effect  of  civilisation  on  the  insect  fauna  of  North  America. 
In  few  other  parts  of  the  world  has  so  rapid  a  change  been  made  in 
the  natural  aspect  of  the  country  by  the  advent  of  the  pioneer  and 
the  farmer,  and  the  transformation  of  swamps  and  forests  into  cul- 
tivated fields  has  led  to  the  extinction  of  many  native  species  of 
insects.  Some  species,  however,  have  adapted  themselves  to  the 
changed  conditions,  while  a  considerable  introduction  of  Tropical 
and  European  forms  has  been  a  direct  result  of  the  advance  of 
civilisation.  Mr  Webster  rightly  lays  stress  on  the  importance  of 
systematic  observations  on  the  natural  history  of  new  countries, 
wherever  possible,  before  the  balance  of  nature  has  been  disturbed 
by  the  advent  of  the  white  man. 


226  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

ASPIDIOTUS 

The  San  Jose"  scale  (Aspidiotus  pemiciosus)  is  a  subject  of  perennial 
interest  to  the  American  entomologists.  Last  year  the  U.S.  Depart- 
ment of  Agriculture  issued  a  pamphlet  by  Messrs  Howard  and  Marlatt 
on  the  spread  of  the  insect  in  the  States,  and  now  from  the  same 
Department  we  receive  a  bulletin  (No.  6  Technical  Series)  on 
the  systematic  position  of  the  scale,  and  the  structural  points  which 
distinguish  it  from  its  allies.  This  work  is  from  the  pen  of  Mr 
T.  D.  A.  Cockerell,  and  it  will  prove  of  great  value  to  the  student 
of  the  coccids,  as  it  contains  not  only  full  descriptions  and  figures  of 
A.  pemiciosus  and  the  species  nearly  related  to  it,  but  a  geographical 
list  of  all  the  described  species  of  Aspidiotus,  with  a  short  summary 
of  their  characters. 


Care  of  the  Brood  in  Holothurians 

Prof.  Hubert  Ludwig  of  Bonn  writes  to  the  Zoologischer  Anzeiger  to 
say  that  he  is  able  to  record  an  antarctic  Chirodota,  in  which  the 
care  of  the  brood  is  well  marked.  The  species  is  Chirodota  co7itorta, 
was  described  in  187-4,  and  forms  an  abundant  part  of  the  material 
obtained  by  the  Hamburg-Magellan  Collecting  Expedition.  Prof. 
Ludwig  says  that  in  this  species  he  has  discovered  a  form  of  care  of 
the  brood  previously  unknown  among  echinoderms.  In  the  female 
(the  sexes  are  separate  in  the  species)  the  genital  canals  themselves 
become  receptacles  for  the  brood,  and  the  entire  development  is 
passed  through  within  them.  The  young  at  3  mm.  in  length  are 
born  through  the  genital  aperture ;  they  have  then  seven  tentacles, 
and  the  '  wheels  '  and  '  hooks '  are  already  well  developed. 
Further  details  of  this  discovery  of  Prof.  Ludwig's  will  appear  in 
his  forthcoming  memoir  on  Antarctic  Holothuria. 


SOLIFUGAE 

When  revising  a  genus  or  describing  a  whole  series  of  new  genera 
and  species,  the  average  describer  looks  upon  all  details  of  habit  or 
economy  as  beneath  his  notice.  Not  so  Mr  E.  I.  Pocock,  who 
frequently  appends  to  his  papers  notes  as  interesting  to  the  general 
reader  as  important  to  the  cabinet  naturalist.  In  the  September 
number  of  the  Annals  and  Magazine  of  Natural  History  Mr  Pocock 
deals  with  the  group  Solifugae,  which  contains  arachnida  of  the 
genera  Galeodes,  Solpuga,  etc.,  coming  from  tropical  Africa.  After 
a  revision  of  the  family  and  a  description  of  the  genera  and  species 
we  find  a  note  on  the  sound  produced  by  a  Natal  species  of  Solpuga. 


1897] 


NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  227 


Mr  G.  H.  K.  Marshall,  the  observer,  seems  inclined  to  attribute  the 
sound  produced  to  "trituration  of  the  creature's  powerful  jaws 
against  the  hard  ground  in  which  they  seem  to  prefer  to  dig  their 
holes,  the  operation  being  performed  with  the  jaws,  and  the  sound 
ceasing  when  the  spider  stops  digging."  Although  Mr  Marshall 
kept  them  alive  he  failed  to  detect  any  stridulation,  though  they 
made  a  considerable  noise  by  energetically  biting  at  the  sides  of  the 
boxes,  one  of  them  nearly  succeeding  in  escaping  by  gnawing  its  way 
through  at  one  spot.  A  further  note  is  to  the  effect  that  the 
Solfugae  succumb  more  rapidly  to  the  cyanide  bottle  than  the  ordinary 
spiders  or  scorpions ;  and  Mr  Pocock,  in  emoting  Mrs  Monteiro,  to 
the  effect  that  a  large  black  scorpion  was  confined  eight  hours  in  a 
strong  poison  bottle  before  it  succumbed,  states  that  this  is  no  doubt 
due  to  the  fact  of  the  richer  development  of  the  respiratory  system 
in  Solpuga.  A  further  note  of  Mr  Marshall's  corroborates  Hutton's 
observation  as  to  the  use  of  the  terminal  organ  on  the  palpus.  This 
is  a  gelatinous  fan-shaped  sucker  with  which  the  animal  has  the 
power  of  picking  up  objects,  probably  prey,  and  conveying  them  to 
its  mandibles.  The  principal  food  of  the  Solpugae,  according  to 
Mr  Marshall,  are  termites,  "  a  small  species  which  makes  no  mound, 
but  builds  mud  tunnels  along  the  surface  of  the  ground  among  dead 
leaves,  sticks,  etc.  When  the  Solpuga  comes  across  such  tunnelling 
it  examines  along  it  carefully,  then  suddenly  breaks  through  the 
mud  and  extracts  a  termite,  the  presence  of  which  it  detects,  I 
suppose,  by  either  hearing  or  touch." 

The  evidence  as  to  the  poisonous  nature  of  these  animals  varies. 
A  Kaffir  boy  declared  them  very  poisonous,  sometimes  fatally  so, 
and  a  bite  supposed  to  be  from  S.  darlingii  did  not  subside  till  the 
fourth  day ;  on  the  other  hand,  Mr  J.  M.  Hutchinson  of  Estcourt, 
Natal,  finds  the  bite  of  &  hustilis  "  to  be  quite  harmless,  the  forceps 
being  unable  to  pierce  the  tenderest  skin." 

The  British  Pleistocene  Mollusca 

In  1890  a  valuable  summary  of  the  Pleistocene  (non-marine) 
mollusca  of  the  London  district  was  published  in  the  Proceedings  of 
the  Geologists'  Association  by  Mr  B.  B.  Woodward.  This  paper  treated 
the  material  from  a  geographical  point  of  view,  describing  the  geology 
of  the  localities  where  the  shells  were  found,  and  concluded  with  a 
valuable  table  of  distribution,  in  which  were  distinguished  the  living 
and  extinct  species.  It  was  hoped  that  Mr  Woodward  would  extend 
his  researches  into  other  districts,  and  we  have  now  to  welcome  a 
second  paper  by  Mr  A.  S.  Kennard  and  himself,  to  which  Mr  W.  M. 
Webb  has  contributed,  on  the  Post-Pliocene  (non-marine)  mollusca 
of  Essex  (Essex  Naturalist,  x.,  pp.  87-109).      This  paper  is  treated 


228  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

in  practically  the  same  way  as  the  former,  with  the  addition  of  a 
bibliography,  and  deals  with  that  important  series  of  shells  obtained 
by  the  late  John  Brown  of  Stanway  at  Copford,  as  well  as  series 
from  many  other  deposits.  The  mere  mention  of  Grays,  Ilford,  and 
Clacton,  as  some  of  these  other  deposits,  will  show  at  once  the  special 
interest  of  the  paper  to  London  geologists  and  conchologists. 

Among  the  more  interesting  notes  given  to  us  is  the  confirmation 
of  the  rarity  of  Helix  hortensis  in  a  fossil  state ;  the  absence  of  H. 
pomatia ;  the  occurrence  of  II.  aspera  in  the  Lea  Valley ;  the 
elimination  of  Eulota  fruticum  from  the  recorded  fauna  of  Copford  ; 
the  restriction  of  the  distribution  of  Pomatias  elegans ;  and  the 
observation  as  to  the  increased  size  of  Hdicclla  caperata  since 
Pleistocene   times. 

We  have  now  a  great  advance  in  our  knowledge  of  the  geo- 
logical history  of  the  non-marine  mollusca  of  our  home  district ; 
and  though  some  of  the  names  in  Messrs  Kennard  and  Woodward's 
list  may  be  a  little  startling  to  the  uninitiated,  we  are  glad  to  see  a 
possible  termination  of  the  confused  nomenclature  which  has 
prevailed   for  so  many  years. 

Triassic  Cephalopoda 

The  description  of  Triassic  Cephalopods  occupies  an  important  part 
of  the  recently-issued  volume  of  the  Denkschr.  d.  h.  Akarl.  Wissensch., 
Wien.  Franz  v.  Hauer,  who  has  been  contributing  to  the  literature 
of  Triassic  Cephalopods  for  more  than  thirty  years,  and  although 
now  considerably  past  his  threescore  years  and  ten,  furnishes  a 
paper  on  the  Trias  Cephalopods  of  Bosnia.  This  author  has  already 
described  Triassic  Cephalopods  from  this  region,  but  he  now  records 
from  a  new  locality  both  Nautiloids  and  Ammonoids,  among  the 
latter  being  the  new  genus  Bosnites.  Dr  E.  von  Mojsisovics,  so 
well  known  for  his  work  on  the  Trias  Cephalopods,  contributes  a 
very  important  paper  on  the  Upper  Triassic  Cephalopod-fauna  of 
the  Himalaya.  It  is  based  not  only  upon  the  older  collections 
made  by  Strachey,  Stoliczka,  and  Griesbach,  but  also  upon  the  rich 
collection  obtained  by  Messrs  Griesbach,  Middlemiss,  and  Dr  Diener 
during  their  expedition  into  the  Central  Himalaya  in  the  year 
1892.  As  was  to  be  expected,  many  new  species  are  described  and 
not  a  few  new  genera  are  proposed.  The  author  points  out  that 
there  is  a  marked  contrast  between  the  Upper  Triassic  fauna  of  the 
Indian  province  and  the  homotaxial  fauna  of  the  Mediterranean 
province,  but  he  believes  there  was  a  sea  connection  between  the 
two  regions  during  Upper  Triassic  times,  and  is  of  opinion  that  an 
examination  of  the  intervening  districts  will  probably  render  the 
provincial  character  of  these  two  regions  less  apparent. 


18971  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  229 

Lobster  Fishery 

Me  -I  ames  Hoknell  has  contributed  two  long  letters  to  the  Jersey 
Times  and  the  Jersey  Evening  Post  relative  to  the  Lobster 
Fishery  of  the '  Channel  Islands.  There  is  a  marked  and  general 
decrease  in  the  size  of  the  catches,  and  some  arrangements  are 
needful  for  regulating  and  preserving  the  supply.  Mr  Hornell  is 
of  the  opinion  that  the  geographical  position  of  the  Channel  Islands 
precludes — in  view  of  the  powerful  currents  sweeping  their  coasts — 
any  useful  purpose  being  served  by  the  hatching  and  liberation  of 
fry,  wherever  fry  are  surface  swimmers  for  any  considerable  length 
of  time.  He  does  not  forget  in  his  argument  that  the  currents 
may  reverse  their  direction  at  regular  times,  but  urges  the  import- 
ance of  a  detailed  and  exact  investigation  of  current  action  around 
the  islands  before  costly  means  are  undertaken  for  stocking  pur- 
poses. And  at  the  same  time  he  casts  doubts  from  his  own  obser- 
vation on  the  accepted  idea  that  the  young  lobster  is  a  pelagic 
animal,  because  he  has  found  that  in  some  experiments  he  has  made 
that  while  he  lost  most  of  the  fry  by  the  surface  pipe  of  his 
aquarium,  those  of  the  age  of  three  days  seemed  inclined  to  sink 
to  the  bottom  and  abandon  a  surface  life.  Again,  Mr  Hornell  has 
never  once  taken  lobster  fry  in  his  almost  continuous  towings  with 
fine  muslin  nets  on  the  south  coast  of  Jersey,  while  the  fry  of 
crabs,  prawns,  and  Squilla  occur  in  countless  thousands.  His 
method  for  the  improvement  and  protection  of  the  Lobster  Fishery 
would  be  to  rigidly  enforce  the  protection  of  the  berried  female 
and  all  lobsters  under  nine  inches,  rather  than  to  commence  a 
nursery,  both  costly  and  difficult  to  manage.  At  the  same  time,  if 
experiment  were  to  prove  the  non-pelagic  nature  of  the  fry,  then 
culture  and  liberation  might  be  useful,  in  addition  to  the  protective 
regulations  referred  to  above. 


'o* 


Pre-Cambrian  (?)  Radiolaria  in  Australia 

Prof.  Edgeworth  David  and  Mr  Walter  Howchin  announce  in  the 
Proceedings  of  the  Linnean  Society  of  New  South  Wales,  pt.  4,  1896, 
the  discovery  of  Ptadiolaria  in  rocks  of  supposed  Pre-Cambrian  age 
in  the  neighbourhood  of  Hallett's  Cove,  about  fifteen  miles  S.S.W. 
from  Adelaide.  The  fossils  occur  in  a  dark,  greenish-grey  silicious 
limestone,  and  in  a  fine-grained  laminated  grey  clay-shale,  but  they 
are  very  obscure  and  badly  preserved. 

Although  no  other  fossils  have  been  found  at  Brighton  and 
Crystal  Brook  in  the  rocks  in  which  the  Padiolaria  occur,  there  is  a 
rich  and  abundant  fauna  in  the  Cambrian  series  of  the  district ;   but 


230  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

in  a  subsequent  note  to  this  paper  the  authors  state  that  they  have 
found  a  great  number  of  ArchacocyatJiinae  at  Normanville  in  lime- 
stone, which  "  appears  to  be  conformable  to  strata  which  most  resemble 
those  in  which  the  radiolarian  casts  have  been  observed."  Hence 
they  are  inclined  to  believe  that  the  Eadiolaria  may  be  in  Lower 
Cambrian  or  passage  beds  rather  than  Pre-Cambrian. 


Freezing  of  Plants 

Messrs  G-ustav  Fischer,  of  Jena,  have  just  issued,  in  book  form 
(73    pages    8vo),  an    account  of    some  researches   by   Prof.   Hans 
Molisch  on  the  freezing  of  plants.      The  author,   by  means  of  an 
arrangement  which  he  describes  in  the  first  chapter,  has  observed 
under  the  microscope  the  changes  which  occur  in  freezing  not  only 
in  plant-cells  and  tissues,  but  also  in  colloidal  substances,  emulsions, 
coloured  liquids,  and  salt-solutions.      For  observation  the  microscope 
is  placed  in  a  triple  box.      The  outer  case  is  of  wood,  then  comes  a 
hollow-walled  zinc  chamber,   inside  which  is  fitted  the  instrument, 
the  tube  projecting  through  the  top.      Sawdust  is  placed  between 
the  outer  wall  and  the  zinc  chamber,  and  the  hollow  walls  of   the 
latter  contain   the    freezing    mixture.     A  wide    zinc    tube    allows 
light  to  pass  from  the  outside  to   the  reflector.      Several  figures  are 
given,  showing  the  appearance  of  non-living  substances  as  freezing. 
In  all  cases  particles  of  ice  are  formed  by  separation  of  the  water, 
while    the    gum,    particles   of    latex    or   concentrated    salt-solution 
occupy  the  intervening  spaces.      Three  figures  (p.  17)  of  an  amoeba, 
alive,  frozen,   and    thawed  respectively,  are  of    interest.       In   the 
frozen  state  the  organism  forms  a  lump  of  ice  intersected  with  a 
highly  complicated  network,  consisting  of  protoplasm  very  poor  in 
water,  concentrated  cell-sap  and  air-bubbles.      When  thawed  there 
is  a  much  less  sharply  defined  reticulum  of  dead  protoplasm,  the 
lacunae  in  which  are  the  spaces  which  in  the  frozen  state  were  filled 
with  ice.    Spirogyrci  cells  (p.  22,  fig.   10)  in  freezing  lose  about  half 
their  diameter  by  withdrawal  of  water,  which  then  freezes  on  the 
outside ;  on  thawing  the  cells  swell  to  their  original  size,  but  proto- 
plasm, chlorophyll  band  and  nucleus  form  a    disorganised  central 
axis  between  which  and  the  walls  is  contained  the  water. 

After  experimenting  for  five  winters  with  hundreds  of  objects,  the 
author  comes  to  the  conclusion  that,  as  a  rule,  it  is  immaterial  to  the 
preservation  of  the  life  of  the  object  whether  thawing  is  rapid  or 
slow,  and  that  death  by  freezing  is  the  result  of  an  excessive  loss  of 
water,  through  ice  formation,  if  the  protoplasm  by  which  its  struc- 
ture ("  architektur  ")  is  destroyed,  and  that  all  the  facts  of  the  case 
can  be  easily  and  natui'ally  explained  from  this  point  of  view. 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  231 

Funafuti 

The  third  part  of  the  Memoir  of  the  Australian  Museum  on  the  Atoll 
of  Funafuti  contains  further  interesting  additions  to  knowledge  of  the 
zoology  of  that  island.  Mr  E.  R.  Waite  has  described  the  collection 
of  mammals,  reptiles  and  fishes  made  by  Mr  Hedley.  The  most 
interesting  part  of  Mr  Waite's  memoir  is  an  account  of  the  habits 
of  the  fruit-eating  Pacific  rat,  for  which,  following  Thomas,  he 
adopts  Peale's  name  of  Inus  cxulans.  An  interesting  fact  is  recorded 
in  reference  to  the  edibility  of  fishes :  at  the  time  the  expedition  was 
on  Funafuti  the  natives  would  only  eat  fish  caught  in  the  lagoon, 
all  those  from  the  reefs  being  condemned.  The  native  explanation 
is  that  the  pumice  which  was  then  being  washed  on  to  the  beach  ren- 
dered the  fish  poisonous ;  but  as  the  pumice  is  harmless,  Mr  Hedley 
concludes  that  some  marine  organism  arrived  with  it  which  rendered 
the  fish  unwholesome.  Mr  Waite  quotes  a  remark  of  Wyatt  Gills 
that  good  food  fish  become  poisonous  by  eating  the  worms  of  the 
genus  Nereis.  The  two  species  of  Enteropneusta  collected  are 
described  by  Mr  J.  P.  Hill ;  one  of  the  two  is  a  new  species 
(Ptycliodera  hedleyi).  Mr  Whitelegge's  account  of  the  Alcyonaria 
includes  a  description  of  four  new  species  and  a  redescription  of 
several  previously  very  imperfectly  known.  We  regret  to  find  that 
some  remarks  concerning  the  publication  of  this  Memoir,  made  in 
reference  to  Part  II.  (Natural  Science,  July  1897,  Vol.  xi.,  p.  5) 
were  based  on  a  misunderstanding. 


lO' 


The  Great  Indian  Earthquake 

At  five  o'clock  in  the  afternoon  of  June  12,  1897,  Calcutta  and 
north-eastern  India  were  startled  by  an  earthquake  which  is  re- 
garded as  having  exceeded  even  the  famous  Lisbon  earthquake 
in  the  area  affected.  The  Geological  Survey  of  India  immedi- 
ately set  to  work  to  collect  the  data  for  a  complete  investigation. 
An  immense  amount  of  information  has  already  been  obtained, 
which  it  will  take  considerable  time  to  digest.  Sufficient  has, 
however,  been  done  to  enable  Mr  R.  D.  Oldham  to  contribute  a 
preliminary  note  to  the  Records  of  the  Geological  Survey.  The 
area  affected  by  the  shock  included  more  than  a  million  and  a 
quarter  square  miles,  while  its  effects  appear  to  have  been  felt 
even  in  Edinburgh  and  Rome.  The  shock  was  most  destructive 
in  Assam :  at  Shillong  in  the  Khasi  Hills  it  is  said  that  hardly 
one  stone  has  been  left  standing  on  another.  Heaps  of  road  metal 
have  been  scattered  into  layers  a  few  inches  deep.  All  masonry  has 
been  shattered  into  pieces,  so  that  the  roofs  fell  bodily  down  on 
to  heaps  of  ruins.      A  cylinder  seismometer  had  fortunately  been 


2  32  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

erected  at  Shillong  in  1882,  and  this  was  thrown  to  the  north- 
east :  it  enables  the  velocity  of  the  wave  to  be  calculated.  The 
range  of  motion  is  estimated  at  7*4  inches.  So  Mr  Oldham  con- 
cludes that  "  the  violence  of  the  shock  at  Shillong  was  at  least 
equal  to  a  backward  and  forward  shake  of  7  inches  repeated  sixty 
times  a  minute."  All  telegraphic  communication  was  of  course 
destroyed,  and  the  accompanying  illustration  (reproduced  from 
a  plate  of  the  Indian  Survey  Eecords)  shows  the  effect  on  the 
railway  lines  produced  by  the  movement  of  the  surface  soil.  The 
rate  of  transmission  of  the  shock  was  over  100  miles  a  minute. 
The  fuller  account  promised  will  be  awaited  with  much  interest, 
for  it  will  probably  yield  suggestive  information  as  to  whether  the 
Himalayan  movements  are  still  in  progress.  It  is  fortunate  that 
the  work  will  be  carried  on  under  the  supervision  of  Mr  Oldham, 
who  is  keenly  interested  in  all  the  broader  problems  connected  with 
seismic  movements. 

Geology  in  New  South  Wales 

The  most  noteworthy  point  in  the  recently  issued  Eeport  of  the 
Geological  Survey  of  New  South  Wales  is  the  discovery  of  Devonian 
plant  remains  and  Lower  Silurian  graptolites  by  Mr  Joseph  Carne. 
This  is  the  first  identification  of  Lower  Silurian  Eocks  in  the 
Colony,  and  they  are  of  special  interest  in  that  they  contain  in  the 
neighbouring  Colony  of  Victoria  the  famous  saddle  reefs  of  Bendigo. 
The  graptolites  were  found  in  a  black  slate  in  the  Parish  of  Lawson, 
Wellesley  Co.,  and  occur  as  shiny  films.  Mr  W.  S.  Dun  identifies 
them  as  Didymograptus  furcatus  (Hall),  D.  cxtcnsus  (Hall),  Dicrano- 
graptus,  Diplograptm,  and  Phyllograptus.  The  Devonian  plants 
comprise  a  Pecopterid  fern  and  a  Sphenoptcris.  They  came  from 
Genoa  Eiver,  Co.  Auckland. 


NATURAL  SCIENCE,    VOL.  XI. 


Plate  VIII 


BRIDGE   ACROSS    NALLAH    AT   HALDIBARI 


LINK    BETWEEN    HALDIBARI    AND    MOGHAL    HAT 


575.1  233 


The  Fundamental  Principles  of  Heredity 

IN  the  recent  elaboration  of  the  Theory  of  Descent,  as  first  fully 
published  by  Charles  Darwin,  two  schools  of  thought  have 
arisen.  The  one,  though  professing  discipleship  pure  and  simple, 
has  laid  extreme  stress  on  the  principle  of  Natural  Selection,  which 
owes  so  much  to  Darwin,  but  has  rejected  his  belief  in  the 
internal  tendencies  of  races  to  vary  in  adaptation  to  changed 
surroundings ;  while  the  other  has  attributed  the  greater  share  in 
the  transformation  of  species  to  the  latter  factor,  and  sent  Natural 
Selection  in  the  background.  The  two  most  illustrious  leaders 
of  scientific  thought  have  been  August  Weismann  on  the  one  side 
and  Herbert  Spencer  on  the  other.  Their  debates  have  long  since 
obtained  an  audience  among  the  cultured  laity ;  but  while  the 
arguments  are  well  known,  some  of  the  most  important  facts  have 
been  rather  taken  for  granted  than  fully  stated  and  clearly  co-or- 
dinated even  in  the  scientific  press.  I  allude  especially  to  the 
coarser  relations  of  the  actual  mechanism  of  reproduction  and  of 
the  act  of  transmission  from  one  generation  to  the  next  of  the 
form  which  clothes  on  or  assumes  the  parental  characters.  Such 
an  exposition  as  we  have  to  make  cannot  be  limited  to  the  higher 
organisms  which  are  familiar  to  us  in  our  daily  life,  for  these  are 
complex  elaborations  ;  while  the  primitive  types,  though  still  existing 
abundantly,  are  only  to  be  studied  with  the  microscope.  It  is  in 
this  field,  hidden  if  not  buried,  that  we  must  first  labour,  if  we  wish 
to  rightly  understand  the  foundations  of  the  wonderful  superstructure 
of  the  higher  Organic  Kingdoms.  We  shall  endeavour  to  use  as 
few  unfamiliar  terms  as  possible,  bearing  in  mind  that  the  reader 
has  no  Handy  Atlas  to  help  him  in  following  the  exploration  of  this 
foreign  country,  with  its  outlandish  names. 

Only  two  centuries  ago  the  microscope  revealed  to  mankind  an 
immense  world  of  minute  living  creatures  as  well  as  the  details  of  the 
structure  of  the  familiar  Animal  and  Plants.  Naturally  enough 
the  early  observers,  or  '  philosophers,'  as  they  were  then  called, 
inferred  that  these  strange  small  creatures  must  have  as  complex 
a  structure  as  our  own.  They  proceeded  zealously  to  search 
for,  and  sometimes  to  proclaim,  the  existence  therein  of  brain, 
heart,  blood-vessels,  etc.,  just  like  those  of  ordinary  bird,  beast,  or 

B 


234  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

fish.1  Since  then  we  have  learned  that  the  ultimate  units  of 
structure  of  the  familiar  organisms  are  identical  in  character  with 
the  entire  organism  of  one  of  such  microscopic  being  ;  and  the 
search  we  have  referred  to  would  be  now  regarded  as  equivalent  to 
seeking  in  a  limestone  pebble  the  pillars  and  buttresses,  the  vaults 
and  domes  of  a  great  cathedral  in  miniature.  Such  units  of  struc- 
ture are  called  '  cells,'  an  ill-chosen  term  indeed,  whose  signification, 
however,  as  a  nucleated  unit  of  protoplasm,  is  familiar  to  everyone. 
The  lower  organisms  consist  of  single  cells  or  of  aggregates  of 
similar  cells  ;  the  higher  ones  consist  of  complicated  arrangements  of 
those  dissimilar  aggregates  of  cells  which  we  call  tissues.  The 
former  we  call  Protists,  distinguishing  between  Protozoa  and  Proto- 
phytes  according  as  the  mode  of  existence  is  animal  or  plant-like  ; 
the  higher  animals  and  plants  we  term  Metazoa  and  Metaphytes 
respectively,  the  appropriate  conjoint  term,  '  Metists,'  not  having 
been  coined  by  any  recognised  authority. 

Throughout  the  higher  groups  the  act  of  reproduction2  of  the 
race  consists  in  the  separation  from  the  complex  organism  of  single 
reproductive  cells,  which  may  either  independently  grow  up  into  the 
original  form,  or  else  one  with  another  fuse  to  produce  a  new  cell 
which  grows  up.  Again  in  most  Plants  and  many  Animals  multi- 
cellular portions  of  the  body  may  become  detached,  and  finally  develop 
into  complete  organisms  ;  this  we  shall  call  '  propagation,'  not  '  repro- 
duction.' In  either  case  the  parent  body  continues  to  exist,  alive  or 
dead,  after  the  detachment  of  these  cells  or  groups  of  cells.  In  Protists, 
matters  are  very  different ;  for  here,  when  the  cell  individual  has 
attained  its  full  size,  it  usually  divides  into  two  new  cells,  and  itself 
is  no  more,  alive  or  dead.  We  call  the  original  cell  a  '  mother  cell,' 
the  new  ones  '  daughter-cell  s,'  by  a  convenient  metaphor ;  but  we 
must  remember  that  the  devoted  mother  here  absolutely  merges  her 
very  existence  into  that  of  her  offspring,  a  self-denying  type  of 
maternity  often  imagined  but  never  realised  among  ourselves.  Thus 
as  Weismann  first  explicitly  stated,  the  Protists  may  escape  personal 
death  by  the  sacrifice  of  their  individual  life  ;  he  therefore  terms 
them  'immortal.'  It  is  with  cellular  pedigree,  according  to 
the  mode  of  parentage  we  have  just  explained,  that  we  shall  mostly 
have  to  deal  in  this  paper. 

The  modes  of  reproduction  among  Protists  are  many  and  various. 

1  Thus  Baker  writes  in  the  middle  of  the  last  century  :  "  Search  we  further  and 
examine  the  Animalcules — many  Sorts  whereof  it  would  be  impossible  for  an  human  Eye 
unassisted  to  discern  ;  those  breathing  Atoms,  so  small  they  are  almost  all  Workman- 
ship !  in  them  too  we  shall  discover  the  same  Organs  of  Body,  Multiplicity  of  Parts, 
Variety  of  Motions,  Diversity  of  Figures,  and  Particular  Ways  of  Living  as  in  the 
larger  Animals. — How  amazingly  curious  must  the  Internal  Structure  of  these  Creatures 
be  !  The  Heart,  the  Stomach,  the  Entrails  and  the  Brain.  How  minute  and  line  the 
Bones,  Joints,  Muscles  and  Tendons  !  How  exquisitely  delicate  beyond  all  Conception 
the  Arteries,  Veins  and  Nerves!"  ("The  Microscope  Made  Easy,"  by  Henry  Baker, 
ed.  v.,  1767.) 

-  In  the  limited  sense,  distinguished  from  '  propagation,'  as  defined  immediately. 


1897]      FUNDAMENTAL  PRINCIPLES  OF  HEREDITY     235 

The  most  familiar  is  the  simple  halving  of  the  cell  each  time  it  has 
attained  double  its  original  bulk  (Herbert  Spencer's  'limit  of  growth'), 
a  process  termed  in  Hibernian  phrase  'multiplication  by  simple 
division.'  Sometimes,  however,  the  first  division  is  followed  im- 
mediately by  another,  and  so  on,  so  as  to  produce  with  little  delay 
grandchildren  or  great-grandchildren,  &c. ;  this  process  is  called 
'  brood-division,'  or,  when  the  progeny  do  not  immediately  separate, 
'segmentation.'  Again  the  progeny  of  brood-divisions  may  as- 
semble in  groups,  usually  in  pairs,  which  fuse  to  form  a  new  or 
'  coup  led-  cell '  ;  this  process  is  called  'conjugation,'  or,  if  the 
'pairing-cells'  are  dissimilar,  'fertilisation.'  We  must  bear 
in  mind  that  conjugation  processes  are  not,  strictly  speaking, 
processes  of  multiplication ;  for  the  act  of  pairing  halves  the  total 
number  of  cells  for  the  time  being,  one  replacing  two:  the  two 
literally  become  one  flesh. 

We  very  often  find  these  three  reproductive  processes  recurring  in 
cycles,  e.g.,  a  succession  of  simple  divisions  at  the  limit  of  growth  is 
wound  up  by  brood-formation,  and  the  brood-cells  conjugate  ;  the 
coupled-cell  then  initiates  a  fresh  cycle.  But  the  order  of  the  processes 
varies  in  different  cases,  and  sometimes  even  different  modes  of  brood 
division  may  alternate.  Thus  a  common  Gregarine,  parasitic  in  the 
Earthworm,  shows  the  following :  after  conjugation  the  coupled-cell 
undergoes  repeated  brood  divisions  so  as  to  form  many  hundred  of 
brood  cells  ;  each  of  these  matures  into  an  oat-shaped  body  sur- 
rounded by  a  hard  shell.  After  a  time  the  oat-shaped  cell  divides 
again  by  brood  formation  into  eight  sickle-shaped  cells,  which  finally 
leave  the  oat-shaped  case  and  migrate  into  the  living  cells  of  the  worm. 

In  many  cases  the  separation  of  the  daughter-  or  brood-cells  is 
not  complete,  and  they  remain  associated  in  more  or  less  close  union. 
Such  an  assemblage  of  cells  of  common  origin  is  called  a  biological 
'colony'  in  the  strict  sense,  the  term  'social  aggregate' 
being  used  for  an  assemblage  formed  like  a  human  colony  by  the 
flocking  together  of  originally  isolated  organisms.  Protist  colonies 
may  be  formed  in  three  ways,  the  third  being  only  a  combination  of 
the  first  two  : 

(1)  Cell  division,  alternating  with  intervals  of  growth,  gives 

rise  to  daughter-cells  which  remain  united  together. 

(2)  Brood  division  (segmentation)  produces  a  number  of 

cells  which  remain  united  together. 

(3)  A  colony  first  formed  by  segmentation  continues  to  enlarge 

by    the    division    after    growth   of  its  several  cells,  the 
daughter-cells  still  remaining  connected. 
Colonies  of  the  first  and  third  type  may  be  propagated  by  the 

separation  of  a  part  of  the  colony  ;  if  the  separated  part  consist  of  a 

single  cell  this  merges  into  true  reproduction. 


236  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

In  the  most  primitive  colonial  Protist,  all  the  cells  of  a  colony 
are  practically  alike  ;  and  the  colony  ultimately  breaks  up  into  its 
individual  cells,  which  reproduce  in  one  or  other  of  the  ways  de- 
scribed above.  But  in  some  cases  the  colonial  habit  has  induced 
differentiation  among  the  cells.  There  is  a  striking  example  of  this 
in  Protospongia  haeckclii  (a  small  organism  found  in  pond-water  by 
Savile  Kent),  which  consists  of  a  large  mass  of  cells  united  by  a 
gelatinous  secretion.  Those  at  the  outside  of  the  mass  are  provided 
with  a  waving  lash,  the  base  of  which  is  surrounded  by  a  funnel  or 
collar  of  protoplasm.  These  cells  take  in  the  food  particles  brought 
into  contact  with  them  by  the  waving  of  the  lashes  in  the  surround- 
ing water ;  while  the  cells  at  the  centre  of  the  colony  appear  to  be 
only  indirectly  nourished  by  the  food,  which  is  digested  and  trans- 
mitted to  them  from  the  collared-cells.  Our  knowledge  of  the  life- 
cycle  of  the  organism  is  still  very  incomplete,  but  it  appears  certain 
that  only  the  central-cells  can  truly  act  as  reproductive  cells  by 
segmentation,  while  outer-cells  may  possibly  separate  to  propagate 
the  race  also  by  the  slower  process  of  nutrition  and  growth,  followed 
at  intervals  by  simple  division.  We  might  almost  regard  this  as  a 
Metazoon  with  two  tissues — the  outer  one  nutritive,  the  inner  repro- 
ductive, and  ascribe  the  specialisation  to  the  relative  position  of  the 
two  layers :  the  outer  one  is  favourably  situated  for  obtaining  food 
from  the  ambient  water  ;  while  the  inner,  debarred  from  all  activity 
by  its  position,  and  fed  and  sheltered  from  the  stress  of  contact  with 
the  unkind  world  by  the  outer  layer,  devotes  its  energies  to  the 
reproduction  of  the  species. 

Indeed,  this  organism,  as  its  name  implies,  is,  as  it  were,  a  fore- 
runner of  the  Sponges,  and  probably  represents  a  last  survivor  of 
their  ancestral  type.  For  a  simple  Sponge  is  a  sack  attached  by 
the  bottom  and  widely  open  above,  with  the  wall  pierced  by 
numerous  pores.  This  wall  consists  of  three  layers,  an  outer 
epidermic  layer,  an  intermediate  layer,  and  an  inner  or  stomach 
layer,  the  cells  of  the  last  possessing  lash  and  collar.  The  lashes  of 
the  stomach-cells  produce  a  constant  current  of  sea  water  through  the 
sack,  which  passes  in  through  the  pores  and  out  through  the  mouth, 
and  brings  with  it  the  food  particles  which  the  stomach-cells 
alone  can  take  up,  the  two  other  layers  being  nourished  by  them. 
In  this  case  it  seems  that  only  such  fragments  of  the  Sponge  as 
contain  all  three  layers  can  propagate  it ;  and  in  nature,  indeed, 
hollow  outgrowths  of  the  sack  are  formed  as  branches,  and  may  even 
be  detached  as  buds.  But  only  the  intermediate  layer,  sheltered  as 
it  is  on  every  side,  differentiates  certain  cells  as  reproductive-cells. 
These  by  brood  divisions  produce  male  and  female  pairing-cells  ;  and 
the  coupled-cell  after  fertilisation  grows  up  into  a  fresh  Sponge. 
We  have  here  a  very   marked  advance  on  the  primitive   colonial 


1897J      FUNDAMENTAL  PRINCIPLES  OF  HEREDITY     237 

Protists  ;  for  here  the  colonial  organism  can  only  be  propagated  by 
the  co-operation  of  all  three  kinds  of  cells.  The  individual  cell  is 
no  longer  a  Jack-of-all-trades,  but  it  has  been  so  specialised  that  it 
needs  the  association  and  co-operation  of  cells  specialised  in  other 
directions  to  form  a  complete  self-sufficing  organism  ;  and  each  kind 
of  cell  can  by  growth  and  division  only  reproduce  its  own  type  and 
tissue  ;  but  not  the  complete  organism  of  which  it  formed  a  part.  This 
has  been  aptly  termed  by  Orpen  Bower  a  process  of  sterilisation. 
We  have  noted  the  richer  endowment  of  certain  of  the  inter- 
mediate-cells. We  must  now  follow  up  the  fate  of  the  coupled-cell 
(fertilised  egg,  oosperm).  This  divides  afresh  repeatedly,  and  by 
its  segmentation  gives  rise  to  a  hollow  spherical  colony,  one  hemi- 
sphere being  composed  of  smooth  cells,  while  the  other  is  provided 
with  lashes.  The  latter  now  sinks  into  the  former  so  as  to  give 
the  colony  the   form   of  a  lined  skull-cap.      The  lining  is  composed 


s£omcx,c7\   gbZZs      V  segme.7i£oc^rcci-rz. 


qZccZeT-rrzoc    c<>Z£&.     ?nzx£cZ£e,   ceZ&s 


A     ' 


&7~oooZ  6Zii/£sio77s 


of  collared-cells,  which  are  the  stomach-cells;  the  outer  layer  of 
cells  again  divides  into  two  layers,  the  epidermic  and  middle 
cells  respectively.  This  is  essentially  the  processes  of  reproduction  and 
early  embryonic  found  growth  in  all  Higher  Animals,  save  that  the 
middle  layer  may  be  formed  from  the  inturned  cells  instead  of,  or  as 
well  as,  the  outer  ones,  and  that  the  reproductive  cells  may  be  formed 
in  different  layers  in  different  classes.  The  annexed  genealogical 
table,  starting  with  the  coupled-cell  and  ending  with  the  pairing  or 
sexual  cells,  represents  the  cellular  pedigree  in  a  Sponge.1 

From  the  above  it  is  clear  that  the  coupled-cells,  though  they 
are  descended  from  middle-cells  only,  yet  produce  by  their  divisions 
offspring  that  ultimately  become  cells  of  kinds  which  are  different, 
and  have  never  been  in  the  line  of  their  direct  descent.  We  might 
compare    this    with    a   race    of    which    the    older    and   the    younger 

1  In  this   and   the  tables  to  follow  we  use  the  signs  X  to  indicate  segmentation, 
A  A  to  indicate  brood  divisions,  and  II  to  indicate  divisions  alternating  with  growth. 


238  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

members  of  a  family  were  always  sterile  and  different  in  character 
and  endowments  from  the  intermediate,  fertile  children,  but  where 
every  fertile  couple  produced  among  its  progeny  some  resembling 
the  parents,  others  with  the  endowments  and  characters  of  the 
sterile  uncles  and  aunts ; x  we  must,  however,  bear  in  mind  that  any 
comparison  of  a  strict  cellular  pedigree  with  the  genealogical  table 
of  the  members  of  a  Metazoan  race  is  only  an  analogy. 

While  the  main  features  of  reproduction  in  the  Higher  Animals 
run  on  the  same  general  lines  as  the  Sponges,  certain  of  them  may 
present  differences  ;  and  especially,  as  above  noted,  the  relation  of 
the  middle  and  the  reproductive  cells  to  those  of  the  two  original 
germ  layers  respectively,  varies  in  different  groups. 

Propagation  by  budding!  in  the  higher  animals,  and  regener- 
ation, or  the  repair  of  injuries,  are  essentially  two  different  aspects 
of  the  same  phenomenon.  In  both  cases  the  cells  of  one  or  more 
tissues  multiply  rapidly,  and  revert  more  or  less  closely  to  the  state 
they  possessed  in  the  developing  embryo.  In  some  cases  these 
'  embryonic  cells '  can  only  give  rise  to  tissues  like  those  they 
respectively  sprung  from,  or,  at  least,  to  tissues  belonging  to  the 
same  layer ;  but  in  the  lowest  Worms  the  middle- cells  are  capable 
of  thus  forming  other  layers.  In  the  Vertebrata  the  regenerative 
functions  are  strictly  limited  ;  thus,  if  the  surface  of  the  skin  is 
completely  removed  over  an  ulcer  or  burn,  the  new  epidermis  only 
grows  over  by  gradual  extension  of  the  living  epidermis  at  the 
edges,  not  by  its  direct  growth  upon  the  raw.  This  is  the  rationale 
of  the  modern  practice  of  '  skin  grafts,'  which  implanted  at  intervals 
over  the  surface  of  a  healing  wound  give  so  many  centres  for  the 
new  overgrowth  of  epidermis  to  start  from,  thus  accelerating  the 
process  of  '  skinning  over.' 

Most  tissues  of  the  Higher  Animals  retain  sufficient  '  vitality ' 
to  be  able  to  enter  at  once  on  processes  of  regeneration  of  their  own 
individual  kind  in  cases  of  wounds ;  and  in  the  Newts,  for  instance, 
even  a  complete  structure  like  a  limb  or  an  eye  can  be  renewed 
after  amputation.  The  epiderm  of  Vertebrates  retains  in  its 
deepest  layer  an  almost  indefinite  power  of  growth  and  reproduction, 
the  cells  next  the  true  skin  forming  a  continuous  stratum,  each  cell 
of  which  is  constantly  growing  and  dividing,  the  upper  cell  at  each 
division  becoming  horny,  to  be  ultimately  cast  off  as  other  horny 
cells  are  formed  beneath  it,  while  the  lower  retains  the  original 
power  of  growth  and  division.  This  layer  is  absolutely  comparable 
to  the  layer  of  cells  that  forms  cork  in  most  green  plants.  The 
periosteum  or  layer  of  cells  overlying  the  bone  has  similar  but  less 
active  powers. 

1  The  case  we  have  suggested  for  comparison  is  actually  found  in  social  Insects  with 
their  '  sterile  castes '  in  each  generation. 


1897]      FUNDAMENTAL  PRINCIPLES  OF  HEREDITY     239 

Reviewing  the  facts,  we  find  that 

(i.)  In  Protista,  each  cell  retains  the  power  of  reproducing  in 
its  offspring  its  own  characters  or  those  of  a  direct  ancestral  cell, 
which  we  may  term  the  law  of  direct  cellular  transmission 
uninterrupted  or  alternating,  according  as  only  one  or  several 
alternating  modes  of  cellular  reproduction  constitute  the  genetic 
cycle. 

(ii.)  In  Metazoa,  the  power  of  reproducing  a  complete  organism 
is  confined  to  certain  reproductive  cells,  which  must  beget  in  their 
progeny  cells  like  those  which  are  only  related  to  them  collaterally ; 
this  we  call  the  law  of  collateral  cellular  transmission. 

(iii.)  The  remaining  cells  of  the  Metazoan  can  seldom  or  never 
revert  closely  enough  to  a  primitive  type  to  produce  all  those  other 
tissues  of  which  they  are  collaterals,  though  their  propagative  power 
may  be  very  great.  This  limitation  of  reproductive  power  we  may 
call  the  law  of  specialised  sterility. 

(iv.)  In  most  cases  of  animal  budding  or  repair  we  find  that  the 
several  tissues  co-operate  to  produce  a  complete  organism ;  this  we 
call  the  law  of  co-operative  propagation. 

Marcus  Hartog. 

(To  be  continued.) 


575  240  [October 

575.3 


II 

The  Place  of  Isolation  in  Organic  Evolution 

ALTHOUGH  most  writers  on  evolution  mention  the  subject  of 
isolation,  very  few  attach  much  importance  to  it,  Professor 
Cope  even  considering  it  as  a  function  of  natural  selection,1  which 
is  putting  the  cart  before  the  horse.  This  neglect  of  isolation  is 
probably  due  to  the  term  '  selection '  having  been  used  in  such  a 
variety  of  ways  and  having  been  made  to  include  almost  every 
process  in  evolution,  even  the  origination  of  variations.  But  such 
indiscriminate  use  of  a  word  which  has  a  very  definite  meaning  is 
objectionable,  for  it  confuses  in  our  minds  several  totally  different 
things.  To  me  it  seems  self-evident  that  all  the  known  factors  of 
organic  evolution  should  be  arranged  under  two  heads  :  (1)  the 
origin  of  variations  capable  of  being  transmitted  by  amphimixis  or 
by  environment,  or  by  use  and  disuse,  or  by  any  other  means ;  and 
(2)  the  preservation  of  variations  by  isolation  or  segregation,  as  it 
has  also  been  called.  Possibly  '  internal  tendency,'  '  kinetogenesis,' 
or  '  action  of  the  environment '  may  be  other  causes  which  tend  to 
preserve  variations,  but  they  have  not  yet  been  clearly  established  as 
such,  while  there  is  strong  evidence  in  favour  of  isolation  being  the 
chief,  if  not  the  only,  cause  of  the  preservation  of  variations.  The 
subject  of  this  paper  is  to  point  out  the  important  part  which 
isolation  must  play  in  evolution. 

Professor  Y.  Delboeuf  has  shown 2  that  if  in  any  species  a 
number  of  individuals,  bearing  a  ratio  not  infinitely  small  to  the 
entire  number  of  births,  are  in  every  generation  born  with  a 
particular  variation,  which  is  neither  beneficial  nor  injurious,  and  if 
it  is  not  counteracted  by  reversion,  then  the  proportion  of  the 
new  variation  to  the  original  form  will  increase  until  it  approaches 
infinitely  near  to  equality.  Now  the  effect  of  the  isolation  of  a  few 
individuals  is  to  largely  increase  the  ratio  of  any  new  variation 
which  may  appear  among  them  to  the  total  number  of  births,  and 
thus  to  largely  increase  the  chances  of  its  preservation.  On  the 
other  hand,  every  variation  which  arises  in  a  few  individuals,  and 
which  is  subject  to  the  free  intercrossing  of  a  large  number  of  other 
individuals,  will  tend  to  disappear.  Intercrossing  is  probably 
favourable  to  the  production  of  variations,  although  it  is  unfavour- 

1  "Primary  Factors  of  Organic  Evolution,"  p.  386. 

2  Quoted  in  Murphy's  "  Habit  and  Intelligence,"  p.  241. 


1897]  PLACE  OF  ISOLATION  IN  ORGANIC  EVOLUTION  241 

able  to  preserving  them  ;  for  while  cross  fertilisation  (amphimixis) 
may  stimulate  variation,  it  also  prevents  the  variations  from 
progressing  by  their  mutual  interference,  and  thus  it  tends  to 
keep  a  species  constant,  but  ready  to  vary  when  circumstances 
require  it  to  do  so.1  Self- fertilisation,  on  the  other  hand,  may  be 
unfavourable  to  the  production  of  variations,  but  when  one  does 
appear  it  has  a  good  chance  of  being  established. 

The  general  belief  that  breeding  in-and-in  is  injurious  has  led 
to  the   conclusion  that   a  large   and  healthy  progeny  cannot   arise 
from   a   few   parents   if  they  are   kept   quite   apart  from  all  others. 
But   that  cross-fertilisation   is   not  necessary  for  the  rapid  increase 
and   continued  health   of  the   descendants  from  a  few  common   an- 
cestors is  proved  by  the  successful  naturalisation  of  many  animals 
in   New   Zealand  from   very  limited  stocks.      The    honey-bee   was 
introduced  by  the  Reverend  Mr  Cotton,  chaplain  to  Bishop  Selwyn, 
who   procured   a  few  hives  from   Sydney;   and,  in    1S6G,  wild  bees 
were  common  in  the  forests  of   the   North.   Island.      Seven   Chinese 
pheasants  were  introduced  in   1851,  and  six  more  in  1856 — more 
than  half  being  cocks  ;   and  pheasant  shooting  near  Auckland  com- 
menced   in    1865.     A   few   black    swans  were   introduced   by    Sir 
Walter  Buller  in    1864.      A  few    cirl   buntings   were  turned  out 
near  Dunedin  about   1868.     A  very  few  silver-gray  rabbits  were 
released  at   Ivaikoura ;   and,  I   believe,  only  three  Tasmanian   opos- 
sums were   turned  out  in   the   forests  of  Southland  ;    yet  all  these 
species   are  now  abundant  and  healthy.      The  herd  of  deer  in  the 
Wairarapa   (Wellington)   has   sprung   from  one  stag   and  two  hinds 
turned  out  in  1863  ;  and  the  herds  in  other  parts  of  New  Zealand 
have  all  started  from  very  few  progenitors.      Also  many  of  the  self- 
introduced   insects — as    the  English  lady-bird   {Coccinclla   undecim- 
j)v ' aetata),  the  drone-fly  (Eristalis  tcnax),  the  horse-bot  {Gastropliilus 
equi),  and   Lucilia  cacsar,  could  only  have  been  introduced  in  small 
numbers,  for  each  has  spread  from   a  single   centre  ;    but  yet  they 
have   been    very    successful.       It   is    true   that    several    failures    to 
naturalise   animals   could   also  be  given,  but   these  failures   do   not 
invalidate  the  evidence   supplied  by  successful  naturalisation,  and  it 
is   evident  that,  when   the  surroundings   are  favourable,  it  is  quite 
possible  for  a  few   individuals   to  give  rise   to   a   new  and  vigorous 
species  which  might  in  time  become  dominant. 

Isolation  must  therefore  be  a  true  cause  of  the  preservation  of 
variations,  and  also  it  must  be  an  important  one.  The  artificial 
selection  of  animals  and  plants  by  man  might  just  as  well  be  called 
artificial  isolation.  The  breeder,  or  the  horticulturist,  certainly 
selects  the  variation  he  wishes  to  preserve,  but  he  also  isolates  it  ; 
and  it  is  the  isolation  which   causes  the  variation  to  be  preserved — 

1  See  Professor  H.  R.  Orr's  "  Development  and  Heredity,"  p.  234. 


242  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [October 

selection  only  securing  that  the  variation  is  a  good  one.  The 
natural  selection  of  Darwin  works  in  the  same  way :  that  is,  it 
isolates  beneficial  variations  by  killing  off  the  others.  It  is  not  so 
much  natural  selection  as  natural  elimination ;  for,  as  Professor 
Lloyd  Morgan  has  pointed  out,1  it  is  not  by  the  survival  of  the 
fittest,  but  by  the  elimination  of  the  least  fit,  that  new  species  are 
made.  Isolation  by  elimination  must  always  tend  to  preserve 
variations  which  are  useful  to  the  competing  individuals,  while 
isolation  by  other  means  may  preserve  not  only  useful,  but  also 
indifferent  and  even  injurious,  variations,  as  in  the  case  of  domesti- 
cated animals  and  cultivated  plants. 

Isolation  by  Selection — or  natural  selection  in  a  restricted 
sense — implies  an  outside  agency  as  selector  for  whose  benefit  the 
isolation  is  made.  These  cases  of  true  natural  selection  are  limited 
to  selection  by  insects.  Several  kinds  of  beetles,  domesticated  by 
ants,  have  become  blind,  and  some  of  them  are  unable  to  feed  them- 
selves. These  variations  are  evidently  injurious  to  the  domesticated 
animals,  but  useful  to  the  ants,  as  they  prevent  the  beetles  from 
running  away.  The  sticky  secretion  of  aphides  must  also  be  in- 
jurious, if  we  may  judge  by  the  eagerness  with  which  they  allow  the 
ants  to  remove  it ;  and  we  must,  therefore,  suppose  it  to  be  due  to 
selection  by  the  ants.  But  how  the  selection  was  made  we  do  not 
know. 

The  structural  growths  which,  in  many  flowers,  necessitate  the 
visits  of  special  insects  to  fertilise  them,  are  also  probably  due  to 
natural  selection  in  its  narrow  sense,  for  it  is  very  doubtful  whether 
they  are  useful  to  the  plants.  In  the  first  place  the  plants  which 
have  the  most  elaborate  apparatus  for  securing  fertilisation  by 
certain  insects  only  are  uniformly  rare ;  while  self-fertilising  and 
anemophilous  plants  are  abundant.2  Secondly,  very  few  annual 
plants,  which  must  set  seeds  every  year,  have  complicated  flowers, 
and  some  of  these — such  as  the  annual  peas  and  beans — are  also 
self-fertilising.  Thirdly,  many  perennial  plants  with  elaborate 
flowers  have  resorted  to  other  means  to  secure  fertilisation  in  case 
insects  fail  to  visit  them.  Fourthly,  the  great  number  and  abund- 
ance of  plants,  whose  inconspicuous  gamopetalous  flowers  show  that 
they  have  reverted  from  insect  fertilisation,  is  a  sufficient  proof  that 
they  have  not  suffered  any  harm  by  doing  so.  We  must  therefore 
conclude  that  the  elaborate  flowers  found  in  many  of  the  so-called 
entomophilous  plants  are  quite  unnecessary  for  their  well-being,  and, 
indeed,  must   be   sometimes  harmful,  for  they   render    fertilisation 

1  "  Animal  Life  and  Intelligence,"  2nd  ed.,  ]>.  791. 

2  Henalow,   "On   the   Self-Fertilisation   of  Plants,"  Trans.  Linn.  Sac,  2nd   series 
(Botany),  vol.  i.,  p.  317. 


1897]   PLACE  OF  ISOLATION  IN  ORGANIC  EVOLUTION  243 

uncertain  and  irregular.  There  is  still  another  reason  for  coming 
to  the  same  conclusion.  If  it  be  good  for  a  plant  to  have  its  flowers 
fertilised  by  pollen  from  other  plants,  then  the  grouping  of  flowers 
into  a  head  or  spike  must  be  injurious,  because  it  almost  insures 
that  the  flowers  shall  be  fertilised  by  pollen  from  other  flowers  of 
the  same  inflorescence,  which  Darwin  says  does  little  or  no  good; 
and  yet  plants  with  capitate  flowers  are  numerous  and  prosperous. 

That  cross-fertilisation  is  useful  is  proved  by  the  fact  that  all 
the  higher  animals  are  bisexual ;  but  that  it  is  not  essential  is  also 
proved  by  the  existence  of  large  numbers  of  asexual  organisms,  and 
by  the  fact  that  the  highest  plants  are  hermaphrodite.  The  first 
phanerogams  were,  no  doubt,  diclinous  and  anemophilous.  As  the 
number  of  species  increased  the  individuals  of  each  species  would 
diminish,  and,  consequently,  fertilisation  by  the  wind  would  become 
more  uncertain ;  and,  probably,  it  is  for  this  reason  that  the  higher 
angiosperms  became  hermaphrodite.  But  this  hermaphroditism  was 
tempered  by  dichogamy,  the  origin  of  which  is  not  connected  with 
insect  fertilisation.  The  visits  of  insects  came  later.  They  com- 
menced to  cultivate,  as  it  were,  the  flowers  for  their  own  use,  each 
species  trying  to  preserve  the  honey  for  its  exclusive  benefit ;  for  it 
is  evident  that  all  these  floral  arrangements — including  colour,  capi- 
tate flowers,  scent,  etc. — are  very  useful  to  the  anthophilous  insects, 
for  whom  the  honey  is  preserved.  But  these  flowers,  elaborated  by 
insects  for  their  own  benefit,  have  secured  complete  isolation  for  the 
plants  to  which  they  belong,  and  the  variations  have  therefore  been 
preserved,  whether  they  were  useful  or  indifferent,  or  even  when  they 
were  injurious,  as  in  the  reduction  of  stigmatic  surface  in  the 
orchids,  the  abortion  of  one  half  of  each  anther  in  Salvia,  and  the 
asexual  condition  of  the  ray-florets  in  some  of  the  Compositae.  All 
the  changes,  however,  are  useful  to  those  insects  which  alone  can 
fertilise  the  flowers,  and  Dr  Hermann  Miiller  thinks  that  different 
kinds  of  insects  have  evolved  different  kinds  of  flowers  suited  to 
their  tastes.  In  fact,  these  flowers  have  been  cultivated  by  moths 
and  bees,  just  as  ants  have  domesticated  some  beetles  and  aphides. 
The  plants  that  have  escaped  from  their  cultivators  have  run  wild 
again,  like  rabbits  in  Australia  and  New  Zealand. 

Isolation  by  Elimination — or  natural  selection  in  Darwin's  sense 
— must  always  have  a  utilitarian  cause,  because  the  elimination  is  for 
the  benefit  of  the  remainder — that  is,  for  the  selected.  It  may  be 
a  struggle  for  food,  or  it  may  be  a  struggle  for  protection  against 
enemies,  or  it  may  be  a  struggle  to  secure  the  persistence  of  the 
species ;  but  in  all  cases  it  must  be  a  struggle  with  death  as  the 
penalty  for  being  vanquished,  because,  without  elimination  by  death, 
there  can  be  no  selection  and  no  isolation.      It  is  only  the  struggle 


244  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

for  food  which  is  brought  about  by  the  rapid  increase  of  the  members 
of  a  species ;  the  struggle  for  protection  and  the  struggle  for  per- 
petuating the  species  do  not  at  all  depend  upon  the  doctrine  of 
Mai  thus.  On  the  contrary,  the  more  individuals  there  are  of  a 
species,  the  less  the  necessity  for  securing  special  means  of  pro- 
tection, and  the  less  is  the  risk  of  the  species  dying  out.  But  in 
all  cases  the  power  of  natural  selection  increases  as  the  structures 
which  influence  the  struggle  get  more  perfect  and  as  competition 
gets  keener.  It  can  hardly  come  into  play  in  the  early  stages  of  a 
variation,  or  where  competition  is  checked  by  geographical  isolation ; 
but  it  has  increased  in  importance  with  the  age  of  the  earth,  and  is 
now  the  dominant  factor  in  the  evolution  of  species  among  the 
higher  animals  and  plants. 

Geographical  Isolation.  The  rapid  increase  of  the  individuals 
of  a  species  not  only  leads  to  competition  for  food,  and  thus  to  iso- 
lation by  elimination,  but  it  also  leads  to  emigration  and  change  of 
habits,  and  thus  to  geographical  isolation.  This  subject  has  been 
fully  discussed,  especially  by  Moritz  Wagner,1  the  Eeverend  J.  T. 
Gulick,2  and  Professor  Romanes,3  and  I  will  merely  give  a  new 
illustration  of  the  principle.  There  are  twelve  different  kinds  of 
albatrosses  belonging  to  three  genera  which  roam  over  the  Southern 
Ocean,  most  of  them  mixing  freely  together — nine  or  ten  occurring 
in  the  Tasman  Sea — but  each  having  its  own  separate  breeding- 
places,  to  which  it  retires  every  year.  Now,  as  these  birds  have  no 
enemies,  and  as  their  specific  characteristics  are  not  connected  with 
the  struggle  for  food,  we  cannot  suppose  that  each  species  was 
formed  by  competition  on  the  ocean,  and  that  each  subsequently 
chose  a  separate  breeding  -  ground,  or — in  other  words — that  the 
development  of  their  specific  characters  preceded  their  isolation. 
Evidently  isolation  preceded,  and  caused  the  preservation  of,  the 
variations,  which  in  time  became  of  specific  importance.  The  three 
species  of  the  North  Pacific  must  also  have  originated  in  the  same 
way.  It  should  be  noticed  that  these  species  are  nearly,  if  not 
quite,  as  well  characterised  as  those  species  which  have  been  de- 
veloped by  natural  selection ;  the  intermediate  varieties  having 
died  out,  although  there  can  have  been  no  elimination  by  com- 
petition. And  as  all  live  under  the  same  conditions,  the  variations 
can  hardly  be  due  to  the  action  of  the  environment.  Geographical 
isolation  must  often  have  been  the  means  of  preserving,  not  only 
indifferent  characters,  but  also  the  incipient  stages  of  useful  ones, 
which  have  been  subsequently  developed  by  elimination. 

1  Sec  Gulick  in  Journ.  Linn.  Soc.  (Zool.),  vol.  xx.,  p.  193. 

2  Journ.  Linn.  Soc.  (Zool.),  vol.  xi.,  p.  496,  and  vol.  xx.,  p.  222. 

3  Jour n.  Linn.  Soc.  (Zool.),  vol.  xix.,  p.  848. 


1897]  PLACE  OF  ISOLATION  IN  ORGANIC  EVOLUTION  245 

Physiological  Isolation.  This  was  first  brought  forward  by 
Professor  G.  J.  Romanes.1  By  it  is  meant  those  cases  where  the 
individuals  of  a  species  mix  together  during  the  breeding  season, 
but,  for  some  reason  or  other,  certain  individuals  are  restrained  from 
having  sexual  intercourse  with  others.  The  simplest  case  is  that  of 
a  sexual  reproduction  which  insures  that  each  individual  is  isolated 
from  all  others,  and,  consequently,  any  variations  that  may  arise 
are  preserved,  unless  counteracted  by  reversion.  Probably  this  is 
the  cause  of  the  immense  variety  found  among  the  Bacteria,  Dia- 
toms, Fungi,  Radiolarians,  and  Foraminifera  ;  and  perhaps  it  is  the 
reason  why  Bacteria  are  so  readily  modified  when  placed  under  new 
conditions  by  cultivation.  Self-fertilisation  is  nearly  as  efficient ; 
but  a  cross  may  occasionally  occur.  Ferns  and  many  other  plants, 
as  well  as  many  Coelenterates,  are  thus  isolated  and  able  to  preserve 
indifferent  variations. 

Partial  sterility  with  the  parent  form  (the  physiological  selec- 
tion of  Professor  Romanes) ;  the  selective  association  of  Dr  A.  R. 
Wallace  ;  and  change  in  the  season  of  flowering  or  of  pairing,  all 
appear  to  be  true  causes  of  physiological  isolation.  I  have  lately 
given  an  example  of  the  process  of  species  manufacture  by  the  last 
process  in  the  case  of  some  petrels  on  the  Kermadec  Islands.2  Two 
varieties  of  Aestrelata  neglccta — the  mutton-bird  and  winter  mutton- 
bird  of  the  settlers — breed  on  the  same  island,  but  at  different  times 
of  the  year.  The  first  has  the  neck  and  breast,  and  sometimes  the 
whole  under  surface,  gray ;  while  the  winter  mutton-bird  has  only 
a  gray  band  on  the  breast,  the  rest  of  the  under  surface  being  white. 
Here  physiological  isolation  is  bringing  about  much  the  same  result 
as  geographical  isolation  has  done  in  the  case  of  the  albatrosses,  for 
— as  with  them — we  must  suppose  that  the  change  in  the  time  of 
pairing  preceded  the  change  of  plumage. 

Sexual  selection  is  better  considered  as  a  form  of  physiological 
isolation  than  of  natural  selection,  for  there  is  no  elimination  of  the 
males ;  they  are  not  killed  off,  but  can,  after  defeat,  try  again  to 
obtain  a  partner.  Some  males  secure  the  females  either  by  greater 
strength  or  by  superior  weapons  of  offence,  or  by  superior  means  of 
capturing  them, while  others  are  selected  or  rejected  by  the  females; 
and  in  the  case  of  birds,  the  latter  mode  of  selection  seems  to  ex- 
plain the  preservation  of  many  beautiful  variations  in  plumage. 
Dr  Wallace  supposes  that  these  beautiful  variations  in  plumage 
have  been  produced  by  the  greater  vigour  of  certain  males,  which  is 
probably  true  ;  but  no  amount  of  vigour  in  the  male  would,  by 
itself,  secure  the  preservation  of  these  variations  without  isolation, 
and  this  has  been  clue  to  sexual  selection.  It  is  possible  that  the 
females  select  the  males  for  their  vigour  and  not  for  their  beauty, 
1  Journ.  Linn.  Soc.  (Zool.),  vol.  xix.,  p.  350.  2  Proc.  Zool.  Soc,  1893,  p.  753. 


246  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

although  there  is  much  evidence  to  the  contrary ;  but,  in  either  case, 
isolation  by  sexual  selection  is  necessary  for  the  preservation  of  any 
variations  the  males  may  possess. 

From  this  examination  of  the  place  of  isolation  in  organic 
evolution  I  conclude  that  species  generally  originate  by  the  pre- 
servation of  individual  variations  by  means  of  geographical  or 
physiological  isolation,  which  may  be  brought  about  in  many  ways  ; 
and  that,  in  most,  but  by  no  means  all,  cases  they  are  improved  and 
developed  by  competition  and  natural  selection ;  and  this  competi- 
tion they  find  only  in  large  and  well-populated  areas. 

F.  W.  Hutton. 


575.1  247 

575.2 


III 

The  Relation  of  Acquired  Modifications  to  Heredity 

TO  most  evolutionists  it  must  be  evident  that  a  distinct  change 
is  coming  over  the  controversy  on  use-inheritance.  Not  only 
are  the  views  expressed  less  positive,  but  there  also  seems  some 
likelihood  of  a  compromise.  A  letter  to  Nature,  last  April,  by 
Professor  Baldwin,  was,  I  think,  expressive  of  the  feelings  of 
evolutionists  generally. 

Bateson  has  remarked  l  that  "  The  study  of  variation  thus  offers 
a  means  whereby  we  may  hope  to  see  the  process  of  evolution." 
This  position  does  not  seem  to  have  received  the  attention  which,  I 
think,  it  deserves ;  and  it  is  with  the  hope  of  helping  to  turn  atten- 
tion to  these  points  that  I  offer  two  suggestions  on  this  subject. 

Ever  since  Galton  put  forward  his  "Theory  of  Heredity,"  the 
problem  of  use-inheritance  has  been  coming  more  and  more  to  the 
front,  and  became  almost  the  main  point  at  issue  after  the  publica- 
tion of  Weismann's  Essays  ;  so  that  we  have  now  the  curious 
anomaly  of  evolutionists  of  the  highest  eminence  occupying  all 
grades  between  the  extremes  of  Professor  Henslow,  who  denies  the 
action  of  natural  selection  altogether  in  the  formation  of  species, 
and  Professor  Weismann,  who  nearly  as  emphatically  denies  the 
action  of  use-inheritance. 

This  is  the  more  extraordinary  when  it  is  remembered  that  the 
intermediate  position,  occupied  by  Eomanes  and  Lloyd  Morgan,  has 
practically  disappeared,  owing  to  the  death  of  Romanes  and  the 
secession  of  Lloyd  Morgan  to  the  Neo-Darwinian  position. 

The  difficult  if  not  impossible  task  of  finding  any  really  satis- 
factory test  case  that  is  capable  of  only  one  explanation  is  no  doubt 
largely  responsible  for  the  divergence  of  opinion.  But  I  believe 
there  is  also  another  cause  for  this  divergence,  namely,  that  the 
vast  field  which  the  subject  covers  compels  all  but  the  most 
powerful  minds  to  limit  themselves  to  a  portion  only  of  the 
subject.  It  will  be  seen  on  reflection  that  most  of  the  Lamarckians 
have  mainly  studied  either  the  lower  forms  of  life  generally, 
have  been  more  or  less  exclusive  botanists  or  palaeontologists, 
or  have  devoted  their  attention  to  less  important  structures 
or  easily  variable  species ;  while  on  the  other  hand  the  Neo-Dar- 
winians  have  studied  large  living  groups  of  animals  or  the  more 
1  "  Materials  for  the  Study  of  Variation. " 


248  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

highly-developed  and  more  differentiated  organisms  in  animal  or 
vegetable  kingdoms.  While  such  men  as  Darwin  and,  to  a  less 
extent,  Romanes  have  occupied  a  more  general  position,  the  numer- 
ous almost  unconscious  impressions  that  come  to  an  investigator  in 
any  branch  of  science,  the  little  details  of  practical  experience  which 
are  rarely  if  at  all  jotted  down,  even  by  the  most  painstaking  re- 
corder, give,  I  believe,  a  general  and  correct,  though  usually  uncon- 
scious, colouring  to  all  his  work,  original  or  otherwise,  and  are 
largely  influential  in  determining  his  convictions. 

It  is  to  this  colouring  from  different  surroundings  that  I  attri- 
bute the  positions  taken  up  by  the  various  evolutionists,  and  I 
think,  had  it  been  possible  for  the  Neo-Lamarckians  and  Neo- 
Darwinians  to  have  exchanged  positions  at  the  commencement  of 
their  scientific  studies,  that  both  sets  of  investigators  would  have 
materially  altered  their  opinions. 

The  conclusions  drawn,  both  on  theoretical  and  practical 
grounds,  from  the  study  of  the  principal  works  of  both  sides, 
seem  to  me  to  support  the  following  propositions : — 

(1)  That  the  simpler  the  organism,  the  greater  the  power  of 

use-inheritance. 

(2)  That  the  higher  stages  of  evolution  entail  increased  differ- 

entiation, and  therefore  increased  difficulty  of  direct 
adaptation  to  environment,  and  therefore  increased  de- 
pendence on  natural  selection. 

(3)  That  high  specialisation  must  be  accompanied  by  a  corre- 

spondingly increased  stability,  and,  therefore,  increased 
difficulties  in  the  action  of  use-inheritance,  on  account 
of  the  increased  dependence  of  those  specialised  parts  on 
each  other. 

(4)  Lastly  that,  with  the  increase  of  natural  selection,  the  varia- 

tions must  become  increasingly  adaptive. 

The  second  point  has  special  reference  to  the  theories  of 
heredity.  To  anyone  who  considers  for  a  moment  the  immense 
importance  assigned  to  automatic,  unconscious,  and  reflex  actions 
in  Psychology,  Physiology,  and  Pathology,  and  the  large  amount 
which  has  been  written  on  habit  and  its  effect  on  the  organism, 
it  must  seem  remarkable  that  so  little  importance  has  been  given 
to  it  in  evolution  and  heredity.  Erasmus  Darwin  considered  that 
as  the  embryo  was  made  up  of  two  portions  which  had  formerly 
belonged  to  its  parents,  it  was  reasonable  to  suppose  that  it  would 
to  a  large  extent  retain  the  habits  of  those  parents. 

More  lately,  Professor  Ewald  Hering  has  extended  this  idea  to 
what  he  aptly  defines  as  unconscious  memory.  His  explanation  of 
heredity  lies  between  the  physiological  and  morphological  schools. 


1897]  RELATION  OF  MODIFICATIONS  TO  HEREDITY    249 

He  supposes  first  that  under  appropriate  circumstances  a  small 
amount  of  the  original  substance  may  be  capable  of  governing  the 
course  of  the  future  organism,  just  as  the  mathematician  may  con- 
struct from  a  small  portion  of  a  curve  its  whole  extent.  And, 
secondly, — 

"  If  in  a  parental  organism,  by  long  habit  or  constant  practice, 
something  grows  to  be  second  nature,  so  as  to  permeate,  be  it  ever 
so  feebly,  its  germinal  cells,  and  if  the  germinal  cells  commence  an 
independent  life,  they  will  aggrandise  and  grow  till  they  form  a 
new  being,  but  their  single  parts  still  remain  the  substance  of  the 
parental  being." 

The  objections  to  this  theory  lie,  I  think,  in  the  fact  that  direct 
communication  with  the  reproductive  organs  becomes  with  increas- 
ing specialisation  increasingly  difficult,  and  therefore  heredity  and 
reproduction  would  cease  when  a  certain  point  in  the  specialisation 
was  reached. 

Nevertheless,  some  kind  of  provisional  theory  such  as  the  fol- 
lowing would,  I  believe,  explain  better  than  any  other  theory  most 
of  the  phenomena  of  inheritance  : — 

(1)  That   in   every   cell    there   are   certain    reproductive   units 

which  are  necessary  to  the  development  of  that  par- 
ticular cell. 

(2)  That   these   reproductive   units   having  a   very  complicated 

structure  (being  composed  of  specialised  protoplasm),  are 
capable  of  modification  when  acted  on  by  external  forces. 

(3)  That  the  various  impressions  made  upon  the  cell  would  of 

necessity  be  made  upon  these  units  also,  and  that  this 
impression  will  be  proportional  to  the  length  of  time  and 
intensity  of  the  impression  made. 

(4)  That  as  specialisation  of    tissue  occurs,  each  reproductive 

unit  will  tend  to  reproduce  its  own  history,  past  im- 
pressions becoming  with  each  successive  addition  more 
and  more  blurred. 

(5)  That  the  stronger  and  more  numerous  the  past  impressions, 

the  more  difficult  will  it  become  for  present  impressions 
to  affect  them,  hence  progressively  diminished  power  of 
use-inheritance. 

(6)  That  the  reproductive  units  have  the  power  of  self  multi- 

plication when  in  the  latent  condition,  and  that  this 
multiplication  will  be  difficult  in  proportion  to  their 
specialisation  and  complexity.  Hence  latent  germs 
would  tend  to  be  carried  on  from  one  generation  to 
another,  and  increase  the  general  stability  of  the 
organism. 


250  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

(7)  That  when  not  required  in  cell  development  they  will  tend 
to  pass  into  the  system  of  the  organism,  and  that  when 
suitable  conditions  arise  they  will  tend  to  reproduce  the 
cells  from  which  they  are  derived. 

In  the  earlier  forms  of  life  these  units  will  diffuse  themselves 
throughout  the  organism  (Protozoa),  but  as  differentiation  occurs 
these  units  will  tend  to  become  localised  at  one  or  more  places 
(Hydrozoa).  Of  these  places  one  will  become  more  important 
either  from  habit  or  position,  and  this  will  become  fixed  and 
subsequently  specialised  (ovary  or  testis).  The  cell  differentiation 
will  at  last  become  so  great  that  it  will  stop  all  reproduction  of 
parts  except  at  the  specialised  centre.  Partial  renewal  of  limbs,  etc. , 
in  the  earlier  vertebrates  becoming  rarer  and  ceasing  altogether  as 
we  ascend  to  the  higher  vertebrates. 


x&" 


(8)  That    these    reproductive     units     having     once     started    a 

phenomenon  in  any  given  direction,  the  direction  will  tend 
to  be  kept  up  and  continued  by  physiological  laws. 

(9)  That  each  unit  would  tend  from  habit  to  occupy  in  a  new 

organism  a  position  similar  to  that  which  it  occupied  in 
the  parent. 

This  theory  would  explain  the  constancy  of  type,  as  there 
would  be  a  continually  increasing  balance  in  favour  of  heredity.  It 
would  satisfactorily  explain  the  recapitulation  theory  of  embryology. 
It  would  account  for  the  recognised  antagonism  existing  in  both 
plants  and  animals  between  the  reproductive  and  bodily  growth,  and 
it  would  afford  an  explanation  of  growth  in  abnormal  situations. 

In  conclusion,  I  think  it  will  be  found  that  we  are  brought 
back  to  a  closer  study  of  the  causes  of  variations  as  the  only 
satisfactory  means  of  solving  the  fundamental  problem  of  use- 
inheritance.  J.  Lionel  Tayler. 


593.5  251 


IV 

A  Carcinological  Campaign 

DURING  the  last  few  months  there  has  been  remarkable  activity 
in  discussing  and  describing  new  and  peculiar  forms  of  the 
smaller  Crustacea. 

At  Liverpool  last  autumn  Mr  A.  O.  Walker  (15)  announced  his 
new  Cumacean  genus  Leuconopsis,  in  which  the  male  has  on  the 
second  joint  of  the  third  foot  a  pair  of  curved  blade-like  processes, 
the  feature  unique,  the  function  not  yet  explained. 

In  the  Transactions  of  the  Royal  Irish  Academy,  Mr  W.  T. 
Caiman  (3)  has  enriched  the  caridea  or  true  shrimps  with  a  new 
family,  Bresiliidae,  established  for  a  specimen  taken  at  a  depth 
of  750  fathoms  off'  the  south-west  coast  of  Ireland.  In  the 
Transactions  of  the  Royal  Society  of  Edinburgh,  Mr  Caiman  (2) 
has  re-described  and  re-figured  the  Anaspidcs  Tasmaniae  of  G.  M. 
Thomson,  with  a  view  of  discussing  the  systematic  position  of  this 
extremely  interesting  crustacean.  It  is  found  in  Tasmania  in  pools 
at  an  elevation  of  4000  feet.  It  is  in  structure  at  present  quite 
unique.  This  combination  of  uncommon  form  with  uncommon 
habitat  led  its  learned  discoverer  to  say  that  "  owing  to  long  isola- 
tion it  has  undergone  very  profound  modification."  But  it  may 
equally  well  be  supposed  that  its  isolation  has  enabled  it  to  retain 
characters  which  in  other  crustaceans  have  been  profoundly  modified. 
Reasons  are  given  by  Mr  Thomson  for  the  opinion  that  the  ancestral 
forms  of  Anaspidcs  found  their  way  from  the  sea  into  the  streams 
and  lakes  of  Tasmania  as  far  back  as  Mesozoic  times.  Its  thoracic 
limbs  being  divided  into  walking  and  swimming  branches,  it  has 
reasonably  been  grouped  with  the  Schizopoda  or  "  cleft-foot " 
shrimps,  and  in  some  respects  it  seems  to  come  nearest  the 
Euphausid  family,  so  distinguished  for  luminous  organs.  To  such 
organs  I  fancied  that  the  minute  group  of  '  ocelli '  on  the  back  of 
the  head,  which  Mr  Caiman  has  pointed  out,  might  perhaps  belong, 
but  .the  guess  has  found  no  favour,  although  visual  ocelli  can 
scarcely  be  needed  to  supplement  the  stalked  eyes.  In  the  seg- 
ments of  the  trunk  the  animal  is  rather  like  an  amphipod,  which  it 
also  resembles  in  having  simple  branchial  vesicles.  But  these  are 
in  pairs.  Mr  Caiman  speaks  of  this  latter  circumstance  as  without 
parallel    in    adult    malacostraca,   overlooking,   it    would    seem,   the 


252  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

'  accessory  branchiae '  in  certain  aniphipoda  to  which  the  late 
Professor  Wrzesniowski  first  called  attention.  In  appearance 
Anaspides  not  only  has  seven  thoracic  segments  distinct  as  in  the 
Amphipoda,  but  also  a  segment  immediately  in  front  of  these 
distinct.  Here,  however,  Mr  Caiman  maintains  that  the  appearance 
is  delusive,  and  that  we  have  only  to  do  with  the  well-known 
cervical  groove  of  the  carapace.  He  may  be  right.  He  may  be 
wrong.  The  suggestion  is  certainly  very  ingenious.  It  would  be 
inconvenient  here  to  follow  him  into  the  details  of  so  technical  a 
question,  or  through  the  important  comparison  which  he  institutes 
between  Anaspides  and  the  palaeozoic  Crustacea,  Pcdacocaris,  Gamp- 
sonyx,  and  Acanthotdson.  To  all  seeming,  however,  Acanthotclson  is 
much  nearer  to  the  isopod  genus  Apiscudes  than  to  a  schizopod,  and 
the  figures  of  Packard's  restoration  would  have  been  better  omitted,, 
since  they  do  not  agree  either  with  the  original  figures  of  the  fossils 
or  with  the  description  given  in  the  text.  Meek's  figures  (Geological 
Survey  of  Illinois,  vol.  III.,  p.  549,  etc.,  1868)  probably  give  all  the 
information  that  can  be  depended  upon. 

Professor  Gr.  0.  Sars  (12)  is  bringing  out  in  rapid  succession 
the  parts  of  his  Isopoda  of  Norway,  always  with  the  fulness  of 
satisfying  illustration  and  exact  description  for  which  his  work  is 
celebrated,  throwing  a  flood  of  light  upon  groups,  such,  for  example, 
as  the  minute  species  of  Munna,  which  before  were  puzzling  and 
obscure.  In  his  account  of  the  Anthuridae  he  does  not  notice,  and  has 
perhaps  forgotten,  the  view  taken  by  Dohrn  and  Gerstaecker,  and  later 
brought  into  prominence  by  Dr  Charles  Chilton  (3),  that  in  this 
family  the  longer  branch  of  the  tail-feet  or  uropods  is  not  the  inner 
branch,  as  authors  have  generally  supposed,  but  in  accordance  rather 
with  homology  than  appearance,  the  outer  branch.  Dr  Chilton  also 
doubts  whether  this  longer  branch  is  ever  really  two-jointed,  though 
it  is  open  to  maintain  that  it  is  sometimes  actually  and  always  vir- 
tually so.  These  are  points  on  which  the  Norwegian  professor's  ex- 
pressly declared  opinion  would  be  of  much  value.  For  the  correct 
name  of  the  very  common  Isopod,  generally  known  as  Idotea  tricus- 
pidata  Desmarest,  Professor  Sars  selects  'Idothea  haltica  (Pallas).'  As 
the  synonymy  of  this  species  was  exhaustively  investigated  by 
Harger  in  1878,  by  Miers  in  1881,  and  by  Dollfus  in  1895,  it  is 
amusing  to  note  that,  in  the  name  finally  adopted  by  each,  they  all 
differ  from  Sars  and  each  one  from  the  other.  Harger  was  unable 
to  consult  Pallas'  work.  He  therefore  acknowledges  that  Meinert 
(1877)  may  have  rightly  regarded  Oniscus  balthicus  Pallas  as  the 
earliest  name  of  the  species.  The  generic  name  Idotea  came  into 
the  world  with  one  letter  missing,  and  this  same  much  victimised 
letter  is  found  as  a  superfluity  in  the  specific  name  hdthicus,  so 
that  Idotea   balthica  (Pallas)  will  be  the  form  upheld  by  those  of 


1897J  A   CARCINOLOGICAL  CAMPAIGN  253 

us  who  think  the  spelling  used  by  our  scientific  forefathers  worth 
preserving. 

For  number  of  remarkable  novelties  the  palm  is  carried  off  by 
M.  Jules  Bonnier.  He  describes  (1)  six  new  genera  and  forty-five 
new  species  of  sessile-eyed  crustaceans,  obtained  by  Prof.  Koehler 
on  board  the  "  Caudan  "  in  the  Bay  of  Biscay.  The  depths  ranged 
from  200  to  1700  metres.  Out  of  52  species  taken  39  proved 
to  be  totally  blind.  The  new  Cumacean  genus  Procarrvpylaspis,  like 
Mr  Walker's  Leuconopsis,  displays  an  unexpected  character,  the 
'  linger '  or  terminal  joint  of  the  second  maxillipeds  being  cut  into 
strong  unequal  teeth,  giving  the  appendage  what  might  almost  be 
called  an  unnatural  appearance.  The  rapid  movement  of  modern 
science  is  exemplified  in  the  circumstance  that  M.  Bonnier's  new 
anthurid,  Calathura  affinis,  is  scarcely  published  before  it  has  to  be 
transferred,  as  it  evidently  must  be,  to  Sars'  new  genus  Lcptanthura. 
To  the  family  Arcturidae  M.  Bonnier  contributes  a  new  species, 
Astacilla  Giardi,  which  is  remarkable  not  only  for  a  quite  abnormal 
appendage  on  the  breast  of  the  male,  but  also  because  the  male  is 
slenderly  drawn  out  to  a  length  thrice  that  of  the  female.  The 
exiguity  of  the  creature  recalls  the  vermiform  male  of  an  anthurid 
discovered  by  Professor  Haswell  wriggling  into  serpula-tubes  in 
Australia.  Another  of  M.  Bonnier's  striking  results  is  the  discovery 
of  a  crustacean  parasite  upon  a  Cumacean  species.  But  this  novelty 
also  has  been  already  transferred  to  a  new  genus  by  Dr  H.  J. 
Hansen,  who,  in  a  work  noticed  elsewhere,  has  described  no  less 
than  seven  new  species  of  such  parasites. 

Miss  Mary  J.  Kathbun  (8,  9)  concerns  herself  only  with  the 
Brachyura,  but,  as  in  more  than  one  of  her  recently  described  new 
species,  the  full-grown  crab  is  less  than  the  fifth  of  an  inch  in 
length,  these  species  at  least  may  be  classed  among  the  smaller 
crustaceans.  On  the  other  hand,  M.  Adrien  Dollfus  (6)  speaks  of 
a  new  woodlouse,  Porccllio  eximhis,  from  the  north  of  Africa,  as 
"cette  magnifique  espece."  It  has  the  outer  branch  of  the  uropods 
in  the  male  half  as  long  as  the  body,  as  though  it  were  a  kind  of 
peacock  among  woodlice,  proud  of  its  tail.  Possibly  these  prolonged 
appendages  enable  their  owner  to  execute  strategic  movements  to 
the  rear  with  caution  and  tact. 

Miss  Harriet  Eichardson  (10,  11)  has  this  year  described  two 
new  species  of  Sphaeroma,  and  given  figures  of  one  of  them.  The 
first  is  notable  for  its  habitat,  having  been  taken  not  from  the  sea 
but  from  a  warm  spring  in  New  Mexico.  The  second  is  notable  for 
its  objectionable  habits,  having  been  found  boring  the  piers  on  St 
John's  river  at  Palatka,  Florida.  The  mischievous  little  creature 
has  powerful  jaws,  and  in  eight  years  reduced  timber  of  16  inches 
diameter  to  less  than  half  that  measurement. 


254  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

In  his  Pelagic  Entomostraca  of  the  Caspian  Sea,  Sars  (13)  dis- 
cusses eighteen  species,  of  which  thirteen  are  new.  Six  belong 
to  the  new  genus  Ccrcopdgis,  meaning  "  sling-tail."  Were  these 
animals  twelve  feet  long  instead  of  a  twelfth  of  an  inch  they  would 
rank  among  the  most  striking  objects  in  zoology.  The  eye  is 
enormous.  The  thread-like  caudal  process  is  sometimes  half  an 
inch  long,  fully  six  times  the  length  of  the  body.  Near  the  end 
this  lash  is  "  bent  in  a  peculiar  sling-like  manner,  the  opposite  edges 
of  the  sling  armed  with  a  double  row  of  recurved  denticles."  Fur- 
thermore, out  of  a  kind  of  gastric  sympathy,  the  intestinal  tube 
forms  also  a  sling-like  flexure  or  loop.  In  the  female  the  incubatory 
pouch  rises  abruptly  from  the  back  and  inclines  forward,  this  mon- 
strous sack  of  young  ones  being  sometimes  as  large  as  the  body  which 
supports  it. 

In  the  Proceedings  of  the  Biological  Society  of  Washington  (vol. 
xi.,  pp.  153-167,  June  9,  1897),  Miss  Rathbun  gives  'A  Eevision 
of  the  Nomenclature  of  the  Brachyura.'  It  appears  to  be  thor- 
oughly sound  in  principle,  and  is  certainly  based  on  wide  and 
accurate  knowledge.  Only,  in  a  few  points  of  detail,  one  may  be 
permitted  to  question  the  results  arrived  at,  and  to  defend,  for  in- 
stance, the  name  Carcinus  for  the  shore-crab,  Thelphusa  for  the 
river-crab,  Macrocheira  for  the  giant-crab  of  Japan,  since  the  reasons 
for  displacing  these  familiar  names  seem  to  be  at  least  not  impera- 
tive. Owners  of  Herbst's  Naturgeschichtc  clcr  Krabben  und  Krebsc 
and  of  Leach's  Malacostraca  Podopkthtdma  Britanniac,  will  find  in 
Miss  Rathbun's  paper  exceedingly  useful  tables,  establishing  the 
dates  of  the  numerous  parts  of  those  works,  the  publication  of 
which  extended  in  the  one  case  over  two-and-twenty  years,  and  in 
the  other  over  no  less  than  sixty. 

The  excellent  plan  of  printing  the  very  day  of  publication  on 
cover  and  title-page  is  followed  in  Miss  Rathbun's  paper.  Therefore, 
for  her  new  generic  name  Ucides,  in  place  of  Latreille's  pre-occupied 
Uca,  we  know  precisely  that  the  date  is  June  9,  1897.  But  of  Dr 
Ortmann's  Ocdiplcura,  also  a  new  name  for  Uca  of  Latreille,  we  can 
say  nothing  positively.  Some  supplementary  notes  of  correction  at 
the  end  of  his  valuable  Carcinologische  Studien  are  dated  "  Princeton 
University,  New  Jersey,  d.  29  Mai  1897."  This  date  was  probably 
written  on  the  proof  copy.  The  paper  was  printed  and  published 
in  Jena.  It  is  for  the  publishers  to  tell  us  the  exact  date  of 
publication.  Until  they  do  an  expectant  world  cannot  know  for 
certain  which  has  the  priority,  Ucides  or  Ocdiplcura. 

It  should  be  understood  that  the  above  remarks  touch  only  a 
small  part  of  the  papers  mentioned,  and  also  that  they  leave  un- 
noticed contributions  by  many  other  well-known  writers,  highly 
worthy  of  attention,  though  the  forms  discussed  may  not  happen  to 


1897]  A  CARCINOLOGICAL  CAMPAIGN  255 

be  quite  so   eccentric   as    those    to   which   allusion   has   here  been 
made. 

REFERENCES. 

1.  Bonnier,  J. — "Resultats  scientifiqucs  de  la  Campagne  du  '  Caudan  '  dans  lc  Golfe  de 

Gascogne — Aout-Septembre  1895 — Edriophthalmes."    Ann.   Univ.  Lyon,  pp. 
527-689,  pis.  28-40.     1896  (?  1897). 

2.  Caiman,    W.    T.— "  On    Deep-Sea   Crustacea   from   the    South-West   of  Ireland." 

Trans.    Boy.   Irish  .trad.,  vol.   xxxi.,    pt.    i.  (Reprint),   pp.    1-22,    pis.   i.,  ii. 
1896. 

. — "On  the  genus  Anaspides  and  its  Affinities  with  certain  Fossil 


Crustacea."    Trail*.  Roy.  Soc,  Edinburgh,  vol.  xxxviii.,  pt.  iv.  (No.  23),  pp. 
787-802,  pis.  i.-ii.     1896. 

3.  Chilton,  C. — ''The  subterranean  Crustacea  of  New  Zealand."     Trans.  Linn.  Soc, 

London,  vol.  vi.,  pt.  2,  p.  217.     1894. 

4.  Dokrn,  Anton.  — "  Untersuchungen  iiber  Ban  und  Entwickelung  der  Arthropoden." 

Heft  v.,  p.  96.     Leipzig,  1870. 

5.  Dollfus,  A.— "Les  Idoteidae  des  cotes  de  France."     Feuille  des  Jeunes  Naturalistes. 

No.  292,  p.  10.     1895. 

6. . — "Les  Isopodes   terrestres  du  Nord   de  l'Afrique.       Du   Cap   Blanc  a 

Tripoli."     Mem.  Soc.  Zoo L,  France,  vol.  ix.,  p.  536.     1896. 

7.  Meek  and  Worthen. — Geological  Survey  of  Illinois,  vol.  iii.,  p.  549.     1868. 

8.  Rathbun,  M.  3.— Proc.  U.S.  Nat.  Mus.,  vol.  xix.,  No.  1104,  p.  141.     1896. 
9. . — Proc.  Biol.  Soc,  Washington,  vol.  xi.,  p.  99. 

10.  Richardson,  H.— Proc.  U.S.  Nat.  Mus.,  vol.  xx.,  No.  1128.     1S97. 

11. . — Proc.  Biol.  Soc,  Washington,  vol.  xi.,  pp.  105-107. 

12.  Sars,  G.  O.  — "  An  Account  of  the  Crustacea  of  Norway."     Vol.   ii.     Isopoda,  pts. 

iii.,  iv.,  v.,  vi.     Bergen,  1897. 
13. .  —  "Pelagic  Entomostraca  of  the  Caspian  Sea."     Pp.  1-74,  8  pis.     Ann. 

Mus.  Zool.  Acad.  Petersbourg,     1897. 

14.  Thomson,  G.  M.  —  "On  a  Fresh  "Water  Schizopod  from  Tasmania."    Trans.  Linn.  Soc, 

London,  vol.  vi.  pt.  3,  pp.  285-303,  pis.  24-26.     1894. 

15.  Walker,  A.  O.—Eep.  Brit.  Assoc     1896.     P.  419.     London,  1896  (?  1897). 

T.  E.  E.  Stebbing. 

Ephkaim  Lodge.  The  Common,  Tunbridge  Wells. 


52J  256  [October 

980 


VI 

South  America  as  the  Source  of  the  Tertiary 

Mammalia 1 

OF  the  Argentine  Territory  during  the  Archaean  era  there  only 
existed  the  frame  of  the  massive  mountains  of  the  north-west 
and  a  few  points  and  islets,  which  to-day  form  part  of  the  various 
isolated  mountain  chains  which  rise  from  the  plain  of  the  Pampa, 
from  Salta  to  Patagonia. 

The  oldest  fossiliferous  deposits  of  the  first  Palaeozoic  epochs 
rest  on  these  Archaean  rocks  :  all  the  organisms  are  marine.  In 
the  latest  times  of  the  Palaeozoic  era,  during  the  Carboniferous  and 
Permian  periods,  these  small  islands  served  as  a  nucleus  for  a 
greater  extension  of  the  land,  and  then  great  numbers  of  terrestrial 
organisms  appeared,  of  a  uniform  aspect,  precisely  as  the  temperature 
in  all  parts  of  the  globe  was  uniform. 

The  deposits  of  the  greater  part  of  the  Mesozoic  era,  with  rare 
exceptions,  are  found  in  the  Cordillera,  where  they  appear  on  either 
side  in  the  form  of  narrow  bands  running  north  and  south,  proving 
that  then  as  now  the  Cordillera  of  the  Andes  already  existed  as  a 
long  and  narrow  land  which  separated  the  Atlantic  from  the  Pacific. 
Both  oceans  reached  the  foot  of  the  Cordillera,  but  in  the  Atlantic 
the  mountain  chains  of  Tandil,  Ventana,  Cordoba,  San  Luis,  and 
various  others  formed  large  islands.  At  this  time  the  geographical 
differences  of  temperature  began  to  be  felt,  causing  climatic  zones, 
the  most  active  of  the  factors  which  operate  in  the  differentiation  of 
organisms — a  differentiation  which  allows  us  to  determine  the  rela- 
tions of  the  floras  and  faunas  of  different  regions,  and  to  restore  the 
routes  which  they  followed  in  their  migrations  across  the  lands  of 
other  times,  which  are  not  the  same  as  those  of  to-day,  furnishing 
us  with  the  data  to  reconstruct  the  ancient  connections  of  the  lost 
continents. 

We  have  now  reached  the  latest  time  of  the  Cretaceous  period, 
the  most  recent  of  those  which  constitute  the  Mesozoic  era.  Water 
predominated  in  the  northern  hemisphere,  and  land  in  the  southern 
— the  reverse  of  what  happens  at  the  present  day.      The  European 

1  Translated  by  Mrs  Smitb  Woodward  from  "La  Argentina  al  travc's  de  las  ultima 
('j)ocas  geologicas,"  an  address  delivered  at  the  inauguration  of  the  University  of  La 
Plata,  April  18,  1897.     (8vo.,  pp.  35.     Buenos  Aires  :  P.  E.  Coni  &  Sons,  1897.) 


18971    THE  SOURCE  OE  THE  TERTIARY  MAMMALIA    257 

continent  had  not  appeared,  except  as  a  few  small  islands.  North 
America,  completely  separated  from  South  America,  formed  a  great 
island,  with  large  lakes  of  brackish  water ;  and  this  part  of  South 
America  had  lost  its  insular  and  peninsular  form.  The  Argentine 
Territory  had  completely  emerged,  and  extended  to  the  east  towards 
South  Africa,  while  to  the  south  and  west  it  was  prolonged  to  form 
a  large  continent,  which  placed  it  in  connection  with  Australia  and 
New  Zealand. 

It  was  during  this  epoch  in  that  great  southern  continent,  and 
especially  in  its  central  portion  now  constituting  the  Argentine 
Territory,  that  the  highest  organisms  developed,  the  great  class  of 
the  mammals  which  immediately  spread  over  the  southern  lands, 
and  subsequently  penetrated  by  different  routes  into  the  northern 
hemisphere. 

The  great  barrier  of  the  Andes  was  then  low,  and  did  not  hinder 
the  atmospheric  currents.  The  climate  was  hot  and  humid,  and  a 
luxuriant  vegetation  covered  all  the  Argentine  Territory.  As  far  as 
the  present  Patagonian  plains,  to-day  dry  and  sterile,  there  flourished 
large  forests  of  palms  and  conifers,  whose  petrified  remains  fill  whole 
deposits,  in  which  one  continually  finds  huge  tree  trunks  trans- 
formed into  flint  still  occupying  their  natural  position  and  constitut- 
ing dead  forests,  forests  of  stone,  columns  of  flint  such  as  that  which 
one  can  see  opposite  the  Museum  of  La  Plata  crowned  with  the  bust  of 
the  unfortunate  Crevaux,  and  which  the  imagination  of  the  dwellers 
of  the  Patagonian  deserts,  on  account  of  the  undulation  of  the  land, 
takes  to  be  the  masts  of  petrified  ships. 

Alternating  with  the  branches  and  tree  trunks  transformed  into 
stone,  which  fill  the  deposits  of  sandy  rock  appearing  at  various 
points  of  the  Patagonian  Territory,  large  bones  are  met  with 
similarly  petrified,  belonging  to  terrestrial  vertebrates  of  the  ex- 
tinct group  Dinosauria.  They  were  reptiles  with  an  enormously 
thick  tail,  and  the  hind  limbs  much  longer  and  thicker  than  the 
fore  limbs,  so  that,  supporting  the  body  on  the  hind  limbs  and  tail, 
they  could  assume  a  semi- vertical  or  oblique  position  resembling 
that  of  a  kangaroo.1  When  one  says  that  as  a  matter  of  fact  they 
could  have  looked  over  the  roofs  of  most  of  the  buildings  at  La 
Plata,  one  can  judge  of  the  truly  colossal  size  which  some  repre- 
sentatives of  this  group  attained. 

The  birds  of  that  time  were  no  less  noteworthy  than  the  reptiles. 
They  were  such  as  Physornis  and  Phororhacos,  true  monsters,  bipeds 
with  short  and  thick  wings,  the  claws  of  an  eagle,  and  the  beak  of 

1  Of  the  three  sub-orders  into  which  the  Dinosauria  are  divided,  namely,  Sauropoda, 
Theropoda,  and  Orthopoda,  the  characters  mentioned  above  are  peculiar  to  the  two  last. 
The  sub-order  of  the  Sauropoda,  to  which  the  gigantic  genera  of  Patagonia,  Argyromurus 
and  Tilanosaurus  Lyd. ,  belong,  have  the  four  limbs  more  or  less  equal,  or  the  front  pair 
scarcely  any  shorter  than  the  hind  pair. 


258  X AT  URAL  SCIENCE  [October 

a  condor,  of  whose  size  we  may  form  an  idea  from  the  head,  which 
is  much  larger  than  that  of  a  horse.1  Being  great  runners,  they 
gave  chase  to  the  mammals  of  that  epoch,  even  to  the  most  gigantic 
of  them,  and  were  doubtless  not  afraid  to  measure  their  strength 
with  the  Dinosaurs  themselves. 

But  the  animals  of  that  period  which  in  our  formations  offer 
special  interest  are  the  mammals.  While  in  Europe  and  North 
America  only  some  small  representatives  of  that  class  lived,  insig- 
nificant and  little  specialised,  in  Argentina  they  had  attained  an 
extraordinary  development ;  they  were  large  and  small,  of  the  most 
varied  forms,  showing  that  the  Cretaceous  deposits  of  our  country 
contain  the  ancestors  of  almost  all  the  groups  of  mammals  which 
have  succeeded  each  other  one  by  one  in  different  regions  of  the 
earth. 

It  would  be  a  lengthy  task  to  give  you  an  account  of  the 
mammalian  fauna  of  that  time ;  it  is  only  possible  for  me  to  outline 
the  subject  and  to  limit  myself  to  noticing  some  forms  related  to 
others  with  which  you  are  familiar. 

That  which  first  attracts  the  attention  of  the  naturalist  in  this 
fauna  is  the  presence  of  remains  of  the  Primates  or  inferior  quad- 
rumana  {Notopithccidae)  of  a  greatly  reduced  size,  which  appear 
to  be  the  ancestors  of  the  extinct  lemurs  of  Europe  and  North 
America,  and  of  those  existing  in  the  South  of  Asia  and  Africa, 
while  another  branch  leads  to  the  Homunculidae  (Homunculus, 
Anthropops,  Pitheculus,  etc.)  of  the  Tertiary  of  our  own  country, 
which  are  the  ancestors  of  the  monkeys  of  both  worlds,  and  conse- 
quently of  man. 

The  carnivorous  mammals  were  represented  solely  by  a  group 
to  which  I  have  given  the  name  Sparassodonta,  whose  size  varied  from 
that  of  a  '  laucha  '  (Pharsophorus)  to  that  of  the  largest  bear  (Probor- 
hyaena)  ;  they  exhibit  a  mixture  of  the  characters  of  placentals  and 
marsupials,  and  represent  the  stock  whence  were  derived  the  car- 
nivorous marsupials  of  the  Australian  continent,  the  placental 
carnivores  of  both  hemispheres,  and  a  large  number .  of  the  extinct 
forms  of  the  northern  hemisphere  designated  under  the  name 
of  Creodonts. 

Another  most  interesting  group  is  that  of  the  Plagiaulacoidea 
{Polydolopidae,  Abdcritidae,  Epanorthidac,  etc.),  small  marsupial 
mammals  with  a  dentition  of  the  type  of  the  Australian  kangaroos, 
but  with  the  limbs  more  nearly  equal,  with  five  digits  on  each  foot, 
and  with  traces  of  syndactylism.  They  were  extremely  numerous, 
and  gave  origin  to  the  greater  portion  of  the  marsupials  of  Australia, 
designated  under  the  name  of  Diprotodonts,  a  group  of  which  the 

1  These  fossils  may  now  be  seen  in  the  Department  of  Geology  in  the  British  Mnsenni 
(Natural  History).  —Trans. 


1897]    THE  SOURCE  OF  THE  TERTIARY  MAMMALIA    259 

kangaroos  form  part.  A  few  years  ago  no  one  would  have  sus- 
pected that  these  latter  could  have  taken  their  origin  in  any 
continent  other  than  that  of  Australia,  and  still  less  in  Argentina, 
separated  to-day  from  the  Australian  lands  by  the  immense  abyss 
of  the  Pacific. 

These  primitive  Plagiaulacoidea  or  Diprotodonts  were  accom- 
panied by  the  Pyrotheria  {Pyrothcrium),  mammals  of  very  variable 
size,  with  pentadactyl  feet,  the  limbs  in  the  form  of  perpendicular 
columns  of  support,  a  short  neck,  large  head,  square  grinding  teeth 
with  two  transverse  ridges  like  those  of  Dinotheriitm,  large  upper 
and  lower  tusks  as  in  the  oldest  Mastodonts,  and  a  large  trunk  like 
that  of  the  elephant.  They  are  the  stock  whence  have  sprung  the 
proboscidians  which  appear  completely  developed  on  the  Euro-asiatic 
continent  in  the  Tertiary  period,  their  origin  until  now  having  been 
an  indecipherable  enigma. 

Together  with  the  Pyrotheria,  there  lived  the  Archaeohyracoidea 
{Archa colli/ rax,  Argyrohyrax,  etc.),  small  plantigrade  mammals  half- 
hoofed  and  half-clawed,  whose  external  aspect  was  that  of  a  cavy 
(Cavi«),  and  which  have  given  origin  to  the  Hyracoidea  (Hyrax) 
existing  in  Asia  and  Africa,  whose  ancestors  have  not  been  known 
until  now  in  these  continents.  The  Notohippidea  (Morphippus, 
Rhynchippus,  etc.),  small  pentadactyl  ungulates,  but  with  the  middle 
digit  much  larger  than  the  side  ones,  constituted  the  stock  from 
whence  the  horses  have  sprung.  The  Notostylopidea  (Notostylops, 
Trig<mostylops,  etc.),  'whose  dentition  has  a  rodent-like  ■  appearance, 
and  give  rise  to  the  Tillodonts  of  the  northern  hemisphere.  The 
Isotemnidea  {Isotemnus,  Trimcrostcphcmos)  which  probably  represent 
the  source  of  all  the  ungulates.  The  Homalodontotheria  (Asmodeus, 
etc.),  the  oldest  ancestors  of  the  extinct  Ancylopoda  of  Europe, 
Asia,  and  North  America,  curious  and  anomalous  herbivores  which 
possessed  all  the  characters  of  perfect  ungulates,  except  in  the 
digits,  which  were  bent  in  the  form  of  hooks  and  armed  with  com- 
pressed claws  like  the  unguiculates. 

I  have  only  mentioned  a  small  portion  of  the  ungulates  of  this 
period,  which  were  very  numerous.  They  were  gigantic  and  with 
large  tusks,  like  the  Parastrapotheria,  of  medium  size  and  generalised 
characters,  like  the  Nesodonts  and  the  Leontinidea ;  small,  sturdy, 
and  annectent  forms  between  the  ungulates  and  unguiculates,  like 
the  Hegetotheridea  (Prohegctothei-iiim),  the  Trachytheridea,  and  the 
Protypotheridea  (Arcliaeophylus)  ;  tall  and  slender,  like  the  deer, 
and  with  a  single  hoof  on  each  foot  imitating  the  horses  in  minia- 
ture, like  the  Proterotheridea  (Deuterotherium),  or  with  ambiguous 
affinities  between  the  even  and  odd  toed  animals  like  Didolodiis. 

Of  these  different  groups  some  few  have  completely  disappeared, 
and  the  rest  have  dispersed  over  the  Argentine  Territory,  passed  on 


260  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

to  other  regions,  where  by  means  of  successive  transformations  they 
have  given  rise  to  the  different  orders  of  mammals  which  live,  or 
have  lived,  in  all  parts  of  the  earth.  But  besides  these  primitive 
mammals,  which  have  left  no  successors  here  to  reach  to  our  epoch, 
one  also  meets  with  the  ancestors  of  those  which  to-day  are  charac- 
teristic of  our  country,  such  as  the  hystricomorphous  rodents  and 
the  opossums  (Didclphys),  which  were  represented  by  types  more  or 
less  resembling  the  living  forms,  but  exceedingly  reduced  in  size. 
Together  with  the  Peltateloidea  {Pcltephilus),  singular  armadillos 
with  variable,  pointed,  bony  horn-cores  above  the  snout,  there  were 
already  armadillos  almost  similar  to  those  now  living,  by  the  side 
of  others  very  different  called  Palaeopcltis,  which  gave  rise  to  the 
Glyptodons  of  more  modern  periods,  and  sloths,  generally  small,  but 
similar  to  those  which  later  were  destined  to  reach  the  gigantic  size 
of  the  Mylodonts  and  Megatheria. 

In  a  sentence,  at  the  end  of  the  Secondary  period  there  lived  in 
the  Argentine  Territory  not  only  the  ancestors  of  the  mammals 
which  inhabit  it  now,  but  also  of  those  which  live  in  all  parts  and 
all  climates  of  the  world. 

The  Secondary  era  closed  and  the  Tertiary  opened  with  a  dis- 
turbance and  a  general  change  in  the  orography  of  the  continents, 
and  in  the  distribution  of  land  and  water.  Great  volcanic  eruptions 
accompanied  the  elevation  of  the  large  mountain  ridges  previously 
only  indicated,  and  the  oceanic  waters  were  shifted  from  north 
to  south.  The  northern  hemisphere  was  transformed  into  a  con- 
tinental one,  and  the  southern  hemisphere  into  an  insular  and  penin- 
sular one.  The  antarctic  continent  has  remained  split  up,  and  the 
faunas  of  its  different  parts  have  thenceforward  evolved  separately. 
South  America  became  reduced  to  an  island  of  varying  outline,  and 
the  ocean  in  this  tremendous  encroachment  covered  the  territory  of 
the  Republic,  rolling  over  the  isolated  sierras  of  the  Pampa,  reached 
as  far  to  the  west  as  the  base  of  the  first  spurs  of  the  Andes  and 
the  great  mountain  mass  of  the  North-West.  This  land  served  as 
the  refuge  for  the  terrestrial  mammals  which  were  saved  from  the 
catastrophe.  It  was  in  the  bottom  of  this  ocean  that  the  beds  of 
the  marine  formation  called  Patagonian  were  deposited,  which  can 
be  traced  along  the  greater  part  of  the  Atlantic  coast  to  the  south 
of  the  Rio  Negro,  with  a  thickness  at  times  of  300  metres,  and 
corresponding  to  the  middle  or  lower  part  of  the  Eocene  period.1 

During  the  Upper  Eocene  period  another  great  upheaval  of  the 
land  or  a  retreat  of  the  ocean  took  place,  the  territory  of  the  Re- 
public rising  again  with  its  eastern  shores  more  to  the  east  than  at 

1  The  Patagonian  formation  lias  no  species  in  common  with  the  territory  of  Chile 
(excepting  the  system  of  Lebu),  as  I  have  said,  but  there  are  some  in  the  formation 
immediately  above,  which  is  "known  as  the  Santacrnzian. 


1897]    THE  SOURCE  OE  THE  TERTIARY  MAMMALIA    261 

the  present  time.  Freshwater  and  atmospheric  agencies  accumu- 
lated on  this  newly-raised  land  the  great  Santacruzian  formation, 
which,  with  a  thickness  of  more  than  200  metres,  appears  exposed 
in  different  parts  of  Patagonia,  and  especially  in  the  region  of  the 
Rio  Santa  Cruz.1 

The  mammals  which  had  taken  refuge  in  the  heights 
turned  to  descend  to  the  plain,  but  already  many  had  become 
extinct.  The  Hyracoidea,  the  Coudylarthra,  the  Pyrotheria, 
and  the  Tillodontia  had  disappeared.  Of  the  Notohippidea,  pre- 
viously so  numerous,  there  scarcely  remained  any  trace.  The 
Ancylopoda  had  diminished  remarkably  in  size  and  number.  The 
iSTotopithecidea  of  the  Cretaceous  {Notopithecus,  Ewpithecops,  etc.)  had 
been  transformed  into  the  Homuuculidea,  which  are  the  direct 
ancestors  of  the  monkeys  of  both  continents.  The  Typotheria  and 
Astrapotheria  had  also  begun  to  decline.  On  the  other  hand,  the 
rodents,  the  Plagiaulacoidea,  the  Sparassodonta,  the  Nesodonta,  and 
the  Litopterna  (Thcosodon,  Proterothcrium,  etc.)  had  increased  in  an 
extraordinary  manner,  the  same  as  the  armoured  and  unarmoured 
edentates.  The  groups  of  the  Glyptodons  and  the  Megatheria  were 
already  perfectly  developed,  but  with  representatives  of  a  com- 
paratively small  size. 

The  data  concerning  the  period  in  question  are  still  much 
confused,  but  we  know  that  at  the  beginning  of  the  Oligocene  epoch 
the  Argentine  Territory  suffered  a  fresh  submergence,  accompanied 
bv  new  volcanic  and  tectonic  disturbances.  The  sea  flowed  back  to 
cover  the  greater  part  of  the  plain,  while  the  lava  streams  thrown 
out  by  the  submarine  volcanoes  formed  the  sheets  of  basalt  which 
cover  like  a  black  shroud  the  older  formations  of  the  Patagonian 
slates.  Later,  during  the  beginning  of  the  Miocene,  impetuous  tor- 
rents brought  down  from  the  rugged,  rocky  heights  granite  and 
porphyritic  blocks,  rocks  of  all  kinds,  which,  beaten  by  the  waves  of 
the  sea,  formed  that  great  deposit  of  boulders  which  covers  the  sur- 
face of  Patagonia  without  break  from  the  Eio  Negro  to  the  Straits 
of  Magellan.2  The  inhabitants  of  the  plains  migrated  again  to  the 
heights,  many  of  them  perishing,  others  adapting  themselves  to  the 
new  conditions. 

At  the  end  of  the  Oligocene  period  the  ocean  made  a  retrograde 
movement,  and  took  up  the  position  it  occupies  more  or  less  to-day, 
and  the  mammals  returned  to  live  on  the  plains,  but  again  fewer 
than    they   had    been.      The   Nesodonts,    the   greater   part   of   the 

1  The  Santacruzian  formation  exhibits  a  considerable  number  of  species  of  fossil 
mollusca  which  are  also  met  with  in  the  Tertiary  system  of  Navidad  in  Chile,  which 
proves  that  both  formations  belong  more  or  less  to  the  same  geological  period. 

2  It  is  this  formation  which  has  been  designated  under  the  name  "  Tehuelche  Forma- 
tion." There  have  been  recently  found  in  it  beds  of  fossil  shells,  which  show  that  it  is 
a  marine  formation,  probably  of  the  same  epoch  as  the  Tertiary  system  of  Coquimbo  in 
Chile. 


262  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

Typothcria,  the  Ancylopoda,  the  Astrapotheria,  the  Peltateloidea, 
the  Plagiaulacoidea,  and  the  monkeys  had  disappeared.  Of  the 
Sparassodonta  and  Litopterna  few  traces  remained.  On  the  other 
hand,  the  Glyptodons  and  Megatheria,  though  in  smaller  numbers, 
were  represented  by  forms  which  frequently  attained  a  gigantic  size. 
The  hystricomorphous  rodents  had  increased  extraordinarily  in 
numbers  and  size :  the  fossiliferous  deposits  of  the  Parana  contain 
remains  which  indicate  the  former  existence  of  mice  of  the  size  of 
oxen  and  horses. 

Let  us  see  what  was  happening  meanwhile  in  the  other  con- 
tinents. Since  the  submergence  and  disintegration  of  the  Antarctic 
continent,  Australia  has  remained  isolated  until  our  days ;  the 
primitive  fauna  of  the  Sparassodonts  and  Plagiaulacoidea,  which 
were  derived  from  the  ancient  Argentine  continent,  continued  their 
evolution  independently  until  they  formed  the  Thylacines,  the 
Dasyures,  and  the  Kangaroos,  living  and  extinct,  of  the  same 
region. 

South  Africa,  on  the  loss  of  its  connection  with  South  America, 
united  itself  with  Asia,  which  already  formed  a  continuous  land  with 
Europe  ;  but  the  Atlantic,  which  extended  over  the  Sahara  as  far' as 
trie  Red  Sea,  opposed  a  barrier  to  the  direct  passage  of  the  faunas 
of  South  Africa  to  Europe,  and  vice  versa.  On  the  other  hand,  with 
the  continental  transformation  of  the  northern  hemisphere,  lands 
emerged,  which  put  the  Euro-asiatic  continent  in  more  or  less  direct 
communication  with  North  America. 

The  ancient  mammals  of  the  Argentine  Territory,  which  by 
reason  of  the  submergence  of  the  Antarctic  continent  had  remained 
in  South  Africa,  passed  on  at  once  to  the  Asiatic  Continent,  where 
they  found  conditions  favourable  to  their  development  and  evolution. 
The  Pyrotheria  developed  into  the  Proboscidia,  the  Archaeohyracoidea 
into  the  living  Hyracoidea,  the  Notohippidea  into  horses,  the  Con- 
dylarthra  into  Artiodactyles  and  Perissodactyles,  the  Sparassodonta 
into  Creodonts  and  Carnivora,  etc.  The  remaining  South  American 
mammals,  such  as  the  Monkeys  (Homunculidae),  the  Hystricomorphous 
Eodents  and  the  Opossums,  invaded  the  Euro-asiatic  continent  by 
the  same  route.  From  Asia  they  passed  on  to  Europe,  and  from 
Europe  to  North  America,  where  they  became  specialised  under 
different  forms,  each  more  bizarre  and  fantastic. 

We  return  to  South  America.  We  fiud  ourselves  in  the  last 
third  of  the  Cainozoic  era  at  the  end  of  the  Miocene  period.  The 
mammalian  fauna  has  continued  to  diminish  in  number.  The 
Proterotheridea  and  the  large  rodents  of  the  previous  epoch  have 
disappeared.  Of  the  numerous  order  of  the  Toxodonts,  there  only 
remains  the  genus  Toxodon,  whose  representatives  attained  the  size  of 
large  rhinoceroses.       The  Megatheria  and  Glyptodons  reached  the 


1897]    THE  SOURCE  OF  THE  TERTIARY  MAMMALIA    263 

summit  of  their  development,  to  end  in  those  gigantic  beings  whose 
skeletons  fill  the  galleries  of  the  Museums  of  Buenos  Aires  and  La 
Plata.  The  two  Americas  had  been  separated  until  now  by  the  ocean, 
and  the  territories  of  Panama  and  Central  America  had  been  sub- 
merged in  a  deep  sea  which  put  the  Atlantic  and  Pacific  in  com- 
munication. 

Great  tectonic  movements  produced  a  general  raising  of  the 
mountain  chains  which  traverse  the  New  World  from  south  to 
north,  followed  by  a  great  retreat  of  the  waters  of  the  ocean. 
The  continental  mass  acquired  a  larger  extension,  and  both  Americas 
were  put  into  communication  by  the  raising  of  a  vast  land-surface, 
in  which  to-day  are  the  Gulf  of  Panama  and  the  Caribbean  Sea. 
The  Galapagos  Islands  on  one  side  and  the  Antilles  on  the  other 
remained  surrounded  in  this  newly-risen  land,  and  America  in  the 
form  of  a  great  rectangular  continental  mass  extended  from  pole  to 
pole. 

The  terrestrial  faunas,  confined  hitherto  by  the  inter-American 
sea,  on  the  disappearance  of  this  barrier  began  to  move  in  opposite 
directions,  that  of  the  north  towards  the  south  and  that  of  the  south 
towards  the  north,  producing  a  zoological  interchange  which  had,  as 
a  result,  the  formation  of  a  mixed  fauna,  whose  origin  has  hitherto 
been  a  little  inexplicable.  Passing  from  the  upper  part  of  this 
recently- upheaved  land,  and  describing  a  complete  circle  through 
time  and  space,  there  returned  to  Argentina  many  of  the  forms 
which  had  lived  there  during  the  Cretaceous  period,  but'  all  of  them 
modified  and  disguised.  There  emigrated  at  this  epoch  from  North 
to  South  America  the  Mastodons,  which  had  become  extinct  on  the 
plains  of  the  Pampa  when,  long  geological  periods  previously,  their 
forefathers  the  Pyrotheria  disappeared  from  our  land.  With  the 
Mastodons  came  the  dogs,  the  felines,  and  the  other  carnivores 
descended  from  the  ancient  Sparassodonts,  the  llamas  and  the  deer, 
the  horses  and  the  tapirs,  which  lived  and  multiplied  on  the 
Argentine  plains  by  the  side  of  the  Toxodons,  the  Glyptodons  and 
the  Megatheria.  But  passing  across  these  same  lands  the  Argentine 
fauna  advanced  to  the  north  and  invaded  North  America.  The 
clumsy  Toxodon  of  our  land  was  exterminated  in  Nicaragua.  The 
heavy  Glyptodons  of  the  Pampa  wandered  away  as  far  as  Anahuac, 
where  their  carapaces  are  found  on  the  slopes  of  the  valley  of 
Mexico  in  the  neighbourhood  of  the  city  of  the  same  name,  and  still 
further  to  the  north  in  the  surface  deposits  of  the  plains  of  Texas. 
The  carpincho  (Hydrochoerus)  of  the  Paver  Parana  wandered  as  far 
as  Florida  accompanied  by  the  Ohlamydothermm,  the  most  robust  of 
the  true  armadillos  which  lived  in  our  land.  The  snR'antic  extinct 
sloths  of  the  Buenos  Aires  plains,  the  Mylodons  and  the  Megatheria, 
advanced  to  a  still  greater  distance,  their  remains  being  met  with 


264  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

in  the  States  of  Virginia,  Georgia,  Carolina,  and  in  the  whole  of  the 
valley  of  the  Mississippi,  mingled  with  the  most  characteristic 
representatives  of  the  North  American  fauna. 

We  arrive  at  the  beginning  of  the  Anthropozoic  era,  and  with  it 
ceased  the  communication  between  the  two  Americas,  the  land 
which  for  a  long  time  had  united  them  being  again  submerged. 
We  see  then  during  the  Quaternary  times  North  America  invaded 
by  new  forms ;  the  Mastodons  were  replaced  by  gigantic  elephants, 
accompanied  by  various  other  genera  and  species  from  the  Old 
World.  We  see  the  Elephas  columbi,  the  bisons,  the  Equus  tau,  and 
E.  conversidens  descending  by  the  valleys  of  Mexico  and  advancing 
towards  the  south  as  far  as  the  isthmus  of  Panama,  but  they  found 
it  interrupted  and  were  not  able  to  tread  the  South  American 
soil. 

A  last  retreat  of  the  ocean  which  made  itself  felt  over  the  greater 
part  of  the  American  coasts  of  the  Atlantic  left  dry  great  shore 
banks  of  marine  shells,  like  those  of  the  neighbourhood  of  La  Plata, 
which  provide  material  for  the  building  of  this  beautiful  city,  made 
by  the  genius  and  energy  of  our  sympathetic  rector  [of  the  uni- 
versity] ;  this  fresh  continental  encroachment  upon  the  ocean  again 
united  both  Americas,  when  the  ElepJtas  columbi  and  the  other  great 
mammals  which  had  accompanied  it  in  its  migration  to  the  south  had 
already  disappeared  from  the  north.  The  bridge  reappeared  in  the 
form  of  a  narrow  and  tortuously  long  piece  of  land,  which  served 
from  that  time  as  a  highway  to  the  pre-Columbian  peoples  of  our 
hemisphere  who  migrated  successively,  and  backwards  and  forwards, 
from  north  to  south,  and  from  south  to  north,  strewing  the  road  with 
ruins,  in  which  the  mixture  of  a  hundred  peoples  to-day  misleads 
the  cleverest  investigators  of  the  prehistoric  past  of  the  world  of 
Columbus.  Florentine  Ameghino. 


18971  265 


SOME  NEW  BOOKS 

"  Terra  Australis  Incognita  " 

The  Naturalist  ix  Australia.  By  W.  Saville-Kent.  4to.,  pp.  xv.  30'2.  Illus- 
trated by  50  full  page  collotypes,  9  coloured  plates  by  Keulemaus  and  other  artists, 
and  over  100  illustrations  in  the  text.  Loudon  :  Chapman  &  Hall.  1897. 
Trice,  £3,  3s. 

Naturalists  of  all  classes,  and  a  good  many  other  people  besides, 
including  the  inhabitants  of  the  nursery,  should  be  grateful  to  Mr 
Saville-Kent  for  producing  such  a  magnificent  picture  book  of  the 
natural  history  of  the  most  interesting  and  least  known  region  of  the 
earth,  and  for  pouring  out  such  a  wealth  of  observation  and  enter- 
taining anecdote  as  are  to  be  found  in  his  latest  volume.  We  can 
attempt  no  summary  of  so  discursive  a  work,  but  may  perhaps  give 
some  idea  of  it  by  extracting  a  few  of  the  new  bits  of  information  that 
it  contains.  The  book  is  in  some  sense  supplementary  to  Mr  Saville- 
Kent's  former  fine  volume  on  the  Great  Barrier  Beef  of  Australia, 
reviewed  in  Natural  Science  for  June  1893  (vol.  ii.,  pp.  453-460),  and 
deals  chiefly,  though  by  no  means  exclusively,  with  Western  Australia, 
about  which  little  has  heretofore  been  written  from  the  naturalist's 
point  of  view. 

In  chapter  i.  we  are  introduced  to  various  aborigines  of  Western 
Australia,  where  they  have  been  less  exposed  to  the  undermining  in- 
fluences of  civilisation  than  in  the  more  settled  colonies.  An  advantage 
of  civilisation,  however,  from  the  native's  point  of  view,  is  the  introduc- 
tion of  glass,  whether  in  the  form  of  bottles  or  telegraph  insulators,  from 
which  wonderfully  fine  spear  heads  are  manufactured,  not  by  blows 
nor  by  breaking  off  with  a  bone,  but  by  pressure  with  a  hard  stone  or, 
preferably,  a  piece  of  iron.  The  frictional  methods  of  kindling  fire 
are  described,  but  the  author  adds  that  they  are  seldom  used — not 
because  of  the  introduction  of  lucifer  matches,  but  because  it  is  the 
duty  of  the  women  to  maintain  the  lire  unquenched,  and  during 
migrations  to  carry  lighted  firesticks  with  them.  This  casts  a  light  on 
the  origin  of  the  Vestal  Virgins  of  antiquity. 

A  good  deal  has  been  written  about  the  spurs  on  the  hind  feet  of 
the  duck-billed  platypus.  Mr  Saville-Kent  suggests  that  they  are 
claspers  used  by  the  male  (to  whom  they  are  confined)  for  the  retention 
of  the  slippery  female.  Similar  spurs  are  found  in  the  male  echidna, 
and  in  each  case  they  are  connected  with  a  gland  on. the  back  part  of 
the  thigh.  The  echidna,  also  known  as  the  spiny  ant-eater,  does  not, 
it  appears,  eat  ants  at  all — that  is  to  say,  not  adult  ants,  but  it  breaks 
open  the  ant-hills  and  devours  the  nymphs,  larvae,  and  pupae. 

Another  error  common  to  the  text  books,  is  the  representation  of 
phalangers  flying  from  tree  to  tree  in  a  horizontal  position  or  with  the 
head  lower  than  the  rest  of  the  body.  The  truth,  according  to  our 
author,  is  that  the  head  and  shoulders  are  always  kept  at  the  highest 
level,  with  the  forearms  outstretched  ready  to  grasp  the  first  object 

T 


266  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

reached.     It  is  a  pity  that  the  photograph  given  is  no  proof,  owing  to 
the  absence  of  accessories. 

Passing  from  mammals  to  birds,  we  regret  to  learn  that  the  lyre- 
bird, Menv/ra  superba,  is  in  danger  of  extinction.  At  the  same  time 
we  can  hardly  wonder  at  it,  since  it  is  the  supposed  duty  of  every 
globe-trotter  to  bring  home  for  his  female  relatives,  present  or  future,  a 
pair  of  the  splendid  tail-feathers  to  which  the  bird  owes  its  name.  In 
the  excellent  chapter  on  birds  the  greatest  space  is  devoted  to  the  fern- 
owls, Podargus  strigoidcs ;  and  the  humorous  series  of  photographs,  illus- 
trating the  remarkable  changes  of  form  and  expression  in  these  quick- 
change  artistes,  should  render  them  familiar  in  our  mouths  as  household 
words.  The  familiar  name,  however,  "more-pork,"  is  based  on  a 
misapprehension,  since  the  bird  which  utters  this  melancholy  cry  is 
really  Ninox  boobook.  Other  birds  on  which  valuable  notes  are  given 
are  the  Queensland  shrike  (Cracticus  torquatus),  the  1ST.  Queensland 
laughing  jackass,  various  finches  (Poephila),  and  the  firetail  (Estrdda 
bella.) 

Zoologists  will  not  be  surprised  to  find  a  large  space  devoted  to 
the  frilled  lizard,  Cldamydosaurm  kingi,  since  they  will  all  be  familiar 
with  the  interesting  observations  that  Mr  Saville-Kent  has  published 
on  this  reptile.  Reptile  one  must  call  it,  though  its  favourite  mode 
of  progression  is  rather  that  of  the  Anglo-Saxon  messenger  in  "  Alice 
through  the  Looking-glass,"  as  shown  in  the  figures.  Another  text-book 
error  is  to  represent  this  animal  with  its  frill  extended,  but  with  its 
mouth  closed,  a  physiological  impossibility,  for  the  frill  is  supported  by 
processes  of  the  hyoid  or  tongue-bone,  which  are  pressed  out  by  the  fall 
of  the  lower  jaw.  The  bearded  lizard  (Amjdiibolurus  barbatus),  the 
mountain  devil  (Moloch  horridus),  the  stump-tailed  lizard  (Trachysaurus 
rugosus),  and  many  others  are  vividly  brought  before  us  by  the  author's 
pen  and  camera. 

Chapter  iv.  introduces  those  marvellous  structures,  the  homes 
of  the  termites  or  white  ants,  and  gives  some  striking  photographs 
of  them.  Among  other  things  not  generally  known,  we  are  told  that 
both  termites  and  termitaria  may  be  used  as  food.  The  animals 
themselves,  though  eaten  in  Africa  and  India,  do  not  yet  grace  the 
menu  of  Australian  colonists  or  black-fellows,  but  the  latter  satisfy 
their  hunger  with  the  earthy  substance  of  the  mounds,  which  con- 
tains a  large  amount  of  proteaceous  matter  in  the  form  both  of 
termite-secretions  and  of  microscopic  fungi.  Here  we  may  also  note 
that  the  green  ants,  described  in  another  chapter,  make,  when  mashed 
up  in  water,  an  acid  drink  pleasant  to  the  European  as  well  as  to  the 
native  palate.  Perhaps  Mr  Saville-Kent  knows  that  Swedish  children 
acidulate  lump-sugar  by  leaving  it  in  an  ant-hill  for  half-an-hour. 
As  for  the  food  of  the  termites  themselves,  it  is  only  too  well  known 
by  those  who  have  spent  any  time  in  our  southern  colonies,  that 
many  species  have  such  a  craving  for  wood  that  they  will  eat  one 
out  of  house  and  home  if  constant  care  be  not  exereised.  Their 
efforts  produce  a  result  like  the  sleeping  palace  of  the  fairy-tale,  in 
so  far  as  furniture  and  walls  are  outwardly  sound  but  crumble  to  dust 
as  soon  as  touched.  There  is  therefore  some  consolation  in  learning 
from  this  book  that  the  mound-builders  do  not  eat  wood  but  grass, 
sallying  forth  from  their  fortresses  by  night  along  hastily  constructed 


1897]  SOME  NEW  HOOKS  267 

covered  ways,  reaping  the  harvest,  and  garnering  it  for  future  use. 
It  is  probably  the  silica  contained  in  the  grass-stalks  that  imparls 
such  firmness  to  the  walls  that  these  Neuroptera  build.  Before  leav- 
ing them,  we  notice  a  figure,  here  published  for  the  first  time,  of  au 
infusorial  parasite  of  the  Tasmanian  termite,  described  by  Mr  Saville- 
Kent  under  the  name  Trichonym/pha  l&idyi. 

Though  this  volume  does  not  deal  with  marine  life  to  the  same 
extent  as  did  its  author's  last  monograph,  yet  room  has  been  found 
for  a  fascinating  account  of  the  island  group  known  as  Houtman's 
Abrolhos,  oh"  the  coast  of  Western  Australia.  Here,  in  consequence, 
it  is  conjectured,  of  a  southward  flowing  current  from  the  Indian 
Ocean,  there  is  a  tropical  marine  fauna,  including  coral  islands  in  all 
stages,  situated  in  a  temperate  climate,  and  only  a  few  hours'  sail 
from  the  port  of  Geraldton.  Mr  Saville-Kent  urges  the  advantages 
offered  by  Houtman's  Abrolhos  for  the  foundation  of  a  biological 
station,  and  hi*  account  inclines  one  to  cut  the  painter  of  bread- 
winning  necessity  and  set  sail  for  these  Treasure  Islands  without 
delay.  The  guano,  for  which  these  islands  are  worked,  need  not 
deter  us,  for  it  is  "absolutely  devoid  of  smell."  This,  however,  does 
not  suit  the  farmer,  who  values  his  manure  by  its  stink  ;  and  appro- 
priately malodorous  chemicals  must  be  added  before  the  guano  can  be 
placed  on  the  market.  Upon  these  reefs  we  shall  find  specimens  of 
the  corals  which  Mr  Saville-Kent  here  describes  and  figures,  appar- 
ently for  the  first  time,  as  Madrepora  protad^ormis  [sic]  and  Monti- 
pora  circinata.  Another  new  species,  that  may  be  found  here,  is  the 
magnificent  nudibranch  mollusc  Doris  imperial^,  which  forms  the 
subject  of  a  coloured  double-plate. 

Brilliancy  of  colour  also  characterises  many  of  the  fish  found  in 
Australian  waters  ;  and  that  the  chromo-plates  of  Syngnathiclae  (sea- 
horses) and  Plectognathi  are  far  from  exaggerated  in  this  respect  will 
be  admitted  by  anyone  who  has  visited  the  little  aquarium  started  at 
Hobart  by  Mr  Saville-Kent  himself.  That  these  colours  are  more 
brilliant  in  the  mating  season,  and  therefore  due  to  sexual  selection, 
is  not  proved  for  all  species,  but  is  known  to  be  the  case  with  Mona- 
canthus  rudis,  even  as  it  is  with  our  familiar  stickleback.  A  very 
important  observation  recorded  by  our  author  is  that  on  the  latent 
colour-markings  of  certain  fish.  In  the  daytime  longitudinal  colour- 
bands  are  conspicuous,  but  at  night  there  appear  further  dark  trans- 
verse markings.  These  markings,  controlled  by  the  nerve-centres  in 
the  adult  (as  proved  by  a  blinded  fish,  which  behaved  as  though  it 
were  always  night)  are,  in  some  cases  at  least,  constant  in  the  young, 
a  fact  suggesting  that  the  species  are  derived  from  transversely-banded 
ancestors. 

Chapter  vii.  does  for  the  pearl-fisheries  of  Western  Australia 
what  the  author's  former  work  did  for  those  of  Queensland.  We  are 
not  surprised  to  read  that  Mr  Saville-Kent  has  unpleasant  memories 
of  wading  ashore  through  the  mud-flats  of  the  port  of  Broome,  which 
is  the  headquarters  of  the  pearl-fishing  fleet,  and  we  are  happy  to  be 
able  to  assure  him  that  the  substantial  jetty  for  which  he  longs  has 
already  been  built,  and  that  from  it  there  embarked  as  many  as  fifty 
passengers  only  a  month  or  two  ago. 

Marine  miscellanea  are  dealt  with  in  the  following  chapter,  which 


268  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

contains  the  account  of  a  remarkable  anemone,  Acrozoanthus  australiae, 
that  builds  itself  a  home  on  the  outside  of  the  tubes  of  a  nereid  worm. 
This  the  worm  does  not  like,  and  stretches  out  its  habitation  in  another 
direction.  The  anemone,  equal  to  the  emergency,  follows  the  new 
branch,  whereupon  the  worm  strikes  out  again  like  a  doubling  hare. 
The  process  continues  till  the  anemone  secures  its  inevitable  victory, 
and  results  in  the  formation  of  a  singularly  regular  zig-zag  polyp- 
stock.  Many  of  these  polyparies  grow  side  by  side  on  submerged 
rocks,  sticking  upwards  when  covered  by  water  but  hanging  down 
when  exposed  by  the  ebb  of  the  tide  like  the  corkscrew  ringlets  of  an 
old  maid.  We  feel  it  our  duty  to  note  that  in  this  chapter  another 
new  species  of  coral  is  proposed,  "  provisionally  associated  with  the 
title  of  Turbinaria  revoluta."  Some  day  naturalists  will  recognise  the 
futility  of  excusing  their  new  names  on  the  ground  of  their  "  provi- 
sional "  nature.  At  present  the  phrase  is  generally  diagnostic  of  the 
amateur,  and  should  be  shunned  by  so  accomplished  a  naturalist  as 
Mr  Saville-Kent. 

Insect  oddities  and  vegetable  vagaries  are  the  titles  of  the  last  two 
chapters,  to  which  space  does  not  permit  further  allusion.  It  is,  how- 
ever, in  these  that  some  of  the  most  beautiful  illustrations  of  the 
volume  are  contained,  notably  of  the  shy-flowering  cacti.  Of  the 
other  illustrations,  those  of  most  interest  to  the  naturalist  are  of  the 
animals  taken  under  water ;  and  in  this  new  branch  of  photography 
the  author  has  made  good  progress  since  we  first  had  the  pleasure  of 
calling  attention  to  his  efforts.  The  group  of  holothurians  (Colochiriis 
ancc/ps),  is  a  notable  and  instructive  example  of  this  genre.  A 
word  of  praise  is  clue  to  Messrs  Waterlow,  whose  reproductions  and 
printing  do  the  fullest  justice  to  the  art  of  the  author.  The  chromo- 
plates  are  ambitious,  but,  with  the  exception  of  plate  4,  representing 
a  madrepore-reef,  and  Mr  Frohawk's  drawing  of  Chlamydosaurns,  they 
do  not  appeal  to  us.  The  attempt  to  reproduce  the  vivid  colours  of 
the  animals  results  in  glaring  masses  devoid  of  life  and  natural 
chiaroscuro.  It  is  with  the  camera  pure  and  simple  that  the  author 
is  most  successful,  and  he  has  learned  the  art  of  applying  the  scissors 
to  his  photographs  with  the  happiest  results.  We  wish,  for  his  own 
.sake,  that  he  would  apply  those  useful  instruments  to  his  prose.  His 
golden  rule  is :  never  use  one  syllable  when  a  word  of  four  syllables 
is  to  hand,  never  use  one  word  when  six  will  do,  and  don't  bother  too 
much  about  the  meaning  of  your  phrases.  When  he  wants  to  tell  us 
that  a  certain  lizard  will  eat  any  food,  he  says  "  the  gastronomic  pro- 
clivities of  Trachysaurus  are  essentially  omnivorous,"  and  it  amuses 
him  to  speak  of  a  hansom  cab  as  "that  indispensable  anticlimax  of 
British  Citizenship."  To  photograph  an  animal  is  "to  immortalise  it 
with  the  camera,"  an  expression  which  shows  that  the  author  properly 
appreciates  his  own  work.  Neither  can  we  fail  to  be  struck  by  the 
number  of  slips  in  the  names  of  people,  and  even  in  some  of  the  long 
words  so  dear  to  him.  Thus  we  find  H.  F.  Blandford  for  W.  T. 
Blanford,  J.  I>.  for  G.  D.  Haviland,  \l  C.  for  A.  C.  Haddon;  Gunther 
for  Gunther,  Rontgen  fur  Rontgen  :  If.  M.  Johnston  of  Hobart  is  called 
Johnson,  though  he  must  be  well  known  to  Mr  Saville-Kent:  even 
four  of  the  officers  at  the  very  museum  where  the  author  was  formerly 
an   assistant  are  incorrectly  referred  to;    Ipswich   is  confused  with 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  269 

Norwich.  The  lmshman  who  says  "  triantelope,"  or,  as  we  have 
heard,  "  triantulope  "  instead  of  turantula,  is  said  to  he  "less  illi- 
terate": what  particular  malapropism  ought  we  to  apply  to  a 
scientific  writer  who  uses  such  unusual  spellings  as  "chaelae"' 
"  1'ulchra,"  "inede,"  " Myrmicobius,"  "vestigeal,"  "  synonomy," 
"Ostraea,"  "Geomiter,"  "Ehoea,"  and  "spinnaret"?  If,  as  our 
author  might  say,  this  sumptuously  embellished  volume  he  dedicated 
to  a  public  with  a  predilection  for  the  literary  pabulum  furnished  by 
the  now  senescent  lions  of  the  Daily  Telegraph,  then  our  critical 
shafts  are  supererogatory.  But  the  hook  deserves  a  higher  circle  of 
readers  and  a  longer  life,  and  therefore  deserved  a  trifle  more  trouble 
in  the  preparation.  Let  Mr  Saville-Kent  learn,  before  it  is  too  late, 
that  one  cannot  take  a  snap-shot  at  immortality. 


The  Fossil-spotter's  Manual 

Die  Leitfonsiliex.     Von  Ernst  Koken.     Svo,  pp.  848,  with  about  900  illustrations  in 
the  text.     Leipzig  :  C.  H.  Tauchnitz,  1896.     Price,  14  marks. 

The  ohject  of  this  book  is  not  to  teach  palaeontology,  but  to  present 
the  geologist  with  a  means  of  discovering  for  himself  the  genera  to 
which  his  collected  fossils  belong  :  the  hook  may  be  described,  in 
brief,  as  a  guide  to  fossil-spotting.  The  aim  is  not  one  with  which 
we  have  great  sympathy  ;  but  within  limits  such  a  work  is  of  value. 
Dr  Koken  will  certainly  have  done  good  service  if  his  book  leads  any 
geologists  or  others  to  pay  more  attention  to  the  essential  diagnostic 
characters  of  genera  and  species,  as  detailed  by  their  authors  in  the 
text  of  their  monographs,  and  to  rely  less  on  the  superficial  features 
shown  in  the  illustrations,  which,  as  every  worker  knows,  are  often 
incorrect. 

The  book  is  professedly  incomplete,  dealing  as  it  does  only  with 
Invertebrata,  and  omitting  even  from  them  such  forms  as  are  not  of 
much  use  to  the  stratigrapher.  All  the  Tertiary  species,  too,  find  no 
place  in  the  second  half  of  the  book,  although  the  more  important 
genera  are  discussed  in  the  systematic  section.  The  illustrations  also 
though  many  are  good,  are  very  unevenly  distributed.  A  book  of 
tins  kind  needs  more  diagrams,  such  as  those  of  Cardinia  (p.  200), 
Megalodon  (p.  205),  goniatite  suture-lines  (pp.  60,  61),  and  trilobites 
(p.  18),  and  can  well  spare  elaborate  pictures,  such  as  that  of  the  rare 
Silurian  Pollicipes  (p.  6,  or  the  uninstructive  Polyjerea  (p.  332). 
Illustrations  that  suited  Dr  Koken's  excellent  semi-popular  work 
"Die  Vorwelt"  (see  Natural  Science,  vi.,  pp.  127-1 29,  Feb.  1895) 
are  not  adapted  to  the  present  student's  manual,  however  much  the 
publisher  may  wish  to  utilise  old  cliches. 

The  first  part  of  the  book  consists  of  a  series  of  analytical  keys, 
arranged  in  the  form  of  short  paragraphs,  each  connected  by  reference 
numbers  with  those  that  follow.  It  is  an  attempt  to  reduce  dicho- 
tomous  tables  to  the  recpiirements  of  the  printed  page,  and  is  at  first 
somewhat  perplexing.  Let  us  try  it  in  practice.  Here  is  a  small 
brachiopod  from  the  Upper  Chalk.  Section  I.  is  "  without  hinge  : 
this  has  a  hinge:  turn  to  section    II.     II.  A.  are  forms  without  free 


270  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

arm-skeleton  ;  our  fossil,  however,  has  an  arm-skeleton  consisting  of 
a  narrow  loop,  which  projects  forward  into  the  shell  cavity,  and  this 
places  it  in  II.  B.  c.  2.     The  first  sub-division  of  this  is  according  to 
the  length  and  curve  of  the  loop,  and  our  brachiopod  agrees  with  the 
second  paragraph,  "Loop  recurrent,  long.   11."     Turning   to   11,  we 
read  "  The  loop  free,"  which  does  not  agree  with  our  specimen ;  and 
then,  "  The  loop  again  fixed  to  the  median  septum  of  the  small  valve. 
16."     Reference  to  16  again  gives  us  two  sub-divisions,  the  first  of 
which  includes  shells  that  are   "Smooth,  .   .   .  have  large  foramen, 
and  rudimentary    deltidium.  17."      Number    17    includes    3   genera, 
Kinqena,  Magas,  and  Rhynchora.     Kingena  has  "  median  septum  in 
the  large  valve,"  and  a  "cross-band  connecting  the  recurrent  loop- 
hands  "  ;  these  structures  are  not  found  in  our  fossil.     Bhynchora  has. 
"  hinge-line  straight,  long,  large  valve  with  area  "  ;  this  also  does  not 
fit.     We  are  therefore  restricted  to  Magas,  and  find  in  fact  that  the 
specimen   agrees  with  the  characters  here  ascribed  to  that   genus. 
Now  this  is  admirable,  and  as  scientific  as  it  is  possible  for  such  keys 
to  be.     But  how  often  will  the  student  or  the  field-geologist  have  a 
specimen  of  Magas  pumilus  showing  all,  or  even  a  few,  of  the  necessary 
characters  ?     Not  one  specimen  in  a  hundred  shows  them.     In  tact 
Professor  Koken  himself  says  of  the  Brachiopoda :  "  Since  the  delicate 
calcareous   bands   are   usually    destroyed   or    only   discoverable  _  by 
laborious  preparation,  other  characters  have  to  be  used  in  practice." 
In  short,  give  the  student  a  decent  work  of  reference,  such  as  David- 
son's Monograph  or  the  "  Paleontologie  Franchise,"  and  he  will  have 
determined  genus  and  species  long  before  you  have  made  up  your 
mind   whether  the  specimen  has  a  brachial  skeleton  at    all.     The 
truth  is  that  the  principles  of  classification  are  one  thing  and  the 
methods  of  fossil-spotting  are  another.     The  first  essential  for  the 
latter  is  an  extensive  acquaintance  with  specimens.     Any  collector 
of  Chalk  fossils  can  tell  Magas  pumilus  if  he  has  once  seen  it,     When 
he  has  this  acquaintance,  then  he  can  proceed  to  the  true  knowledge 
required  for  the  best  systematic  work.     We  must  learn  these  concrete 
sciences  like  we  learn  a  language :  get  a  good  vocabulary  first,  and 
proceed  to  the  structure  and  syntax  afterwards. 

The  second  section  of  the  book  gives  short  diagnoses  of  the  chief 
species  characteristic  of  the  various  formations,  and  is  to  be  used  after 
i  »ne  has  determined  the  genus.  It  is  inevitably  incomplete,  and  chiefly 
intended  for  German  students.  Even  for  the  fossils  of  Germany  it  is 
not  to  be  relied  on  without  confirmation  by  the  more  complete  original 
monographs  ;  and  this  being  so,  it  is  a  pity  that  there  are  no  references 
to  literature.  The  fortunate  collector  of  a  Taxocrinus  rhenanus  cer- 
tainly should  not  be  able  to  identify  it  as  a  Cyathocrimis,  the  genus  in 
which  Dr  Koken  leaves  it.  Some  of  the  genera  and  species  to  which 
reference  is  made,  especially  among  the  Gastropoda,  we  have  been 
unable  to  discover  in  literature  at  all,  and  have  a  strong  suspicion 
that  they  are  here  introduced  for  the  first  time  (e.g.,  Ectomaria,  p.  395). 
This  is  undoubtedly  the  case  with  the  name  Amorphocystites,  intro- 
duced in  a  footnote  (p.  41 1)  as  proposed  by  Jaekel  for  Caryocyslis 
testudinarius  Von  Buch  and  C.  pumilus  Eichwald.  It  is  very  doubt- 
ful if  any  such  change  of  nomenclature  be  needed  ;  and  in  any  case  this 
hole-and-corner  method  of  bringing  out  new  names  has  never  yet  been 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  271 

productive  of  aught  but  confusion,  and  wo  are  astonished  to  find  it 
adopted  by  so  careful  a  worker  as  Professor  Kokcn. 

We  realise  the  enormous  labour  expended  on  this  work,  which 
may  be  of  use  to  many  under  the  guidance  of  a  good  teacher,  and  as 
a  supplement  to  scientific  palaeontology  on  the  one  hand  and  to  iield- 
work  on  the  other.  But  we  ourselves  prefer  Professor  Koken  when 
playing  his  other  parts  of  original  investigator  or  high-class  populariser. 

Miniatures  by  Hansen' 

Tine  Ciioniostomatidak.  A  Family  of  Copepoda,  Parasites  on  Crustacea  Malacostraca. 
By  Dr  H.  J.  Hansen.  4to,  pp.  206,  with  thirteen  copper  plates.  At  the  expense 
of  the  Carlsberg  Fund.  [Author's  Motto: — "We  want  facts,  not  inferences, 
observations,  not  theories,  for  a  long  time  to  come." — Natural  Science,  1896.] 
Copenhagen  :  Andr.  Fred.  Host  &  Son,  1897. 

Within   the   memory  of   men   still  living  an  artist  could  obtain  a 
respectable  reputation  and   a  good  income  by  painting   miniatures. 
The  features  of  the  original  might  reach  any  assignable  degree  of  the 
plain  and  the  commonplace.     It  mattered  not ;  the  portrait  on  ivory 
was  always  like  and  always  lovely.     All  this  delightful  flattery  has 
been  destroyed  or  banished  by  photography,  cheap  and  (sometimes)  cruel. 
But  Dr  Hansen's  volume  proves  that  there  are  mysteries  of  portraiture 
with    which    the  camera  is  still  incapable  of  dealing.     Though  the 
likenesses  are  not  those  of  decorated  officers  or  fashionable  beauties, 
but  of  forms  more  fitted  to  excite  wonder  than  admiration,  the  picture 
of  each  is  drawn  by  him  with  exquisite  delicacy  of   touch   and  the 
most  minute  attention  to  detail.    Each  is  confined  within  the  compass 
of  an  inch  or  two.     But  really  this  is  a  gigantic  enlargement.     The 
true  miniature  is  the  natural  object,  often  only  one-hundredth  of  an 
inch  in  length,  and  sometimes  much  less.     Under  a  powerful  micro- 
scope animals  of  this  size  may  become  decently  conspicuous.     The 
same  can  scarcely  be  said  of  the  mouth,  which  in  the  Choniostomatidae 
is  not  only  absolutely  but  relatively  small.     It  may  be  left  to  pro- 
fessed arithmeticians  to  calculate  the  dimensions  of  their  two  pairs  of 
antennae  and  three  pairs  of  jaws  and  the  joints  thereof,  all  which 
need  observing  for  purposes  of  full  and  accurate  scientific  description. 
When  it  is  added  that  the  animals  are  not  transparent,  and  that  they 
will    not   submit   to  pressure,  the  microphotographer  will   probably 
leave   them   for   the   present,  without   attempting  to  challenge  the 
deftness  of  Dr  Hansen's  pencil. 

For  the  neglect  which  this  curious  family  has  till  lately  ex- 
perienced there  is  more  excuse  than  usual.  The  poet  might  bewail 
that  in  labouring  to  lie  short  he  became  obscure.  These  Copepoda 
were  probably  short  without  labour  and  obscure  by  preference.  How 
else  can  we  account  for  their  choosing  to  belong  to  the  neglected  class 
of  Crustacea,  choosing  a  life  of  self-effacement  within  that  class, 
choosing  their  hosts  chiefly  among  its  unpopular  and  little  known 
sessile-eyed  groups,  and  burying  themselves  for  the  most  part  in 
brood-pouches  and  branchial  cavities  ?  To  lie  plain,  they  are  crus- 
taceans parasitic  on  crustaceans  principally  on  Amphipods,  Isopods, 
and  Cumacea,  having  been  found  in  only  a  few  instances  on  stalk- 
eyed  shrimps.  A  solitary  species  courts  the  public  gaze  on  the  outside 
of  its  host's  body. 


272  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

Some  prejudice  attaches  to  the  habit  of  existence  in  which  these 
creatures  indulge.  On  the  other  hand,  the  Parasite  in  Lucian 
maintains  that  his  profession  and  personality  are  the  true  charm 
and  glory  of  social  life.  The  parasite  in  zoology  may  urge  in  its  own 
favour  that  it  is  an  eminent  preacher  and  teacher  of  cleanliness,  and 
an  unanswered  advocate  for  the  theory  of  evolution.  The  family 
Choniostomatidae  is  at  present  divided  into  six  genera.  Forty-rive 
species  are  known,  chiefly  through  Dr  Hansen's  researches.  The 
first  published,  however,  was  Sphacronclla  hiickarti,  described  by 
Salensky  in  1868.  Thus,  so  far  as  their  history  is  known,  it  is  open 
to  suppose  that  the  whole  batch  has  been  specially  created  within  the 
limits  of  the  present  century.  But  the  reverential  motive  which 
prompts  hypotheses  of  that  kind  is  surely  undermined  when  they 
require  us  to  contemplate  one  set  of  crustaceans  as  specially  contrived 
to  live  and  multiply,  and  another  set  of  crustaceans  as  specially 
contrived  to  be  vampyres  on  the  first  set,  and  to  stop  them  from 
breeding.  The  latter  strange  effect  produced  by  the  presence  of  some 
crustacean  parasites  on  their  crustacean  hosts  was  first  expounded  by 
Prof.  Giard.  Dr  Hansen  finds  reason  to  believe  that,  as  a  rule,  with 
the  exceptions  to  which  all  rules  are  liable,  the  Choniostomatidae 
prevent  their  entertainers  from  rearing  a  family.  With  the  opinion 
advanced  by  Giard  and  Bonnier  in  regard  to  the  Epicaridea,  that  each 
parasite  has  its  particular  host,  and  is  found  on  no  other  species,  he 
does  not  fully  agree,  and  he  also  adduces  evidence  to  show  that  such 
a  rule  is  not  applicable  to  the  whole  of  the  present  group.  Certain 
members  of  it  have  been  discussed  by  the  French  authors  just 
mentioned,  and  some  of  their  results  are  subjected  to  rather  severe 
criticism.  This,  amid  the  intricacies  of  a  new  subject,  will  be  highly 
acceptable  to  the  general  reader.  Apples,  for  choice,  need  a  subacid 
flavour.  They  must  not  be  so  sharp  as  to  set  one's  teeth  on  edge. 
As  the  eminent  authors  reciprocally  compliment  one  another  in  the 
names  of  the  new  species,  there  is  evidently  here  no  very  desperate 
quarrel.  By  the  extraordinary  patience  with  which  during  several  years 
Dr  Hansen  has  been  accumulating  his  observations  he  is  entitled  to  be  a 
little  intolerant  of  more  rapid  methods,  which  cannot  fail  to  be  hazardous 
in  a  material  so  difficult.  The  remark  which  he  quotes  on  his  title-page, 
"  We  want  facts,  not  inferences,  observations,  not  theories,  for  a  long- 
time to  come,"  is  from  Natural  Science  itself,  so  it  must  be  true,  and  a 
paragraph  of  his  own,  beginning,  "  Now-a-days  many  authors  have  a 
remarkable  weakness  for  publishing  innumerable  immature  notes," 
deserves  cosmopolitan  circulation.  In  another  passage  Dr  Hansen 
says,  "  I  confess  that,  though  I  honour  everybody  who  is  capable  of 
suggesting  a  theory  which  proves  to  be  well  founded  and  fertile  in 
results,  I  have  always  felt,  and,  as  time  goes  on,  feel  more  and  more 
distaste  for  superficial  conjectures."  But  this  is  almost  like  saying, 
"There  are  too  many  anglers  ;  what  we  want  is  fish."  People  will  go 
on  angling  to  please  themselves,  without  regard  to  what  we  want. 
Allowance  must  lie  made  for  differences  of  temperament  and  taste. 
Some  misguided  persons  hear  of  the  discovery  of  new  families,  genera, 
and  species  with  a  stolid  want  of  enthusiasm.  They  perhaps  for 
their  part  think  nothing  important  but  the  course  of  the  nerves  or 
the  action  of  the  hepatopancreas.    Mr  Henslow  dismisses  the  origin  of 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  l»7:i 

species  by  means  of  natural  selection  as  a  superficial  conjecture,  and 
hopes  for  a  speedy  recognition  that  Darwin's  deduction,  as  he  calls  it, 
was  a  most  unfortunate  one.  Supposing  it  to  have  heen  so,  the  world 
could  well  do  with  one  or  two  more  misfortunes  of  a  similar  kind. 

Dr  Hansen's  hook  is  in  English.  This  is  evidently  part  of  a 
conspiracy  to  discourage  the  English-speaking  peoples  from  studying 
foreign  languages,  a  plot  in  which  llussia  has,  unfortunately,  not  yet 
joined.  The  translation  from  the  Danish  manuscript  has  heen  well 
executed  by  Miss  Louise  von  Cossel.  It  is  unlucky  that  one  fre- 
quently recurring  word  has  heen  too  literally  rendered  'list,'  not  in 
any  of  the  accepted  English  senses  of  the  word,  hut  to  signify  a  ridge 
or  linear  prominence,  or  possibly  a  seam  or  an  unraised  line  of 
hardening  of  the  integument.  In  naming  the  mouth  organs  Dr 
Hansen  himself  adopts  the  terms  maxillulae  and  maxillae,  respectively 
for  the  first  and  second  maxillae,  on  the  analogy  of  antennulae  and 
antennae  for  the  first  and  second  antennae.  The  great  objection  to 
these  terms  is  that  sometimes  the  first  maxillae  and  the  first  antennae 
are  larger,  even  very  much  larger,  than  the  second,  and  then  the 
diminutives  are  misleading.  As  a  matter  of  fact,  in  a  paper  published 
only  last  year  by  F.  Vejdovsky,  the  second  antennae  are  called  the 
antennules.  The  confusion  is  not  unnatural  in  describing  Anrphi- 
pods,  which  often  have  the  second  antennae  shorter  than  the  first, 
occasionally  less  than  one-fifth  as  long.  But  these  are  not  matters  of 
vital  concern.  For  the  pith  and  marrow  of  the  research  the  reader 
must  have  recourse  to  Dr  Hansen's  volume.  It  is  a  masterly  piece 
of  work,  which  will  confirm  and  increase  his  high  repute  as  a 
naturalist  of  distinction.  T.  R  R  S. 


Prehistoric  Problems,  being  a  Selection  of  Essays  on  the  Evolution  of  Man  and  other 
Controverted  Problems  in  Anthropology  and  Archaeology.  By  Robert  Munro, 
M.A.,  M.D.     8vo,  pp.  xix.  +  371.     London:  Blackwood,  1897.     Price,  10s. 

In  these  days  of  scattered  scientific  literature,  the  bringing  together 
into  a  single  volume  of  a  number  of  essays  by  one  author  is  a  very 
desirable  thing,  particularly  when,  as  in  the  present  instance,  the 
author  is  a  scientist  of  distinction.  Although  the  volume  contains 
comparatively  little  that  has  not  already  appeared  in  print,  Dr 
Alunro's  newly-published  selected  essays  on  "  Prehistoric  Problems  " 
will  be  welcomed  by  many  as  a  valuable  addition  to  Archaeological 
literature.  The  book  consists  of  a  number  of  chapters,  each  of  which 
is  a  separate  and  distinct  essay.  This  collection  of  essays  is  of  a 
decidedly  heterogeneous  nature,  comprising  as  it  does  so  varied  a 
selection  of  subjects  as  :  The  Pise  and  Progress  of  Anthropology  ; 
Man's  Antiquity  and  Place  in  Nature ;  Prehistoric  Trepanning  ;  Otter 
Traps  ;  Bone  Skates  ;  and  Prehistoric  Saws  and  Sickles.  The  very 
varied  nature  of  the  subjects  discussed  imparts  a  character  of  in- 
equality to  the  volume,  and  imposes  a  certain  lack  of  proportion, 
which  is  evident  to  the  reader  who,  taking  the  book  as  a  whole, 
would  read  it  straight  through  from  beginning  to  end.  Taken  indi- 
vidually, the  essays  are  decidedly  both  instructive  and  interesting,  and 
the  first  four,  which  form  Part  I.  of  the  volume,  may  well  be  taken 
together,  as  they  form  a  very  fairly  eonneeted  and  consecutive  series. 


274  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

They  chiefly  deal  with  the  Antiquity  of  Man  and  his  Place  in  Nature, 
together  with  a  brief  history  of  the  scientific  study  of  Anthropology, 
a  field  wide  enough  to  have  tilled  the  whole  volume,  and  one  which 
we  would  gladly  have  seen  treated  in  a  more  complete  and  less 
condensed  manner  by  Dr  Munro.  So  far  as  the  allotted  space  admits 
the  subject  is  skilfully  handled,  and  the  points  are  clearly  brought 
out;  the  style,  too,  is  simple,  so  that  it  does  not  require  a  trained 
scientific  mind  to  grasp  either  the  general  conclusions  or  the  details. 
The  first  part  of  the  book  is,  in  fact,  well  suited  to  the  general  reader, 
as  well  as  of  value  to  the  scientist.  1  >r  Muuro  is  hopeful  in  regard  to 
the  possibility  of  bridging  over  the  gap  between  the  Palaeolithic  and 
Neolithic  civilisations  in  Western  Europe,  and  advances  the  important 
finds  of  M.  Piette  in  the  Mas-d'Azil  cavern,  and  the  curiously  similar 
finds  in  a  cave  at  Oban  described  by  Dr  J.  Anderson,  as  helping 
possibly  to  link  the  two  periods.  The  evidence  of  a  continuity 
between  the  two  periods  is  not  as  yet  sufficiently  complete,  but  a  step 
has  been  made  in  the  right  direction,  and  Mr  A.  Evans'  researches  in 
the  Balsi  Rossi  caves  are  much  to  the  point  in  this  connection. 

One  of  the  most  interesting  essays  in  the  book  is  that  dealing  with 
the  importance  of  the  assumption  of  the  Erect  Posture  as  a  factor  in 
the  physical  and  intellectual  development  of  Man.  Dr  Munro  is  a 
strong  advocate  of  the  enormous  advantage  which  Man  derived  from 
the  attainment  of  the  erect  posture,  and  the  consequent  differentiation 
of  the  limbs  into  hands  and  feet ;  in  other  words,  the  releasing  of  the 
fore-limbs  from  locomotive  duties,  so  that  they  might  become  the 
servants  of  the  brain  in  other  directions,  and  thus  assist  the  develop- 
ment of  mental  qualities.  The  position  of  Pithecanthropus  crcctus  in 
the  human  phylogeny  is  reviewed  in  a  judicial  manner,  and  it  is 
pointed  out  how  the  calvaria  and  femur  of  this  seemingly  inter- 
mediate type  bear  out  the  theory  of  the  erect  posture  having  preceded 
the  higher  development  of  the  brain  in  Man. 

A  slight  rearrangement  of  the  material  in  Chapters  II.  and  IV. 
would  have  obviated  a  certain  amount  of  repetition  in  connection 
with  this  point. 

The  second  part  of  the  volume,  headed  "  Archaeological,"  comprises 
four  essays  on  quite  distinct  and  unconnected  subjects.  These  will 
probably  appeal  less  to  the  general  public  than  those  contained  in 
Part  I.,  as  dealing  with  more  special  points  of  archaeological  interest. 
The  chapter  on  "  Prehistoric  Trepanning  "  is  well  worth  reading,  and 
the  subject  is  rather  to  the  fore  just  at  present,  it  having  been  dis- 
covered that,  in  addition  to  the  interest  attaching  to  the  primitive 
surgical  methods  adopted  in  conducting  so  important  an  operation, 
and  the  fact  of  the  patient  having  so  frequently  recovered,  there  is 
also  a  good  deal  of  folk-lore  connected  with  the  practice,  well  worthy 
of  study.  Dr  Munro  has  brought  together,  in  Chapter  VI.,  all  the 
available  data  regarding  the  curious  wooden  objects  which  he  on 
fairly  good  grounds  calls  "otter  and  beaver  traps."  He  handles  tho 
subject  with  skill,  and,  in  the  absence  of  direct  evidence,  the  probable 
use  of  these  objects  can  only  be  arrived  at  by  comparative  study  of  the 
examples.  Space  does  not  allow  more  than  the  mere  mention  of  the 
essay  on  "Bone  Skates,"  whose  claims  to  be  in  some  instances  con- 
sidered as  prehistoric  are  called  in  question,  and  that  on  "  Prehistoric 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  275 

Saws  and  Sickles,"  in  which  is  giveu  an  excellenl  general  account  of 
these  implements,  together  with  views  on  such  controversial  matters 
as,  for  instance,  the  use  of  the  wooden-handled  Hint  "saws"  from 
Polada,  which  Mr  Spurrell  regards  as  sickles  allied  to  those  found 
by  Mr  Petrie  at  Kahnn. 

The  illustrations  are  numerous,  and  for  the  most  part  good  ;  the 
text  is  not  always  free  from  blemish,  in  the  shape  of  curious  printer's 
errors,  which  have  survived  the  proof-reading  ordeal  ;  there  are  also 
sundry  awkwardly  turned  sentences.  These,  however,  do  not  in  any 
way  affect  the  value  of  the  work,  nor  do  the  unimportant,  if  inartistic 
slips,  impair  our  indebtedness  to  the  author.  H.  B. 

Some  Elementary  Text- Books. 

First  Stack  Physiography  (The  Organised  Science  Series).     By  A.  M.  Davies.     8vo, 

pp.  viii.  238,  with  110  illustrations.  London:  W.  B.  Olive  &  Co.,  1897.  Price,  2s. 
Elements  of  Physical  Geography.     ByS.  15.  J.  Skertchly.     28th  Edition  ;  revised 

by  J.  H.  Howell.     8vo,  pp.  viii.  224.     London :  F.  Murby,  1896.     Price,  2s. 
A   Text-Book   of   Geology.      By  W.   J.    Harrison.     8vo,  pp.    viii.    343,    with   140 

illustrations.     London  :  Blaekie  &  Son,  1897.      Price,  3s.  (3d. 
First  Stage  Mechanics  of  Fluids  (The  Organised  Science  Series).     By  G.  H.  Bryan 

and  F.   Rosenberg.     Svo,    pp.   viii.   208,  with    77  illustrations.     London  :    W.   B. 

Olive  &  Co.,  1S97.     Price,  2s. 
First  Principles  of  Natural  Philosophy.     By  A.  E.  Dolbear.     Svo,  pp.  x.  318, 

illustrated.     Boston,  U.S.A.,  and  London  :  Oinn  &  Co.,  1897.     Price,  4s.  6d. 

The  constant  alterations  in  the  syllabus  for  Physiography  in  the 
.Science  and  Art  Department's  examination  render  necessary  a 
continual  series  of  new  or  greatly  revised  text-books.  Mr  A.  M. 
Davies'  "  First  Stage  Physiography "  will,  therefore,  no  doubt  be 
extremely  useful.  It  has  all  the  merits  of  a  good  elementary  text- 
book ;  it  is  concisely  and  clearly  expressed,  it  is  thoroughly  reliable 
and  up  to  date ;  it  is  illustrated  by  a  series  of  well-selected  diagram- 
matic figures  of  which  many  are  new ;  and  the  definitions  are  ex- 
plained by  homely  illustrations  which  are  so  chosen  as  to  be  very 
suggestive  to  an  intelligent  student.  The  only  point  in  the  book  we 
regret  is  the  use  of  the  metric  system  for  all  dimensions,  an  inno- 
vation in  an  elementary  book  on  this  subject  which  we  think  hardly 
likely  to  lead  to  accurate  perception  among  students.  It  was  perhaps 
a  pity  to  refer  to  a  lustre  in  the  explanation  of  the  form  of  a  prism  ; 
for  as  the  point  in  which  students  most  often  go  wrong  is  by  regard- 
ing a  prism  as  a  triangular  pyramid,  an  error  for  which  comparison 
with  a  lustre,  which  has  a  pointed  end,  is  apparently  generally 
responsible.  It  is  not  cpuite  correct  to  say  that  the  snow-line  reaches  the 
sea-level  in  Greenland.  But  except  for  one  or  two  trivial  points  like 
these,  there  is  nothing  in  the  book  with  which  we  can  find  fault. 
AVe  can  only  wish  the  bock  the  circulation  it  deserves. 

Opportunity  has  been  taken  of  the  issue  of  a  28th  edition  of 
Skertchly's  small  "  Physical  Geography  "  to  subject  it  to  extensive 
revision,  which  might,  however,  have  been  made  even  more  thorough. 
The  book,  as  it  now  stands,  has  many  good  points,  the  chapter  on 
"  Astronomical  Relations  "  being  probably  the  best ;  subjects  such  as 
the  precession  of  the  equinoxes,  and  the  method  of  finding  latitudes 
are  generally  stumbling  blocks  to  the  beginner,  but  they  are  here 
clearly  explained.     The  main  points  to  which  the  editor  might  attend 


276  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [October 

in  the  preparation  of  a  future  edition  is  greater  uniformity  of 
standard,  and  the  reduction  in  number  of  needless  technical  terms. 
In  regard  to  the  latter,  the  editor  even  proposes  new  terms  in  the 
course  of  the  book,  describing  some  springs  as  "  transtatic."  Even  if 
the  term  were  useful,  its  first  publication  in  a  shilling  text-book 
could  hardly  be  commended.  The  restriction  of  "isothermal"  to  mean 
annual  temperature  is  neither  usual  nor  convenient.  There  are  still 
many  points  in  which  revision  is  necessary ;  Africa  is  not  now 
regarded  as  exempt  from  earthquakes  (as  stated  on  p.  154);  it  is  too 
late  to  say  that  the  cause  of  the  rising  of  the  Nile  is  covered  by 
"much  obscurity,"  or  to  affirm  that  glacier  ice  is  "not  plastic."  The 
geological  classification  of  lakes  into  two  divisions  only  (p.  Ill)  is 
quite  inadequate,  while  it  is  only  burdening  a  student  with  useless 
definitions  to  separate  rivers  into  oceanic  and  continental,  according 
to  whether  they  flow  into  the  ocean  or  not.  The  appendix  on  the, 
geographical  distribution  of  animals  could  do  with  thorough  revision  : 
Colubus  is  not  a  "  tail-less  ape  "  (p.  209) ;  and  to  say  that  the  long- 
tailed  manis  and  the  ground-pig  are  "almost  exclusively  African"  is 
an  error  from  excess  of  caution ;  the  python  is  not  only  found  in  the 
Indian  region ;  Lepidosiren  is  not  a  reptile,  and  it  is  not  excusable 
now  to  include  the  crocodile  among  the  lizards. 

Mr  W.  Jerome  Harrison  is  a  very  experienced  science  teacher,  a 
practical  geologist,  and  has  always  shown  himself  a  painstaking  and 
accurate  worker ;  hence  it  is  not  surprising  that  his  "  Text  Book  of 
Geology "  has  reached  a  fourth  edition.  It  now  appears  so  much 
enlarged  and  revised  that  it  is  practically  a  new  book.  The  syllabus 
for  geology  issued  by  the  Science  and  Art  Department  is  reprinted  at 
the  end,  accompanied  by  the  questions  set  at  the  May  examinations 
for  the  past  eight  years.  This  fact  suggests  the  class  of  students  the 
author  wished  to  help  ;  and  for  the  elementary  stage  of  that  examina- 
tion we  know  of  no  better  class-book.  The  book  is,  as  a  rule,  reliable 
and  well  up-to-date ;  but  we  notice  a  few  old  figures  that  might  have 
been  omitted,  and  a  few  points  that  might  be  revised.  #The  author 
might  have  added  the  supposed  land  plant  Berwynia  to  the  list  of  his 
pseudo-fossils,  instead  of  accepting  it  as  unhesitatingly  as  he  has  done 
on  p.  177.  The  pre-glacial  age  of  man  is  not  proved  by  either  the 
Cae  Grwyn  Caves  or  the  Brandon  implements.  The  explanation  of  the 
Moel  Tryfaen  shells  as  "pushed  up  to  their  present  heights  in  front 
of"  a  glacier  [the  italics  are  Mr  Harrison's]  is  one  of  the  type  (if 
explanations  which  prejudices  the  anti-marine  theory.  The  statement 
(p.  180)  that  crinoids  "  are  dying  out,  a  few  specimens  only  lingering 
at  the  bottom  of  the  deep  seas,"  is  a  survival  from  twenty  years  ago, 
which  still  lingers  in  many  elementary  works.  Another  common 
mistake  is  regarding  the  Neocomian  as  the  equivalent  of  the  whole  of 
the  Lower  Cretaceous.  The  illustrations  are  numerous  and  good,  and  we 
hope  the  book  will  soon  reach  a  fifth  edition. 

The  fourth  and  fifth  books  are  not  quite  within  our  range;  but 
geographers  and  geologists  occasionally  have  to  deal  with  questions  to 
which  some  knowledge  of  the  mechanics  of  fluids  is  essential.  We 
therefore  need  make  no  apology  for  calling  attention  to  works  in 
which  tin'  elemental)'  principles  of  the  subject  are  clearly  and  simply 
taught. 


1SP7  J 


SOMti  XKW  HOOKS  277 


The  Nectaries  of  Flowers 


Beitjrage  zttk  Kenntnis  her  Seftalnectarien.     By  J.   Schniewind-Thies.     8vo, 
pp.  87,  with  12  plates.     Jena  :  Gustav  Fischer,  1897.     Price,  15  marks. 

Tins  volume,  with  its  largo  well-spaced  text  and  its  beautiful  supply 
of  nicely  lithographed  plates,  including  266  figures,  once  more  brings 
home  the  fact  of  the  extreme  specialisation  of  present-day  science. 
It  is  surprising  to  know  that  Mr  Gustav  Fischer  can  find  it  worth 
while  to  publish  at  fifteen  shillings  an  independent  work  dealing 
with  a  special  kind  of  simple  honey-secreting  tissue,  and  containing 
about  as  much  matter  (if  we  except  the  plates)  as  half  of  a  single  part 
of  our  Linnean  Society's  Journal. 

Septal  nectaries  are  the  honey-secreting  layers  found,  sometimes 
on  the  outer  surface  of  the  ovary,  but  generally  in  the  walls  separating 
the  ovary  chambers,  in  many  genera  of  Liliaceae  and  other  petaloid 
monocotyledons.  They  have  attracted  the  attention  of  various 
botanists  during  recent  years,  and  we  could  add  to  the  references  to 
papers  cited  in  footnotes  by  Mr  Schniewind-Thies.  The  author  gives 
an  account  of  the  structure  and  position  of  the  nectaries  in  genera  of 
Liliaceae,  Amaryllideae,  Scitamineae  and  Bromeliaceae,  and  dis- 
i  inguishes  seven  groups.  In  the  simplest  the  secretion  is  effected  by  the 
epidermal  cells  of  the  whole  exterior  surface  of  the  ovary,  from  its  base 
to  the  origin  of  the  three  style-arms.  The  only  examples  given  of  this 
are  in  two  species  of  Tofieldia,  one  of  the  simplest  genera  of  Liliaceae. 
In  the  second  group  a  "  double  nectary  "  is  found,  secretion  occurring 
on  the  surface  of  the  ovary  in  three  furrows  lying  along  the  septa,  and 
in  three  slits  which  permeate  the  separating  walls  of  the- carpels.  Ex- 
amples are  found  in  Yucca  and  Agapanthus.  In  the  third  group  there 
are  no  superficial  glands,  secretion  occurring  only  in  true  septal  slits  as 
in  Funlia  and  species  of  Allium.  Where  the  ovary  is  only  partly 
superior  a  double  nectary  may  occur  in  the  upper  part  and  internal 
ones  only  in  the  lower,  as  in  Haivorthia  and  Urginea,  or  only  in  the 
inferior  part,  as  in  Phormium  and  other  Liliaceae,  where  a  further 
complication  ensues  in  lateral  branching  of  the  slits  and  strong 
development  of  vascular  tissue  in  their  vicinity.  Where  the  ovary  is 
wholly  inferior,  as  in  Amaryllideae,  Irideae  and  Scitamineae,  and  some 
Bromeliaceae,  secretion  is  confined  to  three  septal  slits,  or  occurs  also 
in  three  outer  furrows  at  the  thickened  style-base.  In  Bromeliaceae, 
with  a  superior  or  half-inferior  ovary,  the  most  complicated  arrange- 
ment is  found,  since,  besides  the  double  nectary  as  described  for  the 
second  group,  there  are  also  three  internal  glandular  surfaces  pene- 
t  rating  the  dorsal  suture  of  each  carpel,  and  opening  upwards  into  the 
ovary-chamber.  Thus,  it  is  suggested,  increased  complication  in  the 
form  of  the  nectary  accompanies  a  similar  change  in  final  com- 
plexity. In  the  second  part  of  the  paper  the  histology  of  the  secreting 
cell  and  the  part  played  by  the  various  constituents  of  protoplasm  and 
nucleus  are  discussed.  In  conclusion,  we  must  again  refer  to  the  great 
number  of  excellent  drawings,  which  add  greatly  to  the  interest  of  a 
communication  consisting  largely  of  somewhat  detailed  structural  and 
histological  descriptions  of  individual  cases. 


27S  X AT  URAL    SCIENCE  [October 

The  Origin  of  the  Diamond. 

Papers  and  Notes  on  the  Genesis  and  Matrix  of  the  Diamond.  By  the  late 
Henry  Carvill  Lewis :  Edited  from  his  unpublished  MSS.  by  Professor  T.  G. 
Bonney,  D.Sc,  etc.  London:  Longmans,  Green  &  Co.,  1S97.  Pp.  72,  with  2 
plates  and  35  figs.     Price,  7s.  6d. 

The  late  Professor  Carvill  Lewis  was  much  interested  in  the  remark- 
able occurrence  of  the  diamond  at  Kimberley,  and  shortly  before  his 
death  devoted  considerable  care  to  a  study  of  the  rock  in  which  the 
diamonds  are  found.  He  communicated  two  papers  on  the  subject 
to  the  British  Association  in  1886  and  1887  with  the  intention, 
apparently,  of  continuing  his  researches  and  of  writing  a  book  on 
the  general  question  of  the  origin  and  occurrence  of  the  diamond. 
This  work  was  cut  short  by  his  premature  death,  and  the  present 
volume  contains  merely  the  full  text  of  the  two  British  Association 
papers,  with  a  few  notes  and  an  appendix  by  Professor  Bonney. 

The  most  diverse  opinions  have  been  held  regarding  the  nature 
and  origin  of  the  peculiar  rock,  known  as  "  Blue  Ground,"  in  which 
the  diamonds  of  Kimberley  are  embedded.  A  vertical  column  of 
serpentinous  material,  unlike  anything  else  upon  the  surface  of  the 
earth,  extending  to  an  unknown  depth,  and  of  enormous  dimensions, 
it  was  supposed  by  some  to  be  the  neck  of  a  volcano,  by  others  to  be 
a  volcanic  breccia  due  to  a  sort  of  mud  eruption.  The  object  of  Pro- 
fessor Lewis's  papers  is  to  show,  by  an  elaborate  and  minute 
microscopic  study  of  the  rock  itself,  that  it  was  a  true  igneous  lava, 
or,  to  use  technical  language,  the  '  Blue  Ground '  was,  according  to 
him,  a  porphyritic  volcanic  peridotite  or  basaltic  structure,  an  olivine- 
bronzite-picrite-porphyrite,  rich  in  biotite  (now  very  much  de- 
composed), and  for  this  remarkable  rock  he  proposed  the  name 
"  Kimberlite." 

The  chief  argument  upon  which  his  conclusions  were  based  is  that 
in  twTo  American  localities,  namely  at  Syracuse,  New  York,  and  in 
Elliott  County,  Kentucky,  a  precisely  similar  rock  occurs,  though 
without  diamonds,  and  is  there  obviously  an  eruptive  rock.  Professor 
Bonney 's  appendix  consists  of  a  detailed  description  of  these  two 
rocks,  which  he  also  regards  as  practically  identical  with  "Kimberlite," 
although  he  does  not  quite  agree  with  Professor  Lewis's  views  con- 
cerning the  origin  of  the  latter. 

It  has  generally  been  supposed  that  the  diamonds  in  the  blue 
ground  were  either  caught  up  from  some  underlying  rock  or  are  due 
to  the  fusion  of  the  carbonaceous  shales  through  which  the  blue 
ground  passes,  or  are  decomposition  products.  Professor  Lewis  em- 
phatically states  his  opinion  that  the  diamond  is  an  essential 
constituent  of  the  rock  like  any  of  the  other  minerals  which  if 
contains;  in  this  view  he  probably  stood  alone  at  the  time  of  his 
death,  and  it  is  not  one  which  lias  been  generally  accepted  since. 

It  cannot  be  said,  therefore,  that  these  papers  contribute  much 
to  our  knowledge  of  the  origin  of  the  diamond;  they  constitute  a 
careful  description  of  the  rock  in  which  the  precious  mineral  occurs 
and  establish  the  existence  of  a  similar  rock  elsewhere,  but  no  reason 
is  suggested  why  it  only  contains  diamonds  at  Kimberley. 

Professor  Bonney  has  done  well  in  giving  these  posthumous 
papers  to  the  world,  and  has  considerably  enhanced  their  value  by 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  279 

appending  his  own  description  of  the  American  Kimberlites.  Ashe 
slates  in  the  preface  that  he  has  purposely  avoided  all  reference  to  more 
recent  literature,  the  reader  musl  he  content  to  miss  any  allusion  to 
the  occni'rence  of  diamond  in  meteorites,  although  the  resemblance 
hetween  Kimberlite  and  certain  meteorites  is  frequently  mentioned, 
neither  will  any  account  he  found  of  recent  experiments  upon  the 

solvent  action  of  the  blue  ground   u] diamond,  or  of  the  artificial 

production  of  the  mineral. 

For  these  reasons  the  hook  can  only  he  regarded  as  a  publication 
cf  papers  that  should  have  appeared  ten  years  ago,  which,  though 
interesting  and  important  as  a  petrographical  study,  do  not  throw 
much  light  upon  the  vexed  problem  of  the  genesis  of  the  diamond. 

H.  A.  Mieks. 

Landslips. 

REroKT  ex  the  Geological  Structure  and  Stability  01  the  Hill-Slopes  around 
Naini  Tal.  Y>y  T.  H.  Holland.  Officiating  Superintendent,  Geological  Survey 
of  India.  Pp.  viii.,  85,  with  a  map  and  11  plates.  Calcutta:  Office  of  the 
Superintendent  of  Government  Printing,  India.     1897. 

This  report  shows  the  practical  value  of  a  thorough  knowledge  of  the 
geological  structure  of  a  district  as  a  Heeling  its  suitability  for  habita- 
tion. It  is  entirely  a  practical  work,  written  for  the  guidance  of 
engineers  and  others  familiar  with  the  locality,  and  treats  the  subject 
from  a  purely  utilitarian  stand} >oint. 

Naini  Tal  is  a  lake  in  the  north-west  provinces  of  India  on  the 
flanks  of  the  Himalaya.  There  is  a  hill  station  located  here,  but  the 
district  suffers  somewhat  from  the  frequency  of  landslips.  It  is, 
indeed,  probable  that  the  lake  owes  its  origin  to  the  damming  up  of  a 
stream  by  a  great  landslip,  as  was  suggested  by  Dr  Ball  in  1878, 
though  his  views  have  not  been  universally  accepted. 

The  object  of  the  investigation,  of  which  this  report  is  the  outcome, 
was  to  discover  the  cause  of  the  instability  of  the  hill-slopes  in  the 
district,  to  determine  the  extent  of  the  insecure  sites,  and  to  suggest 
means  for  increasing  their  stability. 

The  methods  adopted  by  the  author  were  the  following : — 

(1)  On  a  large  scale  (20"  to  1  mile)  contoured  map  were  inserted 
details  of  the  distribution  and  penological  characters  of  the  rocks. 

(2)  The  angle  of  repose  of  the  rocks  under  different  conditions  was 
determined. 

(3)  Cross-sections  were  constructed  from  the  map  showing  the 
slope  along  the  selected  lines,  and  the  portions  of  the  rock  lying  out- 
side the  lines  of  safety  were  determined  from  the  angles  of  repose. 

The  direction   of  the  movements   is   shown   in  the  report  to  be 
governed  by  the  direction  of  the  stratification  planes,  which  in  many 
areas  have  a  dip  in  the  same  direction  as  the  slope  of  the  hill-sides 
but  smaller  in  magnitude. 

The  rocks  most  affected  are  shales  and  dolomitic  sandstones,  and 
the  lubricant  is  provided  by  the  decomposition  of  the  rock,  which  is 
brought  about  by  water  percolating  along  the  stratification  planes,  and 
forming  in  the  first  instance  a  slippery  clay,  and  in  the  second  a  layer 
of  loose  sand. 

The  great  difference  between  the  angle  of  repose  of  dry  broken 


280  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

slate  and  that  of  the  same  material  when  disintegrated  and  wet,  is 
shown  by  the  fact  that  the  former  will  stand  at  an  angle  of  37°,  while 
the  angle  of  rest  of  the  latter  is  not  more  than  16°,  and  the  author 
points  out  that  "  the  maximum  angle  of  safety  of  interbedded  rocks  is 
determined  by  that  of  the  weakest  constituent." 

The  author  devotes  a  few  pages  to  the  classification  of  the  land- 
slips according  to  Heim's  scheme,  and  proceeds  to  describe  the  warn- 
ings which  foreshadow  a  landslip,  such  as  the  opening  of  cracks 
parallel  to  the  strike  of  the  beds  and  changes  in  the  courses  of  streams. 
Besides  landslips  of  the  ordinary  type  there  occur  subsidences  caused 
l>y  the  removal  in  solution  of  the  dolomitic  cement  of  the  sandstones 
and  the  consequent  settling  down  of  the  loose  material. 

The  most  efficient  methods  of  preventing  the  landslips  appear  to 
be  the  provision  of  means  for  the  removal  of  the  rain-water  before  it 
can  percolate  into  the  ground,  and  also  for  the  discharge  of  subter- 
ranean water  by  the  construction  of  adits. 

The  Report  concludes  with  a  detailed  description  of  three  particular 
sites,  whose  characters  illustrate  the  results  of  the  various  forces- 
described  by  the  author.  The  value  of  the  work  is  increased  by  the 
well-drawn  diagrams  and  sections,  and  by  the  excellent  map  for  which 
a  special  survey  was  made  ;  but  it  may  be  worth  while  to  ask  whether 
such  terms  as  '  demi-official '  and  the  contraction  '  para  '  for  paragraph 
are  improvements  on  the  conventional  modes  of  expression. 


Investigations  into  Applied  Nature.    By  William  Wilson,  Junior.    8vo,  pp.  viii., 
143.     London:  Simpkin,  Marshall  &  Co.,  1896. 

This  little  book  hardly  calls  for  serious  review.  The  author  may  be 
a  pleasant  enough  companion  in  a  country  walk,  if  one  were  willing 
to  be  a  little  bored,  and  may  also  have  certain  powers  of  observation, 
but  he  is  unable  to  arrange  his  matter  in  book-form  or  to  express  him- 
self in  English.  The  book  is  a  strange  conglomeration.  The  first  few 
chapters  relate  to  "  Our  Indigenous  Flora  as  Food-Plants  " ;  "  On  the 
Habits  and  Instinct  of  the  Rook  "  ;  "  Our  Birds  and  their  Functions  "  ; 
"  The  Potato  Disease";  and  so  on.  The  first  paper  has  already  been 
inflicted  upon  the  British  Association,  another  on  the  Inverness  Scien- 
tific Society,  and  another  on  the  Keith  Literary  Institute.  Of  pasture 
plants  Mr  Wilson  says,  "We  have  not  as  much  in  general  use,  taking 
the  knowledge  of  variety  as  known  to  the  average  agriculturist  into 
account,  as  we  can  scarcely  say  there  is  any  variety  in  them."  And 
speaking  of  the  winter  food  of  animals,  "  We  find  that  human  in- 
genuity has  invented  a  large  number  of  so-called  spices  or  condiments 
to  assist  in  feeding  and  keeping  them  (besides  the  fields'  produce, 
turnips  and  straw),  and  are  generally  used."  The  funniest  chapter  is 
that  on  the  crow,  which,  "  like  most  objects  of  natural  history,  is  very 
imperfectly  understood."  It  seems  to  be  a  selfish  and  quarrelsome 
bird,  but  wily  withal  ;  "  unusual  operations  on  the  part  of  man  on  the 
top  of  a  stack  is  watched  by  the  rook  with  suspicion, and  in  nine  cases 
out  of  ten  that  stack  will  be  avoided  by  them."  "Atmospheric 
changes  produce  a  very  marked  effect  on  them.  There  is  no  doubt 
but  this  causes  the  peculiar  reeling  in  the  atmosphere  [!].  Before 
rainfall  a  dulness  passes  over  them,  early  brightening  up  after  the 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  281 

rain  is  over.  Late  nut  of  doors,  so  to  speak,  before  snowstorm,  and 
the  same  again  before  a  thaw  in  many  cases."  Dealing  "  with  the 
horses  of  Britain,  it  is  supposed  that  they  were  first  introduced  by 
Julius  Caesar  into  history."  The  hackney  "  is  a  class  of  beast  well 
adapted  for  many  requirements  to  which  horseflesh  has  been  attached 
in  "  :  and  the  sheep,  "our  most  arduous  animal  inhabitant  of  pastures." 
In  Ins  preface  the  author  congratulates  the  public  generally  on  the 
spread  of  technical  education  and  the  increasing  association  of  agricul- 
ture and  pure  science.  We  regret  that  we  cannot  congratulate  either  the 
author  or  the  public  on  the  appearance  of  these  "  Investigations," 
which  tend  to  the  advancement  neither  of  pure  nor  applied  Science. 

A  Malagasy  Geology 

Geology.  Nataon-d  Rev.  R.  Baron,  F.G.S.,  F.L.S.  Vol.1.  Nohazavain'  ny  Sary  51. 
Pp.  vii.  +  91,  with  51  figs.  Antananarivo  :  London  Missionary  Society's  College, 
1896.     Price.  6s. 

This  very  interesting  production  of  the  London  Missionary  Society's 
press  is  the  first  and  possibly  the  last  geological  work  in  Malagasy 
that  we  shall  see.  The  author  divides  his  work  into  three  sections  and 
twenty-five  chapters,  and  deals  with  mineralogy,  and  the  dynamics  of 
volcanic,  metamorphic,  and  sedimentary  rocks,  with  notes  on  the 
several  districts  from  personal  observation  and  otherwise.  Vol.  II.  is 
promised,  and  will  deal  with  the  fossils.  As  it  is  difficult  to  give  a 
fair  criticism  on  a  book  written  in  Malagasy  we  can  only  offer  a 
specimen  of  the  author's  easy  style : — "  Koa  ny  horohorontany  dia 
fipararetan'  ny  hoditry  ny  tany,  fa  mievotrevotra  ka  manalonalona 
hoatra  ny  rano  izy,  ary  ny  toetran'  izany  fievotrevony  izany  dia 
tahaka  ny  fitopatopan'  ny  alon-drano  hiany.  .  .  ." 

Scraps  prom  Serials 

In  the  last  number  of  La  Feuille  des  Jeunes  Naturalistes  (No.  323, 
Sept.  1897),  M.  L.  Vignal  concludes  his  notes  on  the  fossil  shells  of 
the  family  Cerithiidae  from  the  Eocene  of  the  Paris  Basin,  this  final 
instalment  being  illustrated  by  two  photograped  plates. 

In  the  Scottish  Medical  and  Surgical  Journal  for  September 
Prof.  Cossar  Ewart  prints  his  address  delivered  at  the  Graduation 
Ceremonial  in  the  Edinburgh  University  last  July.  He  announces 
that  he  has  "  practically  proved  that,  notwithstanding  the  statements 
of  Weismann  and  the  experience  of  scientific  German  breeders,  there 
is  apparently  such  a  thing  as  Telegony."  He  promises  to  contribute 
a  note  on  the  subject  to  the  next  number  of  the  same  journal. 

New  Serials 

Messrs  Schleicher  Freres  of  Paris  announce  a  forthcoming  inter- 
national journal  for  zoology,  botany,  physiology,  and  psychology, 
entitled  Intermediarc  des  Biologistes.  It  is  to  appear  on  the  5th  and 
20th  of  each  month,  under  the  editorship  of  M.  Alfred  Binet.  The 
price  and  the  date  of  the  first  issue  are  not  yet  decided. 

According  to  Science,  a  small  scientific  monthly  of  a  popular 
character  has  been  established  at  De  Land,  Fla.,  entitled  Studies  from 
Nature. 

u 


282  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

A  syndicate  in  Boston  has  purchased  the  American  Naturalist 
from  the  executors  of  the  late  Professor  Cope,  and  the  September 
number  is  the  first  issue  under  the  new  management.  Dr  Eobert  P. 
Biy-elow  is  now  chief  editor. 


Further  Literature  Received 

Elements  of  the  Comparative  Anatomy  of  Vertebrates,  adapted  from  the  German  of 
R.  Wiedersheim  by  W.  N.  Parker,  ed.  2  :  Macmillan.  Volcanoes  of  North  America, 
I.  C.  Russell :  Macmillan.  Guide  to  Zermatt  and  the  Matterhorn,  E.  Whymper  :  Murray. 
The  New  Psychology,  E.  W.  Scripture  :  W.  Scott.  A  Critical  Period  in  the  Develop- 
ment of  the  Horse,  J.  C.  Ewart :  A.  &  C.  Black.  Beitriige  zur  Dioptrik,  A.  Kerber : 
Fock. 

Variations  in  the  Spinal  Nerves  of  Hyla  aurea,  G.  Sweet :  Proc.  P.  Soc.  Victoria. 
Affinities  of  Tarsius,  C.  Earle  :  Amer.  Nat.  Princeton  Contributions  to  Psychology, 
vol  ii.,  Nos.  1,  2.  Baeveren  i  Norge,  R.  Collett :  Beryens  Mus.  Field  Columbian 
Museum,  Chicago,  Geol.  Series,  No.  18  ;  Zool.  Series,  Nos.  19,  20  ;  Anthrop.  Series,  No. 
16.  U.S.  Dept.  Agriculture,  Rep.  No.  9.  Australian  Mus.,  Sydney,  mem.  No.  ii. 
(Atoll  of  Funafuti).  Journ.  Marine  Biol.  Assoc,  vol.  v.,  No.  1.  U.S.  Bureau  of 
Ethnology,  14th  and  15th  Ann.  Reports.  Roemer  Mus.  Hildesheim,  mitth.  No.  9. 
The  Glacio-marine  Drift  of  the  Vale  of  Clwyd,  T.  M.  Reade :  Quart.  Journ.  Geol.  Soc. 
Anatomy  of  Apera  burnupi,  W.  E.  Collinge :  Ann.  Mag.  Nat.  Hist.  Australian 
Termitidae,  pt.  ii. ,  and  other  papers,  W.  W.  Froggatt  :  Proc.  Linn.  Soc.  N.S.  Wales 
and  Agric  Gazette.  Glacial  Observations  in  the  Umanak  District,  Greenland,  G.  H. 
Barton  :  Tcchnol.  Quarterly.  The  Diplochorda,  A.  T.  Masterman  :  Quart.  Journ.  Micro. 
Sci.  Ann.  Rep.  Trustees  S.  African  Mus.,  1896.  Ratzel's  History  of  Mankind,  Eng- 
lish Trans.,  pt.  20:  Macmillan.  Journ.  Coll.  Sci.  Imp.  Univ.  Japan,  vol.  x.,  pt.  2. 
Bull.  Nat.  Hist.  Soc.  New  Brunswick,  No.  xv. 

Shooting  Times,  Aug.  21  ;  Newcastle  Courant,  Aug.  21  ;  Pharmaceutical  Journ., 
Sept.  4;  Amer.  Geol.,  Sept.;  Amer.  Journ.  Sci.,  Sept.;  Amer.  Nat.,  Sept.;  L'Anthro- 
pologie,  July-Aug. ;  Feuille  des  Jeunes  Nat.,  Sept.;  Irish  Nat.,  Sept.;  Journ.  Essex 
Techn.  Lab.,  May- July  ;  Journ.  Malacol.,  July;  Knowledge,  Sept. ;  Literary  Digest, 
Aug.  14,  21,  28,  Sept.  4;  Naturae  Novit.,  July-Aug.;  Naturalist,  Sept.;  Nature, 
Aug.  19,  26,  Sept.  2,  9,  16  ;  Nature  Notes,  Sept. ;  Naturen,  Aug. ;  New  Age,  Aug. ; 
Photogram,  Sept.;  Psychol.  Rev.,  Sept.;  Review  of  Reviews,  Aug.;  Rev.  Scient.,  Aug. 
21,  28,  Sept.  4,  11  ;  Rev.  Sci.  Nat.  Quest.,  vol.  vii.,  No.  1  ;  Science,  Aug.  13,  20,  27, 
Sept.  3  ;  Sci.  Gossip,  June-Sept.;  Sci.  Amer.,  Aug.  14,  21,  28,  Sept.  4  ;  Scot.  Geogr. 
Mag.,  Sept.  ;  Scot.  Med.  and  Surg.  Journ.,  Sept.;  Victorian  Nat.,  July  ;  Westminster 
Review,  Sept. 


1897]  283 


OBITUARIES 

SAMUEL  ALLPOET 

Born  January  23,  1816.        Died  July  7,  1897 

We  learn  from  the  Geological  Magazine  of  the  death  of  the  veteran 
petrologist,  Mr  Samuel  Allport,  who  was  one  of  the  pioneers  in  the 
microscopical  study  of  thin  sections  of  rocks,  and  one  of  the  most 
generous  helpers  of  the  younger  generation  studying  his  favourite 
subject.  He  was  horn  in  Birmingham,  where  he  resided  for  the 
greater  part  of  his  life.  For  eight  years  only  he  was  absent  as 
manager  of  a  business  at  Bahia,  in  Brazil,  and  there  he  made  his  first 
original  observations  on  geology,  collecting  the  cretaceous  fossils  from 
the  coast  near  Bahia  and  contributing  a  paper  on  the  subject  to  the 
Geological  Society  in  London  in  18G0.  On  returning  again  to  Birming- 
ham his  interest  was  excited  by  the  work  of  Dr  Sorby  on  the  micro- 
scopical study  of  rocks,  and  thenceforward  he  became  an  accomplished 
petrologist.  He  made  his  own  sections  with  great  skill,  and  amassed 
a  large  collection  of  slides.  His  papers,  chiefly  published  by  the 
Geological  Society,  were  not  numerous,  but  very  valuable,  and  related 
almost  exclusively  to  the  structure  of  igneous  rocks.  In  1887  he 
received  the  Lyell  Medal  from  this  society  in  token  of  appreciation  of 
his  researches.  In  1880  he  quitted  business  occupations  and  became 
librarian  of  the  Mason  College,  Birmingham,  an  office  which  he  held 
for  seven  years,  until  failing  health  necessitated  his  retirement. 

FRANCIS  AURELIAN  PULSKY 

Born  17th  September  1814        Died  9th  September  1897 

Francis  Pulsky,  the  great  Hungarian  patriot,  and  the  friend  of 
Kossuth,  is  dead.  His  political  life  needs  no  mention  here.  On  his 
return  to  Austria  after  the  Imperial  pardon,  he  became  Director  in 
1869,  and  in  1872  General-Director,  of  Hungarian  Museums  and 
Public  Libraries.  An  archaeologist,  Pulsky's  chief  claim  to  the  re- 
membrance of  our  readers  is  his  "  Copper  Age  in  Hungary,"  which 
was  published  both  in  Magyar  and  German. 

Thomas  Brumby  Johnston,  the  Queen's  Geographer  for  Scotland, 
died  at  Edinburgh  on  September  9th,  in  his  eighty-fourth  year.  He 
was  the  last  of  the  firm,  of  which  he  became  a  partner  in  1852. 

Sir  Everett  Millais  died  on  September  7th.  He  was  born  in  1856, 
and  paid  especial  attention  to  the  breeding  of  dogs  and  stock,  and  for 
some  time  was  editor  of  The  Stock  Breeder. 


284  [October 


NEWS 

The  following  appointments  are  announced  : 

Dr  Rodet  to  be  professor  of  bacteriology  in  the  University  of  Lyons  ;  Dr 
W.  Ernest  Thomson  to  the  chair  of  physiology  in  the  Andersonian  College, 
Glasgow  ;  Dr  Alfred  Osann  to  be  teacher  of  mineralogy  in  the  Chemical  School 
of  Miilhausen  ;  Prof.  Raphael  Blanchard  to  be  ordinary  professor  of  botany  in 
the  Medical  Faculty  of  Paris  ;  Prof.  Vladimir  I.  Belajeff,  professor  of  botany  in 
the  University  of  Warsaw,  to  be  director  of  the  Botanical  Garden  in  the  same 
city  ;  Prof.  Vladimir  I.  Palladin,  of  Kharkoff,  to  be  director  of  the  Pomological 
Garden  at  Warsaw  ;  Dr  H.  V.  Neal,  of  Harvard,  to  be  professor  of  biology  at 
Knox  College,  Galesburg,  Illinois  ;  Prof.  George  Ruge,  of  Amsterdam,  to  be 
professor  of  anatomy  and  director  of  the  Anatomical  Institute  at  Zurich  ;  Dr 
Joseph  Baldwin  and  Wm.  S.  Sutton  as  professors,  and  W.  W.  Norman,  as 
assistant-professor,  of  biology  in  the  University  of  Texas  ;  Dr  H.  Fling,  pro- 
fessor of  biology  at  the  Oshkosh  Normal  School  ;  Prof.  H.  de  Vries  and  Prof. 
Ph.  Stohr  to  be  professors  of  botany  and  anatomy  in  the  University  of  Wurz- 
burg  ;  Miss  A.  A.  Smith  as  assistant  in  botany  in  Mount  Holyoke  College, 
Mass.  ;  Ernest  Wm.  MacBride  as  professor  of  zoology  in  McGill  University  ; 
and  Dr  Kihlman  as  assistant-professor  of  botany  in  the  University  of  Hel- 
singfors. 

Women  are  now  admitted  to  the  College  of  Physicians  in  Chicago. 

Mr  Alex.  White  is  the  recipient  of  the  silver  medal  of  the  Zoological  Society 
as  a  reward  for  his  researches  in  the  fauna  of  Nyassaland. 

Dr  0.  F.  von  Moellendorff,  the  well-known  conchologist,  formerly  German 
Consul  at  Manilla,  has  removed  to  the  German  Consulate  at  Kovno,  Russia. 

Professor  R.  Koch  has  returned  to  South  Africa  to  continue  his  experiments 
on  the  nature  of  the  rinderpest.  The  conference  of  the  South  African  States  on 
this  great  scourge  was  held  in  Pretoria  during  the  first  week  of  August  last. 

The  Cothenius  Gold  Medal  of  the  Imperial  Leopold-Caroline  Academy  has 
been  awarded  to  Prof.  Albert  von  Kolliker,  the  veteran  anatomist  of  Wiirzburg. 
The  Baly  Medal  of  the  Royal  College  of  Physicians  of  London  has  been  presented 
to  Prof.  E.  A.  Schiifer  in  l'ecognition  of  his  imjjortant  researches  in  physiology. 

The  first  Fliickiger  Medal — an  honour  to  be  awarded  every  five  years  by  the 
Gec^nan  and  Swiss  Pharmaceutical  Societies  alternately — has  been  presented  to 
Mr  Edward  Morell  Holmes,  Curator  of  the  Museum  of  the  Pharmaceutical 
Society  of  Great  Britain.  A  short  account  of  Mr  Holmes'  work  in  botany, 
illustrated  by  an  excellent  portrait,  appears  in  the  Pharmaceutical  Journal  for 
Sept.  4. 

Mr  William  Shaus  of  Twickenham,  late  of  New  York,  has  presented  his 
collection  of  tropical  Lepidoptera,  comprising  over  10,000  specimens,  to  the 
American  Museum  of  Natural  History.  Mr  E.  A.  Hoffman  has  also  presented 
to  the  same  museum  his  collection  of  North  American  Lepidoptera. 

According  to  the  Hevue  Scientijique,  the  late  M.  J.  Jackson  left  a  legacy  of 
100,000  francs  each  to  the  Geological  Society  of  France,  the  French  Association 
for  the  Advancement  of  Science,  and  to  other  similar  bodies. 


1897]  NEWS  285 

The  Brazilian  Government  has  decided  to  offer  two  prizes  of  $110,000  each 
to  the  discoverer  of  a  bacillus  of  yellow  fever  and  its  precise  characters,  and  to 
the  investigator  who  shall  determine  the  most  efficacious  means  of  dealing  with 
the  disease.  The  Medical  Institute  of  Rio  de  Janeiro,  the  Pasteur  Institute  of 
Paris,  and  the  Hygienic  Institute  of  Berlin  are  conjointly  to  make  the  award. 
Dr  Sanarelli  is  likely  to  be  recipient  of  the  first  prize. 

Dr  H.  H.  Field's  Concilium  Bibliographicum  is  again  showing  promising 
activity.  We  have  received  a  parcel  of  slips  relating  to  the  contents  of  Natural 
Science.     Dr  Field  is,  we  are  glad  to  say,  restored  to  health. 

A  bronze  statue  was  unveiled  at  Crevalcore,  near  Bologna,  on  Sept.  8,  to 
Marcello  Malpighi,  the  famous  anatomist  and  microscopist.  Dr  Vallardi  promises 
a  volume  "  Malpighi  e  l'opera  sua  "  as  a  memorial  of  the  event. 

The  University  of  California,  having  $4,000,000  promised  or  received,  has 
advertised  for  plans,  the  competition  for  which  is  international. 

Science  states  that  Peoria,  Illinois,  is  to  have  a  University  on  the  death  of  Mr 
Washington  Corrington  of  that  city,  who  is  now  eighty-five  years  of  age,  and 
will  leave  a  sum  of  over  $1,000,000  for  the  new  foundation. 

Various  donors  have  subscribed  $100,000  to  Hope  College,  Holland,  Mich. 
The  Laman  Missouri  Educational  Association  has  received  a  gift  of  $10,000  from 
.Mr  D.  A.  Beamer. 

The  Indiana  Academy  of  Science  is  now  receiving  State  aid  in  the  printing 
and  publication  of  its  Proceedings.  It  now  holds  much  the  same  relation  to  the 
State  that  the  National  Academy  of  Sciences  bears  with  respect  to  the  Congress 
of  the  United  States. 

A  bill  for  providing  for  a  geological  survey  of  the  State  of  West  Virginia 
was  passed  by  the  legislature  last  session.  The  commissioners  will  be  the 
governor,  treasurer,  and  president  of  the  West  Virginia  University,  the  president 
of  the  State  Board  of  Agriculture,  and  the  director  of  the  West  Virginia  Agri- 
cultural Exjjerimeut  Station,  who  will  serve  without  compensation,  except  out- 
of-pocket  expenses.  They  will  appoint  a  geologist  of  repute  and  such  assistants 
as  may  be  necessary.  The  survey  is  to  examine  the  geological  formation  of  the 
State,  with  especial  reference  to  economics  ;  soils  and  adaptability  to  particular 
crops  ;  forests  ;  physical  features  with  reference  to  occupations,  industrial  de- 
velopment, and  prosperity  of  the  people  ;  and  to  make  geological  and  economic 
maps,  and  special  reports  on  the  geology  and  resources. 

The  American  Association  for  the  Advancement  of  Science  will  meet  next 
year — its  fiftieth  anniversary — at  Boston,  under  the  presidency  of  Prof.  F.  W. 
Putnam.  The  Vice-Presidents  for  the  sections  are  as  follows  : — Geology,  H.  L. 
Fairchild  of  Rochester  ;  Zoology,  A.  S.  Packard  of  Providence  ;  Botany,  W.  G. 
Farlow  of  Cambridge  ;  Anthropology,  J.  McKeen  Cattell  of  New  York  City. 
M  v  L.  O.  Howard  of  Washington  was  elected  Permanent  Secretary.  A  con- 
siderable number  of  papers  have  already  been  entered,  a  full  list  of  which  will 
be  found  in  the  American  Journal  of  Science  for  September. 

Apart  from  the  President's  Address,  the  addresses  of  the  Presidents  of  the 
Section,  especially  interesting  to  the  readers  of  this  Journal,  are  those  of 
Dr  G.  M.  Dawson,  Prof.  Miall,  Dr  Keltie,  Sir  Win.  Turner,  Prof.  Michael 
Foster,  and  Dr  Marshall  Ward.  Dr  Dawson  dealt  with  the  Ancient  Rocks  of 
North  America,  tracing  the  history  of  the  discovery,  differentiation,  and  clas- 
sification of  the  Palaeozoic  formations.  Prof.  Miall  protested  that  we  study 
animals  too  much  as  dead  things,  and  are  content,  many  of  us,  to  name  and 
arrange  them,  according  to  our  own  notions  of  their  likeness  or  unlikeness,  and 
to  record  their  distribution.     Dr  Keltie  gave   a  sketch  of  recent  progress  in 


286  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

geography,  and  pointed  out  directions  for  further  work.  Sir  William  Turner's 
paper  dealt  with  distinctive  characters  of  human  structure,  and  was  largely 
concerned  with  the  erect  attitude.  Prof.  Michael  Foster  reviewed  the  progress 
of  Physiology  since  the  Association  last  met  in  Canada,  in  1884,  and  Dr  Marshall 
Ward  gave  a  long  and  interesting  paper  on  the  economics  of  Fungi. 

"  The  Globe  "  of  Toronto  provided  a  good  account  of  the  proceedings  of  the 
Association,  and  illustrated  it  with  amusing  portraits  and  interesting  informa- 
tion ;  one  of  the  series  of  pictures  gave  the  coats  of  arms  of  past  presidents.  The 
Honorary  LL.D.  of  Toronto  University  was  conferred  on  Lords  Kelvin,  Rayleigh 
and  Lister,  and  on  Sir  John  Evans  ;  the  D.C.L.  of  Trinity  on  Lords  Kelvin  and 
Lister,  Sir  John  Evans,  Sir  Wm.  Turner,  and  Sir  George  Scott  Robertson.  The 
following  grants  were  made  to  Committees  of  Biology  and  Geology  : — Seismo- 
logical  Observations,  £75  ;  Erratic  Blocks,  £5  ;  Investigation  of  Coral  Reefs, 
£40  ;  Geological  Photographs,  £10  ;  Age  of  rocks  near  Moreseat,  £10  ;  Pleistocene 
fauna  and  flora  of  Canada,  £20  ;  Table  at  Naples  Zoological  Station,  £100  ; 
Table  at  Plymouth,  £20 ;  Index  generum  et  specierum  Animalium,  £100 ; 
Biology  of  Ontario  Lakes,  £75  ;  Oysters,  £30  ;  Climatology  of  Tropical  Africa, 
£30 ;  North- Western  Tribes  of  Canada,  £75  ;  Glastonbury  Lake  Village,  £37, 10s. ; 
Ethnography,  £25  ;  Silchester  excavations,  £7,  10s. ;  Ethnology  of  Canada,  £75  ; 
Torres  Straits  Expedition,  £125  ;  Changes  of  nerve  cells,  £100  ;  Fertilization  in 
Phaeophyceae,  £15.  The  total  amount  granted  was  £1350.  The  total  attend- 
ance numbered  1362. 

We  understand  that,  after  various  delays,  the  fitting  and  arrangement  of  the 
new  Paris  Museum  of  Natural  History  are  now  making  good  progress.  It  is 
hoped  that  the  public  galleries  will  be  ready  for  opening  early  next  year. 

We  hear  from  Science  that  plans  have  been  submitted  to  the  Department  of 
Buildings,  New  York,  for  two  additions  to  the  American  Museum  of  Natural 
History — one,  a  lecture  hall  at  the  north  end  of  the  Museum  ;  the  other,  a  six- 
story  building  attached  to  the  west  wing. 

The  Report  of  the  Trustees  of  the  South  African  Museum,  Cape  Town,  for 

1896,  received  this  month,  records  the  re-organisation  of  the  staff  and  the  com- 
pletion of  the  new  buildings,  to  which  we  have  previously  referred.  The  Museum 
now  has  the  services  of  Mr  W.  L.  Sclater  as  director  ;  Mr  L.  Peringuey  as 
assistant-director,  with  special  charge  of  the  insects  ;  Dr  W.  F.  Purcell  as  keeper 
of  land  invertebrates  ;  Dr  G.  S.  Corstorphine  as  keeper  of  geology  and  miner- 
alogy ;  and  Dr  J.  D.  F.  Gilchrist  as  honorary  keeper  of  marine  invertebrates. 
During  the  year  1896  a  special  grant  was  expended  upon  the  purchase  of  a  series 
of  large  mammals  for  the  collection,  while  an  exchange  with  the  La  Plata  Museum 
furnished  an  important  series  of  South  American  mammals  and  birds.  Large 
acquisitions  of  European  rocks  and  fossils  were  also  purchased  for  comparison 
with  the  South  African  specimens. 

We  have  received  from  Dr  J.  W.  B.  Gunning,  Director  of  the  Museum  of  the 
South  African  Republic,  Pretoria,  a  list  of  acquisitions  for  the  month  of  July 

1897.  The  Zoological  Department  is  being  especially  enriched  with  examples  of 
the  South  African  fauna. 

The  trustees  of  the  Albany  Museum,  Grahamston,  have  decided  to  erect  a  new 
and  more  commodious  building.  The  necessary  funds  are  already  in  hand,  and 
the  work  is  to  be  proceeded  with  at  once.  The  plans  have  been  prepared  by  Mr 
Viesebosse,  architect  of  the  Cape  Town  Museum.  The  new  museum  will  be  a 
two-storied  building,  150  feet  long  by  about  60  feet  deep. 

We  have  received  the  first  annual  report  of  the  Geological  Survey  of  Cape 
Colony,  under  the  direction  of  Prof.  G.  S.  Corstorphine.  The  new  department 
seems  to  be  much  hampered  by  a  clamour  for  immediate  economic  results.     We 


1897]  NEWS  287 

hope  the  Colony  will  not  be  too  impatient,  but  realise  that  the  purely  scientific 
part  of  the  survey  must  first  be  accomplished  in  more  or  less  detail  before  the 
economic  problems  can  be  satisfactorily  attacked. 

According  to  the  American  Nahiralist,  the  Academy  of  Natural  Sciences  of 
Philadelphia  is  trying  to  raise  $50,000  to  purchase  the  palaeontological  collec- 
tions of  Professor  Cope.  Since  the  fund  received  from  the  sale  of  the  collection 
is  to  go  to  the  Academy  for  the  foundation  of  a  professorship  of  palaeontology, 
it  would  seem  appropriate  that  the  collections  themselves  should  become  the 
property  of  this  society. 

We  have  received  the  last  part  of  the  Bulletin  of  the  Natural  History  Society 
of  New  Brunswick  (No.  XV.),  containing  a  long  review  of  the  scientific  work  of 
Abraham  Gesner,  pioneer  in  the  geology  and  mineralogy  of  Nova  Scotia,  by  Dr 
G.  F.  Matthew.  Dr  Matthew  also  describes  supposed  evidence  of  a  thysanurous 
insect  from  the  early  Palaeozoic  rocks  (Little  River  Group)  of  New  Brunswick. 
The  thirty-fifth  annual  report  of  the  Society  makes  the  gratifying  announcement 
that  the  membership  has  considerably  increased  during  the  year.  The  library 
also  increases  rapidly,  and  H.M.  Treasury  has  generously  presented  to  it  a 
complete  set  of  the  '  Challenger  '  Reports. 

We  have  received  from  Mr  C.  A.  Snazelle,  the  energetic  honorary  secretary 
of  the  Jersey  Natural  Science  Association,  a  report  of  the  second  meeting  of  this 
new  society,  and  the  first  programme  for  the  winter's  meetings.  In  addition  to 
the  meetings  for  general  papers  and  lectures,  there  will  be  small  sectional  com- 
mittees for  various  departments  of  detailed  scientific  work.  We  regret  to  learn 
that  Natural  Science  is  so  little  cultivated  in  Jersey  that  the  total  membership 
of  the  Society  is  still  less  than  50. 

Mr  William  Bidgood,  the  Curator  of  the  Museum  of  the  Somersetshire 
Archaeological  and  Natural  History  Society,  in  Taunton  Castle,  has  just  issued 
the  sixth  edition  of  his  Guide.  The  Museum  is  chiefly  remarkable  for  its  archaeo- 
logical collection  relating  to  Somersetshire,  while  among  the  geological  specimens 
are  the  cave  remains  from  Banwell,  Bleadon,  Sandford  Hill,  and  Hutton. 

The  total  number  of  visits  of  students  to  the  reading-room  at  the  British 
Museum  during  the  year  was  191,363,  being  3,600  less  than  that  of  1895,  which 
again  was  lower  than  that  of  1894  by  8,000.  This  we  regard  in  a  very  favourable 
light,  as  it  shows  that  the  wise  regulations  of  Sir  Maunde  Thompson,  regarding 
a  certain  class  of  readers,  have  resulted  in  greater  comfort  for  the  more  serious 
students.     It  also  shows  indirectly  the  value  of  Free  Libraries. 

The  last  number  of  the  Journal  of  the  Marine  Biological  Association  of  the 
United  Kingdom  (vol.  v.,  No.  1,  issued  August  1897)  contains  the  annual  report 
of  the  Director  and  of  the  Council  for  1896-97.  Under  the  direction  of  Mr  Allen 
the  Plymouth  station  continues  to  flourish  and  increase  in  utility.  The  Associa- 
tion is  also  fortunate  in  retaining  the  services  of  Mr  Holt,  for  the  time  beinc,  as 
Honorary  Naturalist.  The  Lords  Commissioners  of  H.M.  Treasury  in  granting 
the  usual  £1000  for  the  year  1897-98,  have  made  it  a  condition  that  the  Associa- 
tion will  give  all  the  assistance  in  its  power  to  the  Inspectors  of  Irish  Fisheries 
in  investigations  which  they  desire  to  be  made  on  the  habits  and  migrations  of  the 
mackerel  visiting  the  Irish  coast.  This  important  work  has  thus  been  begun,  and 
the  principal  contribution  to  the  new  number  of  the  Journal  is  Mr  Allen's  report 
on  the  present  state  of  knowledge  with  regard  to  the  habits  and  migrations  of  the 
mackerel  (Scomber  scomber).  Most  of  the  other  papers  also  have  an  important 
economic  bearing.  The  large  laboratory  in  the  Plymouth  station  has  been  pro- 
vided with  a  new  flat  tank,  eight  feet  by  five  feet  and  eight  inches  deep,  in  which 
Mr  Garstang  has  been  making  the  observations  on  Crustacea  to  which  we  refer 
elsewhere.     The  sea-water  supplied  to  the  laboratory  is  still  kept  distinct  from 


288  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [October 

the  general  circulation  in  the  show  tanks,  and  is  never  returned  to  the  laboratory 
tanks  after  it  has  passed  through  them.  Experience  shows  that  the  theory  of 
'circulation,'  as  applied  to  aquaria,  is  illusory  and  in  jiractice  disastrous. 

Science  announces  that  the  Zoological  Expedition  sent  by  Columbia  Uni- 
versity this  summer  to  Alaska  have  lost  all  the  results  of  their  season's  work  by 
the  wreck  of  the  City  of  Mexico,  in  which  they  were  returning.  Fortunately 
all  the  members  of  the  party  were  landed  in  safety.  The  Duke  of  the  Abruzzi  and 
his  companions  successfully  ascended  Mount  St  Elias  on  July  30,  31.  The  height 
of  the  mountain  was  ascertained  to  be  18,100  ft.  Dr  Sella  was  of  the  party  and 
we  may  hope  for  excellent  photographs  as  illustration  to  the  report  of  the 
expedition. 

We  are  indebted  to  Mr  Duerden  for  an  interesting  account  of  this  summer's 
work  of  Prof.  W.  K.  Brooks'  party  of  Baltimore  students  in  studying  the  tropical 
life  of  Jamaica.  As  we  have  previously  announced,  the  party  this  year  was 
under  the  direction  of  Prof.  J.  E.  Humphrey,  and  established  a  temporary 
laboratory  in  an  hotel  at  Port  Antonio,  a  locality  in  many  respects  more  advan- 
tageous than  Port  Henderson,  the  former  headquarters.  The  director,  one  of 
the  most  distinguished  of  the  younger  American  botanists,  collected  and  preserved 
a  large  amount  of  botanical  material,  giving  special  attention  to  the  shell-perfor- 
ating algae  and  to  the  embryology  of  certain  flowering  plants.  We  deeply  regret 
to  add  that  towards  the  end  of  the  course  of  study  he  became  ill  and  died  almost 
immediately.  Another  botanist,  Mr  A.  Fredholm,  dried  a  large  collection  of 
Jamaica  plants  for  the  herbarium  of  the  U.S.  National  Museum.  Dr  F.  S. 
Conant  continued  his  researches  on  the  medusae,  begun  last  year.  The  chief 
object  of  his  investigation  this  season  was  the  function  of  the  sensory  organs  of 
the  medusa,  and  material  was  prepared  with  especial  reference  to  a  study  of  the 
changes,  under  the  influence  of  light  and  darkness,  in  the  pigment  of  the  retina 
of  the  eyes.  Dr  H.  L.  Clark  also  continued  his  previous  researches  on  the 
echinoderms.  He  devoted  special  attention  to  the  life-history  of  the  interesting 
holothurian  Chirodota.  Mr  Sudler  returned  to  Port  Henderson  to  dredge  for  the 
small  crustacean  Lucifer,  which  he  could  not  find  at  Port  Antonio.  Mr  Grave 
studied  various  ophiurans,  and  doubled  the  number  of  species  recorded  from 
Jamaica.  The  eggs  of  one  species  were  artificially  fertilised  in  the  laboratory,  and 
a  complete  series  of  the  embryos  from  the  single  cell  to  the  fifteen-day  Pluteus 
stage  was  satisfactorily  preserved  for  future  examination.  Mr  E.  N.  Berger 
devoted  his  time  chiefly  to  insects  and  arachnids,  obtaining  many  embryonic 
stages,  especially  of  a  pseudoscorpion,  probably  Obisium.  There  were  also  j  unior 
students.  Mr  Duerden,  as  Curator  of  the  Jamaica  Institute,  was  invited  to 
join  the  party  ;  he  profited  by  the  occasion  in  enriching  the  Museum  collection, 
and  in  continuing  his  researches  on  the  corals. 

ERRATA 
Page  88,  lino  3.     For  '  invariable  '  read  '  variable.' 
„  148,    ,,    6.       „    'Marlotf        „      'Marlatt.' 
,,   l.r>8,    ,,12.       ,,     'collection'    ,,      'collector.' 


NATURAL  SCIENCE 

A  Monthly  Review  of  Scientific  Progress 


No.   69— Vol.  XI— NOVEMBER  1897 


NOTES  AND  COMMENTS 

The  Confirmation  of  Darwin's  Theory  of  Coral  Islands 

During  the  past  few  years  there  has  been  a  lull  in  the  long  contro- 
versy regarding  the  origin  of  the  coral  atolls  of  the  Pacific.  The 
arguments  for  and  against  Darwin's  theory  had  been  so  often  repeated 
that  people  were  tired  of  deductive  reasoning  on  a  problem  which 
might  at  any  time  be  solved  by  a  practical  test.  It  has  been 
admitted  for  many  years  that  the  only  method  of  ending  the  con- 
troversy is  to  make  a  deep  boring  in  an  oceanic  atoll.  The  first 
attempt  to  apply  this  method  was  made  during  the  expedition  of 
the  United  States  cruiser,  the  Tuscarora,  but  the  boring  tools  broke 
at  a  slight  depth.  In  1891  a  committee  was  appointed  by  the 
British  Association  to  arrange  a  plan  for  a  new  attempt.  The 
Admiralty  was  willing  to  assist  by  help  of  a  surveying  ship,  and 
the  Government  of  New  South  Wales  was  ready  to  lend  the  bor- 
ing equipment.  A  report  was  prepared,  and  it  was  recommended 
that  Funafuti,  one  of  the  Ellice  Islands,  should  be  the  site  of  the 
experiment.  Accordingly  a  joint  expedition  was  sent  out  by  the 
Royal  Society  and  the  Australian  Museum  at  Sydney,  and  was  led 
by  Prof.  Sollas.  Valuable  natural  history  collections  were  made 
at  Funafuti,  and  many  interesting  anthropological  observations  re- 
corded ;  but  the  main  object  of  the  expedition  was  not  accomplished, 
as  the  boring  failed.  The  observations  collected  were  claimed  by 
Admiral  Sir  W.  J.  L.  Wharton  as  opposed  to  Darwin's  theory ; 
whereas  Mr  Chas.  Hedley  of  the  Australian  Museum  maintained 
that  the  general  survey  of  the  island  strongly  supported  it.  With 
splendid  perseverance  the  Australian  authorities  resolved  to  renew 
the  attempt.  Accordingly  a  new  expedition  was  sent  out  under 
the  command  of  Prof.  T.  Edgeworth  David  of  Sydney.  A  tele- 
gram from  Sydney  on  October  4  announced  that  all  the  difficulties 
had  been  successfully  overcome,  and  that  the  boring  had  been 
carried  to  a  depth  of  5  5  7  ft. ,  and  was  still  in  coral  rock.  A  further 
telegram  on  October  12  announces  that  the  depth  of  643  ft.  has 
been  reached  and  the  boring  is  still  being  carried  through  coral  rock. 


290  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [November 

Prof.  Edgeworth  David  may  therefore  be  congratulated  on 
having  finally  proved  conclusively  the  truth  of  Darwin's  brilliant 
theory.  It  may  be  objected  that  it  is  too  soon  to  shout,  as  the 
cores  have  not  yet  been  subjected  to  microscopic  examination,  and 
that  one  boring  is  not  sufficient.  But  neither  objection  is  worth 
much.  Coral-reef  rock  is  of  very  varying  composition ;  the  coral 
grows  in  hummocks  separated  by  more  or  less  narrow  spaces,  which 
are  filled  up  by  coral  sand,  broken  shells,  foraminifera,  &c.  Micro- 
scopic examination  of  fragments  of  limestone  broken  from  coral  reefs 
sometimes  shows  no  trace  of  coral.  Coral,  moreover,  is  more  readily 
decomposed  than  shell  sand  or  foraminiferal  limestones.  Hence  it 
will  not  be  surprising  if  most  of  the  slices  cut  from  the  deep  core 
shew  no  trace  of  coral  structure.  But  that  will  not  prove  that  they 
are  not  to  be  regarded  as  reef  rock.  Nevertheless  it  is  to  be  hoped 
that  some  parts  of  the  limestone  from  the  bottom  of  the  core  will  be 
sufficiently  well  preserved  to  show  the  nature  of  its  formation. 

To  the  objection  that  one  boring  is  not  sufficient  to  prove  a 
theory  proposed  for  so  many  islands,  it  is  only  necessary  to  point 
out  that  Darwin  himself  insisted  that  his  theory  was  not  universal. 
He  never  intended  it  to  apply  to  the  coral  reefs  of  the  West  Indies, 
the  Eed  Sea  or  the  Persian  Gulf.  What  the  Funafuti  boring  has 
proved  is  that  the  subsidence  method  is  possible  ;  and  if  one  island 
in  the  Ellice  Archipelago  is  sinking,  it  is  probable  that  the  other 
islands  in  that  group  are  also  doing  so.  No  doubt  some  cases  will 
be  found  in  the  Pacific  of  coral  islands  formed  on  banks  left  by 
denuded  volcanoes.  But  the  arguments  which  Darwin  used  to  show 
the  improbability  of  many  of  the  atolls  having  been  formed  in  this 
way  are  still  valid  ;  and  they  are  strengthened  by  the  demonstration 
in  the  only  atoll  yet  tested,  that  the  basis  is  a  block  of  subsided 
reef  limestone. 

There  is  some  zoological  evidence  in  support  of  a  former  migra- 
tion of  land  animals  across  the  area  now  occupied  by  the  coral  sea  ; 
and  naturalists  are  now  at  liberty  to  explain  their  distribution  by 
the  former  existence  of  land  in  that  area. 

The  persistence  with  which  the  Australian  naturalists  have 
persevered  in  their  attempt  to  settle  this  controversy,  and  the  skill 
with  which  Prof.  Edgeworth  David  has  overcome  the  mechanical 
difficulties,  are  worthy  of  the  highest  praise. 

The  Temperatuees  of  Eeptiles,  Monotremes,  and 

Marsupials 

Several  other  interesting  contributions  have  reached  us  this  month 
from  the  Antipodes,  and  among  the  most  valuable  may  be  noted  an 
account  of  some  new  experiments  on  the  body-temperature  of  verte- 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  291 

brates  by  Mr  Alexander  Sutherland  (Proc.  Boy.  Soc.  Victoria,  n.  s., 
vol.  ix.,  pp.  57-67,  pi.  vi.).  For  many  years  past  there  has  been  a 
tendency  to  diminish  or  ignore  the  distinction  between  the  cold- 
blooded and  the  warm-blooded  types  of  animal  life.  The  new 
results,  however,  seem  to  confirm  the  idea  that  the  distinction  is  a 
real  one,  though  they  show  more  clearly  than  ever  that  several 
gradations  between  the  two  types  still  survive  in  the  existing  world. 
Cold-blooded  animals  sometimes  develop  a  capacity  for  heat-pro- 
duction in  the  action  of  their  viscera.  Mere  digestion,  for  example, 
may  increase  the  temperature  of  a  snake  from  2°  to  4°  C,  while 
amatory  emotion  is  known  to  have  the  same  effect  on  snakes, 
lizards,  and  frogs.  But  in  general  this  excess  of  warmth  is  not 
great,  and  it  leaves  the  gap  between  the  warm-blooded  and  the  cold- 
blooded type  quite  evident. 

Mr  Sutherland's  first  two  experiments  were  arranged  to  re- 
determine to  what  extent  the  temperature  of  a  reptile  varies  with 
that  of  its  surroundings.  He  placed  some  lizards  in  a  tank  of 
water,  leaving  only  their  noses  uncovered,  and  then  warmed  the 
water  at  various  rates  of  speed  by  means  of  one  or  more  lamps.  In 
each  case  he  found  the  rise  in  temperature  of  the  animal  and  of  the 
water  to  correspond  almost  precisely.  Other  observations  also  point  to 
the  same  conclusion,  namely,  that  cold-blooded  animals  at  rest  take 
their  temperature  almost  absolutely  from  their  environment. 

Mr  Sutherland  next  records  his  experiments  with  the  Monotreme 
Mammalia.  Their  low  temperature  has  often  been  remarked  upon. 
Baron  Miklouho-Maclay  once  determined  that  of  the  duck-billed 
platypus  (Ornithorhynchus)  to  be  only  24*8°  C,  while  the  average 
temperature  of  forty-five  specimens  of  the  higher  orders  of  the  mam- 
malia (excluding  monotremes  and  marsupials)  observed  so  long  ago 
as  1825  by  John  Davy,  was  proved  to  be  nearly  39°  C. — a  result 
subsequently  confirmed  by  Max  Fiirbringer.  The  platypus  is, 
indeed,  almost  a  cold-blooded  animal,  and  the  echidna  rises  very 
little  higher  in  the  scale.  Mr  Sutherland  finds  the  average  tem- 
perature of  Echidna  hystrix  to  be  2 9  "4°  C,  but  it  curiously  varies  : — 
"An  echidna  one  cold  morning  was  so  low  as  22° ;  another,  brought 
in  from  the  forest  in  a  sack  exposed  to  a  fierce  midday  heat,  regis- 
tered so  high  as  3  6  "6°.  .  .  .  This  is  an  immense  range  for  a  mam- 
mal, and  suggests  a  reptilian  want  of  capacity  for  temperature 
regulation." 

As  the  result  of  126  observations,  Mr  Sutherland  determines 
the  average  temperature  of  sixteen  different  species  of  marsupials  to 
be  36°  C,  or  three  degrees  below  the  average  of  the  higher  mam- 
mals. The  marsupial  most  nearly  approaching  the  monotremes  in 
temperature  proves  to  be  the  wombat  (34*1°  C).  Next  comes  the 
flying    squirrel    (Petaurus),    with    average   35*7°    C.      Eighty-three 


292  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [November 

observations  on  the  koala  (Phascolarctos)  show  its  average  tempera- 
ture to  be  3  6  "4°  C.  The  range  in  any  one  individual  at  different 
times  is  generally  proved  to  be  very  small.  Mr  Sutherland,  how- 
ever, observes  : — "  I  have  often  known  healthy  specimens  (of  Phas- 
colarctos) that  had  been  for  a  while  in  the  sun  stand  as  high  as 
37'9°,  while  on  a  cool  day,  or  in  a  very  shady  place,  the  same  indi- 
viduals would  be  only  35-3°,  a  range  greater  than  we  would  find 
under  the  same  circumstances  in  any  of  the  higher  mammals.  The 
highest  register  I  ever  obtained  for  a  thoroughly  healthy  koala  was 
3  8 '4°,  which  is  a  degree  and  a  half  above  the  normal  temperature  of 
man;  the  lowest  was  34*9,  or  nearly  two  degrees  below  man's 
normal.  The  former  temperature  would  in  man  imply  some  con- 
stitutional derangement,  a  distinct  case  of  feverishness ;  in  the 
koala  it  denotes  only  that  it  has  been  out  in  the  sun.  The  lower 
temperature,  though  common  in  the  koala,  is  never  met  with  in  man 
except  in  rare  pathological  conditions." 

It  is  clear,  therefore,  that  there  are  grades  of  temperature,  and 
that  the  mammals  which  are  classed  lowest  on  anatomical  grounds 
are  not  only  of  the  lowest  temperature,  but  also  of  the  greatest 
range,  and  they  are  likewise,  of  all  mammals,  those  which  are  under 
the  strongest  and  most  direct  influence  of  the  temperature  of  the 
environment.  Similar,  though  more  incomplete,  connecting  links 
may  also  be  noted  in  the  case  of  birds. 

In  a  very  general  way  (concludes  Mr  Sutherland),  and  not 
forgetting  numerous  limitations  and  contradictions,  it  may  be  said 
that  bodily  activity  depends  on  body  temperatures,  that  creatures, 
such  as  insects  and  reptiles,  are  active  only  when  warmed  up  from 
without,  but  become  torpid  with  decreasing  temperature.  The  type 
in  which  activity  is  generally  habitual,  maintains  its  own  body 
temperature.  This  is  seen  in  the  mammals,  but  more  still  in  the 
birds.  But  this  warm-blooded  active  condition  was  produced  by  no 
sudden  emergence  ;  the  monotremes  and  marsupials  form  a  gentle 
gradation  between  the  reptile  and  the  carnivore  or  ungulate ;  while, 
so  far  as  indications  point,  there  is  reason  to  believe  that  the  lower 
birds  still  are  reminiscent  of  a  once  existent  chain  of  links  which 
equally  joined  the  cold-blooded  lizards  to  those  warmest-blooded  of 
all  creatures,  the  passeriform  and  fringilliform  birds. 

Entomology  in  Australia 

Mr  W.  W.  Froggatt  has  published  (Proc.  Linn.  Soc,  N.S.  Wales, 
1896,  pp.  510-552)  the  second  part  of  his  work  on  the  termites  of 
Australia.  A  short  account  of  the  life-history  and  social  economy 
of  the  insects,  unfortunately  written  without  reference  to  Grassi's 
recent  researches,  is  followed  by  a  revision  of   the  genera,  which 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  293 

will  be  valuable  to  naturalists  elsewhere  than  in  Australia.  The 
Australian  species  which  have  come  under  observation  are  carefully 
described  and  figured. 

In  addition  to  such  systematic  work,  Mr  Froggatt  turns  his 
attention  to  economic  problems,  and  we  have  received  several  of  his 
entomological  notes  from  the  Agricultural  Gazette  of  New  South 
Wales  for  the  current  year.  Some  of  the  insects  dealt  with  are 
native  species,  which  have  become  destructive  in  gardens  and 
orchards,  while  others  are  familiar  British  forms  introduced  with 
European  plants. 

The  Cuckoo 

The  nesting  habits  of  cuckoos  are  always  interesting,  and  Mr  A.  J. 
Campbell  has  recorded  in  the  Victorian  Naturalist  for  August  a  list 
of  the  foster-parents  of  the  Pallid  Cuckoo  (Cuculus  pallidus,  Lath.) 
of  Australia.  The  observations  show  that  the  cuckoo  almost  always 
selects  open  nests,  and  that  the  Honey-eaters  are  the  most  favoured 
foster-parents.  Mr  Campbell  mentions  that  the  supposition  that 
the  cuckoo  throws  out  the  egg  or  eggs  of  the  foster-parent  to  make 
room  for  its  own  has  not  been  proved  with  regard  to  the  Pallid 
Cuckoo  ;  but  he  has  found  a  broken  egg  of  the  bird  underneath  the 
nest  of  the  White-shouldered  Caterpillar-catcher  (Zalage  tricolor). 
At  present  there  is  no  record  of  any  cuckoo's  egg  having  actually 
been  taken  from  any  Caterpillar-catcher's  nest,  though  one  of  these 
birds  has  been  observed  feeding  a  young  Pallid  Cuckoo. 

The  Mental  Development  of  a  Child 

The  latest  of  the  series  of  larger  monographs  published  by  the 
editors  of  the  Psychological  Review  is  a  careful  record  by  Mrs 
Moore  of  the  behaviour  of  her  boy  during  his  first  two  years.  Such 
records  by  psychologically-instructed  observers  are  likely  to  be  of 
much  use  for  child-psychology ;  and  this  may  be  said  of  the  present 
one,  though  the  want  of  arrangement  in  the  earlier  part  detracts 
seriously  from  its  value.  Great  masses  of  facts  are  bewildering 
unless  arranged  on  some  principles.  The  writer  begins  very  sug- 
gestively by  distinguishing  four  periods — first,  of  seeing  till  the  end 
of  the  fourth  month ;  second,  of  feeling  or  fingering  things  till  the 
seventh  month ;  third,  of  examination  or  more  systematic  explora- 
tion ;  fourth,  of  speaking  from  the  close  of  the  first  year.  Unfor- 
tunately, this  division  does  not  reappear  in  the  body  of  the  work. 
The  classification  of  movements  is  also  confused.  But  having  said 
this,  we  may  be  grateful  to  Mrs  Moore  for  what  she  has  given  us ; 
and  it  will  be  best  here  to  select  a  few  of  the  interesting  points 
which  occur  in  the  course  of   the  work.      The  first  is  a  notice  of 


294  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [November 

certain  epochs  or  periods  in  which  the  child  made  very  rapid  pro- 
gress, on  the  thirty-fifth  day,  in  the  eleventh  month,  etc.  (pp.  6,  7) 
—  an  important  observation  on  which  more  data  are  desirable. 
Under  the  head  of  movements  (Part  I.)  there  is  a  useful  record 
of  voluntary  movements,  pointing  to  the  growth  of  volition  out  of 
"  repetition  of  an  act  which  had  originally  caused  either  a  cessation 
of  discomfort  or  a  sense  of  gratification"  (p.  27).  Many  of  the 
conclusions  drawn  are  naturally  rather  corroborative  of  current 
psychology  than  pointing  in  any  fresh  direction.  Parts  II.  and  IV. 
are  inferior  in  quality  to  the  rest.  Under  Part  II.,  which  deals 
with  Sensations,  we  have,  on  pp.  45  and  56,  the  note  that  even 
on  the  second  day  the  eyes  followed  the  movement  of  a  bright  pair 
of  callipers — a  date  important  on  its  bearing  on  the  theory  of  visual 
space-perception.  On  page  66  we  have  the  less  important  denial 
of  an  unborn  ability  of  localising  sounds.  On  pp.  80,  81,  there 
are  some  remarks  on  the  localisation  of  pain,  which  is  declared  to 
follow  that  of  "other"  dismal  sensations.  On  page  87  it  is  denied 
that  attention,  at  any  rate  in  its  involuntary  form,  comes  late  :  the 
child  gazed  at  a  patch  of  light  continuously  on  the  thirtieth  day 
(p.  46).  Part  IV.  deals  with  language,  giving  careful  tables  of  the 
sounds  used  and  the  principal  substitutions  of  sounds  for  one 
another,  as  well  as  full  vocabularies  of  the  child  at  the  close  of  the 
second  year.  The  order  at  which  the  different  parts  of  speech 
begin  to  appear  is  noted,  as  well  as  their  numerical  importance. 
One  point  which  is  emphasised  more  than  once  (pp.  123  and  97) 
is  that  the  child's  first  names  do  not  refer  to  indefinite  or  vaguely 
conceived  individuals,  but  that  the  child  does  not  understand  the 
necessity  of  a  name  for  each  separate  thing,  and  his  words  stand 
for  what  is  interesting  to  him  in  his  experience.  As  against  any 
idea  that  general  concepts  arise  from  the  fusion  of  individual 
precepts — this  is  however  what  would  generally  be  understood. 
Mrs  Moore's  work  will  be  a  useful  repertory  of  facts,  to  which 
she  has  been  careful  to  supply  an  index. 

The  International  Geological  Congress 

The  Seventh  Session  of  the  International  Congress  was  held 
in  St  Petersburg  last  August  with  great  success.  The  attractive 
programme  offered  by  the  Russian  geologists,  with  the  aid  of  their 
Government,  brought  together  a  large  number — nearly  a  thousand — 
especially  from  Germany  and  Austria.  Americans  and  French  were 
well  represented,  largely  by  mining  engineers  anxious  to  study  the 
rich  ore  deposits  of  the  Ourals.  Englishmen  were  no  doubt  diverted 
to  the  other  side  of  the  Atlantic  by  the  meeting  of  the  British  Asso- 
ciation, and  were  therefore  proportionally  few. 

Of  the   excursions  before  the  Congress,  those  to  Finland  and 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  295 

Esthonia  seem  to  have  been  more  successful  than  that  to  the  Ourals, 
owing  to  the  difficulty  of  transporting  the  larger  number  in  the 
latter  case.  Those  who  visited  Finland  had  an  opportunity  of  test- 
ing the  classification  of  supposed  Archaean  rocks  recently  put  forward 
by  Mr  J.  J.  Sederholm  (see  Natural  Science,  vol.  x.  1897,  p.  79). 
The  general  opinion  seemed  to  be  that  the  evidence  was  insufficient 
to  warrant  the  ascription  of  an  Archaean  age  to  many  of  the  rocks. 
Under  the  leadership  of  r>aron  de  Geer  the  glacial  phenomena  of 
the  district  were  studied,  and  the  Asar,  with  which  many  English 
geologists  made  their  first  acquaintance,  gave  rise  to  interesting  dis- 
cussions. The  main  object  of  the  Esthonian  excursion,  under  the 
direction  of  Akademiker  Friedrich  von  Schmidt,  was  the  examination 
of  the  Cambrian,  Ordovician,  and  some  of  the  Silurian  rocks  of  the 
Province.  The  junction  of  Ordovician  and  Silurian  was  not  over 
easy  to  follow  under  the  conditions  of  the  excursion,  but  the  grand 
series  of  absolutely  unaltered  Cambrian  with  Platysolcnites,  Olencllus, 
Obolus,  and  Dictyohema,  was  a  revelation  to  many.  The  party  had 
also  the  advantage  of  the  presence  of  A.  von  Mickwitz,  whose  palaeon- 
tological  work  in  these  Cambrian  beds  has  been  of  the  highest  value. 

At  the  Congress  itself,  if  no  practical   results  were  arrived  at, 
still  many  discussions  on  matters  of  general  importance  to  geologists 
took  place.      The  main  problem  put  before  the  Congress  was  the 
classification  and  nomenclature  of  rocks,  both  stratified  and  igneous, 
but  chiefly  the  former.      Treatises  by  Messrs  Freeh,  Bittner,  Walther, 
and  Loewinson-Lessing  formed  the    basis   of  discussion:      This   re- 
sulted in  the  following  resolutions :    "  The  Congress  is  of  opinion 
that   the   historical   method   of  classification  must  be  adhered  to, 
though  it  should  continually  be  made  more  natural.      The  council 
is  to  nominate  a  committee  to  study  the  principles  of  classification  in 
this  spirit."     "  The  introduction  of  a  new  stratigraphic  term  into 
international  nomenclature  should   be   based   on   a  clearly  defined 
scientific  necessity  supported  by  peremptory  reasons.      The  appella- 
tions applied  to  a  terrane  in  a  definite  sense  cannot  be  applied  in 
any  other  sense.      The  date  of  publication  is  to  decide  the  priority 
of  stratigraphic  names  given  to  the  same  series  of  beds."     "  For  the 
minor  stratigraphical  divisions,  sufficiently  characterised  palaeonto- 
logically,  in  the  case  of  the  creation  of  new  names,  it  is  preferable  to 
take  as  their  basis  the  most  important  palaeontological  characteristics. 
Geographical  or  other  names  should  only  be  used  for  divisions  of  a 
certain  importance  containing    many  palaeontological   horizons,   or 
when  the  terrane  cannot  be  characterised  palaeontologically."    "Names 
badly  formed  from  an  etymological  point  of  view  are  to  be  corrected 
without  excluding  them  from  the  domain  of  science."  Certain  proposals 
of  minor  importance  were  referred  to  the  above-mentioned  committee. 

There  is  no  doubt  that  with  the  advance  of  geological  knowledge 


296  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [November 

we  suffer  from  a  superabundance  of  names.  But  it  is  to  be  hoped 
that  the  promulgation  of  these  rules  will  not  call  into  existence  an 
army  of  nomenclaturists,  whose  delight  it  will  be  to  search  antique 
literature  for  forgotten  appellations,  or  to  puzzle  their  brains  with 
lexicons  in  the  attempt  to  make  all  names  pass  the  same  etymo- 
logical standard.  We  have  enough  of  this  sort  of  thing  in  system- 
atic biology,  and  we  don't  want  any  more  of  it. 

After  the  Congress  about  half  the  members  took  part  in  the 
various  excursions  that  culminated  in  the  Caucasus  and  the  Crimea. 
The  Carboniferous  rocks  of  the  Moscow  neighbourhood,  the  Permian 
of  Nijni-Novgorod,  the'  Mesozoic  and  Cainozoic  strata  of  the  Volga 
and  Donetz  basins  were  introduced  to  the  foreign  geologists  by  such 
able  students  of  them  as  S.  Nikitin,  A.  Pavlov,  W.  Amalitzky, 
T.  Tschernyschev,  and  N.  Sokolov.  The  difficulties  of  transporting 
and  personally  conducting  such  large  numbers  were  successfully 
overcome,  but  necessitated  the  compression  of  the  passage  of  the 
Caucasus  into  far  less  time  than  was  desirable  or  was  originally 
intended.  Side  excursions  to  Elbruz,  Grozny,  Astrakhan,  the  Tsei 
and  Devdorak  glaciers,  and  other  points  of  interest  compensated 
for  this  in  some  measure,  and  usually  proved  to  be  the  most 
enjoyable  parts  of  the  excursion.  After  ridding  themselves  of 
superfluous  roubles  in  the  bazaars  of  Tiflis,  the  visitors  explored 
Baku,  the  city  of  petroleum,  and  then  crossed  the  Black  Sea  to 
study  the  Jurassic,  Cretaceous  and  igneous  rocks  of  the  Crimea 
under  the  leadership  of  A.  de  Lagorio,  N.  Andrussov,  C.  de  Vogt, 
and  others.  F.  Loewinson-Lessing,  after  his  arduous  Caucasus 
campaign,  engaged  in  the  no  less  difficult  enterprise  of  transporting 
some  forty  persons,  of  both  sexes,  to  Ararat.  With  the  rough  way 
made  plain  for  them  and  the  crooked  straight,  those  who  took  part 
in  this  excursion  declared  that  in  beauty  and  interest  it  was  worth 
all  the  rest  put  together.  Its  close  was  unfortunately  saddened 
by  the  loss  of  Mr  Stoeber,  a  lecturer  on  pharmacy  at  Vladikavkaz, 
who  was  helping  Professor  Lessing.  Joining  in  an  unsuccessful 
attempt  to  ascend  Great  Ararat,  he  was  more  rash  than  his  com- 
panions, who  subsequently  found  him  frozen  to  death. 

The  pleasure  of  many  of  these  excursions  was  seriously  marred 
by  the  great  numbers  that  availed  themselves  of  the  exceptional 
opportunity.  Worse  still,  it  appeared  that  many  of  the  members 
were  hardly  geologists.  An  attempt  will  probably  be  made  in 
future  to  restrict  the  membership  of  the  International  Geological 
Congress  to  recognised  workers.  There  is  no  reason  why  such  a 
body  as  this  should  have  its  dignity  and  usefulness  marred  by  all 
the  tag-rag-and-bobtail  that  choose  to  rush  for  railway  passes  and 
free  champagne,  and  we  shall  warmly  support  any  movement  for 
the  more  sparing  distribution  of  its  privileges. 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  297 

A  Floating  Scientific  Station 
An  important  proposal  was  laid  before  the  International  Geological 
Congress  by  Professor  Andrussow.  It  was  that  a  ship,  fitted  with 
scientific  laboratories  and  apparatus,  should  constantly  be  maintained 
at  sea  by  international  contributions,  and  that  geologists  and  biolo- 
gists of  all  contributory  nations  should  be  allowed  a  place  on  board 
for  carrying  out  observations.  The  importance  of  the  study  of  the 
ocean-floor,  and  of  all  marine  deposits  now  forming,  will  be  denied 
by  no  geologist,  but  the  opportunity  as  a  rule  is  lacking.  Hence 
geologists  no  less  than  biologists  are  interested  in  the  maintenance 
of  such  a  floating  scientific  station.  The  difficulties  in  the  way  of 
the  proposal  are  too  obvious  to  need  comment,  but  if  there  is  a  real 
desire  to  see  it  put  into  effect  nothing  need  prove  insuperable.  Since 
the  idea  received  the  warm  support  of  Dr  John  Murray,  Professors 
von  Zittel,  Haeckel,  Walther,  Prinz,  and  other  influential  scientific 
men,  there  is  no  doubt  but  that  we  shall  hear  more  of  it,  and  we 
wish  it  all  success. 

The  Black  Sea 
An  excellent  illustration  of  the  geological  value  of  thalassography  was 
afforded  by  the  Black  Sea.  On  the  steamer  that  conveyed  the  main 
body  of  geologists  from  Batoum  to  Odessa,  dredging  apparatus  was 
provided  and  a  small  laboratory  fitted  up,  enabling  those  who  wished 
to  verify  for  themselves  the  interesting  account  of  this  sea  given  by 
Professor  Andrussov  in  the  Livret  Guide.  The  most  striking 
peculiarity  of  the  Black  Sea  is  the  absence  of  all  life  except  bacterial 
at  depths  exceeding  100  fathoms.  The  cause  of  this  may  be  put 
briefly  thus.  Into  the  deep  and  steep-sided  Euxine  basin  there  is 
poured,  especially  on  the  northern  side,  a  vast  amount  of  cold  fresh 
water  from  the  rivers.  Thus  there  is  started  in  the  direction  of 
the  Bosphorus  a  surface  stream, 

"  Whose  icy  current  and  compulsive  course 
Ne'er  feels  retiring  ebb,  but  keeps  due  on 
To  the  Propontic  and  the  Hellespont." 

From  the  Bosphorus  into  the  Black  Sea  a  very  slow  under-current 
brings  the  warmer  but  Salter  and  therefore  heavier  waters  of  the 
Aegean.  These  scarcely  mingle  at  all  with  the  surface  waters,  but 
sink  to  the  bottom.  The  exchange  takes  place  so  slowly  that,  ac- 
cording to  the  calculations  of  Admiral  Makarov,  it  requires  at  least 
1700  years  to  renew  the  water  of  the  lower  strata,  whereas  the 
water  of  the  upper  100  fathoms  is  renewed  annually.  Below  100 
fathoms,  therefore,  the  quantity  of  oxygen  contained  in  the  water 
diminishes  rapidly,  and  while  the  cold  brackish  water  of  the  surface 
and  of  the  narrow  shelving  shore  is  unfavourable  to  the  develop- 
ment of  ordinary  marine  life,  the  deoxygenated  water  of  the  depth, 
despite  its  saltness  and  warmth,  is  absolutely  fatal  to  all  organisms 
other  than  bacteria. 


298  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [November 

The  action  of  these  deep-sea  bacteria  is  truly  remarkable.  In 
other  seas  the  rain  of  dead  organisms  from  the  surface  plankton 
forms  the  food  of  other  organisms  living  in  the  depths.  But  here 
the  rain,  after  it  has  fallen  through  the  upper  100  fathoms,  finds 
no  organisms  to  eat  it.  The  microbes  have  it  all  to  themselves. 
The  albumen  of  the  descending  dead  organisms  putrefies  under  the 
influence  of  the  bacteria ;  oxygen  is  taken  from  it  to  form  carbon 
dioxide,  and  hydrogen  sulphide  is  evolved.  The  carbon  dioxide 
appears  to  help  in  the  formation  of  the  fine  precipitate  of  carbonate 
of  lime  that  is  found  in  the  depths.  The  hydrogen  sulphide  partly 
acts  on  the  salts  of  iron  in  the  water,  forming  iron  sulphide,  partly 
decomposes  as  it  reaches  the  oxygen  of  the  surface. 

The  gradual  establishment  of  this  peculiar  state  of  things  can 
be  traced.  Geological  evidence  shows  that  in  Oligocene  and 
Miocene  times  the  Euxine  and  Caspian  basins  were  connected,  only 
being  separated  by  the  final  upheavals  of  the  Caucasus.  Connection 
with  the  Aegean  was  due  probably  to  the  cutting  down  and  lower- 
ing of  a  river-channel,  of  which  the  Bosphorus  and  Dardanelles  are 
the  remains.  When  this  took  place  is  uncertain.  It  cannot  have 
been  long  ago,  geologically  speaking,  because  the  shells  of  Drcissensia 
and  other  brackish-water  molluscs  are  found  lying  on  the  bottom  of 
the  Black  Sea  at  depths  where  neither  they  nor  any  animals  can 
now  exist.  On  the  other  hand  the  northern  character  of  the  Black 
Sea  fauna,  notably  the  presence  of  the  common  porpoise,  suggests 
that  the  connection  existed  already  during  the  Glacial  Period. 

Further  interesting  details,  together  with  a  description  of  the 
deposits  now  forming  in  the  Black  Sea,  will  be  found  in  Professor 
Andrussov's  guide.  We  have  merely  quoted  enough  to  show  the 
intimate  relations  between  geology  and  oceanography,  relations  which 
we  are  glad  to  see  officially  recognised  by  the  International  Congress. 

An  Extinct  Sea- Cow 

Last  month  (p.  223)  we  briefly  referred  to  our  unfortunate  lack  of 
knowledge  of  the  ancestors  of  the  Sirenian  mammals  commonly 
known  as  sea-cows.  In  reference  to  this  subject,  we  have  now 
been  favoured  by  Mr  A.  S.  Woodward,  of  the  British  Museum,  with 
the  accompanying  restored  drawing  of  the  skeleton  of  the  best- 
known  extinct  Tertiary  Sirenian,  Halitherium,  which  he  has  recently 
had  prepared  for  a  forthcoming  work  on  Vertebrate  Palaeontology. 
This  figure  (p.  299),  which  is  of  about  one-fifteenth  the  natural  size, 
is  mainly  based  upon  a  skeleton  in  the  Museum  of  Mayence  and 
upon  the  researches  of  Dr  G.  E.  Lepsius,  of  Darmstadt. 

Halithermm  schinzi  is  found  in  the  Lower  Miocene  sands  of 
Hesse  Darmstadt,  and  so  dates  back  to  the  early  part  of  the  Ter- 
tiary period.      It  will  be  seen,  nevertheless,  that  it  only  differs  from 


1897] 


NOTES  AND  COMMENTS 


299 


300  NATURAL  SCIENCE  [November 

such  a  Sirenian  as  the  existing  manatee  in  but  the  smallest  par- 
ticulars. Some  of  its  teeth  seem  to  have  been  replaced  by  vertical 
successors.  The  vertebrae  exhibit  distinct  traces  of  terminal  epi- 
physes in  young  animals.  The  hind  limb  is  represented  not  only 
by  the  rudimentary  pelvis,  but  also  by  a  trace  of  the  femur. 
Otherwise,  its  skeletal  parts  are  almost  identical  with  those  of  its 
surviving  relative.  Since  the  Sirenians  came  into  existence,  indeed, 
very  little  change  has  taken  place  among  them. 

The  Beaver  in  Norway 

The  beaver,  which  was  once  so  common  throughout  northern 
Europe,  still  survives  in  Norway,  and  several  notices  of  its  occur- 
rence in  that  country  have  been  published  in  recent  years.  These 
notices,  however,  are  more  or  less  limited  in  their  scope,  and  Prof.  K, 
Collett,  the  eminent  zoologist  of  Christiania,  has  lately  done  good 
service  in  investigating  the  whole  subject  with  thoroughness.  His 
results  are  published,  with  twelve  beautiful  photographs  of  the 
modern  beaver-haunts,  in  the  first  article  of  the  Bergens  Miiseums 
Aarbog  for  1897. 

Trade  in  beaver  skins  was  carried  on  in  Norway  in  the  Middle 
Ages,  and  the  former  wide  distribution  of  the  animal  in  the  country 
is  indicated  by  reference  to  it  in  many  place-names.  Now,  how- 
ever, its  range  is  much  restricted,  and  unless  the  laws  for  its  pre- 
servation are  rigidly  enforced  it  will  soon  become  quite  extinct. 
It  is  chiefly  confined  to  the  Stifts  of  Christiania  and  Christiansand, 
and  the  largest  colony  is  at  present  located  in  the  middle  and 
southern  parts  of  the  river  Nisser  (or  Nid)  in  Nedenaes  Amt.  The 
banks  of  this  river  are  for  the  most  part  covered  with  forests  of 
Pinus  sylvestris,  and  wherever  these  are  interrupted  by  trees  with 
deciduous  leaves  the  beaver  is  to  be  found.  Its  chief  food  is  the 
fresh  bark  of  the  last-mentioned  trees,  especially  of  Populus  tremula  'r 
and  for  winter  use  small  branches  with  the  bark  on  are  submerged  in 
the  water  in  front  of  the  habitations.  Bark  that  has  been  gnawed 
off  is  not  collected  for  winter  provender.  Most  trees  are  felled 
quite  close  to  the  water,  and  they  are  rarely  brought  from  a  distance 
of  more  than  300  metres. 

Immediately  after  the  break-up  of  the  ice  in  spring,  the  beaver 
commences  to  search  for  food,  and  traces  of  it  are  sometimes  seen  in 
the  snow.  Work  on  the  lodge  or  habitation  is  mainly  done  in  the 
autumn,  and  almost  exclusively  at  night.  When  the  animal  is  seen 
in  the  daytime,  it  is  as  a  rule  only  swimming  in  the  water  without 
any  set  task  on  hand. 

The  trees  cut  down  by  the  beaver  do  not  fall  in  any  one  definite 
direction,  but  lie  pointing  in  every  way.  The  current  of  the  river 
is  used  for  transport  purposes  whenever  possible ;  but  most  of  the 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  301 

lodges  are  situated  in  still  water,  and  there  the  animal  must  itself 
convey  the  logs,  holding  them  between  its  fore  paws,  while  swim- 
ming solely  by  the  hind  legs.  The  construction  of  a  lodge  occupies 
at  least  two  years,  and  it  is  repaired  annually.  It  is  usually 
elongated  in  shape,  rarely  round  or  conical,  and  it  is  always  far  dis- 
tant from  its  nearest  neighbour.  Numerous  burrows  are  made  in 
the  bank  of  the  river  near  the  lodge,  but  rarely  in  connection  with 
it.  They  seem  to  be  inhabited  chiefly  by  young  individuals,  and 
they  are  the  first  refuges  formed  by  the  beaver  at  any  spot  where  it 
has  decided  to  settle  down  and  build. 

As  to  the  inhabitants  of  a  lodge,  Prof.  Collett  thinks  that  only 
one  pair  with  their  latest  young  occupy  each.  The  older  litters 
•either  migrate  or  occupy  the  neighbouring  burrows. 

The  Fishes  of  the  North  Atlantic 

We  have  also  been  favoured  by  Prof.  Collett  with  a  copy  of  his 
handsome  memoir  on  the  fishes  collected  by  the  Prince  of  Monaco 
on  his  yacht  the  Hirondellc  during  the  years  1885-1888,  which  is 
one  of  the  most  important  contributions  to  Ichthyology  of  the  last 
decade*  It  is  published  in  the  sumptuous  style  with  which  the  gener- 
osity of  the  Prince  of  Monaco  has  nowmade  us  familiar,and  the  illustra- 
tions are  among  the  most  exquisite  figures  of  fishes  we  have  yet  seen. 

The  fishes  obtained  belong  to  ninety-five  species,  and  are  of 
great  interest  not  only  in  their  elucidation  of  the  ordinary  pelagic 
fauna  of  the  North  Atlantic,  but  also  in  the  light  they  shed  upon 
the  geographical  and  bathymetrical  distribution  of  a  certain  number 
of  remarkable  forms  obtained  from  depths  of  no  less  than  2000 
metres.  Only  six  new  species  are  determined,  and  only  one  new 
generic  name  is  proposed,  namely,  Halosauropsis  for  Halosaurus  mac- 
rochir  of  Giinther — an  emendation  also  made  some  time  ago  by  Goode 
and  Bean,  who,  however,  proposed  to  term  the  genus  Aldrovandia. 

The  classification  of  Giinther  is  mainly  adopted  in  this  memoir, 
and  the  new  specimens  of  the  more  important  species  are  carefully 
described  in  detail.  The  value  of  the  work  is  also  greatly  enhanced 
by  the  copious  references  to  the  literature  of  the  subject,  and  the 
comparison  of  the  results  with  those  of  previous  authors.  It  would 
tend  much  towards  the  progress  of  systematic  zoology  if  this 
laborious  method  were  more  generally  followed  by  the  authors  of 
such  reports.  When  recording  new  facts,  it  adds  much  to  the  toil 
of  the  work  to  incorporate  them  and  correlate  them  precisely  with 
existing  knowledge ;  but  the  additional  labour  is  well  spent,  and  it 
converts    dry    catalogues,   comprehensible    only   to    a    few    narrow 

*  Poissons  provenant  des  Campagnes  du  Yacht  V Hirondclle  (1885-1888).  By 
Robert  Collott.  4 to,  pp.  viii.,  198,  pi.  vi.  (Resultats  des  Campagnes  Scientifiques 
aecomplies  sur  son  Yacht,  par  Albert  ler->  Prince  Souverain  de  Monaco,  fasc.  x.,  1896.) 


302  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [November 

specialists,     into     readable     narratives     which     any    zoologist     can 
appreciate. 

The  Study  of  Botany 

At  the  meeting  of  the  London  County  Council  on  October  12,  the 
following  resolution  was  adopted  : — "  That  it  be  referred  to  the  Parks 
Committee  and  to  the  Technical  Education  Board,  to  consider  and  report 
as  to  the  practicability  of  laying  out  plots  of  ground  in  certain  parks 
in  such  manner  as  will  afford  assistance  to  scholars  of  elementary  and 
secondary  schools  in  the  study  of  practical  botany."  We  hope  the 
Committee  and  Board  concerned  will  report  favourably  and  that 
some  of  the  resources  of  the  London  parks  will  be  turned  to  account 
in  the  interest  of  the  humble  student  of  botany.  If  we  consider 
only  those  who  sit  each  year  for  the  examination  of  the  Science  and 
Art  Department,  there  must  be  a  large  number  of  students  scattered 
through  the  metropolis,  to  whom  the  suggested  arrangement  would 
be  very  welcome.  Examiners  tell  us  that  answers  to  the  questions 
show  knowledge  derived  mainly  or  entirely  from  books,  and  insist 
on  the  necessity  of  more  thorough  practical  work.  But  the  London 
student  has  not  much  opportunity  for  such.  The  Botanical  De- 
partment of  the  British  Museum  in  Cromwell  Eoad,  by  means  of 
carefully  dried  specimens,  models  and  illustrations,  supplies  an 
excellent  systematic  review  of  the  plant-world,  and  by  skilfully 
prepared  fruits  and  seeds,  and  wax  models  remarkable  for  their  life- 
like accuracy  and  beauty,  associated  with  clearly  written  labels  and 
explanatory  sketches,  demonstrates  to  all  who  come  to  see  such 
matters  as  the  structure  and  mode  of  operation  of  insect-eating 
plants,  or  the  means  of  distribution  of  fruits  and  seeds.  But  there 
is  still  much  which  can  only  be  learnt  from  the  living  plant.  We 
believe  that  Kew  and  the  Eoyal  Botanic  Society's  Gardens 
are  the  only  ones  to  which  the  student  can  get  access ;  the  former 
by  right  (after  12  o'clock),  the  latter  by  courtesy  only  of  the 
Council  at  certain  times  on  certain  days.  The  latter  are 
useful  for  those  living  in  a  certain  part  of  North  London,  while 
a  journey  to  Kew  means  the  underground  railway  or  a  happy 
day  on  the  South  -  Western.  And  after  all,  life  is  short,  and 
there  are  often  other  subjects  which  must  be  studied  in  addition 
to  Botany.  With  even  very  little  alteration  or  additional  expense 
a  park,  such,  for  instance,  as  Battersea  Park,  might  be  made 
very  helpful  to  an  elementary  student.  There  is  a  sheltered  path 
by  the  lake  where,  in  the  summer,  tree-ferns  and  cycads  flourish, 
and  in  the  same  sub-tropical  garden  grow  palm  trees,  most  of  them 
quite  large  enough  to  show  a  characteristic  habit.  But  if  we  re- 
member aright,  many  have  no  labels  at  all,  and  labels  when  present 
are  very  inadequate.  A  bare  binomial  name  conveys  little  informa- 
tion ;  the  addition  of  the  group  or  order  to  which  the  plant  belongs, 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  30 


•> 


and  the  country  of  which  it  is  a  native  will  help  to  crystallise 
certain  ideas  about  that  group  or  order  which  have  been  vaguely 
floating  in  the  student's  mind.  A  considerable  sum  of  money  must 
be  spent  every  year  in  providing  the  chrysanthemum  shows  which 
are  to  be  found  in  many  of  the  parks  each  autumn.  Some  of  the 
chrysanthemums  are  beautiful,  others  very  ugly ;  but  we  are  of 
opinion  that  the  money  would  be  better  spent  in  keeping  a  variety 
of  plants  which  need  the  shelter  of  a  house  all  the  year  round. 
Such  as,  for  instance,  a  few  temperate  orchids,  examples  of  in- 
sectivorous plants  and  the  like,  which  the  ordinary  student  knows 
only  from  pictures.  The  resolution  now  before  the  County  Council 
has  reference  probably  to  laying  out  beds  to  illustrate  some  of  the 
more  important  families.  This  might  be  done  at  very  little  expense, 
and  under  proper  management  would  be  a  great  boon  to  the  would- 
be  botanist. 

Botany  of  the  Azores 

The  Eighth  Annual  Report  of  the  Missouri  Botanical  Garden,  issued 
by  Prof.  Trelease,  the  director,  has  just  reached  us.  It  is  prepared 
in  the  same  clear  and  elaborate  style  as  its  predecessors,  and  gives 
an  exhaustive  account  of  the  work,  educational  as  well  as  horti- 
cultural, achieved  during  the  year.  Excellent  reproductions  of 
photographs  taken  in  the  gardens  are  again  an  interesting  feature. 
One  gives  us  an  idea  of  the  destruction  caused  by  the  memorable 
tornado  of  May  27,  1896,  which  worked  such  havoc  in  St  Louis. 
Though  the  grounds  were  not  actually  traversed  by  the  cyclonic 
funnel,  the  violence  of  the  wind  was  such  that  a  number  of  the 
structures  were  either  unroofed  or  totally  wrecked,  while  some 
450  trees,  often  of  large  size,  where  wholly  or  practically  destroyed, 
and  many  of  those  left  standing  were  seriously  broken.  Six 
days  before  the  tornado  "  the  most  destructive  hailstorm  that  has 
ever  been  experienced  at  the  garden,"  also  caused  great  damage. 
The  scientific  papers  which  occupy  the  greater  part  of  the  volume 
are  extra-American  in  interest,  and  embody  the  results  of  some 
work  by  the  director  in  the  Azores.  Mr  J.  Cardot  supplies  an 
account  of  the  mosses  found  on  the  nine  islands.  These  (excluding 
bog-mosses,  of  which  there  are  eight)  number  eighty,  fifty  of  which 
occur  also  in  Madeira  and  the  Canaries,  sixty-one  in  Europe, 
especially  the  Mediterranean  region,  and  in  Algeria,  and  about  forty 
in  North  America.  One  found  in  Elores  has  been  known  hitherto 
only  from  Madagascar  and  equally  distant  relationships  are  shown 
in  the  distribution  of  the  genus  Sciaromium,  which  has  three 
species  in  the  Azores,  while  nearly  all  its  other  representatives 
are  to  be  found  in  New  Zealand  and  temperate  South  America. 
Seven  species  are  described  for  the  first  time.  The  fact  that  several 
of  the  most  important  islands  do  not  as  yet  muster  together  more 


304  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [November 

than  fourteen  species  indicates  that  there  is  still  much  to  be  done 
before  a  satisfactory  knowledge  of  the  bryology  of  the  islands  is  at- 
tained, and  Mr  Cardot  believes  that  the  number  (eighty)  could 
easily  be  doubled.  The  fungi  are  practically  unstudied,  and  many 
species  should  be  found  in  the  moist  wooded  regions.  The  list  of 
marine  algae,  "  though  unquestionably  small,  may  doubtless  be  in- 
creased considerably  by  collections  prosecuted  through  the  entire 
year,  while  there  is  reason  to  expect  a  very  large  number  of  diatoms 
and  desmids,  as  well  as  many  representatives  of  other  groups  of 
fresh-water  algae,  whenever  careful  collections  shall  have  been 
made."  As  regards  flowering  plants  and  ferns,  though  the  list 
is  probably  nearly  complete,  there  is  still  scope  for  much  interest- 
ins  work,  such  as  a  detailed  local  flora  for  the  islands,  with  an 
analysis  of  the  influences  which  favour  the  extended  distribution  of 
one  species  while  restricting  another  to  a  very  limited  area.  For 
such  an  enterprise  the  catalogue  which  Prof.  Trelease  appends  to 
his  botanical  observations  would  form  a  useful  basis.  Most  of  the 
species,  it  is  suggested,  "  may  have  been  introduced  by  ordinary 
means,  largely  through  human  agency,  since  the  discovery  of  the 
islands,  for  they  are  so  precisely  comparable  with  similarly  named 
species  from  other  parts  of  the  world  as  to  suggest  the  lapse  of  a 
very  short  time  since  their  separation  from  the  parent  stock."  Only 
a  few  are  peculiar.  Some  of  the  latter  are  limited  to  one  or  other  or 
several  of  the  islands ;  but  the  native  flora  has  clearly  suffered  so 
much  through  the  inroads  of  man  and  domesticated  animals,  that  it 
is  impossible  to  say  whether  or  not  these  local  limitations  have 
always  existed.  The  greater  number  of  the  flowering  plants  are 
either  wind-fertilised  or  adapted  for  pollination  by  but  little- 
specialised  insects,  having  as  a  rule  open  flowers,  with  readily 
accessible  nectar  or  pollen.  As  regards  relation  between  plants 
and  animals,  Prof.  Trelease  remarks  that,  as  there  are  only  seven 
species  of  wild  mammals  found  in  the  islands,  and  nine  endemic  or 
commonly  concerned  with  plant-dissemination  elsewhere,  and  few 
birds  capable  of  aiding  in  this  work,  except  for  aquatics  or  marsh 
plants,  "  it  is  scarcely  to  be  expected  that  special  dissemination 
adaptations  would  be  found  on  the  part  of  aboriginal  plants,  which 
presumably  have  been  associated  with  these  animals  for  a  relatively 
short  time,  nor  of  recently  introduced  plants,  unless  the  relations 
have  been  established  and  the  modifications  worked  out  before 
either  plant  or  animal  reached  the  Azores."  "Well  developed  burrs, 
for  instance,  are  found  only  on  recent  introductions,  and  the  great 
majority  of  species  "  either  have  no  special  modification  adapting 
them  to  certain  dissemination,  but  depend  upon  gravitation,  the 
wind,  or  hygroscopic  movements  of  their  seed  vessels,  or  else  their 
adaptations  are  out  of  harmony  with  their  surroundings." 


575.1  305 


The  Fundamental  Principles  of  Heredity 

( Concl  uded  from  p.  239) 

rr^HE  power  of  propagation  of  animals  by  small  fragments  is  pos- 
-L  sessed  very  largely  by  Sponges,  some  Coelenterates,  Starfishes 
and  certain  Flat  worms  ;  it  is  practically  lost  in  the  higher  groups  for 
several  reasons,  considerations  of  nutrition  being  most  important. 
An  Animal  fragment  can  only  obtain  the  nutritive  matter  for  form- 
ing new  cells  by  eating  up,  as  it  were,  part  of  itself,  until  it  has 
formed  new  organs  for  the  prehension  and  digestion  of  food.  To  do 
this,  the  fragment  must  be  always  big  enough  to  render  this  sacri- 
fice possible ;  and,  moreover,  the  tissue-cells  must  not  be  too  special- 
ised to  adapt  themselves  to  the  altered  conditions.  Thus,  the 
complex  tissues  of  a  human  arm,  accustomed  to  be  served  by  a  con- 
stant supply  of  blood  current  bearing  in  an  abundance  of  food  and 
oxygen  and  carrying  off  all  waste  materials,  and  to  the  guidance  of 
a  highly  developed  nervous  system,  can  never  adapt  themselves  to  a 
life  of  isolation.  In  this  respect  Animals  contrast  markedly  with 
Plants. 

To  study  in  the  way  we  have  applied  to  Animals  the  laws  of 
reproduction  and  propagation  in  Plants,  we  must  revert  to  those 
Protists  whose  life  is  essentially  vegetal.  These  possess  a  coloured 
portion  of  protoplasm  (green,  yellow,  or  red),  in  which,  under  the 
stimulus  of  light,  inorganic  materials  are  combined  to  form  the 
organic  food  on  which  (like  animals)  they  feed.  As  these  inorganic 
materials  exist  in  solution,  they  can  soak  into  the  cell,  which  needs 
neither  mouth  nor  stomach ;  and  the  cell  can  exist,  grow,  and 
multiply  by  division  at  the  limit  of  growth,  even  while  invested 
with  a  thin  coating  of  the  papery  material,  cellulose.  If  the  cell 
start  as  a  cylinder  or  ovoid,  and  the  divisions  are  always  in  the 
same  direction,  at  right  angles  to  its  length,  the  product  (a  colony  of 
our  first  type)  is  an  elongated  filament,  like  those  which  form  the 
green,  slimy  scum  on  our  way-side  ditches  ;  if  the  divisions  take  place 
in  two  planes,  the  colony  will  form  a  plate  or  disk  ;  if  in  three,  a  solid 
mass  which  is  much  more  rare.  When  a  period  of  increased  vital 
activity  ensues,  brood-formation  sets  in  ;  the  brood- cells  are  at  first 
naked,  lacking  the  cellulose  wall,  and  usually  provided  wiih  swim- 
ming lashes.      The  brood-cells  may  in  one  and  the  same  species1 

1  The  filamentous  Alga  Ulothrix  zonata. 
Y 


806 


NATURAL  SCIENCE 


[November 


have  very  different  fates.  They  may  (1)  settle  down  within  the 
wall  of  the  parent  cell,  and  grow  out  into  filaments,  which  finally 
rupture  the  parent  cell-wall  by  their  elongation  ;  or  (2)  they  may 
escape,  and  only  after  swimming  about  for  a  short  time  settle  down 
to  grow  into  filaments ;  or  (3)  they  may  pair  first  of  all,  and  then 

A 


/Sfoo?-e 


r 


mx>&&  ft,Zcxrme.7i£s 


/" 


f  N  \?     \r 


ZjulcLq 


(jtxxis 


dcccZa 


e 


cm  Cfccmecz?- 

f\  Si-  ~ 

A      X  3crmxz£c,TnG<?  fcrr?7x& 

the  coupled-cell,  after  a  rest,  makes  a  fresh  start  of  life  and  growth 
and  multiplication  within  the  cell-wall.  The  life-cycle  may  be  very 
complex.  We  may  even  find  states  in  which  the  cell- walls  of  the 
filament  gelatinise,  and  the  cells  themselves  round  off,  the  colony 
forming  a  very  irregular  mass. 


1897]     FUNDAMENTAL  PRINCIPLES  OF  HEREDITY     307 

In  some  forms  that  are  in  other  respects  very  primitive,  we  tind 
a  true  differentiation  that  has  advanced  further  than  Protospowjia, 
the  lowest  animal  type  we  have  selected  as  an  illustration.  Volvox 
globator  is  a  beautiful  green  sphere  the  size  of  a  small  pin's  head, 
found  actively  rolling  over  and  over,  as  its  name  implies,  in  still 
waters  fully  exposed  to  the  light.  On  microscopic  examination  it 
is  seen  to  consist  of  many  hundreds  or  even  thousands  of  green  cells 
imbedded  in  the  surface  of  a  spherical  mass  of  gelatinous  cellulose, 
and  sending  their  active  lashes  into  the  water.  Scattered  among 
these  are  a  few  larger  cells,  which  may  be  seen  in  all  stages  of 
segmentation ;  and  as  these  grow  and  segment,  they  protrude  into 
the  cavity  of  the  sphere,  and  filially  rupture  it  and  become  free  as 
new  individuals.  The  ruptured  sphere  sinks  to  the  bottom,  and  the 
colonial  cells  at  its  surface  soon  die,  whether  from  the  unfavourable 
conditions  or  no  it  is  impossible  to  say.  At  the  time  for  pairing  it  is 
only  the  few  large  cells  that  become  or  give  birth  to  pairing-cells  ;  the 
resulting  coupled-cell  segments  to  form  a  new  colony.  Here  again 
we  have  a  well-marked  sterilisation  of  tissue-cells,  and  their  characters 
are  transmitted  only  through  the  reproductive  cells,  their  collaterals. 
Prom  our  standpoint  Volvox  must  rank  as  a  lowly  Metaphyte. 

The  majority  of  Metaphytes  show  a  much  higher  differentiation 
and  a  power  of  colonial  propagation  far  greater  and  more  continu- 
ously exercised  than  in  any  Animals. 

The  first  that  we  shall  consider  are  the  Scale  and  Leaf-mosses. 
As  is  well  known,  the  little  capsule  or  urn  is  full  of  a  fine  dust  con- 
sisting of  reproductive  brood  cells  or  '  spores.'  These  germinate  and 
grow,  as  in  Protophytes,  into  filaments  consisting  of  elongated  cells, 
some  of  which  are  green  and  run  on  the  surface  of  the  ground,  while 
others  penetrate  it  and  serve  as  roots.  But  so  little  specialised  are 
they  that  the  reversal  of  a  minute  sod  containing  them  will  deter- 
mine a  change  of  their  relative  character  and  functions.  On  branches  of 
these  other  cells  are  formed,  which  are  short  and  thick.  These  divide, 
and  by  their  colonial  growth  the  proper  leafy  moss-plant  is  formed, 
but  only  the  lower  part  for  the  time  being  assumes  the  condition  of 
the  moss  tissues,  the  uppermost  cells  being  colourless,  nourished  by 
the  green  cells  of  the  stem  and  leaves,  and  assuming  and  retaining 
the  functions  of  an  embryonic  tissue.  This  constitutes  the  '  growing 
point'  characteristic  of  all  the  higher  plants. 

Ultimately,  in  the  deeper  parts  of  certain  outgrowths,  near  the 
growing  point,  are  formed  reproductive-cells  which  give  rise  to 
pairing-cells,  male  or  female,  as  the  case  may  be.  Fertilisation  is 
internal,  the  male  cell  swimming  up  to  the  immovable  female,  and 
fusing  with  it  in  situ.  The  coupled-cell  remains  imbedded  in 
the  Moss-plant,  and  is  nourished  thereby  as  a  parasite,  and, 
undergoing   segmentation,  is   converted  into  a  colonial  mass.      The 


308 


NATURAL  SCIENCE 


[November 


outer  layer  of  this  colony  in  the  most  primitive  Scale-mosses 
is  converted  into  a  capsular  wall,  while  the  inner  cells  are  re- 
productive cells,  each  of  which  forms  a  brood  of  four  spores.  In 
the  Leaf-mosses  the  colonial  body  formed  by  the  segmentation  of  the 
coupled-cell  is  much  more  modified,  with  increase  of  specialisation 


Jyem--scaZe 


sSfro 


A 

ve.ce. fa <*ice  <fe.?^> ■  is.es 


/ 


jzgssSstSsizfk  ^ssssss 


rc/brocAxctivs.  cclis 

■     A 


B 


own.   r<?o&s.} 


X 


yeqeCiz.&£trG  Zc&szi&o 


t  'cye&r  <3£t/e  fCast&es 


7VybroclJcAc£ive.  ceCCs 


A 


1/cccCs 


6tjcc£& 


CvuZ^; 


AA 

s/joreji 


and  corresponding  sterilisation  ;  for  its  lower  part  is  converted  into 
a  bristle-like  stalk,  and  the  wall  and  centre  of  the  urn-shaped 
capsule  are  both  composed  of  green  tissue  adapted  for  the  formation 
of  organic  food  materials. 

Before  we  group   these  facts  into  a   table  we  must  notice  the 


1897]     FUNDAMENTAL  PRINCIPLES  OF  HEREDITY     309 

extraordinary  powers  of  propagation  of  the  Moss-plant :  if  cut  up 
into  fragments,  almost  any  green  cell,  whether  of  the  Moss-plant  or 
the  young  urn,  is  capable  of  growing  out  into  a  green  filament  that 
will  produce  new  leafy  plants ;  and  this  is  in  addition  to  the  propa- 
gative  power  by  ordinary  branching  or  budding  of  the  embryonic 
tissues  at  the  growing  point.  We  will,  according  to  custom,  begin 
our  table  with  the  coupled-cell. 

It  will  be  seen  here  that  there  is  no  necessary  colonial  death  (as 
in  Volvox)  of  the  leafy  Moss-plant,  though  the  older  tissues  of  the 
stem  and  the  leaves  usually  die  down  after  the  maturation  of  the 
parasitic  capsule,  and  that  the  power  of  propagation  possessed  under 
certain  circumstances  by  the  green  cells  of  the  Moss-plant  and  urn 
make  them  possible  direct  ancestors  of  reproductive  cells. 

Still,  in  what  we  may  regard  as  the  normal  cycle,  the  repro- 
ductive cells  produce  among  their  offspring  collaterals  as  well  as 
direct  ancestral  forms.  The  character  of  the  cycle  is  noteworthy ; 
two  systems  of  colonial  growth  each  beginning  with  a  single  cell 
are  determined  or  closed  by  the  production  of  brood  mother-cells; 
and  these  systems  contrast  both  in  the  characters  of  the  colony  and 
in  the  nature  of  the  brood-cells.  The  colonial  outcome  of  the  spores 
is  the  filamentous  growth  and  the  leafy  Moss-plant,  and  the  brood- 
cells  formed  therefrom  are  the  sexual  pairing-cells;  the  colonial 
outcome  of  the  coupled-cell  is  the  capsule,  and  its  brood-cells  are 
the  asexual  spores.  This  is  then  an  '  alternation  of  generations  '  in 
the  sense  of  colonial  or  habitual  terminology.  Botanists  have  termed 
the  contrasting  colonial  plants  '  Sexual '  and  '  Asexual,'  Gametophyte 
and  Sporophyte,  respectively  from  the  character  of  the  brood-cells 
which  each  produces  in  turn. 

In  the  ascending  scale  of  the  Vegetable  Kingdom  we  first  meet  in 
the  Moss-plant  with  those  tissue-cells  which  we  term  'embryonic' ; 
these  must  be  defined  as  colonial  cells  nourished  by  the  adult  part 
of  the  colony,  and  having  for  their  sole  function  growth  or  con- 
tinued division  at  the  limit  of  growth  to  form  new  cells  and  organs. 
Such  cells  are  obviously  not  at  all  '  primitive,'  as  they  are  fre- 
quently called,  but  on  the  contrary  are  the  essential  outcome  of 
high  colonial  differentiation.  That  the  whole  colony  may  exist  in 
this  condition  in  the  early  stages  of  development  is  only  rendered 
possible  in  the  ease  of  the  Moss-urn  by  its  receiving  nourishment  as 
a  parasite  from  the  leafy  plant. 

The  Fern  is  only  comparable  with  the  Moss  by  a  complete 
detachment  from  preconceived  ideas.  Most  readers  know  that 
the  Fern  sheds  from  the  brown  ridges  or  spots  on  the  under  side 
of  its  leaves  a  fine  dust,  whose  particles  are  the  spores.  Each 
spore  in  germinating  produces  a  cellular  filament,  which  soon 
expands    into    a    green    plate,  the   equivalent   of   the  leafy   Moss- 


310  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [November 

plant,  or,  better,  the  '  plant '  of  the  Scale-moss  or  Liverwort,  to 
which  it  bears  a  close  resemblance.  On  this  are  borne  sexual 
organs  which  produce  sexual  cells.  The  coupled-cell,  as  in  the  Moss, 
is  at  first  parasitic  on  the  scale,  and  develops  into  a  Fern  '  plant,' 
such  as  we  know  it  with  stem,  roots,  and  leaves,  and  finally  spores. 
The  essential  difference  here  is  that  in  the  Mosses  the  spore-forming 
plant  is  entirely  parasitic  and  of  limited  growth,  while  in  the  Fern  it 
becomes  independent,  and  is  of  unlimited  growth,  being  provided 
with  organs  of  support  and  conduction  as  well  as  of  nutrition.  We 
may  well  say  that  the  sterilisation  (to  use  Bower's  term)  of  part  of 
the  colony  has  led  to  so  extended  a  power  of  colonial  growth  and 
branching,  that  the  power  of  forming  reproductive  cells  is  in  the  end 
enormously  increased.  The  propagative  capacities  of  Ferns  by  buds 
from  embryonic  tissue  are  very  great ;  those  of  fragments  of  the 
spore-bearing  plant  are  slight ;  but  the  sex-bearing  scale  may  be 
artificially  propagated  by  being  cut  into  small  pieces,  although  its  life 
is  usually  limited  by  the  formation  of  the  parasitic  Fern-plant  from 
the  coupled-cell. 

Ferns  then  show  the  same  alternation  between  spore-bearing  and 
sex-bearing  generations  as  Mosses,  but  the  order  of  relative  con- 
spicuousness  and  abundance  of  colonial  growth  is  inverted.  We 
have  seen  that  in  Mosses  a  vegetative  transition  by  cell  growth 
might  take  place  from  the  spore-bearing  generation  to  the  other. 
In  Ferns  similar  transitions  are  possible  both  ways,  so  as  to  cut  out 
the  stage  of  brood  cell  formation,  which  we  regard  as  the  critical 
reproductive  stage.1  Thus  in  many  Film-ferns,  instead  of  producing 
spores,  the  leaves  grow  out  into  scale-plates  bearing  sexual  organs, 
while  in  the  common  Cretan  fern,  the  scale  produced  from  the 
spore  grows  out  directly  into  the  spore-bearing  leafy  Fern-plant 
instead  of  giving  rise  to  sexual  cells.  In  flowering  plants  the 
relations  of  the  sex-bearing  plant  are  much  obscured,  and  it 
would  lead  us  too  far  to  explain  them  here.  Suffice  it  to  say 
that  the  'plant'  as  we  know  it  corresponds  to  the  Fern-plant 
or  moss-capsule  :  it  is  the  Sporophyte,  not  the  Gametophyte.  The 
parasitism  of  the  embryo  formed  from  the  coupled-cell  is  usually 
intense  and  prolonged. 

A  very  remarkable  character  of  Dicotyledons  or  Exogens  is  the 
continuation  downwards  from  the  growing  point  of  a  zone  of  em- 
bryonic tissue,  the  'cambium,'  which  habitually  by  its  growth  and 
multiplication  forms  zones  of  wood  on  the  inner  side,  and  inner-bark 
(or  bast)  on  the  outer.  This  layer  has,  in  cuttings,  an  especial  tendency 
to  form  buds.  But  all  the  living  cells  retain  a  power  of  forming  a 
similar  tissue  at  or  near  an  exposed  surface ;  for  instance,  such  a 
layer  is  formed  a  little  within   the  surface   of  trees   to  produce  the 

1  These  transitions  have  been  aptly  termed  "short  circuitings  "  by  Sir  Edward  Fry. 


1397]      FUNDAMENTAL  PRINCIPLES  OF  HEREDITY     3  1  1 

cork, — this  is  known  as  the  cork-cambium.  We  are  all  of  us 
familiar  with  the  little  brown  scars  on  plums,  &c,  that  have  been 
slightly  injured  when  green  :  these  are  due  to  the  local  development 
of  a  layer  of  embryonic  tissue  below  the  injured  surface,  and  the 
formation  of  a  thin  protective  layer  of  cork  therefrom. 

Colonial  propagation  in  Flowering  Plants  may  take  place  by  the 
separation  of  buds  (which  form  normally  at  the  growing  point),  or 
by  development  of  so-called  adventitious  buds  from  the  embryonic 
cambium  zone  of  the  stem  or  roots.  Such  propagation  by  minute 
fragments  as  occurs  in  Mosses  is  unknown  here ;  but  larger  frag- 
ments of  leaves  can  frequently  produce  buds  and  ultimately  plants. 
The  cells  within  the  cut  surfaces  produce  an  embryonic  tissue,  which 
gives  rise  both  to  a  protective  skin  of  cork  and  to  adventitious  buds. 

The  readiness  to  form  cork  and  adventitious  buds  in  this  way 
varies  extremely,  and  with  this  the  power  of  leaf  propagation.  For  the 
formation  of  cork  is  an  indispensable  protection  against  the  opposite 
dangers  of  drying  up  on  the  one  hand,  and  of  the  attacks  of  microbes 
and  moulds  on  the  other.  Again  most  Begonias  are  readily  propagated 
by  pieces  of  leaf  ;  but  the  bulbous  varieties  form  a  mass  of  embryonic 
tissue,  well  protected  by  cork,  which  remains  for  months  or  years 
before  active  buds  are  developed,  so  that  they  were  long  thought  in- 
capable of  this  mode  of  reproduction.  Not  only  Begonias, but  Gloxinias 
and  other  members  of  the  showy  order  Gesneriaceae,  the  Peperomias 
with  their  massive  speckled  or  veined  foliage,  and  Chrysanthemums, 
are  habitually  multiplied  in  this  way  ;  and  the  list  of  possibilities  in 
this  direction  is  daily  increasing. 

On  reviewing  these  facts  we  see  that  the  law  of  collateral  trans- 
mission applies  to  Plants  as  well  as  to  Animals,  but  that  they  have 
much  greater  powers  of  colonial  propagation,  by  the  formation  of 
embryonic  tissue  from  already  specialised  colonial  cells,  and  by  the 
persistence  of  a  portion  of  the  colony  (the  growing  point,  and  in 
Exogens  the  cambium  layers)  in  the  embryonic  state.  The  fact  that 
green  cells  can  manufacture  plant  food  in  the  light  explains  the 
greater  vitality  and  propagative  power  of  small  Vegetable  fragments 
as  compared  with  those  of  Animals  ;  and  it  is  needless  to  assume 
any  more  recondite  intrinsic  differences.  Even  in  this  mode  of 
propagation,  the  law  of  collateral  transmission  holds ;  for  many  of 
the  cell-forms  of  plants,  such  as  hairs,  wood-cells,  &c,  are  abso- 
lutely sterile,  and  consequently  can  never  take  part  in  the  formation 
of  an  embryonic  tissue  capable  of  giving  rise  to  a  new  plant. 

Thus,  throughout  the  Higher  Kingdoms  we  find  the  problem  of 
heredity  rests  on  different  data  to  those  supplied  by  the  Protista. 
In  these  lowly  forms,  where  the  law  of  direct  transmission  prevails, 
it  is  easy  to  admit  that  when  a  cell  resolves  itself  into  two  new  ones 
which  exactly  reproduce  its  original  state,  they  should  each  possess 


312  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [November 

its  original  qualities ;  even  where  the  transmission  is  alternate,  we 
may  admit  that  the  different  conditions  at  the  different  stages  of  a 
genetic  cycle  modify  the  organisms  produced.  In  the  simplest  case 
of  collateral  transmission,  as  presented  by  Volvox  globator,  the  steril- 
ised colonial  cells  so  closely  resemble  more  primitive  independent 
forms  in  their  behaviour  and  character,  that  we  may  well  believe 
that  they  have  inherited  these  from  such  forms,  directly  and  un- 
altered, from  some  Protist  ancestor,  while  the  reproductive  cells  have 
become  modified.  But  it  is  impossible  to  suggest  such  an  explana- 
tion for  the  higher  Animals  and  Plants,  since  a  nerve-cell  with  its 
outgrowths  many  feet  long,  or  a  woody  fibre  which  has  expended  all 
its  living  protoplasm  in  the  building  up  of  a  firm  wall,  can  only  have 
been  evolved  as  portions  of  a  highly-specialised  colonial  organism. 

The  difficulty  of  explaining  the  mechanism  of  collateral  trans- 
mission in  Metazoa  and  Metaphytes  by  the  direct  transmission  in 
Protista  has  been  the  origin  of  the  recent  lively  discussions  on 
heredity.  To  biologists  saturated  with  the  implicit  conviction  that 
only  direct  cellular  transmission  was  alone  possible,  some  mysterious 
agency,  that  should  be  contained  in  the  reproductive  cells,  and  be 
handed  down  by  them  in  their  direct  cellular  descent,  was  an 
essential  assumption  ;  and  this  agency  is  supplied  by  Weismann  in 
his  Germ-Plasm  Theory.  The  reader  will  do  well  to  bear  in  mind 
that  it  has  been  presented  to  the  world  in  successive  editions ;  each 
has  been  greeted  as  final  by  the  disciples,  who  have  made  light  of 
the  objections  raised  thereto,  though  on  every  occasion  such  objec- 
tions induced  the  Master  to  recast  the  theory  in  his  next  work. 
Our  presentment  of  the  theory  upheld  in  the  "  Germ  Plasm  ;  A 
Theory  of  Heredity,"  published  in  London  in  1893,  may  therefore, 
for  aught  anyone  can  tell,  become  obsolete  very  shortly,  owing  to 
the  author's  "  having  (to  use  his  own  phrase)  in  the  meantime  gained 
a  deeper  insight." 

Weismann  conceives  that  in  the  nucleus  of  what  we  have 
termed  '  reproductive  '  (and  also,  in  part,  '  embryonic  ')  cells  is  a 
mixed  plasm,  the  '  germ-plasm,'  composed  of  certain  entities,  the 
'  determinants  '  for  the  several  organs  of  the  colony ;  that  when  the 
cell  divides  at  the  limit  of  growth  into  two  similar  cells,  the  germ- 
plasm  and  the  several  determinants  divide  in  the  same  way,  so  that 
the  determinants  are  the  same  in  each  of  the  daughter-cells  as  they 
were  in  the  parent.  But  in  those  divisions  which  give  rise  to 
specialised  cells  the  germ-plasm  divides  as  a  whole,  in  such  a  way 
that  the  determinants  are  only  distributed  between  the  daughter- 
cells,  some  to  one,  some  to  another :  we  may  say  that  there  is 
distribution  or  repartition,  not  the  true  division  of  the  several 
determinants.  Similarly,  the  determinants  each  contain  a  group  of 
minor  entities  the  biophors,  and  in  the  ultimate  divisions  of  the  cells 


1897]     FUNDAMENTAL  PRINCIPLES  OF  HEREDITY     313 

of  an  organ  these  biophors  are  distributed  between  the  cells  ;  and 
the  proper  biophors  in  each  cell  constrain  it  to  play  its  specific  part 
in  the  organism. 

Those  cells  which  constitute  the  direct  line  of  descent  between  the 
reproductive  cells  of  one  generation  and  those  of  another  are  formed 
by  true  divisions  of  the  germ-plasm,  with  all  its  determinants.  But 
we  are  met  by  the  facts  of  propagation  by  fragments  composed  only 
of  tissue-cells  in  Animal,  and  still  more  in  Plants,  where  specialised 
tissue-cells  revert  to  an  embryonic  condition,  or  rather  beget 
embryonic  cells  with  a  complete  germ-plasm.  To  explain  this  diffi- 
culty, we  must  suppose  that  in  these  cases  a  portion  of  complete 
germ-plasm  has  passed  at  their  formation  into  such  tissue-cells,  and 
that  it  has  remained  dormant  until  the  stimulus  of  separation  from 
the  colonial  organism  has  revived  its  vitality.  Again  in  the  four- 
celled  stage  of  the  segmented  embryo  of  various  widely  distinct 
Animals  (even  in  the  sixteen-celled  stage  of  some  Medusae)  it  is 
possible  to  isolate  a  single  cell,  which  then  develops  into  a  complete 
embryo,  though  had  it  remained  associated  with  its  fellows  it  would 
have  formed  only  a  definite  part  of  the  embryo.  Here  again  we  find 
the  assumption  of  the  existence  of  dormant  determinants,  which  be- 
come active  only  in  the  separated  cell,  adduced  by  Weismann  to  save 
the  theory.  This  assumption  is  also  used  to  explain  alternation  of 
generations,  where  the  Moss-plant  and  Moss-urn,  or  the  Fern-scale 
and  Fern-plant  alternate  ;  their  germ-plasm  must  contain  two  sets  of 
determinants,  one  for  the  first,  the  other  for  the  second- generation, 
alternating  in  sleep  and  waking  like  the  printer  and  the  hatter  in 
Box  and  Cox.  We  are  reminded  of  the  complex  epicycles  required 
to  render  the  universe  workable  on  Ptolemy's  geocentric  hypothesis, 
and  the  Spanish  king's  comment  thereon.  "  Had  I  been  consulted 
at  the  creation,  I  could  have  simplified  matters." 

So  far  indeed,  this  might  be  held  as  a  formal  or  fictive  hypo- 
thesis to  explain  the  mechanism  of  heredity  on  the  basis  of  Special 
Creation — each  organism  being  created  fully  equipped  with  its 
own  proper  germ-plasm,  determinants,  biophors,  and  all.  But  no  ; 
Weismann  is  a  firm  believer  in  the  theory  of  common  descent,  and, 
as  we  have  seen,  he  and  his  school  profess  to  be  the  only  true 
Darwinians ;  and  we  come  to  his  Theory  of  Variations.1 

The  germ-plasm  with  its  contained  determinants,  as  it  lies 
in  the  reproductive  cells  of  the  body,  is  subject  to  nutritive 
changes,  and  consequently  to  constant  slight  variations  which 
apparently  are  not  correlated  with  anything  else  whatever.  The 
haphazard  variations,  of  the  determinants  induce  corresponding,  and 

1  This  essay  was  written  nearly  two  years  ago.  Since  then  Weismann  has  enlarged 
his  theory  by  the  hypothesis  of  germinal  selection.  Without  going  into  this  we  may 
note  that  it  makes  no  difference  to  the  present  argument. 


314  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [November 

therefore  haphazard,  variations  of  the  organism  ;  and  the  Almighty 
Natural  Selection  now  steps  in,  weeds  out  the  unfittest,  and  so 
induces  the  endless  variety  of  form  and  function  in  the  Organic 
Eealm.  This  has  been  irreverently  termed  the  'toss-up'  or  'dice-box' 
theory  of  variation.  It  is  hard  to  see  how  variations  in  feeding  or 
starving  hypothetical  determinants  can  have  ever  ended  in  the 
development  of  a  vertebrate  eye,  or  in  the  exquisitely  co-operating 
organs  that  render  possible  the  parasitism  of  the  offspring  on  the 
viviparous  mother :  it  would  be  difficult  if  we  had  limitless  aeons  of 
biological  time  at  our  disposal,  instead  of  the  paltry  million  of 
centuries  conceded  as  an  outside  limit  by  Lord  Kelvin,  even  when 
multiplied  by  4000,  as  Perry  and  Poulton  suggest.  We  have  all 
heard  of  the  German  astronomer  who  was  reading  Lucretius,  and 
said  to  himself  as  noontide  approached,  "  So  if  the  atoms  had  been 
flying  about  for  all  time,  cold  potato,  oil,  vinegar,  garlic,  and  salt 
might  have  combined  to  form  a  salad."  "  Yes,  dear,"  said  his  wife, 
who  had  come  in  unperceived  to  call  him  to  dinner,  "  but  not  as 
good  as  you  shall  have  with  your  beef." 

It  must  be  admitted  that  marvellous  ingenuity  is  shown  in  giving 
explanations  on  this  theory  to  cases  where  they  are  not  needed ;  we 
may  cite  the  limitations  of  propagation  by  small  fragments  of 
Animals  or  Plants,  and  the  variations  in  the  power  of  leaf  propaga- 
tion in  the  latter,  which  are  so  readily  explicable  without  the  germ- 
plasm  hypothesis.  On  this  hypothesis,  however,  we  are  asked  to 
overlook  the  plain  and  obvious  questions  of  nutrition,  cork-formation, 
and  bud-formation,  and  to  concentrate  our  ideas  on  the  presence  of 
more  or  less  dormant  germ-plasm  in  the  tissue-cells.  We  may  well 
note  here  that  among  "  Inductive  Fallacies  "  Bain  cites  the  error  of 
assigning  more  causes  than  a  phenomenon  needs.  "  It  is  involved 
in  the  very  idea  of  cause  that  the  effect  is  in  exact  accordance  with 
the  cause ;  hence  the  proof  that  more  causes  were  operative  than  the 
effect  needs  defeats  itself."  l 

But  the  cardinal  defect  in  the  theory  is  its  objective  base- 
lessness. It  professes  to  be  founded  on  the  microscopic  study 
of  the  changes  in  the  nucleus  in  cell-division ;  but  there  we 
find  nothing  to  justify  the  assumption  of  two  modes  of  nuclear 
division  in  the  embryo,  the  one  dividing  the  determinants,  and 
the  other  only  distributing  them  between  the  daughter-cells.  To 
justify  such  a  theory  there  should  at  least  be  some  such  basis  in 
fact,  as  indeed  there  is  for  the  author's  '  id  '  theory  of  the  relations 
of   '  amphigonic  '    inheritance  (from  two  parents),'2  which  does  not 

1  "Logic,"  by  Alexander  Bain.     Part  II.,  Induction,  ed.  2,  1873,  y>.  395. 

2  To  avoid  complication  and  the  undue  lengthening  of  this  essay  we  have  been 
obliged  to  omit  the  consideration  of  the  effect  of  double  parentage  in  the  higher 
organisms  that  reproduce  sexually.  lint  it  is  obvious  that  of  itself  it  must  tend  to  efface 
and  not  to  accentuate  the  variations  from  the  average  standard  of  the  race. 


1897]      FUNDAMENTAL  PRINCIPLES  OF  HEREDITY     315 

come  within  the  purview  of  the  present  article.  As  it  is,  the 
theory  falls  under  the  ever-trenchant  blade  of  Occam's  razor, 
"  Entia  non  sunt  multiplicanda  praeter  necessitatem." 

The  antagonistic  school,  of  Herbert  Spencer,  regard  Living  Beings 
as  characterised  by  their  continuous  adjustment  of  internal  relations 
to  external  conditions,  and  cannot  see  a  priori  grounds  for  regarding 
the  reproductive  cells  as  especially  lacking  in  this  power  of 
adaptation.  They  regard  instinct  as  only  explicable  as  habit 
transmitted  and  relatively  fixed  by  constant  transmission  from  one 
generation  to  the  next,  and  are  disinclined  to  admit  (even  as  a  formal 
hypothesis)  any  scheme  that  leaves  all  such  considerations  on  one 
side.  They  therefore  are  compelled  to  refer  variations  in  the  offspring 
to  the  adaptive  reaction  of  the  parent  to  the  environment,  and  hold 
that  there  must  be  some  mechanism  of  transmission  other  than 
that  of  direct  cellular  inheritance,  by  which  the  reproductive 
cells  hand  clown  to  their  differentiated  cell-offspring  the  characters 
of  the  corresponding  cells  in  the  parent  organism  as  a  whole. 

Charles  Darwin  felt  this  need  so  keenly  (in  a  way  largely  ignored 
by  those  who  style  themselves  his  only  true  disciples)  that  he  for- 
mulated his  elaborate  provisional  hypothesis  of  Pangenesis  to  supply 
the  mechanism  that  he  postulated.  He  supposed  that  every  cell  in 
the  body  gave  forth  minute  buds  or  '  gemmules '  which  circulated  in 
the  blood,  and  were  carried  by  its  current  to  the  reproductive  cells 
where  they  were  stored  up,  and  that  in  the  development  of  the  embryo 
they  induced  the  formation  of  cells  like  those  from  which  they  were 
given  off.  Galton  tried  the  crucial  experiment  of  transfusing  blood 
from  one  breed  of  rabbits  to  another,  and  found  that  this  had  no 
effect  on  the  purity  of  the  offspring.  This  not  only  shattered  the 
theory  of  Pangenesis,  but  settled  in  the  negative  every  conceivable 
theory  of  hereditary  transmission  based  on  the  conveyance  of  formed 
material  particles  or  of  chemical  substances  from  the  other  parts 
of  the  colonial  organism  to  the  reproductive  cells.1 

The  second  theory  is  that  of  Herbert  Spencer,  of  'biological  units,' 
of  definite  form  and  relation,  which  by  their  polarity  tend  to  complete 
the  organism.  I  shall  describe  that  development  of  it  recently  put 
forward  with  great  skill  and  ingenuity  by  Wilhelm  Haacke  under 
the  title  of  the  "  Gemmaria  theory." 2  He  holds  that  all  living 
plasma  is  composed  of  minute  units,  the  '  gemmae,'  grouped 
together  in  aggregates,  the  '  gemmaria,'  both  being  of  definite  form 
and  size,  in  virtue  of  which  they  tend  to  assume  certain  relations  of 

^'Life  and  Habit,"  Loud.  1878;  and  "Unconscious  Memory"  (Lond.,  1890). 
The  latter  work  contains  a  translation  of  Hering's  paper.  "  A  Theory  of  Development 
and  Heredity,"  by  Henry  B.  Orr  (London  and  New  York,  1893),  is  written  essentially 
from  this  point  of  view. 

2  See  "Gestaltung  und  Vererbung,"  Leipzig,  1893,  and  "Schopfung  der  Tierwelt." 
Both  these  works  arc  written  in  a  German  style  of  exceptional  charm,  ease,  and 
vivacity. 


316  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [November 

equilibrium  in  the  cells  and  in  the  whole  organism.  Owing  to  this 
being  a  labile  equilibrium,  any  disturbance  due  to  an  altered 
condition  of  the  environment  will  alter  the  '  set '  of  the 
gemmaria  and  change  the  conditions  of  their  equilibrium.  It  is 
as  the  result  of  their  relation  to  the  organism  at  large  that 
the  gemmaria  of  the  reproductive  cells  E  of  an  organism  A  are 
compelled  to  reproduce  the  likeness  of  A  ;  consequently  when  the 
continuance  of  altered  surroundings  alters  A  to  A',  the  gemmaria  of 
the  reproductive  cells  will  get  a  '  set '  changing  them  to  E',  which 
will  reproduce  the  altered  organism  A'.  Now,  as  a  formal  hypo- 
thesis, this  serves  to  give  a  very  pretty  provisional  explanation  of 
many  phenomena  of  organic  life  ;  but  we  have  no  sufficient  micro- 
scopic evidence  in  its  favour,  and,  to  me  at  least,  much  that  speaks 
against  it.  We  know  too  little  of  the  physical  relations  of  cell- 
life  to  be  able  to  accept,  even  provisionally,  a  theory  based  mainly 
on  geometrical  and  mechanical  conceptions. 

The  most  satisfactory  explanation,  perhaps,  is  that  put  forward  by 
Hering  and  Samuel  Butler,1  the  latter  of  whom  has  written  with 
singular  freshness  and  an  ingenuity  which  compensates  for  the 
author's  avowed  lack  of  biological  knowledge.  This  theory  has 
indeed  a  tentative  character,  and  lacks  symmetrical  complete- 
ness, but  is  the  more  welcome  as  not  aiming  at  the  impossible. 
A  whole  series  of  phenomena  in  organic  beings  are  correlated 
under  the  term  of  memory,  conscious  and  unconscious, 
patent  and  latent.  Our  memory  is  conscious,  when  we  say  a 
lesson  or  remember  a  birthday ;  unconscious,  when  we  let  our 
fingers  play  of  themselves  a  piece  of  music  of  which  we  could 
not  write  down  a  note  ;  patent,  when  we  remember  to  call  at  a 
friend's  house ;  latent,  during  the  interval  while  the  servant  is 
waiting  at  the  open  door,  until  the  sight  of  the  familiar  stick  in 
the  hall  recalls  the  owner's  name  which  would  not  recur  to  our  con- 
sciousness. Of  the  order  of  unconscious  memory,  latent  till  the 
arrival  of  the  appropriate  stimulus,  is  all  the  co-operative  growth 
and  work  of  the  organism,  including  its  development  from  the  repro- 
ductive cells.  Concerning  the  modus  operandi  we  know  nothing  : 
the  phenomenon  may  be  due,  as  Hering  suggests,  to  molecular 
vibrations,  which  must  be  at  least  as  distinct  from  ordinary  physical 
disturbances  as  Eontgen's  rays  are  from  ordinary  light,  or  it  may 
be  correlated,  as  we  ourselves  are  inclined  to  think,  with  complex 
chemical  changes  in  an  intricate  but  orderly  succession.  For  the 
present  at  least  the  problem  of  heredity  can  only  be  elucidated  by 
the  light  of  mental  and  not  material  processes. 

Qceen's  College,  Cork.  MARCUS  HarTOG. 

1  "  On  Memory  as  a  Universal  Function  of  Organised  Matter"  (Vienna,  1870,  ex. 
S.  Butler  in  "  Unconscious  Memory,"  p.  97). 


575.8  317 


II 

Reproductive  Divergence  :  A  Factor  in  Evolution  ? 

IN  the  September  number  of  Natural  Science  (p.  181)  Mr  H.  M. 
Vernon  propounds  a  new  theory,  called  Reproductive  Divergence, 
which,  he  says,  is  essentially  different  from  Romanes'  Physiological 
Selection.  Inasmuch  as  both  Reproductive  Divergence  and  Physio- 
logical Selection  are  a  process,  not  a  cause,  are  based  on  the  occur- 
rence of  the  same  kind  of  variation  among  the  individuals  of  a 
species,  and  have  the  same  end  in  view,  the  differences  between  the 
two  principles  do  not  appear  to  me  to  be  of  great  importance  ;  the 
premise  of  Reproductive  Divergence  is,  however,  more  general,  and 
the  way  in  which  the  principle  is  demonstrated  is  certainly  inde- 
pendent. Reproductive  Divergence  (like  Physiological  Selection)  is 
brought  forward  to  show  that  under  certain  propositions  given 
differences  between  the  individuals  of  a  species  inhabiting  the  same 
locality  and  presumed  to  stand  under  the  same  external  influences 
will  develop  into  specific  differences  solely  by  means  of  Reproductive 
Divergence.  What  we  have  to  understand  by  specific-  differences 
is  quite  clear  in  this  case  :  it  is  that  kind  of  difference  which  we 
find  to  exist  between  two  morphologically  very  closely  allied  forms 
which,  though  existing  together  in  the  same  locality,  are  entirely 
independent  of  one  another,  the  two  forms  (1)  breeding  true,  the 
one  never  producing  an  individual  that  belongs  to  the  other,  and  (2) 
never  fusing  into  one  form,  in  spite  of  their  not  being  mutually 
absolutely  sterile.  In  another  place x  I  have  referred  at  some 
length  to  Physiological  Selection,  and  endeavoured  to  show  that  this 
principle  does  not  hold  good  in  so  far  as  the  outcome  of  Physio- 
logical selection,  as  propounded  by  Romanes,  is,  at  best,  dimorphism, 
not  specific  distinctness  ;  and  I  came  to  the  conclusion  that  forms 
deviating  from  each  other  in  the  way  just  mentioned  cannot  be 
evolved  without  the  aid  of  some  kind  of  local  separation.2  It  does 
not  seem  to  me  that  Mr  Vernon's  arguments  in  support  of  Repro- 
ductive Divergence  as  a  factor  in  the  evolution  of  specific  distinct- 
ness are  any  more  valid  than  those  which  were  adduced  by  Romanes 
in   favour  of   Physiological   Selection.      The  occurrence   of   such   a 

1  "  Novitates  Zoologicae,"  1896,  p.  426  if. 

2  Local  races  are  now  generally  termed  subspecies  ;  their  high  significance,  especially 
in  questions  of  general  Biology,  will  doubtless  be  recognised  in  time  also  by  those 
systematists  who  still  persist  in  ignoring  subspecies. 


318  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [November 

correlation  between  morphological  characters  and  fertility  of  the 
specimens  of  a  species  as  the  theory  requires  cannot  be  denied.  It 
is  quite  conceivable  that,  for  instance,  in  insects  the  copulatory 
organs  of  one  or  the  other  species  vary  correlatively  with  the  size  of 
the  individuals  in  a  similar  way  as  the  horns  on  the  head  and 
thorax  of  Dynastid  beetles,  or  the  mandibles  of  stag-beetles  do ; 
such  a  variation  in  the  copulatory  organs  of  the  males  and  a  cor- 
responding variation  in  the  females  would  necessarily  have  the 
result,  that  copulation  between  specimens  of  different  size  could  be 
less  easily  effected,  and  would  be  less  effective  than  copulation 
between  individuals  of  the  same  size.  Hence  the  premise  of  the 
theory,  or  '  the  first  part,'  which  '  can  only  be  verified  by  experi- 
ment,' must  readily  be  accepted,  and  would  be  admissible  even  if 
there  were  as  yet  no  facts  observed  which  proved  that  the  required 
variation  actually  occurs.  Mr  Vernon  promises  (p.  185)  to  make 
further  experiments  in  this  direction,  for  which  biologists  will  surely 
be  very  thankful. 

The  second  part  of  the  theory,  or  the  statement,  that,  if  the 
above  premise  is  given,  a  species  will  necessarily  develop  into  two 
or  more  varieties  or  even  fresh  species,  is  '  demonstrated  mathemati- 
cally.' Let  us  examine  this  mathematical  demonstration.  Mr 
Vernon  divides  the  1800  specimens  of  a  hypothetical  species,  which 
is  assumed  to  vary  in  size  from  64  to  73  inches,  into  three  sets  of 
males  and  females,  of  300  specimens  each,  the  sets  being  designated 
as  S,  M,  and  L,  and  s,  m,  and  1  respectively  ;  then,  if  it  is  further 
assumed,  that  on  an  average  of  the  300  S,  100  S  will  copulate 
with  s,  another  100  with  m,  and  the  third  100  with  1,  and  so  also 
in  the  case  of  M  and  L,  the  total  number  of  offspring  will  be — the 
total  number  of  individuals  is  accepted  to  be  constant  in  each 
generation — 

I.  100  Ss,  200  Sm,  300  Mm,  200  Ml,  100  LI. 

If  now  "  the  comparative  fertility  of  the  various  sized  individuals  is 
slightly  changed,"  so  that  for  instance  100  specimens  copulating 
with  individuals  of  the  same  size  will  give  birth  to  120  offspring, 
100  specimens  copulating  with  individuals  of  slightly  different  size 
will  produce  95  offspring,  and  100  individuals  copulating  with 
specimens  of  considerably  different  size  will  give  birth  to  80  off- 
spring of  either  sex,  the  total  number  of  offspring  will  be  distributed 
as  follows : — 

II.   120  Ss,  190  Sm,  280  Mm,  190  Ml,  120  LI. 

By  a  comparison  of  II.  with  I.  Mr  Vernon  comes  to  the  two  conclu- 
sions (a)  that  the  limits  of  variation,  which  originally  were  64  and 
73,  will  be  altered  to  02*5  and  74"5  ;  and  (b)  that  the  individuals 


1897]  REPRODUCTIVE  DIVERGENCE  319 

of  intermediate  size  will,  in  succeeding  generations,  decrease  in 
number,  while  the  individuals  of  small  and  large  size  will  increase. 

To  show  that  inference  (a)  is  correct,  Mr  Vernon  argues  as 
follows: — (1)  Variety  S  varied  originally  from  G4  to  G7  inches,  the 
mean  being  65*5,  and  L  from  70  to  73,  the  mean  being  7l'o  ;  (2) 
let  us  then  suppose  that  by  the  principle  of  Reproductive  Divergence 
the  average  of  S  were  reduced  to  64,  [the  specimens  varying  now 
from  6  2 "5  to  65*5],  and  that  of  L  increased  to  73,  [the  individuals 
varying  from  71*5  to  74-5]  ;  (3)  then  "  it  follows  that  these  groups  S 
and  L  would  (approximately)  contain  individuals  varying  between 
62'5  to  65*5  inches,  and  7l'o  to  74*5  inches  respectively."  But 
surely  this  inference  (3)  is  merely  a  re-statement  of  assumption  (2)  ! 

And  as  to  the  conclusion  (b)  that  the  intermediate  individuals 
will  disappear,  it  has  apparently  escaped  Mr  Vernon  that  the  figures 
given  under  II.  are  nothing  else  but  a  re-statement  of  the  proposition 
that  100  pairs  of  equal  size  give  birth  to  120  offspring  (etc.)  ;  the 
result  of  the  chance-breeding  is  quite  different.  We  must  divide 
the  original  900  individuals  into  five  sets,  and  then  compare  these 
five  sets  with  the  five  sets  of  II.,  thus  : — 

I.    180,  180,  ISO,  180,  180  =  900. 
II.   120,  190,  280,  190,  120  =  900. 

It  is  not  for  me  to  point  out  under  which  new  conditions  the  range 
of  variation  would  be  widened  and  the  species  be  split  up  into 
varieties.  Under  those  propositions  upon  which  Mr  Vernon  bases 
his  mathematical  demonstration,  the  mean  of  S  will  not  decrease,  and 
that  of  L  will  not  increase,  but  the  smallest  and  largest  specimens 
will  very  soon  disappear  altogether,  and  the  species  become  mono- 
morphic,  as  a  mathematical  consideration  of  the  chance-breeding  in 
succeeding  generations  will  show.  If  we  start  with  300  S,  300  M, 
and  300  L,  the  number  of  small,  medium-sized,  and  large  individuals 
in  the  first  generation  of  offspring  will  depend  on  the  size  of  the 
offspring  of  each  pair;  the  offspring  of  a  pair  may  be  the  same  in 
size  as  the  parents,  or  may  be  smaller  or  larger.  It  is  sufficient  to 
consider  two  of  the  infinite  possibilities.  (1)  The  300  S  produce  on 
an  average  equal  numbers  of  small,  medium-sized,  and  large  offspring, 
and  so  do  the  300  M  and  300  L.  The  result  will  be  that  the 
numbers  of  different-sized  individuals  will  not  be  altered  in  suc- 
ceeding generations,  and  the  variation  of  the  species  will  also  remain 
the  same.  This  is  the  usual  result  of  chance-breeding,  if  no  special 
factors  come  into  play.  (2)  The  100  S  which  copulate  with  100  s 
will  produce  100  small  specimens  Ss,  no  medium-sized  and  large 
ones ;  the  same  applying  as  to  M  and  L.  This  is  what  Mr  Vernon 
assumes  to  take  place.  Though  this  assumption  cannot  be  allowed  to 
stand,  as  what  is  here  assumed  to  be  true  is  one  of  the  characteristics 


320  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [November 

of  specific  distinctness  which  the  principle  of  Eeproductive  Divergence 
is  propounded  to  explain,  we  will  accept,  for  the  sake  of  argument, 
that  parents  of  the  same  size  breed  true.  Then  of  the  120  Ss  of  the 
first  generation  24  will  copulate  with  small  females  and  24  each 
with  the  other  four  sets ;  hence  there  will  be  produced  only  2  9  Ss. 
These  2  9  will  have  to  copulate  with  nine  sets,  and  so  on.  The  same 
applies  to  LI.  Or  to  put  it  generally,  if  A  is  the  number  of  indi- 
viduals of  each  original  set,  a  the  number  of  original  sets,  x  the  sur- 
plus fertility,  n  the  number  of  generations,  then  under  the  proposi- 
tions adduced  by  Mr  Vernon, 

n  _  f]Q0  +  x\H  A 

bs  "  V   100   ;■ 


a  ((a-l)2+l).((a-l)3  +  l)...^(a-lf+lN) 


In  our  case  the  numbers  of  S  in  the  succeeding  generations  will, 
therefore,  be— T.  =  120  ;  II.  =  29  ;  III.  =  4  ;  IV.  =  0,  3. 

That  is  to  say,  after  the  fourth  generation,  the  largest  and 
smallest  specimens  will  be  weeded  out,  and  this  result  will  not 
materially  be  altered,  even  if  we  assume  that  the  largest  and 
smallest  individuals  are  mutually  absolutely  sterile.  (Compare  also 
Galton's  regression  towards  the  mean.) 

Although  Eeproductive  Divergence  does  not  achieve  what  Mr 
Vernon  claims  for  it,  it  is  not  altogether  to  be  rejected  under  other 
premises  than  those  accepted  by  Mr  Vernon.  There  are  certain 
species,  for  instance  among  Lepidoptera,  which  vary  in  the  same 
locality  in  such  a  way,  that  there  are  two  well-marked  varieties 
which  breed  freely  with  one  another,  but  produce  comparatively  few 
intergraduate  specimens,  the  offspring  belonging  mostly  to  the  one 
or  to  the  other  variety.1  Here  Reproductive  Divergence  may 
eventually  have  free  play,  and  then  necessarily  will  evolve  incipient 
dimorphism  into  complete  dimorphism,  and  in  so  far  Eeproductive 
Divergence  might  be  called  a  factor  in  evolution. 

Karl  Jordan. 

Zoological  Museum,  Tring. 

1  Standfuss,  "  Handbueh  f.  Schnietterlingssammler,"  1895. — See  also  Giard,  Natural 
Science  I.  p.  388  (1892)  ;  Romanes,  ibid.  p.  398. 


550.1  321 


III 

A  New  Scheme  of  Geological  Arrangement  and 

Nomenclature 

Pakt  I 

THE  only  scientific  men  whom  Charon  will  carry  across  the  Styx 
without  a  fee  will  probably  be  those  who  conform  to  orthodox 
shibboleths.  For  the  rest,  including  most  of  the  editors  of  and 
contributors  to  Natural  Science,  I  mean  the  purveyors  of  audacious 
heresy,  a  heavy  charge  will  no  doubt  be  made.  Meanwhile  we 
ought  to  have  our  turn  in  this  world  and  if  we  shock  those  who 
sit  on  velvet  and  dislike  to  have  the  picturesque  dust  of  their 
cherished  prejudices  disturbed,  they  will  remember  that  they  will 
have  their  comfort  when  the  Conservative  old  boatman  leaves  the 
flagrantly  and  impudently  wicked  in  the  mud. 

In  venturing  to  ventilate  a  fresh  heresy  I  thought  it  needed 
such  a  preface. 

The  systematic  arrangement  of  the  various  beds  which  compose 
the  Earth's  crust  began,  as  is  well  known,  with  the  Italian  writers 
of  the  seventeenth  century.  It  was  Lehmann,  however,  who  first 
really  proposed  a  rational  arrangement  by  separating  the  crystalline 
unstratified  rocks,  which  he  called  Primitive,  from  the  beds  arranged 
in  successive  strata,  which  he  called  Secondary. 

This  classification  with  modifications  including  notably  the 
introduction  of  a  third  class  of  beds  called  Transition,  and  answer- 
ing largely  to  our  present  Cambrian  and  Siberian  strata,  continued 
in  vogue  until  the  beginning  of  the  present  century,  and  it  was, 
in  fact,  the  only  possible  arrangement  so  long  as  petrographical 
considerations  were  alone  considered  of  importance  in  discriminating 
between  different  rocks,  for  it  was  early  and  easily  seen  that  beds 
of  very  different  chemical  composition  might  graduate  horizontally 
into  each  other,  being  therefore  probably  on  the  same  horizon, 
while  in  other  cases  beds  of  the  same  chemical  composition 
were  clearly  situated  at  different  horizons. 

The  key  to  the  problem  which  finally  unlocked  the  geological 
riddle  was  the  discovery,  not  made  at  one  bound,  but  first  applied 
systematically  by  William  Smith,  namely,  that  different  geological 
horizons  are  marked  by  different  species  of  fossil  remains.  This 
prime  discovery  has,  of  course,  enabled  us   to  map  out  the   long 


322  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [November 

series  of  stratified  rocks  in  a  continuous  chain  and  to  unerringly 
distinguish  any  particular  horizon  in  discussion  by  its  particular 
ear  mark,  namely,  the  special  fauna  and  flora  whose  debris  are 
found  in  it. 

This  I  need  not  say  is  the  corner  stone  of  modern  strati- 
graphical  geology,  and  this,  so  far  as  we  can  see  it,  will  remain. 
I  have  nothing  to  say  about  the  key  which  is  an  absolutely  in- 
dispensable one.  What  I  propose  to  criticise,  however,  is  the 
arrangement  founded  upon  the  facts  thus  ascertained,  and  I 
propose  to  attack  it  in  two  ways  and  on  two  grounds.  If  our 
object  is  to  ascertain  the  past  sequence  of  events  in  any  particular 
spot  on  the  earth's  surface,  we  cannot  do  better  than  make  a  boring 
at  the  particular  spot  and  describe  in  detail  the  successive  beds 
lying  upon  one  another  or  which  we  can  fairly  conclude  once  lay 
upon  one  another  in  that  particular  spot.  This  will  undoubtedly, 
so  far  as  that  spot  is  concerned,  give  us  the  sequence  of  events. 
If  the  record  be  complete  it  will,  of  course,  be  a  complete  story. 
If  some  pages  be  torn  out  of  the  book  it  will,  of  course,  be  in- 
complete. This  we  may  or  we  may  not  be  able  to  infer.  What 
is  clear  is  that  the  column  of  different  strata  thus  pierced  represents 
not  a  general  universal  geological  pedigree,  but  the  geological 
pedigree  of  one  particular  spot  only.  This,  of  course,  is  universally 
admitted.  No  fact  is  more  elementary  than  that  two  wells  dug 
in  the  same  parish  may  present  us  with  very  different  columns 
of  strata.  Some  thin  out,  some  grow  thicker,  some  disappear, 
and  some  make  their  appearance.  The  one  cardinal  fact,  however, 
remains,  that  so  long  as  we  remain  in  the  same  "  Zoological 
Province "  so  long  will  these  beds  when  found  together  be  found 
arranged  in  the  same  order. 

This  being  sj3  it  is  perfectly  justifiable  and  perfectly  logical  so 
long  as  we  remain  in  the  same  zoological  province  to  collect  all  the 
beds  occurring  within  that  province  and  to  arrange  them  in 
sequence,  and  having  done  so  to  make  that  sequence  a  test  and 
touchstone  by  which  the  relative  position  of  any  particular  bed  in 
any  particular  section  may  be  ascertained  ;  always  remembering, 
however,  that  we  do  not  mean  by  this  arrangement  that  the 
sequence  of  events  in  every  spot  within  this  area  was  precisely  the 
same.  In  some  cases  certain  stages  were  possibly  absent  as  the 
record  seems  to  infer,  or  a  particular  stage  in  one  area  may  have 
become  a  complicated  series  in  another.  These  are,  however, 
mutters  of  detail  in  which  we  have  no  necessity  to  guard  ourselves 
since  they  are  obvious  and  simple.  What  it  is  important  to 
remember,  and  what  has  been  made  the  subject  of  adverse  comment 
by  more  than  one  distinguished  palaeontologist,  is  the  fact  that  the 
arrangement  we  have  been  considering  only  holds  good  and  is  alone 


1897]   NEW  SCHEME  OF  GEOLOGICAL  ARRANGEMENT    323 

useful  when  applied  within  one  zoological  province,  and  becomes 
utterly  misleading  when  applied  to  any  other.  Let  me  explain 
what  I  mean.  Zoologists  have  divided  the  land  surfaces  of  the 
earth  into  several  provinces  marked  by  special  faunas.  Of  these 
divisions  that  proposed  by  Mr  Sclater  long  ago,  and  which  was 
founded  mainly  on  the  distribution  of  birds,  is  the  most  popular. 
Each  one  of  these  provinces  is  marked  by  a  special  animal  and 
vegetable  facies.  Similar  provinces  with  a  similar  variation  in 
their  inhabitants  occur  also  beneath  the  sea.  Now  it  is  clear  that 
each  of  these  life  provinces  has  a  special  pedigree  of  its  own.  It 
may  be  that  they  all  converge  eventually  upon  some  common  and 
universal  original,  but  the  various  lines  of  descent  must  have  been 
separate  from  early  geological  times.  How  then  is  it  possible  or  is 
it  profitable  to  attempt  to  measure  and  test  in  any  way  whatever 
the  geological  record  of  one  zoological  province  by  that  of  another  ? 
We  may  eventually  be  able  to  say  what  was  the  character  of  the 
different  zoological  provinces  contemporary  with  different  geological 
horizons  in  our  own  country,  but  this  kind  of  knowledge  will  profit 
us  little.  What  we  want  to  know  is  the  pedigree  of  each  zoological 
province  by  itself,  and  to  keep  that  pedigree  intact  and  separate  and 
unsophisticated  by  any  false  correlations  with  the  pedigrees  of  other 
provinces.  When  I  am  asked  if  a  particular  bed  in  India  is 
Miocene  or  Pliocene,  or  a  particular  bed  in  New  Zealand  is  Tertiary 
or  Quaternary,  etc.,  etc.,  I  cannot  attach  any  useful  meaning  to  the 
question.  If  it  mean  that  the  bed  is  actually  contemporary  with, 
or  that  it  is  homotaxial  with  the  beds  so-called  in  Europe,  the 
question  is  desperately  hard  to  answer  and  of  very  little  use  when 
answered.  If  it  means  that  a  particular  bed  is  the  penultimate  or 
the  ante-penultimate  geological  stage  in  each  area  irrespective  of 
actual  equating  of  periods  and  dates,  it  may  convey  some  meaning 
but  it  is  a  meaning  crossed  and  sophisticated  with  danger  and  with 
doubt.  What  we  want  to  do  if  we  are  to  do  justice  to  the  great 
fact  of  the  continuity  of  life,  is  to  keep  the  two  stories  entirely 
apart,  and  to  do  so  if  possible  by  using  a  nomenclature  which  shall 
not  be  misleading. 

If  then  we  are  to  retain  the  present  geological  nomenclature  and 
arrangement  for  the  beds  of  the  pan- Arctic  or  hoi-Arctic  region  where 
a  common  fauna  now  prevails,  we"  ought  to  apply  an  entirely 
different  nomenclature  to  the  arrangement  of  the  beds  in  the 
Neotropical,  the  South  American,  the  Indo-African,  the  Australian, 
the  Indonesian,  and  the  New  Zealand  provinces.  We  may  then 
indulge  in  theories  and  systems  of  liomotaxis  without  any  danger, 
and  we  shall  always  be  sure  that  we  are  measuring  the  horizon  we 
are  dealing  with  by  a  fixed  and  not  by  an  unstable  barometer. 
This  is  the  first  parable  I  wish  to  preach. 


324  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [November 

Secondly.  In  the  last  sentence  I  commenced  with  a  very  large 
"  If  "  because  I  am  afraid  my  heretical  perversity  carries  me  a  good 
deal  further  than  I  have  yet  dared  to  admit. 

Before  Herbert  Spencer  held  up  his  great  lamp  and  bade  us  see 
in  animal  and  vegetable  life  not  a  discrete  collection  of  disintegrated 
units  but  a  continuous  unbroken  chain,  it  was  prudent  and  wise 
perhaps  to  be  content  with  an  arrangement  of  the  stratified  beds 
marked  by  no  other  law  or  rule  than  their  mere  order  of  super- 
position in  any  particular  place.  This  will  no  longer  content  us. 
We  want  to  know  a  great  deal  more  than  this.  We  want  to  know 
what  was  the  route  and  road  by  which  a  particular  fauna  and  flora 
came  to  occupy  a  particular  zoological  or  botanical  province, 
and  what  were  the  stages  of  its  growth  and  development.  For 
this  supreme  purpose  we  must  go  further  afield  than  merely 
examine  the  column  of  strata  existing  in  any  particular  place.  A 
very  cursory  examination  at  once  shows  us  that  in  every  such 
column  marine  beds  are  intercalated  with  sub-aerial  beds,  and  no 
ingenuity  can  possibly  derive  the  fauna  of  the  land  from  that  of 
the  sea  and  vice  versd  by  successive  jumps  and  starts.  They  have 
absolutely  nothing  to  do  with  each  other,  and  if  our  purpose  is  not 
merely  to  calendar  the  revolutions  of  land  and  sea  which  have 
occurred  in  a  particular  place,  but  to  trace  out  the  history  of  the 
particular  fauna  occupying  a  particular  province,  either  of  the  land 
or  of  the  sea,  and  thus  to  track  the  continuous  history  of  each  of 
these  divergent  portions  of  the  earth's  surface  along  lines  of  con- 
tinuity and  growth,  we  must  absolutely  discard  our  present  method 
of  geological  arrangement  and  nomenclature  for  a  very  different  one. 
In  the  first  place  (and  the  change  is  so  obvious  that  it  has  always 
seemed  to  me  a  paradox  that  it  was  not  made  long  ago)  we  must 
absolutely  separate  the  marine  beds  from  the  sub-aerial  ones,  put 
them  into  two  entirely  different  columns  and  perhaps  give  them 
entirely  different  names.  To  apply  the  term  Pliocene  to  the  marine 
beds  marked  by  the  Norwich  or  the  Weybourn  Crag  and  to  apply  it 
also  to  the  sub-aerial  beds  known  as  the  Forest  bed,  is  not  an  illumin- 
ating but  a  darkening  process.  These  two  sets  of  beds  may  have 
been  contemporary  but  they  have  no  other  element  in  common,  and 
it  is  utterly  misleading  to  give  them  a  common  name  because  the 
marine  and  land  debris  are  sometimes  mixed  as  in  the  Norwich 
Crag  just  as  Ammonites  and  Mammoths  both  may  be  mixed  with 
striated  boulders  in  the  soft  beds  on  the  coast  of  Holderness.  If  we 
are  to  retain  our  present  geological  nomenclature  for  the  pan-arctic 
region  we  must  qualify  each  name  by  a  distinctive  epithet  showing 
whether  the  bed  we  mean  is  in  the  marine  or  the  sub-aerial  series. 

Again,  we  continually  read  in  geological  books  of  unconform- 
ability,  an  excellent  term  expressing  a  very  patent  fact  when  we 


1897]  NEW  SCHEME  OF  GEOLOGICAL  ARRANGEMENT    325 

are  dealing  with  what  1  would  call  parochial  geology,  but  a  term 
which  ought  to  have  no  place  in  a  general  scheme  in  which  the 
progressive  history  of  a  life  province  is  to  he  illustrated.  If  there 
is  a  hiatus  and  a  gap  here,  it  must  be  in  the  evidence  and  not  in  the 
actual  story.  It  is  the  imperfection  of  the  geological  record  and  not 
the  occurrence  of  a  real  unconformabilitv  in  two  successive  stages 
of  the  history  of  a  life-province  which  is  the  infirmity  of  our 
inquiry,  and  we  disguise  and  distort  the  picture  utterly  by  painting 
it  as  we  do. 

The  ideal  arrangement  of  our  beds  ought  to  correspond  with  their 
history  in  time  as  marked,  not  by  their  accidental  sequence  in  any 
particular  spot,  but  by  the  successive  phases  of  their  life  contents. 
The  land  surface  of  the  Palaearctic  zoological  province  of  to-day 
must  have  been  in  geographical  contact  and  continuity  with  a  corre- 
sponding land  surface  yesterday,  and  so  on  to  the  beginning  of  time. 

A  succession  of  land  bridges  must  have  connected  the  present 
land  surfaces  with  those  of  the  primitive  world  by  a  perfectly  un- 
broken chain,  unless  we  postulate  the  complete  periodic  destruction 
of  land  faunas  and  their  re-creation ;  and  similarly  with  the  marine 
faunas.  This  being  so,  unconformability  and  break  ought  to  entirely 
disappear  from  our  series.  If  we  find  signs  that  a  marine  sub- 
mergence intervened  between  two  stages  of  sub-aerial  history  of 
some  locality  and  caused  a  breach  between  them,  we  must,  neverthe- 
less, conclude  that  these  two  stages  were  connected  geographically 
at  some  point  or  points  by  a  third  one  affording  us  the  intermediate 
chapter,  and  it  is  along  these  bridges  that  we  ought  distinctly  to 
travel.  This  seems  to  me  to  open  up  an  entirely  different  mode  of 
arranging  and  studying  our  beds  to  that  usually  current  in  text- 
books, one  more  consonant  with  modern  zoological  and  palaeontologi- 
cal  notions. 

Our  first  step,  as  I  have  said,  is  to  entirely  separate  the  sub- 
marine and  the  sub-aerial  beds  from  one  another,  and  to  range  them 
in  two  series.  Secondly,  to  arrange  the  beds,  not  according  to  their 
vertical  distribution  in  one  or  more  spots,  but  according  to  their  con- 
tinuity in  regard  to  conditions  of  deposition.  This  will  lead  us  along 
some  unexpected  and  some  not  infertile  lines  of  inquiry.  Once  we 
grasp  this  notion  we  shall  cease  to  attach  much,  if  any,  value  to  the 
accepted  generic  terms  of  stratigraphical  geology — the  primary, 
secondary,  tertiary  beds,  etc.  In  our  own  country,  no  doubt,  the 
beds  are  separated  by  great  gaps,  represented  fairly  by  their  names, 
and  if  we  are  studying  English  geology  only,  the  nomenclature  and 
classification  are  justified ;  but  these  gaps  cannot  have  existed  every- 
where, unless  we  are  to  reverse  all  our  modern  teaching.  The  story 
of  biological  development  must  have  been  quite  continuous,  and  the 
book  in  which  it  was  recorded  must  have  contained  a  continuous 


326  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [November 

series  of  pages,  imseparated  by  gaps,  dislocations,  and  unconforma- 
bilities,  and  this  in  the  marine  series  just  as  much  as  in  the  sub- 
aerial  series. 

There  are  two  initial  lessons,  then,  I  wish  to  press  home  before 
I  venture  on  to  more  concrete  lessons,  namely : — 1.  That  our  pre- 
sent system  of  geological  arrangement  and  nomenclature  is  only 
adapted  to  the  purely  local  sequence  of  facts  and  history  of  the  beds 
of  Western  Europe,  and  not  to  the  whole  world.  2.  That  we 
ought  to  arrange  our  beds  on  a  universal  and  ideal  system  in  two 
perfectly  continuous  series,  one  marine  and  one  sub-aerial,  marked 
not  by  their  superposition  in  any  one  spot,  but  by  the  successive 
changes  in  the  biological  history  of  the  world,  and  by  no  other  test. 

Henry  H.   Howorth. 


571.1  327 


IV 
The  Authenticity  of  Plateau  Man 

THE  antiquity  of  man  and  the  locality  of  his  birthplace  are 
problems  of  perennial  interest,  to  which  Sir  John  Evans' 
address  to  the  British  Association  has  again  directed  general 
attention.  Sir  John  Evan's  emphatic  dismissal  of  all  the  evidence 
yet  advanced  in  favour  of  the  existence  of  man  earlier  than  the  date 
of  the  Palaeolithic  gravels  will  no  doubt  arouse  controversy,  espe- 
cially as  in  the  time  at  his  disposal  he  could  give  only  a  passing 
reference  to  any  single  case,  and  not  state  the  grounds  of  his  dis- 
trust. As  I  have  during  the  past  year  given  careful  attention  to  the 
asserted  '  Eolithic  '  implements  found  in  the  high  plateau  gravels 
near  Sevenoaks,  with  the  result  that  I  have  had  to  abandon  my 
first  belief  in  their  human  origin,  it  may  be  of  interest  if  I  state 
the  reasons  for  my  change  of  opinion. 

The  implements  come  from  the  deposits  described  by  my  late 
friend  Sir  Joseph  Prestwich  in  an  important  paper  published  by  the 
Geological  Society  in  1891.  The  chipped  flints  themselves  were 
described  by  Prestwich  in  a  paper  read  to  the  Anthropological 
Institute  a  year  later.  Further  descriptions  have  been  given  by 
their  original  discoverer,  Mr  Benjamin  Harrison  of  Ightham,  by 
Professor  T.  Kupert  Jones,  Mr  Lewis  Abbott,  and  other  writers. 
Some  geologists  objected  to  the  idea  that  the  plateau  flints  had  been 
worked  by  man  at  the  time  of  their  first  description ;  but  the  drift 
of  expressed  opinion  has  been  lately  rather  in  their  favour. 

Early  in  1896  I  visited  Ightham,  and  Mr  Harrison  kindly 
showed  me  the  great  collection  of  chipped  plateau  flints  which  he 
has  formed  during  the  past  thirty  or  forty  years  with  an  inde- 
fatigable perseverance  that  has  excited  the  admiration  of  every 
student  of  archaeology.  As  Mr  Harrison's  specimens  lay  side  by 
side  there  appeared  a  remarkable  recurrence  of  the  same  external 
form.  This  fact  led  me  to  accept  the  conclusion  that  the  specimens 
had  been  shaped  by  man,  but  a  more  searching  examination 
necessitated  the  abandonment  of  this  opinion,  as  the  flints  them- 
selves tell  me  quite  a  different  story. 

Let  us  first  examine  the  flints  and  see  what  traces  they  show  of 
the  natural  agencies  that  have  acted  upon  them. 

The  flints  occur  as  a  gravel  on  the  surface  of  the  chalk  plateau, 


328  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [November 

or  on  the  upper  part  of  the  escarpment  face.  That  the  flints  have 
been  derived  from  the  chalk  is  unquestioned,  and  the  process  by 
which  they  were  removed  from  it  need  not  be  considered.  During 
the  first  stage  of  the  life  history  of  the  independent  flints  they  were 
split  into  slabs  or  tablets,  most  of  which  have  one  flat  side,  and  one 
showing  the  original  external  surface.  Some  of  the  flint  slabs  were 
flat  on  both  sides,  and  they  are  often  six  or  eight  inches  in  length. 
The  formation  of  these  flint  slabs  was  probably  due  to  extreme  cold, 
as  many  of  the  fractured  surfaces  resemble  those  of  frost-flakes. 
Then  a  siliceous  encrustation  was  deposited  over  the  flint.  The 
next  process — leaving  the  chipping  of  the  edges  out  of  considera- 
tion for  the  present — was  the  staining  of  the  flints  to  a  red  or 
reddish  brown  colour.  The  staining  was  no  doubt  due  to  the  action 
of  ferruginous  solutions.  The  iron  may  have  been  derived  from 
beds  of  iron  sand  in  which  the  flints  were  once  embedded,  as  grains 
of  dark  ferruginous  sand  are  found  still  adhering  to  the  flints  in  the 
hollows  of  chipped  surfaces.  Subsequently  to  the  staining,  the 
flints  were  scratched  by  some  glacial  agent.  The  striae  are  very 
abundant,  and  closely  resemble  those  produced  by  ordinary  glacial 
action.  They  were  no  doubt  caused  by  the  movement  of  pointed 
flints  across  the  flat  surfaces  of  other  flints  under  considerable 
pressure.  The  movement  of  frozen  masses  of  gravel  might  produce 
these  scratches  as  well  as  the  flow  of  dirt-laden  ice,  so  that  it  is 
perhaps  unnecessary  to  assume  the  existence  of  true  glaciers  in  Kent 
on  the  evidence  of  these  scratched  flints  alone. 

The  next  change  in  the  flints  was  the  deposition  over  them  of  a 
thin  layer  of  silex,  which  covers  most  of  the  chipped  surfaces,  and 
often  fills  up  the  scratches.  The  silica  occurs  in  two  varieties,  one 
brown  and  often  very  fibrous,  and  the  other  white.  They  may  have 
been  deposited  at  different  dates.  The  material  is  a  variety  of 
chalcedony,  sometimes  having  the  characteristic  botryoidal  form  of 
that  mineral. 

The  nature  of  this  siliceous  encrustation  is  not  yet  completely 
understood,  but  it  must  have  been  deposited  by  some  siliceous 
solution  similar  to  that  which  has  often  re-cemented  shattered  flints. 
There  is,  for  example,  in  the  Devizes  Museum  a  flint  that  has 
been  broken  into  countless  fragments,  many  of  which  are  as  fine  as 
grains  of  sand ;  but  they  are  all  united  by  a  chalcedonic  infiltration 
into  a  mass  sufficiently  solid  to  bear  a  high  polish.  The  occurrence 
in  situ  of  flints  which  have  been  similarly  crushed  and  re-cemented 
has  been  recorded  by  Englefield  and  Mantell. 

One  feature  that  renders  this  siliceous  encrustation  the  more 
interesting  is  that  it  was  sometimes  deposited  later  than  one  set  of 
glacial  scratches  and  earlier  than  another  set. 

The  last  process  which  the  plateau  flints  have  undergone  is  a 


NATURAL  SCIENCE,   VOL.  XL 


Plate  IX. 


So-called  Flint  Implements  from  the  Plateau  Gravel  of  Kent. 


1897]         THE  AUTHENTICITY  OF  PLATEAU  MAN       :'»29 

certain  amount  of  polishing  by  the  action  of  blown  sands.  Some- 
times the  whole  surface  of  the  flint  has  been  thus  polished,  but 
specimens  often  occur  in  which  the  action  has  been  limited  to  one 
side.  Many  of  the  flints  of  the  Thames  gravels,  as,  for  example,  at 
Clapham,  show  the  same  feature.  In  the  cases  of  these  low  level 
gravels,  the  polishing  was  probably  effected  at  a  time  of  drought, 
when  the  pebbles  were  exposed  and  the  river  sand  was  dry  and  loose. 

We  therefore  see  that  these  plateau  flints  have  been  subjected 
to  six  different  processes,  all  of  which  are  undoubtedly  natural,  and 
each  of  which  has  left  clearly  recognisable  traces.  Taken  in  order 
of  date,  the  processes  are  : — 1st,  splitting  of  the  original  flints  into 
slabs,  probably  by  frost ;  2nd,  a  deposition  of  a  siliceous  encrusta- 
tion ;  3rd,  iron  staining ;  4th,  scratching  by  some  glacial  agent ; 
5th,  deposition  of  a  second  siliceous  encrustation ;  6th,  polishing  by 
blown  sand. 

This  series  forms  a  chronological  table  by  which  we  can 
determine  the  relative  dates  of  the  various  chippings  of  the  flints 
which  are  affirmed  to  be  the  work  of  man.  I  think  it  is  quite  clear 
from  the  evidence  of  the  flints  that  natural  agencies  are  sufficient  to 
account  for  every  splinter  and  scratch  that  they  exhibit. 

The  first  fact  that  tells  against  the  artificial  chipping  of  the 
flints  is  that  the  chipping  is  of  very  different  dates.  The  process 
must  have  been  continued  for  a  considerable  length  of  time.  It  is 
not  difficult  to  distinguish  between  the  chippings  of  different  periods. 
The  earliest  fractures  are  the  largest,  as  might  be  expected,  since  the 
conditions  were  the  most  rigorous.  As  the  climate  became  milder 
the  forces  that  acted  on  the  flints  became  feebler,  and  the  chips 
removed  were  therefore  smaller.  On  some  specimens  it  is  possible 
to  detect  chippings  of  three  different  periods.  The  first  set  were 
struck  off  before  the  flints  were  coloured  red  ;  the  second  set  broke 
acrpss  the  margins  of  the  first,  and  sometimes  exposed  part  of  the 
uncoloured  flint  below.  Then  came  an  interval  during  which  the 
glacial  scratches  were  made.  These  scratches  cut  across  the  surfaces 
formed  by  the  first  two  sets  of  chippings.  The  fractures  of  the  third 
set,  on  the  other  hand,  are  never  scratched,  but  have  themselves  cut 
across  the  striae.  These  latest  chips  were  small,  and  usually  more 
distinctly  conchoidal  than  the  others,  and  in  many  instances  they 
present  the  appearance  of  small  frost-flakes. 

As  definite  illustrations  of  the  different  dates  of  the  chippings, 
let  us  examine  in  detail  four  flints  which  were  given  to  me  by  Mr 
Harrison  as  fairly  good  implements  (Plate  IX.). 

The  first  is  shewn  in  Fig.  1  of  the  Plate.1  It  was  found  by  Mr 
Harrison  at  South  Ash,  and  is  numbered  4997.      Its  size  is  6  cm. 

1  For  the  photographs  I  must  express  my  indebtedness  to  Mr  T.   H.  Powell  of 
Denmark  Hill. 


330  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [November 

long  by  5  cm.  wide.  One  surface  is  flat  and  smooth,  while  the 
other  is  convex  and  rough,  as  about  one-fourth  of  it  is  part  of  the 
original  surface  of  the  flint.  From  the  convex  side  two  large  flakes 
have  been  forced  off,  probably  by  frost,  and  no  doubt  at  about  the 
same  time  as  the  formation  of  the  flat  face.  Both  sides  of  the  flint 
are  scratched.  After  the  scratching  a  thin  coating  of  white  silica 
was  deposited  over  the  two  large-flaked  surfaces,  filling  up  some  of 
the  scratches.  And  after  this  a  second  set  of  scratches  has  cut 
across  the  siliceous  encrustation. 

The  history  of  the  chipping  of  this  specimen  is  as  follows  : — The 
curve  at  a  is  the  result  of  natural  forces  acting  on  the  thin  edges  of 
a  natural  hollow  of  the  flint  :  the  hollow  retains  the  original  surface, 
except  at  the  edge,  where  three  or  four  small  chips  have  been  forced 
off  at  a  period  later  than  the  flaking.  The  single  chip  at  b  has 
been  forced  off  from  the  other  side  of  the  flint,  and  probably  dates 
from  about  the  same  period  as  the  chips  of  the  a  series. 

The  almost  straight  side  of  the  specimen  (c)  was  formed  by 
chipping  at  a  much  earlier  period,  before  the  stone  was  stained  red, 
but  later  than  the  large  frost  flakes. 

This  specimen  therefore  exhibits  surfaces  of  four  distinct  dates — 

1.  The  original  surface  of  the  flint. 

2.  The  flat  side  and  the  two  large  frost  flakes. 

3.  The  chippings  on  the  straight  edge  before  the  iron- 
staining. 

4.  The  chippings  at  a  and  b  subsequent  to  the  iron -staining. 
No.  4390.  A  flint  from  Branshatch  (Fig.  2)  14  cm.  long  by  8  cm. 

wide.  This  specimen  has  the  original  rough  surface  of  the  flint  on 
one  face  and  a  flat  frost-flaked  surface ;  both  have  been  encrusted 
by  silex.  The  specimen  is  much  chipped.  The  chips  have  been 
forced  off  by  pressure  mostly  from  the  flat  side,  but  at  the  larger  end 
the  chipping  was  done  from  both  sides,  forming  a  slight  irregular 
ridge.  The  significant  point  about  this  specimen  is  that  most  of  the 
chipping  occurred  subsequent  to  the  dark  staining  of  the  flint. 

No.  2711.  A  tablet  of  very  dark-red  flint  from  Rogersfield,  near 
Ightham,  measuring  15  cm.  by  9*5  cm.  This  slab  of  flint  was  also 
chipped  before  the  date  of  the  staining,  and  also  shews  chipping  by 
pressure  from  opposite  sides.  The  chips  are  of  different  dates  ;  the 
first  and  second  sets  are  scratched,  and  the  third  set  are  insignificant 
and  irrelevant  to  the  main  chipping.  The  whole  surface  is  encrusted 
by  silica  except  where  it  chipped. 

No.  Pit  VI.  A  triangular  slab  of  flint  (Fig.  3)  probably  flaked  from 
a  large  block  by  frost.  The  original  surface  occurs  on  the  convex  side 
and  extends  over  a  third  of  the  edge  marked  a.  Ancient  chippings 
from  opposite  sides  occupy  the  edges  d,  and  some  of  about  the  same 
date  occur  along  b.      These  chips   were  all  earlier  than  the  iron- 


1897]         THE  AUTHENTICITY  OF  PLATEAU  MAN       331 

staining.  The  whole  of  the  original  surface  is  scratched,  and  the 
scratches  sometimes  extend  over  the  edges  and  also  cut  across  the 
surfaces  left  by  the  chips  previously  referred  to.  A  dark  brown,  in 
parts  fibrous,  incrustation  of  silex  thickly  covers  the  original  surface 
of  this  specimen.  This  was  succeeded,  after  the  glacial  scratching, 
by  a  deposit  of  white  silex  filling  up  the  hollows  and  scratches ;  the 
whole  has  been  subsequently  smoothed  down  and  polished  by  blown 
sand.  This  specimen  was  dug  from  one  of  the  pits  in  the  Plateau 
gravel  in  1890". 

These  four  specimens  illustrate  the  main  process  which  the  flints 
have  undergone.  They  show  that  the  drippings  were  not  all  formed 
at  one  period,  a  fact  which  it  seems  to  me  is  quite  inconsistent  with 
the  theory  that  they  were  artificially  shaped  by  man.  The  objection 
seems  especially  convincing  as,  according  to  the  advocates  of  that 
theory,  all  the  shaping  must  have  been  done  before  the  flints  were 
imbedded  in  the  gravel  in  which  they  now  occur.  If  the  flints  were 
worked,  used,  and  then  thrown  down  again,  we  should  expect  to  find 
them  widely  scattered  over  the  surface  as  is  the  case  with  palaeo- 
lithic and  neolithic  implements.  What  possible  agency  could  have 
picked  them  all  off  the  surface  and  collected  them  together  into  this 
gravel  bed  ?  Further,  we  are  told  that  the  shaping  and  working  of 
the  flints  by  man  "  had  taken  place  before  the  flint  entered  into  the 
remarkable  deposit  which  so  altered  the  surface  of  the  stone,  and 
changed  its  colour  into  that  characteristic  dark-brown."  *  So  accord- 
ing to  the  theory,  the  flints  were  first  chipped  into  shape,  and  then 
carried  into  the  plateau  gravel.  They  were  coloured  subsequently, 
and  the  deposition  of  the  siliceous  encrustations,  the  glacial  scratching, 
and  the  sand  polishing  all  took  place  while  the  flints  were  in  the 
gravel  in  which  they  now  lie. 

Another  objection  to  the  human  working  of  these  flints  is  the 
uselessness  of  the  shapes  into  which  they  have  been  made.  Flints 
often  break  naturally  into  a  triangular  form,  and  as  the  chipping 
has  mainly  acted  on  thin  edges,  abundant  examples  of  pointed  forms 
are  found.  Some  of  these  resemble  in  outline  the  implements  of 
later  dates,  but  all  the  details  of  the  flaking  are  different.  Less 
importance  is  apparently  placed  on  these  triangular  flints  than  on 
those  with  concave  edges,  which  are  supposed  to  have  been  used 
as  flesh-scrapers.  Some  of  the  South  Sea  Islanders  have,  it  is  true, 
been  observed  scraping  their  limbs  with  stones ;  but  we  can  hardly 
suppose  that  such  vast  numbers  of  these  concave  flints  would  have 
been  required  by  the  plateau  folk  for  this  purpose,  especially  as  they 
would  never  wear  out,  and  one  would  last  for  an  indefinite  time. 

The  chipping  in  some  cases  has  not  only  been  useless,  but  has 
even  spoilt  stones  that  might  otherwise  have  been  useful.      Some  of 

1  Nat.  Set.,  April  1894,  p.  259. 


332  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [November 

the  specimens  with  sharp  concave  edges  would  have  served  a 
better  purpose  as  scrapers  if  left  as  nature  had  shaped  them.  The 
irregular  chippings  on  the  edges  of  the  natural  curves  has  spoilt 
them  as  tools. 

The  vast  number  of  the  '  flint  implements '  from  the  plateau 
gravels  is  another  difficulty  in  the  supposition  that  they  have  been 
made  by  man.  The  '  implements  '  occur  in  an  abundance  described 
as  '  marvellous '  by  their  discoverers.  We  are  told  that  two  pits, 
dug  in  1894  into  a  bed  of  gravel  one  foot  in  thickness,  yielded 
thousands  of  artificial  flakes  and  some  hundreds  of  hollow-notched 
and  horseshoe-shaped  scrapers.  The  pits  dug  in  180*6  in  the  same 
beds  have  yielded  a  similar  profusion.  Such  results  are  indeed 
startling.  Plateau  man  must  have  been  a  very  prolific  race,  for  his 
implements,  almost  all  of  one  hollow-scraper  type,  far  outnumber 
those  of  his  palaeolithic  successors. 

In  ordinary  palaeolithic  gravels  the  proportion  of  implements  to 
pebbles  is  extremely  small,  and  there  is  no  difficulty  in  drawing  a 
line  between  artificially  and  naturally  shaped  flints.  But  on  the 
chalk  plateau  the  stained  flints  are  all  more  or  less  chipped.  There 
are  millions  of  flints  on  the  plateaux,  and  it  is  therefore  not  sur- 
prising that  a  large  number  occur  in  which  the  shape  resembles 
that  of  palaeolithic  implements.  But  no  distinctive  line  can  be 
drawn  between  flints  which  are  described  as  '  good  implements ' 
and  others  which  are  admittedly  only  naturally  broken. 

But  if  the  chipping  be  not  the  work  of  man,  what  agency,  it 
will  be  asked,  could  have  produced  it.  Careful  examination  of  the 
chipped  flints  soon  suggests  suspicious  features.  In  the  first  place 
the  chipping  is  limited  to  the  edges  of  the  slabs ;  there  are  no 
known  instances  in  which  the  flint  has  been  artificiallv  flaked  into 
the  form  of  the  weapon  ;  the  asserted  human  workmanship  is  limited 
to  chipping  of  the  edges  of  naturally-shaped  flints. 

Mr  Harrison  maintains  that  the  chips  were  forced  off  by  an 
agent  which  worked  only  from  one  face  of  the  flint  slab.1  He 
regards  this  feature  as  an  argument  in  favour  of  the  artificial  nature 
of  the  chipping.  Why  eolithic  man  should  have  worked  only  on 
one  surface  of  the  stone  is  not  explained.  But.  it  is  really  rare  to 
find  an  example  that  was  chipped  on  one  side  only.  Palaeolithic 
man  certainly  never  allowed  the  utility  of  his  tools  to  be  limited  by 
any  such  restriction. 

The  chipping  was  evidently  due  to  some  pressure  which  acted 
more  or  less  at  right  angles  to  the  flat  surface  of  the  flint  slab. 
The  pressure  and  crushing  that  take  place  during  movements  of 
frozen  gravel  would,  it  seems  to  me,  be  quite  sufficient  to  account 
for  all  the  chipping.  Pebbles  in  the  gravel  would  be  pressed 
1  Proc.  Geol.  Assoc,  November  1893,  vol.  xiii.  p.  162. 


1897]         THE  AUTHENTICITY  OF  PLATEAU  MAN       333 

against  the  upper  edges  of  the  flint  slabs  and  force  off  small  flakes. 
Then  if  the  flint  slab  be  moved  and  inverted,  renewed  pressure 
would  similarly  crush  the  other  edge,  and  thus  account  for  the  cases 
in  which  both  edges  have  been  chipped. 

A  fact  which  seems  to  me  conclusive  proof  that  the  chipping 
was  due  to  pressure  by  some  yielding  material  from  above  is  sup- 
plied by  hollow  flints.  The  decay  of  a  sponge  often  leaves  a  hollow 
in  the  middle  of  a  flint  block  ;  the  edges  of  such  hollows  in  plateau 
flints  are  chipped  in  precisely  the  same  way  as  the  edges.  The  arti- 
ficial chipping  of  such  edges  by  blows  from  another  stone  would  be 
difficult,  and  the  work  would  have  been  absolutely  wasted  to  eolithic 
man.  But  the  forcing  of  the  finer  constituents  of  the  gravel  across 
the  hollows  under  the  pressure  from  overlying  material  might  easily 
have  produced  these  crushed  and  apparently  worked  edges. 

The  view  that  the  plateau  flints  show  no  sign  of  human  work- 
manship I  am  glad  to  find  supported  by  the  high  authority  of  Sir 
John  Evans,  who,  in  a  letter  of  April  1896,  said:  "  I  see  nothing 
upon  them  that  is  undoubtedly  the  result  of  human  work  or  use ; 
on  the  contrary,  the  rolling  and  wearing  of  the  edges  seem  to  me 
more  probably  caused  by  natural  agencies — I  see  nothing  but  the 
hand  of  nature  upon  them."  After  a  careful  study  of  specimens 
lately  selected  as  the  most  convincing  by  Mr  Harrison  himself,  I 
am  in  absolute  agreement  with  this  opinion.  And  as  the  chipping 
of  the  flints  was  apparently  caused  by  the  action  of  extreme  cold 
upon  the  gravels,  movements  in  which  were  produced  by  the  action 
of  ice,  I  propose  for  these  shaped  flints  the  name  of  '  Glacioliths.' 

Wm.  Cunnington. 


571.1  334 


V 

Evidence  of  the  Antiquity  of  Man  in  East  London, 
Cape  Colony ;  with  a  Note  on  the  Castor-Oil 
Plant.1 

ABOUT  the  year  1857,  in  opening  up  a  quarry  on  the  left  bank 
of  the  Quigney  Biver,  at  its  junction  with  the  Buffalo,  a  shell 
mound  was  discovered,  forming  a  rounded  bluff  roughly  measuring  150 
by  150  by  40  feet  deep.  The  mound  was  clothed  by  18  inches  of 
made  soil,  masked  by  vegetable  growth  on  the  surface,  and  con- 
tained abundance  of  shells  of  recent  mollusca  {Patella,  Mytilus, 
Ostrea,  Haliotis,  etc.),  with  bones  of  fish,  birds,  antelopes,  hippopo- 
tami, and  other  mammalia,  layers  of  ash,  fragments  of  charcoal,  and 
pieces  of  coarse  pottery.  No  other  implement  of  any  kind  was 
found,  but  burnt  stones  were  very  common ;  most  of  the  deposit  was 
removed  to  fill  up  a  lagoon  behind  the  East  Training  Wall  of  the 
Buffalo  Biver. 

The  locality  had  remained  unaltered  since  1827,  for  in  1867 
the  writer  accompanied  the  Rev.  W.  B.  Thomson  on  a  visit 
there,  and  heard  him  say  that  the  spot  was  quite  unchanged.  The 
same  trees  and  the  same  track  remained,  and  but  for  the  impedi- 
ment caused  by  the  construction  of  the  West  Training  Wall  of  the 
river  Mr  Thomson  would  have  undertaken  to  drive  a  bullock  waggon 
along  the  same  track  as  he  had  done  in  1827.  This  track,  it  may 
be  of  interest  to  mention,  ran  in  a  straight  line  from  where  Mr  A. 
Webb's  house  now  stands,  to  the  right  bank  of  the  Quigney  at  its 
mouth  ;  then  skirting  the  mound,  it  proceeded  for  one  hundred  yards 
along  the  Buffalo  Biver  towards  the  mouth,  and  from  thence  on  the 
east  bank  it  crossed  the  river  diagonally  to  the  ravine  at  the  large 
quarry  on  the  west  bank. 

So  far  as  is  known  this  kitchen-midden  is  the  most  recent  trace 
of  primitive  man  at  East  London,  and  yet  must  be  in  itself  of  vast 
antiquity. 

Passing  to  the  back  of  the  new  jail  one  sees  a  small  excavation 
in  the  railway  cutting,  which  in  1887  was  covered  with  castor-oil 

[l  The  following  personal  observations  by  Mr  Geo.  R.  M'Kay,  relative  to  discoveries  of 
ancient  man  in  East  London,  have  been  forwarded  to  the  editor  by  Dr  Schiinland. 
They  formed  part  of  a  lecture  delivered  in  1887,  and  the  editor  is  glad  to  put  them  on 
record.] 


1897]  ANTIQUITY  OF  MAN  IN  CAPE  COLONY  335 

plants.1  This  was  dug  out  for  material  to  construct  the  railway 
embankment  close  by,  and  when  undisturbed  was  clothed  with  the 
ordinary  dense  bush  of  the  district.  The  section  showed  from  above 
downwards  4  to  5  feet  of  stiff'  clay  overlying  a  foot  of  rolled  gravel, 
the  gravel  resting  on  decomposed  rock.  The  gravel  had  all  the 
appearance  of  shot  of  all  sizes,  from  buckshot  downwards.  A  little 
above  the  gravel  a  large  number  of  Hint  implements  were  found,  the 
bulk  of  which  appeared  to  be  "rubbers"  possibly  used  for  dressing 
skins  or  similar  purposes.  There  were  a  few  spear  heads,  some 
fragments  of  coarse  pottery,  and  a  few  limpets. 

This  excavation  is  forty  feet  above  the  present  level  of  the 
Quignev,  and  the  gravel  probably  belongs  to  that  river;  the  clay  is 
assumed  to  be  the  accumulated  wash  from  higher  levels.  The 
place  appears  to  have  been  a  workshop,  for  its  position  would  afford 
the  warmth  of  the  morning  sun  with  the  coolness  of  shade  in  the 
afternoon. 

On  the  north  bank  of  the  Buffalo,  about  twenty  chains  from  the 
river,  and  just  W.  of  the  road  to  the  Pontoon,  is  the  residence  of 
Mr  Gately.  The  house  and  grounds  stand  on  the  rounded  top  of 
an  isolated  knoll,  which  is  connected  with  East  London  East  by  a 
narrow  neck  of  land.  This  neck  is  the  watershed  of  two  small 
water  courses  which  unite  at  the  S.  of  the  knoll,  and  run  S.W. 
into  '  1st  creek.'  On  the  top  of  the  knoll  there  are  from  2  to 
3  feet  of  black  mud,  separated  from  the  base  rock  by  1  to  2 
feet  of  decomposed  rock.  The  black  mud  is  again  seen  to  the  E. 
of  the  road  to  the  Pontoon.  In  this  black  mud  on  the- knoll  Mr 
Gately  has  found  round  pierced  stones,  stone  flakes,  spear  heads, 
coarse  pottery,  and  teeth  and  bones  of  hippopotamus.  The  de- 
position of  this  black  mud  was  contemporaneous  with  the  two  water 
courses  when  they  were  at  a  level  with  the  top  of  the  knoll. 

Fringing  the  whole  of  the  south-eastern  coast  of  South  Africa 
there  occurs  in  detached  patches  a  peculiar  wind-stratified  calcareous 
sandstone.  Cove  Rock  and  Bats'  Cave  at  East  London,  the  '  bluff ' 
at  Natal,  and  the  Sisters  and  Fountain  rocks  near  the  Fish  and 
Kowie  rivers,  are  conspicuous  examples  of  the  formation.  At  Cove 
Bock  and  Bats'  Cave  it  abounds  in  fossils,  especially  at  the  latter. 
These  consist  of  land  and  sea  shells,  mammalian  bones,  chiefly 
ruminants,  and  teeth  of  hippopotamus,  with  remains  of  fishes, 
apparently  all  of  recent  species.  The  rude  and  shifting  nature 
of  the  stratification  leaves  no  doubt  that  this  is  an  aeolian  formation, 
and  comparable  to  that  of  the  adjoining  sandhills. 

1  An  idea  is  prevalent  that  the  castor-oil  plant  might  be  profitably  grown  as  a  pro- 
ducer of  a  cheap  lubricant.  My  own  experience  is,  that  it  flourishes  only  where  rivers 
have  cut  deeply  into  their  banks  and  exposed  deeply  seated  soils,  or  where  deep  cuttings 
are  made,  or  around  the  f  arth -holes  of  the  porcupine  and  ant  bear.  It  springs  up  on 
this  new  soil  with  amazing  rapidity,  and  crowds  out  every  other  plant  ;  but  something 
ails  it,  as  after  a  few  years,  whether  cultivated  or  not,  it  dies  down  and  disappears. 


336  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [November 

Out  of  this  deposit  I  have  myself  taken  three  well-formed  stone 
spear  heads  of  the  '  Moustier '  type.  They  were  at  the  level  of  low 
water,  and  in  a  position  where  they  must  have  at  one  time  been 
covered  by  180  feet  of  the  deposit.  One  of  these  is  still  in  my 
possession,  one  is  in  the  Albany  Museum,  and  the  third  was  given 
to  a  friend,  who  subsequently  sent  it  to  Sir  John  Lubbock.  These 
aeolian  deposits  extend,  so  far  as  my  own  observations  go,  to  a  dis- 
tance of  certainly  one  mile  into  the  ocean  from  the  present  shore. 
Between  Sand  Hill  and  Bats'  Cave  the  low  water  platform  has  been 
cut  back  in  many  places  for  a  width  of  over  200  yards  by  wave 
action.  A  visit  to  Cove  Rock  on  a  calm  day  will  verify  this  if  one 
stands  on  the  larger  of  the  two  masses  forming  the  rock-face  on  the 
south,  for  there  one  will  see  a  similar  platform,  only  at  a  much 
lower  level,  extending  as  far  as  the  eye  can  follow  it.  The  sub- 
merged reef  off  Nahoon  Point  is  of  this  aeolian  formation,  and  the 
sea  has  been  observed  to  break  on  it  upwards  of  a  mile  from  the 
shore,  while  the  Sisters  and  Fountain  Rocks  are  really  small  isolated 
masses  three-quarters  of  a  mile  from  present  low-water  line.  About 
one-third  of  the  distance  from  the  Sand  Hill  to  Bats'  Cave  there 
is  an  isolated  mass  of  this  formation  which  becomes  an  island  at 
high  water  ;  on  the  land-face  of  this  mass  there  is  a  heap  of  shells 
embedded  12  feet  above  high- water  mark.  This  is  about  12  feet 
long  by  3  feet  thick,  and  contains,  besides  shells,  fish  bones  and 
splintered  bones  of  mammals ;  and  although  there  are  no  traces  of 
ashes  or  charred  wood,  I  am  satisfied  myself  as  to  its  artificial 
deposition. 

The  facts  concerning  the  aeolian  deposit  enumerated  above  leads 
us  to  the  following  conclusions.  Since  the  three  spear  heads  were  lost 
we  have  to  account  for  a  depression  of  the  land  and  advance  of  the 
shore-line  for  at  least  a  mile,  and  from  the  average  inclination  of  the 
bed  of  the  Indian  Ocean  at  this  point,  that  means  a  land  depression 
of  over  50  feet.  Then  we  have  to  allow  for  the  gradual  emergence 
of  the  land,  which  has  enabled  the  sea  to  cut  the  rock  back  for  a 
distance  of  a  mile,  up  to  its  present  level,  which  it  has  maintained 
long  enough  for  the  sea  to  cut  a  platform  over  200  yards  in  width. 

Geo.  R.  M'Kay. 

East  London,  W.,  South  Africa. 


581.1  337 


VI 
The  Seed  Production  of  Cut  Flowers 

IN  the  second  number  of  the  Botanische  Zeitung  for  this  year  (Jan. 
16th  1897,  p.  17)  Ludwig  Jost  brings  to  light  a  very  curious 
fact  in  historical  botany.  He  points  out  that  at  the  close  of  1896 
H.  Lindemuth  has  re-discovered  a  phenomenon,  which  has  already 
twice  before  been  described  as  new. 

It  is  a  well-known  feature  of  many  bulbous  plants  that  their 
flowers  are  normally  sterile,  and  that  their  reproduction  takes  place 
exclusively  by  the  vegetative  process  of  bulb  formation.  More  than 
three  hundred  years  ago  (1577)  Konrad  Gesner  noticed  that  if  the 
flower  stalks  of  these  plants  be  separated  from  the  bulb,  the  flowers 
will  set  their  seed.  This  observation,  however,  fell  into  the  general 
oblivion  which  overshadowed  the  whole  of  Gesner's  work.  In  1790 
— two  hundred  years  later — Medicus  re-discovered  the  fact,  and 
wrote  of  it  in  his  paper  "  Ueber  Saamenansezen  an  abgeschnittenen 
Bltithenstengeln  einiger  Zwiebeln  und  Knollengewachse "  (Romer 
and  Usteri's  Magazin  fur  die  Botan.,  vol.  xi.,  p.  6.).  He  was 
examining  the  tubers  of  Stellar ioides  canalicuta  (?  Anthericwm), 
and  in  doing  so  cut  off  the  inflorescence,  which  he  stood  up  in  a 
corner  of  the  greenhouse  for  the  gardeners  to  clear  away.  Returning 
to  the  house  a  few  days  later  he  saw  that  the  flower  still  remained 
where  he  had  left  it,  and  that,  moreover,  it  was  still  fresh  and 
unwithered.  This  interested  him,  and  he  determined  to  see  how 
long  it  would  last  thus  "  cut  off  from  its  bulb  and  standing  in  a 
dry  position  exposed  to  the  sun  heat." 

Stellarioides  had  been  grown  and  flowered  in  this  greenhouse 
during  the  three  previous  years  without  once  setting  seed.  "  I  was 
no  little  surprised,  therefore,"  he  says,  "  to  find  that  in  due  course  of 
time  the  older  flowers  of  this  inflorescence,  which  had  been  separated 
from  its  bulb,  formed  true  seed  capsules."  "  This  really  remarkable 
and  cp;iite  unexpected  result,"  he  continues, "  led  me  at  once  to  other 
experiments.  For  twenty  years  past  Amarillis  reginae  L.  had 
bloomed  in  this  greenhouse  without  once  setting  seed ;  as  soon  as 
the  flowers  drooped,  it  was  seen  that  their  ovaries  and  all  they 
contained  withered  likewise."  Medicus  next  proceeded  to  cut  off 
an  inflorescence,  including  three  flowers,  and  to  leave  this  standing 
in  the   greenhouse.      After   a    time   all  three  flowers  formed   seed 

2a 


338  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [November 

capsules.  The  same  phenomenon  was  seen  in  Amaryllis  formosis- 
sima. 

In  discussing  these  observations  Medicus  writes  : — "  Those  plants 
which  have  the  property  of  reproducing  themselves  by  roots,  especi- 
ally marked,  are  most  unfortunate  in  setting  seed,  although  no 
observer  can  deny  the  presence  or  completeness  of  the  sexual  organs. 
The  true  cause  of  this  seems  to  be  that  these  plants  expend  all  their 
energy  in  increasing  their  roots  and  concentrate  their  nutritive 
activities  on  these  parts,  and  so  leave  none  over  to  contribute  to 
the  formation  of  seed.  Annuals,  or  plants  with  a  limited  existence, 
on  the  contrary,  for  the  most  part,  set  seed,  because  they  have  little 
or  no  power  of  multiplying  by  their  roots,  which  decay  as  soon  as 
the  seed  is  formed,  and  their  allotted  span  of  two  to  five  months 
passed."  Referring  again  to  the  complete  sterility  of  Amaryllis 
reginae,  under  ordinary  conditions,  he  adds  that  "  scarcely,  however, 
have  we  separated  the  inflorescence  from  its  root,  and  laid  it  aside 
without  moisture,  than  it  forms  large  seed  capsules,  and  clearly 
shows  us  that  these  would  always  be  produced  if  the  vigorous  root 
formation  did  not  rob  them  of  all  nourishment." 

With  the  exception  that  we  now  regard  bulbs  and  tubers  as 
stem  rather  than  root  structures,  these  words  have  a  very  modern 
ring  about  them,  and  plainly  show  that  what  we  now  call  correlation 
between  the  different  organs  of  a  plant  was  already  then  recognised 
by  Medicus.  One  thing  is  very  noticeable  about  his  writings,  and 
that  is  the  charm  of  his  literary  style,  an  item  which  by  no  means 
graces  too  many  of  the  scientific  essays  and  memoirs  of  the  present 
day. 

Medicus'  paper  was  written  in  May  of  1790,  and  in  the 
century  which  has  elapsed  since  that  time  both  Gesner's  original 
observation  and  Medicus'  re-discovery  have  been  so  completely  for- 
gotten that  in  1896  Lindemuth  published  an  account  of  the  same 
phenomena  without  any  idea  that  it  had  ever  been  noticed  before. 
Thus,  as  Jost's  paper  in  the  Bot.  Zeit.  points  out,  we  have  here  a 
fact  which  has  three  times  been  discovered  as  new,  after  having 
been  twice  completely  forgotten.  H.  Lindemuth  {Berichte  der 
deutsch.  Bot.  Gesell.,  pt.  7,  vol.  14),  after  describing  precisely  similar 
facts  to  those  which  Medicus  had  already  set  down,  using,  however, 
Lachenalia  luteola  and  Lilium  candidum  as  his  experimental  objects, 
proceeds  to  recount  some  facts  which  go  beyond  those  which  his 
predecessors  had  seen.  These  he  embodies  in  a  second  paper,  con- 
tained in  the  same  number  of  the  Berichte.  On  25  th  March  he  cut 
off  forty  inflorescences  of  Lachenalia  luteola,  and  placed  them  in 
water.  About  three  weeks  later  he  noticed  that  the  lower  part  of 
the  stem  which  was  under  water  was  now  curiously  granulated. 
Here  and  there  a  granule  had  become  larger  than  its  neighbours, 


1897]       THE  SEED  PRODUCTION  OF  GUT  FLOWERS      339 

and  was  easily  recognised  as  a  bulbil.  At  first  these  granules  are 
covered  by  the  green  epidermis  of  the  flower-stalk,  but  as  they 
gradually  increase  in  size  they  burst  through  this  as  little  white 
lumps.  Microscopic  examination  shows  that  these  bulbils  are 
always  exogenous  in  their  origin.  Inflorescences  of  hyacinth  which 
were  cut  off  close  to  the  bulb  and  placed  in  water  then  had  their 
flowers  also  removed,  so  that  nothing  but  the  peduncle  remained. 
When  examined  nearly  two  months  later,  it  was  found  that  bulbils 
had  developed  close  to  the  places  where  the  flowers  had  been  situ- 
ated. In  this  case  it  seems  that  the  food-stuff  in  the  peduncle  was 
first  cut  off  from  the  bulb,  and  so  travelled  towards  the  flowers, 
but  finding  its  passage  blocked  here  also  by  the  removal  of  the 
blooms,  it  expends  itself  in  forming  bulbils  close  to  their  remains. 
Finally,  Lindemuth  ends  his  paper  with  practical  conclusions  for  the 
culture  of  bulbous  plants  drawn  from  these  experimental  data. 

This  brief  English  note  has  been  written  in  order  to  call  the 
attention  of  those  into  whose  hands  the  Bot.  Zcit.  does  not  usually 
fall  to  the  services  which  Medicus  rendered  to  plant  biology.  To 
glance  through  the  pages  of  Professor  Sachs'  History  of  Botany,  the 
only  knowledge  that  we  can  gain  of  this  older  observer  is  in  a  few, 
scant,  depreciating  references.  Granted  that  the  light  of  genius  did 
not  lead  him  into  the  right  path  in  one  section  of  botany  (anatomy) 
we  still  should  not  allow  the  memory  of  an  enthusiastic  and  careful 
observer  in  other  departments  of  the  same  science  to  be  altogether 
forgotten,  or,  worse  still,  to  be  alone  remembered  for  the  errors  into 
which  he  fell.  Most  of  us,  even  to-day,  are  not  always  in  the  right, 
and  this  should  teach  us  to  "  render  the  deeds  of  mercy  "  towards 
the  memory  of  others  who,  living  at  a  less  enlightened  period,  some- 
times went  astray  with  their  fellows,  and  did  not  rise  above  their 
times,  but  who  on  other  occasions  saw  things  with  an  "  inward  light  " 
which  was  denied  to  their  contemporaries.  It  is  no  doubt  the  ex- 
traordinary work  of  Professor  Sachs  himself  and  his  school  which  has 
quite  placed  in  the  shadow  all  older  writings  upon  plajit  physiology. 

Eudolf  Beer. 


340  [November 


SOME  NEW  BOOKS 

The  Flora  of  North  America 

Synoptical  Flora  of  North  America.  Vol.  I.,  Part  I.,  Fascicle  II.  By  Asa  Gray,, 
continued  and  edited  by  Benjamin  Lincoln  Robinson.  Imp.  8vo,  pp.  ix.  to  xv., 
207  to  506.     New  York  :  American  Book  Company,  June  10,  1897.     Price,  lis. 

Those  of  our  readers  who  are  interested  in  North  American  botany 
will  remember  that  Dr  Gray  himself  published  the  portion  of  this 
flora  dealing  with  the  Gamopetalous  orders  of  Dicotyledons.  The 
\wo  parts  which  appeared  in  1878  and  188-i  were  re-issued  by  the 
(Smithsonian  Institution  in  1886.  For  some  time  before  his  death  Dr 
Gray  was  engaged  in  monographing  the  earlier  orders  of  the  Poly- 
petalae,  and  after  his  death  the  work  was  continued  by  Dr  Sereno 
Watson  and  then  by  Dr  Eobinson.  The  first  fascicle  of  the  present 
part  was  issued  in  1895  and  contained  an  account  of  the  orders 
beginning  with  Eanunculaceae  and,  following  the  system  of  Bentham 
and  Hooker's  Genera  Plantarum,  ending  with  Frankeniaceae.  The 
second  fascicle  now  before  us  carries  the  work  on  as  far  as  Polygalaceae. 
It  has  been  printed  from  Dr  Gray's  manuscript,  continued  and  edited 
by  Dr  Eobinson,  with  the  collaboration  of  Professors  Trelease,  Coulter 
and  Bailey.  A  third  fascicle  to  include  the  Leguminosae  is  in  pre- 
paration. The  work  forms  a  concise  but  complete  and  carefully 
elaborated  account  of  the  flowering  plants  of  North  America  (north  of 
Mexico).  The  descriptions,  which  are  sufficiently  full  and  clear,  are 
in  English ;  the  synonymy  and  bibliography  of  genera  and  species  are 
included,  and  the  geographical  range  of  species  and  varieties  is  indi- 
cated. Identification  of  the  plants  is  facilitated  by  the  introduction 
of  generic  and  specific  keys.  We  congratulate  Dr  Eobinson  and  his 
colleagues  on  the  portion  already  done  and  wish  them  a  speedy  and 
successful  termination  of  the  Flora. 

Mollusca 

Traitf,  de  Zoologie  publie"  sous  la  direction  de  Raphael  Blanchard.  Fasc. 
xvi.,  Mollusques.  Par  P.  Pelseneer.  Pp.  187,  tigs.  8vo.  Paris:  Ruetf  et  Cie., 
1897.  • 

This,  which  we  understand  is  one  of  the  first  fascicules  published  of 
what  promises  to  be  a  most  important  and  valuable  work,  contains,  in 
addition  to  the  subject  announced  on  the  title,  a  two-page  appendix  on 
Rhodoye.  Otherwise  it  amounts  in  fact  to  a  second  edition  of  Pelseneer's 
"  Introduction  a  l'etude  des  Mollusques,"  to  which  we  called  attention 
on  its  publication  {Natural  Science,  iv.,  1894,  pp.  387-388). 

It  is,  however,  so  much  added  to  and  revised,  that  it  almost  amounts 
to  a  new  work.  At  the  same  time,  we  very  greatly  regret  to  see  that  the 
useful  bibliographies  formerly  given  at  the  end  of  each  section  have 
now  been  omitted.  On  the  other  hand,  certain  omissions  to  which  we 
called  attention  have  been  supplied.  Chlamydoconcha  finds  a  place, 
and  some  of  the  more  important  fossil  families  are  inserted  in  the 
systematic  part,  which  otherwise  remains  unaltered.    A  revised  phylo- 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  341 

genetic  tree  is  also  added.  "When  Dr  Pelseneer  comes  to  study  the 
gastropoda  as  systematically  as  he  has  done  his  own  favourite  bivalves 
we  are  convinced  he  will  abandon  the  classification  of  the  Prosobran- 
chiata  that  he  at  present  takes  from  Bouvier  {Ann.  Sci.  Nat.,  ser.  vii., 
vol.  iii.,  1887),  which  classification  is  founded  solely  on  the  nervous 
system.     He  will  also  add  some  notice  of  Thyrophorclla. 

The  principal  shortcoming,  however,  of  the  work  as  a  whole  is,  we 
think,  the  scanty  reference  to  the  shell,  which  is  after  all  an  important 
feature  of  the  mollusca,  and  in  a  treatise  on  zoology  merits  a  place. 
In  this  respect  the  work  is  an  exception  to  the  generality  of  such  pro- 
ductions where  the  animal  is  neglected.  Curiously  enough  it  is  the 
Pelecypod  shell  that  is  the  most  curtly  dismissed,  and  this  in  the  light 
of  Bernard's  researches  is  the  more  to  be  regretted. 

In  the  development  of  Pelecypods,  too,  we  miss  all  reference  to  the 
second  origin  of  gill  filaments,  by  the  splitting  up  of  a  previously  ex- 
isting lamella,  as  shown  to  occur  in  Cyclas  and  Teredo  by  Korschelt 
and  Heider,  and  again  in  Scioberetia  by  Bernard.  Likewise  our  author 
appears  to  have  overlooked  the  fact  that  the  glochidial  stage  is  not 
peculiar  to  the  Unionidae,  it  having  been  found  by  Dall  to  occur  in 
Philobri/a.  Other  minor  points  for  criticism  are  doubtless  to  be  found 
by  those  who  care  to  make  diligent  search  for  them,  but  the  work  all 
the  same  merits  and  will  attain  a  high  place  in  the  estimation  of  those 
most  competent  to  judge  of  it,  and  the  praise  we  ventured  to  bestow 
on  the  first  edition  is  yet  more  merited  in  the  present  one.  It  will  be 
the  author's  fault  if  subsequent  editions  do  not  carry  us  far  towards  an 
ideal  work  on  the  subject. 

It  is  only  fair  to  add  that  a  word  of  praise  is  but  due  to  the 
printers  and  publishers  for  the  excellent  way  in  which  they  have 
carried  out  their  share  of  the  undertaking.  The  illustrations  are,  of 
course,  those  of  the  previous  edition,  enlivened  in  some  cases  by 
touches  of  colour  to  bring  out  the  salient  features  they  are  intended 
to  illustrate.     There  are  two  good  indexes  at  the  end  of  the  part. 

(BV)2 
The  Vivarium 

The  Vivarium,  being  a  Practical  Guide  to  the  Construction,  Arrangement,  and 
Management  of  Vivaria.  By  Rev.  Gregory  C.  Bateman.  8vo,  pp.  424,  with 
plates.     London:  L.  Upcott  Gill,  1897.     Price,  7s.  6d. 

For  very  many  years  Mr  Bateman  has  kept  living  batrachians  and 
reptiles  as  pets,  and  the  beautifully  got-up  little  volume  now  before 
\is  embodies  the  results  of  his  experience.  The  work,  however,  is  far 
more  than  a  practical  handbook.  The  author  has  added  to  his  own 
personal  observations  several  illustrated  chapters,  in  which  the  more 
striking  forms  of  batrachian  and  reptilian  life  are  described  in  a 
popular  manner.  He  thus  appeals  to  a  much  wider  circle  of  amateur 
naturalists  than  those  who  keep  vivaria.  We  can  thoroughly  re- 
commend the  book  to  the  general  reader  who  desires  a  reliable,  well- 
written,  and  non-technical  account  of  the  much  neglected  animals  of 
which  it  treats.  Our  only  complaint  is  that  the  illustrations  are  of 
very  unequal  merit,  in  many  cases,  indeed,  far  from  accurate ;  and 
this  is  all  the  more  to  be  regretted,  since  most  of  them  are  newly 
drawn,  and  might  have  been  made  admirable  by  a  little  more 
supervision  of  the  artist. 


342  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [November 


Bibliography 

The  Theory  of  National  and  International  Bibliography,  with  special  reference 
to  the  introduction  of  system  in  the  record  of  modern  literature.  By  Frank  Camp- 
bell.    8vo,  pp.  xvi.  and  500.     London  :  Library  Bureau,  1896. 

The  main  object  of  the  present  work  is  to  demonstrate  and  enforce 
the  responsibility  of  the  government  of  each  nation  in  the  matter  of 
cataloguing  the  literature  published  within  its  boundaries.  As  the 
author  points  out,  it  is  impossible  for  any  other  body  to  do  this  work 
thoroughly  and  economically,  because  no  other  can  bring  pressure  to 
bear  upon  the  publishers.  There  is  also  this  further  reason  for  urging 
upon  governments  to  discharge  this  obvious  duty,  that  it  is  just  in  the 
department  of  State  papers  that  the  greatest  confusion  reigns  and  the 
labours  of  the  bibliographer  are  most  difficult.  Witness  Mr  Camp- 
bell's imaginary,  but  most  lifelike,  conversation  between  a  librarian 
and  a  reader  in  some  large  public  library. 

This  main  theme  is  treated  in  a  series  of  papers  which  have  for 
the  most  part  been  read  before  the  Library  Association  and  other 
bodies,  and  published  in  their  journals,  and  in  addition  there  are 
essays  upon  various  collateral  topics,  such  as  "the  influence  and 
functions  of  the  learned  societies  in  regard  to  bibliography " — a 
chapter  which  we  wish  their  councils  would  all  "  read,  mark,  learn 
and  inwardly  digest." 

Mr  Campbell's  book  is  eminently  suggestive,  and  his  schemes  if 
carried  out  would  reduce  confusion  to  something  approaching  order. 
With  the  form  of  his  work  we  are  not  so  satisfied  ;  the  plan  he  has 
adopted  of  reprinting  essays  leads  to  much  repetition,  and  he  often 
sins  against  his  own  '  theories  of  compilation  ; '  but  as  he  explains  in 
the  preface  that  illness  prevented  him  from  carrying  out  all  his  inten- 
tions, it  would  be  ungenerous  to  dwell  upon  these  defects,  which  are 
small  in  comparison  with  the  solid  value  of  the  book. 

W.  E.  H. 

Flight  and  Flying  Machines 

The  Aeronautical  Annual  for  1897.     Edited  by  James  Means.     8vo,   pp.    178, 
pis.  xviii.     London  :  W.  Wesley  &  Son,  1897.     Price  5s. 

The  "Aeronautical  Annual"  for  1897  contains  much  that  is  valuable 
and  interesting,  since  the  contributors  are  nearly  all  of  them  men 
who  are  actively  engaged  in  solving  the  great  problem  how  flight  may 
be  made  possible  for  men.  First  among  these  must  be  mentioned  Mr 
Langley,  who  contributes  an  account  of  the  experiments  which,  after 
many  disappointments,  ended  in  the  manufacture  of  an  aerodrome 
which  actually  rose  in  the  air  and  continued  rising  and  advancing  for 
about  one  and  a  half  minutes,  after  which  it  alighted  rather  than  fell. 
As  in  the  case  of  Mr  Maxim's  flying  machine,  screw-propellers  driven 
by  steam-power  were  employed.  The  action  of  the  propellers  is  to 
drive  the  machine  onward  :  the  spreading  wings  have  a  slight  upward 
slope,  so  that  the  force  is  resolved,  and  there  is  progress  not  only 
onward  but  upward.  This  aerodrome,  as  compared  with  Mr  Maxim's, 
had  the  great  advantage  of  being  light,  weighing,  in  fact,  only  about 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  343 

25   lbs.,   so   that   experiments   with   it  were   easier   and  much  less 
costly. 

Mr  Langley  has  shown,  then,  that  flying  machines  can  be  made 
which  will  rise  in  the  air,  fly  for  a  short  time,  and  descend  without 
mishap.  But  before  the  problem  of  flight  is  solved  many  difficulties 
must  be  got  over,  the  difficulties  of  (1)  launching  without  any 
elaborate  apparatus  ;  (2)  maintaining  equilibrium  in  gusty  winds  ;  (3) 
carrying  sufficient  fuel  for  long  flights  ;  (4)  alighting  safely  even  when 
the  circumstances  are  not  specially  favourable.  An  oil  engine  is  now 
being  made  to  be  affixed  to  the  gliding  machine.  As  an  aeronaut  will 
be  on  board,  a  distinct  advance  on  Mr  Langley's  aerodrome,  which  had 
no  living  pilot,  is  contemplated. 

The  article  on  sailing  flight  by  Mr  Chanute  reviews  the  various 
theories  on  the  subject  judiciously.  There  is  no  doubt,  as  he  says, 
that  in  very  many  cases  birds  soar  by  the  help  of  ascending  currents 
of  air.  But  it  is  probable  that  sometimes  when  there  is  no  such 
current  available,  they  nevertheless  succeed  in  rising  without  a  beat  of 
their  wings.  Over  level  ground  in  Egypt,  covered  with  green  crops, 
where  great  heating  or  unequal  heating  of  the  surface  seemed  out  of 
the  question,  so  that  there  was  nothing  to  start  an  upward  current, 
the  present  writer  has  seen  kites  soaring  with  perfect  ease. 

Mr  Chanute  thinks  that  birds  can  soar  by  the  help  of  a  '  nearly 
uniform '  horizontal  breeze,  but  happily  he  does  not,  in  contempt  of 
dynamics,  hold  that  an  absolutely  uniform  horizontal  breeze  can  lift 
them.  He  makes  some  good  remarks  on  the  question  why  some  birds 
frequently  soar,  whereas  others,  and  among  them  very  good  flyers, 
never  do.  He  thinks  that  soaring  depends  on  the  arching  of  the 
wing,  and  it  is  quite  possible  that  this  may  be  the  case.  In  the  rapid 
pulsations  of  '  rowing '  flight  the  front  margin  of  the  wing  does  the 
main  work.  In  the  stately  gyrations  of  the  soaring  adjutant  it  is 
probable  that  the  ample  concavity  is  of  more  service.  But  far  more 
cross-sections  of  wings  than  he  gives  are  wanted  before  it  is  possible 
to  accept  this  explanation,  and  in  particular  small  birds  should  be 
well  illustrated.  It  is  remarkable  that  no  bird  so  small  as  a  thrush 
ever  soars. 

The  subject  of  flight  does  not  so  often  as  formerly  give  rise  to 
utterly  wild  theories.  The  Annual  as  a  whole  is  remarkably  free  from 
wild  writing.  But  the  old  tendency  shows  itself  in  Mr  Huffaker's 
theory  that  a  bird  in  soaring  causes  a  down-current,  which  in  turn 
starts  an  up-current,  which  supports  him  as  he  rises  ! 

F.  W.  Headley. 


Contemporary  Psychology 

The  Psychology  of  the  Emotions.  By  Th.  Ribot.  8vo,  pp.  xix  +  455.  London: 
Walter  Scott  (Contemp.  Sci.  Ser.),  1897.     Price,  6s. 

The  New  Psychology.  By  E.  W.  Scripture.  8vo,  pp.  xxiv  +  500.  London: 
Walter  Scott  (Contemp.  Sci.  Ser.),  1897.     Price,  6s. 

These  two  volumes  of  the  Contemporary  Science  Series  exhibit 
Psychology  in  very  different  aspects.  Prof.  Eibot's  work  on  the 
emotions  is  characterised  by  breadth  of  view,  wide  range  of  know- 
ledge, admirable  lucidity  of  presentation,  bold  and  yet  critical  use  of 


344  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [November 

hypothesis,  and  a  distinctly  genetic  motive.  The  subjects  with  which 
it  deals  are  of  necessity  vague  in  outline  and  indefinite  in  limitation. 
The  social  and  moral  feelings,  the  religious  and  aesthetic  sentiments, 
the  emotions  associated  with  intellectual  endeavour — all  these  present 
us  with  such  a  variety  of  factors,  such  an  interlacement  of  the  threads 
of  our  mental  life,  so  much  overlap  and  so  much  that  is  dependent  on 
individuality  of  character,  that  anything  like  mathematical  exactness 
or  precision  of  measurement  is  at  present,  and  is  likely  long  to  remain, 
impossible. 

On  the  other  hand,  Dr  Scripture's  New  Psychology  is  characterised 
by  limitation  of  field,  a  devotion  to  exactness  of  measurement,  a  love 
of  mathematical  and  formulated  presentment,  an  impatience  of  hypo- 
thesis, and  a  refusal  to  look  beyond  the  formulated  facts.  The  sub- 
jects with  which  it  deals  are  carefully  restricted  to  those  which  lend 
themselves  to  physical  measurement.  The  new  psychology — a  re- 
markably unsatisfactory  and  somewhat  arrogant  title — deals  with  a 
comparatively  small  area  of  the  field  of  mental  endeavour,  and  one  in 
which  there  is  no  luxuriant  profusion  of  mental  products.  But  it 
endeavours  to  deal  with  this  small  area  with  an  exactness  and  pre- 
cision which  is  in  itself  wholly  praiseworthy.  And  if  the  results 
attained  by  the  large  expenditure  of  time,  money,  and  energy  in  the 
well-equipped  psychological  laboratories  across  the  Atlantic  would 
seem  at  present  scarcely  commensurate  with  the  cost,  this  will  not, 
we  trust,  damp  the  ardour  of  enthusiasts  like  Dr  Scripture.  Psychology 
is  a  great  subject  of  which  we  are  only  just  beginning  to  realise  the 
importance.  There  is  plenty  of  scope  both  for  the  breadth  of  treat- 
ment we  find  in  Prof.  Eibot  and  for  the  patient  experimentation  of 
those  whose  work  is  described  in  the  New  Psychology. 

A  Blind  Guide 

Nature -Chat.     By  Edward  A.  Martin,   F.G.S.     8vo,  pp.   141.     London: 
It.  &  A.  Taylor,  1897.     Price,  Is. 

There  are  numbers  of  folk  who  derive  much  innocent  enjoyment  from 
natural  history,  and  who  have  a  harmless  enthusiasm  for  '  Nature.' 
No  one  would  wish  to  interfere  with  their  amusement ;  but  the  matter 
assumes  a  different  aspect  when  their  trivial  observations  and  inaccu- 
rate assertions  are  obtruded  upon  the  public.  This  is  the  case  in  the 
latest  addition  to  the  biblia  abiblia  which  are  now  so  freely  issued 
from  the  press — "  Nature  -  Chat,"  by  Mr  Edward  A.  Martin.  Mr 
Martin  is  a  leading  light  of  the  Selborne  Society ;  .  he  guides  the 
members  in  their  summer  rambles,  and  lectures  to  them  on  winter 
evenings.  He  has  written  a  bibliography  of  White  of  Selborne,  and 
seems  to  think  he  follows  the  methods  of  '  Gilbert,'  as  he  affection- 
ately styles  him. 

Disraeli  said  that  the  critics  were  men  who  had  failed  in  literature; 
Mr  Martin  makes  it  clear  that  a  teacher  may  be  one  who  has  never 
succeeded  in  learning.  He  has  brought  together  in  this  volume  a 
number  of  paragraphs,  many  of  which,  we  believe,  have  appeared  in 
a  local  magazine  or  newspaper ;  others  are  "parts  of  letters  addressed 
to  friends,"  who  must,  we  think,  be  somewhat  bored  by  the  honour  of 
Mr  Martin's  correspondence.  We  look  in  vain  for  a  single  addition 
to  knowledge  in  this  collection  of  trivialities. 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  345 

The  following  paragraph  may  be  quoted  as  exemplifying  at  once 
Mr  Martin's  scientific  attainments  and  his  literary  style : — 

"  To  be  thoroughly  acquainted  with  the  beautiful  grasses  of  Great 
Britain  is  to  possess  a  knowledge  of  which  I  am  ambitious.  As  I 
was  collecting  grasses  on  my  walk,  I  pulled  some  concerning  which 
I  was  at  a  loss  to  know  whether  they  were  of  identical  species,  or 
whether  they  were  distinct.  Almost  as  the  thought  passed  through 
my  mind,  my  eyes  lighted  upon  a  grass  of  which  the  lower  half  of  the 
blossom  was  fully  expanded.  This  showed  the  features  of  one  speci- 
men, whilst  the  upper  part,  which  evidently  was  yet  to  expand,  showed 
the  features  of  the  other.  Thus  Nature  answered  her  own  problem 
which  she  had  put  to  me."     (P.  34) 

We  are  tempted  to  ask  why  Mr  Martin  has  not  acquired  the 
"  knowledge  of  which  [he  is]  ambitious  "  ?  The  number  of  common 
British  grasses  is  not  large ;  every  manual  contains  their  description. 
But  it  is  only  too  clear  that  Mr  Martin  has  not  even  a  slight  acquaint- 
ance with  grasses,  for  he  talks  of  '  the  blossom '  when  he  means  the 
inflorescence,  just  as  he  speaks  of  a  '  specimen '  when  he  means  a 
species.  And  what  was  the  plant  after  all  ?  He  tells  us  that  "Nature 
answered  her  own  problem,"  but  does  not  give  us  her  reply.  We 
feel  inclined  to  imitate  Nature  in  "  putting  a  problem  "  to  Mr  Martin 
— What  useful  purpose  can  be  served  by  printing  paragraphs  of  this 
kind? 

Mr  Martin  made  the  strikingly  original  observation  that  the  flowers 
of  the  everlasting  pea  turn  blue  when  fading.  He  then  "watched  the 
creeper  closely,  with  the  result  that  it  has  borne  blossoms  which  were 
blue  in  the  first  place."  This  curious  consequence  of  Mr  Martin's 
vigilance  leads  him  to  say — "  the  seeds  it  will  be  well  to  collect "  : 
but  he  was  counting  his  chickens  too  soon,  for  on  p.  77  we  read :  "  In 
a  former  letter  I  referred  to  the  blue  blossoms  of  the  everlasting  pea 
which  had  appeared  in  my  garden.  Neither  of  them  have  been  suc- 
ceeded by  the  usual  pods  of  seeds,  so  that  I  shall  not  have  the  satis- 
faction of  rearing  seedlings  from  them,  as  I  had  anticipated."  Can  Mr 
Martin  suppose  that  this  kind  of  thing  adds  to  our  knowledge  ? 

But  the  author  rises  to  higher  flights  than  these.  "  You  know," 
he  says,  "  the  yucca,  which  is  said  [inaccurately,  but  this  Mr  Martin 
does  not  know]  to  flower  but  once  in  a  hundred  years.  Then  comes 
such  a  burst  of  brilliance  that  it  requires  a  period  equal  to  that  which 
allows  our  orb  to  roll  its  ponderous  body  along  its  tremendous  path 
around  the  sun,  a  hundred  times  or  thereabouts,  in  order  to  recover 
its  flowering  energy.  What  an  act  of  self-denial  is  this :  what  an  act 
of  self-immolation,  in  order  that  its  duty  may  be  fulfilled  ! "  The  only 
parallel  to  this  reflection  is  one  which  occurred  some  years  since  in 
the  catalogue  of  a  picture  exhibition  in  South  London — "  Scene  in 
Ceylon :  Elephants  bathing.  How  much  the  elephants  in  the  Zoo 
have  given  up  for  our  sakes  ! " 

The  book  is  full  of  inanities  and  ineptitudes,  and  the  literary  style 
is  in  harmony  with  the  subjects  discussed.  If  a  fly  tumbles  into  the 
milk-jug,  Mr  Martin  speaks  of  its  '  unwelcome  last  sad  bath.'  Dead 
nettles  are  '  magnificent '  and  '  gorgeous.'  Certain  flowers  smell  like  '  a 
glass  of  sherry ' ;  two  plants  in  the  same  paragraph  '  rejoice  in  '  their 
names.     The  author  speaks  of  his  '  legal  brother,'  as  if  he  had  another 


346  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [November 

brother  who  was  not  legal,  though  we  think  he  only  means  to  say  that 
the  gentleman  in  question  is  a  solicitor.  And  what  are  we  to  make  of 
the  following  sentence  : — "  We  are  so  matter-of-fact  in  our  science — 
too  matter-of-fact — to  thoroughly  appreciate  the  science  which  has 
become  science,  become  what  is  known  (scio,  I  know)  by  the  labours 
of  the  great  men  of  the  past,  who  alone,  perhaps,  when  discovering, 
were  able  fully  to  realise  the  poetry  of  their  own  discoveries."  It  is 
perhaps  our  own  fault,  but  we  are  unable  '  to  thoroughly  appreciate ' 
either  Mr  Martin's  facts  or  his  style. 


JJohn  Hunter 

John  Hunter  :  Man  of  Science  and  Surgeon  (1728-1793).  By  Stephen  Paget.  With 
Introduction  by  Sir  James  Paget.  8vo,  pp.  272.  London :  T.  Fisher  Unwin, 
1897.     Price,  3s.  6d. 

Mr  Stephen  Paget's  small  volume  on  John  Hunter  inaugurates  a 
new  series,  entitled  "  Masters  of  Medicine,"  edited  by  Dr  Ernest  Hart, 
and  published  by  Mr  Fisher  Unwin.  It  is  not  a  technical  work 
appealing  merely  to  the  medical  profession ;  it  is  a  well-written  and 
highly  entertaining  account  of  one  of  the  greatest  students  of  biology 
in  the  last  century,  full  of  interest  to  the  general  scientific  reader. 
The  volume  does  not  contain  much  new  matter ;  but  Mr  Paget  has 
spared  no  pains  to  go  to  the  original  sources  for  information,  and  he 
has  made  good  use  of  the  letters  and  records  preserved  in  the  Eoyal 
College  of  Surgeons,  London. 

John  Hunter,  as  a  great  pioneer  in  biology,  is  perhaps  too  much 
neglected  by  the  present  generation.  His  infusion  of  purely  scientific 
methods  into  the  profession  of  surgery  led  to  results  of  such  moment 
that  his  labours  in  other  directions  are  apt  to  be  overshadowed  and 
forgotten.  Those,  however,  who  are  familiar  with  such  of  his  biologi- 
cal and  geological  writings  as  were  recovered  and  edited  by  Sir 
Eichard  Owen  in  1861,  can  estimate  the  old  surgeon  at  his  true  worth  ; 
and  it  is  of  no  little  importance  that  his  memory  should  be  kept  green 
in  the  minds  of  those  who  are  now  following  in  his  footsteps.  Mr 
Paget's  delightful  chapters  can  scarcely  fail  in  this  purpose,  and  we 
urge  all  who  have  not  yet  realised  the  extent  and  bearing  of  John 
Hunter's  researches  and  the  influence  of  his  personality,  to  read  the 
new  biography  at  once.  His  favourite  maxim  was — "  Don't  think, 
try  ;  be  patient,  be  accurate."  The  story  of  his  life  will  be  found 
inspiriting  by  any  plodding  student. 

Pengelly 

A  Memoir  of  William  Pengelly,  of  Torquay,  F.R.S.,  Geologist,  with  a  Selection 
from  his  Correspondeuce.  Edited  by  his  daughter,  Hester  Pengelly.  With  a  Sum- 
mary of  his  Scientific  Work,  by  the  Rev.  Professor  Bonney.  8vo,  pp.  x.  341, 
portrait  and  10  illustrations.     London  :  John  Murray,  1897.     Price,  18s. 

Not  only  the  numerous  personal  friends  of  William  Pengelly  but  also 
all  who  are  interested  in  the  progress  of  our  knowledge  of  the  anti- 
quity of  man  and  allied  subjects,  will  be  glad  to  learn  that  Miss  Hester 
Pengelly  has  published  an  account  of  her  father's  life.  The  hand- 
some volume  of  over  300  pages  which  we  have  just  received,  contains 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  347 

an  ample  selection  from  his  correspondence  arranged  in  chronological 
order,  with  paragraphs  welding  them  into  a  connected  story ;  and  this 
is  followed  by  an  interesting  chapter  by  Professor  Bonney  on  the 
general  character  and  value  of  his  scientific  work. 

Pengelly's  genial  personality  was  so  widely  known  and  beloved, 
not  only  by  men  of  science  but  by  many  devoted  to  other  intellectual 
pursuits,  that  his  biography  will  find  no  lack  of  enthusiastic  readers. 
The  story  of  his  early  life  as  a  Cornish  sailor ;  of  his  career  as 
a  schoolmaster  at  Torquay ;  of  his  growing  fame  as  a  geologist, 
his  discoveries  of  fossil  fish- remains  in  the  Devonian  rocks  of  Corn- 
wall, and  so  forth ;  of  his  share  in  the  exploration  of  Brixham 
cavern  in  I8f>8  ;  and  finally,  of  his  great  work  in  arranging  and  per- 
sonally superintending  the  excavation  of  Kent's  cavern — all  this  is 
told  in  an  entertaining  manner  in  his  letters.  The  various  little 
incidents  in  his  career  are  recalled  as  we  read,  and  those  who  knew 
the  man  himself  will  recognise  his  characteristic  traits  and  modes  of 
expression.  We  have  only  one  criticism  to  offer,  namely,  that  far  too 
much  of  the  correspondence  is  printed.  A  considerable  proportion  of 
it  is  very  trivial  and  ephemeral,  of  no  interest  to  anyone  except  his 
immediate  family,  for  whose  private  view  alone  it  was  intended. 
Some  other  letters,  we  think,  are  inserted  with  rather  questionable 
taste,  as,  for  example,  one  in  reference  to  a  candidate's  touting  for  the 
fellowship  of  the  Eoyal  Society  on  p.  282.  Biographers  ought  to 
distinguish  between  strictly  personal  matters  and  those  bearing  upon 
the  progress  of  a  life's  work.  The  latter  alone  are  worthy  of  being 
preserved  in  a  memorial  volume. 

Professor  Bonney's  summary  of  Pengelly's  researches,  occupying 
only  thirty  pages,  is  an  admirable  contribution.  It  is  both  concise 
and  clear,  and  written  in  a  style  readily  comprehensible  to  the  general 
reader.  The  first  section  deals  with  the  geologist's  first  serious  under- 
taking, the  investigation  of  the  Tertiary  deposits  of  Bovey  Tracey  ; 
the  next  part  is  concerned  with  the  examination  of  the  caverns,  in 
association  with  which  the  name  of  Pengelly  will  be  longest  remem- 
bered ;  and  the  third  or  final  part  includes  a  number  of  miscellaneous 
geological  studies  of  the  south-western  district  of  England.  We  will 
not  attempt  to  analyse  this  chapter ;  it  must  be  read  in  its  entirety 
to  be  appreciated. 

Miss  Pengelly's  biography  appropriately  concludes  with  a  list  of 
her  father's  writings,  more  than  100  in  number,  and  it  is  prefaced  by 
a  very  successful  copy  of  A.  S.  Cope's  portrait  of  Pengelly,  which  was 
painted  in  1882. 

The  Vertebrate  Skeleton 

The  Vertebrate  Skeleton.     By  Sidney  H.  Reynolds,  M.A.     8vo,  pp.  xvi.  559, 
with  110  illustrations.     Cambridge  :  University  Press,  1897.     Price,  12s.  6d. 

The  latest  volume  of  the  Cambridge  Natural  Science  Manuals 
(Biological  Series)  is  a  useful  small  compendium  of  osteology  by  Mr 
S.  H.  Reynolds,  Lecturer  and  Demonstrator  in  Geology  and  Zoology 
at  University  College,  Bristol.  For  the  most  part  the  work  is  a 
laborious  compilation,  which  sometimes  rather  detracts  from  its 
interest   and  value ;  but  the   actual  descriptions  of  certain  typical 


348  NATURAL  SCIENCE 


[November 


skeletons  are  based  upon  personal  observation  and  research,  while  the 
clear  diagrammatic  illustrations  are  nearly  all  refreshingly  new,  many 
of  them  taken  from  the  beautiful  preparations  in  the  central  hall  of 
the  British  Museum  (Natural  History),  others  from  specimens  in  the 
Cambridge  University  Museum  of  Zoology. 

The  plan  adopted  by  the  author  is  to  give  first  an  account  of  the 
general  skeletal  characters  of  the  group  of  which  he  is  treating,  with 
the  characters  of  its  several  sub-divisions ;  secondly,  to  describe  in 
detail  the  skeleton  of  one  or  more  selected  types  ;  and  thirdly,  to  treat 
the  skeleton  as  developed  in  the  group  in  question,  organ  by  organ. 
The  account  of  each  type  skeleton  is  made  complete  in  itself,  so  that 
the  elementary  student  can,  if  he  wishes,  use  the  book  merely  as 
a  laboratory  guide  to  the  few  leading  forms  of  skeleton  to  which  he 
ordinarily  confines  his  attention. 

The  author  is,  of  course,  a  teacher,  and  he  presumably  knows  the 
requirements  of  his  students ;  but  we  are  inclined  to  think  that  the 
handbook  he  has  produced  is  far  from  well-arranged  for  practical 
purposes.  The  information  is  admirable,  usually  up-to-date,  and  not 
often  faulty — though  a  work  of  such  wide  scope  must  necessarily  have 
its  imperfections  ;  but  there  are  endless  repetitions  as  we  turn  over  the 
pages,  the  facts  concerning  a  single  structure  or  phenomenon  are  some- 
times inconveniently  scattered,  and  there  is  a  lack  of  some  fundamental 
idea  to  unite  the  various  parts  of  the  work  into  one  harmonious  whole. 
The  facts  of  embryology  may  sometimes  be  of  doubtful  import,  and 
our  present  knowledge  of  palaeontology  may  encourage  many  fanciful 
notions  and  speculations.  But  if  both  these  aids  to  formulating  a 
scheme  be  rejected,  there  is  still  the  good  old-fashioned  method  of 
Comparative  Anatomy,  which  (in  our  opinion,  at  least)  is  more  useful 
for  teaching  purposes  than  the  disconnected  mode  of  treatment  in  the 
handbook  before  us.  We  have  noted  similar  want  of  coherence  in 
Cambridge  biological  teaching  before.  Since  the  days  of  Francis 
Maitland  Balfour,  the  philosophy  of  the  subject  seems  to  have  become 
gradually  neglected,  while  the  dry  facts  have  been  more  and  more 
constantly  presented  in  unattractive  array.  Mr  Eeynolds  is  likely  to 
have  the  opportunity  of  revising  his  manual  in  a  new  edition  very 
soon — for  it  fills  a  decided  gap,  and  will  be  helpful  to  many  who  have 
hitherto  been  compelled  to  turn  to  numerous  and  varied  abstruse 
treatises  for  guidance.  We  would  therefore  urge  him  to  consider 
these  important  points,  and  render  his  work  more  worthy  of  the  great 
labour  he  must  have  bestowed  upon  it. 


Two  New  Editions 

Lessons  in  Elementary  Biology.  By  T.  Jeffrey  Parker.  Third  edition.  8vo,  pp. 
xxm.  503,  with  127  illustrations.  London:  Macmillan  &  Co.,  1897.  Price, 
10s.   6d.  ' 

Elements  of  the  Comparative  Anatomy  of  Vertebrates.  Adapted  from  the 
German  of  Dr  Robert  Wiedersheim.  By  W.  N.  Parker.  Second  edition,  founded 
on  the  third  German  edition.  8vo,  pp.  xvi.  488,  with  333  illustrations.  London  : 
-Macmillan  &  Co.,  1897.     Price,  12s.  6d.  net. 

These  two  text-books  by  the  brothers  Parker  are  too  well  known  and 
widely  appreciated  to  need  any  recommendation  here.  It  suffices  to 
record  the  publication  of  a  new  and  revised  edition  of  each  of  them. 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  349 

Prof.  Jeffrey  Parker's  "Elementary  Biology,'  in  its  new  form, 
differs  from  the  preceding  editions  in  the  increased  attention  devoted 
to  the  higher  animals  and  plants.  The  general  chapter  on  the  higher 
animals  has  been  expanded  into  four  beautifully-illustrated  chapters, 
dealing  respectively  with  an  outline  -  classification,  the  starfish,  the 
crayfish,  the  fresh-water  mussel,  and  the  dogfish.  The  additional 
botanical  matter  refers  in  the  same  style  to  Equisetum,  Salvinia, 
Sclaginella,  the  Gymnosperms,  and  the  Angiosperms.  These  supple- 
mentary sections  will  indeed,  as  the  author  himself  remarks,  contri- 
bute much  to  the  usefulness  of  the  book. 

Prof.  Newton  Parker's  second  English  edition  of  "  Wiedersheim  " 
may  almost  be  described  as  a  new  book.  The  original  descriptions 
and  arrangement  are  retained  as  far  as  possible,  and  most  of  the  old 
figures  are  reproduced,  although  a  few  have  been  replaced  and  others 
added.  Prof.  Wiedersheim  has  also  revised  the  whole.  But  to  bring 
the  work  up  to  date,  and  at  the  same  time  not  increase  the  size  of  the 
volume,  it  has  been  necessary  to  abridge  much  of  it  and  recast  other 
portions ;  while  the  useful  bibliography  in  the  appendix  has  been 
considerably  expanded  to  increase  its  usefulness  to  advanced  students. 
We  only  notice  one  serious  blemish,  namely,  the  unreliable  character 
of  some  of  the  references  to  the  skeleton  in  extinct  animals.  The 
figures  of  the  pelvic  arch  of  Plesiosaurus  on  p.  115  are  quite  errone- 
ous, and  might  easily  have  been  replaced.  "  Ldbyrinthodon  rueti- 
mcyeri "  is  certainly  not  a  labyrinthodont.  The  wing-finger  in  the 
Pterodactyles  is  not  the  fourth  but  the  fifth  digit.  Before  the  next 
edition  we  would  suggest  that  this  section  of  the  work  be  submitted 
to  someone  skilled  in  vertebrate  palaeontology  for  revision. 


Sceaps  from  Serials 

Me  Adrien  Dollftjs  has  paid  considerable  attention  to  the  terrestrial 
Isopoda,  the  wood-lice  of  the  world,  and  has  published  a  paper  in  the 
October  number  of  La  Feuille  des  Jewries  Naturalistes  showing  the  wide 
range  of  some  of  these  little  animals.  Considering  the  mode  of  life  of 
these  Isopoda,  it  is  not  at  all  surprising  to  find  certain  species  have  a 
wide  distribution,  but  it  is  interesting  to  have  this  distribution  put  on 
record.  'The  species  dealt  with  are  Armadillo  murinus,  Brandt ; 
Armadillidium  vulgare,  Latr.  ;  Porcellio  scaber,  Latr.  ;  P.  laevis,  Latr.  ; 
M '  etoponorthus  pruinosus,  Brandt;  Ligia  exotica,  Roux.  Of  these  five 
the  Metoponorthus  has  the  widest  range,  being  recorded  for  America 
(N.  to  S.),  Azores,  etc.,  the  whole  of  Europe,  Africa  (N.  to  S.),  Asia 
(E.  to  W.),  and  Australia  (N.  Caledonia  and  Marianna  Islands)  ;  Por- 
cellio laevis  is  the  next  most  widely  distributed,  having  much  the  same 
range  as  the  Metoponorthus,  but  found  also  in  the  Bermudas,  Mel- 
bourne, and  various  islands  of  Oceania,  and  restricted  to  the  N.  of 
Africa.  A  sketch  map  accompanies  the  paper,  which  has  an  additional 
value  in  that  it  mentions  the  collections  in  which  the  particular 
specimens  recorded  are  to  be  found. 

The  American  Journal  of  Psychology,  vol.  viii.  No.  3,  contains  a 
'  Study  of  Apperception,'  based  on  experimental  work  on  the  reading 
of  words  by  Dr  Pillsbury.  Typewritten  words  photographed  on  lantern 
slides  were  projected  on  a  ground-glass  screen,  and  exposed  for  two- 


350  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [November 

tenths  of  a  second.  They  were  mis-spelt  by  the  omission  of  a  letter, 
the  substitution  of  a  wrong  letter,  or  the  blurring  of  a  letter  by  print- 
ing an  x  over  it.  The  object  was  to  determine  the  relative  influence 
of  the  objective  factor  in  the  visual  stimulus,  and  the  subjective  factor 
through  association  and  apperception.  The  experiments  were,  so  far 
as  possible,  carefully  tabulated,  and  it  required  not  a  little  skill  (and 
some  imagination)  to  educe  results  of  any  decisive  value.  A  good 
resume  of  Prof.  Wundt's  views  on  apperception  is  given,  and  the 
conclusions  reached  are  in  line  with  those  obtained  in  a  quite  different 
way  by  Dr  Stout  in  his  recent  work  on  Analytical  Psychology. 

The  New  Age,  which  was  started  in  April,  is  published  on  the  loth 
of  each  month  by  the  proprietor,  68/2  Shikdar  Bagan  Street,  Calcutta. 
The  annual  subscription  is  Es.  2.12.  The  editor  is  S.  C.  Mukho- 
padhaya,  M.A.  There  is  some  want  of  discrimination  shown  in 
the  selection  of  tit-bits  for  this  "  Journal  of  universal  information," 
but  it  will  probably  be  of  interest  to  the  readers  for  whom  it  is  in- 
tended, and  it  interests  us  as  an  expression  of  the  views  of  the  educated 
Hindu  community. 

We  regret  to  learn  that  with  the  October  number  the  Inter- 
national  Journal  of  Microscopy  and  Natural  Science,  for  sixteen  years 
the  organ  of  the  Postal  Microscopical  Society,  has  ceased  to  exist  from 
lack  of  adequate  financial  support. 

The  Psychological  Review,  vol.  iv.  No.  5,  contains  a  suggestive  paper 
by  Prof.  Mark  Baldwin  on  the  "  Psychology  of  Social  Organisation." 
The  author  is  one  of  those  who  are  in  sympathy  with  biological  studies, 
and  who  seek  to  correlate  the  biological  and  the  psychological  factors 
in  the  development  of  social  life  from  its  pre-social  beginnings.  The 
same  writer  gives  in  the  "  Princeton  Contributions  to  Psychology,"  re- 
printed from  the  preceding  number  of  the  Psychological  Review,  a  dis- 
cussion of  "  Determinate  Evolution,"  which  should  prove  of  interest  to 
biologists. 

In  the  Albuquerque  Morning  Democrat,  Prof.  Cockerell  gives  a  report 
on  the  Mexican  dietary  as  studied  by  Prof.  Goss.  He  finds  that  the 
principal  food  of  the  Mexican  peasant  is  flour,  corn  meal,  and  chili, 
and  that  he  is  using  more  carbo-hydrates  and  less  proteids  than  is 
desirable.  The  Mexican  gets  most  of  his  proteids  from  frijoles,  and  for 
the  better  nourishment  of  the  peasant  Prof.  Goss  suggests  a  larger  use 
of  frijoles  in  proportion  to  the  flour  and  meal.  The  work  is  being 
carried  on  at  the  Mesilla  Park  experiment  station,  and  the  object 
aimed  at  is  an  improved  dietary  after  examination  of  soils  and  im- 
provement in  agricultural  produce. 

In  the  Transactions  of  the  Perthshire  Society  of  Natural  Science,  vol. 
ii.  pt.  5,  Colonel  Duthie  writes  on  the  British  abode  of  the  Crested 
Titmouse  (Parus  cristatus) ;  Messrs  Coates  and  Macnair  on  a  banded 
Hornblende  Schist  at  Balhoulan  Quarry,  Pitlochry ;  and  Mr  Macnair 
on  Pocks  of  Highland  Perthshire.  The  president,  Mr  Coates,  also  gives 
a  presidential  address  entitled  The  Origin  of  Soils,  with  special  refer- 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  351 

ence  to  the  soils  of  Perthshire ;  making  altogether  a  good  geological 
part  of  the  Transactions. 

Timchri  for  June  contains  Nesting  of  some  Guiana  Birds,  by  C.  A. 
Lloyd ;  Tobacco  and  Cotton  Cultivation  in  the  British  West  Indies, 
by  W.  H.  Burnley ;  Result  of  Eecent  Scientific  Researches  into  the 
Agricultural  Improvement  of  the  Sugar  Cane,  and  on  other  Sugar 
Cane  Experiments,  by  J.  B.  Harrison. 

New  Serials 

The  Institute  of  Jamaica  has  now  begun  to  issue  Annals  in 
addition  to  its  well-known  Journal.  We  have  received  the  first  part 
containing  a  list  of  the  Decapod  Crustacea  of  Jamaica  by  Mary  J. 
Eathbun  of  the  U.S.  National  Museum. 

The  Archives  de  Parasitologic,  under  the  direction  of  Raphael 
Blanchard,  is  a  new  review  announced  to  appear  in  Paris  next 
January.  The  parts  will  be  published  at  variable  intervals,  each 
containing  about  160  pages,  and  four  will  constitute  a  volume,  price 
30  francs.  The  journal  will  comprise  both  original  articles  and 
reviews  of  progress. 

The  Archives  of  Skiagraphy  has  changed  its  title  to  Archives  of 
the  Roentgen  Ray.  It  is  edited  by  W.  S.  Hedley  and  Sydney  Rowland, 
and  is  published  by  the  Rebman  Co.  The  illustrations  are  chiefly  of 
medical  and  surgical  interest. 

Further  Literature  Received 

Vorlesungen  iiber  Bacterien,  A.  Fischer :  Gustav  Fischer.  An  Introduction  to 
Geology,  W.  B.  Scott :  Macmillan.  Traite  de  Botanique,  L.  Courchet :  Balliere.  The 
Mathematical  Psychology  of  Gratry  and  Boole,  M.  E.  Boole :  Sonnenschein.  In 
Northern  Spain,  Hans  Gadow :  Black.  Catalogus  Mammalium,  fasc.  iii.,  E.  L. 
Trouessart :  Friedliinder.  Darwin  and  After  Darwin,  III.  Post-Darwinian  Questions, 
G.  J.  Romanes  :  Longmans.     Familiar  Wild  Flowers,  F.  E.  Hulme  :  Cassell. 

An  Address  on  Acquired  Immunity,  G.  Archdall  Reid  :  Lancet.  Notes  on  the 
Coccidae,  T.  D.  A.  Cockerell :  Rev.  Mus.  Paulista.  On  the  Nature  of  the  Rontgen 
Rays,  Sir  G.  G.  Stokes  :  Manchester  Lit.  and  Phil.  Soc.  Harvard  University,  Dept. 
Zoology,  1897-98. 

Timehri,  June  ;  Amer.  Geol.,  Oct.  ;  Amer.  Journ.  Sci.,  Oct.  ;  Amer.  Nat.,  Oct.  ; 
Ann.  Inst.  Jamaica,  Vol.  i.,  No.  1  ;  Annot.  Zool.  Japan,  Vol.  i. ,  Part  iii.  ;  Botan. 
Gaz.,  Sept.  ;  East  Asia,  Oct.  ;  Feuilles  des  Jeunes  Nat.,  Oct.  ;  Irish  Nat.,  Oct.  ;  Journ. 
School.  Geogr.,  Sept.  ;  Knowledge,  Oct.  ;  Literary  Digest,  Sept.  11,  18,  Oct.  2,  9; 
Naturae  Novit. ,  Sept.;  Naturalist,  Oct.;  Nature,  Sept.  23,  30,  Oct.  7,  14;  Nature 
Notes,  Oct.  ;  Naturen,  Sept.  ;  New  Age,  Sept.  ;  Photogram,  Oct.  ;  Rev.  Scient.  Sept. 
18,  25,  Oct.  2,  9  ;  Science,  Sept.  10,  17,  24,  Oct.  1  ;  Sci.  Amer.,  Sept.  11,  18,  25,  Oct. 
2  ;  Scot.  Geogr.  Mag.,  Oct.  ;  Scot.  Med.  and  Surg.  Journ.,  Oct.  ;  Victorian  Nat.,  Aug.  ; 
Westminster  Review,  Oct. 


352  [November 


OBITUARIES 

WILLIAM   AECHEE 

Born  May  6,  1830.     Died  AuGust  14,  1897. 

William  Archer,  who  died  in  Dublin  on  August  14th  last,  was  born 
on  May  6th,  1830.  He  devoted  himself  for  many  years  to  the  investi- 
gation of  the  lower  plants  and  animals,  especially  the  Desmids  and 
certain  groups  of  the  Ehizopods  and  Infusoria.  From  187b'  till  1880, 
he  acted  on  the  editorial  staff  of  the  Quarterly  Journal  of  Micro- 
scopical Science,  in  which  most  of  his  important  work  was  published. 
Many  of  his  valuable  papers,  however,  were  issued  by  the  Dublin 
Natural  History  Society,  now  extinct,  whose  proceedings  are,  unfor- 
tunately, very  scarce.  He  was  an  original  member,  and  for  many  years 
secretary  of  the  Dublin  Microscopical  Club.  His  eminence  as  a 
microscopist  led  to  election  into  the  Eoyal  Society  in  1875.  In  1876 
he  became  librarian  to  the  Eoyal  Dublin  Society,  and  when  the  bulk 
of  the  collection  was  transferred  to  the  Government  to  form  the 
National  Library  of  Ireland,  Archer  became  head  of  the  new  institu- 
tion. His  later  years  were  busily  occupied  in  the  duties  of  this 
office,  and  he  laboured  unremittingly  in  the  transfer  of  the  books 
to  new  quarters,  and  their  arrangement  and  cataloguing  on  the 
Dewey  system,  of  which  he  was  an  enthusiastic  advocate.  Two 
years  ago  he  was  compelled  to  retire,  having  reached  the  age  of 
sixty-five.  His  familiar  figure  will  be  sadly  missed  among  Dublin 
men  of  science,  whose  respect  for  his  wide  learning  was  accompanied 
by  hearty  admiration  for  his  personal  worth.  G.  H.  C. 


The  following  deaths  are  also  announced  : — Karl  Vogel  and  Wilhelm  Liebenon, 
eminent  German  cartographers  ;  Karl  Wilhelm  Petzold,  the  physical  and  astro- 
nomical geographer  ;  J.  H.  Trumbull,  philologist  and  member  of  the  National  Academy 
of  Sciences,  U.S.A.;  Ernest  Hutu,  professor  in  Frankfort  and  well  known  as  a  popu- 
lariser  of  science  ;  Emil  Schmidt,  a  teacher  of  zoology  in  Berlin  ;  Edgar  Maclure, 
professor  in  the  Oregon  State  University,  recently  killed  by  a  fall  on  Mount  Rainier, 
which  he  was  exploring  with  a  party  ;  at  Port  Antonio,  Jamaica,  Dr  J.  E.  Humphrey, 
associate  professor  of  botany  in  Johns  Hopkins  University,  Baltimore  ;  C.  S.  Roy,  pro- 
fessor of  pathology  in  the  University  of  Cambridge,  aged  43  ;  August  Mojsisovics, 
professor  of  zoology  and  comparative  anatomy  in  the  Universit}'  of  Graz  ;  Dr  Holm- 
gren, professor  of  physiology  in  the  University  of  Upsala,  aged  66  ;  and  Dr  Welcker, 
professor  of  anatomy  in  the  University  of  Halle. 


1897]  353 


NEWS 

The  following  appointments  are  announced  : — Dr  Lehman  Nitsche  to  be 
keeper  of  the  department  of  Anthropology  in  the  La  Plata  Museum,  in  succession 
to  Dr  Ten  Kate  ;  Dr  P.  Zwaardeniaker  to  be  professor  of  physiology  in  the 
University  of  Utrecht  ;  Dr  Carl  Zelinka  to  be  professor  of  zoology  in  the 
University  of  Czernowitz  ;  W.  L.  Bray  to  be  professor  of  botany  in  the  Univer- 
sity of  Texas  ;  H.  L.  Jones  to  be  associate  professor  of  botany  in  Oberlin  College  ; 
Dr  Hans  Reusch,  director  of  the  geological  survey  of  Norway,  to  be  Sturgis- 
Hooper  professor  of  geology  in  Harvard  University,  for  the  season  1897-98. 

We  have  had  occasion  to  refer  to  the  good  work  that  has  lately  been  done  in 
the  Bootle  Museum.  The  Committee  did  well  when,  some  three  years  ago,  they 
engaged  Mr  H.  C.  Chad  wick  as  museum  assistant.  We  therefore  regret  to  learn 
that  they  can  no  longer  afford  to  retain  his  services. 

The  new  Museum  of  the  Brooklyn  Institute  of  Arts  and  Sciences  was  opened 
early  in  October,  when  President  Eliot  of  Harvard  delivered  an  address. 

Dr  Alexander  Hill,  Master  of  Downing  College,  has  been  elected  Vice- 
Chancellor  of  the  University  of  Cambridge. 

The  Eighth  International  Geological  Congress  is  to  meet  in  Paris  in  1900,  the 
year  of  the  Exhibition.  The  visit  to  Vienna,  which  was  to  have  taken  place  in 
that  year,  is  postponed  to  1903. 

Reuter  announces  that  Nossilor  has  arrived  at  Tiumen  from  the  Kara  Sea. 
He  has  explored  the  Yalmal  peninsula,  and  discovered  a  shorter  waterway 
between  Siberia  and  Europe,  and  one  free  from  the  sea  ice. 

It  is  proposed  to  decorate  the  Zoological  Park  at  Washington  with  bronze 
groups  of  Indians  and  wild  animals.  Mr  Edward  Kemeys  will  probably  receive 
this  commission,  which  will  put  on  record  many  vanishing  types  of  animal  life. 

The  Botanical  Gazette  announces  that  the  Smithsonian  Institution  has  ap- 
pointed a  commission,  with  Dr  V.  Havard  as  chairman,  to  collect  information 
concerning  the  medicinal  qualities  of  the  plants  of  the  United  States  of  America. 

Mr  R.  C.  Christie  has  presented  to  the  Owens  College,  Manchester,  his  share 
of  the  estate  of  the  late  Sir  Joseph  Whitworth,  estimated  at  about  £50,000.  The 
fund  is  to  be  devoted  to  a  new  building  with  which  the  name  of  Whitworth  can 
be  associated. 

According  to  the  Athenceum,  it  is  proposed  to  establish  at  Swansea  a  branch 
University  College  in  association  with  either  Cardiff  or  Aberystwyth.  This  town 
already  possesses  an  important  library  and  museum  in  the  Royal  Institution  of 
South  Wales. 

The  Academy  of  Sciences  of  Berlin  has  granted  a  sum  of  3000  marks  to  Prof. 
B.  Hagen,  Frankfurt,  for  the  publication  of  an  anthropological  atlas  ;  1500  marks 
to  Prof.  Kohen,  Greifswald,  for  mineralogical  researches  ;  and  800  marks  to  Prof. 
R.  Bonnet,  Greifswald,  for  anatomical  work. 

Science  states  that  plans  have  already  been  made  for  the  new  building  of  the 
American  Geographical  Society,  New  York,  although  the  site  has  not  yet  been 

2b 


354  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [November 

decided  upon.     The  Society  owes  its  present  flourishing  condition  to  Judge  Daly, 
who  has  been  its  president  for  thirty-three  years. 

A  collection  of  horns  of  mammals  made  in  South  Africa  by  Mr  J.  Rosen  is 
now  being  exhibited  on  loan  in  the  Brighton  Museum.  Most  of  the  known 
species  are  represented,  and  many  of  the  specimens  are  remarkably  fine.  One 
pair  of  horns  of  a  koodoo  measure  47  inches  in  length. 

The  Louisiana  Society  of  Naturalists  was  founded  on  July  22nd.  It  starts 
with  forty-five  members  under  the  presidency  of  Prof.  J.  H.  Dillard  of  Tulane 
University,  the  secretary  being  Mr  E.  Foster.  According  to  Science  the  Society 
will  establish  a  museum  and  library,  and  will  publish  proceedings. 

The  Museum  of  the  Perthshire  Society  of  Natural  Science  is  progressing 
favourably,  though  hampered  by  want  of  funds.  We  trust  the  town  authorities 
will  help  in  the  matter  after  so  much  energy  has  been  spent  in  getting  things  into 
shape.  The  Society's  library  has  received  a  set  of  the  '  Challenger '  Reports  from 
the  Government. 

Next  year  Mr  J.  E.  Spurr  will  lead  an  expedition  to  Alaska  to  make  a  further 
survey  of  the  gold  resources.  $5000  has  been  appropriated  by  Congress  for  the 
purpose,  but  according  to  Science  an  effort  will  be  made  to  increase  the  appropria- 
tion to  $25,000  in  order  that  a  complete  survey  may  be  made  and  a  geological  map 
of  the  region  prepared. 

During  the  present  session  Prof.  Boyd  Dawkins  will  give  a  series  of  twelve 
short  addresses  on  geological  subjects  in  the  Manchester  Museum.  These  are  to 
be  delivered  alternately  on  Saturday  and  Sunday  afternoons.  We  are  glad  to 
note  that  the  Museum  has  just  received  a  donation  of  £1500  from  Mr  Edward 
Holt  towards  the  building  fund. 

According  to  the  American  Journal  of  Science,  the  Geological  Survey  of  Canada 
has  recently  acquired  a  mass  of  meteoric  iron  from  Thurlow,  Hastings  Co., 
Ontario.  It  is  an  irregularly-shaped,  truncated  pyramidal  mass,  with  a  more  or 
less  rectangular  base,  measuring  O^m.  by  0-135m.,  and  weighs  5*42  kilos.  It  is 
to  be  named  the  Thurlow  meteorite. 

The  International  Ornithological  Congress  will  meet  this  year  at  Aix  on 
November  9.  The  International  Congress  of  Zoology  will  meet  at  Cambridge  on 
August  23,  1898.  Sir  William  Flower  has  issued  a  circular  letter  asking  for 
co-operation  with  the  general  committee  in  raising  a  fund  to  defray  the  necessary 
expenses  of  the  meeting.  The  committee  has  just  met  in  London  to  arrange 
the  preliminaries. 

Prof.  Michael  Foster  has  been  delivering  lectures  in  Baltimore  during 
October,  and  he  now  proceeds  to  deliver  a  course  of  Lowell  Lectures  at  Boston. 
In  the  middle  of  the  month,  Dr  Nansen  passed  through  London  on  his  way  to 
America,  where  he  has  many  engagements.  Science  announces  that  at  the  close 
of  his  first  lecture  at  New  York  a  medal  will  be  presented  to  him  by  the  American 
Geographical  Society. 

At  the  annual  meeting  of  the  Hull  Scientific  and  Field  Naturalists'  Club, 
held  on  September  29,  it  was  reported  that  great  progress  had  been  made  during 
the  year.  Thirty-eight  new  members  had  been  elected,  and  the  attendance  at 
meetings  had  increased  by  50  per  cent.  The  Society  wisely  arranges  its  pro- 
gramme so  that  lectures  of  general  scientific  interest  alternate  with  its  more 
technical  and  original  local  work. 

The  Trustees  of  the  British  Museum  have  been  approached  by  the  Council  of 


1897]  NEWS  355 

the  British  Association  with  regard  to  the  establishment  of  a  Bureau  of  Eth- 
nology for  Greater  Britain.  If  this  arrangement  can  be  come  to  there  is  no  doubt 
that  the  information  obtained  would  be  of  great  service  to  science  and  utility  to 
the  Government.  Sir  John  Evans,  Sir  John  Lubbock,  Mr  C.  H.  Read,  and  Prof. 
E.  B.  Tylor  made  the  report  which  was  placed  before  the  British  Association. 

Sir  Joseph  Hooker  has  finished  the  "  Flora  of  British  India,"  begun  twenty 
years  ago,  and  has  received,  according  to  the  Kew  Bulletin,  a  despatch  from  the 
Government  of  India,  through  Sir  George  Hamilton,  recognising  his  services  to 
India  in  cordial  and  sympathetic  terms.  Sir  J.  Hooker  has,  we  are  also  glad  to 
learn,  offered  to  undertake  the  preparation  of  the  remaining  volumes  of  the  late 
Dr  Trimen's  "  Handbook  to  the  Flora  of  Ceylon,"  and  the  necessary  material  and 
specimens  have  already  arrived  at  Kew  from  Peradeniya. 

Among  the  Russian  geologists  who  took  part  in  the  Oural  excursion,  none 
endeared  himself  more  to  his  fellow-travellers  than  the  young  candidate  in 
Natural  Science,  L.  Spendiarow.  He  died  suddenly  of  heart  disease  almost 
immediately  after  the  return  to  St  Petersburg.  His  father  has  given  to  the 
International  Geological  Congress  the  sum  of  4000  roubles,  the  triennial  interest 
of  which  is  to  be  awarded  by  the  President  of  each  Congress  as  a  prize  for  the 
best  geological  work  done  during  the  preceding  three  years. 

We  learn  that  the  Government  have  presented  a  set  of  the  '  Challenger ' 
reports  to  certain  local  scientific  societies.  This  is  a  very  excellent  stimulus,  no 
doubt,  but  we  hope  the  familiar  notice  that  is  to  be  found  inside  the  Record 
Office  publications  deposited  in  our  Free  Libraries  is  to  be  found  also  in  these 
scientific  reports.  Local  societies  exist  by  the  enthusiasm  of  the  few,  and  when 
they  fall  into  decay  such  volumes  might  well  be  taken  from  them  and  passed  on 
to  another  centre  where  they  will  be  more  appreciated. 

The  Bulgarian  Government  has  received  by  bequest  from  Eulogius  Georgieff, 
the  founder  of  the  Sofia  University,  the  sum  of  20,000,000  francs  for  public 
purposes.  This  includes  6,000,000  francs  for  a  technical  school  for  Sofia.  The 
University  of  Lyons  will  devote  42,000  francs  to  complete  the  biological  labora- 
tory of  Tamaris,  near  Toulon,  and  will  probably  endow  it  to  a  moderate  extent. 
Indianapolis  will  receive  fifty-six  acres  of  land  for  a  botanical  garden  and  ornitho- 
logical preserve  from  Mr  W.  W.  Woolen.  Yale  University  has  received  $5000  by 
the  will  of  Miss  Julia  Lockwood  for  the  foundation  of  a  scholarship. 

The  University  Extension  Lectures  in  London  for  the  coming  session  were 
listed  by  The  Echo  on  October  5.  The  following  may  interest  some  of  our 
readers  : — The  Geography  of  Britain  and  the  British  Seas,  by  H.  J.  Mackinder, 
at  Gresham  College  ;  the  World's  Great  Explorers,  by  H.  Yule,  Oldham,  at 
Toynbee  Hall ;  Evolution  and  Darwinism,  by  E.  O.  Paskyn,  at  Lewisham  ; 
Physiology  of  Plants,  by  E.  O.  Paskyn,' at  Morley  College  ;  the  Earth,  by  F.  W. 
Rudler,  at  Croyden  and  Toynbee  Hall ;  Our  Common  Minerals,  by  F.  W.  Rudler, 
at  West  Ham  ;  and  Human  Anatomy,  by  Chalmers  Mitchell,  at  Toynbee  Hall. 

Miss  Kate  M.  Hall,  Curator  of  the  Whitechapel  Museum,  has  made  arrange- 
ments to  co-operate  with  the  teachers  of  the  elementary  schools  in  the  district  in 
demonstrations  to  their  classes  when  they  visit  the  Museum.  As  is  well-known, 
the  Code  of  1895  allows  visits  to  be  paid  during  school  hours  under  proper  guid- 
ance to  museums,  art  galleries,  and  other  institutions  of  educational  value,  such 
visits  being  counted  as  "attendances."  At  Whitechapel  each  headmaster  or  mis- 
tress is  invited  to  bring  one  assistant  and  forty-five  pupils  on  each  occasion.  The 
pupils  are  divided  into  three  groups,  the  teachers  and  Miss  Hall  each  taking  one. 
Such  specimens  as  may  be  removed  from  the  cases  are  arranged  on  three  tables. 


356  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [November 

Each  group  spends  a  quarter  of  an  hour  at  each  table,   and  the  rest  of  the 
hour  is  devoted  to  questions  or  to  a  general  survey  of  the  Museum. 

The  meeting  of  the  Botanical  Society  of  America,  which  was  held  at  Toronto 
at  the  time  of  the  visit  of  the  British  Association,  seems  to  have  been  a  great 
success.  Dr  J.  M.  Coulter  was  the  president,  and  there  were  present  a  large 
gathering  of  English  and  Foreign  botanists.  N.  L.  Britton  of  New  York  was 
chosen  president  for  1898,  which  session  will  be  held  in  Boston,  an  invitation 
from  the  Missouri  Botanic  Garden  for  the  spring  of  that  year  having  been 
reluctantly  declined.  The  chief  papers  were — A  case  of  ecblasteris  and  axial 
prolification  in  Lepidium  apetalum,  by  B.  L.  Robinson  ;  Movement  of  protoplasm 
in  coenocytic  hyphae,  by  J.  A.  Arthur  ;  Pollen  grains  and  antipodal  cells,  by 
J.  M.  Coulter  ;  The  transition  region  of  the  Caryophyllales,  by  F.  E.  Clements  ; 
A  revision  of  the  species  Picea  occurring  in  North-Eastern  America,  by  D.  P. 
Penhallow  ;  Bibliographic  difficulties,  by  E.  L.  Greene  ;  and  the  botanical  gardens 
of  Jamaica,  by  W.  Fawcett. 


1897]  357 


CORRESPONDENCE 


INHERITANCE  OF  ACQUIRED  CHARACTERS 

In  view  of  the  doctrine  which  constitutes  the  corner  -  stone  of  Prof.  Weismann's 
theories  of  heredity — the  non -inheritance  of  acquired  characters — any  exceptions  to  the 
rule  which  he  lays  down  may  be  worth  notice.  I  desire  to  submit  to  your  readers  for 
consideration  one  which  has  appeared  to  me  to  bear  upon  this  question — viz.,  the  direc- 
tion in  which  the  hairs  slope  on  the  extensor  surface  of  the  forearm  in  certain  hairy 
Quadrupeds  and  in  man.  The  course  which  the  hairs  take  on  this  small  area  varies  in 
ifferent  animals,  but,  as  far  as  I  can  learn,  in  two  main  directions  only.  In  the  first  of 
these,  which  one  may  look  upon  as  more  '  normal, '  the  slope  is  on  the  whole  directed 
in  the  axis  of  the  limb  towards  the  distal  extremity,  and  is  thus  in  keeping  with  the 
general  slope  of  hair  on  the  other  areas  of  this  and  the  posterior  extremity  of  the  animal, 
as  in  the  great  Ungulate  order  and  a  few  species  of  monkeys.  The  second  type  of  direc- 
tion presents  a  certain  reversal  of  the  slope — viz.,  that  the  hairs  after  a  mauus-ward 
course  on  the  flexor  surface  curve  round  the  lateral  borders  of  the  fore-arm,  and  when 
they  reach  the  extensor  surface  they  pass  in  a  reversed  direction,  in  some  animals  on  the 
whole  area,  in  others  on  the  proximal  portion  only,  towards  the  trunk.  This  second 
type  is  seen  clearly  in  man  at  all  ages,  in  the  anthropoid  apes,  especially  in  the  long- 
haired Orang,  to  an  extent  exceeding  any  other  animal  I  have  seen,  in  most  lower 
monkeys,  and  in  the  Carnivores.  In  the  last-named  order  the  direction  is  visible  in  the 
terrestrial  Carnivores,  Arctoidea,  Cynoidea  and  Aeluroidea,  especially  in  the  shorter- 
haired  forms,  but  in  those  with  longer  hair  on  the  limbs  the  general  set  of  hair  on  this 
area  is  towards  the  trunk,  even  if  indistinct  in  some.  It  is  the  second  of  these  types  to 
which  I  would  draw  attention  as  being  a  departure  from  the  first,  which  is  seen  in 
Ungulates,  and  which  is  more  in  accordance  with  the  natural  arrangement  of  hair.  In 
this  great  group  of  animals,  the  Ungulates,  there  is  a  very  general  habit  of  flexing  the 
fore-limb  in  the  attitude  of  repose,  as  one  sees  commonly  in  a  herd  of  cows  and  horses 
grazing,  when  these  limbs  lie  doubled  up  and  the  hoofs  are  resting  under  the  fore  part 
of  the  trunk.  The  same  position  can  be  observed  in  other  families  of  this  order  in  con- 
finement. A  similar  slope  of  hair  is  also  seen  in  certain  Marsupials,  Kangaroos,  for 
example  ;  and  in  these  animals,  which  almost  always  lie  on  their  sides  when  at  rest,  the 
position  would  be  indifferent  as  to  influence  upon  the  slope.  In  Ungulates  the  pressure 
thus  exercised  when  the  limb  is  in  acute  flexion  would  act  at  right  angles  to  the  axis  of 
the  limb,  and,  except  in  so  far  as  it  would  confirm  the  original  slope  of  the  hair  on  the 
extensor  surface,  it  would  be  indifferent  in  its  effect  on  the  hair-slope.  But  in  the 
Primates,  Carnivores,  and  certain  other  animals  in  which  the  surface  of  this  limb-seg- 
ment in  question  is  exposed  to  pressure  acting  in  a  different  manner,  one  is  not  surprised 
to  find  a  different  slope  of  hair.  In  Man  it  is  frequently  subject  to  pressure  against  some 
underlying  fixed  surface.  In  apes  and  monkeys  of  all  kinds  it  is  extremely  common  in 
their  sitting  posture  to  see  their  upper  extremities  strongly  flexed  at  the  elbow  and  rest- 
ing against  their  lower  limbs.  In  terrestrial  Carnivores  the  normal  attitude  of  repose 
is,  except  on  the  occasions  when  they  lie  •  asleep  stretched  out  on  their  sides,  that  the 
fore-limbs  are  planted  in  front  of  the  trunk,  seen  most  noticeably  in  the  '  couchant ' 
position  which  they  commonly  assume.  In  all  these  instances  it  is  obvious  that  there  is 
a  slowly  acting  mechanical  force  in  the  downward  and  forward  direction  by  reason  of  the 
weight  of  the  limb  itself,  and  the  fore  part  of  the  trunk  which  is  supported  by  it.  The 
effect  of  this  pressure  would  be  to  cause  the  hairs  to  slope  towards  the  trunk,  as  is  found 
to  be  the  case  in  these  animals.  There  are  of  course  many  apes  and  monkeys,  notably 
the  chimpanzee,  gorilla,  and  orang,  in  which  the  same  direction  is  taken  by  the  hairs  on 
other  aspects  of  the  same  limb  on  regions  where  no  pressure  can  influence  it.  In  these 
the  general  set  of  hair  towards  the  trunk  is  probably  due  in  part  to  the  effect  of  gravi- 
tation on  the  long  hair,  and  perhaps,  as  Mr  Wallace  has  suggested,  to  the  influence  of 
heavy  rain  in  tropical  forests  when  the  hair  would  act  to  the  body  as  thatch  does  to  the 
roof  of  a  house. 

The  direction  of  hair-slope  on  this  area  is,  of  course,  congenital  ;  it  is  therefore  a 
primary  character,  not  one  acquired  by  the  individual  through  secondary  forces.  It  is 
congenital  in  the  human  infant,  in  the  young  monkeys  and  young  Carnivores  which  I 
have  been  able  to  examine,  and  presumably  it  is  so  in  all  in  which  it  is  found. 


358  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [November 

The  consideration  of  this  point  leads  us  to  the  conclusion  that  the  character  before 
us  is  one  which  it  is  impossible  to  look  upon  as  having  any  '  survival- value,'  or  as  due  to 
any  form  of  selectional  processes  within  the  germ  acting  under  adaptive  requirements. 
An  adequate  secondary  cause  is  suggested  for  its  original  production  in  the  ancestors  of 
those  which  now  exhibit  it.  Perhaps  someone  more  qualified  to  speak  could  determine 
whether  or  not  this  is  one  of  the  exceptions  to  Prof.  Weismann's  rule,  the  non-in- 
heritance of  acquired  characters.  Walter  Kidd. 

12  MONTPELIER  ROW, 

Blackheath, S.E. 


INSECTS  AND  FLOWERS 

Without  at  this  time  attempting  to  discuss  the  general  arguments  used  by  Mr  Bulman 
in  his  interesting  paper  in  your  August  number,  I  should  like  to  draw  attention  to  the 
following  paragraph  (p.  103) : — 

"  Again,  if  our  native  flowers  are  the  result  of  the  selective  action  of  our  native  bees, 
and  those  which  they  have  specially  chosen  for  countless  generations,  how  is  it  that 
bees  take  so  readily  to  many  flowers  of  very  different  forms  introduced  into  our  gardens 
from  abroad  ?  For  such  introduced  plants  are  in  many  cases  freely  visited  by  native 
bees." 

I  think  we  need  more  information  about  this  matter.  I  have  found,  here  in  New 
Mexico,  that  garden  flowers  do  not  as  a  rule  attract  many  species  of  native  bees,  unless 
they  are  very  closely  related  to  native  flowers.  A  flower  garden  is  nearly  always  dis- 
appointing as  a  hunting-ground,  the  bees  found  there  being  mainly  certain  widely  dis- 
tributed types  which  visit  very  many  species  of  native  plants.  In  a  luxuriant  garden  at 
Santa  Fe  the  best  collecting  is  on  the  weeds,  not  at  all  on  the  cultivated  flowers. 

Solidago  canadensis  is  a  native  plant  very  common  in  New  Mexico.  It  is  also  grown  in 
gardens  in  Europe,  and  a  small  list  of  common  flies  visiting  it  there  is  given  by  Hermann 
Mailer.  In  Las  Cruces,  on  Aug.  30  of  this  year,  Prof.  C.  H.  T.  Townsend  was  sweeping 
S.  canadensis  for  flies.  He  swept  at  the  same  time  a  lot  of  hymenoptera,  which  he 
handed  to  me.     I  have  sorted  out  the  fossores  and  bees,  and  here  is  the  list : — 

Anthophila 

Agapostemon  melliventris,  Cress.    3  •  Nomia  nevadensis,  Cress. 

radiatus,  S&y.    6-  Melissodes  agilis,  Cress.  8  ■ 

Panurgus  rhodoceratus,  Ckll.  Perdita  sphaeralceae,  Ckll.,  one  6  • 

Colletes  americana,  Cress.  Epeolus  lunatics,  Say  vel  peraff. 

Ealictus  stultus,  Cress,  vel  peraff.  Podalirius  maculifrons,  Cress. 


ligatus,  Say. 
sp. 


Fossores 


Microbembex  monodonta,  Say.  Slizus  godmani,  Cam. 

Philanthus  vcntilabris  v.  frontalis,  Cress.  Aphilanthops  laticinctus,  Cress. 

,,  sp.  Ccrceris  acanthophilus,  Ckll. 

Stcniolia  dupiicata,  Prov.  Mijzinc  frontalis,  Cress.  M.  S.    9  . 
Oxybelus  quadricolor,  Ckll.  and  Baker,    $.  fj      hyalina,  Cress.    <$• 

,,       sparideus,  Ckll.  Anacrabro  boerhaaviai,  Ckll. 

,,       abdominalis,  Baker.    <$  •  (new  to  Paratiphia,  sp. 

N.  M.).  Scolia,  2  spp. 
sp. 
Plcnoculus  cockerellii,  Fox. 

I  have  on  former  occasions  done  equally  good  collecting  from  the  Solidago.  Who  can 
show  a  similar  list  in  Europe  collecting  from  the  same  plant  ?  I  doubt  if  it  can  be  done, 
yet  the  plant  belongs  to  a  European  genus,  and  is  much  less  specialised  for  insects  than 
many  others.  T.  D.  A.  Cockerell. 

Mesillo,  New  Mexico,  U.S.A., 
Sept.  3,  1897. 

*  I  suspect  that  this  came  from  a  Sphaeralcea  growing  among  the  Solidago,  especially  as  there  are 
in  the  lot  two  beetles  which  breed  on  Spiiaeralcea.  These  may,  however,  have  strayed  from  their  normal 
plant. 


1897]  CORRESPONDENCE  359 

WOMEN  versus  BIRDS 

In  Natural  Science  for  August  (p.  77),  the  question  is  asked  as  to  what  more  we  can  do 
besides  attempting  to  influence  women  in  the  home-circle  so  as  to  prevent  their  bar- 
barian slaughter  of  the  birds  for  decoration  of  themselves.  I  think  we  could  do  a  great 
deal  more,  and  will  instance  this  by  an  account  of  what  occurred  here  some  years  ago. 
A  Frenchman  settled  down  in  the  neighbourhood  of  Mount  Ophii  in  Malacca  as  a  col- 
lector of  bird  skins  for  the  trade.  He  employed  a  large  number  of  native  hunters,  and 
the  slaughter  of  our  most  beautiful  birds — sun-birds,  trogons,  fairy  bluebirds,  and  many 
others — was  horrible.  However,  the  Government,  on  learning  this,  passed  an  ordinance 
forbidding  the  killing  of  birds  in  the  colony  without  a  licence.  The  man  then  moved 
to  one  of  the  native  states  out  of  colonial  jurisdiction,  but  the  law  was  immediately 
introduced  there.  Then  it  is  said  he  sold  the  goodwill  of  the  business  to  an  unsuspect- 
ing native  and  disappeared.  The  native,  of  course,  on  attempting  to  carry  on  the 
business  was  arrested.  Since  then  our  birds  have  returned  to  their  desolated  haunts 
and  are  as  plentiful  as  ever,  and  no  further  attempt  has  been  made  to  establish  the  trade 
in  this  country.  Indeed,  I  can  hardly  remember  a  case  where  it  has  been  found  neces- 
sary to  put  the  law  in  force,  though,  of  course,  a  few  birds  are  now  and  then  illegally 
killed  by  shooters.  Of  course  we  are  much  assisted  by  the  licensing  of  guns.  Natives, 
for  excellent  reasons,  are  only  allowed  gun  licences  for  purposes  of  defence  against  tigers, 
robbers,  etc.,  or  to  keep  away  wild  pigs  or  other  destructive  animals,  and  this  checks 
bird-killing  very  well. 

In  Borneo,  under  British  rule  or  influence,  the  Mias  is  also  protected,  no  person 
being  allowed  to  kill  one  except  by  special  permit,  only  granted  for  scientific  purposes. 
And  licences  to  collect  orchids  are  also  issued  there  to  check  the  wholesale  destruction 
of  these  plants. 

The  forests  of  the  Dindings,  especially  one  jungle  round  a  hill  called  Gunong  Tungul, 
are  tenanted  by  rhinoceroses,  which  the  natives  used  to  trap  in  pitfalls.  As  the  animal 
is  perfectly  harmless,  and  a  very  interesting  beast,  the  District  Officer,  Mr  W.  C.  Mit- 
chell, endeavoured  to  prevent  its  destruction,  and  though  the  Government  did  not  see 
their  way  to  legislating  to  save  it,  he  succeeded  in  preventing  any  more  from  being 
killed.  The  Rhinoceros  is  considered  by  the  Chinese  as  a  very  valuable  medicine,  or 
rather  collection  of  medicines.  They  pay  large  sums  for  its  carcase,  and  dry  and  pre- 
pare every  bit  of  it  to  ship  to  China.  This  was  the  only  inducement  to  the  Malays  to 
kill  it.  Thanks  to  this  action  there  are  still  plenty  in  this  district,  where  I  have  more 
than  once  come  across  them,  or  heard  them  gallop  off  snorting  like  a  pony. 

Now,  for  the  trade  in  bird-skins  in  colonies  or  countries  under  British  influence  there 
can  be  no  excuse.  It  can  and  should  be  stopped  by  local  ordinance.  The  difficulty  lies 
in  countries  not  under  our  control,  such  as  Mexico,  Brazil  and  New  Guinea.  In  nearly 
all  these  places,  however,  there  are  naturalists,  and  often  Natural  History  Societies.  It 
should  be  the  duty  of  all  scientists  in  these  countries  to  bring  pressure  to  bear  upon 
their  Governments  to  check  or  prevent  the  trade  in  bird  skins.  Part  of  New  Guinea  is 
under  British  influence,  and  any  destruction  of  Birds  of  Paradise  here  could  be  pre- 
vented. The  naturalists  of  Holland  and  Germany  might  also  be  asked  to  approach 
their  Governments  on  the  subject,  and  to  stop  the  trade  in  their  Colonies. 

In  the  list  of  birds  destroyed  given  in  the  article  in  Natural  Science,  it  is  not  alto- 
gether easy  to  guess  from  what  part  of  the  world  the  skins  and  plumes  are  derived. 
Some  are  evidently  Indian — e.g.,  Peacock,  Indian  Parrots,  Impeyan  Pheasant,  &c.  ; 
others  Tanagers  and  Humming  Birds  from  South  America.  Let  our  naturalists  at  home 
first  trace  up  the  sources  of  the  supply,  and  then  those  in  the  countries  whence  the 
skins  come  can  be  appealed  to  to  bring  the  matter  before  their  respective  Governments. 
This  plan,  though  it  will  probably  not  entirely  stop  the  trade,  will  at  least  save  the 
birds  of  some  corners  of  the  world,  and  will  strike  a  blow  at  the  fashion  which  I  trust 
it  may  never  recover.  H.  N.  Ridley. 

Singapore,  April  25,  1897. 


AUSTRALIAN  NATURAL  HISTORY 

As  an  Australian  worker  I  trust  that  you  will  allow  me  to  protest  against  the  hostile 
criticism  of  an  Australian  student,  as  sucb,  by  a  London  authority,  as  such,  on  p.  5  of 
this  volume.  Criticism  of  Australian  work  upon  its  merits  will  always  be  welcome,  but 
when  a  reviewer  is  invoked  to  write  down  a  paper  because  if  a  certain  arrangement 
"was  not  made  it  ought  to  have  been  "  then  fair  play  is  disregarded  and  the  honest 
aims  of  criticism  made  subservient  to  less  worthy  ends.  For  it  is  evident  that  under 
ordinary  circumstances  the  brilliant  writer  of  your  editorial  would  not  have  stooped  to 
crush  a  weaker  brother  on  the  score  of  a  few  misprints,  and  the  difference  which  will 
ever  exist  in  their  view  of  what  constitutes  a  'species'  between  a  '  splitter '  and  a 
'  lumper.' 


360  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [November 

More  than  a  year  ago  three  naturalists  gathered  each  a  miscellaneous  collection  from 
a  Pacific  Atoll ;  two  of  these  went  direct  to  London,  the  third  to  Sydney.  Not  a  word 
has  as  yet  been  written  on  the  material  sent  to  England.  A  generation  since  Darwin 
complained,  in  sorrow  and  surprise,  that  he  could  not  secure  specialists  to  work  out  the 
results  of  his  South  American  journey.  To-day  boundless  wealth  of  material  pours  into 
London,  but  what  proportion  of  it  is  ever  studied  ?  There  is  no  lack  in  London  of 
material,  of  Pacific  material,  even  of  Funafuti  material  for  students  with  an  appetite  for 
work  :  yet  is  it  touched  ?  But  if  a  local  student  makes  an  honest  attempt  to  further 
the  cause  of  science,  a  bitter  cry  arises  from  the  British  Museum  specialist — defrauded 
of  his  rights  !  J.  Douglas  Ogilby. 

Livingstone  Road,  Petersham,  Sydney, 
25th  August  1897. 


FUNAFUTI 

In  the  first  paragraph  of  your  review  of  "  Australian  Museum  Memoir  III.  (on  Funafuti 
Atoll),  part  2,"  which  appeared  in  your  July  number,  is  a  statement  of  your  impression 
that  a  stipulation  had  been  made  for  the  Royal  Society  to  have  the  right  of  prior 
publication,  and  that  if  such  an  agreement  was  not  made  it  ought  to  have  been. 

I  am  directed  by  the  trustees  of  the  Australian  Museum  to  put  you  in  possession  of 
the  actual  facts  of  the  case ;  and,  as  your  statement  has  been  made  public,  to  request 
that  this  also  might  be  given  the  same  prominence. 

On  7th  April  1896  the  Local  Committee  in  Sydney,  representing  the  Royal  Society 
of  London,  asked  the  trustees  to  nominate  an  officer  to  accompany  Prof.  Sollas  on  the 
Expedition  to  Bore  a  Coral  Reef,  and  Mr  Charles  Hedley  was  appointed.  The  trustees 
were  informed  in  a  letter,  signed  by  the  Chairman  of  the  Local  Committee,  that  "in 
regard  to  the  secondary  objects,  that  is,  the  Collection  of  Specimens  of  Natural  History, 
each  member  of  the  expedition  will  be  at  liberty  to  retain  or  exchange  anything  he  may 
obtain.  The  expedition  as  an  undertaking,  therefore,  does  not  interfere  with  the  col- 
lections of  [Mr  Hedley].  Your  trustees  are  thus  at  liberty  to  impose  what  conditions 
they  think  best  upon  their  representative  in  this  respect."  In  addition  to  this,  the 
question  of  publication  was  raised  at  a  meeting  of  the  Local  Committee,  at  which  one  of 
the  trustees  of  the  Museum  and  the  curator  were  present  as  well  as  Prof.  Sollas,  and  the 
reply  was  that  no  restriction  would  be  placed  on  it. 

It  will  thus  be  seen  that,  in  taking  part  in  the  expedition,  a  stipulation  was 
made  beforehand  for  the  right  of  publication  of  the  results  obtained  by  the  trustees' 
representative. 

S.  Sinclair, 
Secretary  to  the  Trustees  of  the  Australian  Museum. 

Sydney,  8th  September  1897. 

[We  deeply  regret  that  information  which  we  had  from  two  independent  sources, 
believed  to  be  authoritative,  should  have  led  us  to  make  any  suggestion  of  unfairness  on 
the  part  of  our  friends  and  fellow-workers  in  Sydney.  A  correction  of  our  error  was 
published  before  the  various  Australian  protests  reached  us.  The  rest  of  our  remarks, 
whether  of  praise  or  blame,  remain  absolutely  unaffected  by  this  correction. — Ed. 
Nat.  Sci.] 

NOTICE 

To  Contributors. — All  Communications  to  be  addressed  to  the  Editor  of  Natural 
Science,  at  67  St  James'  Street,  London,  S.W.  Correspondence  and  Notes  intended 
for  any  particular  month  should  be  sent  in  not  later  than  the  10th  of  the  preceding 
month. 

To  the  Trade. — Natural  Science  is  published  on  the  25th  of  each  month  ;  all 
advertisements  should  be  in  the  Publishers'  hands  not  later  than  the  20th. 

To  our  Subscribers  and  Others. — There  are  now  published  Ten  Volumes  of 
Natural  Science.  Nos.  1,  8,  11,  12,  13,  20,  23,  24  being  out  of  print,  can  only  be 
supplied  in  the  set  of  first  Four  Volumes.  All  other  Nos.  can  still  be  supplied  at  One 
Shilling  each. 

Price  of  Set  of  Vols.  I.,  II.,  III.,  IV. 

„      V.,  VI.,  VII.,  VIII. 
,,  ,,  ,,       1.       Vill.  •  •  .  , 

One  Shilling  each  Number  of  any  Bookseller. 

Annual  Subscription,  payable  in  advance  to  J.  M.  Dent  &  Co.,  67  St  James'  Street, 
London,  S.W.,  Thirteen  Shillings  ($3  "50),  post  free. 


2 

10 

0 

1 

4 

0 

3 

10 

0 

NATURAL  SCIENCE 

A  Monthly  Review  of  Scientific  Progress 

No.  70— Vol.  XI— DECEMBER  1897 


NOTES  AND  COMMENTS 

The  Fauna  of  the  Deep  Sea 

One  of  the  most  important  publications  of  the  past  month  is  Dr 
Gunther's  Presidential  Address  to  the  Linnean  Society  of  London, 
just  issued  in  this  Society's  Proceedings.  It  is  a  critical  review  of 
our  present  knowledge  of  the  depths  of  the  sea,  by  one  who  has 
made  a  life-long  study  of  the  subject,  and  added  no  small  contribu- 
tions to  the  solution  of  the  problems  in  question  from  the  biologist's 
point  of  view.  Dr  Glinther  treats  the  subject  under  geographical 
headings,  being  of  opinion  that  this  arrangement  brings  out  some 
points  of  interest  more  prominently  than  a  general  historical  state- 
ment would  do.  He  is  careful,  however,  to  emphasise  the  fact  that 
he  still  believes  the  deep-sea  fauna  to  be  one  indivisible  whole  ; 
such  types  as  seem  to  be  characteristic  of  some  particular  region  of 
the  ocean  being  "accidentally  or  ignorantly  imported  into  the  deep- 
sea  fauna,"  or  else  forms  of  which  the  wide  range  has  not  yet  been 
ascertained. 

Among  the  many  interesting  points  discussed,  there  are  two 
expressions  of  opinion  of  great  importance  from  one  who  has  so 
many  qualifications  to  speak  authoritatively.  The  first  relates  to 
the  question  of  the  permanence  of  the  abyssal  ocean  depths ;  the 
other  refers  to  the  presence  or  absence  of  life  in  the  middle-depths 
of  the  oceanic  waters. 

Dr  Giinther  is  emphatically  in  favour  of  the  idea  that  the 
abysses  of  the  ocean  are  not  permanent,  but  may  well  have  changed 
many  times  in  the  past.  He  declares  that  the  opposite  view 
"cannot  be  accepted  by  the  student  of  the  terrestrial  fauna."  He 
remarks :  "  I  cannot  help  thinking  that  our  knowledge  of  the 
nature  of  the  rocks  at  the  bottom  of  the  sea  is,  at  present,  to  use  a 
mild  expression,  most  imperfect.  Is  it  not  possible  that  continental 
rocks  at  the  abyssal  sea-bottom  are  so  hidden  under  the  deposit 
which  has  been  in  progress  of  formation  for  untold  ages,  as  to  pre- 
vent us  from  penetrating  to  them  ?  Possibly  the  day  may  come 
when  borings  or  some  similar  operation  will  be  successfully  carried 

2  c 


362  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [December 

out  in  the  abysses,  entirely  upsetting  our  present  ideas  of  the  geo- 
logical nature  of  the  sea-bottom.  Besides,  we  have  no  other  means 
for  accounting  for  the  distribution  of  the  terrestrial  fauna,  more 
especially  in  the  southern  hemisphere,  except  by  assuming  that 
great  changes  have  taken  place  in  the  extent  and  position  of  conti- 
nental land,  and,  moreover,  that  these  changes  were  still  in  progress 
at  periods  at  which  our  present  fauna,  or  at  least  part  of  it,  was 
already  in  existence." 

The  question  of  the  existence  of  a  "  mid-water  fauna  "  is  con- 
sidered by.Dr  Giinther  to  be  still  an  open  one,  to  be  "  decided  only 
by  continued  tow-net  experiments  in  great  depths  of  the  open  ocean, 
with  a  bottom  of  clean  ooze  or  mud."  Agassiz,  as  is  well  known, 
maintains  that  there  is  no  such  fauna.  Dr  Giinther,  however, 
observes  that  the  experiments  of  the  distinguished  American 
naturalist  "  prove  too  much.  His  tow-nets  came  up  always  empty 
from  the  intermediate  zones.  It  is  very  singular  that  he  should 
not  have  caught  even  some  of  the  dead  bodies  which,  like  rain, 
drop  constantly  from  the  surface  to  the  bottom.  Further,  so  far  as 
fishes  are  concerned,  there  is  no  reason  why  certain  forms  should 
not  permanently  inhabit  intermediate  zones,  inasmuch  as  also  pelagic 
fishes  are  undoubtedly  free  swimmers  for  nearly  the  whole  of  their 
life,  without  being  tied  to  the  proximity  of  terra  firma.  The  ova  of 
many  species  which  live  in  the  mature  stage  at  the  bottom  of  great 
depths  are  pelagic,  and  hatched  at  or  near  the  surface.  The  young 
continue  to  live  for  some  time  under  pelagic  conditions  {Plagusiae, 
Lcptocephali,  Polyprion),  but  as  they  grow  they  descend  to  the  deep 
sea.  It  is  very  improbable  that  this  descent  is  rapid ;  it  must  be 
gradual  in  order  to  allow  the  physiological  functions  to  get  used  to 
abyssal  conditions ;  or,  in  other  words,  these  fish  must  live  for  some 
time  in  mid-water." 

Finally,  Dr  Giinther  adds  an  appropriate  plea  for  more  deep-sea 
work  in  the  Indian  Ocean  and  the  Antarctic  regions.  The  ordinary 
survey  of  the  sea's  round  British  India  is  now  nearly  completed,  but 
researches  on  the  fauna  have  only  proceeded  just  far  enough  to 
demonstrate  their  interest  and  biological  importance.  "  It  seems  a 
pity,"  as  Dr  Giinther  remarks,  "  that  while  the  experience  gained  on 
board  the  '  Investigator '  is  at  least  still  partly  available  in  the  ser- 
vice, no  further  benefit  should  accrue  from  it  for  science."  In  refer- 
ence to  the  Antarctic  Ocean,  he  points  out  that  our  knowledge  of 
its  abyssal  life  rests  merely  on  six  trawlings  of  the  '  Challenger.'  We 
trust  that  ere  long  the  British  Government  will  be  induced  to  help 
further  in  this  important  biological  work.  To  use  Dr  Giinther's 
words,  "  the  beneficial  influence  which  every  purely  scientific  under- 
taking exercises  upon  mankind  reaches  far  beyond  its  immediate 
aim."     Science  "  is  the  mother  as  well  as  the  daughter  of  peace." 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  363 

The  International  Zoological  Congress,  1898 

The  meeting  of  the  General  Committee  appointed  to  arrange  for  the 
next  meeting  of  the  International  Zoological  Congress  was  marked 
by  an  unfortunate  lack  of  union.  One  well-known  zoologist  described 
it  as  the  most  turbulent  meeting  he  had  ever  attended.  The  Congress 
is  to  meet  in  England  next  August,  and  the  original  arrangement  was 
that  it  should  be  held  in  London,  which,  for  various  reasons,  has  now 
been  altered  to  Cambridge.  The  success  of  a  similar  Congress  in 
America  in  1891  was  seriously  affected  by  a  change  in  the  place  of 
meeting,  which  led  to  the  abstention  of  a  great  number  of  American 
men  of  science,  who  objected  to  the  alteration.  Cambridge  does  not 
now  oeeupy  the  position  in  the  English  zoological  world  which  it  did 
in  the  days  of  F.  M.  Balfour.  There  are  no  doubt  strong  reasons 
for  the  selection  of  Cambridge,  although  the  town  is  not  central. 
But  remembering  the  consequences  of  the  change  of  locality  of  the 
American  Congress  in  1891,  the  advocates  of  Cambridge  might  have 
done  their  best  to  conciliate  provincial  representatives.  Their  attitude 
was  decidedly  the  reverse.  When,  for  example,  Colonel  Wardlaw 
Bamsay  proposed  that  in  order  to  secure  one  Scottish  member  on 
the  executive,  Sir  William  Turner  should  be  elected  a  vice-president, 
Professor  Newton  formed  the  minority  of  one  who  voted  against  it. 
Professor  Poulton,  also  anxious  to  make  the  committee  more  repre- 
sentative, proposed  that  the  presidents  of  the  Linnean  and  Entomo- 
logical Societies  should  be  ex  officio  vice-presidents,  which  secured  at 
once  the  warm  support  of  the  meeting.  The  chairman,  however, 
expressed  himself  confident  that  Mr  Poulton,  on  thinking  the 
question  over,  would  see  the  advisability  of  withdrawing  his  resolu- 
tion and  allowing  the  executive  committee  to  select  itself  the 
additions  to  its  number.  But  Mr  Poulton  remarked  that  he 
did  not  see  the  advisability  of  his  withdrawing  his  resolution,  and 
thought  it  much  better  not  to  trust  the  executive  committee  to  make 
the  additions  recommended.  The  resolution  was  carried  by  an  over- 
whelming majority.  So  the  cut  and  dried  plans  of  those  who  had 
arranged  the  agenda  were  not  accepted  quite  as  they  stood.  A 
member  who  proposed  one  of  the  official  resolutions  read  it  out  as 
"  the  resolution  I  have  been  '  instructed  '  to  propose  ; "  and  then  re- 
commended it  to  the  meeting  by  one  hostile  criticism.  Dr  Murie 
proposed  that  the  executive  committee  should  be  composed  of  an 
equal  number  of  members  from  England,  Ireland  and  Scotland,  a  re- 
markable suggestion  that  only  fell  non-seconded  because  the  zoologist 
who  attempted  the  feat  could  not  complete  his  sentence  until  the 
meeting  was  well  advanced  in  the  consideration  of  the  next  business. 
A  few  proposals  of  this  sort,  by  claim  for  zoological  independence  for 
Wales  and  the  Manxmen,  kept  the  meeting  merry.      But  it  seems 


364  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 

quite  clear  that  the  provincial  and  non-official  London  zoologists 
view  the  present  committee  with  suspicion,  as  not  sufficiently  repre- 
sentative of  British  zoology.  Sir  John  Lubbock  has  succeeded  Sir 
William  Flower  in  the  presidency,  and  he  may  be  trusted  to  prevent 
any  further  irritation  of  the  majority  by  a  tactless  disregard  of  its 
manifest  wishes.  It  is  a  source  of  the  deepest  regret  to  all  British 
zoologists  that  Sir  William  Flower  himself  should  be  compelled,  by 
need  of  rest,  to  refrain  from  any  active  part  in  the  arrangements. 

Stratigraphical  Geology 

In  connection  with  Sir  Henry  Howorth's  articles  on  Geological 
Nomenclature  which  we  are  now  publishing,  attention  may  be 
directed  to  a  paper  by  Dr  Charles  E.  Keyes,  recently  read  before 
the  St  Louis  Academy  of  Sciences,  and  abstracted  in  Science  for 
October  29  (n.s.,  vol.  vi.,  p.  655).  Dr  Keyes  declares  that  "  for  more 
than  a  score  of  years  that  branch  of  geology  called  stratigraphy  has 
been  practically  at  a  standstill.  Its  methods  are  the  same  that  were 
used  fifty  to  seventy-five  years  ago."  At  last,  however,  the  problems 
of  the  correlation  of  sedimentary  rocks  can  be  attacked  in  a  new  way 
suggested  by  the  field-work  of  many  American  geologists.  Organic 
remains,  it  appears,  may  now  be  entirely  omitted  from  consideration, 
and  the  relative  age  of  the  various  strata  can  be  determined  solely 
by  observing  the  succession  of  geographical  changes  in  the  various 
large  areas  under  comparison.  These  new  methods,  Dr  Keyes 
remarks,  are  more  or  less  complex  and  far  from  simple ;  but  he  is 
hopeful  that  they  will  eventually  lead  to  a  really  natural  classifica- 
tion of  the  rocks  and  definitely  put  an  end  to  what  has  been  aptly 
termed  '  parochial  geology.'  He  is  especially  sanguine  as  to  the 
value  of  the  results  to  be  obtained  from  a  detailed  study  of  the 
phenomena  of  mountain-formation.  We  cannot  follow  the  whole 
argument  from  the  brief  abstract ;  but  any  advance  in  methods 
which  will  enable  us  to  restore  the  geographical  features  of  wide 
areas  of  the  earth's  surface  at  different  successive  geological  periods 
will  not  only  make  a  new  era  in  geological  science  but  also  contri- 
bute most  materially  towards  the  solution  of  some  of  the  perplexing 
problems  of  zoology. 

The  Geology  of  Patagonia 

This  leads  us  to  refer  again  to  the  question  of  the  Tertiary  deposits 
of  Patagonia  and  their  remarkable  mammalian  fossils,  discussed  by 
Dr  Florentino  Ameghino  in  our  October  number  (p.  256).  Mr  J.  B. 
Hatcher,  who  has  spent  much  time  in  studying  this  southern  ex- 
tremity of  the  American  continent,  now  expresses  the  opinion  that 


NATURAL  SCIENCE,    VOL.   XL 


Plate  X. 


RESTORED   SKELETON   OF   AN   EXTINCT   STRUTHIOTJS    BIRD 

Aepyornis  liHrfi brandti 

From  a  Peat-deposit,  Strobe",  Central  Madagascar 

[Obtained  fur  the  British  Museum  {Natural  History)  by  Dr  Forsyth  Ma.tou] 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  365 

there  is  no  geological  basis  for  Ameghino's  asserted  discovery  of  the 
Cretaceous  ancestors  of  the  mammalia  in  that  region  (Amer.  Journ. 
Sci.  [4],  vol.  iv.,  pp.  327-354,  Nov.  1897).  He  finds,  apparently, 
Jurassic  rocks  there  on  the  Mayer  river ;  he  also  identifies  the  sup- 
posed Cretaceous  series  containing  Dinosaurian  bones.  When  in 
Patagonia,  however,  he  never  discovered  either  a  mammal  bone 
or  a  tooth  in  the  -  deposits  yielding  Dinosaurian  remains,  and  he 
arrived  at  the  conclusion  that  the  beds  containing  Pyrotherium  were 
not  only  later  than  these,  but  probably  more  recent  even  than 
the  Marine  Patagonian  Formation  itself.  His  words  are  : — "  It  is 
certainly  remarkable  that  in  these  beds  containing  Dinosaurian 
remains,  associated,  according  to  Ameghino,  with  the  remains  of 
mammals,  some  of  them,  as  for  example  Pyrotherium,  of  immense 
size,  only  a  little  less  than  that  of  the  elephant  and  consequently 
easily  to  be  seen,  I  could  have  searched  for  weeks  without  ever 
finding  a  single  mammalian  bone,  while  every  day  I  found  Dino- 
saurian remains." 

We  await  Dr  Ame°'hino's  observations  on  Mr  Hatcher's  results 
with  great  interest,  for  on  the  settlement  of  the  Patagonian  prob- 
lem great  issues  depend.  It  is  to  be  hoped  that  ere  long  some 
other  geologist  skilled  in  the  modern  methods  of  stratigraphy  will 
investigate  the  subject  and  give  us  another  independent  opinion. 

The  Aepyoenis  of  Madagascar 

We  have  several  times  referred  to  the  important  results  of  Dr 
Forsyth  Major's  explorations  and  researches  in  Madagascar.  We 
now  have  the  pleasure  of  directing  attention  to  the  latest  fruit  of 
his  labours  in  the  form  of  a  nearly  complete  skeleton  of  the  extinct 
struthious  bird,  Aejyyornis,  which  was  mounted'  for  exhibition  last 
month  in  the  public  galleries  of  the  British  Museum  (Natural  History), 
South  Kensington.  The  skeleton  is  shown  in  the  accompanying 
photograph  (Plate  X.),  for  which  we  are  indebted  to  the  courtesy  of 
the  Editor  of  the  Geological  Magazine,  and  it  was  described 
last  June  in  the  journal  just  mentioned  by  Mr  C.  W.  Andrews. 
The  bird  must  have  been  about  five  feet  in  height  when  alive,  so 
that  it  represents  one  of  the  smaller  species  of  the  genus.  The 
bones  do  not  belong  to  one  and  the  same  individual,  but  they  have 
been  selected  from  a  very  large  series  and  have  every  appearance  of 
giving  the  animal  its  correct  proportions.  The  skull  is  imperfect  in 
front,  but  the  top  of  the  brain-case  is  marked  with  rows  of  deep 
pits,  which  appear  to  indicate  the  original  presence  of  a  crest  of 
large  feathers.  The  mandible  is  very  stout.  The  vertebral  column, 
as  reconstructed,  consists  of  twenty  true  cervicals  and  eight  vertebrae 
bearing  free  ribs ;  the  fused  pelvic  vertebrae  are  about  twenty  in 


36G  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 

number.  The  sternum,  or  breast  bone,  is  very  short  and  broad,, 
while  the  coraco-scapula  is  much  like  that  of  a  cassowary.  The 
wing  is  reduced  to  a  mere  rudiment,  namely  a  small  humerus  and 
one  other  bone  which  seems  to  represent  the  whole  of  the  rest  of 
the  limb.  The  hind-limb  has  three  toes,  and  there  also  seems  to 
have  been  a  rudimentary  hallux,  though  this  has  not  yet  been 
found.  The  specimen  in  the  Museum  is  appropriately  placed  by 
the  side  of  JDinornis  and  the  ostrich,  and  is  one  of  the  most  striking 
additions  to  the  collection  of  fossil  birds  acquired  during  recent 
years. 

Swedish  Arctic  Exploration 

We  are  very  glad  to  learn  that  the  Swedish  Arctic  expedition, 
which  Prof.  A.  G.  Nathorst  has  been  advocating  for  some  time,  is 
likely  to  take  definite  shape  next  year.  The  necessary  means  have 
at  last  been  procured,  thanks  chiefly  to  the  liberality  of  King  Oscar 
and  the  late  Baron  Oscar  Dickson.  The  main  objects  of  the  expedi- 
tion, Prof.  Nathorst  informs  us,  are  the  scientific,  and  especially 
the  geological,  investigation  of  the  east  coast  of  Spitzbergen,  which 
as  yet  is  very  little  known  ;  the  charting  and  exploration  of  Kung 
Karl's  Land  ;  and,  should  time  permit,  of  the  little  known  islands 
between  Spitzbergen  and  Franz  Josef  Land.  It  is  proposed  to  take 
an  observer  specially  familiar  with  the  study  of  recent  land  move- 
ments and  glacial  action,  a  botanist,  two  zoologists,  who  amongst 
other  things  will,  together  with  the  hydrographer,  make  observations 
on  the  plankton ;  the  hydrographer  will  also  be  a  meteorologist. 
In  addition  there  will  be  a  combined  cartographer  and  photographer, 
and  a  specialist  in  degree-measurement.  An  arc  of  the  meridian 
will  be  carefully  measured  on  the  east  coast  of  Spitzbergen,  but 
during  the  course  of  one  summer  it  will  only  be  possible  to  make 
the  preliminary  studies  for  this  work.  Professor  Nathorst  himself 
will  continue  his  previous  studies  in  both  the  botany  and  geology  of 
the  region,  as  well  as  having  the  command  of  the  expedition.  He 
hopes  to  be  able  to  take  three  scientific  helpers  in  addition  to  those 
mentioned,  but  this  will  depend  on  the  size  of  the  vessel  that  is 
obtained. 

With  the  notable  exception  of  Andree's  bold  attempt,  Sweden 
has  of  late  not  taken  her  usual  share  in  Polar  exploration,  but  the 
names  of  Torell,  Loven,  Nordenskibld,  and  other  Swedes  are  so 
intimately  connected  with  Spitzbergen  that  the  forthcoming  expedi- 
tion is  but  the  natural  sequel  to  a  long  series  of  scientific  voyages. 
With  the  fresh  forces  now  at  his  command  for  attacking  the  prob- 
lems of  the  Arctic  seas,  Professor  Nathorst  may  expect,  and  we 
sincerely  hope  that  he  will  meet  with,  even  more  success  than  his 
predecessors. 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  3G7 

American   Fossil  Brachiopoda 

Despite  the  many  valuable  monographs  that  have  been  issued  of 
late  years  by  our  American  colleagues,  the  study  of  the  fossil 
Brachiopoda  has  hitherto  been  a  task  to  be  undertaken  with  trepi- 
dation. The  labours  of  James  Hall,  J.  M.  Clarke,  C.  E.  Beecher, 
and  Charles  Schuchert  have  considerably  changed  our  views  as  to  the 
inter-relationship  and  classification  of  these  animals,  and  have 
rendered  necessary  extensive  revision  of  nomenclature.  But  while 
we  had  an  uneasy  feeling  that  the  names  in  our  text-books  and  the 
labels  in  our  museums  were  of  too  ancient  a  kind,  we  shrank  from 
the  difficult  duty  of  resorting  and  renaming.  The  magician  prepared 
to  substitute  new  lamps  for  old  arises  in  the  person  of  Mr  Charles 
Schuchert,  who  essays  the  task  for  the  American  fossil  species  ;  and, 
since  North  America  seems  to  have  been  the  gathering-place  of  the 
brachiopod  clans  in  Palaeozoic  times,  much  of  this  welcome  light  is 
also  available  for  European  species. 

The  book  that  forms  the  necessary  keystone  to  previous  writ- 
ings is  entitled  "  A  Synopsis  of  American  fossil  Brachiopoda,  including 
bibliography  and  synonymy,"  and  has  just  been  issued  from  "Wash- 
ington as  Bulletin,  No.  87,  of  the  United  States  Geological  Survey. 
It  has,  however,  been  prepared  after  official  hours,  and  represents 
the  work  of  eleven  years.  The  main  part  of  the  book  is  the  "  Index 
and  Bibliography  of  American  fossil  Brachiopoda ; "  which  occupies 
227  pages  and  contains  about  10,000  references.  All  names  that 
have  ever  been  applied,  rightly  or  wrongly,  to  fossil  brachiopods  of 
North  and  South  America,  are  here  given  in  alphabetical  order.  The 
names  accepted  by  the  author,  after  careful  research,  as  valid,  are 
printed  in  bolder  type,  and  under  each  is  given  the  geological  age, 
chief  localities,  and  a  list  of  synonyms.  Under  each  generic  name  is 
quoted  the  name  of  the  species,  whether  American  or  not,  that 
served  as  the  original  type  of  the  genus  ;  Mr  Schuchert  calls  this  the 
'  genotype.' 

The  index  is  preceded  by  some  useful  and  interesting  chapters 
on  general  questions,  accompanied  by  some  elaborate  tables.  These 
chapters  are  : — "  I.  Geologic  development  and  geographic  distribution 
of  American  fossil  Brachiopoda."  "  II.  Brachiopod  terminology, 
applied  to  fossil  forms " — practically  an  alphabetical  glossary  of 
terms.  "  III.  Biologic  development  of  the  Brachiopoda  " — an  ex- 
ceedingly important  chapter.  "  IV.  Morphology  of  the  Brachia," 
contributed  by  Dr  C.  E.  Beecher.  "  V.  Classification  of  the 
Brachiopoda,"  in  which  the  point  of  chief  importance  is  the  entire 
dismissal  of  the  old  division  into  Lyopomata  and  Arthropomata 
(  =  Inarticulata  and  Articulata),  as  discordant  with  the  facts  of  race- 
development. 


36S  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 

While  this  book  will,  as  we  have  said,  be  an  important  aid  to 
students  of  the  European  fossil  brachiopods,  it  by  no  means  fills  the 
gap  that  has  long  yawned  before  them.  A  corresponding  European 
work  is  greatly  to  be  desired.  E.  Beclard  began  something  of  the 
kind,  but  death  has  stopped  his  energetic  research.  In  England  we 
hardly  take  our  fair  share  in  the  production  of  these  useful  biblio- 
graphic lists  of  recent  or  fossil  organisms  ;  and  yet  their  publication 
would  prevent  many  of  the  descriptions  of  supposed  new  species 
that  are  constantly  being  thrust  upon  us.  Once  upon  a  time  there 
was  a  great  flourish  of  trumpets  over  a  new  edition  of  Morris' 
"  Catalogue  of  British  Fossils  "  as  a  memorial  to  that  geologist,  but 
though  the  talkers  were  many  the  labourers  were  few.  Surely  the 
scheme  might  be  undertaken  by  half  a  dozen  really  serious  workers, 
and  brought  up  to  the  end  of  the  century. 

To  return  to  Mr  Schuchert.  We  can  do  no  more  than  thank 
him  for  the  result  of  his  labours  :  he  has  given  us  a  key  to  the 
writings  of  the  last  two  decades,  he  has  simplified  our  researches, 
and  has  taken  a  heavy  load  off  our  minds.  We  congratulate  him 
on  the  completion  of  his  task,  and  are  glad  to  place  another  solid 
contribution  to  zoological  literature  on  our  bookshelves. 


Wasps  and  Weather 

On  two  previous  occasions  {Natural  Science,  Vol.  iii.,  pp.  273-275, 
and  vi.,  pp.  178-179)  Mr  Oswald  H.  Latter  has  called  attention  in 
these  pages  to  an  apparent  connection  between  abundance  or  scarcity 
of  wasps  and  certain  meteorological  phenomena.  Briefly,  his  con- 
clusion then  was — (1)  that  wasps  were  favoured  by  dry  springs  and 
early  summer,  while  if  these  seasons  were  wet  wasps  were  scarce 
in  the  later  summer  and  autumn ;  (2)  that  low  temperature  during 
the  winter  and  early  spring  had  little  or  no  effect.  He  now  favours 
us  with  a  supplementary  communication,  pointing  out  how  his  obser- 
vations and  enquiries  during  the  present  year  confirm  his  earlier 
conclusions.  "  A  complete  survey,"  he  remarks,  "  must  begin  with 
September  1896  :  this  was  the  wettest  September  known  for  many 
years,  the  rainfall  at  Godalming  amounting  to  7'12  inches;  from 
that  month  up  to  the  end  of  May  of  the  present  year  the  rainfall 
for  every  month,  except  November,  was  considerably  in  excess  of 
the  average,  while  that  of  March  amounted  to  5'01  inches.  The 
total  rainfall  for  the  nine  months,  September  1896  to  May  1897, 
amounted  to  30*38  inches,  which  is  rather  more  than  2h  inches  in 
excess  of  the  annual  rainfall.  Thus  the  period  of  hibernation  and 
nest-founding  among  wasps  was  extremely  rainy.  The  temperature 
of  these  months,  notably  that  of  February  and  March,  was  decidedly 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  369 

above  the  average,  and  thus  many  Queens  were  early  tempted  from 
their  winter  quarters.  Turning  now  to  the  numbers  of  wasps 
observed — in  spring  there  were  many  '  Queens  '  to  be  seen,  and 
many  persons  observed  to  me  that  we  might  expect  a  recurrence  of 
the  '  plague '  of  1893.  This  prediction  was  entirely  falsified,  for  in 
all  parts  of  the  country  wasps  were  conspicuously  absent  during 
August  and  September.  My  own  observations  on  this  point  were 
conducted  in  Surrey,  Hampshire,  Norfolk,  Hertfordshire,  and  Kent, 
and  I  am  informed  by  friends  that  the  same  was  noticeable  in  Scot- 
land, Lancashire,  and  Somersetshire.  These  facts  seem  to  me 
sufficiently  conclusive  of  the  truth  of  my  former  conclusion,  and  I 
should  esteem  it  a  favour  to  be  allowed  to  invite  information  from 
any  of  your  readers  whose  experience  may  perhaps,  during  the  past 
year,  have  furnished  further  evidence  in  the  same  or  the  opposite 
direction." 

Models  of  Cells 

Prof.  A.  L.  Herrera  has  recently  published  in  the  Memorias  y 
Eevista  dc  la  Sociedad  Cicntifica  'Antonio  Alzate,'  Mexico,  1897, 
two  interesting  essays,  in  which  he  describes  some  attempts  of  his 
to  make  working  models  of  the  impact  of  forces  upon  cells  and 
protoplasm.  He  points  out  that  in  the  part  of  physiology  dealing 
with  the  elaborate  mechanisms  of  higher  animals  the  construction 
of  models,  such  as  those  to  illustrate  the  flight  of  insects  or  the 
action  of  the  valves  of  the  heart,  has  been  useful ;  and  he  attempts 
to  apply  the  same  principle  to  the  fundamental  phenomena  of 
protoplasm.  To  a  certain  extent  he  has  been  anticipated  by 
Butschli  and  others,  and  we  are  bound  to  admit  that  his  working 
models  are  of  coarser  texture  and  apparently  less  adapted  to  the 
delicate  reaction  of  protoplasm  than  the  oil  foams  of  his  predeces- 
sors. None  the  less,  many  of  his  experiments  are  interesting  and 
ingenious,  and  may  serve  a  useful  purpose  in  kindergarten  science. 
In  the  first  essay,  entitled  '  Los  Infusorios  Artificiales,'  he  tries  to 
explain  vibratile  movements  of  cilia  by  means  of  elastic  tubes  con- 
taining diffusible  liquids  and  placed  in  other  liquids.  His  idea 
appears  to  be  that  osmosis  currents  between  protoplasm  and  water 
and  the  stresses  produced  in  the  elastic  cell-wall  set  up  the  vibra- 
tions. In  the  second  essay,  written  in  French,  he  describes  a  series 
of  experiments  showing  the  reaction  of  elastic  spherical  bodies  to 
pressure  by  the  elastic  surfaces.  He  obtained  a  number  of  results 
strikingly  resembling  known  animal  and  plant  forms.  We  com- 
mend his  essays  to  the  curious. 


370  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 

A  New  Scientific  Serial  from  Jamaica 

As  we  briefly  announced  last  month  (p.  351),  Jamaica  furnishes  us 
with  one  more  promising  infant  in  an  over-populated  world  of 
scientific  literature  !  To  such  a  new-born  child  it  can  scarcely  be 
said,  "  weeping  thou  sat'st  while  all  around  thee  smiled,"  for,  while 
the  infant  chuckles,  distracted  naturalists  shed  inky  tears.  It 
might  sound  rude  to  say  that  all  such  babes  must  come  to  the 
workhouse.  To  the  house  in  which  the  specialist  works  sooner  or 
later  they  have  to  come.  If  every  name  in  the  atlas  of  the  world 
insists  upon  having  its  own  separate  representative  in  serial  scientific 
literature,  the  wasteful  dissipation  of  energy  will  increase  in  a 
lamentable  degree.  The  diligence  of  the  student  will  be  more  and 
more  exhausted  in  a  vain  attempt  to  garner  all  the  scattered 
fragments  of  information,  which  may  or  may  not  be  of  value, 
concerning  each  strictly  limited  branch  of  enquiry.  It  is,  therefore, 
only  with  a  moderate  rapture  of  welcome  that  we  can  greet  this 
first  number  of  the  Annals  of  the  Institute  of  Jamaica. 

The  opening  number  is  entirely  devoted  to  a  list  of  crustaceans. 
Faunistic  catalogues  are  not  unfrequently  a  weary  waste  of  mis- 
applied industry.  They  often  contain  no  guarantee  whatever  that 
the  author  knows  what  he  is  writing  about.  When  the  identifica- 
tions are  original,  they  are  as  likely  as  not  to  be  wrong  ;  when  they 
are  borrowed,  they  are  not  ver}*-  unlikely  to  be  the  endorsement  of 
some  ancient  error.  Miss  Eathbun's  "  List  of  the  Decapod  Crustacea 
of  Jamaica  "  stands  on  a  different  footing,  because  she  happens  to 
combine  with  a  very  exact  knowledge  of  the  objects  catalogued  a 
full  and  accurate  acquaintance  with  the  literature  of  the  subject. 
The  list,  therefore,  is  a  critical  list,  and  great  confidence  may  be 
placed  in  the  names  and  synonyms  and  geographical  distribution  of 
species  which  it  records.  But  it  also  contains  notes  and  descriptions 
of  independent  importance.  Some  of  these  are  quoted  at  full  length, 
though  without  marks  of  quotation,  from  earlier  papers,  while  others 
contain  corrections  of  previously  published  opinions.  Surely  in  the 
interests  of  science  the  repetitions  would  have  been  better  omitted, 
and  still  more  surely  in  the  interests  of  science  the  corrections 
would  have  better  appeared  in  the  Proceedings  which  published  the 
original  statements. 

While  placing  the  highest  value  on  Miss  Rathbun's  knowledge 
and  acumen,  we  cannot  always  accept  her  decisions  on  points  of 
nomenclature.  The  name  Stenorynclius  scticomis  (Herbst)  should 
stand,  whether  Slabber  were  right  or  wrong  in  stating  that  his 
specimen  came  from  the  East  Indies.  He  appears  to  have  kept  his 
East  and  West  Indian  crabs  together,  and  may  have  made  some 
confusion,  and  if  not,  as  the  present  list  shows,  the  same  species  of 


1897]  NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  371 

crab  may  occur  in  both  the  Indies.  In  naming  Uca  heterochela 
(Lamarck),  the  change  from  Lamarck's  more  scholarly  hetcrocltdos  is 
unneeded,  since  the  Greek  irs^jjXo;  applies  equally  to  the  masculine 
and  feminine  genders.  In  dealing  with  the  genus  Palaemon,  Miss 
Rathbun  unhappily  relies  on  Latreille's  '  Considerations  generates  ' 
of  1810,  a  book  with  a  long-winded  title  too  troublesome  to  quote, 
a  book  crowded  with  definitions  that  don't  define,  and  endimr  with 
a  list  of  types  that  are  not  described. 

A  Year-Book  of  Agriculture 

The  Year-Book  of  the  U.S.  Department  of  Agriculture  for   1896 
has  just  reached    us,  and    set  us  wondering  why  we  have  not  a 
Department   of  Agriculture    manned    by   scientific    experts,   which 
might  issue   each  year   for  the  benefit  of  farmers  and    others   in- 
terested in  the  subject  as  much  useful  matter  as  is  contained  in 
the  six  hundred  odd  pages  of  the  Transatlantic  publication.      The 
history  of  the  year-book  is  this.      It  is  the  successor  of  the  Agri- 
cultural Beport  which,  in  its  original   form,  was   made  up  almost 
wholly  of  business  reports  for  the  use  of  Congress.      When,  how- 
ever, it  began  to  circulate   more   freely  among  farmers,  papers  on 
agriculture,  and  discussions  on  the  results  of  scientific  investigations 
were  introduced,  and  it  gradually  became  more  and  more  a  popular 
report,  business  and  executive  matter  being  reduced  to  the  smallest 
possible  proportion,  till  finally  it  was  decided  (in   1895)  to  issue 
it  in  two  parts — viz.  (1)  an  executive  and  business  report,  (2)  a 
volume   of   papers   "  specially   suited   to   interest   and   instruct  the 
farmers  of  the  country,"  and  to  include  also  "  a  general  report  of 
the   operations   of    the    Department   for   their   information."     This 
second  part  is  the  Year-Book,  and   the  one  now  before  us  is  the 
third  of  the  series.      It  is  published  in  an  edition  of  500,000  copies 
for  free  distributing,  and   is   therefore,   as   the   assistant   secretary 
remarks   in   the   preface,  "  in    many   respects    unique."     Following 
the  report  of  the  Secretary,  which  occupies  nearly  fifty  pages  and 
is  eminently  suggestive,  are  thirty  papers  (filling   500   pages)  con- 
tributed by  nearly  as  many  scientific  expert  members  of  the  staff. 
The  164  figures  and  six  plates  are  a  useful   addition.      Thus  the 
value    of    a   paper   on    some    common    poisonous    plants    is    much 
enhanced  by  very  passable  pictures  of  the  poison  ivy  {Rhusradicans), 
water  hemlock   (Cicuta  maculata),  death  cup  {Amanita  phaUoides), 
and  others.      The   same  applies  to  some  remarks  by  Mr  Herbert 
Webber    on    the     influence     of     environment    on    plant    varieties. 
Enumeration  of  some  of  the  titles  will  give  an  idea   of  the  wide 
scope   of    the   Year-Book : — extermination    of   noxious   animals   by 
bounties — potash    and    its    function    in    agriculture — the    country 


372  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 

slaughter-house  as  a  factor  in  the  spread  of  disease — the  blue  jay 
and  its  food — migration  of  weeds — diseases  of  shade  and  orna- 
mental trees — care  of  dairy  utensils — and  finally  one  by  M.  E. 
Tisseraud,  Councillor  of  State  and  Director  of  Agriculture  of  France, 
entitled,  An  Ideal  Department  of  Agriculture  and  Industries,  which 
is  reprinted  from  a  report  of  a  House  of  Commons  committee  on 
the  establishment  of  a  Department  of  Agriculture  and  Industries 
for  Ireland !  An  appendix  of  one  hundred  pages  includes  an 
account  of  the  organisation  of  the  Department  of  Agriculture, 
copious  statistics  of  crops,  exports,  imports,  and  numerous  items 
of  useful  information. 

An  Ideal  Agriculture  Department 

We  make  no  apology  for  remarks  on  Agriculture,  which  is  only 
practical  Natural  Science  on  a  large  scale,  pursued  for  the  best 
possible  object — the  benefit  of  the  race.  In  the  paper  to  which  we 
have  just  referred  M.  Tisseraud  raises  certain  points  which  are 
worthy  of  emphasis.  The  agriculture  of  Europe,  like  an  old  and 
leaking  ship,  tossed  and  buffeted  on  a  sea  of  breakers,  needs,  to  save 
it  from  foundering,  to  be  steered  by  abler  hands  and  navigated  by 
pilots  who  will  join  to  a  thorough  practical  training  a  profound  and 
extensive  knowledge — scientific  knowledge.  Hence  the  need  for  a 
Ministry  of  Agriculture ;  not  a  sort  of  Providence  on  which  all  may 
lean,  and  which  by  a  series  of  miracles  can  supply  remedies  for  all 
evils,  nor  a  central  authority  which  shall  absorb  all  services  and 
assume  the  functions  of  private  individuals  and  voluntary  associa- 
tions, but  an  authority  which  shall  tend  to  awaken  the  spirit  of 
initiative  and  independence,  and  to  stimulate  and  develop  it  among 
the  agriculturists  themselves.  M.  Tisseraud  refers  to  the  methods 
of  control,  in  France,  where  by  co-operation  with  local  societies  and 
associations,  the  encouragement  of  private  agricultural  schools,  and 
the  establishment,  with  the  assistance  of  skilful  farmers,  of  from 
3000  to  4000  'champs  de  demonstration'  each  year,  the  State  is 
able  to  accomplish  an  enormous  amount  of  good  with  a  very  little 
expenditure. 

Another  task  of  a  ministry  of  agriculture  is  to  induce  the  most 
eminent  scientists  to  occupy  themselves  with  agricultural  questions. 
It  "  must  not  be  niggardly  in  its  encouragements  and  subsidies  to 
such  men.  for  their  discoveries  will  repay,  with  large  interest,  the 
expenditure  which  may  have  been  incurred  to  enable  them  to  carry 
on  their  researches."  By  this  means  there  will  be  prepared  for 
agriculture  "  an  elite  of  men  to  direct  it  in  the  way  of  progress  and 
of  the  application  of  science."  The  Minister,  in  the  nature  of 
things  as  at  present  constituted,  must   lie   a  politician,  but  not  so 


1897' 


NOTES  AND  COMMENTS  373 


the  men  at  the  head  of  the  different  divisions  of  the  department, 
who  should  unite  to  a  great  experience  of  administration  profound 
technical  knowledge  and  an  incontestable  authority  in  the  questions 
with  which  they  have  to  deal,  and  whose  office  should  be  of  a  per- 
manent character.  Such  a  director  must  have  the  choosing  of  the 
stal't'  placed  under  his  orders.  He  must  be  their  master,  and  be 
able  to  reward  those  who  show  merit  and  zeal,  and  to  remove  or 
punish  those  who  cannot  or  do  not  properly  discharge  their  duties. 
"  Let  the  director  himself  be  absolutely  responsible  for  the  good 
working  of  his  department,  and  let  him  be  replaced  if  he  proves 
inefficient."  Finally,  M.  Tisseraud  suggests  the  appointment  of 
scientific  counsellors  selected  from  the  most  distinguished  agricul- 
turists and  men  of  science,  and  technical  committees  of  professional 
men,  specialists,  and  practical  experts,  from  whom  the  Minister  may 
obtain  "  trustworthy  advice  and  indispensable  light  for  rightly 
seeing,  and  judging,  and  forming  in  full  security  the  decisions 
which  concern  the  department  over  which  he  presides." 


Catalogue  of  Fibre  Plants 

ANOTHER  excellent  specimen  of  the  work  of  the  United  States  De- 
partment of  Agriculture  comes  to  hand  almost  while  writing  the 
above.  It  is  a  descriptive  list  of  useful  fibre  plants  of  the  world  by 
C.  E.  Dodge,  special  agent  in  charge  of  fibre  investigations.  More 
than  a  thousand  kinds  are  enumerated  under  the  botanical  names  of 
the  plants  producing  them,  while  common  and  native  names  are  also 
included  in  the  alphabetical  arrangement.  The  book  is  a  large 
octavo  of  360  pages;  there  are  more  than  one  hundred  figures 
in  the  text,  and  thirteen  excellent  photographic  plates  showing  the 
habits  of  the  various  plants.  Much  information  is  given  about  the 
more  important  kinds,  including  the  structure  and  properties  of  the 
actual  fibre,  the  source  and  method  of  cultivation  of  the  plant,  the 
preparation  of  the  fibre,  and  references  to  the  literature.  The  great 
number  of  native  names  possessed  by  some  species  is  evidence  of 
their  long  use.  New  Zealand  flax  (Phormium  tenax),  a  liliaceous 
plant,  has  nearly  sixty  native  names.  Captain  Cook,  who  first 
brought  it  to  the  notice  of  Europeans,  found  it  in  common  us< 
among  the  aboriginal  New  Zealanders ;  he  speaks  of  it  as  "  a  grass 
plant  like  flags,  the  nature  of  flax  or  hemp,  but  superior  in  quality 
to  either,  of  which  the  natives  make  clothing,  lines,  etc."  Mr  Dodge 
gives  in  a  useful  introduction  a  general  account  of  the  history, 
chemistry,  and  structure  of  fibres,  and  suggests  also  a  classification. 
His  system  of  arrangement  serves  to  show  what  very  various  parts 
of  the  plant  are  used  for  the  purpose ;  for  it  includes  not  only  true 


374  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 

fibres  derived  from  the  wood  or  bast  tissue  respectively,  but  whole 
stems,  roots  or  leaves,  or  split  and  shredded  leaves,  as  well  as  ex- 
ternal hair-like  growths,  such  as  cotton,  and  also  a  class  of  "  pseudo- 
fibres."  The  last  comprises  certain  mosses,  like  Sphagnum,  used  for 
packing,  seaweed  wrought  into  lines  or  cordage,  and  the  mycelium 
of  certain  fun^i.  The  book  will  be  a  welcome  addition  to  the 
libraries  of  individuals  and  institutions  interested  in  economic 
botany.  To  enhance  the  value  of  future  editions,  the  author 
requests  notes  or  further  information  on  any  fibre  plants,  and 
especially  photographs  of  foreign  species. 


Wing  Neuration  in  the  Lepidoptera 

Mr  A.  Eadcliffe  Grote  has  been  insisting  both  in  German  (///. 
Wochenschr.  f.  Entomologie,  band  II.,  no.  28),  and  in  English  (Entom. 
Record,  vol.  ix.,  no.  10)  on  the  advantage  of  employing  photography 
in  the  illustration  of  the  wing-nervures  of  moths  and  butterflies,  as 
by  this  means  only  can  absolute  accuracy  be  ensured.  British 
entomologists  will  be  specially  interested  by  Mr  Grote's  severe 
strictures  on  Mr  Meyrick's  descriptions  and  drawings  of  wing- 
neuration  in  his  revision  of  the  Geometridae  {Trans.  Ent.  Soc,  1892) 
and  his  recent  "  Handbook  of  British  Lepidoptera."  Comparison  of 
Mr  Meyrick's  figures  with  the  photographs  have  led  Mr  Grote  to  the 
conclusion  that  in  the  former  "  the  distances,  relative  direction,  and 
at  times  the  point  of  origin  are  frequently  all  wrong.  Worse  than 
this,  Mr  Meyrick  supplies  nervures  which  have  no  existence  .  .  . 
and  omits  nervures  .  .  .  which  are  distinct  in  nature."  We  await 
with  interest  Mr  Meyrick's  reply  to  this  criticism. 


591.9  375 


The  Problems  of  the  British  Fauna 

IN  the  current  volume  of  Natural  Science  (pp.  223-4)  appeared  a 
short  editorial  comment  on  my  friend  Dr  E.  F.  Scharffs  paper 
on  the  Origin  of  the  European  Fauna.1  The  Editor  has  misunder- 
stood Dr  Scharffs  views  in  several  particulars,  and  has  nevertheless 
expressed  the  fear  that  his  "speculations  will  prejudice  the  use  of 
zoological  distribution  in  geological  investigations."  As  the  prob- 
lems raised  are  of  great  interest  to  all  naturalists,  a  further 
examination  of  the  subject  may  perhaps  be  allowed.  It  is  some- 
what unfortunate  that  the  present  writer  approaches  the  ques- 
tion from  the  same  standpoint  as  that  of  Dr  Scharff- — zoological 
geography.  But  it  is  to  be  hoped  that  some  of  the  special  students 
of  our  Pliocene  and  Pleistocene  deposits  will,  in  due  course,  favour 
us  with  their  criticism. 

The  problems  suggested  by  the  fauna  and  flora  of  the  British 
Islands  appeal  in  a  marked  degree  to  naturalists  who  live  in  Ireland, 
especially  if  those  naturalists  happen  to  be  English  immigrants  to 
the  sister  isle.  A  botanist  or  a  zoologist  who  has  grown  up  in  the 
south  of  England,  and  has  then  transferred  himself  to  Ireland,  is 
struck  by  the  absence  of  many  of  his  familiar  wild  friends,  and  the 
presence  of  many  forms  of  life  hitherto  unknown  to  him  as  British 
species.  The  peculiarities  of  the  Irish  flora,  such  as  the  occurrence 
of  Pyrenean  saxifrages  and  Mediterranean  heaths  in  western  Ireland, 
have  long  been  familiar  to  naturalists,  and  are  discussed  in  the 
classical  memoir  of  Forbes.2  It  may  be  well,  however,  to  recall  a 
few  of  the  corresponding  facts  regarding  the  fauna.  The  student  of 
vertebrates  notices  the  absence,  for  example,  from  Ireland  of  the 
Common  Hare  {Lepus  europaeus),  the  Voles,  the  Mole,  the  Weasel,  the 
Polecat,  the  Nightingale,  and  all  reptiles  except  the  Viviparous  Lizard. 
The  entomologist  misses  such  conspicuous  insects  as  the  Stag-beetle 
{Lucanus  cervus),  the  great  water  beetle  Hydrophilus  piceus,  and 
the  Large  tortoiseshell  butterfly  {Vanessa  pohjchloros).  These  are 
representatives  of  a  group  of  animals  to  which  the  present  writer  has 
applied  the  term  "  Teutonic  fauna,"3  while  Dr  Scharff,  in  his  recent 

1  Proc.  E.  Irish  Acad.  (3),  vol.  iv.,pp.  427-.r>14.      An  excellent  summary  appeared 
in  Nature  of  October  28th,  1897. 

2  Mem.  Geol.  Survey  Gt.  Britain,  vol.  i.,  1S46. 

3  Jfuseums  Assoc  it.  Report,  1894. 


376  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [December 

paper,  designates  the  mammals  among  them  as  distinctively  '  Eastern  ' 
or  '  Siberian.'  The  absence  of  these  Siberian  mammals  from  Ireland 
may  perhaps  be  regarded  as  the  central  fact  on  which  his  views  con- 
cerning the  British  fauna  are  founded.  Most  of  the  animals  of  this 
group  die  out  in  Great  Britain  as  one  travels  north  or  west.  It  must 
be  specially  noted,  however,  that  the  mammals  range  over  the  greater 
part  of  the  island.  The  Common  Hare  extends  from  Cornwall  to 
the  shores  of  the  Pentland  Firth  ;  the  Weasel  and  the  Viper  range  far 
north  into  Scotland.  But  most  of  the  corresponding  invertebrates 
are  not  found  north  of  the  Trent  or  west  of  the  Severn. 

Trie  naturalist  in  Ireland  is  compensated  for  the  loss  of  this 
eastern  fauna  by  the  presence  of  two  most  interesting  and  distinct 
sets  of  animals,  almost  unrepresented  in  the  south-east  of  England. 
It  has  been  mentioned  that  the  Common  Hare  is  absent  from 
Ireland,  but  the  Varying  Hare  {Lqms  variabilis)  occurs  all  over  the 
country,  from  north  to  south,  both  on  the  hills  and  in  the  plain. 
This  is  a  typically  arctic  and  alpine  animal,  with  a  complete  circum- 
polar  range,  confined  in  Great  Britain  to  the  Highlands  of  Scotland. 
Quite  a  number  of  insects,  which  in  Great  Britain  are  to  be  found 
only  in  the  north  range  to  the  extreme  south  of  Ireland,  such  as 
the  marsh  ringlet  butterfly  (Coenonympha  typhon)  and  the  ground- 
beetles  Carabus  clatliratus  and  C.  glabratus.  But  perhaps  the  most 
striking  example  of  this  northern  fauna  is  the  ground-beetle 
Pclophila  borealis,  which  has  been  found  in  most  of  the  northern 
and  western  counties  of  Ireland,  from  Antrim  to  Kerry  in  the  far 
south-west.  This  beetle  is,  so  far,  unknown  on  the  mainland  of 
Great  Britain,  but  it  occurs  in  the  Orkneys ;  on  the  continent  it  is 
an  inhabitant  of  high  northern  latitudes.  Together  with  this  arctic 
and  alpine  group  may  be  mentioned  the  three  species  of  North 
American  fresh-water  sponges,  Ephydatia  crateriformis,  Hdero- 
meycnia  Byderi,  and  Tubella  pennsylvanica,  which  Dr  Hanitsch  1  has 
lately  described  from  lakes  in  western  Ireland.  These  are  com- 
parable to  the  few  North  American  plants  which  grow  wild  in  the 
same  districts.  One  or  two  of  the  plants  have  Scotch  stations ;  but 
both  plants  and  sponges  are  unknown  on  the  continent  of  Europe. 

The  second  characteristic  group  of  the  Irish  fauna — like  the 
peculiar  plants  of  the  western  counties,  the  Arbutus,  London  Pride, 
and  St  Dabeoc's  Heath — shows  striking  affinity  with  the  life  of 
south-western  Europe  and  the  Mediterranean  region.  Forbes,  in 
his  memoir  already  referred  to,  expressed  the  opinion  that  no  fauna 
corresponding  to  this  Hibernian  flora  exists  in  the  British  Isles. 
Everyone,  however,  agreed  in  assigning  to  this  type  the  Portuguese 
slug,  Geomalacus  maculosus,  when  it  was  discovered  spread  over  a 
small  area  in  counties  Cork  and  Kerry.  Recently  a  number  of 
1  Irish  Nat.,  vol.  iv.,  1895,  pp.  122-131. 


1897]  THE  PROBLEMS  OF  BRITISH  FAUNA  :\77 

animals  have  been  recognised  which  undoubtedly  show  similar 
faunistic  relationships.  Some  of  these  are  new  discoveries,  and 
are  apparently  confined  to  Ireland,  such  as  the  millipede  Pohy- 
desmtis  gallicus,1  the  earthworms  Allolobqphora  veneta  and  A.  georgii,- 
and  the  weevil  Otiorrhynchus  auropunctatvs.*  Others  have  long 
been  known  as  British  animals,  and  their  occurrence  in  the  west  of 
Great  Britain  as  well  as  in  Ireland  lias  probably  caused  their 
faunistic  import  to  be  overlooked.  Such  are  the  snail  Helix  pisana, 
the  wood-louse  Platyarthrus  hoffmanseggii,  the  ground  beetle  Eury- 
iifbria  complanata,  and  the  weevil  Mesites  tardyi.  Some  of  these 
animals  are  found  both  in  the  east  and  west  of  Ireland,  others  only 
on  the  east  coast.  In  Great  Britain  they  occur  mostly  in  the 
south-west,  but  the  last-named  is  an  example  of  a  section  which 
ranges  northward  into  western  Scotland.  Abroad  all  are  charac- 
teristic of  southern  and  south-western  Europe,  while  several  are 
found  in  the  Azores,  Madeira,  and  Canary  Islands.  It  is  most 
important  to  take  the  foreign  range  into  consideration  when  assign- 
ing animals  to  a  distributional  type.  Just  as  the  Common  Hare  is 
spread  far  to  the  north  in  Great  Britain,  as  compared  with  many 
other  members  of  the  '  Siberian '  fauna,  so  a  number  of  animals 
belonging  to  the  South-western  fauna  range  farther  to  the  east  than 
the  more  typical  species  of  the  group.  For  instance,  the  slugs 
of  the  genus  Tcstacella  must  be  referred  to  the  South-western 
section,  when  we  consider  the  general  range  of  the  genus,  though 
some  species  occur  in  our  eastern  counties.  And  Dr  Scharff  would 
add  to  this  fauna  many  of  our  widely  distributed  species — the 
Bullfinch  among  birds,  for  example. 

He  believes  moreover  that  this  South-western  fauna  merges 
gradually  into  a  '  South-central '  fauna,  including  the  Badger 
among  mammals,  and  Helix  virgata,  H.  acuta,  and  H.  nemoralis 
among  snails.  And  to  these  combined  southern  groups  he  is 
inclined  to  ascribe  the  bulk  of  the  Irish  animals,  even  those  with 
a  wide  range  both  in  Ireland  and  in  Great  Britain  ;  except  a  few- 
species  that  may  have  invaded  the  country  since  it  became  an 
island — such  as  the  white  butterflies,  Pieris  brassicae  and 
P.  rapae,  and  the  '  painted  lady,'  Pyrameis  cardui,  or  that  have 
been  apparently  introduced  by  man — such  as  the  rats  and  the 
house  mouse. 

A  few  remarks  are  necessary  regarding  the  relative  ages  which 
are  to  be  ascribed  to  these  different  sections  of  the  British  fauna.  The 
South-western  group,  the  most  typical  members  of  which  are  found 
in  the  most  remote  parts  of  the  country,  with  ranges  often  discon- 
tinuous, are  evidently  the  oldest.     The  '  Siberian '  animals,  which 

1  R.  I.  Pocock,  Irish  JYaL,  vol.  ii.,  pp.  309-312.      2  H.  Friend,  id.,  vol.  v.,  pp.  69-73. 

3  G.  H.  Carpenter,  id.,  vol.  iv.,  pp.  213-218. 

2  D 


378  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 

are  confined  as  a  rule  to  eastern  and  south-eastern  England,  and 
none  of  which  have  been  able  to  reach  Ireland,  are  clearly  the 
newest.  The  Northern  animals  must  therefore  come  between  these 
two  in  regard  to  the  time  when  they  entered  our  area.  It  will  be 
remembered  that  Forbes,  when  discussing  the  distributional  groups 
of  British  plants,  regarded  the  most  western  ('  Hibernian  ')  flora  as 
the  oldest,  the  '  Germanic  '  flora  as  the  newest,  and  the  arctic  and 
alpine  flora  as  of  intermediate  age.  Forbes,  however,  considered 
the  plants  of  general  British  distribution  to  have  entered  the  country 
subsequently  to  the  arctic  and  alpine  species.  And  as  he  observed 
that  there  is  a  gradual  transition  from  the  most  typical  '  Germanic ' 
to  the  most  widely-spread  '  British '  type,  he  regarded  all  the 
immigrants  since  the  Northern  flora — that  is  to  say  the  '  British,' 
'  English  '  and  '  Germanic  '  types  of  Watson,1  as  belonging  to  one 
great  central  European  flora,  some  of  whose  members  have  spread 
much  more  widely  in  our  islands  than  have  others.  Forbes,  more- 
over, separated  two  small  groups  of  plants,  one  typical  of  Cornwall 
and  Devon  ('  Norman  '  flora),  the  other  characteristic  of  the  chalk  dis- 
tricts of  south-eastern  England  ('  Kentish '  flora),  which  he  believed 
to  be  entirely  distinct  from  the  recent  Germanic  flora.  To  these 
small  sections  he  ascribed  an  age  between  that  of  the  South-western 
and  that  of  the  Northern  flora. 

Dr  Scharff's  estimate  of  the  relative  ages  of  the  sections  of  the 
British  fauna  differs  from  Forbes'  view  of  the  ages  of  the  corre- 
sponding sections  of  the  flora  in  one  important  particular.  While 
Forbes  placed  the  bulk  of  our  widespread  plants  later  than  the 
arctic  and  alpine  species,  Dr  Scharff  considers  that — at  least  as 
regards  the  species  found  in  Ireland — the  vast  majority  of  the 
animals  are  of  southern  origin,  and  not  more  recent  than  the  arctic 
and  alpine  species.  As  mentioned  above,  he  believes  that  there  is 
a  gradual  transition  from  animals  of  the  most  typical  '  Hibernian' 
type,  such  as  Geomalacus  maculosus,  to  such  widespread  animals  of 
his  '  South-central '  group  as  the  Badger  and  the  Fox. 

The  question  of  the  exact  geological  period  during  which  each 
section  of  the  fauna  entered  the  British  area,  and  by  what  route  the 
animals  reached  our  territory,  must  now  be  considered.  With  regard 
to  the  flora,  Forbes  believed  that  the  Hibernian  plants  lived  on  a 
now  sunken  Atlantis  in  Miocene  times,  and  reached  their  present 
Irish  and  Iberian  stations  from  the  west  before  the  Ice  Age.  The 
Cornish  and  Norman  floras  were  supposed  to  have  come  into  the 
country  from  the  south-west  or  south — of  course  across  the  dry  area 
of  the  Channel — also  before  the  Ice  Age.  The  arctic  and  alpine 
plants,  Forbes  naturally  thought  to  be  the  relics  of  the  Glacial 
Period  itself.      And  he  believed  the  rest  of  the  British    flora — the 

1  "  Cybele  Britaunica,"  London,  1870. 


18971  THE  PROBLEMS  OE  BRITISH  FAUNA  379 

1  British,'  '  English  '  and  '  Germanic  '  types — to  have  entered  the 
country  from  the  east  and  south-east  across  the  dry  area  of  the 
North  Sea  and  the  Straits  of  Dover  during  the  subsequent  period 
when  the  British  territory  had  emerged  from  the  Glacial  sea,  England 
being  united  to  the  Continent,  and  Ireland  to  Great  Britain. 

At  the  time  when  Forbes  wrote,  the  glacial  deposits  were 
believed  to  have  been  laid  down  on  the  bed  of  a  sea  covered  with 
Moating  ice.  The  subsequent  adoption  by  the  majority  of  geologists 
of  the  theory  that  the  Boulder  Clay  represents  the  ground  moraine 
of  vast  sheets  of  land  ice  has  led  most  recent  writers  on  the  British 
fauna  and  flora  to  regard  most  if  not  the  whole  of  the  living  things 
in  our  area  as  post-glacial  immigrants.  Whatever  animals  and 
plants  lived  in  these  islands  during  Pliocene  times  are  presumed 
by  Professor  James  Geikie,  and  those  who  share  his  views,  to 
have  been  exterminated  by  the  terrible  rigour  of  the  glacial  condi- 
tions during  the  Pleistocene  age.  And  the  general  view  at  present 
is  that  it  was  not  until  the  climate  improved  in  later  Pleistocene 
times  that  the  country  again  became  the  abode  of  animal  and 
vegetable  life.  On  this  theory  it  would  seem  certain  that  the 
arctic  and  alpine  species  were  the  first  to  establish  themselves  in  our 
area. 

Now,  the  results  to  which  Dr  ScharfF s  studies  have  led  him  are 
in  startling  opposition  to  the  current  opinion  just  mentioned.  He 
believes  that,  with  the  exception  of  the  '  Siberian '  section,  the 
whole  of  the  British  fauna  entered  the  country  in  Pliocene  or  the 
earliest  Pleistocene  times.  With  regard  specially  to  the  Irish 
fauna,  he  considers  that  all  the  animals  which  now  inhabit  Ireland 
must  have  passed  into  that  island  in  the  Pliocene,  or,  at  latest, 
about  the  opening  of  the  Pleistocene  period,  there  being,  in  his  view, 
no  evidence  'of  any  land-connection  between  England  and  Ireland 
after  that  date.  It  is  hardly  necessary  to  recall  the  fact  that  the 
absence  of  so  many  British  animals  and  plants  from  Ireland  has 
led  naturalists  without  exception  to  regard  that  country  as  an  older 
island  than  Great  Britain,  whatever  geological  age  they  may  ascribe 
to  the  fauna  and  flora. 

It  is  specially  the  study  of  the  past  and  present  distribution  of 
the  British  mammals  that  has  led  Dr  Scharff  to  his  results.  The 
'  Siberian  '  mammals  which  are  found — living  or  extinct — in  Great 
Britain,  but  not  in  Ireland,  furnish,  as  has  been  said,  the  key  to  his 
argument.  Piemains  of  these  mammals,  preserved  in  the  continental 
Pleistocene  deposits,  enable  the  course  of  their  migration  from  east 
to  west  to  be  traced  in  considerable  detail.  They  lived  in  Siberia  in 
Pliocene  times,  but  in  Europe  their  remains  are  not  found  except  in 
beds  later  than  the  Lower  Boulder  Clay,  which  Dr  Scharff  suggests 
was    laid   down    in   the    northern    part    of    a   sea    connecting  the 


380  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 

Caspian  and  Aral  with  the  White  Sea  and  the  Baltic,  thus  forming 
an  effectual  barrier  to  the  westward  course  of  the  mammals.  The 
existence  of  such  a  sea  is  supported  by  the  presence  of  arctic  forms 
of  life  in  the  Caspian,  and  the  occurrence  of  the  Caspian  mollusc 
Dreyssensia  polymoiyha  in  the  Lower  Boulder  Clay  of  Germany.  As 
this  central  European  sea  was  replaced  in  part  by  a  land  surface, 
the  way  was  opened  for  the  Siberian  mammals  to  pass  on  into 
western  Europe.  Now  we  are  confronted  with  the  startling  fact  that 
the  British  deposit  in  which  these  mammals  first  appear  is  the 
Forest  Bed,  usually  considered  the  newest  member  of  the  Pliocene 
series.  Are  we  to  suppose,  Dr  Scharff  asks,  that  the  animals  made 
their  way  into  England  by  Asia  Minor,  Greece  and  ►Southern 
Europe,  and  so  reached  our  shores  before  Central  Europe  was  open 
to  them  ?  That  part  of  the  older  southern  fauna — the  '  South- 
Central  '  section — travelled  into  Western  Europe  by  this  route  from 
Siberia  during  Pliocene  times  he  does  believe.  But,  he  argues,  it 
is  impossible  that  the  true  '  Siberian '  animals  could  have  passed 
that  way,  seeing  that  their  remains  are  entirely  absent  from  South 
European,  as  well  as  from  Irish,  Scottish  and  Scandinavian,  deposits. 
He  is  therefore  driven  to  the  conclusion  that  the  Forest  Bed  and 
other  British  deposits  usually  classed  as  Newer  Pliocene  must  be 
considered  as  rather  later  than  the  Lower  Continental  Boulder  Clay, 
and  reckoned  to  be  of  Pleistocene  age.  In  support  of  this  correla- 
tion he  also  brings  forward  the  presence  of  arctic  shells  in  the  newer 
crags.1 

Having  thus  fixed  the  period  when  these  Siberian  mammals 
appeared  in  England,  Dr  Scharff  believes  that  he  has  obtained  the 
latest  possible  date  for  the  '  last  link  '  of  the  land-connection  be- 
tween England  and  Ireland.  For  if  the  way  into  Ireland  remained 
open  long  after  these  mammals  reached  English  territory,  what  can 
have  prevented  their  onward  course  to  the  western  island  ?  The 
wide  range  of  the  mammals  as  compared  with  the  restricted  range 
of  the  invertebrates  of  the  same  faunistic  section  has  been  dwelt 
upon  in  the  opening  part  of  this  paper.  It  is  certain  that  the  vast 
number  of  widespread  invertebrates  that  inhabit  Ireland  as  well  as 
Great  Britain  must  have  passed  over  the  Irish  Se,/  when  it  was  a 
lake  and  river  valley,  or  crossed  the  later  northern  isthmus  which 
joined  northern  Ireland  to  south-western  Scotland.  But  as  the 
Siberian  mammals  were  kept  out  of  Scotland  by  the  Pleistocene  sea, 
this  northern  isthmus  may  be  left  out  of  reckoning  as  far  as  they 
are  concerned.      If  the  slowly-moving  army  of  spiders,  beetles,  snails 

1  The  reader  is  referred  to  Dr  ScharfFs  paper  for  the  numerous  references  supporting 
these  positions.  It  will  he  seen  that  the  editorial  statements  of  Dr  SchartFs  views 
{supra,  p.  224,  "that  the  lower  continental  boulder  clay  is  Pliocene  .  .  .  that  the 
Siberian  mammals  migrated  into  Western  Europe  to  the  south  of  this  sen  ")  convey  the 
exact  reverse  of  the  opinions  really  advocated  by  the  author. 


1897]  THE  PROBLEMS  OF  BRITISH  FAUNA  381 

imd  slugs  did  not  invade  Ireland  until  after  the  Siberian  mammals 
were  in  England,  why  were  the  latter  unable  to  reach  Ireland  as 
well?  Such,  briefly,  is  Dr  ScharfFs  argument  for  the  pre-Glacial 
immigration  of  the  Irish  fauna. 

Turning  to  the  Northern  section  of  the  fauna,  Dr  Scharff  argues 
that  it  must  have  entered  Scotland  by  a  land-connection  from  Scan- 
dinavia,, ami  so  passed  southwards  into  Ireland.  This  land-connec- 
tion he  believes,  in  common  witli  most  geologists,  to  have  been 
■continued  northwards  to  Spitsbergen,  and  westward  to  Greenland 
and  North  America.  Thus  a  way  was  open  for  animals  with  a 
circumpolar  range  to  wander  southwards,  while  North  American 
forms  were  able  to  invade  Western  Europe.  The  continuous  coast- 
line to  the  north  of  the  Atlantic,  shutting  off  that  ocean  from  the 
Arctic  Sea,  must  have  ensured  a  mild  climate  to  its  waters  and 
shores.  The  vast  majority  of  geologists  would,  of  course,  regard  this 
land-connection  and  the  migrations  which  passed  over  it  as  post- 
glacial. Dr  Scharff,  necessarily  considering  the  northern  fauna 
older  than  the  Siberian,  believes,  on  the  contrary,  that  its  entry  into 
our  area  must  be  put  back  to  the  time  when  the  ice-laden  sea  of  the 
Lower  Boulder  Clay  covered  Central  Europe  and  the  newer  crags  were 
being  laid  down  in  eastern  England.  The  land-connection  between 
Scandinavia  and  Ireland  he  considers,  however,  to  have  persisted 
into  late  Pleistocene  times. 

It  has  already  been  mentioned  that  the  bulk  of  the  Irish  fauna 
is  supposed  by  Dr  Scharff  to  have  come  from  South-western  and 
South-central  Europe,  and  that  the  more  western  section  is  regarded 
by  him  (as  the  corresponding  section  of  the  flora  was  regarded  by 
Forbes)  as  the  oldest  section  of  the  whole  British  fauna.  Dr  Scharff 
does  not  share  Forbes'  view  of  an  extensive  Atlantic  continent  ;  he 
believes  that  a  western  continental  coast-line,  including,  of  course, 
.a  tract  to  the  west  of  the  present  British  and  Irish  area,  meets  all 
the  requirements  of  the  facts.  Across  the  valleys  which  occupied 
the  present  beds  of  the  English  and  St  George's  Channels  the  animals 
of  these  southern  migrations  passed  into  Great  Britain  and  Ireland ; 
.according  to  Dr  Scharff,  through  the  Pliocene  and  up  to  the  earliest 
Pleistocene  period.  But  the  land-connection  between  Great  Britain 
and  Ireland  broke  down  in  the  south  sooner  than  in  the  north,  so 
that  the  arctic  migration  could  go  on  after  the  southern  migrations 
had  been  cut  off.  Some  of  the  animals  of  the  '  South-central ' 
migration  are  traced  by  Dr  Scharff  back  to  Siberia,  where  he  believes 
they  originated.  He  points  out,  moreover,  that  the  same  species 
•can  sometimes  be  proved  to  have  taken  part  both  in  the  '  South- 
central  '  and  in  the  (later)  true  '  Siberian  '  migration.  In  such 
cases,  however,  a  distinct  race  of  the  species  usually  characterises 
each  migration.      For  example,  the  Irish  race  of  the  Pied  Deer  is  the 


382  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [December 

small-antlered  form  which  can  be  traced,  by  its  remains  in  south 
European  beds,  from  Western  Asia  into  Greece,  and  "  along  the 
borders  of  the  Mediterranean,  at  the  time  when  Corsica  and  Sardinia 
were  still  connected  with  Sicily  and  Greece  on  the  one  hand  and 
with  Tunis  on  the  other."  In  this  wav  it  is  suggested  that  animals 
from  western  Asia  and  south-eastern  Europe  found  their  way  to 
the  western  edge  of  the  continent,  while  the  central  European  plain 
was  still  covered  by  sea. 

If  Dr  Scharffs  views  as  to  the  geological  periods  during  which 
the  British  fauna  entered  the  country  be  accepted,  it  follows  that 
the  vast  majority  of  our  animal  population  must  have  survived  the 
rigours  of  the  Ice  Age ;  as  regards  Ireland,  the  whole  fauna  (ex- 
cept comparatively  modern  immigrants)  must  have  lived  in  the  area 
from  a  time  before  the  deposition  of  the  British  Lower  Boulder  Clay. 
It  will  be  remembered  that  Forbes,  who  believed  the  distinctive- 
South-western  flora  to  be  pre-glacial,  suggested  that  the  plants  sur- 
vived in  a  sunken  land  to  the  south-west.  Dr  Scharff,  however,, 
rejects  the  idea  of  such  an  asylum  for  the  fauna  on  the  ground  that 
the  south-western  corner  of  Ireland  is  remarkably  poor  in  species,, 
many  forms  of  life,  common  throughout  the  rest  of  the  island, 
being  absent  from  the  peninsulas  of  counties  Cork  and  Kerry  ;  fur 
example,  the  Helices  of  the  sub-genus  Xcwphila.  He  insists  that 
portions  at  least  of  the  present  Irish  area  must  have  been  able  to- 
support  the  present  animal  population  throughout  the  Pleistocene 
period. 

Those  geologists  who  adopt  the  extreme  view  of  the  glaciation 
of  Ireland,  advocated  by  the  Bev.  M.  H.  Close,  and  accepted  by 
Professor  Hull,1  will  naturally  reject  Dr  Scharff's  conclusions  with 
decision,  if  not  with  derision.  For,  according  to  the  opinion  of  this 
school,  an  ice-sheet  of  great  depth  covered  the  whole  country.  It  is 
needless  to  say  that  Dr  Scharff  rejects  with  equal  decision  the 
existence  of  such  an  ice-sheet.  In  the  closing  section  of  his  paper, 
he  expresses  his  agreement  with  those  geologists  who  believe  that 
the  Boulder  Clay  was  formed  in  an  ice-laden  sea,  and  not  as  the 
ground-moraine  of  vast  glaciers.  Of  course,  this  view  requires  the 
submergence  of  much  of  the  country.  But,  recalling  the  opinion 
of  several  geologists  that  the  western  margin  of  the  British  area 
stood  higher  in  relation  to  the  eastern  during  the  Glacial  Period  than 
now,  Dr  Scharff  reconstructs  the  physical  geography  of  our  islands 
during  that  time  of  greatest  submergence,  which  left  shell-bearing 
gravels  on  the  Dublin  mountains  and  Moel  Tryfaen.  According  to 
his  map,  the  Scottish  highlands,  the  Hebrides,  and  northern,  western,, 
and  southern  Ireland  formed  a  peninsula  still  continuous  witli 
Scandinavia  ;  the  Scottish  lowlands   and   northern   England  were  an. 

1  "  The  Physical  fieology  and  Geography  of  Ireland,"  London,  1878. 


1897]  THE  PROBLEMS  OF  BRITISH  FAUNA  383 

archipelago  ;  central  and  southern  Wales  an  island  ;  while  the  south 
and  midlands  of  England  were  joined  to  France  by  an  isthmus.  The 
sea  covered  nearly  the  whole  of  eastern  England,  and  stretched  across 
north  Wales,  and  over  eastern  and  central  Ireland.  Zoological 
evidence  for  this  transgression  of  the  northern  sea  over  eastern 
Ireland  is  found  in  the  distribution  of  the  arctic  marine  crustacean 
3fysis  rdicta,  which  forms  part  of  the  '  relic  fauna  '  not  only  of  the 
Swedish  lakes,  but  also  of  Lough  Neagh.  The  sea  separating 
southern  and  central  England  from  Scotland,  as  well  as  from 
Ireland,  checked  the  northern  as  well  as  the  western  progress  of 
the  '  Siberian '  mammals.  None  of  these  animals  are  found  fossil  in 
Scottish  Pleistocene  deposits,  though  the  recession  of  the  glacial  sea 
has  in  recent  times  opened  a  way  to  the  north,  of  which  the  sur- 
viving species  have  availed  themselves.  But  meanwhile  the  isthmus 
between  Scotland  and  Ireland  had  become  broken  through. 

Having  thus  put  forward  a  summary  of  Dr  Scharff's  views  as  to 
the  ages  and  paths  of  migration  of  the  various  sections  of  the  British 
fauna,  I  venture,  with  some  diffidence,  to  offer  a  few  observations 
and  suggestions.  I  entirely  agree  with  Dr  Scharff  in  considering  the 
South-western  as  the  oldest  section  of  our  fauna,  and  I  have  no 
doubt  that  it  came  into  our  area  long  before  the  Glacial  Period. 
The  North  American  plants  and  animals  seem  to  me  to  be  more 
ancient  than  Dr  Scharff  is  inclined  to  admit.  He  classes  them 
with  the  general  Northern  fauna,  but  I  believe  that  their  very 
restricted  and  discontinuous  ranges  along  the  extreme  western  margin 
of  Europe  mark  them  as  decidedly  older  than  those  northern  animals 
and  plants  which  have  a  general  circumpolar  distribution. 

Study  of  the  distribution  of  British  insects  shows  that  there  is  a 
Southern  fauna1  distinct  from  the  South-western,  in  that  its  members 
occur  generally  in  southern  Britain,  as  well  as  in  Ireland  and 
western  Britain,  and  have  a  wide  continental  range.  It  is  clearly 
newer  than  the  South-western  fauna,  yet  the  fact  that  it  is  confined 
in  Ireland  to  the  south  and  west  suggests  that  it  is  of  considerable 
geological  age.  Along  the  west  coast  of  Ireland  the  insects  of  this 
group  often  range  some  distance  to  the  north,  and  their  general 
British  distribution  around  the  west  and  south  of  our  islands  renders 
it  likely  that  they  held  the  country  west  and  south  of  the  area  where 
the  Glacial  deposits  were  being  formed,  and  have,  since  the  retroces- 
sion of  the  agent  which  produced  those  deposits,  been  unable  to 
spread  far  eastwards  in  Ireland  or  northwards  in  Great  Britain.  This 
fauna  may  safely  be  regarded  as  comparable  to  Forbes'  Norman  and 
Kentish  floras,  and  older  than  the  Arctic  fauna.  As  yet,  however, 
I  am  not  prepared  to  accept  so  great  an  antiquity  for  the  bulk  of 

1  Examples  of  this  group  are  the  ground-beetles,  Carnbus  cancellatus  and  Panagaeus 
cru.r-major,  the  butterflies  Gonepteryx  rhamni,  and  Leplida  sinapis,  and  the  moths  Zeuzera 
pyrina  and  Stauropus  fagi. 


384  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 

the  widespread  Irish  animals  as  Dr  Scharff  claims  by  referring  them 
to  his  '  South-central '  group. 

I  quite  agree  with  Dr  Scharff  in  rejecting  the  theory  that  the 
whole  of  our  fauna  is  post-Glacial,  since  that  theory  would  require 
us  to  regard  the  Arctic  animals  as  the  oldest,  whereas  the  distribu- 
tional facts  require  us   to   consider  the   South-western  section  the 
oldest.      But  it  seems  to  me  that  we  are  equally  bound  to  consider 
the  animals  of  the  Northern  fauna — restricted  as  they  are  to  the 
hill  regions   and  the   west — as  more  ancient  than  the  widespread 
species  which  form  the  dominant  element  in  our  fauna  to-day.      I 
am  quite  prepared  to  believe  that  many  of  these  widespread  species 
inhabited  the  southern  part  of  our  area  throughout  Pleistocene  times, 
but    it   seems   unlikely   that   they   extended   their  range  far  to  the 
north  or  west  until  the  glacial  conditions   had  passed  awTay.     Dr 
Scharff  apparently  believes  that,  the  glacial  deposits  being  due  to  a 
marine  submergence,  sufficiently  extensive   land  tracts   must  have 
been  left  to  enable   the  whole  fauna  to  survive.      But  even  many 
geologists  who  reject  the  theory  that  the  Boulder  Clay  is  a  ground 
moraine,   consider   that    the   polished    and    scratched   rock-surfaces 
beneath  that  deposit  are  evidences  of  a  former  extension  of  land-ice. 
In  the  opening  paragraphs  of  his  paper,  Dr  Scharff  makes  the 
suggestive  remark  that  the  study  of  the  fauna  of  a  single  island  is 
the  best  starting-point  for  the  study  of  a  continental  fauna.     Hence 
he  takes  Ireland  as  the  key  to  the  greater  problem  of  Europe.      It 
seems  likely  that  considerable  light  would  be  thrown  on  the  special 
British  problem  by  one  of  the  smaller  British  islands,  and  I  believe 
that  in   the  Isle  of  Man  we  have  evidence  of  a  post-Glacial  land- 
connection  between  Ireland  and  western  England.    Professor  Carvill 
Lewis  x  and  Mr  Percy  F.  Kendall 2  found  traces  of  glaciation  up  to 
the  summit  of  the  highest  hills  in  the  island,  the  former  remarking 
that  the  whole  shape  of  Snaefell  is  that  of  a  '  roche  moutonnt^e.' 
Whether   we   believe    with    these    geologists   that   the    '  Irish    Sea 
glacier '  passed  over  the  summit  of  Snaefell,  or  prefer  to  consider 
the  high-level  drifts,  boulders,  and  striated  rock-surfaces  as  evidences 
of   an  ice-laden   sea,  it  seems  equally  certain  that   the   present  in- 
habitants of  Man  must  have  reached  that  isle  since  the  climax  of 
tin;  Glacial  Period. 

Now  the  fauna  of  the  Isle  of  Man  ^sembles  on  the  whole  that 
of  Ireland,  western  England,  and  Wales.  Its  cliffs  form  the  most 
northern  station  for  certain  species  of  moths,  such  as  Dianthoecia 
luteago  var.  barrcttii,  D.  cacsia  and  D.  ccqjsojjhila ,  some  of  which  are 
scattered  along  the  western  British  and  the  eastern  ami  southern 
Irish  coasts  as  far  as  Land's  End  and  Dingle  Bay.  If  the  Isle 
of  Man  could   not  have  supported  any  fauna  during  the   height  of 

1    "Glacial  Geology  of  Great  Britain  and  Ireland,"  p  .  3f>7-!>.       2  Op.  cit.,  pp.  433-4. 


1897]  THE  PROBLEMS  OF  BRITISH  FAUNA  385 

the  Glacial  Period,  we  are  forced  to  the  conclusion  that  its  shores 
must,  since  then,  have  formed  part  of  the  northern  coasts  of  a 
gulf  opening  to  the  south,  down  St  George's  Channel.  As  the 
climatic  conditions  improved,  I  believe  that  many  animals  of  the 
old  South-western  fauna — such  as  Helix  piscina,  Euryncbria  com- 
planctfdj  Otwrrhynchus  auropunctatus — which  had  doubtless  lived  to 
the  south  of  England  and  Ireland  from  Pliocene  times,  were  able 
to  make  their  way  northwards  along  the  shores  of  this  ever-widen- 
ing gulf  to  their  present  stations  on  the  eastern  Irish  and  western 
British  shores.  North  of  this  gulf,  I  believe  that  the  vast  majority 
•of  our  present  widespread  species  passed  from  north-western  Eng- 
land into  Ireland,  where  they  have  spread  from  east  to  west.  The 
difficulty  raised  by  Dr  Scharff  that  the  '  Siberian '  mammals  were 
in  England,  and  should  have  passed  over  to  Ireland  with  the  rest, 
is  doubtless  serious.  But  these  mammals  were  kept  out  of  Scotland 
until  recent  times,  and  they  may  well  have  been  kept  out  of  north- 
western England  by  an  arm  of  the  sea  until  the  Irish  land-con- 
nection had  broken  down.  One  of  them,  the  English  Hare,  inhabits 
the  Isle  of  Man,  showing  that  the  barrier  which  confined  them  to 
the  east  had  been  removed  in  time  for  that  one  species  to  spread  so 
far,  though  not  as  far  as  to  Ireland.  The  fact  that  the  other 
mammals  of  the  group — -such  as  the  Voles  and  the  Mole — are 
absent  from  the  Isle  of  Man  proves  that  the  Hare  must  have  made 
the  most  of  her  chance  to  spread  north-westward. 

While,  then,  I  find  myself  in  almost  complete  agreement  with 
Dr  Scharff  with  regard  to  the  older  sections  of  our  fauna,  I  think 
that  those  widespread  species  which  survived  the  Glacial  Period 
must  have  been  confined  to  the  more  southern  parts  of  our  area,  and 
have  only  subsequently  spread  northwards  and  westwards  to  Scot- 
land and  Ireland.  Doubtless  the  speculations  of  the  extreme  glacial 
school  regarding  the  total  extinction  of  all  life  in  our  countries  in 
Pleistocene  times  need  revision  in  the  light  of  the  past  and  present 
•distribution  of  species.  At  the  same  time  there  seems  enough 
agreement  among  those  who  have  specially  studied  the  drift 
■deposits  to  warn  students  of  animal  distribution  that  the  conditions 
over  much  of  the  British  Islands  must  have  been  unfavourable  to 
the  presence  of  a  rich  flora  and  fauna. 

But  in  any  case  it  seems  to  us  a  necessity  to  believe  that  a 
considerable  proportion  of  the  British  flora  and  fauna  did  survive 
the  Glacial  Period  in  our  area,  or  in  the  now  submerged  tracts 
adjacent  thereto.  Readers  of  Natural  Science  will  doubtless  recall 
Mr  G.  W.  Bulman's  paper,1  in  which  a  plea  was  entered  for  the 
pre-Glacial  age  of  our  animals  and  plants  on  the  ground  that  no 
geological  evidence  of  an  elevation  subsequent  to  the  Ice  Age  could 

1  Vol.  iii.,  pp.  261-6. 


3S6  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [December 

be  brought  forward.  Neither  of  the  rival  glacial  theories  requires 
belief  in  the  annihilation  of  all  living  things  in  our  area.  On  the 
land-ice  hypothesis  there  must  have  been  a  now  submerged  tract 
bordering  on  the  Atlantic,  and  stretching  beyond  the  present 
south  coast  of  Ireland,  which  the  late  Professor  Carvill  Lewis  recog- 
nised as  an  unglaciated  area.  A  similar  elevation  to  the  west  of 
our  present  British  islands  is  believed  to  have  accompanied  the 
submergence  by  which  the  other  school  of  geologists  explain  the 
Pleistocene  deposits.  And  it  is  generally  agreed  that  the  south 
and,  in  part  at  least,  the  midland  areas  of  England  were  free  from 
glacial  conditions.  When  we  remember  how  distinctly  temperate 
and  even  sub  -tropical  forms  of  life  can  be  found  to-day  close  to 
areas  of  glaciation,  it  must  be  admitted  that  there  is  no  impossibility 
in  the  suggestion  that  the  ancestors  of  the  older  plants  and  animals 
which  we  now  see  around  us  witnessed  in  our  territory  the  coming 
and  passing  away  of  the  age  of  ice. 

Geo.  H.  Carpenter. 


507  387 


II 

The   Provincial   Museum 

WHAT  may  fitly  be  called  the  provincial  museum  question 
has  of  late  rapidly  assumed  considerable  importance. 
The  need  for  these  institutions  or  the  enthusiasm  of  their  staff 
is  not  called  in  question ;  as  a  matter  of  fact,  it  is  in  a  great  measure 
to  the  energy  of  provincial  curators,  as  manifested  at  meetings  of 
the  Museums'  Association,  that  much  of  the  present  awakening  is 
due.  The  evils  from  which  these  museums  suffer  are  acknowledged 
to  be  a  general  lack  of  means,  undermanning,  and  a  partially  or 
wholly  untrained  staff.  The  widespread  attention  which  the  subject 
receives  even  from  the  lay  mind  is  evidence  of  a  knowledge  that 
better  things  are  possible,  and  that  a  satisfactory  settlement  will 
tend  to  the  public  good  and  educational  progress.  The  museum 
question  has  hitherto  been  attacked  in  two  ways.  The  late  Dr 
Goode  in  America,  and  Sir  W.  H.  Flower  in  this  country,  have 
laboured  alike  to  educate  the  public  mind  to  the  value  and  necessity 
of  these  institutions  as  factors  in  education,  and  to  direct  and 
stimulate  museum  workers.  The  second  form  of  attack  has  been 
made  by  Professor  Petrie  (Brit.  Assoc,  Liverpool),  and  more  recently 
by  the  editorial  comments  of  Natural  Science  (Vol.  xi.,  No.  66,  Aug. 
1897).  It  may  be  defined  as  the  suggestion  of  remedial  measures. 
The  addresses  and  papers  of  Sir  W.  H.  Flower  and  Dr  Goode  have 
undoubtedly  done  much  to  pave  the  way  for  better  progress,  but 
before  the  remedial  measures  which  are  now  advocated  can  be 
made  effective  or  adequate  to  the  needs  of  provincial  museums,  it  will 
be  necessary  to  consider  fully  their  present  position  as  a  whole. 

Even  a  brief  consideration  of  the  provincial  museum  reveals 
much  that  is  anomalous  and  unsatisfactory.  Hardly  any  two  can 
be  said  to  work  upon  a  common  plan,  whilst  most  develop  and 
exist  rather  as  the  sport  of  circumstances  than  as  the  outcome  of 
definite  purpose  and  design.  We  much  doubt  if  one  can  be  pointed 
out  which  has  an  income  at  all  equal  to  its  needs,  or  which  is  able 
to  develop  and  maintain  its  various  sections  according  to  their  true 
value  and  proportion. 

We  find  also  that  Government  recognition  is  accorded  to  pro- 
vincial museums  in  a  vague  and  half-hearted  manner.  The  Libraries 
and  Museums  Act  can  be  put  into  operation  if  the  people  of   a 


388  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 

borough  demand  it,  but  the  operation  of  the  act  is  dependent  upon 
the  action  of  the  very  people  who  are  most  needing  instruction  by 
museum  agency.  Not  infrequently  the  act  is  put  into  operation  to 
gain  a  library,  and  a  museum  of  ill-assorted  material  grows  up  with 
it,  by  a  system  of  accretion  rather  than  assimilation.  Indeed,  it  is 
this  accretionary  growth  for  want  of  a  defined  plan  which  is  the  bane 
of  provincial  museums,  and  one  which  the  curators  themselves  are  at 
present  powerless  to  prevent.  Further,  museums  are  recognised  by 
the  Educational  and  Science  and  Art  Departments  in  that  attend- 
ance at  a  museum  by  school  children  and  science  students  is,  under 
certain  conditions,  allowed  to  count  as  class  attendance,  and  specimens 
are  loaned  to  them  from  the  Art  collection  of  South  Kensington. 

It  has  followed  from  the  operation  of  causes  such  as  those  in- 
dicated that  a  type  of  museum  has  arisen  throughout  the  country 
which  justifies  the  charge  of  ill-conceived,  lacking  in  proportion, 
wanting  in  utility  and  inadequately  supported  and  staffed.  If  we 
bear  the  present  conditions  in  mind,  and  consider  the  proposed 
remedies,  it  is  manifest  at  once  that  the  utmost  difficulty  would  be 
experienced  in  the  attempt  to  create  a  federal  staff  of  scientific  ex- 
perts on  the  lines  which  have  been  advocated  by  Professor  Petrie. 
The  museums  are  so  unequal,  their  sections  vary  so  strangely,  both  in 
ratio  to  one  another  and  in  their  value,  that  the  attempt  to  send  to 
a  series  of  museums  a  number  of  specialists,  devoting  equal  amounts 
of  time  to  each,  would  result  in  confusion  and  failure. 

The  first  plan  suggested  in  the  editorial  comment  of  Natural 
Science  of  August  last  is  practically  that  of  Professor  Petrie,  with 
the  added  proviso  that  the  specialists  should  be  resident,  one  at  each 
museum,  whilst  the  same  round  of  visits  was  maintained.  Other 
considerations  apart,  municipal  jealousies  would  effectually  kill  the 
scheme. 

The  second  plan  is  delightful  by  reason  of  its  naive  character 
rather  than  its  practicability.  The  visits  of  specialists  from  the 
Government  museums  are  red-letter  days  to  the  provincial  curator, 
valuable  alike  for  the  rare  good  fellowship  meted  out  to  the  humbler 
brother  in  science,  for  the  gratuitous  work  done,  and  the  remarkable 
stimulus  and  enthusiasm  imparted;  but  that  the  arrangement  and 
scientific  work  of  provincial  museums  should  be  left  to  the  staff  of 
Government  museums,  increased  in  numbers  for  the  purpose,  is  a 
plan  hardly  likely  to  commend  itself  to  the  provincial  curator  or  his 
governors,  and  even  less  likely  to  Parliament,  which  would  need  to 
be  approached  to  decide  the  question. 

There  is  much  in  each  plan  that  is  admirable,  but  after  all  they 
are  in  the  nature  of  makeshifts  rather  than  a  solution  of  the 
question.  What  seems  to  be  needed  is  a  thorough  grapple  with 
flii;    whole    question    of    museum    development,   and    (to    borrow    a 


1897 J  THE  PROVINCIAL  MUSEUM  381) 

sentence  from  Natural  Science)  of  the  means  of  "co-ordination,  in- 
vestigation, and  effective  utilisation  of  all  our  obscured  scientific  and 
artistic  material,"  together  with  the  creation  of  means  by  which  those 
aspiring  to  take  up  curatorial  work  may  receive  a  thorough  training. 
A  somewhat  rough-and-ready  classification  of  provincial  museums 
seems  to  indicate  naturally  a  string  of  suggestions  which  might 
possibly  be  elaborated  into  a  workable  and  effective  scheme.  At 
present  provincial  museums  may,  we  think,  be  placed  in  three  or 
four  classes  as  follows  : — 

T.   Museums  of  University  Colleges,  and  of  large  cities  possess- 
ing large  collections  and  a  trained  staff. 
IT.    Museums   of    important    manufacturing    centres,   or   county 
towns,   with    usually    fair   collections   and  a  self-educated 
staff. 

III.  Museums  of  small  towns,  and  of   scientific  societies    which 

are  managed  by  honorary  curators,  or  once  arranged  and 
afterwards  left  unaltered  in  the  hands  of  a  care-taker. 

IV.  Museums  under  the  Libraries  and  Museums  Act  which  are 

managed  by  the  librarian  in  addition  to  his  own  work, 
outside  help  being  obtained  from  time  to  time.  Some  of 
these  museums  rank  in  importance  with  those  of  Class  II. 

That  a  relative  importance  of  provincial  museums  exists  such  as 
that  implied  in  this  classification  will,  we  think,  be  admitted,  and 
upon  this  assumption  the  following  suggestions  are  formulated  as  a 
means  of  bringing  about  that  co-ordination  and  improvement  of 
museum  development  which  is  so  much  desired. 

Suggested  Plan 

I.  Creation  of  an  annual  museums'  grant  by  Government  in  aid 
of  provincial  museums  of  the  first  class,  the  sum  allotted  to  each 
being  determined  by  considerations  similar  to  those  which  guide  the 
application  of  the  present  University  Colleges'  Grant. 

Upon  the  strength  of  such  a  grant  the  Government  could  charge 
each  museum  with  a  definite  scope  of  work  and  the  attainment  and 
retention  of  a  certain  standard  of  excellence. 

For  example,  a  museum  might  be  called  upon  as  a  condition  of 
receiving  the  grant  to  have  special  aims  such  as  the  following : — 

(a)  The  specific  task  of  investigating  and  demonstrating  by  col- 

lections the  natural  history,  &c,  of  a  defined  geographical 
area  of  which  the  museum  would  be  the  centre. 

(b)  The  formation   and   continued   progress    of  a  good  general 

collection  suited  to  the  needs  of  the  area  served  by  the 
museum. 


390  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [December 

(c)  The    attainment   of   a    certain   standard    of   excellence    and 

completeness. 

(d)  An  adequate  staff. 

Means  could  be  devised  by  which  certain  of  the  museums  in 
classes  II.  and  IV.  could  be  raised  to  the  standard  of  class  I.,  so  that, 
speaking  generally,  the  country  would  become  parcelled  out  into 
areas,  in  each  of  which  a  museum  was  maintained,  in  constant  good 
order,  and  ministering  in  a  special  as  well  as  a  general  manner  to 
the  needs  of  the  population. 

II.  Remaining  museums  might  be  subsidised  through  the  agency 
of  County  Councils,  upon  certificates  of  efficiency  and  progress  re- 
ceived annually  from  an  accredited  visitor,  who  might  be  an  official 
of  the  Government  or  of  one  of  the  first-class  museums. 

Great  help  would  be  rendered  to  the  curators  of  small  museums 
if,  as  a  condition  of  the  subsidy,  a  member  of  the  staff  of  the  first- 
class  museum  had  a  seat  and  vote  upon  the  committee.  Such  a  po^t 
might  well  be  honorary,  and  would  be  analogous  to  that  which 
obtains  in  the  case  of  certain  Grammar  Schools,  a  governor  serving 
upon  the  board  by  appointment  from  one  of  the  larger  Colleges  or 
Universities. 

III.  The  small  museums  might  be  grouped  around  the  larger 
according  to  locality  and  function,  and  by  means  of  a  nominal  con- 
tribution to  the  funds  of  the  larger  have  a  claim  for  help  and 
direction. 

The  advantages,  if  a  scheme  of  this  sort  be  applied  to  the  whole 
country,  might  be  dealt  with  at  considerable  length,  but  it  will  be 
less  likely  to  confuse  if  we  narrate  briefly  what  we  consider  to  be 
the  chief. 

Museums'  aims,  management,  and  development  would  become 
organised  throughout  the  country,  and  lead  at  the  outset  to  the 
abolition  of  a  needless  overlapping  where  several  museums  exist  in 
a  large  town  or  city  under  different  management. 

More  museums  of  the  first  class  would  be  created,  and  the 
curators  of  county  museums,  and  students  generally,  would  find  help 
nearer  at  hand  than  at  present.  The  conditions  of  existence  of  the 
large  museums  would  require  that  the  systematic  study  of  the  fauna, 
flora,  &c,  of  large  districts  be  prosecuted  with  diligence  and  the 
salient  features  of  each  being  demonstrated  in  the  museum  collections. 
The  whole  would  necessarily  become  of  prime  importance  to  the 
public,  a  permanent  memorial  of  the  scientific  value  of  the  area 
served,  and  of  great  usefulness  to  the  specialist  and  the  nation. 

The  small  museums  might  have  a  similar  charge,  though,  of 
course,  in  a  smaller  and  more  localised  degree,  whilst  being  also  re- 
quired to  maintain  a  good  type-collection  suited  to  the  wants  of  the 
population. 


1897]  THE  PROVINCIAL  MUSEUM  391 

Museums  would  be  brought  into  direct  communication  with  each 
other,  and  the  transference  of  specimens  to  centres  where  they  would 
be  of  most  use  would  be  immensely  facilitated,  while  the  small 
museums  would  naturally  become  agents  of  supply  of  material 
obtainable  in  their  districts.  The  whereabouts  of  material  for  the 
specialist  would  be  better  known,  and  be  more  readily  available. 

The  linking  up  and  increased  usefulness  of  provincial  museums 
would  provide  a  healthy  stimulus  to  local  scientific  societies,  would 
result  in  increased  and  more  thorough  field  work,  and  do  much  to 
aid  that  federation  of  remote  scientific  workers  which  is  so  desirable. 
Moreover,  it  must  not  be  forgotten  that  such  a  chain  of  museums 
offers  the  best  means  whereby  the  collections  of  the  humblest  and 
most  distant  worker  might  be  conveyed  to  the  one  best  fitted  to 
deal  with  them. 

The  plan  we  advocate  is  crude,  but  designedly  so,  for  elaboration 
provokes  criticism  of  detail  rather  than  of  principles,  and  it  is  the 
latter  which  are  all-important  to  determine  in  connection  with  the 
present  phase  of  the  provincial  museum  question. 

Herbert  Bolton. 


576.3 


"' 9  2  [December 


III 

Cell  or  Corpuscle  ? 

/^~\NE  of  the  youngest  and  most  vigorous  among  the  sciences  is 
^S      that  which  has  been  named  Cytology. 

Its  strength,  in  all  probability,  is  due  to  the  fact  that  it  has 
sprung  from  a  broad  foundation,  and  that  it  still  rests,  not  upon  oner 
but  many  pillars  of  support.  The  botanist,  the  zoologist,  the  physi- 
ologist, divergent  from  one  another  as  their  daily  walks  unfortunately 
are,  yet  agree  to  join  hands  over  the  common  basis  of  their  sciences 
— the  organic  cell. 

With  such  splendid  results  already  gathered  into  its  encompass 
and  with  the  hope  and  promise  of  such  a  brilliant  future  before  it,  it 
is  all  the  more  to  be  regretted  that  the  language  of  Cytology  is  not 
only  in  contradiction  to  common  sense,  but  such  that  it  must  assuredly 
lead  to  endless  perplexities. 

The  word  cell,  the  very  watchword  of  the  science,  is  one  that  in 
this  mouth  means  one  thing,  in  that  quite  another. 

Dealing  with  the  lower  plants,  the  botanist  will  speak  of  the 
'  swarmspores  '  as  cells,  whilst  when  he  turns  to  the  phanerogams 
he  will  apply  the  same  term  to  the  elements  of  cork  or  sclerenchyma, 
notwithstanding  the  fact  that  the  former  consist  of  protoplasm  and 
nucleus  without  a  cell  wall,  whilst  the  latter  are  composed  of  cell 
walls  without  either  protoplasm  or  nucleus. 

Such  inexactitude  as  this,  such  a  want  of  definite  expression, 
must  hang  as  a  burden  around  the  neck  of  the  science,  impeding  its 
progress  at  every  turn. 

More  especially  is  it  from  the  side  of  the  student  of  vegetable 
life  that  this  confusion  is  felt,  the  zoologist,  although  he  uses  the 
word  cell  in  a  sense  which  stands  in  flat  contradiction  to  its  every- 
day meaning,  yet  attaches  a  significance  to  it  which  is  clear  and 
precise  in  his  own  mind. 

However  desirable,  therefore,  it  may  be  for  a  more  common  sense 
terminology  to  be  introduced  into  zoology  as  well  as  botany,  it  is  not 
absolutely  essential  for  scientific  advance.  When  it  is  remembered 
also  that  any  change  of  nomenclature  in  this  respect  must  involve 
with  difficulties  the  immense  mass  of  zoological  literature  which  has 
gathered  together  since  1839,  it  should  make  us  pause  before  we 
suggest  giving  up  the  word  cell,  in  the  zoological  sense,  in  favour  of 
energid  or  biophor. 


897J  CELL  OR  CORPUSCLE?  393 

It  seems  to  me  that  there  are  only  two  possible  ways  of  reform 
open  to  us,  and  both  are  accompanied  with  grave  difficulties. 

We  may  introduce  that  change  from  the  word  cell  to  that  of 
energid  (Sachs)  or  biophor  (Hansen),  which,  it  has  already  been 
pointed  out,  will  bring  countless  troubles  with  it  in  respect  to  the  old 
and  classical  literature ;  or  we  may  effect  an  alteration  in  nomencla- 
ture within  the  science  of  botany  itself.  Retaining  the  word  cell  to 
express  protoplasm  and  nucleus,  we  may  bring  in  a  new  name  for  the 
cell  wall  minus  its  living  contents.  Here  also  great  confusion  would 
result  to  the  older  writings,  but  the  confusion  would  be  within  a 
more  limited  sphere.  As  we  have  already  mentioned,  it  is  in  the 
province  of  the  vegetable  kingdom  that  the  difficulties  with  regard 
to  the  meaning  of  the  term  'cell'  have  arisen,  and  in  reading  the 
older  memoirs  we  are  frequently  brought  to  a  pause  to  enquire 
whether  it  is  cell-wall  or  living  cell-contents  that  are  being  referred 
to  under  the  name  of  cell.  The  perplexities  accompanying  a  substi- 
tute for  the  word  cell  in  its  significance  of  cell-membrane  would, 
therefore,  not  be  so  heavily  felt  as  those  associated  with  a  new  word 
for  the  protoplasmic  contents.  The  changes  involved  would  be  heavy 
within  their  sphere  (it  is  not  simply  the  word  cell  but  the  compound 
expressions  which  have  been  formed  from  it  which  would  have  to  give 
place  to  the  new  order  of  things),  but  still  this  range  would  be  a 
fairly  limited  one.  It  would  be  only  the  single  science  of  botany, 
already  perplexed  with  difficulties  of  meaning  and  not  the  additional 
provinces  of  zoology  and  animal  (and  human)  physiology,  which  are 
clear  in  their  use  of  the  word,  which  would  suffer  from  the  innova- 
tion. What  substitute  might  be  employed  for  the  word  cell  in  its  ap- 
plication to  the  membrane  and  the  cavity  included  by  it,  is  not  easy 
to  see — perhaps  the  word  '  vesicula '  is  not  altogether  inappropriate, 
but  if  changes  on  these  lines  should  ever  prove  applicable,  it  will 
then  be  time  enough  to  look  about  for  a  new  term. 

The  first  alternative,  which  was  mentioned  above,  is  the  one 
which  hitherto  has  alone  been  dealt  with  by  biologists. 

Sachs,  in  his  two  notes  in  Flora  (1892,  1895),  has  proposed 
to  call  the  nucleus,  together  with  the  protoplasm  governed  by  it  at 
any  time,  an  energid.  If  such  an  energid  be  included  within  a 
membrane  it  is  to  be  spoken  of  as  a  cell.  The  distinguishing 
characteristic  of  an  energid  is  the  living  element  (protoplasm  and 
nucleus),  whilst  that  of  a  cell  is  the  membrane. 

From  this  point  of  view,  therefore,  the  swarmspore  of  Ulothria 
is  an  energid,  whilst  immediately  that  it  forms  a  wall  around  itself 
it  reaches  the  further  dignity  of  a  cell  :  the  elements  of  cork  tissue 
are  also  cells.  In  plants  of  the  type  of  Vaucheria  the  protoplasm 
is  studded  with  nuclei,  and  the  whole  mass  is  enclosed  within  a  single 
cell-membrane.      Each  nucleus  may  be  conceived  as  exerting  its  in- 

2  E 


394  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [December 

fiuence  over  a  limited  area  of  protoplasm,  and  ruler  and  ruled  may 
together  be  mentally  mapped  off  as  a  unit.  The  body  of  Vaucheria 
can  therefore  be  described  as  consisting  of  a  number  of  units — the 
energids — enclosed  within  a  single  cell  wall. 

Quite  lately  another  small  work  dealing  with  these  matters  has 
been  written  by  Dr  Adolph  Hansen,  Professor  of  Botany  at  the 
University  of  Giessen.1 

That  part  of  the  little  book  which  deals  with  the  '  Geschichte  ' 
is  most  carefully  and  judiciously  written,  and  it  at  the  same  time 
has  a  life  and  vigour  in  its  sentences  that  fire  our  enthusiasm  for 
the  subject.  When  we  turn  to  the  latter  pages  of  the  pamphlet  in 
which  the  '  Kritik  '  is  embodied,  it  awakens  very  mixed  feelings 
within  us.  It  sets  us  thinking,  which  is  a  good  thing,  but  nowhere 
does  it  bring  conviction  with  it.  Where  the  views  are  most  de- 
finitely stated  we  feel  the  greatest  doubt,  and  where  the  arguments 
should  be  the  most  irresistible  we  are  the  least  convinced. 

Glancing  at  what  is  written  on  pp.  50-58,  we  see  that  the 
zoological  definition,  if  I  may  so  term  it,  of  a  cell  is  taken  as  the 
starting-point  of  the  argument.  The  zoologist  {e.g.  Professor  Oscar 
Hertwig)  defines  a  cell  as  a  little  mass  of  protoplasm  that  includes 
a  nucleus  within  its  substance. 

From  this  point  of  view  Hansen  maintains  that  the  general 
assertion  '  that  plants  are  composed  of  cells '  is  untenable,  since  the 
larger  mass  of  them  is  built  up  of  cell-walls  ;  moreover,  whilst  a 
naked  swarmspore  may  be  correctly  named  a  cell,  it  ceases  to  be 
such  immediately  that  it  forms  a  wall  around  its  surface. 

In  considering  these  statements  we  must  first  ask  whether  it  is 
really  a  general  assertion  that  '  plants  are  composed  of  cells.'  I  do 
not  think  so.  I  myself,  and  all  whom  I  have  ever  heard,  have 
always,  both  in  animal  and  plant  histology,  stated  that  the  plant  or  the 
animal,  as  the  case  may  be,  consists  of  cells  and  the  products  of 
cells.  Our  author  meets  this  qualification  in  part,  perhaps,  by  saying 
that  those  who  assert  that  plants  consist  of  cells  (in  the  zoological 
sense)  approach  the  difficulties  in  the  above  cases  by  regarding  the 
membrane  as  '  secondary  '  or  '  unessential,'  and  in  that  case  he  goes 
on  to  argue  how  are  we  to  look  upon  Caulerpa,  whose  whole  form 
and  existence  is  determined  by  the  cell- wall  ? 

Secondary  and  unessential  the  cell-wall  certainly  is,  however, 
when  we  compare  it  with  the  protoplasm  and  nucleus. 

The  latter  determine  whether  a  structure  is  living  or  dead  ;  the 
former  merely  influences  the  manner  of  life. 

Caulerpa  as  a  genus  is  undoubtedly  dependent  on  the  presence 
of  a  membrane,  but    Caulerpa  as  a  living  thing  is  due  to  the  co- 

1  "  Zur  Geschichte  and  Kritik  <les  Zcllcnbegritfes  in  der  Botanik,"  yon  Dr  Adolph 
Hansen.     Giessen:  .1.  Kicker,  1897. 


1897]  CELL  OR  CORPUSCLE ?  395 

existence  of  protoplasm  and  nuclei.  Hansen  cannot  maintain  that 
the  fibres  and  inorganic  parts  of  a  bone  are  not  '  secondary  '  in  im- 
portance when  placed  side  by  side  with  bone  corpuscles,  and  yet 
the  whole  form  and  existence,  nay,  the  whole  use  of  the  bone, 
depends  upon  their  presence. 

Another,  and  perhaps  even  more  analogous  case,  is  furnished  by 
the  elastic  fibres  of  certain  ligaments  (Ligamentum  nuchae) :  the 
whole  existence  of  these  bands  is  justified  by  the  elastic  fibres  they 
contain,  and  yet  when  valued  against  the  protoplasmic  corpuscles 
upon  which  their  origin  depends,  these  fibres  must  be  relegated  to  a 
'  secondary '  place. 

The  white  connective  tissue  fibres,  the  elastic  fibres,  and  the 
vegetable  membranes  are  all  of  enormous  importance  in  the  phylo- 
genetic  development  of  the  organism  ;  without  them  neither  animals 
nor  plants  would  ever  have  been  able  to  rise  above  the  state  of  mere 
flabby  masses  of  protoplasm  of  limited  size,  but  that  which  stands 
higher  than  race  development,  the  existence  of  life  is  interwoven 
with  the  protoplasm  and  its  nucleus.  It  is  only  compared  with  this 
high  standard  that  we  dare  speak  of  the  membrane  of  plants  as 
'  unessential '  or  '  secondary.'  When  Hansen,  however,  a  few  lines 
further  on,  indicates  that  those  who  use  these  two  words  when 
speaking  of  the  cell-wall  do  so  alternatively  with  the  expression  of 
'  no  importance,'  he  altogether  misunderstands  their  position. 

The  next  few  pages  are  occupied  with  a  criticism,  more  or  less 
destructive,  of  Sachs'  views  on  energids  ;  this  is  followed  by  a  pro- 
posed improvement.  The  word  energid  shall  be  dropped ;  in  such 
cases  as  the  Siphoneae  the  separation  of  energids  is  artificial,  and 
therefore  to  be  avoided  ;  in  its  place  the  whole  contents  of  a  single 
membrane,  or  the  whole  mass  of  a  membraneless  organism,  shall  be 
named  a  '  biophpr,'  whether  this  be  uni-  or  multi-nuclear.  "When  a 
*  biophor  '  is  enclosed  by  a  wall  it  becomes  a  cell.  "  The  cell,"  he 
adds,  "  consists  always  of  a  biophor  and  a  membrane."  When, 
therefore,  a  few  lines  further,  he  says  that  with  the  adoption  of  this 
nomenclature  there  is  no  reason  why  the  elements  of  wood  or  cork 
should  not  be  named  cells — cells  that  have  lost  their  biophors  — 
certain  inconsistencies  of  statement  become  apparent.  Dr  Hansen 
himself  points  out  that  the  name  biophor  has  already  been  used  by 
Weismann  in  quite  another  sense.  I  cannot  think  that  it  would 
be  wise  therefore  to  employ  it  in  this  new  relation,  as  even  suppos- 
ing Weissmann's  biophors  do  not  prove  all  that  was  hoped  of  them, 
they  certainly  will  take  a  permanent  historical  value,  and  fresh 
troubles  will  appear  on  the  horizon  in  consequence. 

Although  the  last  eight  pages  of  Hansen's  pamphlet  seem  to  me 
to  be  open  to  criticism,  the  fifty  foregoing  pages  can  only  give 
pleasure  and  satisfaction  to  those  who  read  them. 


Q 


96  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 


The  historical  account  of  the  cell  theory  is  one  of  the  best  that 
has  been  written  for  a  very  long  time,  and  the  frequent  apt  quota- 
tions from  and  references  to  the  original  memoirs  breathe  a  spirit  of 
life  into  the  story  which  one  only  seldom  finds  in  these  retrospective 


writings. 


Before  leaving  the  subject  of  reform  by  change  in  the  name  of 
•  protoplasm  plus  nucleus  '  it  may  be  mentioned  that  if  a  new  term 
is  to  be  given  to  these  parts,  a  more  justifiable  one  than  energid  is 
that  of  '  corpuscle.'  It  is  a  name  which  is  already  used  in  this 
sense  by  the  zoologist:  he  speaks  of  the  white  blood  corpuscle,  the 
bone  corpuscle,  etc.,  and  its  introduction  into  botany  would  be  far 
from  insurmountable.  To  speak  of  a  swarmspore  as  a  '  corpuscle ' 
would  be  both  common  sense  and  simple.  The  membrane  which 
this  '  corpuscle '  manufactures  might  be  termed  a  '  cell,'  and  we 
should  be  speaking  both  logically  and  intelligibly  when  we  spoke  of 
the  '  corpuscle '  which  lies  within  the  '  cell '  when  we  dealt  with  an 
element  of  the  cambium,  or  if  we  spoke  of  an  aggregate  of  corpuscles 
lying  within  the  cell  when  we  treated  of  Vauchcria.  When  the 
elements  of  cork  came  into  view  they  would  be  cells  pure  and 
simple. 

If  a  collective  name  for  the  living  contents  of  a  cell  be  required 
we  might  resort  to  the  terminology  which  has  already  been  employed 
by  Professor  Strasburger.  A  corpuscle,  in  the  above  sense,  might  be 
described  as  consisting  of  cytoplasm  and  nucleus,  and  the  name 
protoplasm  be  applied  to  the  cytoplasm  or  the  nucleus,  or  both 
together,  whether  one  nucleus  or  many,  or  none,  were  associated 
with  the  cytoplasm. 

In  what  has  been  written  above  I  only  wish  to  throw  out  a 
few  rough  suggestions  which  may  perhaps  help  the  cytologist  in  a 
small  degree  as  he  gropes  in  the  darkness  for  the  right  path. 

It  is  either  the  wall  of  the  cell  or  the  living  contents  of  the  cell 
which  must  be  re-named.  ,  If  it  be  the  former  the  difficulty  will 
fall  upon  the  shoulders  of  the  botanist  but  leave  the  zoologist 
unharmed ;  if  the  latter,  much  depends  upon  the  nature  of  the 
alteration. 

If  we  radically  change  things  by  bringing  into  use  a  new  name' 
(energid,  biophor)  endless  perplexities  will  undoubtedly  arise,  but 
if  we  resort  to  a  word  like  that  of  '  corpuscle,'  and  employ  it  in  the 
way  indicated,  the  troubles  may  be  smoothed  over.  It  is  a  word 
that  the  animal  histologist  has  already  often  used,  and  one  that  is 
not  really  difficult  for  the  botanist  to  adopt;  it  is  one  that  is  com- 
mon sense,  and  which  likewise  would  allow  the  term  cell  to  be 
brought  into  the  same  category. 

I  will  leave  matters  here,  however,  for  others  to  judge  and  to- 
criticise.  Kudolf  Beer. 


565.3  -397 


IV 

Fossil  Apodidae 

EVERY  group  of  animals  contains  in  itself  its  own  record  if  we 
could  but  decipher  it.  The  zoology  of  the  future  is  bound 
under  the  fascination  of  this  idea  to  devote  itself  to  an  ever  closer 
comparative  study  for  the  express  purpose  of  gaining  insight  into 
the  lines  of  their  past  development.  "We  have  no  royal  roads,  and 
the  hopes  which  were  held  out  to  us  a  few  years  back  that  embryology 
would  provide  us  with  one  have  not  been  realised.  It  can  only 
supply  us  with  hints,  the  full  meaning  of  which  we  must  learn  by 
other  methods.  Most  hopeful  of  good  result  are  those  groups  in 
which  allied  forms,  recent  and  extinct,  offer  themselves  in  sufficient 
numbers  for  comparison.  None  can  compare  in  this  respect  with 
the  Crustacea.  There  is  an  enormous  wealth  of  known  crustacean 
forms  extending  upwards  from  the  very  lowest  fossiliferous  strata 
and  still  swarming  in  every  suitable  part  of  the  globe.  The 
problem  has  long  been  to  find  a  genealogical  key  to  reduce  this 
immense  stream  of  organised  life  to  some  order  of  development. 

The  first  and  most  striking  feature  noted  was  the  fact  that  all 
but  the  most  extreme  forms  are  segmented,  and  the  natural  inference 
was  that  the  common  ancestor  of  the  whole  immense  family  must 
have  been  some  less  specialised  segmented  form.  Of  recent  years 
the  attention  of  zoologists  in  search  of  the  most  primitive  form 
among  existing  Crustacea  has  been  concentrated  upon  the  freshwater 
Apus  which  appears  sporadically  in  rain  pools  all  over  the  world. 
"When  the  pools  dry  up  the  eggs  remain  in  the  mud  ;  indeed  it  is  said  to 
be  a  necessary  condition  of  development  that  they  should  be  so  dried. 
How  long  they  remain  capable  of  development  is  not  known.  These 
facts  are  interesting  because  they  suggest  to  us  a  way  in  which  Apus 
may  have  survived,  practically  isolated  from  the  struggle  for  exist- 
ence, almost  unchanged  from  the  days  when  the  Crustacea  first 
appeared  on  the  planet.  Those  who  claimed  the  primitive  character 
of  Apus  were  not  disconcerted  by  the  absence  of  fossil  remains  which 
could  be  definitely  assigned  to  Apus.  There  was,  of  course,  always 
the  hope  that  such  might  be  found,  and  further  there  was  the  strik- 
ing fact  to  which  they  could  appeal  that  one  of  the  most  prolific  of 
early  crustacean  forms,  the  Trilobites,  possessed  many  characters  in 
common  with  Apus.      The  great  Paleozoic  family  of  the  Trilobites 


398  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 

are  thus  claimed  as  relations  of  the  modern  Apus.  Now,  however, 
that  the  claims  of  Apus  to  have  been  co-existent  with  and  in  some  way 
closely  related  to  the  Trilobites  are  being  reasserted  on  the  basis  of 
a  new  interpretation  of  the  morphology  of  the  former  and  of  new 
facts  as  to  the  organisation  of  the  latter — other  mysterious  relations 
are  cropping  up.  With  two  of  these — viz.,  Protocaris  from  the  Lower 
Cambrian,  and  Dipeltis  from  the  Lower  Carboniferous,  Mr  Schuchert 
deals  in  the  Proceedings  of  the  U.S.  National  Museum  (vol.  xix.). 
Neither  are  quite  new,  the  former  having  been  figured  and  described 
by  Walcott,1  and  the  latter,  from  very  imperfect  material,  by  Packard. 
Mr  Schuchert  gives  a  new  figure  of  Protocaris  showing  a  little  more 
detail,  refigures  the  type  specimens  of  Dipeltis,  and  is  fortunate 
enough  to  be  able  to  describe  three  new  and  almost  perfect  speci- 
mens of  the  same,  one  of  which  represents  a  new  species. 

Mr  Schuchert  has  no  hesitation  in  claiming  both  these  as 
Apodidae,  a  welcome  claim  to  any  who,  as  above  described,  have 
interested  themselves  in  placing  Apus  with  the  Trilobites  at  the 
root  of  the  crustacean  phylum.  But  inasmuch  as  Mr  Schuchert 
only  deals  with  these  new  claimants  very  generally,  it  has  been  sug- 
gested that  a  cross-examination  of  them  from  this  special  point  of 
view  would  not  be  uninteresting. 


*o' 


Protocaris  marshi 

This  fossil,  only  known  in  one  specimen  from  the  very  oldest  fos- 
silif erous  strata,  speaks  for  itself  (see  fig.  1 ).  Its  large  cephalic  shield 
spreading  backwards  over  the  trunk  segments,  the  extraordinary 
shortness  of  these  segments  in  strong  contrast  with  the  wide  anal  seg- 
ment with  its  pair  of  cercopoda,  and  lastly,  which  is  a  new  detail 
added  by  Mr  Schuchert,  the  pair  of  circular  markings  suggesting 
eyes  near  the  anterior  margin  of  the  carapace — all  proclaim  its  close 
affinity  to  Apus.  Indeed,  on  first  acquaintance  with  this  fossil,  I 
went  so  far  as  to  suggest  that  it  might  with  advantage  be  called 
Apus  marshi. 

Since  studying  Mr  Schuchert's  paper,  however,  I  have  been  struck 
by  two  features  which  seem  to  me  to  have  been  generally  over- 
looked, one  of  which  is  of  prime  importance.  A  comparison  of 
the  abdominal  segmentation  of  Protocaris  and  Apus  appears  to 
show  that  the  former  retained  a  primitive  condition  which  has  been 
secondarily  lost  in  the  latter. 

One  of  the  principal  arguments  in  favour  of  the  great  antiquity 
of  Apus  was  found  in  the  fact  that  a  great  and  varying  number  of 
posterior  segments  are  fixed  in  a  rudimentary  condition.  The  evi- 
dence for  this  was  found  in  the  progressively  diminishing  sizes  of  the 

1  Bull  U.S.  Geol.  Survey,  10,  1884,  p.  50,  pi.  x.  fig.  1  ;  Amcr.  Nat.,  1885,  p.  293  ; 
Mem.  Nat.  Acad.  Sri.,  Hi.  pt.  2,  p.  145,  pi.  v. 


1897] 


FOSSIL  APODIDAE 


390 


limbs  (see  fig.  6),  each  pair  being  provided  with  a  pair  of  abdominal 
sanslia.  It  was,  of  course,  more  or  less  of  an  assumption  that  these 
limbs  and  ganglia  represented  true  segments,  because  to  all  appear- 
ance the  true  segments  are  marked  off  on  the  body  as  shown  in  the 
fio\  6.  Further,  authors  were  not  wanting  who  definitely  claimed 
that  the  apparent  segmentation  was  the  true  one,  and  that  the 
multiplication  of  the  limbs,  as  many  as  four,  five,  and  even  six  to 
one  single  segment,  was  due  to  some  kind  of  secondary  reduplication 


] .  Protocaris  marshi,  Walcott ;  2.  Dipeltis  carri,  Schuckert  ;  3.  Dipeltis  diplocliscus, 
Packard  ;  4-5.  Another  specimen  of  the  same,  showing  the  under  surface  and  part 
of  the  upper  with  the  eyes  ;  6.  Apus  glacialis,  var.  spitzbcrgensis  from  the  side, 
with  left  half  of  the  carapace  cut  away  to  show  the  whole  trunk  ;  bp.  left  limbs  of 
the  eleventh  segment  modified  into  a  brood-pouch,  p.  pore  leading  into  the  water 
sacs  over  the  eyes.     [Figs.  1-5  after  Schuchert.] 

of  organs  on  one  and  the  same  segment.  The  present  writer,  on  the 
contrary,  maintained  that,  as  at  the  front  end  of  the  body  each  pair 
of  limbs  with  its  pair  of  ganglia  corresponded  with  a  true  body  seg- 
ment, the  whole  series  of  the  limbs  should  be  taken  as  true  seg- 
mental structures,  and  where,  after  the  eleventh  segment,  marked 
by  its  brood  pouch  (hp.),  the  limbs  begin  to  diminish  in  size,  there 
being  more  than   one  to  each  external  division  of  the  body,  these 


400  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [December 

external  divisions  must  be  considered  as  secondary  rings  and  not  as 
true  segments. 

The  correctness  of  this  suggestion  seems  to  me  to  be  entirely 
borne  out  by  the  abdominal  segmentation  of  Protocaris  in  which 
this  secondary  ringing  has  not  taken  place.  If  a  body-ring  were 
marked  round  the  abdomen  of  Apus  for  each  of  the  pairs  of  limbs, 
leaving  out  the  most  minute  at  the  posterior  end  (cf.  rigs.  1  and  6), 
we  should  get  a  condition,  at  least  for  the  limb-bearing  portion  of 
the  abdomen,  not  unlike  that  shown  in  Protocaris,  in  which  a  multi- 
tude of  very  small  segments  (though  not  diminishing  quite  so  clearly 
as  they  would  in  Apus)  are  in  striking  contrast  with  the  anal  seg- 
ment. 

It  should,  however,  be  noted  by  the  way  that  this  interpretation 
of  the  segmentation  of  Apus  which  receives  such  unexpected  and 
welcome  support  from  Protocaris  was  greatly  complicated  by  the 
presence  in  Apus  of  a  varying  number  of  limbless  segments  in  front 
of  the  anal  segment.  These  still  require  explanation ;  at  present  I 
am  inclined  to  look  upon  them  as  secondary  reduplications  of  the 
anal  segment. 

This  difficulty  must  not,  however,  be  thought  to  stand  in  the 
way  of  my  interpretation  of  the  segmentation  of  Apus.  That  inter- 
pretation has  already  received  abundance  of  support  from  the  fact 
that  the  same  fixation  of  rudimentary  segments  is  found  in  the 
Trilobites.  Inasmuch,  however,  as  the  relationship  between  Apus 
and  the  Trilobites  is  still  a  matter  of  discussion,  it  is  especially 
welcome  to  obtain  direct  evidence  from  a  fossil  whose  close  affinity 
with  Apus  cannot  be  for  a  moment  doubted. 

The  second  point  arises  from  the  peculiar  shape  of  the  shield. 
Mr  Schuchert  describes  it  as  subquadrangular,  and  quotes  Clarke's 
suggestion  that  it  has  probably  been  subjected  to  some  horizontal 
distortion  in  the  shale.  The  longer  I  contemplate  the  figure  of  this 
shield  the  more  convinced  I  am  that  it  has  simply  been  flattened 
out,  and  that  in  its  original  shape  it  was  folded  down  at  the  sides 
of  the  body.  Not  only  do  the  two  anterior  lateral  projections  of 
the  shield  suggest  this,  but  the  absence  of  the  usual  spikes  at  the 
postero-lateral  corners  of  the  shield  are  quite  in  accord.  In  Apus 
these  spikes  are  turned  up  somewhat  on  to  the  back  (fig.  6),  and  in 
the  Trilobites  they  are  spread  out  wide  of  the  body  in  the  horizontal 
plane.  If  the  shield  were  folded  down  at  the  sides,  these  spikes  would 
be  a  serious  danger  to  the  limbs  and  abdomen,  and  would  be  sooner 
or  later  dispensed  with.  Whether,  again,  the  dotted  lines  running 
along  the  shield,  shown  in  Mr  Sclmchert's  figure  (reproduced  in  fig. 
1),  lend  any  support  to  this  view,  I  should  not  like  to  say,  because 
we  have  no  means  of  getting  at  their  true  meaning,  but  they  cer- 
tainly suggest  to  my  mind  a  dorso-ventral  flattening. 


1897]  FOSSIL  APODIDAE  401 

We  have  then,  it  seems  to  me,  a  simple  and  natural  interpreta- 
tion of  the  shape  of  the  shield  of  Protocaris  without  assuming  any 
other  distortion  than  that  due  to  flattening.  Had  there  been  any 
horizontal  distortion,  it  would,  one  would  expect,  be  more  apparent 
in  the  abdomen  than  in  the  shield.  1  am  therefore  disposed  to  look 
upon  Protocaris  as  an  Apus  in  process  of  folding  down  laterally 
its  whole  carapace,  a  modification  which,  as  I  have  shown  in  some 
detail  elsewhere,1  would  lead  on  to  the  peculiar  organisation  of  the 
ostracods.  I  lay  stress  upon  the  word  '  whole,'  because  if  only  the 
free  lateral  flaps  behind  the  head  region  are  folded  down,  we 
should  get  a  form  which  might  lead  on  to  the  other  bivalve- 
entomostraca,  the  Daphnidae  and  Estheridae.  In  making  these 
suggestions  I  am  again  taking  up  my  original  position  that  Apus  is 
the  protonauplius  of  authors,  and  that  from  it  or  its  young  stages 
all  the  Crustacea  can  be  deduced.  I  may  add  indeed  that  nothing 
which  has  been  said  during  the  last  five  years  has  shaken  me  in 
that  conviction,  based  originally  upon  my  study  of  Apus.  On  the 
contrary,  all  the  new  facts  which  have  come  to  light  have  tended 
without  exception  to  confirm  it.  I  refer  mainly  to  the  brilliant 
researches  of  Beecher  on  the  limbs  of  the  Trilobite,  Triarthrus,  and 
to  these  fossil  Apodidae  now  under  discussion. 

The  whole  question,  however,  must  of  course  be  decided  solely 
by  the  evidence ;  hence,  I  may  remark  in  passing,  it  is  somewhat 
surprising  to  find  a  zoologist  declaring  that  he  has  no  "  sympathy 
(sic)  with  the  peculiar  phylogenetic  speculations  of  Bernard."  Anti- 
pathy against  the  views  of  a  fellow-worker,  however  unscientific 
such  an  attitude  of  mind  may  be,  is  perhaps  excusable,  but  it  is  not 
so  excusable  merely  to  refer  readers  to  a  semi-popular  summary 
and  not  to  the  papers  containing  the  detailed  evidence  for  the 
hypothesis  condemned.  Readers  could  then  judge  for  themselves 
whether  these  '  peculiar  phylogenetic  speculations '  are  speculations 
at  all,  and  not  rather  necessary  deductions  from  established  facts. 

Mr  Schuchert's  claim  that  '  eyes '  can  be  faintly  seen  on  the 
specimen  will  be  noticed  below. 

Dipeltls 

The  claims  of  this  fossil,  of  which  only  four  specimens  are  known, 
to  belong  to  the  Apodidae,  seem  to  me  far  more  intricate  than  are 
those  of  Protocaris.  It  appears  at  first  sight  as  if  it  might  be  a 
transition  form  between  Apus  and  the  Trilobites,  and  yet  it  only  (so 
far  as  at  present  known)  appears  on  the  scene  in  the  Lower 
Carboniferous,  when  the  Trilobites  were  already  beginning  to  pass 
away. 

]   "  Apodid.'e,"  Section  xv.,  p.  252. 


402  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 

We  note,  particularly  at  the  outset,  that  Mr  Schuchert  evidently 
assumes  that  the  head  of  Dvpeltis  corresponds  to  the  head  of  Apus 
with  its  five  segments.  There  is  no  reason  to  doubt  the  correctness 
of  this  assumption. 

When  analysing  the  differences  between  Apus  and  the  Trilobites,1 
I  came  to  the  conclusion  that  the  essential  distinction  between  them 
was  as  follows : — In  Apus,  after  the  formation  and  fixation  of  the 
head  region  out  of  five  fused  segments,  the  cephalic  shield  grew 
backwards  as  a  large  free  carapace  over  the  trunk  segments,  which 
remained  cylindrical,  whereas  in  the  Trilobites  the  head  shield  did 
not  grow  backwards  freely  over  the  body,  but  was  repeated,  by 
the  familiar  process  of  segmental  repetition,  on  each  of  the  trunk 
segments,  giving  rise  on  them  to  their  pleural  extensions.  This 
curious  difference  in  the  mechanism  of  development  resulted  in  two 
such  apparently  distinct  forms  as  Apus  and  the  Trilobites. 

Dipeltis  now  conies  on  the  scene.  Its  general  appearance  is 
that  of  Apus,  but  its  repetition  of  the  head  shield  is  that  of  the 
Trilobite.  The  head  shield  and  its  two  large  segmental  repetitions 
together  appear  as  if  they  imitated  the  true  free  carapace  of  Apus. 
They  only  appear  to  cover  the  trunk  segments,  as  the  carapace  of 
Apus  covers  its  cylindrical  trunk.  Further,  the  trunk  segments 
also  show  in  their  small  pleurae  a  slight  repetition  of  the  head 
shield,  or  rather  of  the  last  of  the  two  large  repetitions  of  the  head 
shield.  These  are  unmistakable  Trilobitic  characters.  On  the 
other  hand,  the  anal  segment  with  its  pair  of  cercopoda,  the  arrange- 
ment of  the  large  eyes  with  anterior  eyes  or  pores  at  the  front  of 
the  head,  the  smooth  round  forehead  without  glabella  or  furrows, 
are  unmistakably  apodidan  features.  The  animal  looks  remarkably 
like  a  cross  between  an  Apus  and  a  Trilobite  !  The  only  explana- 
tion I  can  suggest  of  this  singular  creature  is  that  it  resulted  from 
a  second  attempt  on  the  part  of  the  main-  or  ^Ms-stem  of  the 
crustacean  phylum  to  adopt  the  Trilobitic  modification ;  that  is,  for  a 
second  time  these  primitive  Crustacea  tried  the  segmental  repetition 
of  the  early  head  shield  instead  of  its  free  backward  extension  as  a 
carapace.  I  would  explain  the  Apus-Uke  appearance  of  this  second 
attempt  as  being  due  to  the  fact  that  it  started  from  a  true  Apus, 
whereas  the  Trilobites  owe  their  peculiar  characters  to  the  fact  that 
they  branched  off  before  the  Apus  type  was  fixed — i.e.  while  the 
head  region  was  still  in  process  of  formation — hence  the  glabella, 
the  transverse  furrows,  and  the  uncertain  position  of  the  eyes  on  the 
head  shield,  with  the  three  longitudinal  regions  running  along  the 
dorsal  surface  due  to  the  segmental  repetition  of  that  head  shield. 

Turning,  in  conclusion,  to  the  eyes  in  figure  3,  these  are  shown 
very  like  those  of  Apus  as  to  position  and  arrangement,  while  in  front 

1  V-  Jowrn.  deal.  Soc,  vols.  li.  and  lii. 


1897]  FOSSIL  APODIDAE  403 

of  these  larger  eyes  are  two  spots.  These  are  also  found  on  another 
specimen,  part  of  which  is  shown  in  figure  5,  copied  from  Dr 
Schuchert's  paper.  In  Apus  in  front  of  the  paired  eyes  is  a  median 
pore  (fig.  6,  p>-)  leading  into  the  water  sac,  in  which  these  paired 
eyes  are  now  sunk.  Tn  the  base  of  the  channel  leading  from  this 
pore  to  the  water  spaces  above  the  eyes  a  body  called  the  median 
eye  is  suspended.  The  structure  of  this  eye  and  its  probable  origin 
— as  suggested  by  its  structure — out  of  a  pair  of  anterior  eyes  I 
have  discussed  elsewhere.1  It  is  therefore  of  some  interest  to  me 
to  find  an  animal,  with  such  claims  to  be  a  relative  of  Apus,  having 
a  pair  of  what  appear  to  be  eyes  in  front  of  the  usual  pair.  It  is 
true  that  this  anterior  pair  persists  in  Limulus,  but  here  again  the 
relationship  between  Apus  and  Limulus  is  still  matter  of  discus- 
sion. It  is  therefore  once  more  pleasant  to  find  what  appears  to  be 
a  direct  confirmation  of  one's  morphological  deductions  in  an  animal 
certainly  related  to  Apus.  What  the  peculiar  ovals  round  these 
anterior  '  eyes  '  are  in  fig.  5  it  is  impossible  to  say.  It  may  be  that 
here  we  see  these  eyes  being  drawn  into  the  median  line  and  below 
the  surface. 

In  Protocaris  I  should  regard  the  two  eyes,  suggested  in  figure 
1 ,  as  corresponding  with  the  paired  eyes  of  Apus :  perhaps  owing 
to  the  bending  of  the  carapace  they  are  sunk  deeper  in  the  water 
sacs. 

I  quite  agree  then  with  Dr  Schuchert  in  calling  these  early 
crustaceans  fossil  Apodidae.  Protocaris  I  suggest  is  a  modifica- 
tion of  Apus  in  the  direction  of  the  bivalve  Ostracods,  Dipeltis 
as  a  second  attempt  of  a  true  Apus  to  adopt  the  Trilobitic  modi- 
fication of  repeating  the  head  shield  as  pleurae  along  the  trunk 
segments,  while  preserving  for  some  reason  or  other  the  habit  of 
Apus.  Henky  M.  Beknakd. 

1  "Apodidae,"  pp.  100-111. 


575.8  404  [December 


Reproductive  Divergence  :  A  Rejoinder 

IN  the  last  month's  number  of  Natural  Science  (p.  317)  Dr  Karl 
Jordan  criticises  a  theory  which  I  had  briefly  suggested  in  a 
previous  number  of  the  journal  (p.  181),  and  which  I  had  entitled 
"  Eeproductive  Divergence  :  an  Additional  Factor  in  Evolution."  I 
had  there  maintained  that  my  theory  differed  essentially  from 
Eomanes'  theory  of  Physiological  Selection,  for  I  endeavoured  to 
show  that  if  the  less  similar  individuals  in  any  species  were  at  the 
same  time  less  fertile  inter  se  than  the  more  similar,  it  would  neces- 
sarily follow  that  in  the  course  of  succeeding  generations  these 
members  would  diverge  more  and  more  from  each  other,  till  eventu- 
ally two  or  more  new  and  mutually  sterile  species  would  be  formed. 
I  still  hold,  in  spite  of  Dr  Jordan's  view  to  the  contrary,  that  this 
theory  is  essentially  different  from  Eomanes',  which  maintains  that 
if  a  portion  of  the  members  of  a  species  happen  to  be  sterile  with  all 
the  other  members,  they  will,  in  virtue  of  this  physiological  barrier, 
be  enabled  to  vary  independently  of  the  parent  stock,  and  so  give 
rise  to  a  new  species. 

I  stated  that  my  theory  was  made  up  of  two  parts,  one  of  which 
was  capable  of  mathematical  demonstration,  whilst  the  other  could 
only  be  verified  by  experiment.  Dr  Jordan  takes  exception  to  the 
former,  but  accepts  the  latter,  he  holding  that  the  "  correlation  between 
morphological  characters  and  fertility  of  the  specimens  of  a  species 
cannot  be  denied."  He  also  adduces  an  additional  instance  in  support 
of  the  existence  of  this  correlation. 

The  mathematical  demonstration  of  the  validity  of  the  theory 
which  I  gave  was,  it  would  seem,  rather  too  brief  for  its  purpose. 
In  excuse  I  must  plead  that  my  paper  was  intentionally  of  only  a 
short  and  preliminary  nature,  as  I  thought  a  more  extended  discus- 
sion had  better  be  deferred  till  I  had  more  experimental  evidence  at 
my  command.  As,  however,  Dr  Jordan  appears  to  have  entirely 
misunderstood  my  reasoning,  he  holding  indeed  that  in  the  particular 
example  1  adduced  to  prove  a  divergence  of  character  there  would 
on  the  contrary  be  a  convergence,  I  must  now  endeavour  to  explain 
the  mathematical  basis  of  the  theory  more  fully.  Thus  of  its  validity 
I  am  convinced  there  can  be  no  question.  Its  adequate  demon- 
stration depends  only  on  skill  in  manipulation  of  figures,  though 
this  I  am  afraid  1  do  not  possess. 


18971  REPRODUCTIVE  DIVERGENCE  405 

The  fresh  example  I  propose  to  adduce  is  founded  on  actual  data, 
namely,  the  measurements  of  human  stature  in  the  case  of  parents 
and  their  offspring,  which  are  given  by  Galton  in  his  work  on 
"Natural  Inheritance"  (p.  208).  Here  the  relations  between 
the  stature  of  205  'parents  of  each  sex  and  of  their  adult 
offspring  are  classified.  The  mid-parents  1  split  up  into  three 
nearly  equal  groups — viz.,  those  below  6 7  "8  inches  in  stature,  those 
from  GT'S  to  G9'2  inches,  and  those  above  69'2  inches.  These 
groups  were  found  to  give  rise  to  more  or  less  equal  numbers  of 
children.  The  numbers  of  children  of  each  stature  which  were 
given  birth  to  by  each  of  these  three  groups  of  short,  medium  and 
tall  mid-parents  were  then  determined,  partly  by  plotting  out  the 
various  numbers  and  calculating  from  the  smoothed  curves,  and 
partly  by  direct  enumeration  of  the  numbers.  By  then  taking 
means  between  the  numbers  of  tall  children  produced  by  tall  parents 
with  those  of  the  short  children  produced  by  short  ones,  and  also 
between  the  numbers  of  short  children  produced  by  tall  parents  with 
those  of  tall  ones  produced  by  short  parents,  roughly  speaking  the 
following  mean  values  were  arrived  at : — 

Short. 

100  short  parents  give        .      54 

100  medium    .  .  .31 

100  tall  .  .  .      15 

100  100  100 

From  these  figures  it  is  seen  that  the  percentage  numbers  of  children 
are  given,  and  not  the  actual  numbers.  This  plan  was  adopted  in 
order  that  the  numbers  of  children  might  be  kept  the  same  as  that 
of  the  parents.  We  see,  therefore,  that  if  100  short,  medium  and 
tall  parents  of  each  sex  be  taken,  the  numbers  of  short,  medium  and 
tall  children  will  still  remain  at  100,  in  spite  of  the  fact  that  the 
children  of  each  group  produced  by  the  different  parents  vary  from 
15  per  cent,  to  54  per  cent. 

In  addition  to  the  children  produced  by  short,  medium  and  tall 
parents,  it  is  for  our  purpose  necessary  to  know  the  numbers  pro- 
duced by  intermarriages  of  short  and  medium,  and  of  medium  and 
tall  parents.  These  numbers  may  be  approximately  obtained  by 
taking  means  between  the  percentages  for  short  and  medium  parents 
on  the  one  hand  and  for  medium  and  tall  ones  on  the  other.      Thus  : 

Short.  Medium.    Tall  children. 

100  short  and  medium  parents  give    425  34'5  23 

100  medium  and  tall     .  .  .23  345  42*5 

It  is  also  necessary  to  assume,  as  Galton  has  shown  his  statistics 
warrant  us  in  doing,  that  short  and   tall  and  also  tall  and  short 


Medium. 

Tall  children 

31 

15 

38 

31 

31 

54 

406  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 

parents  give  rise  to  the  same  numbers  of  children  in  each  group  as 
do  medium  parents. 

If  we  now  take  the  case  of  900  parents  of  either  sex  and  divide 
them  into  three  groups  of  300  short,  medium  and  tall  individuals,  it 
will  be  found  that,  as-  the  result  of  their  chance  intermarrying,  they 
will  give  rise  to  the  following  numbers  of  offspring  of  each  sex  : 

293  short.  314  medium.  293  tall. 

These  numbers  thus  differ  slightly  from  the  300  of  each  group 
which  were  started  with,  but  it  is  not  possible  to  arrange  the  numbers 
resulting  from  the  various  intermarryings  so  as  to  give  quite  identical 
figures.  This,  in  fact,  is  not  necessary,  as  it  is  only  sought  to 
compare  two  different  cases,  in  one  of  which  a  correlation  between 
fertility  and  stature  is  absent,  and  in  the  other  of  which  it  is  present. 
This  latter  case  we  will  now  proceed  to  discuss. 

Let  it  be  granted  that,  in  pursuance  of  this  principle,  100 
parents  intermarrying  with  parents  of  similar  stature  now  give  rise 
to  120,  and  not  100  offspring  of  each  sex.  When  on  the  other 
hand  they  marry  with  moderately  taller  or  shorter  individuals,  let 
the  number  of  offspring  remain  unchanged,  and  when  tall  or  short 
parents  marry  with  short  or  tall,  let  only  80  offspring  instead  of 
100  arise.  If  now  the  same  900  parents  of  either  sex  intermarry 
according  to  the  laws  of  chance,  it  will  be  found,  on  calculating  out 
the  numbers  in  accordance  with  the  data  given  above,  that  the 
following  numbers  of  offspring  will  be  produced : 

Short.  Medium.  Tall. 

300-6  318-8  300-6 

instead  of  293  3,14  293. 

That  is  to  say,  the  numbers  of  short  and  tall  individuals  will  have 
increased  by  2-59  per  cent.,  but  those  of  the  intermediate  ones  by 
only  1-52  per  cent.  There  is  thus  a  gain  of  about  1*07  per  cent, 
in  favour  of  the  extreme  individuals  over  the  intermediate  ones,  or 
supposing  the  original  3,00  medium  individuals  had  again  been 
produced,  there  would  now  be  303-2  instead  of  3,00  tall  and  short 
ones.  This  seems  a  very  small  amount  in  comparison  with  the 
fairly  large  differences  of  fertility  we  assumed  to  be  present.  It  is, 
however,  none  the  less  genuine,  in  spite  of  its  smallness,  and  it  will 
of  course  become  increasingly  larger  in  succeeding  generations. 
Thus  supposing  that  in  the  next  generation  respectively  3,03-2,  300, 
and  303-2  short,  medium  and  tall  individuals  of  each  sex  inter- 
marry, the  short  and  tall  offspring  will  be  increased  by  slightly 
more  than  1-07  per  cent.  ;  by  in  fact  about  1/08  per  cent.  There 
will  now,  therefore,  be  300  +  3-2  1  +  3'24  =  306*45  short  and  tall 
offspring,  instead  of  300.  In  succeeding  generations  the  increase 
will  gradually  become  more  and   more  marked,  and  the  divergence 


1897]  REPRODUCTIVE  DIVERGENCE  407 

of  the  race  into  two  distinct  races  more  and  more  obvious.  Again, 
I  had  supposed  that  the  more  widely  any  two  individuals  differed, 
the  less  on  an  average  would  lie  their  mutual  fertility.  Hence  this 
principle  of  reproductive  divergence  is  a  cumulative  one,  and  the 
later  stages  of  divergence  will  be  very  much  more  rapid  than  the 
initial  ones. 

Again,  Dr  -Jordan  objects  to  my  statement  that  as  the  race 
diverges,  shorter  and  longer  individuals  than  those  originally  present 
will  gradually  be  evolved.  This  seems  to  me  to  be  so  obvious  as  to 
scarcely  need  demonstration.  Thus,  let  us  suppose  for  the  moment 
that  our  900  individuals  of  each  sex  are  split  up  into  450  short 
individuals  and  450  tall  ones.  The  members  of  each  of  these 
groups  will  deviate  in  either  direction  from  the  average  size  in  the 
same  proportion  as  the  members  of  the  original  single  group  did. 
For  instance,  in  the  928  adult  offspring  obtained  in  the  above- 
mentioned  anthropometric  data,  the  mid-stature  or  median  of  the 
whole  group  was  about  68*2  inches,  and  10  per  cent,  of  the  group 
were  below  G4-5  inches  in  height.  Supposing  now  the  median  of 
the  new  group  of  short  individuals  be  6  5  "8  inches,  it  follows  that 
10  per  cent,  of  this  group  will  be  below  62-2  inches  in  height. 
That  is  to  say,  individuals  shorter  than  any  of  those  originally 
present  will  have  arisen.  The  tall  individuals  will,  of  course, 
deviate  in  a  similar  manner  in  the  opposite  direction. 

This  fresh  attempt  to  demonstrate  the  correctness  of  the  prin- 
ciple of  reproductive  divergence  will  not,  I  am  afraid,  appear  much 
more  easy  to  understand  than  the  former  one,  but  it  at  least  has 
the  merit  of  being  roughly  founded  on  actual  data,  so  that  fewer 
preliminary  assumptions  are  necessary,  and  the  result  obtained  is  a 
more  absolute  one,  and  is  moreover  independent  of  the  Law  of 
Regression  towards  mediocrity.1  To  me  it  seems  the  principle  is 
sufficiently  obvious  without  the  help  of  any  mathematics  at  all,  if 
it  be  looked  at  in  the  following  manner.  Let  any  number  of 
individuals  in  a  species  be  divided  up  into  two  groups — the  larger 
ones  and  the  smaller.  Then  if  there  be  a  correlation  between  size 
and  fertility,  it  follows  that  those  larger  individuals  which  happen 
to  breed  with  the  smaller  ones  will  give  rise  to  fewer  individuals  of 
intermediate  size  than  they  would  have  done  if  there  had  been  no 
such  correlation.  That  is  to  say,  the  race  will  begin  to  diverge, 
and  as  this  divergence  is  cumulative,  it  will  ultimately  split  up  into 
two  or  more  new  races.  H.  M.  Vernon. 

1  •'  Natural  Inheritance,"  p.  95. 


575  408  [December 


VI 

Professor  Schiller  on  Darwinism  and  Design 

I  SUPPOSE  that  it  must,  on  the  whole,  be  reckoned  as  an  encour- 
aging sign  of  gradual  advancement  that,  from  time  to  time, 
articles  dealing  with  physical  science  are  allowed  to  appear  in  the 
monthly  Reviews ;  for  the  appearance  of  such  articles  indicates  that 
the  editors  of  these  strictly  commercially-conducted  Reviews  can 
safely  reckon  upon  a  tolerable  percentage  of  their  readers  being 
interested  in  physical  science. 

This  apparent  gradual  spread  of  an  interest  in  physical  science 
is  comforting  ;  and  it  is  good  that  the  huge  section  of  the  public, 
who  never  by  any  chance  read  scientific  books  or  scientific  periodi- 
cals, should  yet,  through  the  medium  of  the  Revieivs,  acquire  some 
slight  taste  for  physical  science  and  some  trifling  knowledge  of 
recent  advances  therein.  From  this  standpoint,  then,  the  practice  of 
inserting  scientific  articles  in  the  lay  Reviews  is  much  to  be  com- 
mended ;  but  it  is  not  to  be  denied  that  there  are  compensating  dis- 
advantages, and  these  are  due  to  two  factors. 

In  the  first  place,  the  editors  of  these  Reviews,  being  usually — 
like  most  other  "  well-educated  "  Englishmen — utterly  ignorant  of 
physical  science,  are  hopelessly  unable  to  estimate  for  themselves 
the  value  of  any  scientific  article  submitted  to  them,  and  are  thus 
entirely  incapacitated  from  exercising  any  truly  editorial  functions 
with  regard  to  such  articles ;  and,  in  the  second  place,  all  these 
Reviews  are  conducted  upon  strictly  commercial  principles,  being- 
regarded  primarily  as  money-making  machines,  and  only  secondarily 
as  organs  of  education  and  enlightenment.  Both  these  factors  con- 
spire to  bring  about  one  and  the  same  result,  viz.,  that  the  editors 
taboo  all  articles  not  signed  by  a  big  name — which'  is  at  once  the 
guarantee  of  profit  to  their  purses  and  of  safety  to  their  ignorance — 
and  are  naturally  tempted  to  exclude  controversial  replies.  Usually 
their  assiduous  worship  of  big  names  safeguards  them  from  any 
fiasco  ;  but  now  and  then  there  creeps  into  a  Review  an  article  which 
betrays  only  too  signally  the  fact  that  it  was  entirely  unintelligible 
to  the  "  editor,"  and  that  that  omnipotent  functionary  was  education- 
ally disqualified  from  perceiving  the  extraordinary  nature  of  the 
statements  and  arguments  appearing  in  his  Re/view. 

To  this  category  seems  to  belong  the  article  on  Darwinism  and 
Design,  contributed  by  Professor  F.  C.  S.  Schiller  to  the  Contemporary 


1897]        SCHILLER  ON  DARWINISM  AND  DESIGN        409 

for  -Tune  last — an  article  that,  though  dealing  with  physical  science, 
bears  the  most  obvious  traces  of  a  metaphysician's  handiwork.  I 
certainly  do  not  propose  to  criticise  this  article  in  detail ;  for  such  a 
criticism,  to  be  at  all  adequate,  might  require  an  article  a  good  deal 
longer  than  Professor  Schiller's  own  :  and,  fortunately,  any  such  de- 
tailed criticism  were  superfluous ;  firstly,  because  all  readers  who  have 
any  familiarity  with  biological  science  may  perceive  for  themselves 
the  errors  into  which  Professor  Schiller  has  fallen  ;  and,  secondly, 
because  those  readers  of  his  article  who  are  entirely  ignorant  of  the 
subject  would  hardly  be  among  the  readers  of  Natural  Science,  nor 
would  they  perhaps  be  affected  by  my  arguments  even  if  they  read 
them.  I  propose,  therefore,  merely  to  call  attention  to  two  or  three 
notable  points  in  Darurinism  and  Design. 

The  article,  which  opens  with  somewhat  of  a  flourish  of  trumpets, 
and  excites  expectations  that  are  by  no  means  realised  in  the  sequel, 
is  directed  to  prove  that  '  Darwinism '  has  not  necessarily  excluded 
the  possibility  of  a  teleological  conception  of  organic  nature ;  but 
that,  properly  scrutinised,  evolutionism  rather  strengthens  the  argu- 
ment from  '  Design'  than  otherwise.1  Now  Professor  Schiller  makes 
one  or  two  initial  omissions  of  a  notable  character.  He  intentionally 
confines  himself  to  "  living  nature,"  thus  putting  aside  altogether  the 
awkward  question  as  to  whether  the  evolution  of  solar  systems  be, 
or  be  not,  ascribable  to  Design  ;  and  he  writes  as  though  evolution- 
ism and  Darwinism  were  the  same  thing — as  though  to  demonstrate 
an  error  in  any  one  of  Darwin's  initial  assumptions  were  to  at  once 
clear  out  of  the  way  all  biological  objections  to  the  teleological  con- 
ception of  the  world.  The  former  omission  is  highly  significant  of 
the  philosophical  value,  or  otherwise,  of  Professor  Schiller's  article ; 
the  latter  oversight  appears  to  me  to  vitiate  his  entire  argument,  and 
to  render  it  little  more  than  a  beating  of  the  air ;  and  one  is  tempted 
to  say  that  the  article  would  have  been  topical  in  1860,  but  is  a 
generation  out  of  date  now. 

Professor  Schiller  is  good  enough  to  tell  us  that  the  old-fashioned 
argument  from  design  was  rotten  even  before  the  advent  of  Dar- 
winism ;  but  he  proposes  to  recast  the  argument  in  such  fashion 
that  '  Darwinism '  shall  be  no  obstacle,  but  rather  indeed  an  as- 
sistance, to  the  teleologist.  He  tells  us  that  "  before  the  argument 
from  design  has  any  theological  value,  two  things  have  to  be  shown  : 
(1)  that  intelligence,  i.e.,  action  directed  to  a  purpose,  has  been  at 
work  ;  and  (2)  that  the  intelligence  has  not  been  that  of  any  of  the 
admitted  existences." 2  The  former  part  of  this  statement  reads 
rather  curiously  ;  but  it  only  means  that,  for  the  author's  purpose, 
it  is  essential  to  prove  that  the  adaptations  in  organic  nature  have 
not  been  brought  about  solely  by  a  blind  mechanical  process,  but 

1  Cf.  p.  144.  2  Contemporary  Review,  p.  868. 

2  F 


410  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [December 

are  due,  at  least  partly,  to  intelligent  effort  on  somebody's  part. 
To  make  good  this  position,  Professor  Schiller  has  recourse  to  some- 
what strained  arguments.  For  instance,  he  suggests  that  "  a  com- 
plete denial  of  design  in  nature  must  deny  the  efficacy  of  all 
intelligence  as  such.  ...  If  that  view  were  true,  we  should  have 
to  renounce  all  efforts  to  direct  our  fated  and  ill-fated  course  adown 
the  stream  of  time  "  (p.  868).  But  this  ingenuous  attempt  to  make 
the  anti-teleologist  damn  himself — on  the  plea  that  logically  he  is 
bound  to  deny  the  efficacy  of  all  intelligence  if  he  deny  the  argu- 
ment from  design — seems  to  me  a  mere  trifling  with  words,  and 
recalls  the  old  saying  that  "  words  are  wise  men's  counters,  they  do 
but  reckon  with  them;  but  they  are  the  money  of"  metaphysicians. 
Professor  Schiller  must  know  perfectly  well  that  the  "  denial  of  de- 
sign "  is  merely  an  elliptical  phrase  meaning  the  "denial  that  the 
adaptations  in  nature  evidence  the  design  of  an  over-ruling  Divine 
intelligence  "  ;  and  that  this  denial,  neither  logically  nor  historically, 
implies  anything  so  absurd  as  the  denial  of  "  the  efficacy  of  all  in- 
telligence " — such  intelligence  itself  being  regarded  by  consistent 
evolutionists  as  a  notable  adaptation  to  our  environment.  But  this 
playing  with  words,  this  use  of  words  in  Humpty-Dumpty's  port- 
manteau fashion,  so  that  two  very  different  meanings  are  packed 
into  one  word,  is  typical  of  Professor  Schiller's  article.  Of  this  we 
have  a  glaring  example  in  the  following  passage,  which  is,  to  a 
certain  extent,  the  key  to  the  author's  position : — 

"  The  ease  with  which  the  Darwinian  argument  dispenses  with 
all  intelligence  as  a  factor  in  survival,  excites  suspicion.  It  is 
proving  too  much  to  show  that  adaptation  might  equally  well — i.e., 
as  completely,  if  not  as  rapidly — have  arisen  in  automata.  For 
we  know  that  we  ourselves  are  not  automata,  and  strive  hard  to 
adapt  ourselves.  In  us  at  least,  therefore,  intelligent  effort 
is  a  source  of  adaptation,  and  the  same  will  surely  be  admitted 
in  the  case  of  the  higher  animals.  .  .  .  Intelligence  therefore  is  a 
vera  causa,  as  a  source  of  adaptations,  at  least  co-ordinate  with 
natural  selection ;  and  this  can  be  denied  only  if  it  is  declared  in- 
efficacious everywhere — if  all  living  beings,  ourselves  included,  are 
declared  to  be  automata.  ...  If,  however,  intelligence  is  read- 
mitted as  a  vera  causa,  there  arises  at  least  a  possibility  that  other 
intelligence  besides  that  of  the  known  living  beings  may  have  been 
operative  in  the  world's  history"  (p.  871  ;  spaced  type  mine). 

It  is  worth  while  to  realise  the  fallacy  involved  in  this  passage  ; 
for,  when  once  that  is  realised,  there  is  not  much  left  in  our  author's 
case.  The  whole  fallacy  lurks  in  that  word  adaptations.  It  is 
obvious  that  individual  animals  do  functionally  adapt  themselves 
in  many  ways  to  their  environment ;  and  that,  the  greater  their  in- 
telligence, and  the  better  consequently  their  adaptations,  the  greater 


1897]        SCHILLER  ON  DARWINISM  AND  DESIGN        411 

their  chance   of  life.      But,  to   Professor   Schiller's   argument,  it   is 
essential  to  show  (1)   that  structural  adaptations  can  be,  and  are, 
thus   brought   about;    and  (2)  that  such   adaptations   are  inherited. 
This  Professor  Schiller   does   not   even  attempt  to  prove ;  but  it  is 
the  crux  of  the  entire  argument.      If  Professor  Schiller  can  prove 
that  individual  intelligence  is  capable  of  producing  direct  structural 
modifications  —  i.e.,  modifications   at   which    it    has   directly 
aimed — and  if  he  can  farther  show  that  such  modifications  are  in- 
herited, he  will  certainly  have  made  out  the  former  part  of  his  hypo- 
thesis,viz.,  that  "intelligence,  i.e.,  action  directed  to  a  purpose,  has  been 
at  work."    This  proof,  however,  he  does  not  even  attempt;  but  contents 
himself  with  asserting  of  '  adaptations '  what  is  true,  so  far  as  we 
know,  only  of  individual  functional  adaptations;  and  by  thus  using  the 
word  '  adaptations,'  simply  and  without  any  expressed  qualifications, 
he  obtains  a  fictitious  appearance  of  a  demonstration ;  for  the  term 
'  adaptation,'  when  used  in  such  arguments  by  evolutionists,  is  used  in 
the  sense  of  '  inherited  structural  adaptations  ' — as  Professor  Schiller 
ought  to  know  perfectly  well.      It  is  simply  the  old  metaphysical 
sophism  of  using  one  and  the  same  word  in  two  distinct  senses,  and 
crediting  to  the  one  sense  of  it  what  is  readily  granted  to  the  other ; 
and  to  perceive  the  fallacy  involved  in  his  use  of  the  word  '  adap- 
tations '  is  to  knock  a  pretty  considerable  hole  in  the  bottom  of  Pro- 
fessor Schiller's  argument.      Can  our  author  see  no  difference  in  kind 
between  the  functional  adaptations  of  an  individual  man  to  a  mari 
time  life  or  a  desert  life  and  the  structural  adaptations  of  a  whale 
and  a  camel  to  these  respective  modes  of  life  ?     We  all  know  that 
individual  men,  by  varying  their  food  and  clothing,  can  thus  in- 
telligently adapt  themselves  to  very  different  conditions  of  life  ;  but 
how   does  this   fact  create  any  presumption  that  even  the  camel's 
stomach    or   the  whale's   form   is    the   result   of   intelligent   action 
directed  to  a  purpose,  and  still  less  that  the  countless  wonderful 
adaptations  of  which   no   man  even   is  conscious   until  he  studies 
anatomy,  and  over  which  even  then  he  is  powerless  to  exert  any 
intelligent  control,  and   which  work   best  when  he  is  unconscious 
— such  adaptations,  I  mean,  as  the  valves  of  the  heart  and  countless 
•others — are  the  outcome  of  intelligent  action  directed  to  a  purpose  ? 
It  does  not  indeed  seem  clear  that  even  Lamarckian  factors  would 
avail  Professor  Schiller  here,  unless,  possibly,  the  proverbial  mouse 
■could  be  shown  to  have  acquired  a  neck  a  yard  long  by  intelligently 
and  purposefully  directing  its  gaze  to  the  unattainable  cheese  above  it; 
for  it  were  one  thing  to  admit  that  the  effects  of  use  were  inherited, 
but  quite  another  to  assert  that  any  evolution  has  been  due  to  the 
intelligent  action  of  animals  directed  to  the  purpose   of  adapting 
themselves  to  their  surroundings.      Even  were  Mr  Spencer's  argu- 
ment concerning  the  giraffe  conceded  by  his  opponents,  I  scarcely  see 


412  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 

how  this  would  help  Professor  Schiller ;  for  not  even  the  most  fervid 
Lamarckian  ever  dreamed  that  the  giraffe,  when  straining  at  the 
leaves,  was  intelligently  and  purposefully  directing  the  develop- 
ment of  muscles  and  bones  and  the  rearrangement  of  his  internal 
and  external  anatomy  generally.  Thus  the  very  modifications,  on 
which  the  whole  value  of  his  Lamarckian  neck  rested,  were  due  to 
blind  mechanical  action  over  which  he  exercised  no  intelligent  con- 
trol.  Moreover,  it  does  not  appear  that  Professor  Schiller  had  even 
cleared  up  his  notions  of  '  adaptations '  so  far  as  to  think  of  appeal- 
ing to  Lamarckism  to  support  his  contention  that  intelligent  action 
is  responsible  for  many  adaptations  ;  for  in  that  section  he  does  not 
even  mention  Lamarck,  though  soon  afterwards  he  remarks  in  pass- 
ing (p.  872)  that  "  it  is  practically  certain  that  some  Lamarckian  in- 
fluences must  affect  both  the  number  and  the  character  of  the 
variations  " — the  metaphysician,  with  typical  assurance  and  hasti- 
ness, thus  dogmatically  deciding  a  question  over  which  our  leading- 
biologists,  who  alone  are  competent  to  speak  authoritatively,  are 
hopelessly  at  variance. 

I  pass  over  the  curious  passage  in  which  Professor  Schiller  cites 
the  action  of  the  '  general  physical  and  chemical  laws  of  nature '  as 
barring  variations  in  certain  directions,  and  thus  rendering  impossible 
the  indefinite  variation  on  which  Darwin  founded  his  arguments 
(p.  872),1  and  I  will  not  comment  here  upon  his  strange  citation 
of  Bateson's  work  on  Discontinuous  Variation — which  he  fondly 
supposes  to  constitute  a  stumbling-block  to  Natural  Selection — for 
I  have  already  replied  to  that  argument  in  the  columns  of  Natural 
Science  (May,  1895)  ;  but  we  will  pass  at  once  to  the  concluding 
section  of  Professor  Schiller's  article.  This  is  really  suggestive  and 
ingenious ;  and,  had  the  author  excised  the  first  ten  pages  of  his 
article  and  retained  only  the  latter  part,  he  would  probably  have 
stood  higher  in  the  opinion  of  biologists.  The  pith  of  this  latter 
part  of  his  argument  may  be  stated  in  very  few  words. 

Darwin  assumed  that  organisms  vary  indefinitely  in 
every  direction,  and  that  the  evolution  of  species  is  due  to  the 
action  of  natural  selection  in  seizing  upon  and  fixing  a  few  among 
these  countless  variations.  Were  this  assumption  a  literal 
statement  of  fact,  any  possibility  of  interpreting  the  universe 
teleologically  would  be  barred  al>  initio ;  but,  if  variation  be  not 
indefinite  in  every  direction,  but  more  frecruent  in  one  direction  than 
in  others,  it  may  be  purposive ;  and  thus  the  ground  is  cleared  for 
building  up  a  new  teleology.  Now  Darwin's  assumption  was  not 
a  statement  of  fact,  but  a  methodological  assumption,  exactly 
analogous  to  the  economic  assumption  of   an  ideal  '  economic  man,' 

1  The  same  sort  of*  objection  might  be  brought  against  the  first  law  of  motion,  and  in- 
either  case  is  obviated  by  the  insertion  of  the  words  '  tends  to — ' 


1897]        SCHILLER  ON  DARWINISM  AND  DESIGN        413 

or  to  the  mathematician's  assumption  of  a  single  body  in  an  other- 
wise void  space.  By  arguing  from  such  methodological  assumptions, 
the  '  laws '  of  motion  and  the  '  laws  '  of  economics  were  obtained ; 
but  all  these  '  laws  '  are  applicable  to  concrete  facts,  only  with 
modifications,  and  after  re-introducing  the  qualifications  that  were 
methodologically  omitted  from  the  premises,  and  the  methodological 
assumption  must  never  be  accepted  as  a  statement  of  literal 
facts. 

Now  this  is  certainly  a  very  interesting  and  ingenious  thesis,  and 
I  do  not  remember  previously  to  have  seen  the  suggestion  made 
that  Darwin's  assumption  was  thus  purely  methodological ;  but  it 
does  not  seem  likely  that  Professor  Schiller's  ingenuity  will  be  of 
any  service  to  the  teleologist.  It  were  necessary  before  any  teleo- 
logical  argument  can  be  founded  that  he  should  prove  (1)  that 
variations  are  not  indefinite  but  definite ;  and  (2)  that  such 
definite  variation  can  be  attributed  to  no  mundane  factors,  but  can 
be  explained  only  by  the  assumption  of  supra-mundane  purposive 
intelligence. 

The  former  hypothesis — for  the  sake  of  the  argument — we  will 
grant  to  Professor  Schiller,  although  he  has  not  even  attempted  to 
prove  it,  except  by  his  curious  remarks  about  '  chemical  and 
physical  laws,'  &c. : x  but  what  is  it  worth  to  him  ?  Nothing  !  for 
that  '  ultra-Darwinian '  Weismann  has  already  contended  that 
variation  is  definite  in  direction,  and  he  has  offered  a  purely 
mechanical  explanation  of  such  definiteness  ;2  so  that  what  was  to  be 
treasured  up  as  the  trump  card  of  the  teleologist  has  already  been 
played  on  the  other  side.  But  is  it  not  indeed  significant  that  the 
author  of  this  curiously  belated  article,  seeking  to  turn  the  evolu- 
tionists' flank  and  to  clear  the  field  for  the  teleologists,  should  be 
unaware  that  our  most  prominent  living  evolutionist  had  already, 
by  anticipation,  outflanked  his  flanking  movement  more  than  a  year 
ago  ?  Thus  the  only  really  at  all  valuable  part  of  Professor 
Schiller's  article,  the  one  part  not  invalidated  by  fallacious  trifling 
with  words,  is  yet  invalidated  by  his  ignorance  of  the  science  that 
he  seeks  to  press  into  the  service  of  teleology.  What,  in  this  year 
1897,  can  be  more  hopelessly  belated  than  the  following  remarks 
(p.  875) :  "  It  is  clear  then  that,  to  explain  the  changes  which  have 
resulted  in  the  existing  forms  of  life,  some  variable  factor  has  to  be 
added  to  natural  selection.  And  as  to  the  nature  of  that  factor, 
Darwinism  qua  Darwinism  tells  us  nothing."  Perhaps  it  is  even 
clearer  that,  had  Professor  Schiller  possessed  any  acquaintance  with 

1  It  is  one  thing  to  argue  that  Darwin  did  not  prove  variation  to  be  indefinite,  quite 
another  to  prove  that  it  is  not  intrinsically  indefinite  ;  and  the  teleologist  must  prove 
the  latter  proposition,  and  prove  it  by  a  wide  induction  from  multitudinous  details  and 
experiments,  before  he  can  even  talk  of  teleology. 

2  See  his  "Germinal  Selection." 


414  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [December 

Weismann's   work — of  the   whole   of   which,   and,  indeed,  even  of 
Weismann's    existence,  he   seems   to   be  profoundly  ignorant — this 
passage,  and  the  whole  of  his  article  besides,  would  have  remained 
unwritten.      It  does  seem   to  me  rather  hard  that  metaphysicians 
who  want  to  write  about  evolution  will  not  take  the  trouble  to  find 
out  what  evolutionism  connotes  at  the  present  day  ;  but  Professor 
Schiller's  ignorance  of  recent  advances  in  biology  is  quite  on  a  par 
with  the  curious  and  fatal  misconception  of  the  processes  and  factors 
of  evolution  that  prevails  throughout  his  article  ;  and  the  cue  to  his 
philosophical  status  is  afforded  by  his  very  theological  conclusion, 
from  which  we  learn  that,  if  the  whole  of  his  argument  be  valid, 
evolutionism  rather  helps  than  hinders  the  teleologist,  since  he  is  no 
longer  compelled   to  attribute  perfection,  but  only  gradual  perfec- 
tioning,  to  this  very  imperfect  scheme  of  nature,  nor  to  saddle  an 
omnipotent  deity  with  the  responsibility  for  deliberately  planning 
and  designing  all  the  cruelty  and  suffering  prevalent  throughout  the 
world.      In  other  words,  he  proposes,  by  the  help  of  evolution,  to 
save  divine  morality  at  the  expense  of  divine  power ;  his  directing 
Intelligence  being,  not  an  omnipotent  fiend,  but  only  an  unpractised 
though  well-meaning  bungler.      I  hope  that  the  theologians  will  be 
duly  grateful  to  their  very  candid  friend.1 

lie  theory  of  an  innate  tendency  to  vary  in  a  definite  direction  of  advance  was, 
e,  advocated  long  ago  by  Nageli.     In  an  article  on  "Evolution  and  Teleology  " 


1  The 
of  course, 

that  appeared  in  the  Nev)  Science  Review  of  July,  1S95,  I  pointed  out  how  strongly  the 
recent  advances  in  botany  have  told  against  this  theory,  and  how  in  nearly  every  line  of 
ascent  evolution  upwards  has  ended  in  a  blind  alley. 


F.  H.  Pekey  Coste. 


•i  i  r> 


SOME  NEW  BOOKS 

"Let  us  now  Praise  Famous  Men!" 

The  Founders  of  Geolocy.     By  Sir  Archibald  Geikie.     8vo,  pp.  x+  "298.     London: 

Macmillan  &  Co.,  1897.     Price,  6s.  net. 

If,  as  Emerson  has  said,  all  history  may  be  read  in  the  lives  of  a  few 
great  men,  this  may  be  regarded  as  specially  true  of  the  history  of 
science.  The  facts  of  science,  no  doubt,  are  accumulated  by  a  multi- 
tude of  workers ;  but  ideas  have  their  genesis  in  the  brains  of  the 
leaders,  and  the  growth  of  the  ideas  may  best  be  studied  as  it  took 
place  originally  in  the  minds  of  a  few  individuals.  Hence  Sir  Archi- 
bald Geikie.  when  eager  to  dispel  the  lamentable  ignorance  of  most  of 
us  concerning  the  historical  development  of  geology,  could  have  chosen 
no  better  means  than  tins  skilful  and  charming  narration  of  the 
endeavours  of  the  early  pioneers. 

The  occasion  of  this  work  was  the  inauguration  of  the  George 
Huntington  Williams  Lectureship  at  Johns  Hopkins  University,  and 
one  can  imagine  the  delight  with  which  American  geologists  listened 
to  the  polished  periods  and  lucid  exposition  of  Sir  Archibald.  Some 
of  the  perorations,  indeed,  are  better  adapted  to  the  lecture-platform 
than  the  study,  and  an  occasional  weakness  in  the  usually  correct  and 
forceful  style  suits  the  written  less  than  the  spoken  word.  Careful 
revision,  for  instance,  would  have  eliminated  such  a  sentence  as  this : 
"  His  father  .  .  .  died  while  the  son  was  still  very  young,  to  whom 
he  left  a  small  landed  property  in  Berwickshire."  We  test  the  author 
by  his  own  high  standard. 

The  geologists  referred  to  in  this  book  are — Leibnitz  and  Buffon 
(who,  however,  are  not  regarded  as  among  the  founders  of  geology,  but 
as  the  last  of  the  cosmogonists),  Guettard,  Desmarest,  Pallas,  De 
Saussure,  Lehmann,  Fuchsel,  Werner,  D'Aubuisson,  Von  Buch, 
Hutton,  Sir  J.  Hall,  Giraucl-Soulavie,  Cuvier,  A.  Brongniart,  Omalius 
d'Halloy,  Bev.  J.  Michel],  William  Smith,  Murchison,  Sedgwick, 
Logan,  Agassiz,  ISucol,  Sorby,  Lyell,  and  Darwin.  Many  others  are 
mentioned  incidentally  and,  in  relation  to  these,  the  pioneers.  For 
the  expressed  purpose  of  the  book,  this  list  is  an  excellent  one.  No 
doubt,  every  one  that  has  read  much  in  the  early  literature  of  geology 
will  be  ready  with  suggestions  for  its  amendment.  The  fact  is  that 
a  vast  number  of  these  old  writers  were  not  so  ignorant  or  so  foolish 
as  we  are  too  ready  to  suppose.  Guettard  is  one  whose  claims  have 
been  strangely  overlooked,  and  we  are  delighted  to  see  this  admirable 
appreciation  of  his  many  services  to  our  science.  But  the  list,  it  will 
be  noticed,  is  almost  entirely  confined  to  French,  German,  and  British 
geologists :  Linnaeus  and  Wallerius  are  dismissed  in  a  single  line. 
Linnaeus,  however,  did  more  than  arrange  certain  minerals  in  one  of 
his  kingdoms  of  nature  :  he  studied  the  strata  in  which  minerals  and 
organised  fossils  occurred,  travelling   through    Sweden  and  making 


416  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 

careful  geological  observations,  which  he  published  in  the  accounts  of 
his  journeys  to  Gotland,  to  Oeland,  and,  above  all,  to  Westrogothia 
and  Scania.  He  drew  a  section  of  the  strata  composing  Kinnekulle, 
and  paralleled  them  with  beds  in  other  parts  of  Sweden,  subsequently 
using  his  knowledge  to  interpret  the  structure  of  Scania.  "Thus," 
said  he,  "  the  section  of  Kinnekulle  serves  as  introduction  to  Strata 
terrae  or  the  anatomy  of  the  earth-crust,  not  only  here  in  Westro- 
gothia, but  probably  over  the  greater  part  of  the  world."  He  recog- 
nised that  the  strata  had  been  deposited  in  the  sea  throughout  many 
long-vanished  periods,  and  attempted  to  classify  them  according  to 
their  relative  age.  Thus  Linnaeus  laid  the  foundations  of  the 
Wernerian  system  before  Werner  was  born ;  and  it  was  not  long 
before  his  fellow-countryman  Bergman  erected  upon  that  foundation 
the  actual  framework  that  Werner  filled  in.  Other  Scandinavians 
might  have  been  mentioned,  such  as  Gyllenhahl,  with  his  truly  re- 
markable palaeontological  study  of  Echinosphaera,  and  Hermelin, 
with  his  geological  maps  of  Southern  Norway  and  Sweden.  The 
most  curious  omission,  however,  considering  the  occasion  of  the 
lectures,  is  that  of  citizens  of  the  United  States.  Featherstonhaugh 
and  H.  D.  Rogers  are  just  alluded  to,  but  that  remarkable  and  much- 
abused  geological  genius,  Ebenezer  Emmons,  is  not  even  named. 

We  have  not  mentioned  these  omissions  for  the  sake  of  fault- 
finding, but  as  further  evidence  of  the  amount  of  good  work  done  by 
many  whom  it  is  the  fashion  of  the  present  day  to  disregard.  We 
sympathise  warmly,  as  we  have  already  said,  with  Professor  Miall's 
recent  plea  for  a  more  historical  method  of  teaching  the  natural 
sciences,  and,  as  a  help  in  that  direction,  no  book  is  better  adapted 
than  the  present.  But  those  who  imagine,  if  such  there  be,  that  they 
have  passed  beyond  the  student  stage,  would  yet  do  well  to  dip  now 
and  again  into  the  battered  volumes  that  grow  dusty  on  topmost 
shelves.  There  are  many  observations  and  many  shrewd  suggestions 
hidden  in  those  old  books,  made  perhaps  too  early  in  the  day  to  have 
taken  effect,  but  waiting  to  be  applied  by  us  now  with  our  modern 
knowledge  and  methods.  Eosinus,  for  instance,  178  years  ago,  de- 
scribed the  course  of  the  nerve-canals,  "foramina  jure  meritoque  pro 
nervorum  canalibus  reputanda,"  in  the  cup  of  the  lily-encrinite,  in 
language  that  Dr  W.  B.  Carpenter  (the  modern  discoverer  of  that 
nerve-system)  could  not  have  bettered.  The  fact  is  that  the  worth  of 
a  man's  work  does  not  necessarily  depend  on  the  number  of  his  years 
or  on  the  century  in  which  he  lives. 

Some  of  the  most  valuable  passages  in  this  book  are  those  in 
which  Sir  Archibald  uses  the  weight  of  his  experience  to  enforce 
the  morals  to  be  derived  from  the  study  of  the  older  writers,  hi 
one  place  he  quotes  Fitton's  review  of  the  Wernerian  school :  "  A 
Wernerian  geognost  is  chiefly  employed  in  placing  the  phenomena  he 
observes  in  the  situations  which  his  master  has  assigned  to  them  in 
his  plan  of  the  mineral  kingdom.  It  is  not  so  much  to  describe  the 
strata  as  they  are,  and  to  compare  them  with  rocks  of  the  same 
character  in  other  countries,  as  to  decide  whether  they  belong  to  this 
or  that  series  of  depositions,  supposed  once  to  have  taken  place  over 
the  whole  earth,  ...  to  ascertain  their  place  in  an  ideal  world." 
Similar  criticism  might  justly  be  applied  to-day  in  various  branches 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  417 

of  science.  Sir  Henry  Howorth's  '  heretical '  article  in  our  November 
number  did  little  more  than  translate  the  words  of  Fitton.  Then  are 
there  not  a  good  many  hard-working  zoologists  and  botanists  who  are 
perfectly  satisfied  if  they  can  assign  their  specimens  to  certain  pigeon- 
holes made  for  them  in  a  rather  hypothetical  cupboard  called  a  System? 
It  is  even  a  fact  that  many  excellent  old  writers  are  ignored  jnst 
because  they  could  not,  or  would  not,  use  a  regular  Linnaean  termin- 
ology. Their  works  are  neither  read  nor  to  be  found  in  our  scientific 
libraries.  Into  such  obscurity  even  Hutton's  great  work,  "  The 
Theory  of  the  Earth,"  may  fall.  It  is  nothing  that  we  saw  it 
characterised  recently  in  the  catalogue  of  a  second-hand  bookseller 
as  "  This  extravagant  theory  which  was  defended  by  the  celebrated 
Professor  Play  fair  " ;  but  we  were  indeed  surprised  to  find  no  copy  of 
it  in  the  geological  library  at  the  Natural  History  Museum. 

"With  reference  to  Playfair's  defence,  known  as  "  Illustrations  of 
the  Huttonian  Theory,"  Sir  Archibald  remarks :  "  For  precision  of 
statement  ami  felicity  of  language,  it  has  no  superior  in  English 
scientific  literature.  To  its  early  inspiration  I  owe  a  debt  which 
I  can  never  fully  repay.  Upon  every  young  student  of  geology 
I  would  impress  the  advantage  of  reading  and  re-reading,  and  reading 
yet  again,  this  consummate  masterpiece.  How  different  would  geo- 
logical literature  be  to-day  if  men  had  tried  to  think  and  write  like 
Playfair  \ » 

Put  it  may  be  objected,  How  can  we  find  time  to  read  these  old 
authors,  much  less  to  write  like  the  best  of  them  ?  We  have  to  read 
the  modern  literature,  and  even  a  small  part  of  that  is  overwhelming. 
We  have  so  much  to  do  that  we  cannot  waste  our  energies  on  mere 
style,  and  we  must  rush  out  our  results  the  easiest  and  quickest  way 
we  can,  or  we  shall  be  anticipated.  Sir  Archibald's  answer  should  be 
laid  to  heart,  not  merely  by  geologists  old  and  young,  but  by  all 
scientific  workers.  He  finds  his  consolation  in  "  the  conviction,  borne 
in  upon  us  by  ample  and  painful  experience,  that  a  very  large  mass 
of  the  geological  writing  of  the  present  time  is  utterly  worthless  for 
any  of  the  higher  purposes  of  the  science,  and  that  it  may  quite  safely 
and  profitably,  both  as  regards  time  and  temper,  be  left  unread.  If 
geologists,  and  especially  young  geologists,  could  only  be  brought  to 
realise  that  the  addition  of  another  paper  to  the  swollen  flood  of  our 
scientific  literature  involves  a  serious  responsibilit}'',  that  no  man 
should  publish  what  is  not  of  real  consequence,  and  that  his  state- 
ments when  published  should  be  as  clear  and  condensed  as  he  can 
make  them,  what  a  blessed  change  would  come  over  the  faces  of  their 
readers,  and  how  greatly  they  would  conduce  to  the  real  advance  of 
the  science  which  they  wish  to  serve."  There  is  not  a  dull  page  in 
"  The  Founders  of  Geology,"  but,  were  it  only  on  account  of  this  last 
paragraph,  we  should  wish  for  it  many  readers  in  all  parts  of  the 
world. 

The  Death  of  Rocks 

A  Treatise  on  Rocks,  Rock-Weathering,  and  Soils.     By  G.  P.  Merrill.     8vo,  pp. 
xx  +  411,  pis.  xxv.     New  York  :  The  Macmillan  Company,  1897.     Price,  17s. 

What  the  unsatisfactory  preservation  of  fossils  is  to  a  palaeontologist 
and  surface  drift  to  a'  stratigrapher,  decomposition  of  rocks  has  long 


418  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 

been  to  the  petrologist.  Each  is  regarded  as  an  unmitigated  nuisance, 
interfering  with  the  observation  of  facts  for  which  the  enquirer  is- 
searching ;  and  as  the  stratigrapher  is  expected  to  map  solid  rock 
through  its  drift  covering,  the  petrological  specialist,  when  consulted 
as  to  the  character  of  a  rock,  is  expected  to  say,  not  what  it  is,  but 
what  it  may  once  have  been. 

Professor  Merrill,  however,  has  endeavoured,  in  the  work  under 
review,  to  make  the  processes  and  results  of  weathering  as  interesting 
and  full  of  real  importance  as  the  American  and  English  glacialists 
are  making  the  drift.  For  it  is  the  weathering  of  rocks  which  forms 
soil,  the  link  between  the  dead  earth-crust  and  the  living  plants  and 
animals  upon  it.  Geologists  have  studied  rocks  in  all  their  various 
kinds,  their  origin,  differentiation,  and  metamorphism,  their  birth, 
growth,  and  life  ;  we  have  now  to  study  their  death,  and  the  earliest 
parts  of  the  process  which  culminates  in  their  resurrection. 

In  order  to  make  his  book  self-contained,  Professor  Merrill  devotes 
several  chapters  to  considering  the  chemical  and  mineralogical  com- 
position structures,  mode  of  occurrence,  and  various  types  of  rocks  ; 
this  is  a  fairly  useful  summary,  but  we  are  inclined  to  doubt  whether 
the  geologist  will  need,  or  the  lay-reader  understand  it.  Many  of  the 
illustrations  in  this  part  are  admirable,  and  the  abundant  analyses  are 
particularly  valuable  for  reference  later  on.  To  many  of  these  no 
references  are  appended,  and  we  may  conclude  that  they  are  due  to 
the  author  himself,  who  must  have  expended  a  great  deal  of  time  and 
labour  on  the  analyses  throughout  the  work. 

Part  III.  is  devoted  to  the  weathering  of  rocks,  each  of  the 
chemical  and  mechanical  agencies  being  taken  in  turn.  Several 
valuable  instances  of  the  effect  of  alternations  of  high  and  low 
temperature  are  given,  and  the  effect  of  cold  rain  on  highly  heated 
surfaces  is  referred  to.  While  stress  is  laid  on  the  effect  of  hydra- 
tion, the  work  of  carbonated  rain-water,  and  of  the  humic,  ulmic, 
and  crenic  acids  naturally  comes  in  for  a  lion's  share  of  consideration. 
The  action  of  the  first  of  these  solvents  upon  many  silicates  can  be  de- 
tected within  ten  minutes,  while  forty-eight  hours'  digestion  will  obtain 
from  some  amphiboles,  epidotes,  felspars,  etc.,  quantities  of  lime,  mag- 
nesia, iron,  alumina  and  silica,  amounting  to  from  0*4  to  1  per  cent, 
of  the  mass.  Hornblende  is  more  easily  acted  upon  than  felspar,  and 
even  magnesian  silicates  are  attacked,  so  that  serpentine  cannot  be 
considered  a  final  product  of  decomposition.  Increasing  the  pressure 
on  the  solvent  has  much  more  effect  than  prolonging  the  time  of  its 
action.  Daubrce's  experiments  on  attrition  are  referred  to,  and  the 
work  of  plants,  bacteria,  termites,  and  marine  animals  on  the  sea-bed, 
is  not  neglected. 

Special  cases  of  weathering  are  next  treated  in  detail  and  illus- 
trated by  full  analyses.  Mere  bulk  analyses  of  the  fresh  and 
weathered  rock  are  misleading,  as  thev  do  not  show  all  that  has 
actually  occurred.  It  is  necessary  to  ascertain  which  constituents 
are  least  liable  to  be  leached  out,  and  to  recalculate  the  analyses  on 
the  assumption  that  they  remain  constant.  Alumina  and  iron  oxides 
are  least  liable  to  this,  and  the  analyses  of  acid  rocks  are  worked  out 
on  this  assumption.  An  example  will  show  the  value  of  this  method ; 
the  one  chosen  illustrates,  in  addition,  that  while  only  30  per  cent,  of 


1897]                                SOME  NEW  BOOKS  419 

the  original  rock  was  soluble  in  hydrochloric  acid  and  sodium  car- 

1 1<  mate,  the  proportion  is  now  nearly  70  per  cent.  The  instance  is 
that  of  a  gneiss  from  Virginia. 


FRFSH 

OHBISS. 

imposed 

GNEISS. 

CA1.CULATKI 

)  AMOUNTS  SAV 

ED    AND    LOS 

' 

Percentage  of 

Percentage 

Bulk 

Soluble 

Bulk 

Soluble 

each  con- 

each con- 

analysis; 

portion. 

analysis. 

portion. 

Total  loss. 

stituent 
saved. 

stituent 
lost. 

SjO*      . 

60-69 

10-09 

45-31 

17-69 

31*90 

47-55 

52-45 

Al2Os    . 

16-89 

\ 

13-54 

26-55 

24-86 

o-oo 

100-00 

o-oo 

FeaO»    . 

9-06 

J 

12-88 

11-80 

1-30 

85-65 

11-35 

CaO      . 

IN 

1*61 

Tr. 

0-06 

4-44 

o-oo 

100-00 

MgO     . 

1-06 

0-89 

0-40 

0-37 

0-80 

25-30 

74-70 

K80       . 

4-25 

2-40 

1-10 

0-75 

3-55 

16-48 

83-52 

XaoO     . 

2-82 

1-10 

0-22 

0-25 

2-6S 

4-97 

95-03 

P2O5      ■ 

0-25 

0-23 

0-47 

— 

o-oo1 

100- 

o-oo1 

Loss  on 

ignition 

0-62 

0-62 

13-75 

13-40 

o-oo1 

100- 

o-oo1 

100-08  30-17  99-9S  69-18  44-67 

i  Ga'n. 

This  table  makes  at  once  obvious  the  great  loss  in  silica,  lime,  and 
alkalies,  and  the  gain  in  water ;  while  it  further  indicates  from  the 
increase  in  the  soluble  portion  that  the  state  of  combination  in  many 
of  the  compounds  has  changed.  Mechanical  separation  and  micro- 
scopic examination  of  the  decomposed  material  throws  further  light 
on  the  character  of  the  decomposition  and  nature  of  the  surviving 
minerals. 

In  basic  rocks  the  loss  of  silica  is  rather  less,  and  that  of  iron  and 
magnesia  more  conspicuous,  while  in  a  French  basalt  the  felspars 
were  the  first  to  yield,  and  the  augite  and  olivine  the  last. 

Under  the  heading  "  Physical  Manifestations  "  are  treated :  Dis- 
integration without  decomposition,  influences  of  crystalline  and  rock- 
structure,  mineral  composition  (roughening  and  crusting),  indura- 
tion and  colour  changes.  Original  characters  are  sometimes  lost 
entirely  through  weathering,  basalts  pass  into  apparent  argil- 
laceous deposits,  and  granites  and  gneisses  with  their  veins  and 
every  structural  detail  well  preserved,  may  become  so  soft  that  a 
stick  can  be  thrust  deeply  into  them.  Chemical  compounds  become 
on  the  whole  simplified  by  weathering,  but  oxidation  and  all  chemical 
change,  except  hydration,  seems  to  cease  below  the  permanent  water- 
level.  More  refractory  and  dense  residues,  like  xenotime,  monazite, 
tourmalines,  rutiles  and  precious  gems,  have  tended  to  accumulate  in 
favoured  spots,  on  account  of  the  weathering  and  destruction  of  the 
rocks  in  which  they  were  originally  contained. 

The  rate  of  weathering  is  influenced  by  composition,  texture,  and 
position  of  rocks,  and  by  humidity  of  climate.  Weathering  in  humid 
climates  differs  in  kind,  as  well  as  degree  from  that  effected  in  dry 
climates  as  shown  in  California  by  the  author  and  by  Judd  in  the 
Xile  delta.  Prehistoric  implements  and  old  surfaces  covered  uncon- 
formably  by  newer  deposits  may  sometimes  enable  us  to  guess  at  the 
amount  of  work  done  in  a  given  time,  but  the  ascertaining  of  the  actual 
rate  of  work  is  difficult,  and  the  results  not  very  satisfactory.  Geikie's 
results,  on  this  branch  of  the  subject,  not  quoted  here  by  the  author, 


420  NATURAL   SCIENCE  [December 

are  important.     A  summary  of  the  work  of  transporting  agents  con- 
cludes this  portion  of  the  work. 

The  fifth  and  last  part  of  the  hook  is  devoted  to  the  consideration 
of  the  regolith,  a  term  used  to  include  the  soil  which  covers  the  solid 
rocks  like  a  blanket  (p>/yo?),  an  incoherent  mass  of  varying  thickness 
composed  of  materials  essentially  the  same  as  those  which  make  up 
the  rocks  themselves,  but  in  greatly  varying  conditions  of  mechanical 
aggregation  and  chemical  combination.  The  materials  of  the  regolith 
are  either  sedentary  or  transported,  the  first  class  being  either  residual 
like  wacke,  laterite,  terra  rossa,  &c,  or  cumulose  like  peat.  Residual 
deposits  are  generally  unstratified  and  may  possess  characteristics 
which  they  have  '  inherited  '  from  hundreds  or  even  thousands  of  feet  of 
rock  which  have  totally  disappeared.  Transported  deposits  are  col- 
luvial  (scree  and  avalanche  debris),  alluvial  and  aeolian,  or  glacial. 
Alluvia  vary  in  character  and  to  a  striking  extent  in  fertility  according 
to  whether  the  river  bearing  them  drains  a  dry  or  a  damp  country  ;  in 
the  former  case  the  undecomposed  silicates  will  be  rich  in  plant  food. 
Where  saline  deposits  are  absent,  indeed,  the  soils  of  very  dry 
countries  are  of  an  extremely  fertile  character  and  only  need  rain  to 
be  covered  with  luxuriant  vegetation,  and  this  is  especially  the  case 
because  percolating  rain  has  not  been  present  to  concentrate  the  clay 
into  a  '  hard-pan  '  below  the  surface. 

The  averages  of  several  hundred  analyses  of  soils  in  dry  and  humid 
regions  show  that  the  soluble  constituents  of  the  soil  in  arid  tracts 
amount  to  30  and  in  wet  tracts  to  15  per  cent.,  the  greatest  differences 
being  in  the  quantity  of  lime,  magnesia,  and  alkalies. 

Richthofen's  aeolian  hypothesis  is  considered  satisfactory  when 
applied  to  the  Chinese  loess,  but  not  to  that  of  America,  which  latter 
the  author  supposes  to  be  the  result  of  streams  draining  from  the  ice 
of  the  glacial  period. 

An  important  organic  agent  in  the  formation  of  marine  deposits  in 
inlets  is  found  in  the  eel-grass,  which  grows  vigorously  as  soon  as  a 
little  mud  has  formed  on  the  bottom,  and  then  by  deadening  all  cur- 
rents promotes  very  rapid  deposition  of  fine  salt. 

In  dealing  with  the  '  rock-flour '  brought  down  by  glaciers,  Pro- 
fessor Merrill  alludes  to  the  small  amount  of  actual  clay  present.  It 
has  been  proved  by  Mr  E.  Dickson  that  what  there  is  of  this  material 
is  ground  up  felspar  and  not  kaolin. 

To  illustrate  the  wonderful  degree  of  comminution  reached  in  soils, 
it  is  pointed  out  that  the  total  surface  area  of  the  grains  in  a  cubic 
feet  of  soil  amounts  on  an  average  to  50,000  square  feet.  On  areas 
like  this  the  operation  of  organic  acids,  plants,  animals,  and  water 
must  be  enormous.  Ants  working  in  such  soil  effect  as  much  change 
as  the  earthworms  studied  by  Darwin,  and  Shaler's  calculation  that 
the  former  bring  a  layer  of  soil  one-fifth  of  an  inch  thick  to  the  surface 
every  year  finds  a  close  parallel  in  the  figures  obtained  by  Darwin. 

Professor  Merrill's  book  is  an  admirable  introduction  to  a  com- 
plicated and  difficult  subject.  It  is  packed  with  facts,  not  perhaps 
arranged  in  the  best  possible  manner,  and  illuminated  with  a  wonderful 
series  of  analyses  which  contain  a  fund  of  valuable  information.  The 
author  is  modest  in  his  deductions,  not  eager  to  generalise,  and  only 
adopting  or  advocating  a  conclusion  after  full  discussion.     It  is  to  be 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  421 

hoped  that  his  work  will  lead  to  the  more  detailed  study  of  the 
changes  produced  in  rocks  as  they  weather  down  and  pass  into  their 
final,  but  by  no  means  least  useful,  form.  The  illustrations  are  for  the 
most  part  clear  and  well  chosen,  but  it  would  be  well  to  indicate  the 
exact  magnification  of  the  diagrams  oi'  microscopic  objects  in  the  text. 


Tht.  Volcanoes  of  North  America 

Volcanoes  of  Nobth  America  :    A  Reading  Lesson  for  Students  of  Geography 

AND  Gkoliicy.  P>y  Israel  C.  Russell,  Professor  of  Geology,  University  of  Michigan. 
Svo.  Pp.  xiv  +  346,  with  1(5  plates  and  11  figs,  in  text.  New  York:  The 
Macmillan  Co.  ;  London  :   Macmillan  &  Co.,  Ltd.     1897.     Price,  16s.  net. 

The  second  title  of  this  handsomely  printed  book  must  be  regarded  as 
that  which  expresses  the  intentions  of  its  author.  To  the  American 
reader,  the  work  is  an  introduction  to  the  study  of  volcanoes,  com- 
parable to  those  of  Prof.  Judd  and  others,  which  are  already 
familiar  to  us  in  Europe.  Only  170  pages,  or  half  the  book,  deal  with 
the  volcanoes  of  North  America ;  and  it  is  to  these  that  the  professed 
geologist  will  most  naturally  turn.  Considered,  then,  in  its  dual 
aspect,  Prof.  Russell's  work  must  do  much  to  stimulate  curiosity 
and  observation  in  the  United  States,  by  pointing  out  the  absorbing 
interest  of  volcanic  phenomena,  and  the  extraordinary  illustrations  of 
the  subject  possessed  by  the  North  American  continent. 

Vesuvius,  as  seems  inevitable,  introduces  the  description  of  com- 
plex volcanic  mountains ;  and  the  famous  photographs  of  1872 
repeat  themselves  on  the  second  plate.  Nor  will  the  beginner  feel 
any  irritation  at  perusing  the  graphic  details  provided  by  the 
younger  Pliny.  He  is  directed  to  Mr  Lobley's  book  on  Vesuvius  for 
a  history  of  the  mountain  ;  and  wTe  should  have  liked  a  reference  also 
to  the  classic  work  of  Phillips.  Palmieri's  experiences,  and  the  report 
of  the  Krakatoa  committee,  are  then  drawn  on ;  and  these  passages 
conclude  with  a  remarkable  quotation,  from  "  one  of  our  most  pro- 
found students  of  volcanic  phenomena "  (p.  28),  to  the  effect  that 
the  performances  of  Vesuvius  "  are  mere  Fourth  of  July  fireworks 
in  comparison  with  the  Day  of  Judgment  proceedings  of  Krakatoa." 
Prof.  Russell's  own  good  taste  and  style  fortunately  prevent  his 
imitating  this  profundity,  even  where,  as  in  Chapter  VIII.,  he  allows 
himself  romantic  possibilities. 

Dutton  and  Dana  furnish  the  account  of  Hawaii,  and  the  Deccan 
trap  and  the  Newark  system  of  the  Atlantic  coast  are  quoted  as 
examples  of  surface-flows  of  vast  extent.  In  the  latter  instance, 
we  may  remind  ourselves  of  the  wide  field  of  literature  and  '  solid 
geology '  already  traversed  by  Prof.  Eussell  in  the  Eastern  States. 

The  terms  '  aa '  and  '  pahoehoe '  seem  to  have  gained  vitality  in 
geological  literature  (pp.  60-62),  just  as  we  might  borrow  with  profit 
many  of  the  names  by  which  a  Highlander  or  a  Welshman  designates 
the  various  forms  of  mountains.  Prof.  Eussell  refers  the  '  aa '  type 
of  lava-surface  to  imperfectly  fluid  streams,  in  opposition  to  what  has 
been  stated  to  occur  upon  the  slopes  of  Vesuvius.  The  pahoehoe, 
on  the  contrary,  flows  easily  and  cools  in  thin  sheets  before  it 
can  break  up,  furnishing  a  smooth  and  often  glassy  surface. 

The  classification  and  description  of  igneous  rocks  professes  only 


422  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 

to  be  a  sketch,  and  granite  is  selected  as  the  deep-seated  type,  fol- 
lowed by  four  lavas.  Augite  or  soda-augite,  as  well  as  hornblende 
and  biotite,  should,  we  think,  have  been  mentioned  among  the  com- 
mon constituents  of  rhyolite  (p.  122)  and  trachyte  (p.  124).  We  do 
not  quite  gather  the  meaning  of  the  description  of  andesites  "  as  gener- 
ally dark,  and  mostly  fine-grained  rocks,  with  a  restricted  amount  of 
glassy  base,  but  larger  than  in  the  trachytes." 

On  p.  127  we  commence  the  study  of  North  American  volcanoes, 
and  it  is  interestingly  pointed  out  (p.  133)  that  the  two  ends  of  the 
great  western  line  are  highly  active,  while  there  is  a  "  middle  region 
of  extinct  or,  perhaps,  in  part,  dormant  volcanoes,  extending  from 
central  Mexico  through  the  western  part  of  the  United  States  and 
far  into  Canada." 

Considering  the  enormous  area  to  be  covered,  no  one  geologist  can 
be  expected  to  have  an  intimate  acquaintance  with  North  American 
volcanoes ;  and  hence  the  description  of  those  in  Central  America  and 
Mexico  is  necessarily  a  compilation  from  works  already  published. 
So  little  is  known  of  this  district,  however,  that  we  are  glad  to  be  put 
in  touch  with  the  amazing  history  of  lzalco,  the  growth  of  which,  from 
nothingness  to  a  height  of  1500  feet,  was  witnessed  by  the  cure  of 
Sonsonate  during  his  quiet  country  life,  or  the  catastrophic  explosion 
of  Consesuina  in  1835,  which  seems  to  have  been  connected  with 
earthquakes  that  carried  ruin  into  <  'bile.  Among  recent  accounts 
— still  far  too  few — we  have  those  of  Prof.  Heilprin's  ascents  in 
Mexico.  There  seems  some  contradiction,  however,  between  p.  178, 
where  we  are  promised  mountaineering  excitements  on  Ixtaccihuatl, 
and  the  mere  comparison  with  Popocatepetl  on  p.  183. 

A  country  that  possesses  the  denuded  necks  near  Mount  Taylor 
(PL  6,  fig.  B),  and  the  exquisitely  preserved  Ice  Spring  craters  of 
Utah  (PL  7),  is  truly  a  paradise  for  the  student ;  but  the  distances 
from  point  to  point  must  still  remain  obstacles  to  research.  The  cone 
near  Lassen's  Peak,  described  by  Diller,  is  of  admirable  freshness,  and 
may  have  been  active  in  the  present  century.  Hence  there  are 
further  volcanic  possibilities  in  store  for  observers  within  the 
limits  of  the  United  States. 

On  p.  234  we  gain  a  conception  of  the  huge  chain  of  peaks,  still 
awaiting  detailed  enquiry,  that  runs  north  from  San  Francisco  into 
Washington.  These  seem  to  result  from  Tertiary  eruptions,  and  are 
not  unworthy  companions  of  the  Andes,  which  are  more  familiar  to 
us,  owing  to  the  pre-eminence  of  certain  of  their -summits.  The  photo- 
graph of  Mount  Rainier  (PL  14)  may  be  cited,  among  the  beautiful 
series  of  illustrations  that  adorns  Prof.  Russell's  book.  • 

The  account  of  the  Columbia  lava  (p.  250)  will  interest  students 
of  fissure-eruptions.  Prof.  Russell  clearly  points  out  that  the  enor- 
mous area,  200,000  to  250,000  square  miles,  is  not  buried  in  one 
vast  flow ;  "  the  lava  sheets  overlay)  and  supplement  one  another  so 
as  to  form  a  continuous  and  highly  compound  system."  Individual 
flows  have,  however,  been  traced  on  canon-walls  for  a  score  or  more 
of  miles. 

When  we  reach  Alaska,  we  welcome  the  photographs  of  peaks  and 
islands  on  Plates  15  and  10,  and  feci  more  than  ever  grateful  for  the 
records   that   Prof.   Russell   has   brought  together  in    the  American 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  423 

portion  of  his  book.  This  portion  concludes  with  an  account  of  the 
great  part  played  by  volcanic  'lust  in  the  soils  of  many  of  the  western 
States.  A  reference  to  Prof.  Judd's  paper  on  the  lavas  of  Kraka- 
toa  {Geological  Magazine,  L888)  would  have  excellently  supplemented 
the  important  quotation  from  Diller  on  p.  293,  to  the  effect  that  vol- 
canic dust  is  richer  in  silica  than  its  parent  lava. 

In  the  'theoretical  considerations'  of  chapter  VII.,  we  fancy 
that  there  is  a  certain  amount  of  slaying  of  the  slain.  But  this  walk 
across  the  battlefield  is  in  reality  of  service  to  learners,  who  are  liable 
to  regard  all  printed  text-hooks  as  infallible.  The  suggestion  on 
p.  314  that  "  volcanic  activity  increased  with  geological  ages,  and 
reached  its  maximum  in  Tertiary  times,"  is  confessedly  based  on  the 
geological  history  of  North  America,  and  is,  we  fancy,  not  even  well 
founded  for  that  area.  The  amount  of  denudation  that  has  laid  bare 
the  Archaean  rocks  of  the  north-east  has  probably  wrought  havoc 
along  many  old  lines  of  volcanic  activity. 

Prof.  Eussell  regards  the  water  in  lavas  as  collected  during  the 
passage  of  molten  matter,  moving  under  earth-pressure,  from  the 
lower  into  higher  and  waterlogged  regions  of  the  crust  (p.  318)  ;  and 
the  liquid  matter  may  arise  during  local  relief  from  pressure,  as  the 
product  of  rocks  previously  solid  (p.  312).  Hence  he  considers 
steam  rather  as  a  variable  and  unessential  factor  in  determining  a 
volcanic  outburst. 

The  work  is,  as  we  have  hinted,  admirably  produced  by  the  pub- 
lishers. The  printers  give  us  '  Koichthofer '  for  '  Eichthofen  '  on 
p.  252,  and,  far  more  excusably,  '  lavas '  and  '  lava  cases '  for 
■  larva? '  and  '  larva  cases '  on  p.  209. 

Geenville  A.  J.  Cole. 


Another  Memoir  on  Funafuti 

The  Ethnology  of  Funafuti.     By  Charles  Hedley.     Australian  Museum,  Sydney. 

Memoir  III.,  part  4,  1897. 

The  pressing  necessity  of  a  systematic  and  immediate  survey  of  the 
ethnology  of  the  islands  of  the  Pacific  is  again  brought  clearly  before 
us  by  Mr  Hedley's  paper.  It  is  only  too  manifest  that  the  strictly 
native  culture  of  Funafuti  is  rapidly  dying  out,  that  the  older  arts, 
customs,  and  appliances  are  changing  apace  under  the  influence  of 
European  missionaries  and  traders.  In  a  few  years'  time  the  very 
recollection  of  the  older  culture  will  die  out,  and  it  will  be  impossible 
to  obtain  for  our  museums  even  models  of  the  former  appliances  made 
with  any  accuracy  at  any  rate.  Hence  every  careful  contribution  to 
South  Pacific  ethnological  literature  must  be  welcomed.  Mr  Hedley's 
paper  does  not  profess  to  be  in  any  way  an  exhaustive  monograph, 
but  is,  in  the  main,  a  descriptive  list  of  the  ethnological  specimens 
and  models  collected  by  himself  and  others,  and  placed  now  in  the 
Australian  Museum  at  Sydney.  Most  of  these  are  described  clearly 
and  in  some  detail,  while  their  interest  is  increased  by  reference  to 
the  resemblances  observable  between  the  various  native  implements 
of  Funafuti  and  those  of  other  islands,  as  bearing  upon  their  affinities 
and  upon  the  probably  complex  origin  of  the  general  culture  of  the 
inhabitants  of  the  island.     Funafuti  seems  to  have  drawn  its  culture 


424  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 

from  various  directions.  Though  in  the  main  Polynesian,  more  par- 
ticularly Samoan,  in  general  character,  there  is  evidence  in  the  arts 
and  appliances  of  affinities  with  Micronesian  culture,  while  even 
Melanesian  traces  are  not  wanting.  The  curious  shell-bladed  cocoa- 
nut  scraper,  mounted  upon  a  wooden,  elbow-shaped  stock,  belongs  to 
a  type  of  tool  which  has  been  recognised  in  Matty  Island,  to  the 
north  of  New  Guinea,  while  Mr  Hedley  might  have  added  that  the 
same  is  also  found  in  the  Solomon  Islands,  and  that  it  crops  up  again 
in  Ceylon,  with  a  metal  blade  substituted  for  the  shell.  In  North 
India,  too,  a  nearly  allied  implement  is  found  with  a  knife-blade 
replacing  the  scraper.  The  details  given  regarding  the  various  types 
and  the  manufacture  of  fish-hooks  are  of  importance,  and  point  to 
affinities  with  the  fish-hooks,  both  of  the  eastern  and  the  western 
Pacific  groups.  The  canoes  are  described  in  detail.  The  various  im- 
plements, toys,  etc.,  are  too  numerous  even  to  be  mentioned  here,  but 
all  are  recorded  with  care.  It  is  a  pity  that  the  term  'drum'  is 
applied  to  the  hollow  trough-shaped  wooden  instrument  of  Funafuti. 
This  belongs  to  a  very  widely  distributed  type  of  instruments,  which 
belongs  essentially  to  the  gong  series,  and  should  on  no  account  be 
confused  with  the  drums,  which  are  characterised  by  a  sounding 
medium  of  tense  membrane.  The  vague  descriptions  of  some  travel- 
lers constantly  confuse  the  two  perfectly  distinct  instruments,  and 
ethnologists  should  studiously  avoid  falling  into  the  same  error.  Mr 
Hedley  is  wrong  in  supposing  that  the  'ploughing'  method  of  pro- 
ducing fire  by  friction  is  the  only  one  employed  in  the  Pacific  Islands. 
The  simple  twirling  drill  has  been  described  from  New  Zealand,  the 
New  Hebrides,  and  Carolines,  and  other  instances  might  be  men- 
tioned. In  this,  as  in  many  other  instances,  a  specialist  would,  no 
doubt,  have  added  greatly  to  the  information  given  in  the  paper,  but 
at  the  same  time  Mr  Hedley 's  contribution  should  prove  a  useful  one, 
and  welcome  to  ethnologists.  Henry  Balfour. 


A  Catalogue  of  Mammals 

Catalogus  Mammalium,  Tam  Viventium  Qxtam  Fossilium,  a  Dr  E.  L.  Trouessart. 
Nova  editio  (prima  completa).  Fasciculus  II.,  Carnivora,  Piimipedia,  Rodentia 
I.  (Protrogomorpha  and  Sciuromorpha),  pp.  219-452  ;  Fasciculus  III.,  Rodentia  II. 
(Myomorpha,  Hystricomorpba,  Lagomorpha),  pp.  453-664.  Berlin  :  R.  Fried- 
lander  &  Sohn,  1897.     Price,  10  marks  each  fasciculus. 

The  second  and  third  portions  of  this  admirable  and  most  useful 
list  fully  bear  out  the  promise  of  the  first  part,  noticed  in  Natural 
Science  for  May.  They  contain,  besides  the  Carnivora  and  Pinnipedia, 
which  the  author  separates  ordinally,  the  whole  of  the  rodents,  the 
most  difficult  and  most  numerous  order  of  mammals,  and  will  there- 
fore be  most  welcome  to  every  working  mammalogist.  The  list 
seems  throughout  to  be  remarkably  complete  and  up  to  date,  and  we 
have  scarcely  been  able  to  find  a  single  omission.  The  print  and  get- 
up  are  even  better  than  in  the  first  parts,  and  the  misprints  due  to 
some  of  the  specific  names  being  printed  with  capitals  are  reduced  to 
a  minimum  (though  not  to  nil).  Acting  on  a  suggestion  in  our  pre- 
vious notice  the  original  localities  for  the  names  considered  to  be 
synonyms  have  been  printed  opposite  the  latter,  so  that  it  can  be  seen 


1897]  SOME  NEW  BOOKS  425 

at  a  glance  what  forms  have  been  described  from  different  parts  of  the 
main  area. 

En  passant  we  may  note  two  accidental  mistakes — the  first  that  a 
number  of  rodents  from  Mashonaland,  described  by  Mr  de  Win  ton  in 
189G,  have  been  wrongly  credited  to  the  present  reviewer,  and  the 
second  that  by  a  confusion  of  two  similar  names,  the  marsupial 
Thylamys  rani,  of  Trinidad,  appears  as  a  rodent  in  the  genus 
Ti/lomys. 

We  may  express  a  hope,  in  conclusion,  that  this  invaluable  list 
will  not  be  allowed  to  come  to  an  end  without  having  a  good  index 
appended  to  it,  at  least  of  the  genera  names  and  their  synonyms  (with 
page,  not  number,  references),  as  this  will  enormously  increase  the 
facility  of  its  use,  and  will  make  it  really  worthy  of  its  claim  to  be 
Edifio  complrta.  0.  T. 

Parasitic  Flies 

Revision  of  the  Tachinidae  of  America  North  of  Mexico.     By  D.  W.  Coquillett. 
Pp.   15-4.      "Washington.      1897.     (U.S.   Department  of  Agriculture,   Division  of 
Entomology.     Technical  Series,  No.  7.) 

Like  most  of  the  publications  of  the  admirable  Washington  depart- 
ment, this  work  will  be  welcomed  both  by  the  systematic  student  and 
the  practical  farmer.  The  flies  described  are  parasitic  on  various 
insects,  usually  on  the  caterpillars  of  moths,  hence  they  play  an 
important  part  in  keeping  the  numbers  of  injurious  species  within 
bounds.  The  work  contains  tables  of  the  parasites  with  their  hosts 
and  the  hosts  with  their  parasites,  together  with  synoptical  tables, 
and  full  descriptions  of  all  the  Nearctic  genera  of  species.  As  most  of 
the  genera  are  identical  with  those  of  Europe,  the  monograph  should 
be  valuable  to  dipterologists  generally.  We  notice  with  regret  that 
there  are  no  illustrations.  In  the  study  of  so  difficult  a  family,  a  few 
figures  of  structural  details  would  be  of  great  help  to  the  beginner. 

Further  Literature  Received 

Das  Kleine  Botanische  Practicum,  E.  Strasburger,  ed.  3  :  Gustav  Fischer.  Bau  und 
Leben  unserer  Waldbiiume,  K.  Biisgen  :  Gustav  Fischer.  The  Span  of  Gestation,  J. 
Beard  :  Gustav  Fischer.  Wild  Traits  in  Tame  Animals,  L.  Robinson  :  Blackwood.  La 
Face  de  la  Terre,  French  Trans,  of  Suess,  Das  Antlitz  der  Erde,  by  E.  de  Margerie,  vol. 
i. :  Colin,  Paris.  The  Living  Substance  as  such  and  as  Organism,  Mrs  E.  A.  Andrews  : 
Ginn,  Boston.  Cheltenham  as  a  Holiday  Resort,  S.  S.  Buckman  ;  Norman,  Sawyer  & 
Co  :  Cheltenham. 

On  some  European  Slugs  of  genus  Arion,  and  on  two  new  species  of  Parmarion, 
W.  E.  Collinge  :  Proc.  Zool.  Soc.  On  Flow-Structure  in  an  Igneous  Dyke,  and  on  Augite- 
diorites,  by  T.  H.  Holland  :  Rcc.  Gcol.  Surv.  India.  A  Dictionary  of  the  Call  Notes  of 
British  Birds,  C.  L.  Hett.  Field  Columbian  Museum,  Papuan  Crania,  G.  A.  Dorsey. 
Ratzel's  History  of  Mankind,  pts.  21,  22:  Macmillan.  U.S.  Dej)t.  Agriculture, 
N.  Amer.  Fauna,  No.  13.     Concilium  Bibliographicum,  cards  relating  to  Nat.  Sci. 

Amer.  Geol.,  Nov.;  Amer.  Journ.  Sci.,  Nov.;  Amer.  Nat.,  Nov.;  Botan.  Gaz.,  Oct.; 
Feuille  des  Jeunes  Nat.,  Nov.;  Irish  Nat.,  Nov.;  Journ.  School  Geogr.,  Oct.;  Literary 
Digest,  Oct.  16,  23,  30,  Nov.  6  ;  Naturae  Novit.,  Oct.;  Naturalist,  Nov.;  Nature,  Oct. 
21,  28,  Nov.  4,  11,  18  ;  Naturen,  Oct.;  Photogram,  Nov.;  Psychol.  Rev.,  Nov.;  Rivista 
Quindicinale  di  Psichologia,  vol.  i.,  fasc.  9,  11  (Sept.,  Oct.)  ;  Revue  Scientifique,  Oct.  16, 
23,  30,  Nov.  6,  13  ;  Science,  Oct.  8,  15,  22,  29,  Nov.  5  ;  Scientific  American,  Oct.  9,  16, 
23,  30,  Nov.  6  ;  Scot.  Geogr.  Mag.,  Nov.;  Scot.  Med.  and  Surg.  Journ.,  Nov.;  Vic- 
torian Nat.,  Sept.,  Oct.;  Westminster  Rev.,  Nov. 


•1  U 


426  [December 


OBITUARIES 

CHARLES  SMART  ROY 
Born  at  Arbroath,  1854.     Died  at  Cambridge,  October  4,  1897 

The  death  of  the  professor  of  pathology  in  the  University  of  Cam- 
bridge is  a  serious  loss  to  the  scientific  study  of  that  subject.  Roy 
received  his  training  at  St  Andrews  and  Edinburgh.  His  earliest 
research  work,  that  on  the  pleuro-pneumonia  of  cattle,  was  conducted  at 
London,  chiefly  in  the  Brown  Institution,  of  which  Burdon-Sanderson 
was  head.  Proceeding  to  Berlin,  he  studied  in  the  laboratories  of 
Virchow  and  Du  Bois-Reymond,  and  produced  his  paper  "  On  the 
influences  which  modify  the  work  of  the  heart,"  published  in  the 
Journal  of  Physiology.  In  1879  Roy  became  assistant  at  the  Physio- 
logical Institute  of  Strassburg  University  under  Prof.  Goltz,  where  he 
invented  the  sphygmotonometer  and  other  instruments  for  measuring 
the  changes  in  blood-vessels.  Here  also  he  invented  the  well-known 
ether  freezing  microtome.  Passing  next  to  Cohnheim's  Institute  at 
Leipzig,  he  invented  the  renal  oncometer  for  the  study  of  variations 
in  blood-flow  through  the  kidney.  From  here  in  1880  he  came  to 
Cambridge  as  George  Henry  Lewes'  student  in  physiology,  and 
worked  in  the  laboratory  of  Prof.  Michael  Foster.  In  1882  Roy 
succeeded  Dr  Greenfield  as  Director  of  the  Brown  Institution,  a  post 
which  he  held  for  two  and  a  half  years,  during  which  time  he  visited 
the  Argentine  Republic  to  investigate  a  disease  raging  among  the 
cattle  of  Entre  Rios.  In  1884  he  was  elected  a  Fellow  of  the  Royal 
Society  and  to  the  newly-founded  chair  of  pathology  at  Cambridge. 
His  chief  work  was  on  the  mammalian  heart,  partly  carried  out  in 
conjunction  with  Prof.  Adami.  In  prosecuting  this  research  he 
invented  yet  other  ingenious  instruments.  Among  his  students  at 
Cambridge  may  be  mentioned  the  names  of  Kanthack,  Hankin, 
Griffiths,  Lorrain-Smith,  Cobbett,  Lloyd-Jones,  Rolleston,  and 
Wesbrook.  Many  of  these  came  as  J.  Lucas  Walker's  students  in 
pathology,  an  endowment  which  he  himself  was  largely  instrumental 
in  securing.  Prof.  Roy's  health  had  been  failing  for  some  time,  and 
for  the  past  year  his  work  at  Cambridge  has  been  undertaken  by  Dr 
Kanthack,  who  has  now  succeeded  him. 

PETER  BELLINGER  BRODIE 
Born  1815.     Died  November  1,  1897 

The  veteran  geologist,  the  Rev.  P.  B.  Brodie,  who  had  been  a  Fellow 
of  the  Geological  Society  of  London  for  more  than  sixty  years,  passed 
away  on  the  first  day  of  last  month.  He  was  born  in  London  in  1815, 
iiiid  early  proceeded  to  Cambridge,  where  he  came  under  the  influence 


1897]  OBITUARIES  427 

of  Sedgwick,  and  was  for  some  time  volunteer  assistant  in  the  Wood- 
wardian  Museum.  His  first  paper,  on  land  and  fresh  water  shells  in 
association  with  mammalian  bones  in  the  gravels  around  Cambridge, 
was  read  before  the  Cambridge  Philosophical  Society  so  long  ago  as 
1838,  but  he  became  best  known  by  his  numerous  discoveries  of  fossil 
insects  in  the  secondary  rocks,  and  in  1845  he  summarised  all  that 
was  then  known  in  reference  to  this  subject  in  his  small  illustrated 
volume,  "A  History  of  the  .Fossil  Insects  in  the  Secondary  Kocks  of 
England,"  dedicated  to  his  revered  teacher  Sedgwick.  In  the  deter- 
mination of  the  insects  the  author  was  assisted  by  the  late  Prof.  J.  0. 
Westwood.  In  1838  Brodie  entered  the  Church  and  became  curate  at 
Wylye,  Wiltshire ;  in  1840  he  removed  to  Steeple  Claydon,  Bucking- 
hamshire ;  next  year  he  was  elected  vicar  of  Down  Hatherley, 
Gloucestershire  ;  and  in  1855  he  became  vicar  of  Bowington,  near 
Warwick,  where  he  died.  In  all  these  districts  he  accomplished 
much  original  work,  and  he  contributed  several  papers  to  the 
Geological  Society  of  London,  besides  others  to  the  British  Associa- 
tion and  various  Field  Clubs.  In  recognition  of  the  value  of  his 
labours  the  Geological  Society  awarded  to  him  the  Murchison  Medal 
in  1887.  He  amassed  a  large  collection  of  fossils,  of  which  the  more 
important  specimens  have  been  acquired  by  the  British  Museum,  and 
he  was  indefatigable  in  his  exertions  to  spread  an  interest  in  science 
among  those  by  whom  he  was  surrounded.  In  1854  he  was  instru- 
mental in  founding  the  Warwickshire  Naturalists'  and  Archaeologists' 
Field  Club,  and  at  the  time  of  his  death  he  was  President  both  of  this 
Club  and  of  the  Warwickshire  Natural  History  and  Archaeological 
Society.  An  excellent  portrait  of  Mr  Brodie  appeared  in  the  Proc. 
Warivick  Field  Club  early  this  year,  and  it  is  reproduced,  with  an 
extended  biographical  notice,  in  the  November  number  of  the  Geological 
Magazine. 

ANDEEW  MATTHEWS 
Born  June  18,  1815.    Died  September  14,  1897 

At  the  ripe  age  of  eighty-two  one  of  the  most  accomplished  of  our 
clerical  naturalists  has  passed  away.  The  Ptev.  Andrew  Matthews, 
who  had  held  the  living  of  Gumley,  Leicestershire,  since  1853,  was  a 
close  observer  of  Nature,  and  interested  in  botany  and  ornithology. 
His  fame  will  rest,  however,  on  his  studies  of  the  family  of  minute 
beetles  known  as  the  Trichopterygidae.  He  published  a  beautifully 
illustrated  monograph  of  these  insects  in  1872,  and  we  are  glad  to 
know  that  the  MSS.  and  drawings  of  a  second  volume  had  been  com- 
pleted by  him  in  recent  years,  and  will  probably  be  issued  shortly. 
He  also  contributed  the  account  of  these  beetles  to  the  "  Biologia 
Centrali-Americana."  All  collectors  of  coleoptera  are  familiar  with 
the  catalogue  of  the  British  species  of  the  order  which  he  compiled  in 
conjunction  with  Canon  Fowler  in  1883.  That  entomologist,  in  an 
appreciative  notice  of  Mr  Matthews  in  the  Entom.  Monthly  Mag. 
for  November,  claims  that  the  deceased  naturalist  was  worthy  to 
rank  with  Gilbert  White  as  an  observer,  while  he  far  surpassed  the 
famous  parson  of  Selborne  as  a  close  student  of  minute  structure. 


428  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 

LOUIS  CALOBI 

Born  February  8,  1807.     Died  November  1897 

Louis  Calori,  the  doyen  of  the  Italian  anatomists,  was  born  at  San 
Pietro  in  Casala,  Bologna.  His  father  was  a  doctor  of  medicine  in 
practice  at  San  Pietro,  and  young  Louis  attended  the  University  of 
Bologna,  becoming  M.D.  in  1829.  In  1830  he  was  elected  assistant 
professor  of  anatomy  at  his  University ;  in  1835  he  obtained  the  chair 
of  comparative  anatomy  ;  and  in  1844  that  of  human  anatomy.  He 
was  ten  times  President  of  the  Bologna  Academy,  and  that  body 
published  a  bibliographical  list  of  his  works  in  the  fifth  volume  of  the 
fourth  series  of  the  Ades.  In  the  same  year,  1884,  the  Academy 
gave  a  fete  in  his  honour.  Calori's  chief  zoological  work  was  done 
among  the  Eeptilia,  but  his  researches  threw  light  on  many  other 
groups  of  the  animal  kingdom. 

Captain  Edward  Yerbury  Watson,  who  was  killed  by  a  sniper  on 
November  8  at  Simla  while  with  Sir  Wm.  Lockhart's  camp,  was  well 
known  as  an  authority  on  the  Hesperidae.  He  had  arranged  the 
collection  at  the  British  Museum  before  returning  to  India.  Captain 
Watson  was  acting  as  Deputy-Assistant  Commissary-General,  and 
had  seen  a  good  deal  of  service  in  Burmah.  He  was  promoted  to  the 
captaincy  in  1895. 

Dr  Otto  Volger,  whose  death  was  announced  at  the  end  of  October, 
was  a  well-known  German  educationalist.  His  chief  claim  to  posterity 
was  his  worship  of  Goethe  and  his  care  of  the  Goethehaus,  but  he  was 
an  indefatigable  writer  in  the  teaching  of  natural  history  and  geology, 
both  in  Switzerland  and  Germany,  and  has  left  many  minor  works  on 
those  subjects. 

The  deaths  are  also  announced  of : — 

Henry  Calderwood,  professor  of  moral  philosophy  in  the  University  of  Edinburgh, 
on  Nov.  19  ;  Leopold  Auerbach  and  Rudolf  Heidenhain,  professors  of  physiology 
in  the  University  of  Breslau  ;  Hjalmar  Heiberg,  professor  of  pathological  anatomy  in 
the  University  of  Christiania  ;  E.  Le  Gros,  professor  of  physiology  in  the  new  Univer- 
sity of  Brussels,  aged  36  ;  Edmund  Drechsel,  professor  of  pharmacology  in  the  Uni- 
versity of  Berne  ;  Giuseppe  Fissore,  sometime  professor  of  pathology  in  the  University 
of  Turin,  aged  82  ;  W.  Marme,  director  of  the  pharmacological  institute  of  Gbttingen  ; 
Alexander  Milton  Ross,  author  of  several  works  on  the  fauna  and  flora  of  Canada,  at 
Montreal,  Oct.  27  ;  Dr  Mietschke,  the  German  entomologist  and  naturalist  ;  Max 
Sintenis,  the  German  entomologist  ;  Isaac  N.  Travis,  taxidermist  at  the  American 
Museum  of  Natural  History  ;  Rev.  Samuel  Haughton  of  Trinity  College,  Dublin  ;  Dr 
M.  F.  Heddle,  late  professor  of  mineralogy  in  the  University  of  St  Andrews  ;  GEORGE 
Harry  Piper,  geologist  of  Ledbury,  Herefordshire  ;  John  Calvert,  mining  expert, 
aged  86  ;  and  William  Scott,  director  of  Royal  gardens  and  forests,  Mauritius,  aged  38. 


1897]  429 


NEWS 

The  following  appointments  are  announced  : — Dr  A.  A.  Kanthack  to  be 
professor  of  pathology,  and  J.  Graham  Kerr  to  be  demonstrator  of  animal  mor- 
phology, in  the  University  of  Cambridge  ;  Dr  A.  W.  Sheen  to  be  demonstrator  of 
anatomy  in  the  medical  department  of  University  College,  Cardiff;  Dr  Max  von 
Frey,  of  Leipzig,  to  be  professor  of  physiology  in  the  High  School  of  Zurich  ;  Dr 
W.  Eothert,  of  Kazan,  to  be  professor  of  botany  and  director  of  the  physiological 
division  of  the  botanical  department  of  the  University  of  Charkow  ;  Henry  S. 
Pritchett,  of  Washington  University,  St  Louis,  to  be  superintendent  of  the  U.S. 
Coast  and  Geodetic  Survey  ;  William  S.  Carter  to  be  professor  of  physiology  in 
the  University  of  Texas  ;  Dr  Arthur  Allin  to  be  professor  of  psychology  in 
Colorado  University  ;  Dr  Francis  Kennedy  to  be  demonstrator  in  experimental 
psychology  in  Princeton  University. 

Sir  Archibald  Geikie  has  been  appointed  Romanes  Lecturer  at  Oxford  for 
1898. 

Dr  Hans  Molisch  of  Prague  intends  to  spend  the  coming  winter  in  botanical 
research  at  Buitenzorg,  Java. 

Dr  Arthur  Willey  has  returned  to  Cambridge,  where  he  proposes  to 
investigate  his  collections  during  the  winter. 

The  tenth  annual  meeting  of  the  Geological  Society  of  America  will  be  held 
in  M'Gill  University,  Montreal,  at  the  end  of  December. 

Letters  from  Mr  C.  W.  Andrews  announce  his  safe  arrival  in  Christmas 
Island,  where  he  has  already  made  some  progress  in  collecting. 

We  are  pleased  to  learn  from  Sir  Frederick  M'Coy  that  our  announcement  of 
his  retirement  from  his  professorship  in  the  University  of  Melbourne  is  premature. 

'  The  Louisiana  Society  of  Naturalists '  has  been  founded  at  New  Orleans  to 
investigate  systematically  the  fauna  and  flora  of  the  State  of  Louisiana,  which  has 
hitherto  been  much  neglected. 

The  new  building  for  the  Radcliffe  Library  at  Oxford  is  to  be  towards  the 
western  end  of  the  south  front  of  the  University  Museum,  that  is  to  say,  the  end 
where  the  chemical  laboratories  are. 

A  Laboratory  for  Experimental  Psychology  has,  says  the  Psychological 
Review,  been  opened  in  the  Illinois  Eastern  Hospital  for  the  Insane,  at 
Hospital,  111.,  under  the  direction  of  Dr  W.  O.  Krohn. 

According  to  Science,  the  University  of  the  State  of  New  York,  following  the 
plan  it  has  adopted  of  lending  to  the  schools  libraries  and  pictures,  offers  to  make 
loans  of  specimens  of  natural  history  from  the  State  collections. 

The  Annual  Report  of  the  Preston  Scientific  Society  for  1896-97  records  the 
accession  of  more  than  one  hundred  members  during  the  year.  Sections  for 
technical  scientific  work  have  been  formed,  and  we  look  forward  to  interesting 
results. 


430  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 

Dr  Franz  Steindachner  superintends  the  zoological  work  on  board  the 
Austrian  ship  Pola,  which  this  year  continues  the  scientific  exploration  of  the 
Red  Sea,  covering  the  ground  between  Jedda  and  Aden.  Researches  in  physical 
oceanography  will  also  be  carried  on. 

Prof.  Schauinsfeld,  Director  of  the  Bremen  Museum,  has  returned  with  a 
large  collection  from  a  voyage  of  fourteen  months  in  the  Pacific.  He  spent  some 
time  on  the  small  island  of  Laysan,  and  visited  among  other  places  the  Sandwich 
Islands,  Samoa,  New  Zealand,  and  Chatham  Island. 

The  sum  of  £500  has  recently  been  granted  to  the  Manchester  Museum  at  the 
Owens  College  for  the  purpose  of  installing  the  electric  light.  We  understand 
that  Mr  Edward  Holt's  donation  of  £2500,  lately  announced,  is  to  be  devoted 
entirely  to  the  rebuilding  of  the  gymnasium  of  the  College. 

The  Geological  Circle  of  the  Upper  Holloway  Centre  of  the  London  Society 
for  the  Extension  of  University  Teaching  will  issue  a  strong  programme  for  1898. 
AVe  expect  great  things  from  a  Society  with  a  name  of  such  dimensions,  and  shall 
look  for  the  programme  with  interest.     Mr  Rudler  is  the  President. 

The  Imperial  Russian  Geographical  Society  is  sending  an  expedition  to 
Abyssinia,  chiefly  for  the  anthropological  investigation  of  the  country.  The 
leader  of  the  party  is  Mr  Nicolas  Dmitrieff,  of  Astrakhan,  who  has  had  some 
experience  of  the  country  as  medical  volunteer  with  the  Italian  army. 

Messrs  Schuchert  and  White,  of  the  U.S.  National  Museum,  have  returned 
from  Lieut.  Peary's  las  Greenland  expedition  with  a  collection  of  Cretaceous 
and  Miocene  plants,  as  well  as  many  Cretaceous  invertebrates  from  the  Noursoak 
peninsula.  They  seem  to  think  the  last  word  on  these  plants  was  said  by  Heer, 
which  is  hardly  the  view  of  European  palaeobotanists. 

The  Jersey  Natural  Science  Association  is  wisely  including  in  its  programme 
economic  questions  of  general  interest.  At  the  October  meeting  Mr  J.  Hornell 
read  an  important  paper  on  "  The  Possibilities  of  Fishery  Improvement  in  Jersey, 
with  Notes  on  the  present  state  of  Marine  Pisciculture  and  Fishery  Regulation." 
It  appears  in  full  in  the  Jersey  Weekly  Press  of  October  16. 

One  of  the  results  of  the  terrible  famine  in  India  last  year  shows  itself  in  the 
increase  of  deaths  from  wild  animals.  The  greatest  increase  was  in  the  North- 
West  Provinces  from  wolves,  and  in  the  Sunderbunds  from  tigers,  and  was,  no 
doubt,  the  result  of  a  more  vigorous  search  for  food  by  the  natives  in  the  jungles. 
Snake-bites,  however,  decreased  considerably,  there  being  only  21,000  deaths  in 
the  year. 

An  Act  was  passed  at  the  last  meeting  of  the  West  Virginia  Legislature, 
establishing  a  State  Geological  and  Economic  Survey  in  connection  with  the 
W.  Virginia  University,  Morgantown.  For  its  expenses  a  sum  of  3000  dollars 
per  annum  has  been  appropriated.  Dr  Israel  C.  White  is  Superintendent,  Prof. 
S.  B.  Brown  is  First  Assistant  Geologist  and  Curator  of  the  Collections,  and 
Professor  J.  L.  Johnson  is  Assistant  Geologist. 

The  Hull  Scientific  and  Field  Naturalists'  Club  opened  its  winter  session  by 
an  Exhibition  and  Conversazione  which  ran  for  two  nights — namely,  November 
10th  and  11th,  from  7.30  to  10  p.m.  The  whole  of  the  exhibits  were  from  the 
collections  of  members  of  the  club,  and  testified  to  commendable  activity  in  many 
right  directions.  The  President  of  the  club  is  Dr  J.  Hollingworth,  and  the 
Secretary  is  T.  Sheppard,  78  Sherburn  Street,  Hull.  The  annual  subscription  is 
four  shillings. 


1897]  NEWS  431 

Science  announces  that  the  United  States  Geological  Survey  has  practically 
completed  the  distribution  of  the  Educational  Series  of  Rocks,  17")  suites  of  15G 
specimens  each  having  been  sent  out  during  the  past  summer  to  universities, 
colleges,  and  technical  institutions  in  the  United  States.  There  remains  a  small 
number  of  incomplete  sets,  wliich  will  be  placed  in  such  smaller  colleges  as  will 
make  them  most  useful.  The  Educational  Series  were  prepared  by  the  Survey 
with  much  care,  for  the  purpose  of  aiding  students  in  acquiring  a  general  and 
special  knowledge  of  rocks  and  promoting  the  study  of  geology. 

The  illustrations  of  geological  sections  as  aids  to  the  geologist  who  ventures 
into  a  museum  are  familiar  to  everyone  who  visits  the  museums  at  Jermyn  Street, 
Cromwell  Road,  and  many  places  on  the  Continent  and  in  America  ;  but  there  is 
one  particular  section — that  built  in  the  gardens  of  the  Landwirthschaftliche 
Institut  of  the  University  of  Halle,  in  honour  of  Dr  Julius  Kuehn — which  we  do 
not  think  has  been  brought  to  the  notice  of  readers  of  this  journal.  It  is  built  up 
of  the  rocks  themselves,  and  represents  a  section  through  the  mountainous  district 
of  north  and  middle  Germany.  This  very  striking  representation  of  geology  was 
described  by  Professor  K.  v.  Isitsch  as  long  ago  as  1891.  Besides  forming  an 
unique  memorial  to  Dr  Kuehn,  it  has  considerable  value  for  the  teaching  of 
geology. 

We  learn  from  the  Shooting  Times  that  the  Guildford  Natural  History  Society 
have  been  considering  the  question  of  the  preservation  of  Wolmer  Forest,  which 
is  only  fifteen  miles  from  that  town,  and  have  decided  to  present  a  petition  to  the 
Commissioners  of  Woods  and  Forests,  praying  that  Wolmer  Forest  may  be  reserved 
as  a  sanctuary  for  wild  birds,  in  which  they,  their  nests,  and  eggs  may  remain 
unmolested  throughout  the  year  ;  that  it  may  not  be  let  at  any  time  for  game 
preserving,  or  for  any  purpose  inimical  to  bird  life  ;  and  that  it  may  remain  in 
perpetuity  as  a  national  memorial  to  the  greatest  outdoor  naturalist  England  has 
produced — Gilbert  White  of  Selborne.  Such  a  recognition,  the  society  iirge, 
would  show  that  the  admiration  of  Gilbert  White  in  the  nineteenth  century  was 
so  practical  as  to  be  of  value  to  the  naturalist  and  the  English-speaking  race  for 
all  succeeding  time.  The  society  have  no  wish  to  attempt  to  interfere  with  the 
use  of  the  forest  by  the  War  Office  for  the  purposes  of  military  manoeuvres. 

An  editorial  comment  in  the  American  Naturalist  for  October  includes  some 
complimentary  remarks  on  the  British  Association,  which  will  be  read  in  this 
country  with  interest : — "  We  may  be  pardoned  if  we  point  out  some  features  in 
which  we  think  the  British  Association  superior  to  our  own.  In  the  first  place, 
the  Presidential  Addresses  delivered  before  the  British  Association  strike  us  as,  on 
the  whole,  better  than  those  with  which  our  audiences  are  greeted.  While  now 
and  then  an  American  address  will  rise  to  as  high  a  standard  as  anything  that 
Great  Britain  can  boast,  theirs  are  on  the  average  the  more  thoughtful  and 
scholarly,  while  ours  too  often  have  a  perfunctory  air  and  lack  in  breadth  of  view. 
In  personnel  of  those  who  attend,  the  British  Association  again  has  the  advantage. 
In  England  it  is  the  fashion  to  attend  these  annual  meetings,  and  no  one  there 
has  reached  such  a  pinnacle  of  greatness  that  he  can  afford  to  ignore  or  neglect 
this  national  society.  As  a  result,  at  their  gatherings  one  can  be  reasonably 
certain  of  meeting  most  of  those  who  are  the  leaders  in  English  scientific  thought. 
In  America,  on  the  other  hand,  the  tendency  is  in  the  other  direction.  It  would 
be  an  easy  matter  to  give  a  considerable  list  of  names  of  those  prominent  in 
American  science  whose  faces  are  never  seen  at  the  association  meetings." 


432  NATURAL    SCIENCE  [December 


CORRESPONDENCE 

LACEPEDE'S  TABLEAUX.  .  .  .  DES  MAMMIFERES  ET  DES  OISEAUX  ;   1799 

Lacepede' s  "Memoire  sur  line  nouvelle  table  methodique  des  animaux  a  mamelles  " 
was  read  before  the  Institute  on  21  Prairial  an  7  [9  June  1799].  It  was  published  in  the 
Memoires  de  l'lnstitut,  vol.  iii.,  in  1801.  Louis  Agassiz  quotes  the  table  as  Mem.  de 
l'lnstit.,  iii.,  1797,  an  obviously  incorrect  date  ;  but  many  others  have  quoted  it  as  1799 
without  giving  any  evidence  as  to  the  accuracy  of  the  quotation.  As  great  importance 
attaches  to  the  proper  date  of  this  paper,  it  became  necessary  for  me  to  investigate  the 
matter  carefully,  but  I  could  not  discover  any  definite  statement  except  that  of  Engel- 
mann,  who  in  his  Bibl.  Hist.  Nat.  1846,  p.  376,  refers  to  it  as  "in-4.  Paris,  an  vii. 
(1799).  Plassan.  (38  pag.)."  Up  to  the  present,  however,  I  have  completely  failed  to 
find  this  4to  tract ;  it  cannot  be  a  separate  of  the  Mem.  de  l'lnst.  paper  because  that  was 
printed  by  Baudouin,  and  Engelmann  gives  Plassan  as  the  printer  of  the  tract  ;  besides 
the  pages  of  the  Institute  paper  are  32  against  38  of  the  tract  referred  to  by  Engelmann. 
But  I  have  found,  quite  by  accident,  in  Didot's  issue  of  Buffon's  Hist.  Nat.,  18mo  Paris, 
76  vols.,  1799-1806,  in  the  xiv.  vol.  of  Quadrupedes,  this  interesting  tableau,  and  it  is 
dated  1799,  and  it  was  printed  by  Plassan.  The  title  of  the  two  papers  (for  the  birds 
are  included)  are  as  follows  :—"  Tableau  des  divisions,  sous-divisions,  ordres  et  genres 
des  Mammiferes,  Par  le  Cea  Lacepede  ;  Avec  l'indication  de  toutes  les  especes  decrites  par 
Buffon,  et  leur  distribution  dans  chacun  des  genres,  par  F.  M.  Daudin  "  (pp.  143-196). 

"Tableau  des  sous-classes,  divisions,  sous-divisions,  ordres  et  genres  des  Oiseaux, 
Par  le  Cen  Lacepede  ;  Avec  l'indication  de  toutes  les  especes  decrites  par  Buffon,  et  leur 
distribution  dans  chacun  des  genres,  par  F.  M.  Daudin  "  (pp.  197-346).  Both  of  these 
are  referred  to  as  one  tract,  "  in-18.  Paris,  1802.  Plassan,"  by  Engelmann,  Bibl. 
Hist.  Nat.  1846,  p.  322.  , 

It  will  be  noted  first— That  the  Genera  only  are  by  Lacepede  ;  and  secondly— that  all 
the  species  are  by  F.  M.  Daudin. 

As  the  period  1798-1801  is  a  critical  one  for  nomenclature,  I  need  do  no  more  than 
point  out  the  interest  of  this  recovery  ;  but  my  friend  Oldfield  Thomas  hopes  to  prepare 
an  analysis  of  the  Mammalia.  Ornithologists  will  find  many  interesting  points  to  con- 
sider in  nomenclature  when  comparing  the  above  paper  with  Daudin's  ' '  Traite 
Elementaire,"  which  it  undoubtedly  precedes. 

C.  Davies.Sherborn, 

17th  Nov.  1897.  INDEX  Animalium. 

Mr  R.  Quick  writes  from  the  Homimau  Museum,  that  an  examination  of  Mr  Harrison's 
collection  of  flints  from  the  Plateau  gravels  of  Kent  has  convinced  him  that  these  are 
truly  primitive  implements.  He  thus  agrees  with  Sir  Joseph  Pretwich,  and  considers 
that  Mr  Cunnington's  reasoning  in  our  last  number  (pp.  327-333)  is  not  cogent. 

Erratum.— Page  321,  line  25.     For  '  Siberian  '  read  '  Silurian.' 


NOTICE 

To  Contributors. — All  Communications  to  be  addressed  to  the  Editor  of  Natural 
Science,  at  29'  Bedford  Street,  London,  AV.C.  Correspondence  and  Notes  intended 
for  any  particular  month  should  be  sent  in  not  later  than  the  10th  of  the  preceding 

To  the  Trade. — Natural  Science  is  published  on  the  25th  of  each  month  ;  all 
advertisements  should  be  in  the  Publishers'  hands  not  later  than  the  20th. 

To  our  Subscribers  and  Others. — There  are  now  published  Ten  Volumes  of 
Natural  Science.  Nos.  1,  8,  11,  12,  13,  20,  23,  24  being  out  of  print,  can  only  be 
supplied  in  the  set  of  first  Four  Volumes.     All  other  Nos.  can  still  be  supplied  at  One 

Shilling  each. 

Price  of  Set  of  Vols.  I.,  II.,  III.,  IV £2  10    0 

„      V.,  VI.,  VII.,  VIII.  .         .         .14     0 

I!  „  „      I— VIII.  .         .  .         :       310     0 

One  Shilling  each  Number  of  any  Bookseller. 

Annual  Subscription,  payable  in  advance  to  J.  M.  Dent  &  Co:,  29  Bedford  Street, 
London,  W.C„  Thirteen  Shillings  ($3  -50),  post  free. 

CHANGE   OF  ADDRESS. 

Messrs  J.  M.  DENT  &  CO.  beg  to  give  notice  that  from  January  1,  1898, 
the  Publishing  and  Editorial  Offices  of  NATURAL  SCIENCE  will  be  removed 
to  their  new  premises,  29  Bedford   Street,  W.C. 


1897] 


433 


INDEX 


An  Asterisk  (*)  indicates  (hat  a  figure  is  given. 


*  ABBOTT,  W.   J.    L. ,  on  Hastings  Refuse 

Heaps,  40,  94. 
Aconcagua .  140 
Aepyornis,  149,  365 
"Aeronaut.  Journ.,"  60 
Agriculture,  Year  Book  of,  371 
Agricultural  Department,  an  Ideal,  372 
"  Agri.  Gaz.  N.S.W.,"  282,  293. 
Alaska.  138,139 

Albany  Mus.,  Graharastone,  142,  286,  336 
"  Albuquerque  Morning  Democrat,"  350 
Alca  i ut pi' a  a  >'*  in  Ireland,  149 
Algae,  Polymorphism  in,  107 
Anieghino,   F.,   on   Tertiary  Mammalia, 

256 
American  Assoc,  285 

,,         Geogr.  Soc,  353,  354 
"     „        Journ.  Sci.,"  135,  150,  222 
■"      ,,         Journ.  Psychol.,"  136,  349 

„         Mus.   Nat.  Hist.,  66,  68,  150, 
284,  2S6 
"      „  Nat.,"  282 

"     ,,         X-ray  Journ.,"  208 
Auckland  Institute,  69 
"  Anatom.  Anz.,"  80 
Andree  Expedition,  66,  145 
Andrews,  C.  W.,  211 
"Annals  of  Botany,"  86 
"       ,,  Inst.  Jamaica,"  351,  370 

"       „  Mag.  Nat.  Hist,"  226,  282 

"       ,,  Rep.  Missouri  Bot.  Garden," 

303 
*•       .,  Rep.  Ohio  State  Acad.  Sci.," 

208,  225 
"  Annee  Biol.,"  80,  81 
"Annotat.  Zool.  Jap.,"  82,  83,  85 
Antarctic  Continent,  Mammals,  221 
Antarctic  Exploration,  140 
"  L Anthropologic,"  154 
Anthropology,  68 
Ants  and  Mites,  8 
"AnuaruluMus.  Geol.,"  88 
*Apodidae,  397 
Appointments — 

Abbe,  C,  211 

Allin,  A.,  429 

Baldwin,  J.,  284 

Bardeen,  C.  R.,  211 

Baum,  H..  137 

Beck,  A.,  137 

Beecher,  C.  E.,  211 

Belajetr,  V.  I.,  284 

Bittner,  A..  66 

Blanchard,  R.,  284 

Boccardi.  G.  137 

Bolson,  P.,  211 

Boulton,  W.  S.,  13" 


Appointments — (continued) — 
Brault,  Dr,  137 
Bray,  W.  L.,  353 
Buttikofer,  J.,  137 
Bukowski,  G.  von,  66 
Campbell,  J.  R.,  137 
Carter,  W.  S.,  429 
Clark,  D.,  66 
Copeland,  E.  B.,  66,  211 
Crocichia,  A.,  137,  211 
Dabney,  C.  W.,  jun.,  66 
Dodge,  R.  E.,  137 
Emary,  Percy,  211 
Engelmann,  W.  I.,  137 
Erlanger.  Freiherr  von,  66 
Fassig,  O.  L.,  211 
Fischer,  E.,  211 
Fling,  H.,  211,  284 
Forbes,  E.  B.,  211 
Franz,  S.  I.,  137 
Freeh,  F.,  66 
Frey,  Max  von,  429 
Fuchs,  T.,  Dr,  137 
Garstang,  W.,  66 

Geikie,  A.  (Romanes  Lecturer),  429 
Geyer,  G.,  66 
Gorringe,  L. ,  137 
Heim,  L.,  137 
Hill,  A.,  353 
Howe,  H.  M.,  66 
Hume,  W.  F.,  137 
Jones,  H.  L.,  353 
Kauthack,  A.  A.,  429 
Karpinski,  A.  P.,  66 
Kate,  T.,  353 
Kaufmann,  E.,  66 
Kennedy,  F. ,  429 
Kerr.  J.  G.,  429 
Kihlmann,  A.  O.,  137,  284 
Eraemer,  H.,  211 
Kruse,  W.,  66 
Lang,  W.  H.,  66 
M  'Bride,  E.  W.,  137,  284 
MacGregor,  Jas.  H.,  137 
Maclean,  M. ,  66 
Martin,  J.,  137 
Matsumoto,  M..  137 
Mayr,  Dr.  137  ' 
Mitchell,  F.  A.,  211 
Moses,  A.  Y.,  66 
Miinsterberg,  H.,  211 
Muir,  137 

Muschketoff,  T.  Y.,  66 
Neal,  H.  V.,  284 
Nitsche,  L.,  353 
Norman,  W.  "W.,  284 
Osann,  A.,  2S4 


2  H 


434 


INDEX 


[1897 


Appointments — (continued) — 

Palladin,  V.  J..  284 

Paoletti,  J.,  211 

Peirce,  G.  Y.,  66 

Pennington,  M.  E.,  137 

Philippi,  137 

Pierce,  G.  J.,  211 

Pillsbury,  W.  B.,  137 

Pirsson,  L.  V.,  211 

Pocock,  T.  I.,  137 

Prevost,  Y.  L.,  66 

Pritehett,  H.  S.,  429 

Raciborski,  M.,  211 

Ransome,  F.  L.,  137 

Reusch,  H.,  353 

Richards,  H.  M.,  137 

Rodet,  284 

Rosiwal,  A.,  66 

Rothert,  W. ,  429 

Rnckert,  J.,  66 

Ruge,  G.,  284 

Samassa,  P.,  66 

Schneider,  A.,  211 

Seashore,  C.  E.,  Dr,  137 

Shattuck,  G.  B.,  211 

Sheen,  A.  W.,  429 

Sherman,  F.  D.,  211 

Slidell,  R.,  66 

Smith,  A.  A.,  284 

Stohr,  P.,  284 

Stoneman,  B.,  137,  211 

Stoss,  A.,  66 

Sutton,  W.  S.,  284 

Szadowski,  J.,  137' 

Thomayer,  J.,  66 

Thomson,  W.  E.,  284 

Tschirwinski,  Dr,  66 

Ule,  W.,  66 

Volkens,  G.,  Prof.,  137 

Vries,  H.  de,  284 

Watts,  W.  W.,  211 

Weyer,  E.  M.,  137 

Williamson,  H.  C,  211 

Wolters,  M.,  66 

Zehnter,  211 

Zelinka,  C,  353 

Zumstein,  J.  J.,  137 

Zwaardemaker,  P.,  353 
Apus,  79 
*A2nts  glacititis,  399 
Archaeology,  "The  Times"  on,  229 
"Arch.  Parasitol,"  351 
"    „       Roentgen  Ray,"  351 
"    ,,       Skiagraphy,"  351 
Arctic  Exploration,  366 
Arctic  Geology,  145 

,,     Ocean,  Warm  Undercurrent,  48 
Arthropods,  72 

,,  of  Funafuti,  5 

Arunta  Tribe,  119 
*  Assam  Earthquake,  231 
Ascomycctes,  86 
Aspidiotus,  226 
Assoc.  Franeaise,  137,  284 
Asterolepidae,  45 
Athelgue  anicidi,  7 
Atoll,  sec  Funafuti,  5 
Auckland  Inst.  Mus.,  69 
Australia,  Entomology,  292 


Australia,  Natural  History,  359 

Radiolaria,  229 
Australasian  Assoc,  139 
Australian  Mus.,   Sydney,    5,    143,  231r 

289,  360 
Azores,  Botany  of,  303 

Bacon  beetle,  7 

Bacteria  of  Black  Sea,  297 

Bacterium  in  Alcohol,  87 

Baffin  Land,  212 

Baikal,  Lake,  138 

Baly  Medal,  284 

Basic  dykes  in  India,  15 

Beards  on  Women,  2,  215 

Beaver  in  Norway,  300 

Bedstraws,  13 

Beer,  R. ,  on  seed  production,  337 

Beer,  R.,  Cells  or  Corpuscles,  392 

Bees  and  flower  development,  100  ;  and 

flowers,  35S 
Bennett,  A.  W.,  211 
"  Bergens  Mus.  Aarbog,"  300 
Berlin  Ac.  Sci.,  66  ;  awards,  213  ;  grants, 

353 
Berlin  Institute,  213 
*  Bernard,   H.    M.,    on    Fossil   Apodidae, 

397 
Bibliography  of  Science,  79 
Biol.  Soc. ,  Paris,  80 

,,     Training,  217 
Birds,  anatomy  of,  144  ;  Madagascar,  ex- 
tinct,   149  ;    protection    of,    75,    359  ; 

stomachs  of,  146 
Bison,  139 

Bivalves,  embryonic  shell,  10 
Blackman,  V.  H.,  139,  212 
Black  Sea,  297 
Bogdanov,  Anatole,  138 
Bolton  on  Provincial  Museums,  387 
Bonn  Univ.,  66 
Books  free  into  U.S.,  138 
Bootle  Mus.,  69,  353 
Born,  Gustav,  212 
"  Botanical  Gazette,"  14,  157 

,,  Soc.  of  America,  68,  356 

Botany  of  Azores,  303 
Study  of,  302 
Botrychium  lunaria,  141 
Boyle  Lecture,  66 
Brachiopoda,  American  Fossil,  367 
Brighton  Mus.,  354 
British  Assoc,  217,  285  ;  grants,  286 
British  Mus.,  3,  62,  63,  67,  132,  139,  190, 

191,  192,  194,  195,  203,  204,  212,  213, 

287,  298,  302,  348,  354 
Brittle-Star,  Japan,  84 
Brooklyn  Inst.  Mus.,  353 
Buckman  on  Bearded  Women.  215 
Buffalo  v.  Bison,  72 
"Bull.  Amer.  Mus.  Nat.  Sci.,"  150 
"     ,,     Boissier  Herbarium."  70 
"     ,,     Entomol.    U.S. 

fcure,",7 

"  ,,  Geol.  Surv.  Chicago,"  20S 
"  ,,  Inst.  Inter.  Bibl./'  79,  80 
"     „     Tech.  U.S.  Dept.  Agriculture,"  8T 

226 
"     ,,     U.S.  Dept.  Agriculture,"  146 


Dept.     Agricul- 


1897] 


INDEX 


435 


Bulman,  (i.  W..  on  Bees  and  Flower- 
Development,  100 

Bureau  of  Ethnology  for  Greater  Britain, 
355 

Buthus  brevicandatus,  6 

Buttercups,  13 

"Calcutta,  Earthquake,  -231 
"California,  Hopkins'  Lab.,  28 

,,  Insect  Control  in,  148 

,,  Univ.,  285 

Cambridge  (Engl.)  Mus.,  67,  348 
Cambridge     Univ.,    353  ;    Degrees     for 

Women,  1 
Camel  in  Europe,  88 
( 'ainelus  alutensis,  88 
Cape  Colony,  Prehistoric  Man,  334 
Cape  Town,'  S.  African  Mus.,  68,  286 
Carcinology,  251 
Carotin,  13 

Cavernicolous  Animals,  67 
Castor-Oil  Plant,  335 
Cells,  392 

Cells,  Models  of,  369 
Centrornis,  150 
Cephalaspidae,  45 
Cephalopods  of  Trias,  228 
Centra  vinula,  148 
Chalazogamy,  85 

Chalk  Rock,  Fossils  of  English,  157 
"Challenger"  Album,     3;    Reports,    3, 

354,  355 
"Chances  of  Death,"  Pearson's,  50 
Chcirocephalus,  79 
Chemistry,  plant,  12 

,,  in  museums,  215 

Ckcnalopex,  150 

Chicago  Univ.,  284  ;  Institute,  69 
Child's  mental  development,  293 
Chirodota  contorla,  226 
Chita  (Trans- Baikal)  Mus.,  69 
Chubut,  ethnology  of,  214 
Civilisation  and  Insects,  225 
Cockerell  on  Bees  and  Flowers,  358 
Collections — 

Cope,  E.  D.,  68 
Haviland  (Termites),  143 
Hoffmann  (Lepidoptera),  284 
Miiller-Argau  (Lichens,  &c. ),  70 
Rosen  (S.  African  horns),  354 
Savin  (Forest  Bed),  213 
Schauinsfeld  (Pacific),  430 
Seton-Karr's  Implements,  137 
Shaus  (Lepidoptera),  284 
Collinge  on  Slugs,  71 
Colouration,  protective,  224 
Commensalism,  8 
"  Comptes   Rendus   Acad.   Sci. ,    Paris," 

10 
Concilium  Bibliographicum,  285 
Congresses — 

Intern.  Bibliographic,  67 
,,      Postal,  139 
,,      Geological  (8th),  212, 294,  353 

(9th),  353 
,,      Medicine  and  Surgery,  67 
„      Ornith.,  354 
,,      ZooL,  354,  363 
Puss.  Nat.  and  Physicians,  139 


Cope  bequests,  68 

Copenhagen,  Nat.  Hist.  Mus.,  161,  162 

Coral  Reef  Poring,  142,  289.     See  Funa- 
futi 

Cornell  Univ.,  69 

Corpuscles,  392 

Costa  Rica,  Nat.  Mus.,  69 

Cothcnius  Medal,  '284 

Crustaceans  of  Funafuti,  6 

Crustacea  (Decapod),  pigments  of,  9 

Cuckoo,  nesting  of,  293 

Client  us  /in// ill us,  293 
*Cunnington,  W.,  on  Plateau  Man,  327 

Cut  flowers,  seed,  337 

Cycas,  85 

Cycads,  156 

,,       new  discovery  in,  85 

Darwin   Statue,   140,   212  ;   Theory  of 
Coral  Reefs,  289 

Danesdale  Graves,  139 

Darwinism  and  Design,  408 

Dates  of  Books,  16,  432 

David  exped.  to  Funafuti,  142 
*Dean,  B.,  on  Hopkins  Laboratory,  28 

Deaths  from  Wild  Animals  in  India,  430 

Decapods,  pigments  of,  9 

"Denkschr.  Akad.  Wiss.  Wien,"  228 

Derby  and  Mayer  Museum,  137 

Devizes  Mus.,  328 

Diatoms,  reproduction  of,  10 
* Dimorphodon  macronyx,  191 
*Dipeltis  carri,  399 
*Dipeltis  diplodiscus,  399 

Distribution,    geographical,    of    Dragon- 
Flies,  4 
"Distribution,  geogr.,  of  Foraminifera,  17 

Dragon-Flies,  geogr.  distr.,  4 

Dublin  Mus.,  223 

Duerden  on  work  in  Jamaica,  288 

Dyke-Rocks  from  S.  India,  15 

*Earthqtjake,  June  12,  1897,  231 
"East  Asia,"  135 
E.    London,    Cape    Colony,    prehistoric 

man,  334 
Echinoderms  of  Funafuti,  6 
Edentata,  origin  of,  150,  152 
Embryonic  Shell  of  Bivalves,  10 
Emary,  Percy,  211 
Entomology,  Australian,  292 
Epping  Forest  Mus.,  70 
"Essex  Naturalist,"  227 
Ethnology  of  Funafuti,  423 
Evolution,  240,  317 

,,  Karl  Pearson  on,  50 

,,         Woman's  Influence  in,  89 

, ,         Variation  in  Man  and  Woman, 

115 
,,         Reproductive  Divergence,  181 
Evans  on  Flint  Implements,  219 
Expeditions — 

Abruzzi  (Alaska),  288 

Andree,  66,  145 

Andrews  (Christmas  Island),  211 

Belgian  Antarctic,  67 

Bogdanovitch  (Kamtschatka),  138 

Bryant  (Alaska),  68 

Columbia  Univ.  (Alaska),  288 


436 


INDEX 


[1897 


Expeditions — {continued) — 
Conway  (Spitzbergen),  138 
David  (Funafuti),  142 
Dickson  (Fuego),  158 
Dmitrieff  (Abyssinia),  430 
Drizhenko  (Baikal),  138 
Evans  (Alaska),   139 
Fewkes  (Pueblo  Region),  138 
Fitzgerald  (Aconcagua),  140 
Haddon  (Torres  Straits),  67 
Jackson -Harmsworth,  224 
Nossilov  (Siberia),  353 
Peary,  68,  145 

Perkin's  (Sandwich  Isles),  67 
Port  Barrow  (Alaska),  138 
Putnam  (Anthropology),  68 
Rothschild  (Galapagos),  138 
Russ.  Geogr.  Soc.  (Roshan,  &c),  66 
Spurr  (Alaska),  354 
Wakeham  (Hudson's  Bay),  140. 

Exploration,  Polar,  145 

Explorations,  Sheldon  (Blue  Mts.),  66 

Fauna,  Irish,  223 
Fauna  of  Deep  Sea,  361 
Fauna,  protection  of,  75 
"  Feuille  Jeunes  Nat.,"  281,  349 
Fibre-plants,  a  catalogue  of,  373 
Fishes,  Atlantic,  301 
Field,  H.  H.,  285 
Flint  Implements,  219 
"  Flora  of  British  India,"  355 
Flora,  protection  of,  75 
Flowers  and  Bees,  100 
Flowers,  Seed  Production  of  Cut,  337 
Fluckioer  Medal,  284 
*Foraminifera,  distribution  of,  17 
Forest-bed  Vertebrata,  213 
Foster,  Michael,  354 
Franz  Josef  Land,  224 
Freezing  of  Plants,  230 
"  Frou-frou"  and  Feathers,  76 
Funafuti,  5,  6,  231,  289,  359,  360,  423 
Fungi  and  their  hosts,  86 

Gadow  on  Anat.  of  Birds,  144 
Galapagos  Exped.,  138 
Ganodonta,  151,  152 
Gardening,  school  of,  213 
Gee  Fellowship,  213 
Geogr.  Inst,  of  Lisbon,  212 
Geol.  Congress,  294 
Geological  Nomenclature,  321 
Geological  Sections  in  Museums,  431 
Geol.  Survey  of  Canada,  354 
Geol.  Soc.  France,  284 
Geol.  Survey  of  Japan,  140 
Geologists'  Assoc,  211 
Geology,  Arctic,  145 
Geology  in  N.S.  Wales,  232 
Geol.  Survey  of  C.  Colony,  286 
Geol.  Survey  of  United  Kingdom,  77 
German  Assoc.  Nat.,  212 
German  Botan.  Soc,  212 
German  Zool.  Soc,  212 
Qingko,  new  discovery  in,  85 
dill  on  Oceanic  Ichthyology,  71 
Glands  in  Insects,  148 
Glasgow  Mus.,  131 


Grahamston,  Albany  Mus.,  141,  286,  336 
Granivorous  Insects,  7 
Graptolites  in  N.S.  AVales,  232 
Great  Auk,  in  Ireland,  149 
Great  Britain,  Geology,  77 
Greenland,  Undercurrent,  48 

Map  of  E.  Coast,  67 
Grehant,  Louis,  67 
Godman,  F.  Ducane,  66 
Golden  Eagle,  72 
Government    and    Provincial    Museums, 

74 
Giinther,  R.  T.,  211 

Halifax,  Nat.  Hist.  Mus.,  69 
*Halitherium,  298 

Hamilton  Biol.  Station,  139 

Harkness  Scholarship,  139 

Hartog,  M.,  on  Heredity,  233,  305 

Harvard  Univ.,  213 
■"Hastings,  Kitchen  Middens,  40,  94 

Helix  hortensis  fossil,  228 

Hemlock  Lake  Biol.  Station,  138 

Henslow,  G.,  on  Natural  Selection  among 
Plants,  166 

Heredity,  233,  305 

,,  of  Acquired  Modifications,  247 

Hill,  Alexander,  353 

"Hirondelle"  Fishes,  301 

Holmes,  E.  M.,  284 

Holothuria,  brood  in,  226 
,,  spicules,  83 

Hooker,  Sir  J.  D. ,  355 

Hope  College,  285 
*Hopkins'  Laboratory,  28 

Howorth,  H.  H.,  on  Geological  Arrange- 
ment and  Nomenclature,  321 

Hull  Scientific  Club,  141,  354,  430 

Human  Race,  AVoman  and  Evolution  of, 
89 

Humphry  Library,  212 

Hutchinson  Scholarship,  139 

Hutton,   F.    W.j  on  Organic  Evolution, 
240 

Hyatt,  A.,  on  Woman  and  Evolution,  89 

*  Iclithijosaurus  communis,  193 

Illinois  Hospital  Laboratory,  429 

Inheritance  of  acquired  characters,  357 

India,  basic  dykes  in,  15 

India,  facetted  pebbles  of,  197 

Indiana  Acad.  Sci.,  285 
"Indian  Earthquake,  231 

Indianopolis  Botan.  Garden,  355 

Insects,  North  American  Granivorous,  7 
,,       glands  in,  148 
,,       Control,  California,  148 
,,       of  N.  America,  225 

"  Intermediare  Biol.,"  281 

International  Floating  Biological  Station, 
297 

Internat.  Geol.  Congress,  294 

"Inter.  Journ.  Micros.  Nat.  Sci.",  350 

Internat.  Postal  Congress,  139 

Irish  Fauna,  origin  of,  223 

Irish  Field  Club  Union,  211 

"  Irish  Naturalist,"  135,  149 

Iron  and  steel  testing,  70 

Isolation  as  factor  of  Evolution,  240 


1897] 


INDEX 


437 


Jackson  legacies,  2S  1 

Japan,  Botanical  Discovery,  85 

,,      Brittle  Star,  84 

,,     Natural  Science,  82 
Jamaica,  212 

,,      Biology  in.  28* 

,,     Johns  Hopkins  at,  138 

,,      Institute,  288 

,,      New  Serial  tor,  370 
Jeffrey,  John,  87 
"Jersey  Evening  Post,"  229 

,,        Lobster  Fishery,  229 

,,        Nat.  Sci.  Assoc.,  212,  2S7,  430 

,,       Proposed  Mus.,  212 
"    ,,        Times,"  229 
Jennyi]  Street  Mus.,  214 
Jordan,  K..  on  Reproductive  Divergence, 

317 
"Journ.  Coll.  Sci.,  Tokyo,"'  153 
"      ,,     Conchyliol,"  16 
"       „      Geol.,"61 
"       ,,      Malacol,"61 
««      ,,      Morph.,"  135 
"       „      NY.  Entoni.  Soc,"  208,  225 
"       ,,      Physiol.,"  9 
"       ,,  -    School  Geog.,"  60 
Jubilee  Honours,  list  of,  141 

Kamtschatka  Exped..  138 
Kelvingrove  Mus.,  131 
Kidd  on  inheritance  of  acquired  charac- 
ters, 357 
"Kitchen  Middens,  Hastings,  40,  94 
Kitson,  R.  H.,  139 
Klebs,  G.,  on  Algae,  107 
Kolliker,  A.  von,  284 
Koch  and  Rinderpest,  284 

Laboratory  for  testing  iron  and  steel, 

70 
Lacepede's  Tableaux,  432 
"  Lancet,"  351 
Lankester,  E.  Ray,  on  Pteraspidae,  &c, 

45 
La  Plata  Mus.,  353 
Lenian  Missouri  Edueat.  Assoc,  285 
Lepi<loptera,  Neuration  of,  374 
Lichenotheca  Universalis  Miiller-Argau, 

70 
Literature — 

Carcinology,  255 
Flowers  and  insects,  106 
Reptiles  extinct,  190 
See  also  Bibliography. 
Little  Barrier  Island,  69 
Liverpool  Mus.,  137 
Lobster  Fishery,  229 
Louisiana  Soc.  Mus.,  354 
Louisiana  Soc.  Nat.,  354,  429 
Lowell  Lectures,  354 
Liitken,  C.  F. ,  on  Steenstrup,  159 
Lyons  Univ.,  355 

M'Coy,  Sir  F.,  211,  429 
M'Kay,  G.  R.,  on  Antiquity  of  Man  in 
Cape  Colony,  334 
,,  on  Castor  Oil  Plant,  335 
Madagascar,  149  ;  extinct  Birds,  149 
,,  Experiment  Station,  211 


Malpighi  Statue,  285 

Mammalia,  Tertiary,  256 

Mammals    of  Lost  Antarctic  Continent, 
221 
,,         Origin  of  Edentata,  150 
,,         Protection  of,  75 

Manchester  .Micro.  Soc,  78 
,,  Mus.  35  I 

Man,  Prehistoric,  334 

Marine  Biol.  Assoc,  287 
•Marine  Biol.  Lab.,  28 

Marsupials,  290 

Mayenec,  Mus.  298 

Medicinal  Plants  of  North  Amer.,  353 

Megrim  and  Cod,  216 

Mental  development  of  child,  293 

Miall  on  Biology,  219 

Mias,  359 

Micromotoscope,  the,  149 

Microscopy  and  photography,  149 

Mimicry,  224 

Mississippi    Summer  School  of  Biology, 
137 

Missouri  Botan.  Gai'den,  138 

Moellendorff,  O.  F.  von,  284 

Mollusca,  Brit.  Pleist.,  227 

Monotremes,  Temperature,  290 

Montana  Univ.,  137 

Moonwort  in  Yorkshire,  141 

Moscow  Univ.  Mus.,  69 

Miiller-Argau  Collection,  70 

Midler  Botan.  Soc,  138 

Miillerornis,  1 50 

Murray,  George,  212 
*Murray,  J.,  on Foraminifera  Distribution, 
17 

Museums,  3,  5,  62,  63,  66,  67,  68,  69, 
70,  74,  131,  132.  134,  137,  138,  139, 
140,  141,  142,  143,  150,  155, 161, 162, 
190, 191, 192,  194,  213,  214,  215, 223, 
283,284,  286,  287,  288,  289,  298.  302, 
328,  336,  348,  353,  354;  355,  360.  387. 
See  under  name  of  town 

Mus.  Hist.  Nat.,  Paris,  67,  155,  286 

Mus.  Pract.  Geol.,  214 

Museums,  215 

,,         and  Lecture  Rooms  Syndicate, 

143 
„         provincial,  74 
,,         Assoc,  74,  131 

Nansen,  354 

"Naturalist,"  12,  135 

Natural  Science  in  Japan,  82 

Natural  Selection  among  Plants,  166 

"Nature,"  145 

"Nauch.,  Oboz.,"  60 

"  New  Age,"  350 

Newberry  Fund,  67 

New  Brunswick  N.  H.  Soc,  287 

New  Guinea,  spear-throwers,  156 

"  Neues  Jahrb.  Min.,"  81 

New  South  Wales,  232 

New  York  Botan.  Garden,  213 

„         Nat.  Hist.  Mus.,  66 

,,  Zool.  Park,  36 

North  America,  Insects,  7 
N.  Atlantic  Fishes,  301 
Norway,  Beaver,  300 


438 


INDEX 


[1897 


Obituaries — 

Abbadie,  A.  T.  d\  65 
Acbon,  H.  d',  65 
Allport,  S.,  283 
Archer,  W.,  352 
Asclian,  C.  Q.,  210 
Auerbacb,  L.,  428 
Bastin,  E.  S.,  65 
Beclard,  F.,  210 
Biart,  L.,  65,  210 
Bodington,  A.,  65 
Breitenlolmer,  J.,  65 
Brodie,  P.  B.,  426 
Bueknill,  J.  Chas.,  209 
Bugnion,  C.  J.  J.  M.,  65 
Calderwood,  H.,  428 
Calori,  L.,  428 
Calvert,  J. ,  428 
Carter,  H.  V.,  65 
Chudzinski,  Th.,  210 
Console,  M.  A.,  210 
Cross,  J.  E.,  65 
Deroubaix,  Dr,  65 
Devvevre,  A.,  65 
Dickson,  O.,  65 
Dollfus,  Mme.,  65 
Douglas,  R.,  210 
Drechsel,  E.,  428 
Elias,  N.,  209 
Feulard,  Dr,  65 
Fissore,  G.,  428 
Franks,  A.  \V.,  62 
Green,  T.,  Qb 
Gregory,  E.  L. ,  65 
Le  Gros,  E.,  428 
Hamilton,  J.,  65 
Haucrbton,  S.,  428 
Heddle,  M.  F.,  428 
Heiberg,  H.,  428 
Heidenhain,  R.,  428 
Heydenreich,  G.,  210 
Hofer.  D.,  210 
Hodgkinson,  J.  B.,  65 
Holmgren,  Dr,  352 
Hollander,  L.,  65 
Horn,  W.,  65 
Humphrey,  J.  E.,  352 
Hunter,  R.,  210 
Huth,  E.,  352 
James,  J.  F.,  65 
Johnston,  Thos.  B.,  283 
Jones,  J.  W.,  210 
Jordan,  A.,  65 
Jullien,  J.,  210 
Juranyi,  L. ,  65 
Kessler,  H.  F.,  65 
Keyser,  P.  D.,  65 
Klatt,  F.  W.,  65 
Knabe,  210 
Kolbel,  K.,  65 
Kortschagin,  A.  N.,  65 
Kubary,  J.  S.,  65 
Laing,"  S.,  209 
Lemoine.  J.,  65 
Liebenon,  W.,  352 
Linell,  M.  L.,  65 
Macfarland,  J.  E.,  65 
Magi  tot,  E.,  65 
Maelure,  E.,  352 


Obituaries — [continued) — 

Malmgren,  A.  J.,  210 

Manen,  L.,  65 

Marine,  W.,  428 

Matthews,  A.,  427 

Mietsehke,  428 

Millais,  E.,  283 

Mojsisovics,  A.,  352 

Moquart,  A.,  210 

Mueller,  F.,  64 

Midler,  D.,  210 

Neminar,  E.,  65 

Nevill,  H.,  65 

Nobile,  A.,  210 

Oertel,  Prof.,  210 

Ossowski,  G.,  210 

Pasquier,  L.  du,  65 

Petzold,  K.  W.,  352 

Piper,  G.  H.,  428 

Plugge,  P.  C,  210 

Pulsky,  F.  A.,  283 

Robertson,  C.  A.  L.f  65 

Ross,  A.  M.,  428 

Roy,  C.  S.,  352,  426 

Russow,  E. ,  65 

Sachs,  J.  von,  63 

Sakaki,  S.,  65 

Salter,  S.  J.  A.,  210 

San  Leon,  V.  T.  di,  210 

Schmidt,  E.,  352 

Scholz,  Ch.,  65 

Schutzenberger,  P.,  210 

Sclater,  B.  L.,  209 

Scott,  W.,  428 

Seelig,  F.,  65 

Sintenis,  M. ,  428 

Steenstrup,  Johannes  J.  S. ,  88,  159 

Stocquart,  A.,  65 

Stoeber,  296 

Straub,  F.  C,  210 

Sutton,  A.,  210 

Teinturier,  J.  M.,  65 

Traill,  G.  W.,  65 

Travis,  I.  N.,  428 

Trumbull,  J.  H.,  352 

Tunner,  P.,  210 

Verlot,  P.  B.  L.,  210 

Vogel,  K.,  352 

Volger,  O.,  428 

Wankel,  H.,  65 

Watson,  E.  Y.,  427 

Welcher,  Dr,  352 

Wells,  Chas.  F.,  210 

Wight,  R.  A.,  210 

Wilckens,  M.,  210 

Wolfert,  Dr,  210 
Oceanic  Ichthyology,  71 
Ogilby    on   Australian   Nat.    Hist,    and 

Funafuti,  359 
Obio  State  Univ.,  213 
Oldham,  R.  D.,  on  facetted  pebbles,  197 
Ophiurid,  Japan,  83 
Ord  on  Museums,  215 
Oregon  Botan.  Assoc,  87 
Organic  Evolution,  240 
Orgyin,  8 
Orizaba,  140 

Ostracoderms  of  Cope,  144 
Ova  of  Vertebrate,  153 


1897] 


INDEX 


439 


Owen's  College,  353 

Packard  on  artheopods,  72 
Pamir  Dwarfs,  67 

Parasites,  7,  8,  86 
*Paria8auru8  baini,  195 

Paris  Mus.  Hist.  Nat.,  67,  155,  286 

Patagonia,  12 1  I 

Patagonian  geology,  221,  222,  364 

Pearson,    Karl,    on    Evolution,    50 ;    on 
Variability,  115 

Pebbles,  facetted,  197 

Peel  Park  Mus.,  Salford,  132 

Pennsylvania  Univ.  Mus.,  139 

"  Pensiero  Moderna,"  208 

Peoria  Univ.,  285 

Perthshire  Nat.  Hist.  Mus.,  131,  354 
,,  Soc.  Nat.  ScL,  35  1 

Phenacomys,  3 

Philadelphia  Acad.  Sci.,  287 

••  Photogram,"  60,  135 

Photography  of  moving  organisms,  149 

Physiology  of  the  senses,  69 

Phyllopods,  British,  7'.' 

Pigments  of  Decapods,  9 

Pinus  Jeffreyi,  87 

Plant-Chemistry,  12 

Plants,  Freezing  of,  230 

,,       Natural  Selection,  166 
,,      and  the  Weather,  12 
•Plateau  Man,  327 

Pleistocene  Mollusca,  British,  227 
*Plesio8auru8  rostratus,  193 

Pleurotomaria  beyrichi,  139 

Plon  Biol.  Station,  66,  138 

Polar  Exploration,  145 

"  Policlinico,"  80 

Polymorphism  in  Algae,  107 
*Portraits,  "Challenger,"  3 

Postages  on  specimens,  139 

"Press,"  Christchurcb,  N.Z.,  60 

Pribyloff  Islands,  survey,  67 

Primroses,  13 

"Proc.  Biol.  Soc.,  Washington,"  4,  87 

"      ,,     Geol.  Ass.,"  227 

"      ,,     Linn.  Soc,"  156,  229,  282,  292 

"      ,,     Roy.  Irish  Acad.,"  61,  223 

"      ,,     Roy.  Soc.,"  61 

"      ..     R.  Soc,  Dublin,"  4 

"      „     Roy.  Soc,  Edin.,"  11 

"      ,,     Roy.  Soc,  Victoria,"  282,  291 
* Protocaris  marslii,  399 

"  Psychol.  Review,"  293,  350 

Psychology,  69 

Pteraspidae,  45 

Publications,  False  Dates  of,  16 

Purpurin,  13 

"Puss  "moth,  148 

"  Quart.  Journ.  Geol.  Soc,"  158,  282 
Quart.  Journ.  Micros.  ScL,  61,  217,  282 
Quick,  R.,  on  Plateau  Man,  432 

Radcliffe  Lirrary,  70,  429 
Radiolaria,  Pre-Cambrian,  229 
Raffles  Mus.,  Singapore,  141 
Rath,  G.  von,  66 

"  Rec  Geol.  Surv.,  India,"  15,  231 
"Rep.  Geol.  Surv.,  N.S.W.,"  232 


"Rep.  Geol.  Surv.,  U.K.,"  77 
*Reports,  "Challenger, "contributors to,  3 

Reproduction  of  Diatoms,  10 
Reproductive  Divergence,  181,  317,  401 
*  Reptiles,  Restoration  of  extinct,  190 
,,        temperature,  290 
Reviews — 

Acloque's  Faune  de  France,  130 
"Aeronautical  Annual,"  1897,  60 
L'Annee  Biologkpue,  80 
Austral.  Mus.  Funafuti  Mem.,  5,  231, 

423 
Baron's  Madagascar  Geology,  281 
Bateman's  Vivarium,  3  11 
Bonney's  William  Pengelly,  346 
Brit.  Mus.  Fossil  Invertebrates,  132 
Bryan  and  Rosenberg's  Mechanics  of 

Fluids,  276 
Campbell's  Bibliography,  342 
"Challenger"  Portraits,  3 
Collett's  Poissons.  301 
Concise  Natural  History,  205 
Crick  and  Foord's  Fossil  Cephalopoda, 

Part  III.,  203 
Davies'  Physiography,  275 
Dawson's  Primeval  Life,  133 
Delage  and  Herouard's  Zoologie  Con- 
crete, 200 
Dolbear's  Natural  Philosophy,  276 
Drude's  Geographie  Botanique,  207 
Foord  and  Crick's  Fossil  Cephalopoda, 

Part  III.,  203 
Foster-Barham's  Westmorelandshire's 

Field  Geology,  134 
Geikie's  British  Volcanoes,  55 
Geikie's  Founders  of  Geology,  415 
Gill's  Our  Naturalists,  134 
Gray's  N.  Amer.  Flora,  340 
Hansen's  Choniostomatidae,  271 
Harrison's  Geology,  276 
Herouard  and  Delage's  Zoologie  Con- 
crete, 200 
Hertwig's  Zoologie,  128 
Hofmann's    Beetle-collector's    Hand- 
book,  130 
Holland's   Hill-slopes  around  Naini- 

Tal,  279 
Kirby's  Lepidoptera,  206 
Koken's  Leitfossilien,  269 
Lewis'  Diamond,  278 
Martin's  Nature-Chat,  344 
Merrill's  Death  of  Rocks,  417 
Miall's  Round  the  Year,  59 
Munro's  Prehistoric  Problems,  273 
Museums  Assoc.  Rep.,  131 
Ogilvie's     Madreporarian     Types     of 

Corals,  124 
Paget's  John  Hunter,  346 
Parker's  Biology,  348 
Parker's   Wiedersheim's   Vertebrates. 

348 
Pearson's  Chances  of  Death,  &c,  50 
Pelseneer's  Zoologie,  340 
Pengelly's  William  Pengelly,  346 
Poirault's     Drude's    Geographie    Bo- 

tanique,  207 
Reynold's  Vertebrate  Skeleton,  347 
Ribot's     Psychology     of     Emotions, 
343 


440 


INDEX 


[1897 


Reviews — (continued) — 

Rosenberg  and  Brvan's  Mechanics  of 

Fluids,  276 
Russel's  Volcanoes  of  N.  America,  421 
Saville-Kent's  Naturalist  in  Australia, 

265 
Schiller   on    Darwinism  and    Design, 

408 
Skertchly's  Physical  Geography,  275 
Scherren's  Through  a  Pocket- Lens,  129 
Schniewind-Thies'Septalnectarien,  277 
Scripture's  New  Psychology,  343 
Trouessart's   Catalogus    Mammalium, 

424 
Wilson's  Applied  Nature,  280 
"  Rev.  G6n.  Botan.,"  60 
"Rev.  Ital.  Sociol.,"  60 
"  Rev.  Mus.  Paulista,"  351 
"Rev.  Nueva,"  61 
"Rev.  Quindic  Psicol.,"  61 
"Rev.  Sci.,"  2 
Rliinoceros   in    Singapore,    359  ;    tichor- 

hinus  skin,  141 
*Ridewood,  W.  G. ,  on  Extinct  Reptiles,  190 
Ridley  on  Birds  and  Mammals  of  Singa- 
pore, 359 
Rocks,  Death  of,  417 
Romanes  Lecturer,  429 
Royal  Botanic  Society,  213 
Rum,  bad,  87 
Russia,  geology  of,  294 
St  Petersburg  Zool.  Mus.,  141 
Salamander,  Giant,  at  Paris,  138 
Salford,  Peel  Park  Mus.,  132 
Salix,  14,  143 

San  Francisco  Zool.  Gardens,  66 
Santa  Cruz  formation,  222 
Surcidiomis,  150 
Schleswig-Holstein  Mus.,  131 
"Science,"  61,  208,  281 
Science  in  Elementary  Schools,  69 
"Scientific  American,"  149 
Schafer,  E.  A.,  284 
Sclcrotinia  hetcroica,  86 
'  Scot.  Geog.  Mag.,"  60,  134,  158 
"Scot.  Med.  Surg.  Journ.,  281 
*Sclater,  P.  L.,  on  Zool.  Park,  N.Y.,  36 
*Sea-Co\v,  29S 
Sea-Cucumbers,  83 
Sebastopol  Biol.  Stations,  137 
Seed  Production  of  Cut  Flowers,  337 
Selborne  Society,  76 
Seton-Karr's  Implements,  137 
Shell  in  Bivalves,  Embryonic,  10 
Sherborn,  C.  Davies,  211 

,,  on  Lacepede's  Tableaux,  432 

Shrewsbury  Mus.,  140 
Sliute  Scholarship,  67 
Singapore,  Rattles  Mus.,  141 
Sinclair  on  Funafuti,  360 
Sirenia,  the,  223,  298 
Slugs,  71 
Smith,  B.  Leigh,  on  Arctic  Undercurrent, 

48 
Smithsonian  Inst.,  353 
Society  helo^tique,  139 
Sommering  Prize,  212 
Sofia  Univ..  355 
Solifugae,  226 


Solpuga,  226 

Somerset  Arch.  Nat.  Hist.  Soc,  287 

S.  America,  Edentate  Mammals,  152 
,,  Mammals.  221 

,,  Tertiary  Mammalia,  256 

S.  African  Republic  Museum,  286 
,,  Museum,  68,  286 

South-Eastern  Union  of  Sci.  Soc,  70,  73, 
214 

S.  India,  Basic  Dyke-Rocks,  15 

Spanish  Universities,  67 

Spendiarov,  L.,  355 

,,  Fund,  355 

Spear-throwers,  156 

Springfield  Zool.  Club,  138 

Spitzbergen,  Undercurrent,  48 

Stebbing,  T.  R.  R. ,  on  Carcinology,  251 
*Steenstrup,  J.  J.,  88,  159 

Stomachs  of  Birds,  146 

Stratigraphical  Geology,  364 

"  Studies  from  Nature,"  281 

Swansea  Mus. ,  353 

Swansea  Univ.  College,  353 

Swedish  Arctic  Expedition,  366 

Sydney,   Australian  Mus.,   5,    143,  231, 
289,  360 

Tansley,  A.  G.     See  Klebs  on  Algae 

Taunton  Mus. ,  287 

Tayler,  J.  L.,  on  Acquired  Modifications, 

247 
Technical  Education  Grant,  73 
"Technol.  Quart,"  282 
Temperatures  of  Vertebrates,  290 
Termites  of  Australia,  292 
Tertiary  Mammalia,  256 
*Thomson,  Chas.  Wyville,  3 
Thomson,  Joseph,  66 
Thurlow  Meteorite,  354 
Tierra  del  Fuego,  158 
Titanus  Gold  Medal,  66 
"  Timehri,"  351 
"Times"  on  Archaeology,  219 
Tokyo  Imp.  Coll.  tSci.,  67 
Training  of  Biologists,  217 
"Trans.  Entotn.  Soc,  London,"  148 
"Trans.  Manchester  Micros.  Soc,"  78 
"Trans.  N.Y.  Acad.  Sci.,"  61 
"Trans.  Perth  Soc.  Nat.  Sci.,"  350 
"Trans.  S.  E.  Union  Sci.  Soc,"  73 
Trefoils,  13 
Trepanning,  154 
Triassic  Cephalopoda,  228 
Tribonyx,  150 
Trinidad,  212 

Undercurrent  in  Arctic  Ocean,  48 
US.  Dept.  Agriculture,  148 
U.S.  Geolog.  Survey,  431 
U.S.  Nat.  Mus.,  138,  213,  288 
Univ.  Coll.,  Liverpool,  213 
Univ.  Degrees  for  Women,  1 

,,      Extension  Lectures,  355 

,,      of  London,  214 
Urumiya,  Lake,  211 

Variability,  scientific  measure  of,  115 
Vernon,  H.  M. ,  on  Reproductive  Diverg- 
ence, 181,  404 


1897] 


INDEX 


441 


Yertebrata,  Ova  of,  153 
Virginia,  Geol.  Survey  of  W.,  285 
Victoria  Institute,  Worcester,  140 
"  Victorian  Naturalist,"  293 
Volcanoes  of  N.  America,  421 

Washington  Zool.  Park,  353 

Wasps  and  Weather,  368 

Weather  and  Plants,  12 

Weather  and  Wasps,  368 

Weldon,   W.   F.   R.,  on    Karl   Pearson's 

"Chances of  Death,"  50 
"Westminster  Review,"  69,  135 
Whidbome's  Devonian  types,  143 
White,  Alex.,  284 
Whitechapel  Public  Library,  14,  355 

,,  Mus.,  140,  355 

Whyte,  Alex.,  139 
Willows,  14,  113 
Wiltshire  Library,  67 
Winchester  Col.  Mus.,  70 
Wing  Ncuration  of  Lepidoptera,  374 
Wuhner  Forest,  preservation  of,  431 
Women  at  Cambridge,  1 


of  the  future, 
bearded,  2,  215 
and  feathers,  76, 


359 


Women  in  Univ.  of  Chicago,  284 
,,       Influence  in  Evolution,  89 

Woodward,  A.  S.  on  Cope's  Ostracoderms, 
144 

Wood-bison,  139 

Woodward,  Henry,  212 

Woodwardian  Mus.,  67 

Worcester  Mus.,  140,  141 


Yale  Univ.,  213,  355 
"Year  Book  U.S.  Dept 
Yellow  Fever  Bacillus,  285 


Agric.,' 


208 


Zamia,  157 

Zamias,  156 

"Zeitschr.  Pflanz.  krank.,"  86 

"Zool.  Anz.,"80,  226 

"     ,,     Bull.,"  135 

"     ,,     Forsch.  Austral.  ;  Malay.  Archi- 

pel.,"  223 
"     ,,     Jahr.  Ber.,"81 

,,     Mus.  Cambridge,  348 

,,     Park,  N.Y.,  36 
"     ,,     Rec,"  81 

,,     Soc.  Medal,  139 
Zurich,  Mus.,  197 
Zwaardemaker,  Dr,  66 


2  I 


Ai^H 


'3 


'-O 


■J>( 


'#&. 


Sv  u